The website is undergoing scheduled maintenance.
Sorry for the inconvenience. Come back a bit later, we will be ready soon!

Cause = WordPress maintenance mode is enabled for the website manually. A plugin update probably didn’t complete.

Resolution = Go into wordpress toolkit. At the server level or hosting account level switch off the checkbox Maintenance mode. If it’s already off… Toggle it.

Moving QTS to M.2 SSD while Keeping shared folders on HDD.

  1. Back up everything important to external storage or cloud.
  2. Shut down and back up VMs from Virtualization Station to a shared folder.
  3. Back up system config via Control Panel.
  4. Select “Safely Detach” for the TR-004 enclosure in the External RAID manager if you have one. Remove attached USB devices. Shut down the enclosure once that is done.
  5. Select the main storage pool in Storage & Snapshots manager and do “Safely Detach” as well. See this article for details.
  6. Shut down NAS and remove all the drives, then power it up, log into QTS and do “Reinitialize NAS” via Control Panel. M.2 SSD drives should be installed for QNAP to add the OS there.
  7. Once the NAS is restarted, use Qfinder Pro to set up the NAS. Format SSDs as RAID1 and let QTS use it as the system volume.
  8. Log in and restore the system config from previously saved file.
  9. Shut down NAS, insert all the drives and boot it back up. Go to Storage & Snapshots and do “Scan and recover storage space” on the NAS. The system should recover the storage pool and volumes.
  10. Power up the TR-004 and do the “Scan and recover storage space” again.
  11. Reinstall the necessary apps. Start up Virtualization Station and recover the VMs from the backups.

Johnson Controls Commercial Refrigeration

For the latest product updates, visit us online at johnsoncontrols.com,

search commercial refrigeration

BUILDING EFFICIENCY

Refrigeration Products Catalog

Single-Stage Electromechanical Temperature Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-17 Single-Stage Electronic Temperature Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-44

Multi-Stage Electromechanical Temperature Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-59

Multi-Stage Electronic Temperature Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-74

Temperature Control Sensors and Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-79

Standard Electromechanical Pressure Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-85

Single-Stage Electronic Pressure Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-103 Electromechanical Lube Oil and Differential Pressure Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . R-105 Electronic Lube Oil and Differential Pressure Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-111 Pressure Sensors and Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-114

Refrigerant Sensors/Monitors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-125

Liquid Level and Flow Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-127

Motor Speed Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-137

Valves and Valve Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-145

Relays and Transformers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-190

System 450 Control Series . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-192

Cross-Reference . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-223

Table of Contents

Single-Stage Electromechanical Temperature Controls . . . . . . R-17

A11 Series Low Temperature Cutout

Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-17

A19 Series Remote Bulb Control . . . . . . . . R-19 A19 Series High Range Temperature

Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-21

A19 Series Thermostat for Crop Drying. . R-22 A19 Series Hot Water Temperature Control

(Well Immersion) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-23

A19 Temperature Control Less Enclosure (SPDT, Close Differential) . . . . . . . . . . R-24

A19 Series Thermostat for Hazardous Locations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-25

A19 Series Coiled Bulb Space

Thermostat. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-26

A19 Thermostat for Portable Heaters (Chain Mount and Drop Cord

Electrical Connection) . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-27 A19 Thermostat for Portable Cooling

Applications (Chain Mount and

Drop Cord Electrical Connection) . . . . R-28 A19 Series Automatic Changeover with

Strap-On Mounting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-29

A19D Series Surface Mounted

Temperature Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . R-30 A19 Flange Mounted Duct Thermostat . . . R-31 A19 Series Fan or Cutout Control

(Liquid Expansion Bulb) . . . . . . . . . . . . R-32

A19 Temperature Control with Rainproof Enclosure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-33

A19 Agricultural/Industrial Thermostat with NEMA 4X Enclosure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-34

A19 Industrial Thermostat (Watertight and Dusttight) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-35

A19 Temperature Control with NEMA 4X Enclosure (Remote Bulb). . . . . . . . . . R-36

A19 Water Chiller Control with Locked

Cut-Out/Adjustable Cut-In . . . . . . . . . . R-37 A19 Defrost Duration and Fan Delay

Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-38

A25 Series Warm Air Limit Control with

Manual Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-39

A70 Series Four-Wire, Two-Circuit

Temperature Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-40 A72 Series Two-Pole Heavy Duty

Temperature Controls

(Adjustable Differential) . . . . . . . . . . . . R-41 A72 Series Cooling Tower or Evaporative

Condenser Controls (Single-Stage

Temperature Control with

Outdoor Enclosure) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-42 A72AA Coiled Bulb Space Thermostat

(Cooling) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-43

Single-Stage Electronic

Temperature Controls . . . . . . R-44

A421 Series Electronic Temperature

Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-44

A421 Series Electronic Temperature

Controls with Integral Power Cord . . . R-47 A421 Series Electronic Temperature

Controls with Off-Cycle Defrost . . . . . R-50

A421 Series Electronic Temperature

Controls with Integral Cycle Timer . . . R-53 MR Series Defrost Control Modules . . . . . R-56 MR4PMUHV Electronic

Temperature/Defrost Control with

Relay Pack . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-58

Multi-Stage Electromechanical Temperature Controls . . . . . . R-59

A28 Series Two-Stage Temperature

Control. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-59

Two Stage Temperature Control . . . . . . . . R-59 A28 Series Two-Stage Flange Mounted

Duct Thermostat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-61

A28 Two-Stage Industrial Thermostat (Watertight and Dusttight) . . . . . . . . . . R-62

A28 Two-Stage Temperature Control with Weatherproof Enclosure . . . . . . . . . . . R-63

Table of Contents

A28 Two-Stage Agricultural Thermostat with NEMA 4X Enclosure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-64

A36 Series Four-Stage Remote Bulb Thermostats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-65

S26 Series Switching Subbase . . . . . . . . R-66 T22/T25/T26 Series Line Voltage Wall

Thermostat (Heating, Cooling, or

Heating and Cooling) . . . . . . . . . . . . R-67 Typical Wiring Diagram and Electrical

Ratings for Line Voltage Thermostats . R-69

T23 Series Fan Coil Thermostat

(with Fan and System Selectors) . . . . . R-70 T28 Series Fan Coil Thermostat (with or

without Fan Selector Switches) . . . . . . R-71

T46 Series Fan Coil Thermostat . . . . . . . R-72

Multi-Stage Electronic

Temperature Controls . . . . . . . R-74

MS Series Temperature Stage Control

Modules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-74

MS Series Single-Stage Control Modules

with Voltage Input . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-76 MS4PMUHVT Multi-Stage Electronic

Temperature Control with Relay Pack . R-78

Temperature Control Sensors and Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-79

A99B Series Temperature Sensor . . . . . R-79 Bulb Wells . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-80

G Series Thermostat and Humidistat

Guards . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-81 T22, T25, T26, T28, T46, and T91

Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-83

T91 Series Room Temperature Sensor . . . R-84

Standard Electromechanical

Pressure Controls . . . . . . . . . . R-85

P10 Series Low Pressure Control . . . . . . . R-85 P20 Series Air Conditioning/Pressure

Cutout Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-86

P29 Series Low Pressure Control with

Time Delay. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-88

P47 Series Steam Pressure Limit Control. R-89 P67 Series Low Pressure Control . . . . . . R-90 P70, P72 Approximate Low Pressure

Settings for Typical Applications . . . . . R-91

P70, P72, and P170 Series Controls for

Low Pressure Applications . . . . . . . . . R-92 P70, P72, and P170 Series Controls for

High Pressure Applications . . . . . . . . . R-96

P70, P72, and P170 Series Controls for

Dual Pressure Applications . . . . . . . . R-100

Single-Stage Electronic

Pressure Controls . . . . . . . . . R-103

P470 Electronic Pressure Control with

Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-103

Electromechanical Lube Oil and Differential Pressure

Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-105

P28 Series Lube Oil Pressure Cutout

Control with Time Delay . . . . . . . . . . R-105 P32 Series Sensitive Pressure Switch . . R-106 P45 Series Lube Oil Pressure Cutout

Control with Time Delay . . . . . . . . . . R-107

P74 Series Differential Pressure Control. R-108 P128 and P145 Series Lube Oil Pressure

Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-109

P12 Series Differential Pressure

Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-110

Electronic Lube Oil and Differential Pressure

Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-111

P545 Series Electronic Lube Oil Control . R-111 CST29A Adaptor Block for Carlyle®

Compressors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-113

Pressure Sensors and

Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-114

Replacement Timing Relays for P28 and

P29 Lube Oil Controls . . . . . . . . . . . R-114

Table of Contents

P100 Series Encapsulated Pressure

Switches. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-115

P499 Series Electronic Pressure

Transducers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-119

R310A Series Current Sensing Switch . . R-122 Universal Mounting Brackets . . . . . . . . . . R-123 SEC99A UltraCap Armored Capillary . . . R-124

Refrigerant Sensors/Monitors . R-125

RLD-H10PRO Refrigerant Leak

Detector . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-125

RLD Refrigerant Leak Detector

Accessories and Replacement Parts . R-126

Liquid Level and Flow

Controls. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-127

F59 Series Sump Pump Switch . . . . . . . . R-127 F261 Series Fluid Flow Switches . . . . . . R-128 F262 Airflow Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-130

F263 Series Liquid Level Float

Switches. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-132

F61 and F62 Series Replacement

Paddles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-134

F92 Series Air Volume Controls for

Shallow Wells . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-135

F93 Series Air Volume Controls for

Deep Wells . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-136

Motor Speed Controls . . . . . . . . R-137

P266 Series Single-Phase Condenser

Fan Speed Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-137 P66/S66 Series Controls to P266 Series

Controls Replacement Guide . . . . . . R-140

VFD68 Variable Frequency Drives . . . . . R-142

Valves and Valve Accessories . R-145

V43/V243 Series Pressure-Actuated

Water-Regulating Valves . . . . . . . . . . R-145 V46 Series Pressure Actuated

Water-Regulating Valve . . . . . . . . . . . R-151

V46N Series Reverse Acting Valve . . . . . R-154

V46 Series Valve Sizing Information—90% Open Method. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-155

V46 Series Valve Dimensions . . . . . . . . . R-156 V47 Series Temperature Actuated

Modulating Valve. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-157

V47N Series Reverse Acting Valve. . . . . R-159 V48 Series Three-Way Water

Regulating Valve . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-160

V146 Series Two-Way Pressure-Actuated Water-Regulating Valves . . . . . . . . . R-161

V148 Series Three-Way Pressure-Actuated Water-Regulating Valves . . . . . . . . . R-166

V246 Series Two-Way Pressure-Actuated Water-Regulating Valves for

High-Pressure Refrigerants . . . . . . . R-171 V248 Series Three-Way Pressure-Actuated

Water-Regulating Valves for

High-Pressure Refrigerants . . . . . . . R-181 STT Water Valve Renewal Kit for

V46, V47, and V48 Series Valves . . . R-188

Companion Flanges and Gaskets for

V43, V46, and V47 Series Valves . . . R-189

Relays and Transformers . . . . . R-190

Y63, Y64, Y65, Y66, and Y69 Series

Transformers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-190

System 450 Control Series . . . . R-192

System 450™ Series Modular Controls . R-192 System 450™ Series Control Module with

Network Communications . . . . . . . . R-203

System 450™ Reset Control Modules with

Real-Time Clock and Relay Output. . R-206 System 450™ Control Modules with

Analog Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-208

System 450™ Control Modules with

Relay Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-210

System 450™ Control Module with

Hybrid Analog Output . . . . . . . . . . . . R-212 System 450™ Expansion Modules with

Analog Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-214

System 450™ Expansion Modules with

Relay Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-216

Table of Contents

System 450™ Power Module . . . . . . . . . R-218 System 450™ Compatible Sensors,

Transducers, and Accessories . . . . . R-219

Cross-Reference . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-223

Ranco® Refrigeration Cross-Reference . R-223 ALCO® Cross Reference . . . . . . . . . . . . R-231

Code Number Index

Numerics

210-604R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-87

246-423 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-153, R-158, R-189

246-424 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-189

246-425 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-153, R-158, R-189

271-51 . . . . .R-88, R-107, R-109, R-112, R-123

426-424 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-153, R-158

A

A19AAB-10C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-21

A19AAB-4C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-21

A19AAB-7C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-21

A19AAC-4C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-19

A19AAC-9C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-21

A19AAD-12C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-19

A19AAD-5C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-19

A19AAE-3C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-22

A19AAF-12C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-19

A19AAF-20C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-19

A19AAF-21C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-19

A19AAT-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-28

A19ABA-40C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-19

A19ABB-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-21, R-22

A19ABB-7C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-21

A19ABC-11C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-23

A19ABC-12C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-23

A19ABC-24C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-19

A19ABC-36C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-19

A19ABC-37C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-19

A19ABC-4C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-19

A19ABC-74C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-19

A19ACA-14C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-19

A19ACA-15C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-19

A19ADB-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-19

A19ADB-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-23

A19ADN-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-19

A19AGF-31C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-24

A19ANC-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-33

A19AUC-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-25

A19AUC-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-25

A19AUC-3C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-25

A19AUC-4C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-25

A19BAB-3C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-26

A19BAC-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-26

A19BAF-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-26

A19BAG-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-27

A19BBC-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-26

A19BUC-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-25

A19CAC-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-29

A19CAC-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-29

A19DAC-10C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-30

A19DAC-12C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-30

A19DAC-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-30

A19DAC-9C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-30

A19DAF-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-30

A19EAF-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-31

A19EAF-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-31

A19EBA-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-32

A19EBB-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-32

A19EBC-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-32

A19EDB-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-32

A19KNC-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-35

A19PRC-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-34

A19QSC-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-36

A19QSC-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-36

A19QSC-3C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-36

A19QSC-4C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-36

A19ZBA-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-37

A19ZBC-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-38

A25AN-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-39

A25AP-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-39

A25CN-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-39

A25CP-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-39

A28AA-28C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-59

A28AA-29C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-59

A28AA-36C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-59

A28AA-37C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-59

A28AA-4C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-59

A28AA-9C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-59

A28AB-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-59

A28AJ-4C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-59

A28AK-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-61

A28AK-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-61

A28KA-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-62

A28MA-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-63

A28MA-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-63

A28PA-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-64

A28PJ-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-64

A36AHA-50C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-65

A36AHA-52C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-65

A36AHA-58C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-65

A36AHB-33C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-65

A421ABC-02C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-45

Note: Page numbers in italics denote pages where the product code number appears, but not as the main part.

Code Number Index

A421ABC-03C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-45

A421ABC-04C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-45

A421ABC-06C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-45

A421ABD-02C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-51

A421ABG-02C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-48

A421ABJ-02C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-48

A421ABT-02C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-54

A421AEC-01C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-45

A421AEC-02C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-45

A421AED-01C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-51

A421AED-02C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-51

A421AEJ-01C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-48

A421AET-01C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-54

A421GBF-02C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-45

A421GEF-01C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-45

A421GEF-02C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-45

A70GA-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-40

A70GA-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-40

A70HA-14C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-40

A70HA-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-40

A70HA-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-40

A70KA-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-40

A72AA-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-41

A72AA-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-41

A72AA-3C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-41

A72AA-4C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-43

A72AE-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-42

A72AP-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-41

A72CE-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-42 A99BA-200C . . . . . . R-74, R-79, R-195, R-220 A99BB-200C . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-58, R-74, R-78,

. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-79, R-195, R-220

A99BB-25C . . . . . . . . . . . . R-79, R-195, R-220

A99BB-300C . . . . . . R-74, R-79, R-195, R-220

A99BB-500C . . . . . . R-74, R-79, R-195, R-220

A99BB-600C . . . . . . R-74, R-79, R-195, R-220

A99BC-1500C . . . . . . . . . . R-79, R-195, R-220

A99BC-25C . . . . . . . . . . . . R-79, R-195, R-220

A99BC-300C . . . . . . . . . . . R-79, R-195, R-220

A99BC-500C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-79

A99-CLP-1 . . . . . . . . . . . . R-79, R-196, R-220

ADP11A-600R . . . . . . . . . R-79, R-196, R-220

B

BKT16A-600R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-85

BKT182-1R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-106

BKT229-1R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-106

BKT287-1R . . . . . . . . . . . R-195, R-204, R-207,

. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-208, R-210, R-213,

. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-214, R-216, R-218

BKT287-2R . . . . . . . . . . . R-195, R-204, R-207,

. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-208, R-210, R-213,

. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-214, R-216, R-218

BKT287-3R . . . . . . . . . . . R-195, R-204, R-207,

. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-208, R-210, R-213,

. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-214, R-216, R-218

BKT287-4R . . . . . . . . . . . R-195, R-204, R-207,

. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-208, R-210, R-213,

. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-214, R-216, R-218 BKT38A-600R . . . . . . . . . R-107, R-109, R-123 BKT38A-601R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-109

BKT48A-600R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-72

BOX10A-600R . . . . . . . . . . R-79, R-195, R-220

C

C450CBN-3C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .R-195, R-210

C450CCN-3C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .R-195, R-210

C450CEN-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .R-195, R-204

C450CPN-3C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .R-195, R-208

C450CPW-100C . . . . . . . . . . . . . .R-195, R-213

C450CQN-3C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .R-195, R-208

C450CRN-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .R-195, R-204

C450RBN-3C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .R-195, R-207

C450RCN-3C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .R-195, R-207

C450SBN-3C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .R-195, R-216

C450SCN-3C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .R-195, R-216

C450SPN-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .R-195, R-214

C450SQN-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .R-195, R-214

C450YNN-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .R-195, R-218

CSE57A-600 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-65

CST29A-600C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-113

CVR17A-620R . . . . . . . . . . . . R-40, R-41, R-43

CVR17A-621R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .R-40, R-41

CVR28A-617R . . . . . . R-20, R-21, R-23, R-24,

. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-26, R-29, R-60

CVR28A-618R . . . . . . R-20, R-21, R-23, R-24,

. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-26, R-31, R-32, R-60

CVR61A-600R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-37

CVR88A-600R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-72

Code Number Index

D

DBK10A-600R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-147

DBK10A-601R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-147, R-148

DBK10A-602R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-147

DBK10A-603R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-147

DBK11A-600R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-147

DBK11A-601R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-147

DBK11A-602R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-147

DBK11A-603R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-147

DPM17A-600R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-188

DPM17A-601R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-188

DPM18A-600R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-147

DPM18A-601R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-147

DPM18A-602R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-147

DPM18A-603R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-147

DPT2650-005D-AB . . . . . . . . . . . R-196, R-221

DPT2650-0R5D-AB . . . . . . . . . . R-196, R-221

DPT2650-10D-AB . . . . . . . . . . . . R-196, R-221

DPT2650-2R5D-AB . . . . . . . . . . R-196, R-221

DPT2650-R25B-AB . . . . . . . . . . . R-196, R-221

DSC16A-600R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-147

DSC16A-601R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-147

DSC16A-602R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-147, R-148

DSC16A-603R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-147

F

F261KAH-V01C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-128

F261KEH-V01C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-128

F261KFH-V01C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-128

F261KFH-V02C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-128

F261MAH-V01C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-128

F261MAL-V01C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-128

F261MEH-V01C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-128

F261MFH-V01C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-128

F262KDH-01C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-130

F263MAC-V01C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-132

F263MAP-V01C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-132

F59A-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-127

F59A-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-127

F59H-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-127

FLG15A-600 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-189

FLG15A-601 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-189

FTG13A-600R . . . . . . . . . . . . R-20, R-21, R-37,

. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-41, R-59, R-80

FTG18A-600R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-106

G

GRD10-1R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-81

GRD10A-600 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-81

GRD10A-601 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-81

GRD10A-606 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-81

GRD10A-608 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-81

GRD10A-609 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-81

H

HE-6300 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-76

HE-6310 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-76

HE-67S3-0N00P . . . . . . . . . . . . . .R-196, R-221

HE-67S3-0N0BT . . . . . . . . . . . . .R-196, R-221

HE-68N2-0N00WS . . . . . . . . . . . .R-196, R-221

HE-68N3-0N00WS . . . . . . . . . . . .R-196, R-221

K

KEY12A-600 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-81

KIT14A-612 . . . . . . . . . . . R-153, R-158, R-189

KIT14A-613 . . . . . . . . . . . R-153, R-158, R-189

KIT14A-614 . . . . . R-146, R-153, R-158, R-189 KIT21A-600 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-134

KIT21A-601 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-134

KITP545-82C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .R-112, R-113

KNB17A-600R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-83

KNB20A-600R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-83

KNB20A-602R . . . . . . . . . . . R-20, R-21, R-23,

. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-24, R-26, R-60

KNB26A-600R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .R-72, R-83

M

MR1DR24-11C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-56

MR2DR24-11C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-56

MR2PM24-11C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-56

MR4DR24-12C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-56

MR4PM12C-12C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-58

MR4PM24-12C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-56

MR4PMUHV-12C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-58

MS1DR24T-11C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-74

MS1DR24V-11C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-76

MS2DR24T-11C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-74

MS2PM24T-11C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-74

MS4DR24T-11C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-74

MS4PM12CT-11C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-78

Code Number Index

MS4PM24T-11C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-74

MS4PMUHVT-11C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-78

P

P10BC-7C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-85

P10BG-3C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-85

P10BJ-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-85

P10FC-4C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-85

P10PA-11C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-85

P128AA-17C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-109

P128AA-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-109

P128AA-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-109

P12AA-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-110 P145NCA-12C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-107, R-109

P145NCA-82C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-107, R-109

P145NCB-12C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-107, R-109

P145NCB-82C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-107, R-109

P170AA-118C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-96

P170AA-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-97

P170AA-400C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-97

P170AB-12C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-93

P170AB-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-93

P170CA-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-93

P170CA-3C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-96

P170CA-400C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-97

P170DA-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-96

P170DA-400C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-97

P170EA-14C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-93

P170KA-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-96

P170LB-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-101

P170LB-6C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-100

P170MA-18C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-100

P170MA-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-101

P170NA-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-101

P170SA-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-100

P20BB-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-86

P20DB-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-86

P20EB-18C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-86

P20EB-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-86

P20EB-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-86

P20GB-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-86

P28AA-17C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-105

P28AA-18C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-105

P28AA-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-105

P28AA-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-105

P28AN-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-105

P28DA-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-105

P28DN-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-105

P28GA-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-105

P28NA-5C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-105

P29NC-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-88

P29NC-3C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-88

P29NC-49C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-88

P29NC-53C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-88

P29NF-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-88

P32AC-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-106

P32AC-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-106

P32AF-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-106

P32AF-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-106

P400AD-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .R-112, R-113

P400AD-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-112

P400BD-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-112

P45NAA-10C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-107

P45NAA-5C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-107

P45NCA-12C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-107

P45NCA-82C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-107

P47AA-13C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-89

P47AA-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-89

P47AA-4C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-89

P47AB-3C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-89

P47BA-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-89

P47BA-6C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-89

P47EA-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-89

P47GA-9C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-89 P499RAP-101C . . . . . . . . . . . . . .R-197, R-222

P499RAP-101K . . . . . . . . . . . . . .R-197, R-222

P499RAP-102C . . . . . . . . . . . . . .R-197, R-222

P499RAP-105C . . . . . . . . . . . . . .R-197, R-222

P499RAP-105K . . . . . . . . . . . . . .R-197, R-222

P499RAP-107C . . . . . . . . . . . . . .R-197, R-222

P499RAP-107K . . . . . . . . . . . . . .R-197, R-222

P499RAPS100C . . . . . . . . . . . . . .R-197, R-222

P499RAPS100K . . . . . . . . . . . . . .R-197, R-222

P499RAPS102C . . . . . . . . . . . . . .R-197, R-222

P499RAPS102K . . . . . . . . . . . . . .R-197, R-222

P499RCP-101C . . . . . . . . . . . . . .R-197, R-221

P499RCP-101K . . . . . . . . . . . . . .R-197, R-221

P499RCP-105C . . . . . . . . . . . . . .R-197, R-221

P499RCP-105K . . . . . . . . . . . . . .R-197, R-221

P499RCP-107C . . . . . . . . . . . . . .R-197, R-221

P499RCP-107K . . . . . . . . . . . . . .R-197, R-221

P499RCP-401C . . . . . . . . . . . . . .R-197, R-221

P499RCP-402C . . . . . . . . . . . . . .R-197, R-221

Code Number Index

P499RCP-404C . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-197, R-221

P499RCP-405C . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-197, R-221

P499RCPS100C . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-197, R-221

P499RCPS100K . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-197, R-221

P499RCPS102C . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-197, R-221

P499RCPS102K . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-197, R-221

P545NCB-22C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-111

P545NCB-25C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-111

P545NCB-82C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-111, R-113

P67AA-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-90

P67CA-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-90

P67EA-5C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-90

P70AA-118C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-96

P70AA-119C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-97

P70AA-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-97

P70AA-400C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-97

P70AA-5C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-93

P70AB-12C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-93

P70AB-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-93

P70AB-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-93

P70BA-10C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-93

P70BA-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-93

P70CA-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-93

P70CA-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-96

P70CA-3C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-96

P70CA-400C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-97

P70CA-4C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-93

P70CA-5C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-97

P70DA-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-96

P70DA-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-97

P70DA-400C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-97

P70EA-10C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-93

P70EA-14C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-93

P70GA-11C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-93

P70HA-3C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-93

P70KA-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-96

P70KA-7C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-97

P70LA-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-101

P70LB-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-100

P70LB-6C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-100

P70MA-18C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-100

P70MA-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-100

P70MA-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-101

P70NA-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-100

P70SA-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-100

P72AA-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-93

P72AA-27C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-96

P72AB-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-93

P72CA-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-96

P72DA-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-96

P72LA-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-100

P72LB-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-100

P72MA-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-100

P72NA-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-100

P74AA-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-108

P74BA-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-108

P74EA-10C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-108

P74EA-8C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-108

P74FA-10C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-108

P74FA-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-108

P74FA-5C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-108

P74JA-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-108

PLT112-1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-134

PLT112-2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-134

PLT213-6R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-83

PLT231-1R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-83

PLT333-12R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .R-72, R-83

PLT333-1R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .R-72, R-83

PLT333-2R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-83

PLT333-3R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .R-72, R-83

PLT333-4R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-83

PLT333-5R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .R-72, R-83

PLT344-1R . . . . . . . . . . . R-195, R-204, R-207,

. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-208, R-210, R-213,

. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-214, R-216, R-218

R

R310AD-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .R-112, R-122

R310AE-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-122

RLD-H10-100 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .R-125, R-126

RLD-H10-101 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-125

RLD-H10-102 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-125

RLD-H10-103 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-125

RLD-H10-105 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-125

RLD-H10-600R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .R-125, R-126

RLD-H10-601R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .R-125, R-126

RLD-H10-602R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .R-125, R-126

RLD-H10-603R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .R-125, R-126

RLD-H10-604R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-125

RLD-H10-606R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .R-125, R-126

RLD-H10-607R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .R-125, R-126

RLD-H10PM-1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-125

RLD-H10PRO-1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-125

Code Number Index

RLY13A-600R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-114

RLY13A-602R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-114

RLY13A-608R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-114

RLY13A-609R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-114

RLY13A-610R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-114

RLY13A-613R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-114

RLY13A-616R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-114

RLY13A-617R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-114

ROD18A-600R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-147

ROD18A-601R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-147

ROD18A-602R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-147

ROD18A-603R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-147, R-148

ROD18A-604R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-147

RP4MRUHV-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-58

RP4MSUHV-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-78

S

S26AA-1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-66

S26AH-1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-66

S26DH-1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-66

SCN10A-600R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-147

SCN10A-601R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-147, R-148

SEC37A-600R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-151

SEC37A-601R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-151

SEC37A-602R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-151

SEC99AA-18C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-124

SEC99AA-24C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-124 SEC99AA-36C . . . . . . . . R-124, R-151, R-152,

. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-154, R-160

SEC99AA-48C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-124

SEC99AA-60C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-124

SEC99AB-18C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-124

SEC99AB-24C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-124

SEC99AB-36C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-124

SEC99AB-48C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-124

SEC99AB-60C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-124

SEP107A-602R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-151, R-160

SEP127A-600R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-151, R-160

SEP13A-600R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-152

SEP13A-602R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-152

SEP13A-603R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-152

SEP50A-600R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-152

SEP50A-601R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-152

SEP70A-601R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-152

SEP70A-604R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-152

SEP70A-605R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-152

SEP77A-605R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .R-151, R-160

SEP81A-601R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .R-151, R-160

SEP81A-602R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .R-151, R-160

SEP86A-600R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-147

SEP87A-600R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-147

SEP88A-600R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .R-147, R-148

SEP88A-601R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-147

SEP91A-600R . . . . . . . . . R-151, R-152, R-154

SEP91A-601R . . . . . . . . . R-151, R-154, R-160

SEP91A-602R . . . . . . . . . R-151, R-154, R-160

SEP91A-603R . . . . . . . . . R-151, R-154, R-160

SET29A . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-157

SET29A-601R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-157

SET29A-602R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-157

SET29A-604R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-157

SET29A-605R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .R-157, R-159

SET29A-606R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-157

SET29A-622R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-157

SET29A-623R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-157

SET29A-624R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-157

SET29A-625R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-157

SET29A-626R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-157

SET29A-627R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-157

SET29A-629R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-157

SET29A-630R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-157

SET29A-632R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-157

SET29A-633R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-157

SET98A-621R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-157

SHL10A-600R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-79 SHL10A-603R . . . . . . . . . . R-79, R-196, R-220 STT14A . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-157 STT14A-600R . . . R-151, R-154, R-157, R-188 STT14A-601R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .R-152, R-188

STT14A-603R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-152

STT15A . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-157 STT15A-602R . . . . . . . . R-151, R-154, R-157,

. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .R-159, R-188 STT15A-603R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .R-152, R-188

STT15A-605R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .R-160, R-188

STT16A . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-157 STT16A-601R . . . . . . . . R-151, R-152, R-154,

. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-157, R-159, R-188

STT16A-604R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .R-160, R-188

STT17A . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-157

STT17A-604R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .R-160, R-188

STT17A-609R . . . . . . . . R-151, R-152, R-154,

. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .R-157, R-188

Code Number Index

STT17A-610R . . . . . . . . . R-151, R-152, R-154, T28DB-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-71
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-157, R-159, R-188 T28DD-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-71
STT17A-611R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-152, R-188 T28DG-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-71
STT17A-612R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-152, R-188 T46ABH-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-72
STT17A-613R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-152, R-188 T46ADH-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-72
STT17A-616R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-160, R-188 T46JBH-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-72
STT17A-617R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-160, R-188 T46JDH-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-72
STT18A . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-157 T46JEA-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-72
STT18A-600R . . . .R-151, R-152, R-157, R-188 T46SAA-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-72
STT18A-601R . . . .R-151, R-152, R-157, R-188 T46SAH-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-72
STT18A-602R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-152, R-188 T46SDA-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-72
STT19A-600R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-147 T46SDH-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-72
STT19A-602R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-147 T-800-1605 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-80
STT19A-603R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-147 T-800-1606 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-80
STT19A-605R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-147 T-800-1618 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-80
STT19A-606R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-147 T-800-1620 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-80
STT19A-607R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-147, R-148 T91BAA-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-84
STT19A-608R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-147 T91BBA-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-84
STT19A-609R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-147 T91BCA-1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-84
TBG16A-600R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-89

T

T22AAA-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-68

T22ABC-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-68

T22ABC-3C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-68

T22BBC-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-68

T22CBC-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-68

T22CBC-3C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-68

T22JAA-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-68

T22JCC-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-68

T22SDA-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-68

T22SEB-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-68

T22SFB-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-68

T22TFB-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-68

T23A-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-70

T23B-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-70

T25A-16C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-68

T25A-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-68

T26A-14C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-68

T26A-15C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-68

T26J-7C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-68

T26J-9C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-68

T26S-18C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-68

T26T-3C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-68

T28BD-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-71

T28CD-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-71

T28DA-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-71

TE-6000-x . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .R-196, R-220

TE-6001-1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .R-196, R-220

TE-6001-11 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .R-196, R-220

TE-631xx-x . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .R-196, R-220

TE-68NT-0N00S . . . . . . . . . . . . . .R-196, R-221

V

V248GB1-001C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-181

V248GB1B001C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-181

V248GC1-001C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-181

V248GC1B001C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-181

V248GD1-001C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-181

V248GD1B001C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-181

V248GE1-001C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-181

V248GE1B001C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-181

V248GF1-001C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-181

V248GF1B001C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-181

V248GK1-001C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-181

V248GL1-001C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-181

V248GM1-001C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-181

V248HC1B001C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-181

V43AS-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .R-145, R-147

V43AS-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .R-145, R-147

V43AS-5C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-147

V43AT-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .R-145, R-147

V43AT-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .R-145, R-147

Code Number Index

V43AT-5C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-147 V46AE-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-151
V43AV-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-145, R-147 V46AE-4C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-152
V43AV-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-145, R-147 V46AJ-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-151
V43AV-5C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-145, R-147 V46AL-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-151
V43AW-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-147 V46AM-2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-151
V43AW-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-145, R-147 V46AR-10C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-151
V43AW-5C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-147 V46AR-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-151
V43BS-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-147 V46AR-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-152
V43BS-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-147 V46AS-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-151
V43BS-3C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-146, R-147 V46AS-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-151
V43BS-6C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-145, R-147 V46AS-3C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-152
V43BS-7C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-145, R-147 V46AT-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-151
V43BT-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-147 V46AT-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-151
V43BT-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-147 V46AT-3C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-152
V43BT-3C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-146, R-147 V46BA-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-152
V43BT-6C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-145, R-147 V46BB-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-152
V43BT-7C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-145, R-147 V46BC-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-152
V43BV-10C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-145, R-147 V46BD-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-152
V43BV-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-147 V46BE-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-152
V43BV-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-147 V46BR-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-152
V43BV-4C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-146, R-147 V46BS-3C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-152
V43BV-5C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-147 V46BS-4C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-152
V43BV-6C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-147 V46BT-3C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-152
V43BV-7C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-145, R-147 V46BT-4C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-152
V43BV-8C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-147 V46CJ-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-152
V43BV-9C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-147 V46CN-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-152
V43BW-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-146, R-147 V46CP-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-152
V43BW-6C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-147 V46CQ-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-152
V43BW-7C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-146, R-147 V46CR-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-152
V43CS-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-146, R-147 V46CS-3C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-152
V43CS-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-146, R-147 V46CS-4C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-152
V43CS-3C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-147 V46CT-3C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-152
V43CT-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-147 V46CT-4C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-152
V43CT-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-146, R-147 V46DA-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-152
V43CV-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-146, R-147 V46EK-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-151
V43CV-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . R-146, R-147, R-148 V46NA-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-154
V46AA-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-151 V46NA-4C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-154
V46AA-50C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-151 V46NB-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-154
V46AB-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-151 V46NB-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-154
V46AB-25C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-151 V46NC-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-154
V46AC-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-151 V46NC-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-154
V46AC-26C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-151 V46ND-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-154
V46AC-8C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-152 V46ND-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-154
V46AD-13C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-151 V46NE-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-154
V46AD-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-151 V46NE-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-154
V46AD-4C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-152 V47AA-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-157
V46AE-17C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-151 V47AA-26C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-157

Code Number Index

V47AA-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-157

V47AA-3C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-157

V47AB-27C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-157

V47AB-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-157

V47AB-3C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-157

V47AB-4C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-157

V47AB-5C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-157

V47AC-3C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-157

V47AC-40C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-157

V47AC-4C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-157

V47AC-6C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-157

V47AC-8C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-157

V47AD-19C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-157

V47AD-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-157

V47AD-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-157

V47AD-3C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-157

V47AE-13C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-157

V47AE-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-157

V47AE-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-157

V47AE-3C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-157

V47AR-1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-157

V47AR-2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-157

V47AR-3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-157

V47AS-1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-157

V47AS-13C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-157

V47AS-2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-157

V47AS-3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-157

V47AT-1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-157

V47AT-2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-157

V47AT-3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-157

V47NB-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-159

V47NC-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-159

V47NR-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-159

V48AB-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-160

V48AB-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-160

V48AC-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-160

V48AC-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-160

V48AD-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-160

V48AD-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-160

V48AE-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-160

V48AE-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-160

V48AF-1C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-160

V48AF-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-160

V48AJ-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-160

V48AL-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-160

V48AM-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-160

V48EK-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-160

VFD68BBB-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-143

VFD68BCB-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-143

VFD68BDC-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-143

VFD68BFD-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-143

VFD68BGG-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-143

VFD68BHG-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-143

VFD68BJK-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-143

VFD68BKL-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-143

VFD68BLL-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-143

VFD68BMP-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-143

VFD68BNP-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-143

VFD68CDF-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-143

VFD68CFF-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-143

VFD68CGG-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-143

VFD68CHH-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-143

VFD68CJJ-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-143

VFD68CKL-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-143

VFD68CLL-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-143

VFD68CMP-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-143

VFD68CNP-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-143

VFD68DFM-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-143

VFD68DGM-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-143

VFD68DHM-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-143

VFD68DJN-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-143

VFD68DKN-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-143

VFD68DLN-2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-143

W

WEL11A-601R . . . . . . . . . . . R-33, R-36, R-79,

. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-80, R-196, R-220

WEL14A-601R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-80 WEL14A-602R . . . . . . R-19, R-21, R-25, R-37,

. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-59, R-65, R-80 WEL14A-603R . . R-19, R-25, R-59, R-65, R-80

WEL16A-600R . . . . . . . R-25, R-35, R-62, R-80

WEL16A-601R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .R-19, R-80

WEL17A-600R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .R-80, R-157

WEL17A-601R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .R-80, R-157

WEL17A-602R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-80

WEL17A-604R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-80

WEL18A-600R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-80

WEL18A-601R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-159

WEL18A-602R . . . . . . . . . . R-80, R-157, R-159

WGT11A-600R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-127

WGT11A-604R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-127

Code Number Index

WHA-C450-100C . . . . . . R-195, R-204, R-207, Y63T31-0 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-190
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-208, R-210, R-213, Y64T15-0 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-191
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-214, R-216, R-218 Y64T21-0 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-191
WHA-P400-100C . . . . . . . . . . . . R-112, R-113 Y64T22-0 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-191
WHA-P400-125C . . . . . . . . . . . . R-112, R-113 Y65A13-0 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-190
WHA-P400-250C . . . . . . . . . . . . R-112, R-113 Y65A21-0 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-190
WHA-P400-400C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-113 Y65F13-0 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-190
WHA-P400-430C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-112 Y65F42-0 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-190
WHA-PKD3-200C . . . . . . R-119, R-197, R-222 Y65G13-0 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-190
WHA-PKD3-400C . . . . . . R-119, R-197, R-222 Y65S13-0 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-190
WHA-PKD3-600C . . . . . . R-119, R-197, R-222 Y65T31-0 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-190
WZ-1000-2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-80 Y65T42-0 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-190
WZ-1000-4 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-80 Y65T54-0 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-190
WZ-1000-5 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-80 Y66F12-0

Y66F13-0

. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

R-191

R-191

Y

Y63F22-0 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-190

Y63T22-0 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-190

Y66T12-0 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-191

Y66T13-0 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-191

Y69T15-0 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R-191

Single-Stage Electromechanical Temperature Controls Code No. LIT-1927005

A11 Series Low Temperature Cutout Controls

Description

A11 Series Low Temperature Cutout Controls are available with single-pole, single-throw (SPST) or single-pole, double-throw (SPDT) contact action. Typical applications include the sensing of low temperature conditions to avoid over cooling or icing of hydronic coils, cooling coils, and liquid-handing pipes. The controls are compact and sturdy, and have an adjustable temperature setpoint range with a fixed differential. The range adjustment screw is accessible at the bottom of the control, and at the top of the control when the cover is removed.

The A11 Controls are compact and sturdy and feature an adjustable range with a fixed differential. The range adjustment screw is accessible at the bottom of the control or at the top, when the cover is removed. A factory-set low temperature stop is available when specified.

Refer to the A11 Series Low Temperature Cutout Controls Product Bulletin (LIT-125010) for important product application information.

Electrical Rating

Motor Rating 120 V 208 V 240 V
Motor Description
AC Full Load Amperes 16.0 9.2 8.0
AC Locked Rotor Amperes 96.0 55.2 48.0
Non-Inductive Amperes 16.0 9.2 8.0
Pilot Duty 125 VA, 24 to 277 VAC

Selection Chart

Features

  • precision repeat accuracy remains unaffected by ambient temperature at the control diaphragm cup and 4 ft (1.2 m) capillary (20 ft [6.1 m] sensing bulb must be in the controlled area)
  • trip-free manual reset allows the lever to reset. You must press and release the lever before operation resumes.
  • precision snap-acting contacts in a dust protected enclosure enables the A11 Control to operate to the fullest potential
  • direct reading scale provides

easy-to-adjust setpoint. Adjustments can be made from the top or bottom of the control.

Repair Information

If the A11 Series Low Temperature Cutout Control fails to operate within its specifications, replace the unit. For a replacement control, contact the nearest Johnson Controls® representative.

A11 Series Low Temperature Cutout Control

Model Description
A11A SPST, open low, manual reset
A11B SPST, open low, automatic recycle
A11D SPDT, manual reset
A11E SPDT, automatic recycle

( )

( )

( )

( )

( )

( )

( )

( )

( )

( )

( )

( )

( )

( )

( )

( )

( )

( )

( )

( )

A11 Series Low Temperature Cutout Controls Dimensions, in. (mm)

Single-Stage Electromechanical Temperature Controls

A11 Series Low Temperature Cutout Controls (Continued)

Technical Specifications

A11 Low Temperature Cutout Controls
Product Codes A11A: SPST, open low, manual reset

A11B: SPST, open low, automatic recycle A11D: SPDT, manual reset

A11E: SPDT, automatic recycle

Range Cutout 35 to 45°F (2 to 7°C)
Differential A11A and A11D: Temperature must be 12°F (6.7°C) above cutout point before control can be reset. A11B and A11E: 12°F (6.7°C)
Ambient Temperature Minimum: 0°F (-18°C) Maximum: 140°F (60°C)
Maximum Temperature at Bulb 250°F (121°C)
Sensing Element 1/8 in. x 20 ft (3 mm x 6.1 m) or 1/8 in. x 40 ft (3 mm x 12.2 m)
Capillary Length 4 ft (1.2 m)
Switch Snap-acting contacts in dust-protected enclosure
Material Case: 0.6 (2 mm) cold rolled steel Cover: 0.3 in. (1 mm) cold rolled steel
Finish Galvanized steel
Conduit Opening 22 mm (9/10 in.) hole for 13 mm (1/2 in.) conduit
Mounting Bracket Standard on all controls
Shipping Weight Individual pack: 1.8 lb (0.8 kg)

Overpack of 20 units: 38 lb (17 kg)

Electrical Rating Pilot Duty: 125 VA, 24 to 277 VAC
Motor Ratings AC Full Load Ampere: 120 V = 16.0 A, 208 V = 9.2 A, 240 V = 8.0 A

AC Locked Rotor Ampere: 120 V = 96.0 A, 208 V = 55.2 A, 240 V = 48.0 A

Non-Inductive Ampere: 120 V = 16.0 A, 208 V = 9.2 A, 240 V = 8.0 A

Compliance United States UL Listed, File SA516, SDFY
FCC Compliant to CFR 47, Part 15 Subpart B, Class A
Canada UL Listed, CSA Class No. 1222 01, File LR948
Industry Canada, ICES-003

Single-Stage Electromechanical Temperature Controls Code No. LIT-1927010

A19 Series Remote Bulb Control

Description

The A19 Series Controls are single-stage temperature controls that incorporate environmentally friendly liquid-filled sensing elements.

Refer to the A19 Series Hot Water Heating Controls Well Immersion Product Bulletin (LIT-125025) for important product application information.

Features

  • wide temperature ranges available
  • constant differential throughout the entire range
  • compact enclosure
  • fixed or adjustable differential available
  • variety of sensing element styles
  • unaffected by cross-ambient conditions

Applications

The A19 is suitable for temperature control in HVAC/R applications.

Selection Charts

A19 Series Remote Bulb Control1

A19 Series

Y

R

B

Action on Increase of Temperature

a19.eps

A19 Series

Terminal Arrangement for Single-Pole, Double-Throw (SPDT)

A19ABC-24 Remote Bulb Control

Product Code

Number

Switch

Action

Range

°F (°C)

Differential

F° (C°)

Bulb and

Capillary

Bulb Well No.

(Order Separately)

Range

Adjuster

Max. Bulb

Temp. °F (°C)

Adjustable Differential (Wide Range)
A19ABA-40C2 Single-Pole,

Single-Throw (SPST)

Open low

-30 to 100 (-34 to 38) 3 to 12 (1.7 to 6.7) 3/8 in. x 4 in., 6 ft. capillary WEL14A-602R Screwdriver Slot 140 (60)
A19ABC-4C SPDT 50 to 130 (10 to 55) 3-1/2 to 14 (1.9 to 8) 3/8 in. x 5 in., 8 ft. capillary WEL14A-603R Knob 170 (77)
A19ABC-24C3 SPDT -30 to 100 (-34 to 38) 3 to 12 (1.7 to 6.7) 3/8 in. x 4 in., 8 ft. capillary WEL14A-602R Convertible 140 (60)
A19ABC-36C SPDT -30 to 100 (-34 to 38) 3 to 12 (1.7 to 6.7) 3/8 in. x 4 in., 20 ft. capillary WEL14A-602R Convertible 140 (60)
A19ABC-37C SPDT -30 to 100 (-34 to 38) 3 to 12 (1.7 to 6.7) 3/8 in. x 4 in., 10 ft. capillary WEL14A-602R Screwdriver slot 140 (60)
A19ABC-74C SPDT -30 to 100 (-34 to 38) 3 to 12 (1.7 to 6.7) 3/8 in. x 4 in., 6 ft. capillary WEL14A-602R Screwdriver slot 140 (60)
Fixed Differential
A19AAF-12C SPDT 25 to 225 (-4 to 107) 3-1/2 (1.9) 3/8 in. x 3 in., 10 ft. capillary WEL14A-602R Screwdriver slot 275 (135)
Fixed Differential (Case Compensated)
A19AAC-4C SPDT 0 to 80 (-18 to 27) 5 (2.8) 3/8 in. x 4 in., 6 ft. capillary WEL14A-602R Screwdriver slot 140 (60)
A19AAD-12C SPST

Open low

-30 to 50 (-34 to 10) 2-1/2 (1.4) 3/8 in. x 4 in., 7 ft. capillary WEL14A-602R Screwdriver slot 140 (60)
Fixed Differential (Close)
A19AAD-5C4 SPST

Open low

30 to 50 (-1 to 10)

(Bulk Milk Cooler)

2-1/2 (1.4) 3/8 in. x 2-5/8 in.,

6 ft. capillary

WEL16A-601R Screwdriver slot 190 (88)
A19AAF-20C SPDT -30 to 100 (-34 to 38) 2-1/2 (1.4) 3/8 in. x 4 in., 6 ft. capillary WEL14A-602R Screwdriver slot 140 (60)
A19AAF-21C SPDT 40 to 90 (4 to 32) 1-1/2 (0.8) 3/8 in. x 5-3/4 in., 6 ft. capillary WEL14A-603R Screwdriver slot 140 (60)
Manual Reset
A19ACA-14C SPST

Open low

-30 to 100

(-34 to 38)

Manual reset 3/8 in. x 4 in.

6 ft capillary

WEL14A-602R Screwdriver slot 140 (60)
A19ACA-15C SPST

Open low

-30 to 100

(-34 to 38)

Manual reset 3/8 in. x 4 in. 10 ft capillary WEL14A-602R Screwdriver slot 140 (60)
A19ADB-1C SPST

Open high

100 to 240

(38 to 116)

Manual reset 3/8 in. x 3-1/2 in. 6 ft capillary WEL14A-602R Knob 290 (143)
A19ADB-38C SPST

Open high

100 to 240

(38 to 116)

Manual reset 3/8 in. x 4 in. 6 ft capillary WEL14A-602R Screwdriver slot 290 (143)
  1. Specify the control model code number, packing nut code number (if required), and bulb well code number (if required).
  2. Replaces White-Rodgers® 1609-101

3. Replaces White-Rodgers 1609-12, -13; Ranco® 010-1408, -1409, – 1410, -1490, 060-110; Honeywell® L6018C-1006, L6021A-1005, T675A-1011, -1508, -1516,

-1821, T4301A-1008, T6031A-1011, T6031A-1029

4. Case-Compensated

Single-Stage Electromechanical Temperature Controls

A19 Series Remote Bulb Control (Continued)

Replacement Parts

Product Code Number Description
CVR28A-617R Concealed adjustment cover
CVR28A-618R Visible scale cover
KNB20A-602R Replacement Knob Kit

Accessories

A packing nut is available for closed tank application. Specify the code number FTG13A-600R.

Bulb wells (WEL14A Series) are available for liquid immersion applications. See the selection chart or the Bulb Wells Catalog Page (LIT-1922135).

Technical Specifications

Electrical Ratings

Motor Ratings VAC 120 208 240
Wide Range – Adjustable Differential
AC Full Load A 16.0 9.2 8.0
AC Locked Rotor A 96.0 55.2 48.0
Non-Inductive A1 22 A, 120 to 277 VAC
Pilot Duty 125 VA, 24 to 600 VAC
Fixed Differential and Close Differential
AC Full Load A 6.0 3.4 3.0
AC Locked Rotor A 36.0 20.4 18.0
Non-Inductive A 10 A, 24 to 277 VAC
Pilot Duty 125 VA, 24 to 277 VAC
Case Compensated – Fixed Differential A19AAC-4
AC Full Load A 16.0 9.2 8.0
AC Locked Rotor A 96.0 55.2 48.0
Non-Inductive A1 22 A, 120 to 277 VAC
Pilot Duty 125 VA, 24 to 600 VAC
A19AAD-12
AC Full Load A 6.0 3.4 3.0
AC Locked Rotor A 36.0 20.4 18.0
Non-Inductive A 10 A, 24 to 277 VAC
Pilot Duty 125 VA, 24 to 277 VAC
Manual Reset
AC Full Load A 16.0 9.2 8.0
AC Locked Rotor A 96.0 55.2 48.0
Non-Inductive A 16.0 9.2 8.0
Pilot Duty 125 VA, 24 to 600 VAC

1. SPST and N.O. contact of SPDT control;

SPDT N.C. contact- 16 amperes 120 to 277 VAC

Single-Stage Electromechanical Temperature Controls Code No. LIT-1927015

A19 Series High Range Temperature Control

Description

The A19 Series Controls are single-stage temperature controls that incorporate liquid-filled sensing elements.

Refer to the A19 Series Hot Water Heating Controls Well Immersion Product Bulletin (LIT-125025) for important product application information.

Features

  • wide temperature ranges available
  • constant differential throughout the entire range
  • single-pole, single-throw (SPST) or single-pole, double-throw (SPDT) snap-acting switches
  • fixed or adjustable differential available
  • unaffected by barometric pressure changes
  • unaffected by cross-ambient conditions
  • compact enclosure
  • variety of sensing element styles

Applications

The A19s are suitable for temperature control in HVAC/R applications.

Selection Charts

A19 Series High Range Temperature Control

A19 Series

Y

R

B

Action on Increase of Temperature

a19.eps

A19 Series

Terminal Arrangement for SPDT

A19AAB Temperature Control

Product Code

Number1

Switch

Action

Range

°F (°C)

Diff F° (C°)

(Factory Set)

Bulb and

Capillary

Bulb Well No.

(Order Separately)

Range

Adjuster

Max Bulb

Temp °F (°C)

A19AAB-4C SPST, open high

Remote Bulb Thermostat

30 to 110

(-1 to 43)

3-1/2 (1.9) 3/8 in. x 5 in.

copper 6 ft. capillary2

WEL14A-602R Screwdriver slot

Visible scale

140 (60)
A19AAB-7C SPST, open high Oven Thermostat 100 to 300

(38 to 149)

7 (3.9) 3/16 in. x 9-1/2 in. copper 6 ft. capillary Knob Visible scale 350 (177)
A19AAB-10C SPST, open high Oven Thermostat 200 to 550

(93 to 288)

10 (5.6) 3/16 in. x 6 in. copper 8 ft. capillary Convertible 620 (327)
A19AAC-9C SPDT 100 to 240

(38 to 116)

6 (3.3) 3/8 in. x 3-1/2 in. copper 6 ft. capillary2 WEL14A-602R Screwdriver slot Visible Scale 290 (143)
A19ABB-2C SPST, open high Remote Bulb Thermostat 50 to 200

(10 to 93)

Adjustable 6 to 24

(3 to 13)

0.290 in. x 2-1/2 in. copper 10 ft. capillary Knob

Visible Scale

240 (116)
A19ABB-7C 50 to 201

(10 to 94)

7 x 64 mm

copper 3m capillary

240 (116)
  1. Specify code number, and closed tank fitting (Code Number FTG13A-600R), or bulb well, if required.
  2. With 3-inch bulb support

Replacement Parts

Product Code Number Description
CVR28A-617R Concealed adjustment cover
CVR28A-618R Visible scale cover
KNB20A-602R Replacement knob kit

Technical Specifications

Electrical Ratings

Motor Ratings VAC 120 208 240
AC Full Load A 16.0 9.2 8.0
AC Locked Rotor A 96.0 55.2 48.0
Non-Inductive A1 22 A, 120 to 277 VAC
Pilot Duty 125 VA, 24 to 600 VAC

1. SPST and N.O. contact of SPDT control SPDT N.C. contact – 16 A, 120 to 277 VAC

Single-Stage Electromechanical Temperature Controls Code No. LIT-1927020

A19 Series Thermostat for Crop Drying

Description

The A19 Series are single-stage temperature controls that incorporate liquid-filled sensing elements.

Refer to the A19 Series Utility Thermostats for Farm, Industrial, and Commercial Use Product Bulletin (LIT-125030) for important product application information.

Technical Specifications

The maximum bulb temperature for the A19AAE-3 is 200°F (93°C) and for the A19ABB-2 is 240°F (116°C).

Electrical Rating 120 VAC

Motor Ratings VAC 120 208 240
A19AAE-3
AC Full Load A 6.0 3.4 3.0
AC Locked Rotor A 36.0 20.4 18.0
Non-Inductive or Resistance Load A (Not Lamp Loads) 10 A

120 to 277 VAC

Pilot Duty 125 VA,

24 to 277 VAC

A19ABB-2
AC Full Load A 10.0 6.0
AC Locked Rotor A 60.0 36.0
Pilot Duty 125 VA,

24 to 600 VAC

Features

  • designed for high temperature applications
  • narrow (2F° fixed) or wide adjustable differentials

Applications

Crop drying thermostat energizes gas valve to maintain temperature.

Repair Information

If the A19 Series Thermostat for Crop Drying fails to operate within its specifications, replace the unit. For a replacement thermostat, contact the nearest Johnson Controls® representative.

Selection Chart

A19AAE-3 Thermostat

Product

Code Number

Switch

Action

Range

°F (°C)

Differential

F°(C°)

Bulb and

Capillary

Range

Adjuster

Max. Bulb

Temperature

°F (°C)

A19AAE-3C Single-Pole,

Single-Throw (SPST) open high

80 to 180

(27 to 82)

2 (1.1) fixed 1/8 in. x 1-1/4 in.

copper-coiled 10 ft capillary

Knob

Ext. scale

200 (93)
A19ABB-2C SPST open high 50 to 200

(10 to 93)

6 to 24

(3 to 13)

adjustable

0.290 in. x 2-1/2 in.

10 ft. capillary

Knob

Ext. Scale

240 (116)
Single-Stage Electromechanical Temperature Controls Code No. LIT-1927030

A19 Series Hot Water Temperature Control (Well Immersion)

Description

The A19 Series Temperature Controls are a universal replacement control for open high or single-pole, double-throw (SPDT) applications. The control is furnished with a well assembly for 1/2 in. tapping.

Refer to the A19 Series Hot Water Heating Controls Well Immersion Product Bulletin (LIT-125025) for important product application information.

Features

  • liquid-filled element provides rapid response to temperature change
  • adjustable differential
  • universal replacement

Applications

This operating control is ideal for hot water boilers.

Selection Charts

A19 Series Hot Water Temperature Control (Well Immersion)

A19ABC-11

Temperature Control

A19ABC-12 Temperature Control

Product Code

Number

Application Switch

Action

Range

°F (°C)

Differential

F° (C°)

Well Connector

Size–NPT

Range

Adjuster

Max. Bulb Temp.

°F (°C)

A19ABC-11C Open high (R-B)

Open low (R-Y)

Single-Pole,

Double-Throw (SPDT)

100 to 240

(38 to 116)

6 to 24

(3 to 13)

1/2 in. Convertible 250 (121)
A19ABC-12C 1/2 in.; 8 ft. capillary 290 (143)
A19ADB-2C High temperature lockout Single-Pole, Single-Throw (SPST)

Open high with lockout

100 to 240

(38 to 116)

Manual reset (locks out high) 1/2 in. Knob 250 (121)

Replacement Parts

Product Code Number Description
CVR28A-617R Concealed adjustment cover
CVR28A-618R Visible scale cover
KNB20A-602R Knob kit

Technical Specifications

Electrical Ratings

Motor Ratings VAC 120 240
AC Full Load A 10.0 6.0
AC Locked Rotor A 60.0 36.0
Pilot Duty 125 VA, 24 to 600 VAC

Single-Stage Electromechanical Temperature Controls Code No. LIT-1927035

A19 Temperature Control Less Enclosure (SPDT, Close Differential)

Description

The A19 Temperature Control Less Enclosure is an open-type temperature control for mounting in cases or enclosures.

Refer to the A19 Series Temperature Controls Less Enclosure Product Bulletin (LIT-125045) for important product application information.

Features

This control is designed with single-pole, double-throw (SPDT) contacts for open high or open low applications.

Applications

Use for panel-mounted temperature control for a packaged terminal air conditioner or for

self-contained HVAC equipment.

Selection Charts

A19 Series

Y

R

B

Action on Increase of Temperature

a19.eps

A19 Series

Terminal Arrangement for SPDT

A19AGF-31 Temperature Control

A19 Temperature Control Less Enclosure (SPDT, Close Differential) Replacement Parts

Product

Code Number

Switch

Action

Range

°F (°C)

Differential

F° (C°)

Bulb and

Capillary

Range

Adjuster

Maximum

Bulb Temp.

°F (°C)

Product Code Number Description
CVR28A-617R Concealed adjustment
CVR28A-618R Visible scale
A19AGF-31C Single-Pole,

Double-Throw (SPDT)

40 to 90

(4 to 32)

1-1/2

(0.8)

3/8 x 5 in.;

5 ft. capillary

Shaft 140 (60) KNB20A-602R Knob Kit

Technical Specifications Electrical Ratings

Motor Ratings VAC 120 208 240
AC Full Load A 6.0 3.4 3.0
AC Locked Rotor A 36.0 20.4 18
Non-Inductive 10 A, 120 to 277 VAC
Pilot Duty 125 VA, 24 to 277 VAC
  • back mounting
  • knob supplied by the customer
Single-Stage Electromechanical Temperature Controls Code No. LIT-1927045

A19 Series Thermostat for Hazardous Locations

Description

The A19 Series Thermostat provides remote bulb or coiled bulb sensing for hazardous environments.

Refer to the Types A19AUC, A19BUC Fixed Differential Thermostat For Hazardous Location Product Bulletin (LIT-121035) for important product application information.

Features

  • precision enclosed switch and a liquid-filled sensing element provides repeat accuracy that is unaffected by barometric pressure and cross-ambient temperature fluctuations
  • single-pole, double-throw (SPDT) switch provides open high or close high action for heating or cooling
  • electrical rating permits direct control of most equipment

Selection Chart

Applications

These thermostats are designed for use in grain elevators, chemical and powder plants, mines, oil refineries, and similar sites. For use in Class I, Group D and Class II, Groups E, F, and G hazardous locations.

Repair Information

If the A19 Series Thermostat for Hazardous Locations fails to operate within its specifications, replace the unit. For a replacement thermostat, contact the nearest Johnson Controls® representative.

Technical Specifications

Electrical Ratings

Motor Ratings VAC 120 208 240 277
Full Load Amperes 16.0 9.2 8.0
Locked Rotor Amperes 96.0 55.2 48.0
Non-Inductive Amperes 22.0 22.0 22.0 22.0
Pilot Duty 125 VA, 24 to 600 VAC

A19AUC

Thermostat

A19BUC

Thermostat

Product Code

Number

Switch

Action

Range

°F (°C)

Differential

F° (C°)

Bulb and

Capillary

Bulb well

(if required)

Range

Adjuster

Maximum Bulb

Temp. °F (°C)

A19AUC-1C SPDT -30 to 50 (-34 to 10) 5 (2.8) 3/8 in. x 4-1/16 in., 6 ft. capillary WEL14A-602R Knob 140 (60)
A19AUC-2C 20 to 80 (-7 to 27) 3-1/2 (1.9) 3/8 in. x 4-31/32 in., 6 ft. capillary WEL14A-603R 140 (60)
A19AUC-3C 0 to 150 (-18 to 66) 6 (3) 3/10 x 2-1/2 in., 10 ft. capillary WEL16A-600R 190 (88)
A19AUC-4C 100 to 250 (38 to 121) 6 (3) 3/10 x 2-3/8 in., 10 ft. capillary WEL16A-600R 290 (143)
A19BUC-2C 20 to 80 (-7 to 27) 3-1/2 (1.9) Coiled 140 (60)

Single-Stage Electromechanical Temperature Controls Code No. LIT-1927050

A19 Series Coiled Bulb Space Thermostat

Description

The A19 Series Thermostat is a wide range temperature control with air coil sensing element.

Refer to the A19 Series Utility Thermostats for Farm, Industrial, and Commercial Use Product Bulletin (LIT-125030) for important product application information.

Features

  • wide temperature range
  • NEMA 1 enclosure

Applications

Use for return air or space temperature sensing.

Selection Charts

A19 Series Coiled Bulb Space Thermostat

A19 Series

Y

R

B

Action on Increase of Temperature

a19.eps

A19 Series

Terminal Arrangement for SPDT

A19BAC Thermostat

Technical Specifications

Electrical Ratings

Motor Ratings VAC 120 208 240
A19BAB, A19BAC
AC Full Load A 16.0 9.2 8.0
AC Locked Rotor A 96.0 55.2 48.0
Non-Inductive or Resistance Load A1 (Not Lamp Loads) 22 A,

120 to 277 VAC

Pilot Duty 125 VA,

24 to 600 VAC

A19BAF
AC Full Load A 6.0 3.4 3.0
AC Locked Rotor A 36.0 20.4 18.0
Non-Inductive or Resistance Load A (Not Lamp Loads) 10 A,

120 to 277 VAC

Pilot Duty 125 VA,

24 to 277 VAC

Cooling – A19BBC
AC Full Load A 16.0 9.2 8.0
AC Locked Rotor A 96.0 55.2 48.0
Non-Inductive or Resistance Load A1 (Not Lamp Loads) 22 A,

120 to 277 VAC

Pilot Duty 125 VA,

24 to 600 VAC

Product

Code Number

Switch

Action

Range

°F (°C)

Differential

F° (C°)

Bulb and

Capillary

Range

Adjuster

Maximum

Bulb Temp

°F (°C)

Ventilating, Heating
A19BAB-3C Single-Pole,

Single-Throw (SPST),

open high

35 to 95

(0 to 35)

3 (1.7) fixed 1-3/8 in. x 2-1/4 in.

coiled

Knob 140 (60)
A19BAC-1C Single-Pole,

Double-Throw (SPDT)

30 to 110

(-1 to 43)

3-1/2 (1.9)

fixed

1-3/8 in. x 2-1/4 in.

coiled

Convertible
A19BAF-1C SPDT 30 to 110

(-1 to 43)

1-1/2 (0.9)

fixed

1-3/8 in. x 2-1/4 in.

coiled

Knob
Cooling
A19BBC-2C 1 SPDT -30 to 100

(-34 to 38)

3 to 12

(1.7 to 7)

1-3/8 in. x 2-1/4 in.

coiled

Convertible 140 (60)

1. Replaces White-Rodgers® 201-16, -8, 2A37-1; Ranco® 010-1418, -1802, 016-594, C30-C1101; Honeywell® T631A, T696A, T6054 A1005.

Replacement Parts

Product Code Number Description
CVR28A-617R Concealed adjustment cover
CVR28A-618R Visible scale cover
KNB20A-602R Knob kit

1. SPST and only one side of SPDT control; SPDT – 16 A 120 to 277 VAC

Single-Stage Electromechanical Temperature Controls Code No. LIT-1927055

Description

A19 Thermostat for Portable Heaters (Chain Mount and Drop Cord Electrical Connection)

Applications

The A19 Series Thermostat is a sturdy compact thermostat designed especially for temporary installations.

Refer to the Type A19BAG Thermostat for Portable Heaters with Thermostat Extension Cord and Beaded Chain Hanger Product Bulletin (LIT-121040) for important product application information.

Features

  • 6-foot extension cord with piggyback style plug
  • NEMA 1 enclosure
  • chain mount

Selection Chart

  • on/off control of portable space heaters
  • agriculture

Repair Information

If the A19 Thermostat for Portable Heater fails to operate within its specifications, replace the unit. For a replacement thermostat, contact the nearest Johnson Controls® representative.

Technical Specifications

Electrical Ratings

Motor Ratings VAC 120
AC Full Load A 15
AC Locked Rotor A 90

A19BAG-1 Thermostat

Product Code

Number

Switch Action Range

°F (°C)

Differential

F° (C°)

Maximum Bulb

Temperature °F (°C)

A19BAG-1C Single-Pole,

Single-Throw (SPST) open high No-Heat position

35 to 95

(2 to 35)

3 (1.7)

Non-adjustable

140 (60)
Single-Stage Electromechanical Temperature Controls Code No. LIT-1900402

A19 Thermostat for Portable Cooling Applications (Chain Mount and Drop Cord Electrical Connection)

Description

The A19 Series Thermostat is a sturdy compact thermostat designed especially for temporary installations.

Refer to the A19 Series Hot Water Heating Controls Well Immersion Product Bulletin (LIT-125025) for important product application information.

Features

  • 6-foot extension cord with piggyback style plug
  • NEMA 1 enclosure
  • chain mount
  • remote sensing bulb with 6 ft (1.8 m) capillary tube

Selection Chart

Applications

  • on/off control of portable cooling applications
  • home brewing

Repair Information

If the A19 Thermostat for Portable Cooling Applications (Chain Mount and Drop Cord Electrical Connections) fails to operate within its specifications, replace the unit. For a replacement thermostat, contact the nearest Johnson Controls® representative.

Technical Specifications

Electrical Ratings

Motor Ratings VAC 120
AC Full Load Amperes 15
AC Locked Rotor Amperes 90

A19AAT-2 Thermostat

Product

Code Number

Switch

Action

Range

°F (°C)

Differential

F° (C°)

Maximum Bulb

Temperature

°F (°C)

A19AAT-2C Single-Pole, Single-Throw

(SPST)

open low

20 to 80 (-7 to 27) 3-1/2 ± 2 (2 ± 1.11)

Non-adjustable

140 (60)

Single-Stage Electromechanical Temperature Controls Code No. LIT-1927060

A19 Series Automatic Changeover with Strap-On Mounting

Description

The A19 Series Changeover is a control for use with combination heating and cooling thermostats.

Refer to the A19CAC Type Automatic Changeover Control Product Bulletin

(LIT-125065) for important product application information.

Features

This control automatically selects the correct thermostat function.

Applications

Recommended for convectors, fan coils, and blast coil units, and similar devices. The A19CAC-2 Control can be mounted directly on either a vertical or a horizontal pipe, using the can mounting strap supplied with control. The A19CAC-1 Control has a remote bulb for greater mounting convenience.

Selection Charts

A19 Series

Y

R

B

Action on Increase of Temperature

a19.eps

A19 Series

Terminal Arrangement for SPDT

A19CAC-1 Control (Remote Bulb Model)

Technical Specifications

A19 Series Automatic Changeover with Strap-on Mounting

Product Code Number Switch Action Range °F (°C) Differential F°(C°) Mounting
A19CAC-1C Single-Pole,

Double-Throw (SPDT)

60 to 90 (16 to 32) 10 (5.6) 42 in. Capillary
A19CAC-2C SPDT 60 to 90 (16 to 32) 10 (5.6) Direct

Replacement Parts

  • maximum case ambient temperature: 131°F (55°C)
  • maximum bulb temperature: 250°F (121°C)

Electrical Ratings

Motor Ratings VAC 120 240
AC Full Load A 10.0 6.0
AC Locked Rotor A 60.0 36.0
AC Non-Inductive A 10.0 6.0
Pilot Duty 125 VA,

24 to 240 VAC

Product Code Number Description
CVR28A-617R Concealed adjustment cover

Single-Stage Electromechanical Temperature Controls Code No. LIT-1927065

A19D Series Surface Mounted Temperature Controls

Description

The A19D Series Surface Mounted Temperature Controls are reliable, durable On/Off temperature controls with line-voltage single-pole, double-throw (SPDT) switches. The A19D Series Controls are designed primarily for fluid piping applications and include two adjustable mounting straps for mounting the control directly to a pipe.

Refer to the A19D Series Surface Mounted Temperature Controls Product Bulletin

(LIT-125070) for important product application information.

Features

  • SPDT switch action provides either high or low temperature detection.
  • sealed, dust-protected switch provides reliable and durable On/Off control for commercial and industrial applications.
  • color-coded electrical terminals simplify wiring the controls.
  • sensing element insulated from the control case minimizes the effects of ambient temperature on the control setpoint.

Selection Chart

  • convertible range adjuster kit provides knob, screwdriver, or concealed adjustment options.
  • multi-position mounting capability allows you to mount the control in any position on horizontal, vertical, or angled pipes.
  • NEMA 1 enclosure provides protection against contact with the control’s electrical components and protects the switch and electrical terminals from incidental contact.

Applications

Typical A19D control applications include high temperature detection on boiler applications and low temperature detection on unit heaters coil applications.

SPDT Switch

Switch Action 6

At Setpoint Y-R is open

B-R is closed

On Increase Y-R closes B-R opens

Y

R

B

A19D Series Control Switch Action

FIG:6SPDT_chngHI

A19D Series Temperature Control

Repair Information

If the A19D Series Surface Mounted Temperature Control fails to operate within its specifications, replace the unit. For a replacement control, contact the nearest Johnson Controls® representative.

Product Code

Number

Description
A19DAC-1C 100 to 240°F Temperature Range and Scale, 10 F° (± 2.8 F°) Differential, Visible Range Scale
A19DAC-9C 40 to 120°C Temperature Range and Scale, 6 C° (± 1.0 C°) Differential, Visible Range Scale
A19DAC-10C 40 to 120°C Temperature Range and Scale, 6 C° (± 1.0 C°) Differential, Concealed Range Scale
A19DAC-12C 100 to 240°F Temperature Range and Scale, 10 F° (± 2.8 F°) Differential, Concealed Range Scale
A19DAF-2C 200 to 240°F Temperature Range and Scale, 3-1/2 F° (± 2.0 F°) Differential, Concealed Range Scale

Technical Specifications

A19D Series Surface Mount Temperature Controls
Product Code Number A19DAC: SPDT switch, standard differential

A19DAF: SPDT switch, narrow differential

Adjustable Temperature Range A19DAC: 100 to 240°F or 40 to 120°C A19DAF: 200 to 240°F (95 to 120°C)
Fixed Temperature Differential A19DAC: 10 F° or 6.0 C° A19DAF: 3-1/2 F° (1.9 C°)
Maximum Ambient Operating Temperature Controller Housing: 140°F (60°C) Sensor Element: 250°F (121°C)
Switch Contact Action SPDT, Snap Acting, Enclosed Dust Protected Pennswitch

Red to Yellow Terminal Contacts Close on Temperature Increase Red to Blue Terminal Contacts Open on Temperature Increase

Terminal Screws No. 8-32 x 1/4 in. Binder Head with Cup Washers
Electrical Ratings Motor Rating VAC A19DAC: Standard Differential

120 240

A19DAF: Narrow Differential

120 240

Full Load Amperes Locked Rotor Amperes Non-Inductive Amperes Pilot Duty 10.0 6.0

60.0 36.0

10.0 6.0

125 VA, 24 to 277 VAC

6.0 3.4

36.0 20.4

6.0 3.4

125 VA, 24 to 277 VAC

Enclosure NEMA Type 1 General Purpose; Cold Rolled Steel, Gray Baked Enamel
Mounting Clamp-On (Straps Included)
Shipping Weight 1-1/5 lb (.54 kg)
Compliance UL Guide No. XAPX, File E6688 CSA Class No. 4813 02, File LR948

C-Tick

Single-Stage Electromechanical Temperature Controls Code No. LIT-1927070

A19 Flange Mounted Duct Thermostat

Description

The A19 Flange Mounted Duct Thermostat is a wide-range temperature control with a special air coil sensing element and an adjustable mounting flange.

Refer to the A19 Series Hot Water Heating Controls Well Immersion Product Bulletin (LIT-125025) for important product application information.

Features

  • single-pole, double-throw (SPDT) snap-action switch
  • unaffected by barometric pressure or cross-ambient temperatures
  • flat flange mounting with the coil element permits positioning the sensing bulb in the appropriate portion of the air stream

Selection Charts

A19 Flange Mounted Duct Thermostat

Applications

These duct thermostats are used on rooftop units, make-up heaters, duct heaters, and air handling systems of all types.

Technical Specifications

Electrical Ratings

Motor Ratings VAC 120 208 240
AC Full Load A 6.0 3.4 3.0
AC Locked Rotor A 36.0 20.4 18.0
Non-Inductive 10 A, 120 to 277 VAC
Pilot Duty 125 VA, 24 to 277 VAC

A19EAF Thermostat

Product Code

Number

Switch

Action

Range

°F (°C)

Differential

F° (C°)

Maximum Bulb

Temperature °F (°C)

A19EAF-1C SPDT 60 to 130 (16 to 54) 2 (1.1) 200 (93)
A19EAF-2C SPDT 30 to 110 (-1 to 43) 2 (1.1) 140 (60)

Replacement Parts

Product Code Number Description
CVR28A-618R Visible scale cover
Single-Stage Electromechanical Temperature Controls Code No. LIT-1927075

A19 Series Fan or Cutout Control (Liquid Expansion Bulb)

Description

The A19 Series Fan or Cutout Control is a wide range temperature control with adjustable dial stops and mounting flange.

Refer to the A19E Series Warm Air Fan and Duct Controls Low or Line Voltage Product Bulletin (LIT-125075) for important product application information.

Features

  • liquid charged element for fast response
  • may be mounted in any position

Applications

This control is designed for low or line voltage applications including warm air or furnace fan control.

Selection Chart

A19 Series Fan or Cutout Control (Liquid Expansion Bulb)

A19EBA, A19EBB, A19EBC

A19EDB Cutout Controls (A19EDB not for use as cutout control)

Product Code

Number

Application Switch

Action

Range

°F (°C)

Differential F° (C°) Adjustable Stop °F (°C) Bulb

Length

Maximum Bulb

Temperature °F (°C)

Min Max Min Max
A19EBA-1C Furnace Fan

Control

Close high

Single-Pole, Single-Throw (SPST)

50 to 250

(10 to 121)

9

(5)

36

(20)

145

(63)

250

(121)

6 in. 290

(143)

A19EBB-1C Warm Air Open high SPST 100 to 350

(38 to 177)

9

(5)

36

(20)

240

(116)

350

(177)

6 in. 375

(191)

A19EBC-1C Counter-Flow Warm Air Furnace Single-Pole, Double-Throw (SPDT) 100 to 350

(38 to 177)

9

(5)

36

(20)

240

(116)

350

(177)

6 in. 375

(191)

A19EDB-1C1 Warm Air With Lock Out Open high SPST 100 to 350

(38 to 177)

Manual Reset 240

(116)

350

(177)

6 in. 375

(191)

1. A19EDB-1 not for use as a limit control.

Replacement Parts

Product Code Number Description
CVR28A-618R Visible scale cover

Technical Specifications

Electrical Ratings

Motor Ratings VAC 120 208 240 277
A19EBA, A19EBB
AC Full Load A 16.0 9.2 8.0
AC Locked Rotor A 96.0 55.2 48.0
AC Non-Inductive A 22.0 22.0 22.0 22.0
Pilot Duty 125 VA, 24 to 600 VAC
A19EBC
AC Full Load A 16.0 9.2 8.0
AC Locked Rotor A 96.0 55.2 48.0
AC Non-Inductive A 16.0 16.0 16.0 16.0
Pilot Duty 125 VA, 24 to 600 VAC
A19EDB
AC Full Load A 16.0 9.2 8.0
AC Locked Rotor A 96.0 55.2 48.0
AC Non-Inductive A 22.0 22.0 22.0 16.0
Pilot Duty 125 VA, 24 to 600 VAC
Single-Stage Electromechanical Temperature Controls Code No. LIT-1927040

A19 Temperature Control with Rainproof Enclosure

Description

The A19 Temperature Control is a remote bulb temperature control with a rainproof (NEMA Type 3R) enclosure.

Refer to the A19 Series Hot Water Heating Controls Well Immersion Product Bulletin (LIT-125025) for important product application information.

Features

This control has a rainproof gasketed enclosure.

Selection Chart

Applications

Use for control of cooling tower sump heaters.

Repair Information

If the A19 Temperature Control with Rainproof Enclosure fails to operate within its specifications, replace the unit. For a replacement control, contact the nearest Johnson Controls® representative.

A19ANC-1 Temperature Control

Product

Code Number

Switch

Action

Range

°F (°C)

Diff.

F° (C°)

Bulb and

Capillary

Bulb Well No.

(Order Separately)

Range

Adjuster

Max.

Bulb Temp.

°F (°C)

A19ANC-1C Single-Pole,

Double-Throw (SPDT)

0 to 150

(-18 to 66)

5 (2.8)

fixed

3/10 x 2-1/2 in.

10 ft. capillary

WEL11A-601R Screwdriver

slot

190 (88)

Technical Specifications

  • maximum bulb temperature: 190°F (88°C)
  • maximum ambient temperature: 140°F (60°C)

Electrical Ratings

Motor Ratings VAC 120 208 240 277
AC Full Load A 16.0 9.2 8.0
AC Locked Rotor A 96.0 55.2 48.0
Non-Inductive A When connected Single-Pole, Single-Throw (SPST) 22.0 22.0 22.0 22.0
When connected SPDT 16.0 9.2 8.0 6.9
Pilot Duty 125 VA, 24 to 600 VAC
Single-Stage Electromechanical Temperature Controls Code No. LIT-1927080

A19 Agricultural/Industrial Thermostat with NEMA 4X Enclosure

Description

The A19PRC is a single-stage temperature control designed for heating and ventilation applications. It features a raintight enclosure for use in agricultural and industrial applications that require compliance with Article 547 of the National Electrical Code. The A19PRC Thermostat has a rugged thermoplastic enclosure that meets NEMA 4X specifications.

Refer to the A19 Series Hot Water Heating Controls Well Immersion Product Bulletin (LIT-125025) for important product application information.

Features

  • an O-ring sealed setpoint adjustment knob
  • exposed portion of the liquid filled sensing elements are plated and plastic coated to resist damage in corrosive atmospheres

Selection Chart

Applications

Typical applications include controlling ventilation or heating equipment in animal confinement or industrial buildings.

Repair Information

If the A19 Agricultural/Industrial Thermostat with NEMA 4X Enclosure fails to operate within its specifications, replace the unit. For a replacement thermostat, contact the nearest Johnson Controls® representative.

Technical Specifications

Electrical Ratings

Motor Ratings VAC 120 208 240
AC Full Load A 16.0 9.2 8.0
AC Locked Rotor A 96.0 55.2 48.0
Non-Inductive or Resistance Load A (Not Lamp Loads)1 22 A, 120/277 VAC
Pilot Duty 125 VA, 24 to 600 VAC

1. Single-pole, single-throw (SPST) and only one side of single-pole, double-throw (SPDT) control; SPDT – 16 A, 120 to 277 VAC

A19PRC Thermostat

Product Code Number Switch Action Range °F (°C) Differential F° (C°) Bulb and Capillary Range Adjuster
A19PRC-1C SPDT 30 to 110 (1 to 43) 3 to 12 (1.7 to 6.7) 1-3/8 in. x 2 -1/4 in. Coiled Knob
Single-Stage Electromechanical Temperature Controls Code No. LIT-1927085

A19 Industrial Thermostat (Watertight and Dusttight)

Description

The A19 Industrial Thermostat is a wide range temperature control with rainproof enclosure, single-pole, double-throw (SPDT) switch, and 5F° fixed differential.

Refer to the A19 Series Hot Water Heating Controls Well Immersion Product Bulletin (LIT-125025) for important product application information.

Features

  • rugged steel enclosure
  • liquid filled sensing element (provides uniform control)

Applications

Use for refrigeration, air conditioning, and heating applications that require a NEMA 4 watertight and dusttight enclosure.

Accessories

Order code number WEL16A-600R bulb well, if required.

Repair Information

If the A19 Industrial Thermostat (Watertight and Dusttight) fails to operate within its specifications, replace the unit. For a replacement thermostat, contact the nearest Johnson Controls® representative.

Technical Specifications

Electrical Ratings

Motor Ratings VAC 120 208 240
AC Full Load A 16.0 9.2 8.0
AC Locked Rotor A 96.0 55.2 48.0
Non-Inductive or Resistance Load A (Not Lamp Loads) 16.0 9.2 8.0
Pilot Duty 125 VA,

24 to 600 VAC

Selection Chart

Product

Code Number

Switch

Action

Range

°F (°C)

Differential

F° (C°)

Bulb and

Capillary

Bulb Well No.

(Order Separately)

Range

Adjuster

A19KNC-1C SPDT 0 to 150

(-15 to 65)

5 (2.8) fixed 3/10 x 2-1/2 in.

10 ft. capillary

WEL16A-600R Knob

A19KNC-1 Thermostat

Single-Stage Electromechanical Temperature Controls Code No. LIT-1900403

A19 Temperature Control with NEMA 4X Enclosure (Remote Bulb)

Description

The A19 Temperature Control is a remote bulb temperature control with a watertight NEMA 4X enclosure.

Refer to the A19 Series Hot Water Heating Controls Well Immersion Product Bulletin (LIT-125025) for important product application information.

Applications

  • cooling tower sump heaters
  • control of heating or ventilating equipment

Technical Specifications

Maximum ambient temperature: 140°F (60°C).

Electrical Ratings

Features

  • watertight gasketed thermoplastic enclosure that meets NEMA 4X specifications
  • concealed setpoint adjustment

Repair Information

If the A19 Temperature Control with NEMA 4X Enclosure (Remote Bulb) fails to operate within its specifications, replace the unit. For a replacement control, contact the nearest Johnson Controls® representative.

A19QSC Temperature Control

Motor Ratings VAC 120 208 240 277
AC Full Load Amperes 16.0 9.2 8.0
AC Locked Rotor Amperes 96.0 55.2 48.0
Non-Inductive

Amperes

When connected

Single-Pole, Single-Throw (SPST)

22.0 22.0 22.0 22.0
When connected

Single-Pole, Double-Throw (SPDT)

16.0 9.2 8.0 6.9
Pilot Duty 125 VA, 24 to 600 VAC

Selection Chart

Product

Code Number

Switch

Action

Range

°F (°C)

Differential

F° (C°)

Bulb and Capillary Bulb Well No.

(Order Separately)

Range

Adjuster

Maximum Bulb

Temperature

°F (°C)

A19QSC-1C SPDT 0 to 150 (-18 to 66) 5±2 (2.82 ±1.11) fixed 3/10 x 2-1/2 in.; 10 ft. capillary WEL11A-601R Concealed

screwdriver slot

190 (88)
A19QSC-2C 100 to 250 (38 to 121) 6±2 (32 ±1.11) fixed 3/10 x 2-3/8 in.; 10 ft capillary 290 (143)
A19QSC-3C 200 to 350 (93 to 176) 5±2 (2.82 ±1.11) fixed 3/10 x 2-1/4 in.; 10 ft capillary 390 (199)
A19QSC-4C 0 to 190 (-18 to 88) 5±2 (2.82 ±1.11) fixed 3/10 x 2-1/2 in.; 20 ft capillary WEL11A-601R 190 (88)
Single-Stage Electromechanical Temperature Controls Code No. LIT-1927090

A19 Water Chiller Control with Locked Cut-Out/Adjustable Cut-In

Description

The A19 Water Chiller Control is a remote bulb temperature control with limited setpoint range, adjustable differential, and adjustable cut-out.

Refer to the A19ZBA Type Temperature Control Product Bulletin (LIT-121065) for important product application information.

Features

  • adjustable cut-out (38 to 47°F)
  • wide differential adjustment range

Accessories

  • includes Code No. FTG13A-600R Packing Nut as standard
  • replacement cover: CVR61A-600R

Selection Chart

Applications

Use for water chillers.

Repair Information

If the A19 Water Chiller Control with Locked Cut-Out/Adjustable Cut-In fails to operate within its specifications, replace the unit. For a replacement control, contact the nearest Johnson Controls® representative.

Technical Specifications

Maximum bulb temperature is 140°F (60°C).

Electrical Ratings

Motor Ratings VAC 120 208 240
AC Full Load A 16.0 9.2 8.0
AC Locked Rotor A 96.0 55.2 48.0
Non-Inductive or Resistance Load A (Not Lamp Loads) 16.0 9.2 8.0
Pilot Duty 125 VA, 24 to 277 VAC

A19ZBA Water Chiller Control

Product Code

Number

Switch

Action

Range

°F (°C)

Differential

F° (C°)

Bulb and

Capillary

Bulb Well No.

(Order Separately)

Range

Adjuster

A19ZBA-1C Single-Pole, Single-Throw

(SPST)

Close high, open low

38 to 80 (3 to 27) 8 to 40 (4 to 22)

Adjustable

3/8 in. x 3-7/16 in.

6 ft. capillary

WEL14A-602R Knob
Single-Stage Electromechanical Temperature Controls Code No. LIT-1927095

A19 Defrost Duration and Fan Delay Control

Description

The A19 Defrost Duration and Fan Delay Control is a remote bulb control with adjustable defrost termination temperature and preset fan delay temperature.

Refer to the A19ZBC Type Temperature Control Product Bulletin (LIT-121071) for important product application information.

Features

  • sensing element unaffected by barometer pressure and cross ambient temperature problems
  • limited adjustment range

Applications

Use for defrost termination control for refrigerated display cases.

Selection Chart

Repair Information

If the A19 Defrost Duration and Fan Delay Control fails to operate within its specifications, replace the unit. For a replacement control, contact the nearest Johnson Controls® representative.

Technical Specifications

  • maximum bulb temperature: 140°F (60°C)
  • fan delay temperature: factory set at 25°F (-4°C)

Electrical Ratings

Motor Ratings VAC 120 208 240
AC Full Load A 16.0 9.2 8.0
AC Locked Rotor A 96.0 55.2 48.0
Non-Inductive or Resistance Load A (Not Lamp Loads) 16.0 9.2 8.0
Pilot Duty 125 VA, 24 to 277 VAC

A19ZBC-2 Defrost Duration and Fan Delay Control

Product Code

Number

Switch

Action

Defrost Termination

°F (°C)

Bulb and

Capillary

Range

Adjuster

A19ZBC-2C Single-Pole,

Double-Throw (SPDT)

45 to 85 (7 to 29) 19/64 in. x 3-1/8 in.; 6 ft. capillary Knob

Single-Stage Electromechanical Temperature Controls Code No. LIT-1927105

A25 Series Warm Air Limit Control with Manual Reset

Description

The A25 Warm Air Control Locks out on a temperature increase to the control setpoint. Manual reset is required before the electrical contacts can be reclosed.

The A25 Control is normally located in a return air duct and is wired to shut down air conditioning or ventilating fans when the temperature of the air becomes excessively hot.

Refer to the A25 Series Warm Air Control with Manual Reset Product Bulletin (LIT-125118) for important product application information.

Applications

Use for high temperature cut-out.

Features

A25 Series

Y

R

B

Action on Increase of Temperature

a25.eps

A25 Series Action Diagram

A25AN-1 Warm Air Limit Control

Technical Specifications

A25AP-1 Warm Air Limit Control

  • trip-free reset lever does not permit restarting until the reset lever is manually released
  • the rod and tube type sensing element provides positive control action

Repair Information

If the A25 Series Warm Air Limit Control with Manual Reset fails to operate within its specifications, replace the unit. For a replacement control, contact the nearest Johnson Controls® representative.

Selection Chart

The maximum element temperature is 300°F (149°C).

Electrical Ratings

Motor Ratings VAC 120 208 240 277
AC Full Load A 16.0 9.2 8.0
AC Locked Rotor A 96.0 55.2 48.0
Non-Inductive A 16.0 A at 120/277 VAC
Pilot Duty 125 VA, 24 to 600 VAC
Product Code

Number

Switch

Action

Range

°F (°C)

Range

Adjuster

Dial Stop

°F (°C)

A25AN-1C Single-Pole,

Single-Throw (SPST),

Open high

25 to 215

(-4 to 102)

Knob High limit

set at 125 (52)

A25CN-1C Single-Pole, Double-Throw (SPDT) 25 to 215

(-4 to 102)

Knob High limit

set at 125 (52)

Factory Mutual Approved Models
A25AP-1C SPST

Open high

25 to 215

(-4 to 102)

Concealed

screwdriver slot

High limit

set at 125 (52)

A25CP-1C SPDT 25 to 215

(-4 to 102)

Concealed screwdriver slot High limit

set at 125 (52)

Single-Stage Electromechanical Temperature Controls Code No. LIT-1927140

A70 Series Four-Wire, Two-Circuit Temperature Control

Description

The A70 Series Temperature Control incorporates a vapor-charged sensing element. The A70G, A70H, and A70K have a four-wire, two-circuit contact block that contains two isolated sets of contacts.

The contacts are designed so that when the main contact opens, the auxiliary contact closes.

Refer to the A70, A72 Series Temperature Controls for Refrigeration and Heating Product Bulletin (LIT-125155) for important product application information.

Features

  • long-life, snap-acting contacts
  • automatic or manual reset models

Applications

Typical applications include energizing an indicator light after a low temperature cutout on a ventilating system.

Selection Charts

A70 Series

Action on Increase on Temperature

Li ne 2

M2

M1

Li ne 1

a70s.eps

A70 Series Action Diagram A70GA-1 Temperature Control

A70 Series Four-Wire, Two-Circuit Temperature Control

Product Code

Number

Switch Action Range

°F (°C)

Differential

F° (C°)

Bulb and

Capillary

Maximum Bulb

Temperature °F (°C)

Range

Adjuster

Main Contacts Auxiliary Contacts
A70GA-1C1 Open low Close low 15 to 55

(-9.4 to 12.8)

5 (2.8) 20 ft of 1/8 in.

O.D. tubing

400 (204.4) Screwdriver slot
A70GA-2C 35 to 80

(1.7 to 26.7)

3 to 30

(-16.1 to -1.1),

factory set at 12 (-11.1)

3/8 in. x 3 in.

6 ft capillary

250 (121)
A70HA-1C1 15 to 55

(-9.4 to 12.8)

Manual reset 20 ft of 1/8 in.

O.D. tubing

400 (204.4)
A70HA-2C 35 to 80

(1.7 to 26.7)

3/8 in. x 3 in.

6 ft capillary

250 (121)
A70HA-14C 15 to 55

(-9.4 to 12.8)

20 ft of 1/8 in.

O.D. tubing

400 (204.4)
A70KA-1C Open high Close high 100 to 170

(37.8 to 76.7)

3/8 in. x 3 in.

6 ft capillary

240 (116)

1. On these models, the low cutout stop is set and sealed at 35°F (1.6°C). It cannot be set lower. The control responds only to the lowest temperature along any 14 to 16 in. section of the entire 20 ft element.

Replacement Covers

Product Code Number Description
CVR17A-620R Automatic reset cover
CVR17A-621R Manual reset cover

Technical Specifications

Electrical Ratings

Pole Number LINE-M2 (Main) LINE-M1 (Auxiliary)
Motor Ratings VAC 120 208 240 277 4801 6001 120 208 240 277
AC Full Load A 16.0 9.2 8.0 5.0 4.8 6.0 3.4 3.0
AC Locked Rotor A 96.0 55.2 48.0 30.0 28.8 36.0 20.4 18.0
AC Non-Inductive A 16.0 9.2 8.0 7.2 6.0 6.0 6.0 6.0
Pilot Duty – Both Poles 125 VA, 120 to 600 VAC and 57.5 VA, 120 to 300 VDC

1. Not compressor motor loads.

Single-Stage Electromechanical Temperature Controls Code No. LIT-1927145

Description

A72 Series Two-Pole Heavy Duty Temperature Controls (Adjustable Differential)

A72 Series

The A72 Series Temperature Controls incorporate a vapor charged sensing element and heavy duty contacts.

Refer to the A70, A72 Series Temperature Controls for Refrigeration and Heating

(LIT-125155) for important product application information.

Features

The double-pole, single-throw (DPST) contact block contains two isolated sets of contacts that make or break simultaneously.

Applications

Use for automatic control of heavy electrical loads.

Selection Charts

M1

Line 1

M2

Line 2

Action on Increase on Temperature

A72 Action Diagram

A72AA-3 Temperature Control

a27.eps

Product Code

Number

Switch

Action

Range

°F (°C)

Differential

F° (C°)

Bulb and

Capillary

Maximum Bulb

Temperature °F (°C)

Range

Adjuster

A72AA-1C DPST

Close high Open low

-30 to 30

(-34 to -1)

4 to 25

(2 to 14)

3/8 in. x 3 in.1

6 ft capillary

200

(93)

Screwdriver slot
A72AA-2C DPST

Close high Open low

15 to 55

(-9 to 13)

3 to 30

(1.7 to 17)

3/8 in. x 3 in.1

6 ft capillary

200

(93)

Screwdriver slot
A72AA-3C DPST

Close high Open low

50 to 90

(10 to 32)

3 to 30

(1.7 to 17)

11/16 in. x 6-3/4 in. Cross ambient

6 ft capillary

135

(57)

Screwdriver slot
A72AP-1C2 DPST

Close high Open low

-10 to 65

(-23 to 18)

4 to 40

(2 to 22)

11/16 in. x 6-3/4 in. Cross ambient

6 ft capillary

130

(54)

Screwdriver slot
  1. Packing nut assembly available for direct immersion applications, Code No. FTG13A-600R.
  2. Equipped with manual PUSH TO START button. Manual start feature is especially desirable on milk cooler jobs; permits manual start of the compressor when bulb temperature is between closing and opening setting of switch.

Replacement Covers

Product Code Number Description
CVR17A-620R Automatic reset cover
CVR17A-621R Manual reset cover

Technical Specifications

Electrical Ratings

Motor Ratings VAC 120

Single-Phase

2081

Single-Phase

2401

Single-Phase

2201

Two-Phase

208

Three-Phase

220

Three-Phase

Horsepower 2 3 3 5 5 5
AC Full Load A 24.0 24.0 24.0 15.0 15.9 15.0
AC Locked Rotor A 144.0 144.0 144.0 90.0 95.4 90.0
AC Non-Inductive A 24.0 24.0 24.0
DC Non-Inductive A2 3.0 0.5
Pilot Duty 125 VA, 120 to 600 VAC; 57.5 VA, 120 to 300 VDC
  1. These full load and locked rotor ampere (not horsepower) ratings apply to hermetic compressors only.
  2. This rating does not apply to the A72AP-1C Control.
Single-Stage Electromechanical Temperature Controls Code No. LIT-1927160

A72 Series Cooling Tower or Evaporative Condenser Controls (Single-Stage Temperature Control with Outdoor Enclosure)

Description

The A72AE and A72CE are wide range temperature controls with heavy duty double-pole, single-throw (DPST) contacts and neoprene-coated sensing elements.

Refer to the A72 Series Temperature Controls for Cooling Towers and Evaporated Condensers with Weather Resistant Enclosure Product Bulletin (LIT-125165) for important product application information.

Selection Chart

Features

Open high or close high models are available.

Applications

Use for control of cooling tower fans; motorized valves or solenoid operated valves.

Repair Information

If the A72 Series Cooling Tower or Evaporative Condenser Control fails to operate within its specifications, replace the unit. For a replacement control, contact the nearest Johnson Controls® representative.

A72 Series Temperature Control

Product

Code Number

Switch

Action

Range

°F (°C)

Differential

F° (C°)

Bulb and

Capillary

Range

Adjuster

A72AE-1C DPST; close high 25 to 90

(-5 to 30)

4 to 25

(2.2 to 14)

11/16 in. x 6-3/4 in. Neoprene-coated 6 ft cap. Internal screwdriver slot
A72CE-1C DPST; open high

Technical Specifications

  • ambient temperature limits: -65 to 150°F (-54 to 66°C)
  • maximum bulb temperature: 170°F (77°C)

Electrical Ratings

Motor Ratings VAC 120

Single- Phase

2081

Single- Phase

2401

Single- Phase

2201

Two- Phase

208

Three- Phase

220

Three- Phase

Horsepower 2 3 3 5 5 5
AC Full Load A 24.0 24.0 24.0 15.0 15.9 15.0
AC Locked Rotor A 144.0 144.0 144.0 90.0 95.4 90.0
AC Non-Inductive A 24.0 24.0 24.0
DC Non-Inductive A 3.0 0.5
Pilot Duty 125 VA, 120 to 600 VAC; 57.5 VA, 120 to 300 VDC

1. These full load and locked rotor ampere (not horsepower) ratings apply to hermetic compressors only.

Single-Stage Electromechanical Temperature Controls Code No. LIT-1927150

A72AA Coiled Bulb Space Thermostat (Cooling)

Description

The A72 is a space sensing temperature control with heavy-duty contacts.

Refer to the A72 Series Temperature Controls for Cooling Towers and Evaporative Condensers with Weather Resistant Enclosure Product Bulletin (LIT-125165) for important product application information.

Applications

Use for compressor cycling for walk-in coolers and freezers.

Accessories

For replacement cover, order code number

CVR17A-620R.

Selection Chart

Product Code

Number

Switch

Action

Range

°F (°C)

Differential

F° (C°)

Bulb and

Capillary

Range

Adjuster

A72AA-4C DPST

Close high, open low

15 to 55

(-9 to 13)

3 to 30

(1.7 to 17)

Coiled copper

bulb

Screwdriver

slot

Technical Specifications

Maximum bulb temperature is 200°F (93°C).

Electrical Ratings

Features

Double-pole, single-throw (DPST) contact block contains two isolated sets of contacts that make or break simultaneously.

Repair Information

If the A72AA Coiled Bulb Space Thermostat fails to operate within its specifications, replace the unit. For a replacement thermostat, contact the nearest Johnson Controls® representative.

A72AA-4 Thermostat

Motor Ratings VAC 120

Single-Phase

2081

Single-Phase

2401

Single-Phase

2201

Two-Phase

208

Three-Phase

220

Three-Phase

Horsepower 2 3 3 5 5 5
AC Full Load Amperes 24.0 24.0 24.0 15.0 15.9 15.0
AC Locked Rotor Amperes 144.0 144.0 144.0 90.0 95.4 90.0
AC Non-Inductive Amperes 24.0 24.0 24.0
DC Non-Inductive Amperes 3.0 0.5
Pilot Duty 125 VA, 120 to 600 VAC; 57.5 VA, 120 to 300 VDC

1. These full load and locked rotor ampere (not horsepower) ratings apply to hermetic compressors only.

Single-Stage Electronic Temperature Controls Code No. LIT-1900933

A421 Series Electronic Temperature Controls

Description

The A421 Series Electronic Temperature Controls are single-stage controls with a single-pole, double-throw (SPDT) output relay.

A421 Controls feature a bright backlit LCD with adjustable brightness and a three-button touchpad interface that can be set up to restrict user adjustments. An LED indicates the output relay’s On/Off status. Standard A421 Series control modules have simple On and Off temperature settings for heating or cooling, an adjustable anti-short cycle delay, temperature setback, and sensor offset capability. The temperature control range is

-40 to 212°F or -40 to 100°C.

The A421 controls are available either in Type 1 (NEMA), IP20 (CE), high-impact plastic enclosures suitable for surface or DIN rail mounting or in Type 4X (NEMA), IP67 (CE) watertight, corrosion resistant surface mount enclosures.

Refer to the A421 Series Electronic Temperature Controls Product Bulletin (LIT-12011972) for important product application information.

Applications

The A421 Electronic Temperature Control can be used to control a wide variety of

single-stage refrigeration or HVAC equipment.

Sample temperature control applications include:

  • temperature monitoring and alarming
  • on/off control of boilers and chillers
  • boiler and chiller pump control
  • heating and cooling control
  • floating temperature control of damper and valve actuators
  • cooling tower fan control based on water temperature
  • supply, makeup, and mixed air temperature control
  • temperature actuated valve control
  • supply and makeup air damper and fan control
  • condenser fan control based on condenser temperature

Features

  • easy-to-read, bright, adjustable backlit LCD screen displays the temperature, parameters, and status clearly and allows you to adjust LCD brightness for the ambient light conditions. Custom icons on the display provide visual cues on system and control status.
  • basic and advanced programming menus allow you to easily set up your control application on the LCD using a simple three-button touchpad interface.
  • adjustable On and Off temperature setpoints enable easy to set up cooling or heating control applications on the

three-button touchpad, eliminating the need to remove the cover and reposition jumpers for reverse or direct control actions.

  • high and low temperature setpoint adjustment stops allow you to set up your application for your desired range of adjustment and restrict user adjustment to just the desired temperature adjustment range.
  • displayed temperature offset allows you to adjust the displayed temperature to the actual sensed temperature in applications where the resistance error in long sensor cable leads cause a deviation in the displayed temperature from the actual sensed temperature.
  • adjustable anti-short cycle delay keeps the output relay Off after the Off setpoint is reached for a user-defined time delay, which helps avoid short cycling, hard starts, and nuisance overload outages on compressors and other inductive applications.
  • temperature setback/offset control enables the control to shift the On and Off setpoint values by a user-defined offset when an external switch closes the binary input control circuit. Using a switching timer enables you to set up occupied/unoccupied temperature setback schedules for your applications.
  • high-impact, thermoplastic Type 1/IP20 or Type 4X (NEMA)/IP66 watertight, corrosion-resistant enclosures increase application options, allowing surface and snap-fit DIN rail mount, or watertight surface mount.

A421 Series Electronic Temperature Control

  • parameter adjustment restriction allows you to lock the control’s setup parameters and restrict user adjustments to just the On and Off temperature setpoint values within your defined setpoint adjustment range.
  • low- and line-voltage control models provide industry standard control voltage options for most refrigeration and HVAC control applications.

Repair Information

If the A421 Series Electronic Temperature Control fails to operate within its specifications, replace the unit. For a replacement A421 Control, contact the nearest Authorized

Johnson Controls/PENN® Distributer or Sales Representative.

Single-Stage Electronic Temperature Controls

A421 Series Electronic Temperature Controls (Continued)

Selection Chart

A421 Electronic Temperature Control Selection Chart

Product Code Number Description
A421ABC-02C Line-Voltage Type 1 Electronic Temperature Control: Type 1 (NEMA), IP20 standard enclosure for DIN rail and surface-mount

applications. Rated for 120/240 VAC.

Includes an A99BB-200C temperature sensor with 6 ft 7-1/5 in. (2.0 m) cable.

A421ABC-03C Line-Voltage Type 1 Electronic Temperature Control: Type 1 (NEMA), IP20 standard enclosure for DIN rail and surface-mount applications. Rated for 120/240 VAC.

Includes an A99BB-300C temperature sensor with 9 ft 9 in. (3.0 m) cable.

A421ABC-04C Line-Voltage Type 1 Electronic Temperature Control: Type 1 (NEMA), IP20 standard enclosure for DIN rail and surface-mount applications. Rated for 120/240 VAC.

Includes an A99BB-400C temperature sensor with 13 ft 1-1/5 in. (4.0 m) cable.

A421ABC-06C Line-Voltage Type 1 Electronic Temperature Control: Type 1 (NEMA), IP20 standard enclosure for DIN rail and surface-mount applications. Rated for 120/240 VAC. Includes an A99BB-400C temperature sensor with 19 ft 6 in. (6.0 m) cable.
A421AEC-01C Line-Voltage Type 4X Electronic Temperature Control: Type 4X (NEMA), IP67 weathertight enclosure for surface-mount applications. Rated for 120/240 VAC.

Includes an A99BB-25C temperature sensor with 9-7/8 in. (0.25 m) cable.

A421AEC-02C Line-Voltage Type 4X Electronic Temperature Control: Type 4X (NEMA), IP67 weathertight enclosure for surface-mount applications. Rated for 120/240 VAC.

Includes an A99BB-200C temperature sensor with 6 ft 7-1/5 in. (2.0 m) cable.

A421GBF-02C Low-Voltage Type 1 Electronic Temperature Control: Type 1 (NEMA), IP20 standard enclosure for DIN rail and surface-mount applications. Rated for 24 VAC Class 2, Safety Extra Low Voltage.

Includes an A99BB-200C temperature sensor with 6 ft 7-1/5 in. (2.0 m) cable.

A421GEF-01C Low-Voltage Type 4X Electronic Temperature Control: Type 4X (NEMA), IP67 weathertight enclosure for surface-mount applications. Rated for 24 VAC Class 2, Safety Extra Low Voltage (SELV).

Includes an A99BB-25C temperature sensor with 9-7/8 in. (0.25 m) cable.

A421GEF-02C Low-Voltage Type 4X Electronic Temperature Control: Type 4X (NEMA), IP67 weathertight enclosure for surface-mount applications. Rated for 24 VAC Class 2 (SELV).

Includes an A99BB-200C temperature sensor with 6 ft 7-1/5 in. (2.0 m) cable.

A99 Temperature Sensors Compatible with the A421 Control1

Product Code

Number

Description
A99BA-200C PTC Temperature Sensor: Standard probe 2 in. (5.1 cm) with 6 ft 7-1/5 in. (2.0 m) shielded PVC cable; Ambient operating temperature range: -40 to 212ºF (-40 to 100ºC)
A99BB-25C PTC Temperature Sensor: Standard probe 2 in. (5.1 cm) with 9-7/8 in. (0.25 m) PVC cable; Ambient operating temperature range: -40 to 212ºF (-40 to 100ºC)
A99BB-200C PTC Temperature Sensor: Standard probe 2 in. (5.1 cm) with 6 ft 7-1/5 in. (2.0 m) PVC cable; Ambient operating temperature range: -40 to 212ºF (-40 to 100ºC)
A99BB-300C PTC Temperature Sensor: Standard probe 2 in. (5.1 cm) with 9 ft 9-3/5 in. (3.0 m) PVC cable; Ambient operating temperature range: -40 to 212ºF (-40 to 100ºC)
A99BB-400C PTC Temperature Sensor: Standard probe 2 in. (5.1 cm) with 13 ft 1-1/5 in. (4.0 m) PVC cable; Ambient operating temperature range: -40 to 212ºF (-40 to 100ºC)
A99BB-600C PTC Temperature Sensor: Standard probe 2 in. (5.1 cm) with 19 ft 8-2/5 in. (6.0 m) PVC cable; Ambient operating temperature range: -40 to 212ºF (-40 to 100ºC)
A99BC-25C PTC Temperature Sensor: Standard probe 2 in. (5.1 cm) with 9-7/8 in. (0.25 m) high-temperature silicon cable; Ambient operating temperature range: -40 to 248ºF (-40 to 100ºC)
A99BC-100C PTC Temperature Sensor: Standard probe 2 in. (5.1 cm) with 3 ft 3-3/5 in. (1.0 m) high-temperature silicon cable; Ambient operating temperature range: -40 to 248ºF (-40 to 120ºC)
A99BC-300C PTC Temperature Sensor: Standard probe 2 in. (5.1 cm) with 9 ft 9-3/5 in. (3.0 m) high-temperature silicon cable; Ambient operating temperature range: -40 to 248ºF (-40 to 120ºC)
A99BC-500C PTC Temperature Sensor: Standard probe 2 in. (5.1 cm) with 16 ft 4-4/5 in. (5.0 m) high-temperature silicon cable; Ambient operating temperature range: -40 to 248ºF (-40 to 120ºC)
A99BC-1500C PTC Temperature Sensor: Standard probe 2 in. (5.1 cm) with 49 ft 2-2/5 in. (15.0 m) high-temperature silicon cable; Ambient operating temperature range: -40 to 248ºF (-40 to 120ºC)
A99CB-200C PTC Temperature Sensor: Extended probe 6 in. (15.2 cm) with 6 ft 7-1/5 in. (2.0 m) PVC cable; Ambient operating temperature range: -40 to 212ºF (-40 to 100ºC)
A99CB-600C PTC Temperature Sensor: Extended probe 6 in. (15.2 cm) with 19 ft 8-2/5 in. (6.0 m) PVC cable; Ambient operating temperature range: -40 to 212ºF (-40 to 100ºC)

1. When any A99 Series Temperature Sensor is connected to a standard temperature A421 Control model, the range of usable values is -40 to 212ºF (-40 to 100ºC).

Single-Stage Electronic Temperature Controls

A421 Series Electronic Temperature Controls (Continued)

Accessories for the A421 Controls

Product Code

Number

Description
BKT287-1R 12 in. (305 mm) long DIN rail section
BKT287-2R 36 in. (914 mm) long DIN rail section
PLT344-1R Two End Clamps for DIN rail sections
A99-CLP-1 Surface Mounting Clip for A99B and A99C Series Temperature Sensors
SHL10-603R Sun Shield for A99B and A99C Series Temperature Sensors
BOX10A-603R PVC Enclosure for A99B and A99C Series Temperature Sensors
WEL11A-601R Immersion well for applying sensor in fluid applications

Technical Specifications

A421 Series Electronic Temperature Controls
Power Consumption 1.8 VA maximum
Supply Power Low Voltage Models: 24 VAC (20 to 30 VAC), 50/60 Hz, Class 2 or Safety Extra-Low Voltage Line Voltage Models: 110/120 or 208/230/240 VAC, 50/60 Hz
Ambient Conditions Operating: Type 1 Models: -40 to 150°F (-40 to 66°C), 0 to 95% RH Noncondensing Type 4X Models: -40 to 140°F (-40 to 60°C), 0 to 95% RH Noncondensing

Shipping and Storage: -40 to 185°F (-40 to 85°C), 0 to 95% RH Noncondensing

Temperature Control Range -40 to 212°F (-40 to 100°C)
Input Signal 1,035 ohm at 77F (25C) for A99 PTC temperature sensors
Sensor Offset Range ±5ºF or ±3ºC
Output Relay Contacts Electrical Ratings 24 VAC models:

100 VA, 30 VAC maximum, Class 2

120/240 VAC models: Applied Voltage: Horsepower N.O. (N.C.) :

Full Load Amperes N.O. (N.C.):

Locked Rotor Amperes N.O. (N.C.): Resistive Amperes N.O. (N.C.): Pilot Duty N.O. (N.C.):

24 VAC

15 (10) A

125 (50) VA

120 VAC

1 (0.25) hp

16 (5.8) A

96 (34.8) A

15 (10) A

125 (125) VA

208 VAC

1 (0.33) hp

9.2 (4.0) A

55.2 (24) A

10 (10) A

125 (125) VA

240 VAC

1 (0.5) hp

8.0 (4.9) A

48 (29.4) A

10 (10) A

125 (125) VA

Enclosure Material Type 1/IP20 high-impact thermoplastic or Type 4X/IP66 watertight, corrosion-resistant, high-impact thermoplastic
Compliance

North America: cULus Listed; UL 60730, File E27734, Vol. 1; FCC Compliant to CFR47, Part 15, Subpart B, Class B Industry Canada (IC) Compliant to Canadian ICES-003, Class B limits

Europe: CE Mark – Johnson Controls, Inc. declares that this product is in compliance with the essential requirements and

other relevant provisions of the EMC Directive 2004/108/EC and the Low Voltage Directive 2006/95/EC.

Australia: Regulatory Compliance Mark (RCM)

Single-Stage Electronic Temperature Controls Code No. LIT-1900934

Description

A421 Series Electronic Temperature Controls with Integral Power Cord

Features

The A421 Series Electronic Temperature Controls are single-stage controls with a single-pole, double-throw (SPDT) output relay, a bright backlit LCD, and a

three-button touchpad interface that can be set up to restrict user adjustments. An LED indicates the output relay’s On/Off status. The A421 Series Controls have simple On and Off temperature settings for heating or cooling, an adjustable anti-short cycle delay, and a temperature offset function.

The control range is -40 to 212°F

(-40 to 100°C) for standard models. Models with a control range of -40 to 248°F

(-40 to 120°C) are available in quantity orders. The controls feature remote sensing capability and interchangeable sensors. The A421 Controls are available in either Type 1 (NEMA)/IP20 high-impact plastic enclosure suitable for surface or DIN rail mounting or Type 4X (NEMA)/IP66 watertight,

corrosion-resistant surface mount enclosures.

The A421ABG Controls Type 1 (NEMA)/IP20 enclosure feature factory-installed power cords with plug and receptacle to provide easy plug-in connection and control of 120 VAC plug-in cooling and heating equipment.

Refer to the A421 Series Electronic Temperature Controls Product Bulletin (LIT-12011972) for important product application information.

Applications

The A421 Electronic Temperature Control can be used to control a wide variety of

single-stage refrigeration or HVAC equipment.

Sample temperature control applications include:

  • temperature monitoring and alarming
  • on/off control of boilers and chillers
  • boiler and chiller pump control
  • heating and cooling control
  • floating temperature control of damper and valve actuators
  • cooling tower fan control based on water temperature
  • supply, makeup, and mixed air temperature control
  • temperature actuated valve control
  • supply and makeup air damper and fan control
  • condenser fan control based on condenser temperature
  • easy-to-read, bright, adjustable backlit LCD screen displays the temperature, parameters, and status clearly and allows you to adjust LCD brightness for the ambient light conditions. Custom icons on the display provide visual cues on system and control status.
  • basic and advanced programming menus allow you to easily set up your control application on the LCD using a simple three-button touchpad interface.
  • adjustable On and Off temperature setpoints enable easy to set up cooling or heating control applications on the

three-button touchpad, eliminating the need to remove the cover and reposition jumpers for reverse or direct control actions.

  • high and low temperature setpoint adjustment stops allow you to set up your application for your desired range of adjustment and restrict user adjustment to just the desired temperature adjustment range.
  • displayed temperature offset allows you to adjust the displayed temperature to the actual sensed temperature in applications where the resistance error in long sensor cable leads cause a deviation in the displayed temperature from the actual sensed temperature.
  • adjustable anti-short cycle delay keeps the output relay Off after the Off setpoint is reached for a user-defined time delay, which helps avoid short cycling, hard starts, and nuisance overload outages on compressors and other inductive applications.
  • temperature setback/offset control enables the control to shift the On and Off setpoint values by a user-defined offset when an external switch closes the binary input control circuit. Using a switching timer enables you to set up occupied/unoccupied temperature setback schedules for your applications.
  • high-impact, thermoplastic Type 1 (NEMA)/IP20 or Type 4X (NEMA)/IP66 watertight, corrosion-resistant enclosures increase application options, allowing surface and snap-fit DIN rail mount, or watertight surface mount.
  • parameter adjustment restriction allows you to lock the control’s setup parameters and restrict user adjustments to just the On and Off temperature setpoint values within your defined setpoint adjustment range.

A421 Series Electronic Temperature Controls with Integral Power Cord

  • low- and line-voltage control models provide industry standard control voltage options for most refrigeration and HVAC control applications.

Repair Information

If the A421 Series Electronic Temperature Control with Integral Power Cord fails to operate within its specifications, replace the unit. For a replacement A421 Control, contact the nearest Authorized

Johnson Controls/PENN® Distributer or Sales Representative.

Single-Stage Electronic Temperature Controls

A421 Series Electronic Temperature Controls with Integral Power Cord (Continued)

Selection Chart

A421 Electronic Temperature Control Selection Chart

Product Code Number Description
A421ABG-02C Line-Voltage Type 1 Electronic Temperature Control with Dual Power Cords: Type 1 (NEMA), IP20 standard enclosure for DIN rail

and surface-mount applications. Rated for 120 VAC. Control is factory wired with a 6 ft (1.8 m) cord with 120 VAC grounded external plug and a 1 ft (0.30) cord with 120 VAC grounded internal receptacle. Includes an A99BB-200C temperature sensor with 6 ft 7-1/5 in. (2.0 m) cable.

A421ABJ-02C Line-Voltage Type 1 Electronic Temperature Control with Single Power Cord and Piggyback Plug: Type 1 (NEMA), IP20 standard enclosure for DIN rail and surface-mount applications. Rated for 120 VAC. Control is factory wired with a 6 ft (1.8 m) cord with 120 VAC grounded piggyback plug. Includes an A99BB-200C temperature sensor with 6 ft 7-1/5 in. (2.0 m) cable.
A421AEJ-01C Line-Voltage Type 4X Electronic Temperature Control with Single Power Cord and Piggyback Plug: Type 4X (NEMA), IP67 weathertight enclosure for surface-mount applications. Rated for 120 VAC. Control is factory wired with a 6 ft (1.8 m) cord with grounded piggyback plug. Includes an A99BB-25C temperature sensor with 9-7/8 in. (0.25 m) cable.
A421AEJ-02C Line-Voltage Type 4X Electronic Temperature Control with Single Power Cord and Piggyback Plug: Type 4X (NEMA), IP67 weathertight enclosure for surface-mount applications. Rated for 120 VAC. Control is factory wired with a 6 ft (1.8 m) cord with grounded piggyback plug. Includes an A99BB-200C temperature sensor with 6.6 ft (2.0 m) cable.

A99 Temperature Sensors Compatible with the A421 Control1

Product Code Number Description
A99BA-200C PTC Temperature Sensor: Standard probe 2 in. (5.1 cm) with 6 ft 7-1/5 in. (2.0 m) shielded PVC cable; Ambient operating temperature range: -40 to 212ºF (-40 to 100ºC)
A99BB-25C PTC Temperature Sensor: Standard probe 2 in. (5.1 cm) with 9-7/8 in. (0.25 m) PVC cable; Ambient operating temperature range: -40 to 212ºF (-40 to 100ºC)
A99BB-200C PTC Temperature Sensor: Standard probe 2 in. (5.1 cm) with 6 ft 7-1/5 in. (2.0 m) PVC cable; Ambient operating temperature range: -40 to 212ºF (-40 to 100ºC)
A99BB-300C PTC Temperature Sensor: Standard probe 2 in. (5.1 cm) with 9 ft 9-3/5 in. (3.0 m) PVC cable; Ambient operating temperature range: -40 to 212ºF (-40 to 100ºC)
A99BB-400C PTC Temperature Sensor: Standard probe 2 in. (5.1 cm) with 13 ft 1-1/5 in. (4.0 m) PVC cable; Ambient operating temperature range: -40 to 212ºF (-40 to 100ºC)
A99BB-600C PTC Temperature Sensor: Standard probe 2 in. (5.1 cm) with 19 ft 8-2/5 in. (6.0 m) PVC cable; Ambient operating temperature range: -40 to 212ºF (-40 to 100ºC)
A99BC-25C PTC Temperature Sensor: Standard probe 2 in. (5.1 cm) with 9-7/8 in. (0.25 m) high-temperature silicon cable; Ambient operating temperature range: -40 to 248ºF (-40 to 100ºC)
A99BC-100C PTC Temperature Sensor: Standard probe 2 in. (5.1 cm) with 3 ft 3-3/5 in. (1.0 m) high-temperature silicon cable; Ambient operating temperature range: -40 to 248ºF (-40 to 120ºC)
A99BC-300C PTC Temperature Sensor: Standard probe 2 in. (5.1 cm) with 9 ft 9-3/5 in. (3.0 m) high-temperature silicon cable; Ambient operating temperature range: -40 to 248ºF (-40 to 120ºC)
A99BC-500C PTC Temperature Sensor: Standard probe 2 in. (5.1 cm) with 16 ft 4-4/5 in. (5.0 m) high-temperature silicon cable; Ambient operating temperature range: -40 to 248ºF (-40 to 120ºC)
A99BC-1500C PTC Temperature Sensor: Standard probe 2 in. (5.1 cm) with 49 ft 2-2/5 in. (15.0 m) high-temperature silicon cable; Ambient operating temperature range: -40 to 248ºF (-40 to 120ºC)
A99CB-200C PTC Temperature Sensor: Extended probe 6 in. (15.2 cm) with 6 ft 7-1/5 in. (2.0 m) PVC cable; Ambient operating temperature range: -40 to 212ºF (-40 to 100ºC)
A99CB-600C PTC Temperature Sensor: Extended probe 6 in. (15.2 cm) with 19 ft 8-2/5 in. (6.0 m) PVC cable; Ambient operating temperature range: -40 to 212ºF (-40 to 100ºC)

1. When any A99 Series Temperature Sensor is connected to a standard temperature A421 control model, the range of usable values is -40 to 212ºF (-40 to 100ºC).

Accessories for the A421 Controls

Product Code Number Description
BKT287-1R 12 in. (305 mm) long DIN rail section
BKT287-2R 36 in. (914 mm) long DIN rail section
PLT344-1R Two End Clamps for DIN rail sections
A99-CLP-1 Surface Mounting Clip for A99B and A99C Series Temperature Sensors
SHL10-603R Sun Shield for A99B and A99C Series Temperature Sensors
BOX10A-603R PVC Enclosure for A99B and A99C Series Temperature Sensors
WEL11A-601R Immersion well for applying sensor in fluid applications
Single-Stage Electronic Temperature Controls

A421 Series Electronic Temperature Controls with Integral Power Cord (Continued)

Technical Specifications

A421 Series Electronic Temperature Controls
Power Consumption 1.8 VA maximum
Supply Power 110/120 VAC, 50/60 Hz
Ambient Conditions Operating: Type 1 Models: -40 to 150°F (-40 to 66°C), 0 to 95% RH noncondensing Type 4X Models: -40 to 140°F (-40 to 60°C), 0 to 95% RH noncondensing

Shipping and Storage: All Models: -40 to 185°F (-40 to 85°C), 0 to 95% RH noncondensing

Temperature Control Range -40 to 212°F (-40 to 100°C)
Input Signal 1,035 ohm at 77F (25C) for A99 PTC temperature sensors
Sensor Offset Range ±5ºF or ±3ºC
Output Relay Contacts Electrical Ratings 120 VAC Model with Integral Power Cord:

Applied Voltage: 120 VAC

Full Load Amperes N.O.: 12 A

Locked Rotor Amperes N.O.: 72 A

Resistive Amperes N.O.: 12 A

Pilot Duty: 125 VA (N.O. contacts) at 24 to 120 VAC

Enclosure Material NEMA 1/IP20 high-impact thermoplastic or

NEMA 4X/IP66 watertight, corrosion-resistant, high-impact thermoplastic

Compliance North America: cULus Listed; UL 60730, File E27734, Vol. 1; FCC Compliant to CFR47, Part 15, Subpart B, Class B Industry Canada (IC) Compliant to Canadian ICES-003, Class B limits
Single-Stage Electronic Temperature Controls Code No. LIT-1900935

A421 Series Electronic Temperature Controls with Off-Cycle Defrost

Description

The A421 Series Electronic Temperature Controls are single-stage controls with a single-pole, double-throw (SPDT) output relay, a bright backlit LCD, and a

three-button touchpad interface that can be set up to restrict user adjustments. An LED indicates the output relay’s On/Off status. The A421 Series Controls have simple On and Off temperature settings for heating or cooling, an adjustable anti-short cycle delay, and a temperature offset function.

The control range is -40 to 212°F

(-40 to 100°C) for standard models. Models with a control range of -40 to 248°F

(-40 to 120°C) are available in quantity orders. The controls feature remote sensing capability and interchangeable sensors. The A421 Controls are available in either Type 1 (NEMA)/IP20 high-impact plastic enclosure suitable for surface or DIN rail mounting or Type 4X (NEMA)/IP66 watertight,

corrosion-resistant surface mount enclosures.

A421 Controls with Off-Cycle Defrost (A421ABD and A421AED models) provide off-cycle defrost control with

user-configurable defrost cycle duration and frequency.

Refer to the A421 Series Electronic Temperature Controls Product Bulletin (LIT-12011972) for important product application information.

Applications

The A421 Electronic Temperature Control can be used to control a wide variety of

single-stage refrigeration or HVAC equipment.

Sample temperature control applications include:

  • temperature monitoring and alarming
  • on/off control of boilers and chillers
  • boiler and chiller pump control
  • heating and cooling control
  • floating temperature control of damper and valve actuators
  • cooling tower fan control based on water temperature
  • supply, makeup, and mixed air temperature control
  • temperature actuated valve control
  • supply and makeup air damper and fan control
  • condenser fan control based on condenser temperature

Features

  • easy-to-read, bright, adjustable backlit LCD screen displays the temperature, parameters, and status clearly and allows you to adjust LCD brightness for the ambient light conditions. Custom icons on the display provide visual cues on system and control status.
  • basic and advanced programming menus allow you to easily set up your control application on the LCD using a simple three-button touchpad interface.
  • adjustable On and Off temperature setpoints enable easy to set up cooling or heating control applications on the

three-button touchpad, eliminating the need to remove the cover and reposition jumpers for reverse or direct control actions.

  • high and low temperature setpoint adjustment stops allow you to set up your application for your desired range of adjustment and restrict user adjustment to just the desired temperature adjustment range.
  • displayed temperature offset allows you to adjust the displayed temperature to the actual sensed temperature in applications where the resistance error in long sensor cable leads cause a deviation in the displayed temperature from the actual sensed temperature.
  • adjustable anti-short cycle delay keeps the output relay Off after the Off setpoint is reached for a user-defined time delay, which helps avoid short cycling, hard starts, and nuisance overload outages on compressors and other inductive applications.
  • integrated off-cycle defrost timer (defrost control models only) shuts off the refrigeration system for a user-defined defrost time interval at a user-defined frequency. This eliminates the cost and time to install a separate defrost timer in many refrigeration applications.
  • temperature setback/offset control enables the control to shift the On and Off setpoint values by a user-defined offset when an external switch closes the binary input control circuit. Using a switching timer enables you to set up occupied/unoccupied temperature setback schedules for your applications.
  • high-impact, thermoplastic Type 1 (NEMA)/IP20 or Type 4X (NEMA)/IP66 watertight, corrosion-resistant enclosures increase application options, allowing surface and snap-fit DIN rail mount, or watertight surface mount.

A421 Series Electronic Temperature Control with Off-Cycle Defrost

  • parameter adjustment restriction allows you to lock the control’s setup parameters and restrict user adjustments to just the On and Off temperature setpoint values within your defined setpoint adjustment range.
  • low- and line-voltage control models provide industry standard control voltage options for most refrigeration and HVAC control applications.

Repair Information

If the A421 Series Electronic Temperature Control with Off-Cycle Defrost fails to operate within its specifications, replace the unit. For a replacement A421 Control, contact the nearest Johnson Controls® representative.

Single-Stage Electronic Temperature Controls

A421 Series Electronic Temperature Controls with Off-Cycle Defrost (Continued)

Selection Charts

A421 Electronic Temperature Controls

Product Code Number Description
A421ABD-02C Line-Voltage Type 1 Electronic Temperature Control with Off-Cycle Defrost Timer: Type 1 (NEMA), IP20 standard enclosure for DIN rail and surface-mount applications. Rated for 120/240 VAC. Includes integral timer for off-cycle defrost control.

Includes an A99BB-200C temperature sensor with 6 ft 7-1/5 in. (2.0 m) cable.

A421AED-01C Line-Voltage Type 4X Electronic Temperature Control with Off-Cycle Defrost Timer: Type 4X (NEMA), IP67 weathertight enclosure for surface-mount applications. Rated for 120/240 VAC. Includes integral timer for off-cycle defrost control.

Includes an A99BB-25C temperature sensor with 9-7/8 in. (0.25 m) cable.

A421AED-02C Line-Voltage Type 4X Electronic Temperature Control with Off-Cyle Defrost Timer: Type 4X (NEMA), IP67 weathertight enclosure for surface-mount applications. Rated for 120/240 VAC. Includes integral timer for off-cycle defrost control.

Includes an A99BB-200C temperature sensor with 6 ft 6 in. (2 m) cable.

A99 Temperature Sensors Compatible with the A421 Control1

Product Code Number Description
A99BA-200C PTC Temperature Sensor: Standard probe 2 in. (5.1 cm) with 6 ft 7-1/5 in. (2.0 m) shielded PVC cable; Ambient operating temperature range: -40 to 212ºF (-40 to 100ºC)
A99BB-25C PTC Temperature Sensor: Standard probe 2 in. (5.1 cm) with 9-7/8 in. (0.25 m) PVC cable; Ambient operating temperature range: -40 to 212ºF (-40 to 100ºC)
A99BB-200C PTC Temperature Sensor: Standard probe 2 in. (5.1 cm) with 6 ft 7-1/5 in. (2.0 m) PVC cable; Ambient operating temperature range: -40 to 212ºF (-40 to 100ºC)
A99BB-300C PTC Temperature Sensor: Standard probe 2 in. (5.1 cm) with 9 ft 9-3/5 in. (3.0 m) PVC cable; Ambient operating temperature range: -40 to 212ºF (-40 to 100ºC)
A99BB-400C PTC Temperature Sensor: Standard probe 2 in. (5.1 cm) with 13 ft 1-1/5 in. (4.0 m) PVC cable; Ambient operating temperature range: -40 to 212ºF (-40 to 100ºC)
A99BB-600C PTC Temperature Sensor: Standard probe 2 in. (5.1 cm) with 19 ft 8-2/5 in. (6.0 m) PVC cable; Ambient operating temperature range: -40 to 212ºF (-40 to 100ºC)
A99BC-25C PTC Temperature Sensor: Standard probe 2 in. (5.1 cm) with 9-7/8 in. (0.25 m) high-temperature silicon cable; Ambient operating temperature range: -40 to 248ºF (-40 to 100ºC)
A99BC-100C PTC Temperature Sensor: Standard probe 2 in. (5.1 cm) with 3 ft 3-3/5 in. (1.0 m) high-temperature silicon cable; Ambient operating temperature range: -40 to 248ºF (-40 to 120ºC)
A99BC-300C PTC Temperature Sensor: Standard probe 2 in. (5.1 cm) with 9 ft 9-3/5 in. (3.0 m) high-temperature silicon cable; Ambient operating temperature range: -40 to 248ºF (-40 to 120ºC)
A99BC-500C PTC Temperature Sensor: Standard probe 2 in. (5.1 cm) with 16 ft 4-4/5 in. (5.0 m) high-temperature silicon cable; Ambient operating temperature range: -40 to 248ºF (-40 to 120ºC)
A99BC-1500C PTC Temperature Sensor: Standard probe 2 in. (5.1 cm) with 49 ft 2-2/5 in. (15.0 m) high-temperature silicon cable; Ambient operating temperature range: -40 to 248ºF (-40 to 120ºC)
A99CB-200C PTC Temperature Sensor: Extended probe 6 in. (15.2 cm) with 6 ft 7-1/5 in. (2.0 m) PVC cable; Ambient operating temperature range: -40 to 212ºF (-40 to 100ºC)
A99CB-600C PTC Temperature Sensor: Extended probe 6 in. (15.2 cm) with 19 ft 8-2/5 in. (6.0 m) PVC cable; Ambient operating temperature range: -40 to 212ºF (-40 to 100ºC)

1. When any A99 Series Temperature Sensor is connected to a standard temperature A421 control model, the range of usable values is -40 to 212ºF (-40 to 100ºC).

Accessories for the A421 Controls

Product Code Number Description
BKT287-1R 12 in. (305 mm) long DIN Rail section
BKT287-2R 36 in. (914 mm) long DIN Rail section
PLT344-1R Two End Clamps for DIN Rail sections
A99-CLP-1 Surface Mounting Clip for A99B and A99C Series Temperature Sensors
SHL10-603R Sun Shield for A99B and A99C Series Temperature Sensors
BOX10A-603R PVC Enclosure for A99B and A99C Series Temperature Sensors
WEL11A-601R Immersion Well for applying sensor in fluid applications
Single-Stage Electronic Temperature Controls

A421 Series Electronic Temperature Controls with Off-Cycle Defrost (Continued)

Technical Specifications

A421 Series Electronic Temperature Controls
Power Consumption 1.8 VA Maximum
Supply Power 24 VAC, 50/60 Hz, Class 2:

108/110/115/120 or 208/230/240 VAC, 50/60 Hz

Ambient Conditions Operating: -40 to 150°F (-40 to 66°C), 0 to 95% RH Noncondensing

Shipping and Storage: -40 to 185°F (-40 to 85°C), 0 to 95% RH Noncondensing

Temperature Control Range -40 to 212°F (-40 to 100°C) or -40 to 248ºF (-40 to 120ºC), depending on the model selected
Input Signal 1,035 ohm at 77F (25C) for A99 PTC temperature sensors
Sensor Offset Range ±5ºF or ±3ºC
Output Relay Contacts Electrical Ratings 24 VAC Models:

100 VA, 30 VAC maximum, Class 2

120 VAC Model with Integral Power Cord: Applied Voltage: 120 VAC Full Load Amperes N.O. and N.C.: 12 A Locked Rotor Amperes N.O. and N.C.: 72 A Non-inductive Amperes N.O. and N.C.:12 A

Pilot Duty: 125 VA (N.O. contacts) at 24 to 120 VAC

120/240 VAC Models:

Applied Voltage: 120 VAC 208 VAC 240 VAC

Horsepower N.O. (N.C.) : 1 (0.25) hp 1 (0.33) hp 1 (0.5) hp

Full Load Amperes N.O. (N.C.): 16 (5.8) A 9.2 (4.0) A 8.0 (4.9) A

Locked Rotor Amperes N.O. (N.C.): 96 (34.8) A 55.2 (24) A 48 (29.4) A

Non-inductive Amperes N.O. (N.C.):15 (10) A 10 (10) A 10 (10) A

Pilot Duty: 125 VA (N.O. contacts) at 24 to 240 VAC 125 VA (N.C. contacts) at 24 to 240 VAC

50 VA (N.C. contacts) at 24 VAC

Enclosure Material NEMA 1/IP20 High-Impact Thermoplastic or

NEMA 4X/IP66 Watertight, Corrosion-Resistant, High-Impact Thermoplastic

Compliance

North America: cULus Listed; UL 60730, File E27734, Vol. 1; FCC Compliant to CFR47, Part 15, Subpart B, Class B Industry Canada (IC) Compliant to Canadian ICES-003, Class B limits

Europe: CE Mark – Johnson Controls, Inc. declares that this product is in compliance with the essential requirements and

other relevant provisions of the EMC Directive 2004/108/EC and the Low Voltage Directive 2006/95/EC.

Australia: Mark: C-Tick Compliant (N1813)

Single-Stage Electronic Temperature Controls Code No. LIT-1900936

Description

A421 Series Electronic Temperature Controls with Integral Cycle Timer

Features

The A421 Series Electronic Temperature Controls are single-stage controls with a single-pole, double-throw (SPDT) output relay, a bright backlit LCD, and a

three-button touchpad interface that can be set up to restrict user adjustments. An LED indicates the output relay’s On/Off status. The A421 Series Controls have simple On and Off temperature settings for heating or cooling, an adjustable anti-short cycle delay, and a temperature offset function.

The control range is -40 to 212°F

(-40 to 100°C) for standard models. Models with a control range of -40 to 248°F

(-40 to 120°C) are available in quantity orders. The controls feature remote sensing capability and interchangeable sensors. The

A421 Controls are available in either Type 1 (NEMA)/IP20 high-impact plastic enclosure suitable for surface or DIN rail

mounting or Type 4X (NEMA)/IP66 watertight, corrosion-resistant surface mount enclosures.

The A421 Controls with Integral Cycle Timer provide On/Off control of ventilation fans in agriculture applications, warehouse and storage facilities, and other ventilation application that require air-exchange based on temperature or a ventilation schedule with a user-defined On-time and Off-time cycle.

Refer to the A421 Series Electronic Temperature Controls Product Bulletin (LIT-12011972) for important product application information.

Applications

The A421 Electronic Temperature Control can be used to control a wide variety of

single-stage refrigeration or HVAC equipment.

Sample temperature control applications include:

  • temperature monitoring and alarming
  • on/off control of boilers and chillers
  • boiler and chiller pump control
  • heating and cooling control
  • floating temperature control of damper and valve actuators
  • cooling tower fan control based on water temperature
  • supply, makeup, and mixed air temperature control
  • temperature actuated valve control
  • supply and makeup air damper and fan control
  • condenser fan control based on condenser temperature
  • easy-to-read, bright, adjustable backlit LCD screen displays the temperature, parameters, and status clearly and allows you to adjust LCD brightness for the ambient light conditions. Custom icons on the display provide visual cues on system and control status.
  • basic and advanced programming menus allow you to easily set up your control application on the LCD using a simple three-button touchpad interface.
  • adjustable On and Off temperature setpoints enable easy to set up cooling or heating control applications on the

three-button touchpad, eliminating the need to remove the cover and reposition jumpers for reverse or direct control actions.

  • high and low temperature setpoint adjustment stops allow you to set up your application for your desired range of adjustment and restrict user adjustment to just the desired temperature adjustment range.
  • displayed temperature offset allows you to adjust the displayed temperature to the actual sensed temperature in applications where the resistance error in long sensor cable leads cause a deviation in the displayed temperature from the actual sensed temperature.
  • adjustable anti-short cycle delay keeps the output relay Off after the Off setpoint is reached for a user-defined time delay, which helps avoid short cycling, hard starts, and nuisance overload outages on compressors and other inductive applications.
  • temperature and timed ventilation control (integral cycle timer models only) enables you to set up timed ventilation or makeup air cycles independent from temperature controlled cycles. This eliminates the cost and time to install a separate interval timer in ventilation and makeup air applications.
  • temperature setback/offset control enables the control to shift the On and Off setpoint values by a user-defined offset when an external switch closes the binary input control circuit. Using a switching timer enables you to set up occupied/unoccupied temperature setback schedules for your applications.
  • high-impact, thermoplastic NEMA 1/IP20 or NEMA 4X/IP66 watertight,

corrosion-resistant enclosures increase application options, allowing surface and snap-fit DIN rail mount, or watertight surface mount.

A421 Series Electronic Temperature Control with Integral Cycle Timer

  • parameter adjustment restriction allows you to lock the control’s setup parameters and restrict user adjustments to just the On and Off temperature setpoint values within your defined setpoint adjustment range.
  • low- and line-voltage control models provide industry standard control voltage options for most refrigeration and HVAC control applications.

Repair Information

If the A421 Series Electronic Temperature Control with Integral Cycle Timer fails to operate within its specifications, replace the unit. For a replacement A421 Control, contact the nearest Johnson Controls® representative.

Single-Stage Electronic Temperature Controls

A421 Series Electronic Temperature Controls with Integral Cycle Timer (Continued)

Selection Charts

A421 Electronic Temperature Controls

Product Code Number Description
A421ABT-02C Line-Voltage Type 1 Electronic Temperature Control with Duty-Cycle Timer: Type 1 (NEMA), IP20 standard enclosure for DIN rail and surface-mount applications. Rated for 120/240 VAC. Includes integral timer for On/Off duty-cycle control.

Includes an A99BB-200C temperature sensor with 6 ft 7-1/5 in. (2.0 m) cable.

A421AET-01C Line-Voltage Type 4X Electronic Temperature Control with Duty-Cycle Timer: Type 4X (NEMA), IP67 weathertight enclosure for surface-mount applications. Rated for 120/240 VAC. Includes integral timer for On/Off duty-cycle control.

Includes an A99BB-25C temperature sensor with 9-7/8 in. (0.25 m) cable.

A99 Temperature Sensors Compatible with the A421 Control1

Product Code Number Description
A99BA-200C PTC Temperature Sensor: Standard probe 2 in. (5.1 cm) with 6 ft 7-1/5 in. (2.0 m) shielded PVC cable; Ambient operating temperature range: -40 to 212ºF (-40 to 100ºC)
A99BB-25C PTC Temperature Sensor: Standard probe 2 in. (5.1 cm) with 9-7/8 in. (0.25 m) PVC cable; Ambient operating temperature range: -40 to 212ºF (-40 to 100ºC)
A99BB-200C PTC Temperature Sensor: Standard probe 2 in. (5.1 cm) with 6 ft 7-1/5 in. (2.0 m) PVC cable; Ambient operating temperature range: -40 to 212ºF (-40 to 100ºC)
A99BB-300C PTC Temperature Sensor: Standard probe 2 in. (5.1 cm) with 9 ft 9-3/5 in. (3.0 m) PVC cable; Ambient operating temperature range: -40 to 212ºF (-40 to 100ºC)
A99BB-400C PTC Temperature Sensor: Standard probe 2 in. (5.1 cm) with 13.1 ft (4.0 m) PVC cable; Ambient operating temperature range: -40 to 212ºF (-40 to 100ºC)
A99BB-600C PTC Temperature Sensor: Standard probe 2 in. (5.1 cm) with 19 ft 8-2/5 in. (6.0 m) PVC cable; Ambient operating temperature range: -40 to 212ºF (-40 to 100ºC)
A99BC-25C PTC Temperature Sensor: Standard probe 2 in. (5.1 cm) with 9-7/8 in. (0.25 m) high-temperature silicon cable; Ambient operating temperature range: -40 to 248ºF (-40 to 100ºC)
A99BC-100C PTC Temperature Sensor: Standard probe 2 in. (5.1 cm) with 3 ft 3-3/5 in. (1.0 m) high-temperature silicon cable; Ambient operating temperature range: -40 to 248ºF (-40 to 120ºC)
A99BC-300C PTC Temperature Sensor: Standard probe 2 in. (5.1 cm) with 9 ft 9-3/5 in. (3.0 m) high-temperature silicon cable; Ambient operating temperature range: -40 to 248ºF (-40 to 120ºC)
A99BC-500C PTC Temperature Sensor: Standard probe 2 in. (5.1 cm) with 16 ft 4-4/5 in. (5.0 m) high-temperature silicon cable; Ambient operating temperature range: -40 to 248ºF (-40 to 120ºC)
A99BC-1500C PTC Temperature Sensor: Standard probe 2 in. (5.1 cm) with 49 ft 2-2/5 in. (15.0 m) high-temperature silicon cable; Ambient operating temperature range: -40 to 248ºF (-40 to 120ºC)
A99CB-200C PTC Temperature Sensor: Extended probe 6 in. (15.2 cm) with 6 ft 7-1/5 in. (2.0 m) PVC cable; Ambient operating temperature range: -40 to 212ºF (-40 to 100ºC)
A99CB-600C PTC Temperature Sensor: Extended probe 6 in. (15.2 cm) with 19 ft 8-2/5 in. (6.0 m) PVC cable; Ambient operating temperature range: -40 to 212ºF (-40 to 100ºC)

1. When any A99 Series Temperature Sensor is connected to a standard temperature A421 control model, the range of usable values is -40 to 212ºF (-40 to 100ºC).

Accessories for the A421 Controls

Product Code Number Description
BKT287-1R 12 in. (305 mm) long DIN rail section
BKT287-2R 36 in. (914 mm) long DIN rail section
PLT344-1R Two End Clamps for DIN rail sections
A99-CLP-1 Surface Mounting Clip for A99B and A99C Series Temperature Sensors
SHL10-603R Sun Shield for A99B and A99C Series Temperature Sensors
BOX10A-603R PVC Enclosure for A99B and A99C Series Temperature Sensors
WEL11A-601R Immersion well for applying sensor in fluid applications
Single-Stage Electronic Temperature Controls

A421 Series Electronic Temperature Controls with Integral Cycle Timer (Continued)

Technical Specifications

A421 Series Electronic Temperature Controls
Power Consumption 1.8 VA maximum
Supply Power 24 VAC, 50/60 Hz, Class 2:

108/110/115/120 or 208/230/240 VAC, 50/60 Hz

Ambient Conditions Operating: -40 to 150°F (-40 to 66°C), 0 to 95% RH noncondensing

Shipping and Storage: -40 to 185°F (-40 to 85°C), 0 to 95% RH noncondensing

Temperature Control Range -40 to 212°F (-40 to 100°C) or -40 to 248ºF (-40 to 120ºC), depending on the model selected
Input Signal 1,035 ohms at 77F (25C) for A99 PTC temperature sensors
Sensor Offset Range ±5ºF or ±3ºC
Output Relay Contacts Electrical Ratings 24 VAC Models:

100 VA, 30 VAC maximum, Class 2

120 VAC Model with Integral Power Cord: Applied Voltage: 120 VAC Full Load Amperes N.O. and N.C.: 12 A Locked Rotor Amperes N.O. and N.C.: 72 A Non-inductive Amperes N.O. and N.C.:12 A

Pilot Duty: 125 VA (N.O. contacts) at 24 to 120 VAC

120/240 VAC Models:

Applied Voltage: 120 VAC 208 VAC 240 VAC

Horsepower N.O. (N.C.) : 1 (0.25) hp 1 (0.33) hp 1 (0.5) hp

Full Load Amperes N.O. (N.C.): 16 (5.8) A 9.2 (4.0) A 8.0 (4.9) A

Locked Rotor Amperes N.O. (N.C.): 96 (34.8) A 55.2 (24) A 48 (29.4) A

Non-inductive Amperes N.O. (N.C.):15 (10) A 10 (10) A 10 (10) A Pilot Duty: 125 VA (N.O. contacts) at 24 to 240 VAC

125 VA (N.C. contacts) at 24 to 240 VAC

50 VA (N.C. contacts) at 24 VAC

Enclosure Material NEMA 1/IP20 high-impact thermoplastic or

NEMA 4X/IP66 watertight, corrosion-resistant, high-impact thermoplastic

Compliance

North America: cULus Listed; UL 60730, File E27734, Vol. 1; FCC Compliant to CFR47, Part 15, Subpart B, Class B Industry Canada (IC) Compliant to Canadian ICES-003, Class B limits

Europe: CE Mark – Johnson Controls, Inc. declares that this product is in compliance with the essential requirements and

other relevant provisions of the EMC Directive 2004/108/EC and the Low Voltage Directive 2006/95/EC.

Australia: Mark: C-Tick Compliant (N1813)

Single-Stage Electronic Temperature Controls Code No. LIT-1900003

MR Series Defrost Control Modules

Description

The MR Series Controls are versatile, microprocessor-based, multifunction, programmable temperature controls. Depending on the model chosen, the

MR Series Controls can also manage alarm, defrost cycle (active or passive defrost), and evaporator fan functions.

The MR Series Controls have large red LED displays. These compact controls are available in panel mount and DIN rail mount varieties. The MR Series Controls use the A99B temperature sensors, which allow remote mounting of the display unit.

All MR Series Controls perform temperature and alarm management. Some models have additional capabilities.

MR1 Series Controls

The MR1 Series provides temperature and alarm management functions. It can replace a temperature control and digital temperature readout.

MR2 Series Controls

The MR2 Series provides temperature, alarm, and defrost cycle management. The MR2 control performs defrost cycle management using time-based, passive, off cycle defrost. It can replace a temperature control, a digital temperature readout, and a defrost timer.

Refer to the MR Series Refrigeration Temperature Controls Product Bulletin (LIT-125199) for important product application information.

Applications

MR4 Series Controls

The MR4 Series provides temperature, alarm, defrost, and evaporator fan management.

The MR4 Series provides defrost cycle management with hot gas or electric heat defrost and defrost termination based on time or temperature. The MR4 Series consolidates the functions of a temperature control, a digital temperature readout, a defrost cycle timer, and a defrost termination device.

Refer to the MR Series Refrigeration Temperature Controls Product Bulletin (LIT-125199) for important product application information.

Features

  • programmable functions allow adjustment of control settings to meet application needs
  • alarm management functions provide local alarm display and an alarm output relay that can be used to trigger a remote alarm or dial-out modem
  • easily readable LED display displays temperature and other functions quickly and clearly
  • programming button lockout allows user to disable programming buttons and deter accidental or unauthorized changes
  • accurate, interchangeable temperature sensor provides accurate control performance with up to 300 feet of wiring (an adjustable temperature offset is provided for longer wiring)
  • self-test procedure checks control operation by cycling all outputs and testing all LEDs

Selection Chart

MR4 Series

DIN Rail and Panel Mount Modules

Repair Information

If the MR Series Defrost Control Modules fails to operate within its specifications, replace the unit. For a replacement control, contact the nearest Johnson Controls® representative.

Application MR1 MR2 MR4
Cooling tower pump control
Space and return air temperature control
Convenience store coolers
Convenience store freezers
Supermarket display cases for produce
Reach-in coolers
Walk-in coolers
Freezers or coolers with passive defrost, time-based termination
Freezers with hot gas defrost (temperature or time-based termination
Freezers with electrical defrost (temperature or time-based termination)
Product Code

Number

Description Ship. Wt.

lb (g)

MR1DR24-11C MR1 Single-Stage, DIN Rail Mount Defrost

Control, One A99BB-200C sensor included

0.75 lb

(340 g)

MR2PM24-11C MR2 Two-Stage, Panel Mount Defrost Control, One A99BB-200C sensor included 0.53 lb (240 g)
MR2DR24-11C MR2 Two-Stage, DIN Rail Mount Defrost Control, One A99BB-200C sensor included 0.79 lb (360 g)
MR4PM24-12C MR4 Four-Stage, Panel Mount Defrost Control, Two A99BB-200C sensors included 0.90 lb (410 g)
MR4DR24-12C MR4 Four-Stage, DIN Rail Mount Defrost Control, Two A99BB-200C sensors included 1.17 lb (530 g)

Single-Stage Electronic Temperature Controls

MR Series Defrost Control Modules (Continued)

Technical Specifications

MR Series Defrost Control Modules
Power Requirements 24 VAC, 50/60 Hz Class 2 (20 to 30 VAC)
Power Consumption 3.7 VA at 24 VAC
Accuracy ± 1.8F° (± 1°C)
Ambient Conditions Operating +14 to +140°F (-10 to +60°C); 0 to 95% RH (noncondensing)
Storage -22 to +176°F (-30 to +80°C); 0 to 95% RH (noncondensing)
Dimensions (H x W x D) Panel Mount 1.38 x 2.95 x 2.68 in. (35 x 75 x 68 mm)
DIN Rail: 4.65 x 2.76 x 2.07 in. (118 x 70 x 53 mm)
Agency Listings UL Recognized: File E194024, CCN XAPX2

Canadian UL Recognized: File E194024, CCN XAPX8

Electrical Ratings of Contacts

Rating Category 120 VAC 240 VAC 24 VDC
Horsepower 1/4 1/2
Full Load Amperes 5.8 4.9
Locked Rotor Amperes 34.8 29.4
Inductive (Non-Motor) Amperes 8 8 8
Pilot Duty VA 275 450

Note: Relay outputs must not exceed 20 Amperes total connected load. Open collector transistors on MR1 alarms have a maximum rating of 40 VDC 100 mA. Alarms require external power source.

Refer to Rating Table for more information

Internal to Control

Process Temperature Sensor

Sensor

Common

Binary Input

Binary Common

Evaporator Alarm Temperature

Sensor

Internal to Control

Power Compressor

Supply

Evaporator

Fan

Defrost

Refer to Rating Table for more information

S1

SC

D

CD

S2

A1

A2

Terminal Not Used

V1

V2

C1

Fr

C3

Fn

C2

Df

Common

C

Fr

A1

Df

Fn

V1

V2

D

Defrost

Power Binary

Sensor

S1

SC

S2

Alarm Compressor

mr4panel.eps

Supply

Evaporator Input

Fan

Common

Evaporator Temperature

MR4 DIN Rail Control

mr4dinrl.eps

Process Temperature Sensor

MR4 Panel Mount Control

Sensor

Single-Stage Electronic Temperature Controls Code No. LIT-1927380

MR4PMUHV Electronic Temperature/Defrost Control with Relay Pack

Description

The MR Series temperature controls are designed for use with hot gas or electric heat defrost in both refrigeration and freezer units. Either time or temperature based defrost termination may be selected.

The MR Series incorporates control functions such as compressor control, defrost management, fan management, and alarm management.

Refer to the MR4PMUHV Electronic Temperature/Defrost Control with Relay Pack Product Bulletin (LIT-125190) for important product application information.

Features

  • single package provides the functionality of multiple components at a cost-effective price
  • mounting flexibility allows the control and relay pack to be mounted together or separately, facilitating multiple configurations
  • accurate, interchangeable temperature sensor provides reliable control performance with up to 300 ft. of wiring (an offset is provided for longer wiring)
  • easily readable temperature display can show either evaporator or process temperature at the touch of a button
  • heavy-duty relays allow direct control of compressors, fans, defrost heaters, and alarms
  • alarm management functions provide both local alarm codes and a relay closure that can be used to trigger a remote alarm or a dial-out modem

Applications

These relay pack mounted controls provide direct control of compressors up to 2 hp, electric heater loads of up to 20 amperes, and evaporator fan loads of up to 3/4 hp. The need for separate relays is eliminated in these applications.

MR4PMUHV Temperature Control

In addition, the MR4PMUHV controls combine the functionality of an electromechanical thermostat, mechanical clock, defrost termination device, and temperature readout device with the accuracy of electronic technology.

Selection Charts

MR4PMUHV Electronic Temperature/Defrost Control with Relay Pack

Product Code Number Description
MR4PMUHV-12C Relay pack defrost control with two

A99BB-200C sensors

Repair Parts

Product Code Number Description
MR4PM12C-12C Replacement control for use in relay pack
RP4MRUHV-1C Relay pack without control
A99BB-200C Sensor, cable length: 6.5 ft/1.98m

Technical Specifications

MR4PMUHV Electronic Temperature/Defrost Control

with Relay Pack (Part 1 of 2)

Frequency 60/50 Hz at 120/240 VAC
Power consumption 10 VA at 240 VAC, 5 VA at 120 VAC
Supply Level 120 and L1: 120 VAC +10%/-15%

240 and L1: 240 VAC +10%/-15%

Accuracy ± 1.8F°/± 1C°
A99 Sensor Cable 6.5 ft/1.98 m
Ambient Operating Conditions MR4PMUHV-12C +14° to +111°F/-10° to +44°C;

derating 6.25% per 1°C to 60° C; 0 to 95% RH (noncondensing)

MR4PM12C-12C +14° to +140°F/-10° to +60°C;

0 to 95% RH (noncondensing)

RP4MRUHV-1C -40° to +111°F/ -40° to +44°C;

derating 6.25% per 1°C to 60° C; 0 to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ambient Storage Conditions MR4PMUHV-12C -22° to +176°F/-30° to +80°C

0 to 95% RH (noncondensing)

MR4PM12C-12C -22° to +176°F/-30° to +80°C

0 to 95% RH (noncondensing)

RP4MRUHV-1C -40° to +185°F/-40° to +85°C

0 to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Dimensions (H x W x D) 7.94 x 3.6 x 2.4 in./202 x 92 x 61 mm

Technical Specifications (Continued)

MR4PMUHV Electronic Temperature/Defrost Control

with Relay Pack (Part 2 of 2)

Agency Listings UL Listed (File SA516, UL Guide SDFY;

cUL Guide SDFY7)

Shipping Weight 2.9 lb/1,320 g

Relay Electrical Ratings

24 120 208 240
SPST Compressor Relay
Horsepower Rating 1 1.5 2
AC Full Load Amperes 16 11 12
AC Locked Rotor Amperes 96 66 72
Pilot Duty (VA) 125 750 875 1,125
SPDT Fan Relay
Horsepower Rating 1/3 1/2 3/4
AC Full Load Amperes 7.2 5.65 6.9
AC Locked Rotor Amperes 43.2 33.9 41.4
Pilot Duty (VA) 50 325 450 600
SPST Defrost Heater Relay
Horsepower Rating 1 1.5 2
AC Full Load Ampere 16 11 12
AC Locked Rotor Amperes 96 66 72
Non-Inductive Load Amperes 20 20 20
Pilot Duty (VA) 125 750 825 1,125
SPST Alarm Relay
Non-Inductive Load Ampere 5 5 5 5
Pilot Duty (VA) 125 250 325

Relay Electrical Ratings Note:

Ratings shown are for ambient operation at -40 to 44°C. Derate electrical ratings 6.25% per 1°C (1.8°F) between 44°C (111°F) and 60°C (140°F).

Multi-Stage Electromechanical Temperature Controls Code No. LIT-1927110

A28 Series Two-Stage Temperature Control

Description

The A28 Series are two-stage temperature controls that incorporate a liquid-filled sensing element.

Refer to the A28 Series Two-Stage Temperature Controls with NEMA 1 Enclosure Product Bulletin Product Bulletin (LIT-125130) for important product application information.

A28 Series

Action on Increase of Temperature

A28 Action Diagram

A28AA-4

Temperature Control

Y

R

B

High Stage

Y

R

B

Low Stage

a28.eps

Applications

A28AB-29

Temperature Control

Features

  • wide temperature ranges available
  • constant differential throughout the entire range
  • single-pole, double-throw (SPDT) snap-acting switches
  • unaffected by changes in barometric pressure
  • unaffected by cross ambient conditions
  • compact enclosure
  • variety of sensing element styles

Selection Charts

Use for temperature sensing applications requiring two-stage control of HVAC/R equipment.

Accessories

  • packing nut assembly available for direct immersion applications (Code No. FTG13A-600R)
  • remote bulb models include 5/8 in. mounting clip
Product Code

Number

Switch

Action

Range

°F (°C)

Differential

F° (C°)

Bulb and

Capillary

Bulb Well No.

(Order Separately)

Range

Adjuster

Coiled Bulb-Fixed Differential
A28AA-4C Two-SPDT 30 to 110

(-1 to 43)

3-1/2 (1.9) each stage

3 (1.7) fixed between stages

1-3/8 in. x 2-1/4 in.

coiled

Convertible
Case Compensated-Fixed Differential
A28AA-9C Two-SPDT 20 to 80

(-7 to 27)

3-1/2 (1.9) each stage

3 (1.7) fixed between stages

3/8 in. x 5 in. 6 ft capillary1 WEL14A-603R Knob
Wide Range-Adjustable Interstage Differential
A28AA-28C Two-SPDT 30 to 110

(-1 to 43)

3-1/2 (1.9) each stage

2 to 7 adjustable between stages

12 ft averaging bulb

6 ft capillary

Screwdriver

slot

A28AA-29C Two-SPDT -30 to 100

(-34 to 38)

5 (2.8) each stage

2 to 7 adjustable between stages

3/8 in. x 4 in. 8 ft capillary1 WEL14A-602R Convertible
A28AA-36C Two-SPDT 40 to 90

(4 to 32)

3 each stage

2 to 7 adjustable between stages

3/8 in. x 5-3/4 in. 6 ft capillary Knob
A28AA-37C Two-SPDT 60 to 140

(16 to 60)

5 each stage

2 to 7 adjustable between stages

3/8 in. x 4 in. 6 ft capillary WEL14A-602R Knob
A28AJ-4C Two-SPDT 20 to 80

(-7 to 27)

2 each stage

2 to 7 adjustable between stages

3/16 in. x 22 in. 6 ft capillary Knob
Changeover Control
A28AB-1C Two-SPDT2 20 to 80

(-7 to 27)

3-1/2

(1.9)

3/8 in. x 5 in.

6 ft capillary

WEL14A-603R Screwdriver

slot

  1. Packing nut assembly available for direct immersion applications (Code No. FTG13A-600R).
  2. Switches within 1 F° (0.6 C°) of each other.
Multi-Stage Electromechanical Temperature Controls

A28 Series Two-Stage Temperature Control (Continued)

Replacement Parts

Product Code Number Description
CVR28A-617R Concealed adjustment
CVR28A-618R Visible scale
KNB20A-602R Knob kit

Technical Specifications

Maximum bulb temperature of A28AA-37 is 230°F (110°C). For all others, maximum bulb temperature is 140°F (60°C).

Electrical Ratings

Motor Ratings VAC 120 208 240 277
A28AA, A
AC Full Load A 16.0 9.2 8.0
AC Locked Rotor A 96.0 55.2 48.0
Non-Inductive or Resistance Load A (Not Lamp Loads) 16.0 9.2 8.0 7.2
Pilot Duty 125 VA, 24 to 277 VAC1
A28AJ
AC Full Load A 6.0 3.4 3.0
AC Locked Rotor A 36.0 20.4 18.0
Non-Inductive or Resistance Load A (Not Lamp Loads) 15.0 9.2 8.0 7.2
Pilot Duty 125 VA, 24 to 277 VAC1
A28AB
AC Full Load A 16.0 9.2 8.0
AC Locked Rotor A 96.0 55.2 48.0
Non-Inductive or Resistance Load A (Not Lamp Loads) 16.0 9.2 8.0 7.2
Pilot Duty 125 VA, 24 to 277 VAC1

1. When used as two-circuit control, the total connected load must not exceed 2,000 VA.

Multi-Stage Electromechanical Temperature Controls Code No. LIT-1927115

A28 Series Two-Stage Flange Mounted Duct Thermostat

Description

The A28AK is a two-stage temperature control with special air coil sensing element and adjustable mounting flange.

Refer to the A28 Series Two-Stage Temperature Controls with NEMA 1 Enclosure Product Bulletin (LIT-125130) for important product application information.

Features

  • flat flange mounting with special coil element permits positioning of sensing bulb in the appropriate portion of the air stream
  • two single-pole, double-throw (SPDT) snap-acting switches
  • unaffected by barometric pressure or cross ambient temperatures

Applications

These duct thermostats are used on roof top units, make-up heaters, duct heaters, and air handling systems of all types.

Selection Chart

Product Code

Number

Number

of Stages

Switch

Action

Range °F (°C) Differential F° (C°) Fixed Maximum Allowable

Temperature at Bulb

°F (°C)

Each

Stage

Between

Stage

A28AK-1C Two Two-SPDT switches 30 to 110

(-1 to 43)

2 (1.1) 3 (1.7) 140 (60)
A28AK-2C Two Two-SPDT switches 60 to 130

(16 to 54)

2 (1.1) 3 (1.7) 200 (93)

Technical Specifications

Electrical Ratings

A28 Series

Y

Y

R

R

B

B

High Stage Low Stage

Action on Increase of Temperature

a28.eps

A28 Action Diagram

Repair Information

If the A28 Series Two-Stage Flange Mounted Duct Thermostat fails to operate within its specifications, replace the unit. For a replacement thermostat, contact the nearest Johnson Controls® representative.

A28AK Thermostat

Motor Ratings VAC 120 208 240 277
AC Full Load A 6.0 3.4 3.0
AC Locked Rotor A 36.0 20.4 18.0
Non-Inductive or Resistance Load A (Not Lamp Loads) 10.0 9.2 8.0 7.2
Pilot Duty 125 VA, 24 to 277 VAC

Note: When used as a two-circuit control, the total connected load must not exceed 2,000 VA.

Multi-Stage Electromechanical Temperature Controls Code No. LIT-1927120

A28 Two-Stage Industrial Thermostat (Watertight and Dusttight)

Description

The A28KA is a wide range temperature control with gasketed enclosure and two single-pole, double-throw (SPDT) switches.

Refer to the A19A, A19K, A28K Series Industrial Controls Remote Bulb Product Bulletin (LIT-125105) for important product application information

Features

  • rugged steel enclosure
  • liquid-filled sensing element that provides uniform control

Applications

This control is for refrigeration, air conditioning, and heating applications. This model incorporates a gasketed enclosure that can be used in a wide range of industrial and general purpose applications.

Repair Information

If the A28 Two-Stage Industrial Thermostat fails to operate within its specifications, replace the unit. For a replacement thermostat, contact the nearest Johnson Controls® representative.

Technical Specifications

Electrical Ratings

Motor Ratings AC 120 208 240
AC Full Load A 16.0 9.2 8.0
AC Locked Rotor A 96.0 55.2 48.0
Non-Inductive or Resistance Load A (Not Lamp Loads) 16.0 9.2 8.0
Pilot Duty 125 VA, 24 to 277 VAC

Note: When used as a two-circuit control, the total connected load must not exceed 2,000 VA.

A28AKA Industrial Thermostat

Selection Chart

Product Code

Number

Switch

Action

Range

°F (°C)

Differential

F° (C°)

Bulb and

Capillary

Bulb Well No.

(Order Separately)

Range

Adjuster

A28KA-1C Two-SPDT 0 to 150

(-15 to 65)

5 (2.8) each stage

3 (1.7) fixed between stages

0.290 x 2-1/2 in.

10 ft capillary

WEL16A-600R Knob
Multi-Stage Electromechanical Temperature Controls Code No. LIT-1927125

A28 Two-Stage Temperature Control with Weatherproof Enclosure

Description

The A28MA Controls are wide range temperature controls with rainproof NEMA 3R enclosure and two single-pole, double-throw (SPDT) switches.

Refer to the A28MA Type Two-Stage Tower Fan Control Two-Stage Air Cooled Condenser Fan Control Product Bulletin

(LIT-125135) for important product application information

Technical Specifications

Electrical Ratings

Motor Ratings 120 208 240
AC Full Load A 16.0 9.2 8.0
AC Locked Rotor A 96.0 55.2 48.0
Non-Inductive or Resistance Load A (Not Lamp Loads) 16.0 9.2 8.0
Pilot Duty 125 VA, 24 to 277 VAC

Note: When used as a two-circuit control, the total connected load must not exceed

2,000 VA.

Features

  • rugged steel enclosure
  • liquid-filled sensing element provides uniform control

Applications

  • sump water temperature control for cooling towers and evaporative condensers
  • fan cycling control for air-cooled condensers

Repair Information

If the A28 Two-Stage Temperature Control with Weatherproof Enclosure fails to operate within its specifications, replace the unit. For a replacement control, contact the nearest Johnson Controls® representative.

Selection Chart

Product

Code Number

Switch

Action

Range

°F (°C)

Differential

F° (C°)

Bulb and

Capillary

Range

Adjuster

A28MA-1C Two-Stage Two-SPDT

Switches

40 to 120

(4 to 49)

Factory set

5 (2.8) each stage

8 (4.4) between stages

3/8 in. x 4 in.;

Neoprene-coated 6 ft capillary

Screwdriver slot
A28MA-2C 3/8 in. x 4-1/16 in.; 6 ft capillary

A28MA Temperature Control

Multi-Stage Electromechanical Temperature Controls Code No. LIT-1927130

A28 Two-Stage Agricultural Thermostat with NEMA 4X Enclosure

Description

The A28PJ and A28PA are two-stage temperature controls with raintight and dusttight enclosures.

Refer to the A28 Series Two-Stage Temperature Controls with NEMA 1 Enclosure Product Bulletin (LIT-125130) for important product application information.

Features

  • rugged thermoplastic gasketed enclosures that meet NEMA 4X specifications
  • O-ring sealed setpoint adjustment knobs
  • range scale with oversized white markings for easy readability in low light
  • exposed portion of liquid-filled sensing elements are plated and plastic coated to resist damage in corrosive atmospheres

Selection Chart

Product Code Number Switch Action Range °F (°C) Differential F° (C°) Bulb and Capillary Range Adjuster
A28PJ-1C Two-SPDT 30 to 110

(-1 to 43)

2 (1.1) each stage

2 to 7 (1.1 to 3.9) adjustable between stages

1-3/8 in. x 2-1/4 in.

coiled

Knob
A28PA-2C Two-SPDT 30 to 110

(-1 to 43)

2 (1.1) each stage

2 to 7 (1.1 to 3.9) adjustable between stages

1-3/8 in. x 2-1/4 in. coiled Knob

Technical Specifications

Electrical Ratings

Applications

Designed for use in agricultural and industrial applications that require compliance with Article 547 of the National Electrical Code.

Repair Information

If the A28 Two-Stage Agricultural Thermostat with NEMA 4X Enclosure fails to operate within its specifications, replace the unit. For a replacement thermostat, contact the nearest Johnson Controls® representative.

A28PJ, A28PA Thermostat

Motor Ratings VAC 120 208 240 277
A28PJ
AC Full Load A 6.0 3.4 3.0
AC Locked Rotor A 36.0 20.4 18.0
Non-Inductive or Resistance Load A (Not Lamp Loads) 10.0 9.2 8.0 7.2
Pilot Duty 125 VA, 24 to 277 VAC1
A28PA
AC Full Load A 16.0 9.2 8.0
AC Locked Rotor A 96.0 55.2 48.0
Non-Inductive or Resistance Load A (Not Lamp Loads) 16.0 9.2 8.0 7.2
Pilot Duty 125 VA, 24 to 277 VAC1

1. When used as a two-circuit control, the total connected load must not exceed 2,000 VA.

Multi-Stage Electromechanical Temperature Controls Code No. LIT-1927135

A36 Series Four-Stage Remote Bulb Thermostats

Sw itch

D ifferentia l

Description

The A36 series are four-stage thermostats with open construction for use in panel mounting.

Refer to the Type A36AHA 4-Stage Computer Environmental Temperature Control Product Bulletin (LIT-125145) for important product application information.

In ter sta ge Dif ferent ial

A36 Series Differential Diagram

Sw itch

D iffe ren tia l

Sw itch

D iffere n tial

a36diff.eps

Features

Screwdriver slot adjustment with calibrated dial enables movement of entire staging band within the range.

Applications

Use for cycling control for multiple refrigeration compressors or unloading type compressors.

Accessories

Order Enclosure CSE57A-600 separately, if required.

a36 IN.eps

A36AHA-52 Remote Bulb Thermostat

Repair Information

If the A36 Series Four-Stage Remote Bulb Thermostat fails to operate within its specifications, replace the unit. For a replacement thermostat, contact the nearest Johnson Controls® representative.

A36 Series Action Diagram

Selection Chart

Product Code

Number

Switch

Action

Range °F (°C) Differential F° (C°)

Fixed

Bulb and

Capillary

Bulb Well No.

(Order Separately)

Range

Adjuster

A36AHA-50C1 Four Single-Pole,

Double-Throw (SPDT)

switches

55 to 95

(13 to 35)

Two each stage

1 1/2 (0.8) between stages

3/8 in. x 5-1/4 in.

18 in. capillary

w ith 12 in. nylon armor

WEL14A-603R Screwdriver slot with

calibrated dial

A36AHA-52C1
A36AHA-58C2 0 to 70

(-18 to 21)

Three each stage

2-1/2 (1.4) between stages

3/8 in. x 4-3/4 in.

15 ft braid armor capillary

WEL14A-602R
A36AHB-33C1 Two each stage

2-1/2 (1.4) between stages

  1. Calibrated at mid-switching point; computer room or comfort control.
  2. Calibrated at low-switching point; special close control chiller applications.

Specifications

Maximum bulb temperature is 120°F (49°C) in operation and 140°F (60°C) when shipping.

Electrical Ratings (Per Switch)

Motor Ratings VAC 120 208 240 277
A36AHA
AC Full Load A 10.0 6.9 5.0
AC Locked Rotor A 60.0 41.4 30.0
Non-Inductive A 16.0 9.2 8.0 7.2
Pilot Duty 125 VA, 120 to 227 VAC
A36AHB
AC Full Load A 6.0 3.4 3.0
AC Locked Rotor A 36.0 20.4 18.0
Non-Inductive A 10.0 5.7 5.0 4.3
Pilot Duty 125 VA, 120 to 227 VAC

Multi-Stage Electromechanical Temperature Controls Code No. LIT-1922250

S26 Series Switching Subbase

Description

The S26 Series is a switching subbase used in conjunction with T26A, T26J, and T26S thermostats to provide system and fan switching capability.

The variety of switching configurations available with the S26 Series adds application flexibility to the T26 Series thermostats.

Applications

S26 Series subbases are available with a variety of system switch configurations for manual control of system operation and fan speed for heating, cooling, and combination heating/cooling equipment.

Selection Chart

Product Code

Number

System

Switch

Fan Switch
S26AA-1 Heat-off-cool Low-med-high
S26AH-1 Heat-off-cool None
S26DH-1 Off-auto None

Refer to the S26 Series Switching Subbase Product Bulletin (LIT-125610) for important product application information.

Features

  • mounts directly to a two-gang electrical box
  • wiring connections enclosed and isolated from the user
  • smooth action multi-position slide switches for dependable service
  • can be added to existing T26 Series thermostats (new style with plastic cover)
  • high-impact plastic enclosure

Repair Information

If the S26 Series Switching Subbase fails to operate within its specifications, replace the unit. For a replacement subbase, contact the nearest Johnson Controls® representative.

S26 Series Switching Subbase

Technical Specifications

Gray

Typical Wiring Configuration for Cooling S26

T26S and S26AH (T46SAH) Heat-Off-Cool Selector Switch with Continuous Fan (Heating and Cooling)

Black

FIG:T46SAH

S26 Series System Switching Subbase
Finish Cover Almond
Faceplate Gold metallic with dark brown border and lettering
Material Base 0.050 in. (1 mm) cold rolled steel
Cover 0.090 in. (2 mm) high impact PVC plastic
Mounting Mounts to a 2-gang electrical box
Shipping Weight Individual Pack 7 oz (0.20 kg)
Overpack of 20 Units 10 lb, 4 oz (4.65 kg)
Wiring Connections Color coded No. 16 AWG wires, 8 in. (203 mm) long

Typical Wiring Configurations for Combinations

Electrical Ratings
Motor Ratings 120V 208V 240V 277V
AC full load A 12.0 6.9 6.0 5.2
AC locked rotor A 72 41.4 36 31.2
AC non-inductive A 6.5 6.5 6.5
Pilot Duty 125 VA, 24 to 277 VAC

Black

Red

H C H C

Gray

T26S and S26AA (T46SAA) Heat-Off-Cool Selector Switch with Fan Speed Control (Heating and Cooling)

Black

T26S and S26DH (T46SDH) Off-Auto Selector Switch with Manual or Automatic Changeover Switch and

Gray

FIG:T46SAA

FIG:T4SDH

Continuous Fan (Heating and Cooling)

Multi-Stage Electromechanical Temperature Controls Code No. LIT-1922255

T22/T25/T26 Series Line Voltage Wall Thermostat (Heating, Cooling, or Heating and Cooling)

Description

For line voltage control of residential, commercial, or industrial heating or year-round air conditioning. Heat or cold anticipators are not required. The

liquid-charged temperature sensing element and highly efficient diaphragm and leverage provide close temperature control.

Refer to the following documents for important product application information:

  • T22 Series Line Voltage Thermostats with Selector Switch Product Bulletin

(LIT-125630)

  • T25 Two-Stage Room Thermostat Product Bulletin (LIT-125640)
  • T26 Series Line Voltage Thermostats Product Bulletin (LIT-125645)

Features

  • attractive beige colored, high-impact plastic enclosure (T26 Series)
  • close differential without the need for anticipators
  • bi-metal thermometer supplied as standard except where indicated
  • equipped with adjustable dial stops (T26 Series)

T22 Series Line Voltage Wall Thermostat

Series T25

Y

Y

B R

B

R

High Stage

T25 Series Line Voltage Wall Thermostat

Low Stage

t28cd.eps

T25 Series Line Voltage Wall Thermostat

SeriesT26

3

2

1

t28cd.eps

Specifications

Action on Increase of Temperature

Action on Increase of Temperature

Temperature range is 40 to 90°F (5 to 30°C),

except energy conservation models.

Accessories

  • replacement knobs and faceplates
  • for double trim plate for mounting two T22s or T26s

Repair Information

If the T22/T25/T26 Series Line Voltage Wall Thermostat (Heating, Cooling, or Heating and Cooling) fails to operate within its specifications, replace the unit. For a replacement thermostat, contact the nearest Johnson Controls® representative.

Applications

Use for line voltage control of heating and cooling equipment.

T25, T26 Series Action Diagrams

Multi-Stage Electromechanical Temperature Controls

T22/T25/T26 Series Line Voltage Wall Thermostat (Heating, Cooling, or Heating and Cooling) (Continued)

Selection Chart

Product Code

Number1

Type of

Adjustment

Application Selector

Switch

Differential Approximately C° (F°) Shipping

Wt. (lb)

Heating Cooling
Heating
T22AAA-1C Knob Single-Pole, Single-Throw (SPST) Off-Auto 1-3/4 (1) 1.3
T22ABC-1C Auto-Off-Fan
T22ABC-3C Concealed
T22BBC-1C Knob SPST, medium duty 3 (1.7)
T22CBC-1C SPST, heavy duty
T22CBC-3C Concealed
T26A-14C

(No Thermometer)

Knob SPST, Energy Conservation Heating

model, max. setting 75°F (24°C)

None 2 (1.1) 1.0
T26A-15C

(No Thermometer)

SPST, Energy Conservation Heating

model, max. setting 65°F (18°C)

Cooling
T22JAA-1C Knob SPST Off-Auto 2-1/4 (1.3) 1.3
T22JCC-1C Auto-Off-Fan
T26J-7C

(No Thermometer)

SPST, Energy Conservation Cooling

model, min. setting 75°F (24°C)

None
T26J-9C

(No Thermometer)

SPST, Energy Conservation Cooling

model, min. setting 78°F (26°C)

2 (1.1) 1.0
Heating and Cooling
T22SDA-1C Knob Single-Pole, Double-Throw (SPDT),

permits system shutdown at the thermostat

Off-Auto 1-3/4 (1) 2-1/4 (1.3) 1.3
T22SEB-1C SPDT, used when the same device

controls heating and cooling

Heat-Off-Cool
T22SFB-1C2 SPDT, used to control separate

loads on heating and cooling

T22TFB-1C2 SPDT, heavy duty, used to control

separate loads on heating and cooling

3 (1.7) 3 to 4 (1.7 to 2.2)
T26S-18C3 SPDT None 1-3/4 (1) 2-1/4 (1.3) 1.0
T26T-3C2 SPDT, heavy duty 3 (1.7) 3 to 4 (1.7 to 2.2)
Two-Stage
T25A-1C Knob Two SPDT switches

Two-stage heating, cooling or one- stage heating and one-stage cooling

None 1-3/4 (1) 2-1/4 (1.3) 1.5
T25A-16C Concealed 3 (1.7) between stages
  1. For the thermostat guard, refer to G Series Thermostat and Humidistat Guards (LIT-1922145).
  2. Can also be used where one unit provides both heating and cooling by adding a jumper between terminals 2 and 3. Refer to Typical Wiring Diagram and Electrical Ratings for Line Voltage Thermostats (LIT-1922600).
  3. Includes a faceplate for horizontal mounting. The plate is for on-the-job installation over a vertical plate. Can field-convert to other configurations.

The T26S-18 is a universal replacement for Honeywell T451A, -B, T651A; White-Rodgers 179-1, 180-1, 181-1, 182-101, -102; Robertshaw® TA500, TH71,

-72, -79, -500, TX550.

T26T-3 replaces: Honeywell T4051A, -B, T6051A; White-Rodgers 151-6, 152-9, 159-3, -5.

Multi-Stage Electromechanical Temperature Controls Code No. LIT-1922600

Typical Wiring Diagram and Electrical Ratings for Line Voltage Thermostats

Technical Specifications

H

Off

Off

h

H eat C ool H eat C ool

3

1

2

Cooling

System

Heating

System

G

t22sfb.eps

T22SFB, T22TFB

Typical Wiring Diagram for Line Voltage Thermostat

Electrical Ratings T22A, T22J, T22S, T25A, T26A, T26J, T26S

Motor Ratings VAC 120 208 240 277
AC Full Load A 6.0 3.4 3.0
AC Locked Rotor A 36.0 21 18.0
AC Non-Inductive A (1) (1) (1) (1)
Pilot Duty 125 VA, 24 to 277 VAC

Note: T25A Non-Inductive Ratings are 10.0, 9.2, 8.0 and 7.2 A. T26A, T26S Non-Inductive Rating is 10.0 A,

120 to 277 VAC.

Electrical Ratings T22BBC

Motor Ratings VAC 120 208 240
AC Full Load A 10.0 6.9 6.0
AC Locked Rotor A 60.0 41.4 36.0
Pilot Duty 125 VA, 24 to 277 VAC

Electrical Ratings T22CBC1, T26T2

Motor Ratings VAC 120 208 240
Heat Cool Heat Cool Heat Cool
AC Full Load A 16.0 8.0 9.2 8.0 8.0 8.0
AC Locked Rotor A 96.0 48.0 55.2 48.0 48.0 48.0
Non-Inductive Rating 120 240 227
AC Non-Inductive A 22.0 22.0 22.0
Pilot Duty 125 VA, 120 to 240 VAC
  1. Heating rating only applies. Non-inductive ratings do not apply to Type T2CBC.
  2. Non-inductive rating does not apply to the cooling side of T26T.

Electrical Ratings T22TFB

Motor Ratings VAC 120 208 240
Heat Cool Heat Cool Heat Cool
AC Full Load A 16.0 8.0 9.2 8.0 8.0 8.0
AC Locked Rotor A 96.0 48.0 55.2 48.0 48.0 48.0
Pilot Duty 125 VA, 120 to 240 VAC

Multi-Stage Electromechanical Temperature Controls Code No. LIT-1922260

T23 Series Fan Coil Thermostat (with Fan and System Selectors)

Description

This line voltage thermostat controls heating, cooling, or combination heating and cooling systems. It operates fan motors, relays, or valves on fan-coil units. All thermostats have a three-speed fan selector switch.

Refer to the T23 Series Line Voltage Fan Coil Thermostat Product Bulletin (LIT-125635) for important product application information.

Features

  • dual voltage switching provided (120/240 VAC) without the need for

anticipators to achieve close temperature control

  • field-adjustable high and low dial stops
  • mounts on a standard double outlet box
  • attractive one-piece beige cover with inlaid two-tone panel

Applications

  • line voltage control of fan motors, relays, or valves on fan-coil units

T23A Thermostat

2 3 Y h

MED

L O H I B

OF F

5 6 4

R

H E A T C O OL

2

3

Y

h

ME D

LO

HI

B

OF F

5

6

R

AU T O

t23a.eps

T23B Thermostat

2

3

Y

h

ME D

LO

HI

B

OF F

5

6

R

AU T O

T23A-1 Thermostat

Repair Information

If the T23 Series Fan Coil Thermostat (with Fan and System Selectors) fails to operate within its specifications, replace the unit. For a replacement thermostat, contact the nearest Johnson Controls® representative.

t23b.eps

Selection Chart

Product Code

Number

Switches Range °F (°C) Differential F° (C°) Shipping

Weight (lb)

Fan System Heating Cooling
T23A-1C Low-Med-High Heat-Off-Cool 50 to 90

(10 to 32)

1-3/4 (1) 2-1/4 (1.3) 1.5
T23B-1C Low-Med-High Auto-Off

Technical Specifications Mounts on a standard double outlet box. Electrical Ratings

Motor Ratings VAC 120 240
AC Full Load Amperes 5.8 2.9
AC Locked Rotor Amperes 34.8 17.4
Pilot Duty 125 VA, 120 to 240 VAC

Multi-Stage Electromechanical Temperature Controls Code No. LIT-1922265

T28 Series Fan Coil Thermostat (with or without Fan Selector Switches)

Description

This thermostat controls light duty line voltage fan coil or baseboard valves on heating, cooling, and heating-cooling systems. The thermostat can control one or two valves directly. These thermostats are rated for 120, 208, or 240 VAC at 50 to 60 Hz.

Refer to the T28 Series Fan Coil Thermostats Product Bulletin (LIT-125650) for important product application information.

Features

  • precision, snap-acting contacts
  • heating and cooling anticipation
  • cooling and heating-cooling models have an interlocked fan off position

Applications

Use for line voltage control of heating and cooling equipment.

HI ME D h

OFF

LO

T28CD

t28cd.eps

Heating-Cooling Thermostat with Off-Hi-Med-Lo Fan Switch

HI ME D h

OF F LO

T28DG

Sequenced Heating-Cooling Thermostat with Off-Hi-Med-Lo Fan Switch

t28dg.eps

T28CD Thermostat

Repair Information

If the T28 Series Fan Coil Thermostat (with or without Fan Selector Switches) fails to operate within its specifications, replace the unit. For a replacement thermostat, contact the nearest Johnson Controls® representative.

Selection Chart

Product Code Number Fan Switch Shipping Weight, lb (kg)
Cooling
T28BD-1C Off-Hi-Med-Lo 1.3 (0.59)
Heating-Cooling (Remote changeover, Single valve for heating and cooling)1
T28CD-1C Off-Hi-Med-Lo 1.3 (0.59)
Heating-Cooling, Sequenced (Automatic changeover, Separate valves for heating and cooling)2
T28DA-1C None 1.0 (0.45)
T28DB-1C1 Off-On 1.3 (0.59)
T28DD-1C1 Off-Hi-Med-Lo 1.3 (0.59)
T28DG-1C3 Off-Hi-Med-Lo 1.3 (0.59)
  1. Off position of fan switch interlocks to turn off cooling.
  2. For automatic changeover where one valve functions for heating or cooling, use A19CAC-2 Strap-On Changeover Control.
  3. Off position of fan switch interlocks to turn off both heating and cooling.

Technical Specifications

The T28 mounts on a standard, double outlet box.

Nominal operating differential at 0.6°F (0.3 C°) heating, 1 F° (0.6 C°) cooling on standard 120 VAC fan coil valves. Sequenced models have 6 F° (3.3 C°) differential from heat on to cool on.

Electrical Ratings – Ampere

VAC Thermostat Fan Switch
Cooling Heating
Normal Inrush Normal Inrush Full Load Amperes Locked Rotor Amperes
120 0.32 1.0 0.12 0.36 5.8 34.8
208 0.18 0.57 0.07 0.21 3.3 19.8
240 0.16 0.50 0.06 0.18 2.9 17.4
Multi-Stage Electromechanical Temperature Controls Code No. LIT-1922270

T46 Series Fan Coil Thermostat

Description

The T46 Series Thermostat is used to control line voltage, fan coil, and heating zone valves on heating, cooling, and combination heating and cooling systems. Models are available with single-pole, single-throw (SPST) or single-pole, double-throw (SPDT) contact action for standard duty (nominal 1/4 hp,

6 A non-inductive) applications. Thermostats are available with or without fan speed control or built-in thermometers. Various system switch combinations are available, including fan speed selection.

Field-installable faceplate combinations of knob or concealed adjustment are possible. Also, the T46 is available with or without thermometer indication. These thermostats have plastic locking covers with an

Allen-head screw to discourage unauthorized tampering. Standard models are supplied with the thermostat faceplate installed with knob adjustment and thermometer.

Refer to the T46 Series Fan Coil Thermostats Product Bulletin (LIT-125655) for important product application information.

Selection Charts

T46 Series Fan Coil Thermostat

Features

  • knob or concealed setpoint adjustment
  • low and high temperature dial stops that are concealed and adjustable throughout setpoint range
  • can be set for a locked dial
  • narrow differential without the need for anticipator
  • standard internal dual Celsius and Fahrenheit scales
  • switch mechanism and wiring connections go into the switch box to isolate electrical circuits from the sensing element
  • mounts on a standard double outlet box
  • separable mounting plate allows easy mounting and wiring without removing thermostat cover
  • locking cover reduces unauthorized tampering
  • high-impact plastic enclosure
  • smooth action multi-position slide switches for dependable service

Replacement Parts

Product Code Number Description
CVR88A-600R Thermostat Cover Assembly for knob adjustment models with thermometer,

°F scale, faceplate supplied unassembled

KNB26A-600R Plastic push on knob for thermostat
BKT48A-600R Mounting plate for T46

T46 Thermostat

Applications

These thermostats control fan coil and zone heating valves on a wide variety of heating and cooling combinations for conditioned space.

Accessories

Product Code

Number

System

Switch

Fan

Switch

Heating
T46ABH-1C Auto-off-fan None
T46ADH-1C Off-auto None
Cooling
T46JBH-1C Auto-off-fan None
T46JDH-1C Off-auto None
T46JEA-1C On-off Low-med-high
Heating and Cooling
T46SAA-1C Heat-off-cool Low-med-high
T46SAH-1C Heat-off-cool None
T46SDA-1C Off-auto Low-med-high
T46SDH-1C Off-auto None
Product Code

Number

Faceplate Selection1
Mounting

Position

Type of

Adjustment

Thermometer

Cutout

Temperature

Scale

PLT333-1R2 Vertical Knob Yes Fahrenheit
PLT333-3R Vertical Concealed Yes Fahrenheit
PLT333-5R Vertical Knob Yes Celsius
PLT333-12R Vertical Concealed No

Technical Specifications

  1. Faceplates must be ordered in multiples of ten.
  2. Supplied with standard wholesaler models.
T46 Series Fan Coil Thermostats
Range Thermostat 40 to 90°F (5 to 30°C)
Thermometer 50 to 90°F (10 to 30°C)
Differential Mechanical Approximately 0.7°F (0.4°C)
Operating See next page
Finish Cover Almond
Faceplate Gold metallic with dark brown border and lettering
Mounting Double gang box, separable mounting plate
Material Base 0.050 in. (1 mm) cold rolled steel
Cover 0.090 in. (2 mm) high-impact plastic
Sensing Element Liquid-filled for positive trouble-free operation
Shipping Weight Individual Pack 1 lb (0.45 kg)
Overpack of 20 Units 20 lb (9.07 kg)
Thermometer Bimetal type for accuracy and clarity, can be field-calibrated
Wiring Connections Color coded No. 16 AWG wires, 8 in. (203 mm) long

Multi-Stage Electromechanical Temperature Controls

T46 Series Fan Coil Thermostat (Continued)

Technical Specifications (Continued)

Electrical Ratings

Typical Wiring Application for Heating

Black

Motor Ratings 120 V 208 V 240 V 277 V
T46 System and Fan Switches
AC Full Load A 12.0 6.9 6.0 5.2
AC Locked Rotor A 34.8 19.1 17.4 14.4
AC Non-Inductive A 6.5 6.5 6.5
Pilot Duty 125 VA, 24 to 277 VAC
T46 Thermostat Only
AC Full Load A 6.0 3.5 3.0
AC Locked Rotor A 34.8 19.1 17.4
AC Non-Inductive A 6.5 6.5 6.5
Pilot Duty 125 VA, 24 to 277 VAC

L1 (Hot)

Grey

Operating Differentials

5

T46A, T46S Heating

4

Operating Differential F 0

3

2.2

Orange

Red

Neutral

T46ABH Auto-Off-Fan Selector Switch with Continuous Fan (Heating Only)

Typical Wiring Application for Cooling

To Fan

To Heating

t46auht.eps

2

1

0

0 2 4 6 8

Amperage Load

1.1

L1 (Hot)

Operating Differential C 0

Bla ck

Grey

Orange

Blu e

To Fan

t46auco.eps

Operating Differential for T46A and Heating Side of T46S

t46heat.eps

Neutral

To Cool ing

T46JBH Auto-Off-Fan Selector Switch

5 with Continuous Fan (Cooling Only)

T46J, T46S Cooling

4 2.2

Operating Differential F 0

Operating Differential C 0

3

2 1.1

1

Typical Wiring Application for Combination

Fan

Orange

To

L1 (Hot)

Fan

Off

Changeover

Control

Blue

Y

B

Red

R

Valve

Neutral

Black

0

t46cool.eps

Grey

0 2 4 6 8

Amperage Load

Operating Differential for T46J and Cooling Side of T46S

Note: The heavy line in each of the above figures is the nominal operating temperature differential. Production thermostats may vary from the norm, as indicated by the dotted line.

T46SDH Off-Auto Selector Switch.

t46_2.eps

Used on Fan-Coil Unit with Cycling Valve and Continuous Fan.

Terminal Markings Shown for

A19CAC Changeover Control (Heating and Cooling)

Multi-Stage Electronic Temperature Controls Code No. LIT-1900004

MS Series Temperature Stage Control Modules

Description

The MS Series Temperature Controls are versatile, microprocessor-based, multifunction, programmable temperature controls. They are designed for single and multiple-stage temperature control applications.

Depending on the model selected, the

MS Series Controls can operate in the following modes:

  • Direct mode
  • Reverse mode
  • Deadband mode
  • Independent Setpoint mode

The MS Series Controls have large, easy-to-read, red LED displays. These

compact controls are available in panel mount and DIN rail mount models. MS Series Controls use the A99B temperature sensors, which allow remote mounting of the display unit.

Refer to the MS Series Multi-Stage Electronic Temperature Controls Product Bulletin

(LIT-125198) for important product application information.

Features

  • programmable functions allow adjustment of control settings to meet application needs
  • alarm management functions provide visible alarm codes on the display
  • easily readable LED display shows temperature and functions quickly and clearly
  • programming button lockout allows user to disable programming buttons to deter accidental or unauthorized changes
  • accurate temperature sensors provide precise control performance with up to 300 feet of wiring (An adjustable offset is provided for longer wiring)
  • self-test procedure checks control operation by cycling all outputs and testing all LEDs

MS4 Series Panel and DIN Rail Mount, Multi-Stage, Electronic Temperature Controls

Repair Information

If the MS Series Temperature Stage Control Modules fails to operate within its specifications, replace the unit. For a replacement control, contact the nearest Johnson Controls® representative.

Applications

Application MS1 Series Single-Stage MS2 Series Two-Stage MS4 Series Four-Stage
Rooftop heating or cooling units
Boiler or pump control
Convenience store coolers
Space temperature control
Cooling tower pump control
Compressor or chiller staging
Reach-in coolers
Supermarket display cases for produce
Restaurant and Convenience store walk-in coolers

Selection Chart

Product Code Number Description Shipping Weight, lb (g)
MS1DR24T-11C MS1 Single-stage, DIN Rail Mount Temperature Control, A99BB-200C sensor included 0.75 (340)
MS2DR24T-11C MS2 Two-stage, DIN Rail Mount Temperature Control, A99BB-200C sensor included 0.79 (360)
MS2PM24T-11C MS2 Two-stage, Panel Mount Temperature Control, A99BB-200C sensor included 0.53 (240)
MS4DR24T-11C MS4 Four-stage, DIN Rail Mount Temperature Control, 2 A99BB-200C sensors included 1.17 (530)
MS4PM24T-11C MS4 Four-stage, Panel Mount Temperature Control, 2 A99BB-200C sensors included 0.90 (410)

Accessories

Product Code Number Description
A99BB-200C Temperature Sensor: Range: -40 to 212°F (-40 to 100°C)

Cable length and type: 6-1/2 ft (2 m) PVC

A99BB-300C Temperature Sensor: Range: -40 to 212°F (-40 to 100°C) Cable length and type: 9-3/4 ft (3 m) PVC
A99BB-500C Temperature Sensor: Range: -40 to 212°F (-40 to 100°C) Cable length and type: 16-3/8 ft (5 m) PVC
A99BB-600C Temperature Sensor: Range: -40 to 212°F (-40 to 100°C) Cable length and type: 19-1/2 ft (6 m) PVC
A99BA-200C Temperature Sensor: Range: -40 to 212°F (-40 to 100°C) Cable length and type: 6-1/2 ft (2 m) Shielded

ms4pm24t.eps

ms4dr24t.eps

Multi-Stage Electronic Temperature Controls

MS Series Temperature Stage Control Modules (Continued)

Technical Specifications

MS Series Temperature Stage Control Modules
Power Requirements 24 VAC, 50/60 Hz, Class 2 (20 to 30 VAC)
Power Consumption 5 VA at 24 VAC
Accuracy  1.8°F ( 1°C)
Ambient Conditions Operating +14 to +140°F (-10 to +60°C); 0 to 95% RH (noncondensing)
Storage -22 to +176°F (-30 to +80°C); 0 to 95% RH (noncondensing)
Agency Listings UL Recognized: File E194024, CCN XAPX2

Canadian UL Recognized: File E194024, CCN XAPX8

Dimensions (H x W x D) Panel Mount 1.38 x 2.95 x 2.68 in. (35 x 75 x 68 mm)
DIN Rail 4.65 x 2.76 x 2.07 in. (118 x 70 x 53 mm)

Electrical Ratings

120 VAC 240 VAC 24 VDC
Horsepower 1/4 1/2
Full Load Amperes 5.8 4.9
Locked Rotor Amperes 34.8 29.4
Inductive (Non-Motor) Amperes 8 8 8
Pilot Duty VA 275 450

Note: Relay outputs must not exceed 20 Amperes total connected load. Open collector transistors on the MS1 Alarm Circuits have a maximum rating of 40 VDC 100 mA. Alarms require separate power source.

Refer to Ratings Table for more information

Internal to Control

Stage Stage

1

3

Power

Stage

Stage Supply

2 4

Common

Binary Input

Auxiliary Temperature Sensor

Process Sensor

Binary/Sensor Common

C

1

2

3

4

V1 V2 D S2 SC S1

Terminal Not Used

Binary Input

Sensor Common

Process Sensor

Binary and Sensor Common

Auxiliary Temperature Stage Sensor

SC D CD S2 C2

Internal to Control

V1 V2

C1 1

C4

C3 3

Stage 1 Stage 4 Stage 3

Power Supply

See Ratings Table for more information

MS4PM24T Panel Mount Control Wiring MS4DR24T Din Rail Mount Control Wiring

Multi-Stage Electronic Temperature Controls Code No. LIT-1900009

MS Series Single-Stage Control Modules with Voltage Input

Description

The MS Series Controls are versatile, microprocessor-based, multifunction, programmable controls for humidity, pressure, or other 0 to 10 VDC input. They are designed for single- and multiple-stage control applications.

Depending on the model selected, the MS Series Control can operate in one of several modes:

  • Direct mode
  • Reverse mode
  • Deadband mode
  • Independent Setpoint mode

The MS Series Controls have large, easy-to-read, red LED displays. These

compact controls are available in panel mount and DIN rail mount models.

Refer to the MS Series Multi-Stage Electronic Controls Product Bulletin (LIT-125502) for important product application information.

Applications

Application MS1 Series Single-Stage
Rooftop heating or cooling units
Boiler or pump control
Convenience store coolers
Space temperature control
Cooling tower pump control

Selection Chart

Product Code Number Description
MS1DR24T-11C MS1 Single-Stage thermostat, DIN Rail Mount Control; A99 sensor included
MS1DR24V-11C MS1 Single-Stage, DIN Rail Mount Control; 0 to10 VDC input; no sensor included

Accessories

Product Code Number Description
HE-6300-3

HE-6310-3

Humidity Sensor: 0 to 100% RH noncondensing

20 to 140°F (-29 to 60°C)

Technical Specifications

Features

  • programmable functions allow adjustment of control settings to meet application needs
  • alarm management functions provide visible alarm codes on the display and alarm relay contacts that can be used to activate a remote alarm or dial-out modem
  • easily readable LED display shows condition and functions quickly and clearly
  • programming button lockout allows user to disable programming buttons to deter accidental or unauthorized changes
  • provides accurate control performance with up to 300 feet of wiring (an adjustable offset is provided for longer wiring.)
  • self-test procedure checks control operation by cycling all outputs and testing all LEDs

MS1 Series DIN Rail Mount, Single-Stage, Electronic Pressure, Temperator

Repair Information

If the MS Series Single-Stage Control Modules with Voltage Input fails to operate within its specifications, replace the unit. For a replacement control, contact the nearest Johnson Controls® representative.

MS Series Stage Control Modules with Voltage Input
Power Requirements 24 VAC, 50/60 Hz, Class 2 (20 to 30 VAC)
Power Consumption 5 VA at 24 VAC
Accuracy  1.8°F ( 1°C)
Multi-Stage Electronic Temperature Controls

Electrical Ratings

MS Series Stage Control Modules with Voltage Input
Ambient Conditions Operating +14 to +140°F (-10 to +60°C); 0 to 95% RH (noncondensing)
Storage -22 to +176°F (-30 to +80°C); 0 to 95% RH (noncondensing)
Agency Listings UL Recognized: File E194024, CCN XAPX2

Canadian UL Recognized: File E194024, CCN XAPX8

Dimensions (H x W x D) Panel Mount 1.38 x 2.95 x 2.68 in. (35 x 75 x 68 mm)
DIN Rail 4.65 x 2.76 x 2.07 in. (118 x 70 x 53 mm)

MS Series Single-Stage Control Modules with Voltage Input (Continued)

120 VAC 240 VAC 24 VDC
Horsepower 1/4 1/2
Full Load Amperes 5.8 4.9
Locked Rotor Amperes 34.8 29.4
Inductive (Non-Motor) Amperes 8 8 8
Pilot Duty VA 275 450

Note: Relay outputs must not exceed 20 Amperes total connected load. Open collector transistors on the MS1 Alarm Circuits have a maximum rating of 40 VDC 100 mA. Alarms require separate power source.

Multi-Stage Electronic Temperature Controls Code No. LIT-1927375

Description

MS4PMUHVT Multi-Stage Electronic Temperature Control with Relay Pack

    • Surface Mounted Design (SMD)

The MS4PMUHVT Control is intended for multi-stage temperature control applications. This microprocessor based control offers innovative features and state-of-the-art technology to improve all your staged temperature control applications.

Refer to the MS4PMUHVT Multi-Stage Electronic Temperature Control with Relay Pack Product Bulletin (LIT-125195) for important product application information.

Features

  • four enclosed, line voltage relays provide direct control of motor loads without additional relays
  • 120/240 VAC power supply eliminates need for separate transformers
  • one control provides single-sensor multi-stage control or dual-sensor reset

control, which reduces need for warehouse or truck to stock multiple controls for similar applications

  • accepts A99 sensor signal, which is suitable for a wide range of applications

Selection Charts

technology assures high quality, reliable components in a compact package

  • keypad lock deters accidental changes to parameter settings
  • listed for use on refrigeration equipment in accordance with Canadian and U.S. National standards

Applications

This control is specifically designed for the control of four-stage applications in the following configurations:

  • four cooling stages with common setpoint
  • four heating stages with common setpoint
  • four stages with deadband (two heating stages and two cooling stages with common setpoint)
  • two independent sets of two dependent stages (two heating stages and two cooling stages with independent setpoints)

Repair Information

If the MS4PMUHVT Multi-Stage Electronic Temperature Control with Relay Pack fails to operate within its specifications, replace the unit. For a replacement control, contact the nearest Johnson Controls® representative.

Technical Specifications

MS4PMUHVT Electronic Temperature Control

MS4PMUHV Multi-Stage Electronic Temperature Control with Relay Pack

MS4PMUHVT Multi-Stage Electronic Temperature Control

with Relay Pack

Power Requirements 120 VAC ±10% or 240 VAC ±10%
Frequency 60/50 Hz
Power Consumption 10 VA at 240 VAC, 10 VA at 120 VAC
Sensor Range -40 to 158°F (-40 to +70°C)
Accuracy ±1 F°/±1 C°
Ambient Operating Conditions MS4PMUHVT-11C +14 to +140°F (-10 to +60°C);

0 to 95% RH (noncondensing)

MS4PM12CT-11C +14 to +140°F (-10 to +60°C);

0 to 95% RH (noncondensing)

RP4MSUHV-1C -40 to +140°F (-40 to +60°C);

0 to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Ambient Storage Conditions MS4PMUHVT-11C -22 to +176°F (-30 to +80°C);

0 to 95% RH (noncondensing)

MS4PM12CT-11C -22 to +176°F (-30 to +80°C);

0 to 95% RH (noncondensing)

RP4MSUHV-1C -40 to +185°F (-40 to +85°C);

0 to 95% RH (noncondensing)

Agency Listings UL File SA516, Guide SDFY cUL File SA516, Guide SDFY7
Emissions Compliance FCC (US), DOC (Canada)
Dimensions (H x W x D) 7.94 x 3-3/5 x 2-2/5 in. (202 x 92 x 61 mm)
Shipping Weight 2.9 lb (1,320 g)
Product Code Number Description
MS4PMUHVT-11C Multi-Stage Electronic Temperature Control with

Relay Pack and One Temperature Sensor

Accessories and Maintenance Parts

Product Code Number Description
A99BB-200C Sensor with 6-1/2 ft/1.98 m Cable Length
MS4PM12CT-11C Replacement Control (for use only with relay pack)
RP4MSUHV-1C Replacement Relay Pack without Control

Electrical Ratings per Relay

24 VAC 120 VAC 208 VAC 240 VAC
HP 1/3 3/4 1
FLA (Ampere) 7.2 7.6 8
LRA (Ampere) 43.2 45.6 48
Non-Inductive (Ampere) 8 8 8
Pilot Duty (VA) 50 325 625 750
Temperature Control Sensors and Accessories Code No. LIT-1900006

A99B Series Temperature Sensor

Description

The A99B Series Temperature Sensors are passive PTC (Positive Temperature Coefficient) sensors. The A99B sensors are splashproof and are designed to measure temperature in a variety of refrigeration applications. Several accessories allow easy tailoring of the temperature sensor to various mounting configurations.

Applications include temperature sensing for freezers and coolers, as well as in defrost termination sensing, space and return air temperature sensing, and condenser fan cycling.

Refer to the A99B Series Temperature Sensors Product Bulletin (LIT-125186) for important product application information.

Selection Chart

Product Code

Number

Description
A99BA-200C PTC Silicon Sensor with Shielded Cable;

Cable length 6-1/2 ft (2 m);

Range: -40 to 212°F (-40 to 100°C)

A99BB-25C PTC Silicon Sensor with PVC Cable; Cable length 9-3/4 in. (0.25 m); Range: -40 to 212°F (-40 to 100°C)
A99BB-200C PTC Silicon Sensor with PVC Cable; Cable length 6-1/2 ft (2 m);

Range: -40 to 212°F (-40 to 100°C)

A99BB-300C PTC Silicon Sensor with PVC Cable; Cable length 9-3/4 ft (3 m);

Range: -40 to 212°F (-40 to 100°C)

A99BB-500C PTC Silicon Sensor with PVC Cable; Cable length 16-3/8 ft (5 m);

Range: -40 to 212°F (-40 to 100°C)

A99BB-600C PTC Silicon Sensor with PVC Cable; Cable length 19-1/2 ft (6 m);

Range: -40 to 212°F (-40 to 100°C)

A99BC-25C PTC Silicon Sensor with High Temperature Silicon Cable; Cable length 9-3/4 in. (0.25 m);

Range: -40 to 248°F (-40 to 120°C)

A99BC-300C PTC Silicon Sensor with High Temperature Silicon Cable; Cable length 9-3/4 ft (3 m);

Range: -40 to 248°F (-40 to 120°C)

A99BC-500C PTC Silicon Sensor with High Temperature Silicon Cable; Cable length 16-3/8 ft (5 m);

Range: -40 to 248°F (-40 to 120°C)

A99BC-1500C PTC Silicon Sensor with High Temperature Silicon Cable; Cable length 49 ft (15 m);

Range: -40 to 248°F (-40 to 120°C)

Features

  • variety of lead lengths available to encompass most application requirements and simplify wiring sensors
  • an assortment of mounting hardware provides configurations for many applications
  • exceptional accuracy of sensing element provides excellent performance in a wide variety of control applications
  • stainless steel sensing bulb allows use in more applications than other types of bulbs without corrosion
  • lead length may be extended up to 800 ft (244 m)

Applications

A99B Temperature Sensors

Repair Information

If the A99B Series Temperature Sensor fails to operate within its specifications, replace the unit. For a replacement sensor, contact the nearest Johnson Controls® representative.

Accessories

The A99B temperature sensor line offers an economical solution for a wide variety of temperature sensing needs in refrigeration and HVAC applications.

Typical temperature sensing applications and environments include:

  • freezers
  • display cases
  • walk-in coolers
  • reach-in coolers
  • defrost termination temperature sensing
  • condenser fan cycling
  • space and return air temperature sensing
  • outdoor air sensing
  • process cooling and heating

Technical Specifications

A99B Series Temperature Sensor
Sensing Range A99BA

A99BB

-40 to 212°F (-40 to 100°C)
A99BC -40 to 248°F (-40 to 120°C)
Reference Resistance 1,035 ohms at 77°F (25°C)
Accuracy 0.9°F (0.5°C)

between 5 and 167°F (-15 and 75°C)

Sensor Construction Stainless steel probe
Sensor Lead Wire Insulation A99BA Shielded PVC cable
A99BB PVC cable
A99BC High temperature silicon cable
Lead Wire Gauge 22 AWG
Maximum Allowable Bulb Temperature 257°F (125°C)
Ambient Operating Conditions A99BA A99BB -40 to 212°F (-40 to 100°C);

0 to 100% RH, condensing

A99BC -40 to 248°F (-40 to 120°C);

0 to 100% RH, condensing

Ambient Storage Conditions A99BA A99BB 40 to 221°F (-40 to 105°C);

0 to 100% RH, condensing

A99BC -40 to 266°F (-40 to 130°C);

0 to 100% RH, condensing

Product Code

Number

Description
A99-CLP-1 Surface Mounting Clip for the A99B Temperature Sensor
ADP11A-600R 1/2 in. diameter EMT Conduit Adaptor (box of 10) for use with BOX10A-600R
BOX10A-600R PVC Enclosure
SHL10A-600R Sun Shield for Single Sensor
SHL10A-603R Sun Shield for Two Sensors
WEL11A-601R Immersion Well

Temperature Control Sensors and Accessories Code No. LIT-1922135

Bulb Wells

Description

Bulb Wells are used in conjunction with Remote Bulb Temperature Controls where bulb insertion into a vessel or container to sense temperature is required. These wells are used with TE-6000 and TE-6300 Series Sensors.

A variety of shapes, sizes, and materials are available for a wide range of applications.

Refer to the appropriate temperature control for the exact bulb well required.

Accessories

The Code No. FTG13A-600R Packing Nut Assembly is used in applications where the temperature does not fall below -35°F (-37°C). The maximum liquid pressure limit is 150 psig (1,034 kPa). Use with Style 1, 3/8 in. diameter bulb for direct immersion application. A19s require models with support tube; A70s and A72s do not need support tubes.

Selection Charts

WEL Series Bulb Wells

Repair Information

If the Bulb Wells fail to operate within thier specifications, replace the unit. For a replacement Bulb Well, contact the nearest Johnson Controls® representative.

WEL Series Bulb Well

WEL Series Bulb Wells

FIG:Wel_3

FIG:Wel_2

FTG13A-600R

Packing Nut

Interlocking Retainer Washers

½ in. N.P.T. Adaptor

Style 1

Bulb Support Tube

FIG:Wel_1

FIG:FTG13A_600R

Product Code

Number

See

Figure

Dimension, in. Pipe Thread, in. Material Maximum

Temp °F

Maximum

Pressure psig

Type of

Solder Joint

Plating
A B C Inside

D

Outside

E

Connector Tube
WEL11A-601R1 2 2-3/8 2-5/16 .299 1/2 Brass Copper 250 300 Soft
WZ-1000-22 1 5-1/4 1-1/4 .500 1/2 1/2 Stainless steel Stainless steel 300 400
WZ-1000-4 1 5-1/4 1-1/4 .500 1/2 1/2 Stainless steel Stainless steel 600 400
WZ-1000-52 2 2-3/8 2-5/16 .299 1/2 Malleable Brass 250 300
WEL14A-601R 3 3 7-9/16 1-13/16 .430 1/2 Brass Copper 250 300 Silver Brite-Dip
WEL14A-602R 3 3 4-15/16 1-13/16 .430 1/2 Brass Copper 250 300 Silver Brite-Dip
WEL14A-603R 3 3 5-13/16 1 13/16 .430 1/2 Brass Copper 250 300 Silver Brite-Dip
WEL16A-600R1 2 2-3/8 1-5/16 .299 1/2 Brass Copper 250 300 Soft
WEL16A-601R 2 2-13/16 1-13/16 .375 1/2 Brass Copper 250 300 Soft
WEL17A-600R3 1 10-7/16 3/4 .763 1/2 3/4 Malleable Copper 250 250 Silver Tin
WEL17A-601R3 1 8-11/16 3/4 .763 1/2 3/4 Malleable Copper 250 250 Silver Tin
WEL17A-602R3 1 10-7/16 3/4 .753 1/2 3/4 Malleable Steel 250 540 Silver Tin
WEL17A-604R3 1 14-13/32 3/4 .763 1/2 3/4 Malleable Copper 250 250 Silver Tin
WEL18A-600R3 1 3-1/2 3/4 .773 1/2 3/4 Malleable Steel 250 150 Silver Tin
WEL18A-602R3 1 3-1/2 3/4 .773 1/2 3/4 Malleable Brass 250 150 Silver Tin
  1. With phenolic bushing 0.093 in. slot
  2. Includes thermal compound
  3. For 11/16 in. diameter style 4 bulbs. Style 1 can be used, but is not fastened into well

T-800 Wells

Product Code

Number

Description
T-800-1605 Brass well, 6-1/2 inch
T-800-1606 Stainless steel well, 5-1/4 inch
T-800-1618 Brass well, 9-1/2 inch
T-800-1620 Brass well, 9-1/2 inch
Temperature Control Sensors and Accessories Code No. LIT-1922145

G Series Thermostat and Humidistat Guards

GRD10-1R

Wire Guard

GRD10A-601

Cast Aluminum Guard

GRD10A-608

Large Clear Plastic Guard

GRD10A-609

Rectangular Clear Plastic Guard

Description

The G Series Guards protect thermostats and humidistats from damage, vandalism, tampering, and unauthorized adjustment.

They are available in plastic, cast aluminum, or wire construction.

Features

• clear plastic guards have tumbler-type key locks

• GRD10A-608 and -609 include a mounting ring for mounting to a wall or flat surface

• plastic baseplate and plastic mounting ring available

• the baseplate mounts to a flat surface or to a single or double outlet box

• the mounting ring permits mounting over a thermostat or humidistat already installed

Applications

Ideal for locations where locked protection is required, such as schools, warehouses, churches, hospitals, or offices.

Selection Chart

Product Code

Number

Description Thermostat or Humidistat Series Number
T22 T25 T26 T28

No Switches

T91
GRD10-1R Wire guard only
GRD10A-600 Wire guard and baseplate
GRD10A-601 Aluminum guard and baseplate
GRD10A-606 Plastic guard with baseplate
GRD10A-608 Plastic guard with baseplate, mounting ring
GRD10A-609 Plastic guard with baseplate, mounting ring

Repair Parts

Replacement key KEY12A-600 (set of two) is available.

Temperature Control Sensors and Accessories

G Series Thermostat and Humidistat Guards (Continued)

6-3/4 (171)

(64)

2-2/3

(68)

3-3/8 (86)

6-1/5 (157)

6-3/4 (171)

1-2/5 (36)

3-5/8

(92)

4-1/5

(106)

(127)

2-7/8 (73)

1-5/8 (41)

4-3/4 (121)

grd10a_dm.eps

7-2/3 (195)

3-2/3 (94)

6-3/8 (162)

4-3/4 (121)

3-1/3 (84)

1-5/8 (41)

4-1/5

(106)

2-2/3

(68)

5-4/5 (148)

5-1/3 (135)

4-2/3 (119)

6-5/9

(167)

1-5/8

(41)

grd10a_dm2.eps

3-1/3

(84)

G Series Dimensions, in. (mm)

Temperature Control Sensors and Accessories Code No. LIT-1922285

T22, T25, T26, T28, T46, and T91 Accessories

Description

Replacement Knob and Cover Kits

Replacement Knob Kit numbers KNB17A-600R, KNB20A-600R, and

KNB26A-600R are designed as direct replacements for original equipment knobs.

Faceplates

Faceplates are available with metal or plastic covers.

Thermostat Trim Plates

Trim plate PLT231-1R is for mounting two wall thermostats such as T22, T25, T26, T58, T91 or one thermostat and one humidistat on a three-gang electrical box. The PLT61A-600 is a similar three-gang plate but with one cutout and a 3/8 in. hole for mounting accessory switches.

These plates are finished in tawny silver to complement the design of the thermostat and humidistat.

PLT61A-600 Faceplate

Selection Charts

Replacement Knob and Cover Kits

Product Code Number Description Replacement Knob For
KNB17A-600R Includes two plastic knobs T91, T22, T25, and T26 with metal knob and metal cover
KNB20A-600R Includes one plastic knob T26 and W43 with plastic knob and metal cover
KNB26A-600R Includes one plastic knob with trim disc T26, T46, and W43 with plastic cover

Faceplates

Product Code

Number

Mounting

Position

Type of

Adjustment

Cutout for

Thermometer

Use With Temperature

Scale

Faceplates for T22, T25, T26, T80, T91, and W43 with Metal Cover
PLT213-6R Vertical Concealed No T26, T91BA, W43 with metal cover None
Faceplates for T26, W43 AND W45 with Plastic Cover
PLT333-1R Vertical Knob Yes T26, T46 Fahrenheit
PLT333-2R Horizontal Knob Yes T26 Fahrenheit
PLT333-3R Vertical Concealed Yes T26, T46 Fahrenheit
PLT333-4R Horizontal Concealed Yes T26 Fahrenheit
PLT333-5R Vertical Knob Yes T26, T46 Celsius
PLT333-12R Vertical Concealed No T26, T46, and W43 None

Trim Plates

Product Code Number Description Replacement Trim Plate For
PLT231-1R Tawny silver trim plate T22, T25, T26, T28, T58, T91, W42, W43

Temperature Control Sensors and Accessories Code No. LIT-1922280

T91 Series Room Temperature Sensor

Description

The T91 Series Temperature Sensor is a solid state thermistor sensor detects temperature changes in a room or similar space.

Series T91 Sensors may be used directly with Series M100Q Motor Actuators.

Refer to the T91 Thermistor Room Temperature Sensor Product Bulletin (LIT-125675) for important product application information.

Applications

Use for room or space temperature sensing to position sequencers or actuators for heating and/or cooling systems.

Selection Chart

Features

• highly sensitive thermistor sensing element

• fast response

• integral Fan and System switch options

• vertical or horizontal mounting

• three types of adjusters: external knob, concealed knob, or provisions for remote setpoint

• easy to install and wire

• separable mounting plate with screws saves installation time

Repair Information

If the T91 Series Room Temperature Sensor fails to operate within its specifications, replace the unit. For a replacement sensor, contact the nearest Johnson Controls® representative.

T91 Series Room Temperature Sensor

Product Code

Number1

Range

°F (°C)

Thermometer Setpoint Adjustment Switches
Fan System
T91BAA-1C 40/90 (5/32) No Remote
T91BBA-1C 40/90 (5/32) No Concealed
T91BCA-1C 40/90 (5/32) Yes Knob

1. Supplied with vertical faceplate installed.

Technical Specifications

T91 Series Room Temperature Sensor
Ambient Temperature -40 to 140°F (-40 to 60°C)
Baseplate 0.050 in. (1 mm) cold rolled steel with dichromate dip finish
Cover 0.025 in. (1 mm) cold rolled steel. Baked on tawny silver finish. Faceplate is aluminum with dark brown and light brown finish. Letters and markings are bright aluminum surface.
Electrical Rating for Switches 5 A at 24 VAC
Wiring Connections 6 in. No. 18 color coded wire leads

Standard Electromechanical Pressure Controls Code No. LIT-1927175

P10 Series Low Pressure Control

Description

The P10 Series Pressure Controls open or close electrical circuits from a change in operating air pressure. R to Y terminals make (cut-in) on pressure rise

Refer to the P10 Series Low Range Pressure Controls Product Bulletin (LIT-125400) for important product application information.

.

P10 Series

Y

R

B

B

Y

R

Action on Increase of Pressure

p10.eps

P10 Series Action Diagram

Selection Chart

Features

• visible calibrated adjustable range scale

• snap-acting switch in a dust protected enclosure

• easily accessible wiring terminals

Applications

• pneumatic systems

• control of pumps or small air compressors

Accessories

• universal mounting bracket

No. BKT16A-600 as well as a barbed fitting supplied as standard

• model P10FC-4 has a jumper installed on the common terminals

Repair Information

If the P10 Series Low Pressure Control fails to operate within its specifications, replace the unit. For a replacement control, contact the nearest Johnson Controls® representative.

P10BC-7

with Bracket No. BKT16A-600R

Product

Code Number

No. of

Stages

Contact

Action

Range

psi (kPa)

Factory Setting Pressure

Connector

psig (kPa) Switch Diff psi (kPa)
P10BC-7C 1 Single-Pole,

Double-Throw (SPDT)

3 to 20 (21 to 138) 12 (R to Y Cut-in) 2 Barbed Fitting
P10BG-3C 1 SPDT 2 to 20 (15 to 138) 12 (R to Y Cut-in) 0.2 1/8 in. Internal NPSF
P10BJ-1C 1 SPDT 3 to 20 (21 to 138) 12 (R to Y Cut-in) 2 1/8 in. Internal NPSF
P10FC-4C 2 SPDT 3 to 20 (21 to 138) (R-Y Cutout) Low Stage 8 (55) (R-Y Cut-in) High Stage 12 (82) Low Stage 2 (14) High Stage 2 (14) 1/8 in. Barbed Fitting
P10PA-11C 3 SPST 3 to 20 (21 to 138) Stage One Open High 6 (41) Stages Two & Three Open High

18 (120)

Stage One 3 (21) Stages Two & Three 0.4 (3) 1/8 in. Barbed Fitting

Technical Specifications

• model P10BJ-1 is rated for 24 A non-inductive when used as a

single-pole, single-throw (SPST) (R-Y). (See Electrical Ratings chart below.)

  • maximum allowable pressure is 150 psig (1,034 kPa)
  • maximum ambient temperature is 140°F (60°C)

Electrical Ratings (Part 1 of 2)

Motor Ratings VAC 120 208 240 277 600
AC Locked Rotor A 96.0 55.2 48.0 42
Non-Inductive

A

Double Throw 16.0 16.0 16.0 16.0 16.0
Single Throw 24.0 24.0 24.0 24.0 24.0
Pilot Duty 125 VA, 24 to 600 VAC
Motor Ratings VAC 120 208 240 277 600 P10FC-4
P10BC-7 AC Full Load A 16.0 9.2 8.0 7.0
AC Full Load A 16.0 9.2 8.0 7.0 AC Locked Rotor A 96.0 55.2 48.0 42.0
AC Locked Rotor A 96.0 55.2 48.0 42.0 Non-Inductive A 16.0 9.2 8.0 7.2
Non-Inductive A 16.0 9.2 8.0 7.2 Pilot Duty 125 VA, 24 to 277 VAC

On two- and three-stage models, maximum connected load shall not exceed 2,000 VA

Pilot Duty 125 VA, 24 to 277 VAC
P10BG-3
P10PA-11
AC Full Load A 6.0 3.4 3.0
AC Locked Rotor A 36.0 20.4 18.0 AC Full Load A 6.0 3.4 3.0
Non-Inductive A 6.0 3.4 3.0 2.6 AC Locked Rotor A 36.0 20.4 18.0
Pilot Duty 125 VA, 24 to 277 VAC Non-Inductive A 6.0 3.4 3.0
P10BJ-1 Pilot Duty 125 VA, 24 to 277 VAC

On two- and three- stage models, maximum connected load shall not exceed 2,000 VA

AC Full Load A 16.0 9.2 8.0 7

Electrical Ratings (Part 2 of 2)

Standard Electromechanical Pressure Controls Code No. LIT-1927180

P20 Series Air Conditioning/Pressure Cutout Control

Description

The P20 Series are field replacement high and low pressure controls for non-corrosive refrigerants. They include a dust-tight contact unit with quick connect connectors, and a

36 in. or 42 in. capillary with 1/4 in. sweat section. The setpoint is screwdriver adjustable.

Refer to the P20, P21 Series Air Conditioning Limit Controls Product Bulletin (LIT-125415) for important product application information.

Features

• accurate repeatability

• compact size

• trip-free manual reset

Applications

• air conditioning high/low pressure control

• refrigeration high/low pressure control

• head pressure control

Repair Information

If the P20 Series Air Conditioning/Pressure Cutout Control fails to operate within its specifications, replace the unit. For a replacement control, contact the nearest Johnson Controls® representative.

P20DB-1 Air Conditioning/ Pressure Cutout Control

SPST

Construction

SPDT

Construction

Red Red

Blue

(Open High)

Yellow (Open Low)

Yellow (Open Low)

Blue

(Open High)

Seal

White: Open Low Control Red: Open High Control

Low Range High Ranges

Control action is identified by

p20spst.eps

colored sealing compound or terminal markings on switch.

Selection Chart

Product

Code Number1

Pressure

Connections

Switch

Action

Range

psi (kPa)

Differential

psi (kPa)

Factory Setting, psig (kPa) Max. Bellows

Pressure psig (kPa)

Max.

Temp.

Opens Closes
P20BB-1C2 36 in. capillary

1/4 in. sweat tube

Open on fall 7 to 150 (48 to 1,034) Manual reset 40 (276) Lockout 250 (1,724) 140°F
P20DB-1C3 Open on rise 100 to 425 (690 to 2,930) Manual reset 400 (2,758) Lockout 450 (3,103)
P20GB-1C 42 in. capillary

1/4 in. sweat tube

Single-Pole,

Double-Throw (SPDT)

Open on rise

100 to 425 (690 to 2,930) Manual reset 360 (2,482) Lockout 450 (3,103)
P20EB-1C4 36 in. capillary

1/4 in. sweat tube

SPDT 7 to 150 (48 to 1,034) 30 (172) fixed 40 (276) 70 (448) 250 (1,724)
P20EB-18C 42 in. capillary

1/4 in. sweat tube

SPDT 7 to 150 (48 to 1,034) 22 (152) fixed 15 (103) 37 (255) 250 (1,724)
P20EB-2C5 36 in. capillary

1/4 in. sweat tube

SPDT 100 to 425 (690 to 2,930) 75 (483) fixed 400 (2,758) 324 (2,275) 450 (3,103)

1. Mounting bracket supplied on all models.

2. Replaces Ranco® G20-4412; Robertshaw® 3126-216, 3160-212

3. Replaces Ranco G23-5253; Robertshaw 3127-220, 3161-205; Honeywell® P430X-1250, 1268, 1292, 1300

4. Replaces Ranco G20-4050; Robertshaw 3126-116, 3160-012, 3160-014; Honeywell P431X-1092, 1100

5. Replaces Ranco G23-5052; Robertshaw 3127-140, 3127-414, 3161-009; Honeywell P430X, 1235, 1243, 1276, 1284

Standard Electromechanical Pressure Controls

Accessories

P20 Series Air Conditioning/Pressure Cutout Control

Product Code Number Description
210-604R Black phenolic resin spring clip snap-on insulated terminal cover

Technical Specifications

Electrical Ratings

Motor Ratings VAC 120 208 240 277
AC Full Load A 16.0 9.2 8.0 7.0
AC Locked Rotor A 96.0 55.2 48.0 42.0
SPDT 16.0 16.0 16.0
Pilot Duty 125 VA at 24 VAC, 720 VA at 120 to 277 VAC

Standard Electromechanical Pressure Controls Code No. LIT-1927190

P29 Series Low Pressure Control with Time Delay

Description

P29NC is a low pressure control with time delay and lockout, which requires manual reset. A drop in pressure energizes the time delay relay and opens a contact after the time delay, shutting down the equipment. The time delay prevents nuisance shutdowns due to momentary fluctuations in system pressures.

Refer to the P29 Series Low Pressure Cutout Control with Time Delay Relay Product Bulletin (LIT-125425) for important product application information.

Features

• direct reading scale indication

• dust-protected snap action switch

• trip-free manual reset

• replacement timing relays available

Selection Chart

Applications

• chiller low temperature

• industrial equipment, oil pressure lubrication

• low suction pressure

Technical Specifications

• pilot duty rating of 750 VA, 120/240 VAC

• external step down transformer for 440 and 550 VAC applications must be of sufficient capacity to supply 15 VA at 120 VAC or 30 VA at 240 VAC for time delay

Accessories

• universal mounting bracket (271-51)

• replacement timing relays (Refer to Replacement Timing Relays for P28 and P29 Lube Oil Controls Catalog Page [LIT-1927395].)

P29 Series Low Pressure Control

Repair Information

If the P29 Series Low Pressure Control with Time Delay fails to operate within its specifications, replace the unit. For a replacement control, contact the nearest Johnson Controls® representative.

Product Code

Number

Switch

Action

Pressure

Range

Differential

psi (kPa)

Max Overpressure

psig (kPa)

Max Working Pressure

psig (kPa)

Pressure

Connection

Time Delay

Setting

P29NC-2C Single-Pole,

Single-Throw (SPST)

20 in. Hg Vacuum

to 100 psig

(-68 to 690 kPa)

2.2 ±1.5

(15.2 ±10.3)

325

(2,241)

250

(1,723)

1/4 in. external

flare fitting

60 seconds

(factory set)

P29NC-3C 36 in. copper

capillary tube

with 1/4 in. flare nut

P29NC-49C 120 seconds
P29NC-53C 90 seconds
P29NF-1C1 120 seconds

1. With alarm contacts

Example: Setpoint at 10 psig. On a rise in pressure, the timing circuit opens at 10 psig and time out ends. On a fall in pressure, the timing circuit energizes at 6 to 9 psig and the time out begins. If the pressure fails to reach 10 psig within the 60 second time delay, the main contacts open, shutting down the controlled equipment.

Standard Electromechanical Pressure Controls Code No. LIT-1927205

P47 Series Steam Pressure Limit Control

Description

The P47 Controls are available with single-pole, single-throw (SPST), double-pole, single-throw (DPST), or

four-wire, two-circuit contacts for line voltage or low voltage. The pressure connector is 1/4 in. external NPT (0 to 15 psi only) or

1/4 in. internal NPT (for all other ranges).

Refer to the P47 Series Steam Pressure Controls Product Bulletin (LIT-125450) for important product application information.

Features

• long-life contact structure with high contact force

• easy-to-adjust single sight set scales show both cut-in and cut-out settings

Selection Chart

Product

Code Number

Switch Action Range

psi (kPa)

Diff psi (kPa) Max.

Over-pressure psig (kPa)

Min. Max.
Contacts Open On Rise – Automatic Reset
P47AA-1C SPST 0 to 15 (0 to 103) 2 (14) 8 (55) 50 (345)
P47AA-4C 20 in. Hg to 50 (-68 to 345) 5 (34) 35 (241) 180 (1,241)
P47AA-13C 0 to 150 (0 to 1,034) 12 (83) 50 (345) 325 (2,241)
Contacts Close On Rise – Automatic Reset
P47BA-1C SPST 0 to 15 (0 to 103) 2 (14) 8 (55) 50 (345)
P47BA-6C 0 to 150 (0 to 1,034) 12 (83) 50 (345) 325 (2,241)
Four-Wire, Two Circuit1 – Automatic Reset
P47GA-9C1 Main open high;

Auxiliary open low

0 to 150 (0 to 1,034) 12 (83) 50 (345) 325 (2,241)
P47AB-3C SPST 50 to 240 (345 to 1,655) Manual reset 300 (2,069)
P47EA-1C SPDT 50 to 240 (345 to 1,655) 10 (69) Fixed 300 (2,069)

Applications

P47 steam pressure controls are designed for high limit or operating control applications. A typical use is as a limit control on steam heating systems. Models that close on a pressure increase are used on steam unit heaters to avoid blower operation when steam pressure is below the point required for adequate heating. The P47 can be used with steam, water, air, or noncombustible gases that do not harm iron or copper.

Accessories

The Part No. TBG16A-600 Siphon is supplied with all controls except models with

0 to 15 psi range.

P47AA-1 Steam Pressure Limit Control

Repair Information

If the P47 Series Steam Pressure Limit Control fails to operate within its specifications, replace the unit. For a replacement control, contact the nearest Johnson Controls® representative.

1. The main contacts (Line-M2) open on rise, as the auxiliary contacts (Line-M1) close.

P47AA

Opens on Pressure Rise

P47BA

Closes on Pressure Rise

Technical Specifications

Electrical Ratings for P47AA, P47AB, and P47BA

Motor Ratings VAC 120 208 240 277
AC Full Load A 16.0 9.2 8.0
AC Locked Rotor A 96.0 55.2 48.0
AC Non-Inductive A 16.0 16.0 16.0 16.0
Pilot Duty 125 VA, 120 to 600 VAC; 57.5 VA, 120 to 300 VDC

Electrical Ratings for P47EA

p47ga_1.eps

Motor Ratings VAC 120 208 240 277
AC Full Load A 16.0 9.2 8.0
AC Locked Rotor A 96.0 55.2 48.0
AC Non-Inductive A 16.0 10.0 10.0 10.0
Pilot Duty 125 VA, 120 to 227 VAC

Electrical Ratings for P47GA

p47ga_2.eps

Pole Number Line-M2 (Main) Line-M1 (Auxiliary)
Motor Ratings VAC 120 208 240 277 120 208 240 277
AC Full Load A 16.0 9.2 8.0 6.0 3.3 3.0
AC Locked Rotor A 96.0 55.2 48.0 36.0 19.8 18.0
AC Non-Inductive A 16.0 9.2 8.0 7.2 6.0 6.0 6.0 6.0
Pilot Duty: Both Poles 125 VA, 120 to 600 VAC; 57.5 VA, 120 to 300 VDC

SPST

P4 7 G A

Four-Wire, Two-Circuit Action on Pressure Rise

Standard Electromechanical Pressure Controls Code No. LIT-1927215

P67 Series Low Pressure Control

Description

P67 pressure controls are used to close or open an electrical circuit, based on a predetermined air pressure signal. The operating point of the control and the differential, are easy to adjust with the externally located adjustment screws on the top of the control enclosure. The pressure controls incorporate a non-metallic diaphragm that is positioned by air pressure changes. The diaphragm, in turn, actuates a heavy-duty electrical contact block using a lever mechanism.

Refer to the P67 Series Low Range Pressure Control Product Bulletin (LIT-121445) for important product application information.

Selection Chart

Features

• long-life contact structure, high contact force

• easy-to-adjust settings: single sight-set scales show both cut-in and cut-out settings

Applications

Typical applications include the control of air compressors, fans, pilot lights, resistance heating elements, and other devices.

P67 Series Low Pressure Control with 271-350 Mounting Bracket

Repair Information

Product

Code Number

Control

Action

Scale

Range psi1 (kPa)

Temp.

Range

Diff.

psi (kPa)

Maximum

Over- pressure psig (kPa)

Connector
P67AA-1C Double-Pole, Single-Throw

(DPST) opens on pressure drop

3 to 30

(21 to

207)

32 to

140°F

0 to 60°C

1-1/2-20

(10 to 138)

Adjustable

50 (345) Angle

Barbed Fitting

P67CA-1C DPST opens on pressure rise
P67EA-5C L-M2 contacts connect on

pressure rise and simultaneously the L-M1 contacts break

1/8 in.

External NPT

If the P67 Series Low Pressure Control fails to operate within its specifications, replace the unit. For a replacement control, contact the nearest Johnson Controls® representative.

1. Range is minimum cut-out to maximum cut-in on Open Low controls. It is minimum cut-in to maximum cut-out on Open High controls.

Technical Specifications

Electrical Ratings for P67AA and P67CA

Electrical Ratings for P67EA and P67FA

Pole Number LINE-M2 (Main) LINE-M1 (Auxiliary)
Motor Rating VAC 120 208 240 277 120 208 240 277
AC Full Load A 16.0 9.2 8.0 6.0 3.3 3.0
AC Locked Rotor A 96.0 55.2 48.0 36.0 19.8 18.0
AC Non-Inductive A 16.0 9.2 8.0 7.2 6.0 6.0 6.0 6.0
Pilot Duty 125 VA, 120 to 600 VAC; 57.5 VA, 120 to 300 VDC
Motor Ratings VAC 1 Phase 2 – 3 Phase
120 208 240 277 208 240
AC Full Load A 12.0 12.0 12.0 12.0 12.0
AC Locked Rotor A 72.0 72.0 72.0 72.0 72.0
AC Non-Inductive A 12.0 12.0 12.0 12.0
DC Non-Inductive A 3.0 0.5 0.5
Pilot Duty 125 VA, 120 to 600 VAC; 57.5 VA, 120 to 300 VDC

P67 Wiring Diagram (no alarm) P67 Dimensions, in. (mm)

Line

Line

M2

Line

M1

Line

Load

Action on

Pressure Increase

Standard Electromechanical Pressure Controls Code No. LIT-1927220

P70, P72 Approximate Low Pressure Settings for Typical Applications

Vacuum – in. Hg Approximate Temperature

°F

Pressure – psig1
Application Refrigerant
R-12 R-22 R-502 R-717 R-134A
Cut-Out Cut-In Cut-Out Cut-In Cut-Out Cut-In Cut-Out Cut-In Cut-Out Cut-In Cut-Out Cut-In
Ice Cube Maker – Dry Type Coil -11 14 4 17 16 37 22 45 2 15
Sweet Water Bath – Soda Fountain 20 31 21 29 43 56 52 66 33 45 18 26
Beer, Water, Milk Cooler, Wet Type 17 31 19 29 40 56 48 66 16 26
Ice Cream Trucks, Hardening Rooms -16 10 2 15 13 34 18 41 5 24 0 13
Eutectic Plates, Ice Cream Truck -21 -11 1 4 11 16 16 22 4 8 1 2
Walk In, Defrost Cycle 9 37 14 34 32 64 40 75 23 55 12 32
Reach In, Defrost Cycle 20 39 19 36 40 68 48 78 30 57 16 36
Vegetable Display, Defrost Cycle 7 38 13 35 30 66 38 77 10 34
Vegetable Display Case – Open Type 12 45 16 42 35 77 44 89 14 40
Beverage Cooler, Blower Dry Type 11 37 15 34 34 64 42 75 24 55 12 32
Retail Florist – Blower Coil 29 45 28 42 55 77 65 89 44 67 26 40
Meat Display Case – Defrost Cycle 19 38 17 35 37 66 45 77 15 34
Meat Display Case – Open Type 4 28 11 27 27 53 35 63 8 25
Dairy Case – Open Type 2 38 10 35 26 66 33 77 16 34
Frozen Food – Open Type -32 -9 7 5 4 17 8 24 10 3

1. Conversion factor: 1 psig = 6.9 kPa

Note: These settings represent approximate starting values. Actual values may vary widely, depending on application-specific guidelines.

Standard Electromechanical Pressure Controls Code No. LIT-1900170

P70, P72, and P170 Series Controls for Low Pressure Applications

Description

The P70, P72, and P170 Controls for low pressure applications are designed primarily for low pressure cut-out control, pump-down control, and capacity control on commercial refrigeration and air conditioning applications.

These controls are available in several pressure ranges and are compatible with most common refrigerants. They may also be used on other non-corrosive fluid applications. Ammonia-compatible models are also available.

Controls also are available in several different electrical ratings and switch configurations. The P72 models provide direct control of 208 to 240 volt single-phase motors up to

3 horsepower, and 208 to 220 volt

three-phase motors up to 5 horsepower.

Refer to the P70, P72, and P170 Series Controls for Low Pressure Applications Product Bulletin (Part No. 24-7664-2608) for important product application information.

Features

• all-steel case and cover built to provide long lasting, rugged protection for internal components

• sight-set calibrated pressure adjustment displays a visible pressure scale, fully adjustable through the range without removing the cover (on NEMA 1 enclosure models)

• MICRO-SET™ differential option allows for precise control on critical low pressure applications

• manual reset lockout option provides

trip-free low pressure lockout that cannot be overridden or reset until pressure returns to specified level

• limited knob adjustment option restricts control adjustment ranges and deters tampering and over-adjustment

Applications

NEMA 1 enclosures are standard on most models.

P70A and P170A models with single-pole, single-throw (SPST)

Open Low switch action are the most popular models, and are typically used for low pressure cut-out and pump-down control.

P70 and P170 models are also available with SPST Open High switch action, and are typically used for capacity control. Models with single-pole, double-throw (SPDT) or four-wire, two-circuit switch action allow users to install alarm devices or other control circuits.

P72 models have a double-pole, single-throw (DPST) switch with

load-carrying contacts that can provide direct control of 208 to 240 V single-phase motors up to 3 horsepower, and 208 to 220 V 3-phase motors up to 5 horsepower. See the DPST Electrical Ratings (P72A, B, C, and D Models) that follow.

P70AB-12 MICRO-SET

Low Pressure Control

Repair Information

If the P70, P72, and P170 Series Controls for Low Pressure Applications fail to operate within their specifications, replace the units. For a replacement control, contact the nearest Johnson Controls® representative.

Standard Electromechanical Pressure Controls

P70, P72, and P170 Series Controls for Low Pressure Applications (Continued)

Selection Chart for Standard P70, P72, and P170 Controls for Low Pressure Applications

Product

Code Number

Switch

Action

Range

psi (kPa)

Differential

psi (kPa)

Pressure

Connection

Max.

Overpressure

Max. Working

Pressure

Limited Knob

Adjustment

MICRO-SET Controls (For Non-Corrosive Refrigerants)
P70AB-12C SPST open low 12 in. Hg to 80

(-41 to 551)

Minimum 5 (34)

Maximum 35 (241)

36 in. capillary with 1/4 in. flare nut 525 psig

(3,617 kPa)

80 psig

(551 kPa)

Supplied,

but not assembled

P170AB-12C 1/4 in. external flare connector
P70EA-14C SPDT

1 to 3 open low

1 to 2 close low

36 in. capillary with 1/4 in. flare nut None
P170EA-14C 1/4 in. external flare connector
All-Range Controls (For Non-Corrosive Refrigerants)
P70AB-1C SPST open low 20 in. Hg

to 100

(-68 to 690)

Minimum 7 (48)

Maximum 50 (345)

1/4 in. external flare connector 325 psig

(2,239 kPa)

100 psig

(690 kPa)

Supplied,

but not assembled

P70AB-2C 36 in. capillary with 1/4 in. flare nut
P70BA-1C Manual reset

lockout

None
P70BA-10C 1/4 in. external flare connector
P70EA-10C SPDT

1 to 3 open low

1 to 2 close low

5 (34)

fixed

P72AA-1C DPST open low Minimum 7 (48)

Maximum 50 (345)

36 in. capillary with 1/4 in. flare nut
P72AB-1C Mounted on

differential screw

P170AB-2C SPST open low 1/4 in. external flare connector
P70CA-1C SPST open high 36 in. capillary with 1/4 in. flare nut None
P170CA-1C 1/4 in. external flare connector
All-Range Controls (Ammonia-Compatible)
P70AA-5C SPST open low 20 in. Hg to

100

(-68 to 690)

Minimum 7 (48)

Maximum 50 (345)

1/4 in. SS Internal NPT 325 psig

(2,239 kPa)

100 psig

(690 kPa)

None
P70CA-4C SPST open high
P70GA-11C Four-wire,

Two-circuit

Line M1 close low Line M2 open low

P70HA-3C Manual reset

lockout

Note: To order models not listed in the selection chart, please contact Johnson Controls/PENN® Refrigeration Application Engineering at 1-800-275-5676.

Technical Specifications

Single Pressure Controls Switch Action, Low Event, High Event, and Models

Switch and Action Low Event High Event Models
SPST Open Low Cut-Out

(Opens Line to M1)

Cut-In

(Closes Line to M1)

P70A, P70B, P170A
SPST Open High Cut-In

(Closes Line to M1)

Cut-Out

(Opens Line to M1)

P70C, P70D, P170C, P170D
SPDT Opens 1 to 2 and

closes 1 to 3

Closes 1 to 2 and

Opens 1 to 3

P70E, P70F
Four-Wire, Two-Circuits, 1 N.O., 1

N.C. Open Low

Cut-Out

(Opens M2 to Line and Closes M1 to Line)

Cut-In

(Closes M2 to Line and Opens M1 to Line)

P70G, P70H
Four-Wire, Two-Circuits, 1 N.O., 1

N.C. Open High

Cut-In

(Closes M2 to Line and Opens M1 to Line)

Cut-Out

(Opens M2 to Line and Closes M1 to Line)

P70J, P70K, P170K
DPST Open Low Cut-Out

(Opens M1 to Line and M2 to Line)

Cut-In

(Closes M1 to Line and M2 to Line)

P72A, P72B
DPST Open High Cut-In

(Closes M1 to Line and M2 to Line)

Cut-Out

(Opens M1 to Line and M2 to Line)

P72C, P72D

Standard Electromechanical Pressure Controls

P70, P72, and P170 Series Controls for Low Pressure Applications (Continued)

L1 L2

Load

M1

Line

Open-Low switch action: opens on pressure drop.

(A and B Models) L1

Alarm

Load

2

1

3

L2

L1 L2

Load

M1

p7s_wir_spst.eps

p7s_wir_spdt.eps

Line

Open-High switch action: opens on pressure rise. (C and D Models)

1 to 3 opens, and 1 to 2 closes on pressure rise.

Typical Wiring for SPST Open Low Switch and Open High Switch (P70A, B, C, D, and P170A, C, D, Models)

Typical Wiring for SPDT Switch (P70E, F Models)

L1 L2

L3*

M2

Line

M1

Load

Line

Typical Wiring for Four-Wire Two-Circuit Switch (P70G and H Models)

eps 2.

4-

r

s_wi p7

L1

L2

Alarm

Alarm

Circuit Power

M1

Line

Load

Line

M2

Main circuit (Line to M2) opens and

auxiliary circuit (Line to M1) closes on pressure rise.

Line to M1 and Line to M2 open on pressure drop.

*(L3 is third supply line in three-phase applications.)

p7s_wir_dpst.eps

Typical Wiring for DPST Switch (P72A and B Models)

Standard Electromechanical Pressure Controls

P70, P72, and P170 Series Controls for Low Pressure Applications (Continued)

Technical Specifications (Continued)

SPST Electrical Ratings

(P70A, B, C, and D, and P170A, C, and D Models)

2-15/16

(74)

Two Mounting Holes 10-32 UNF-2B Thread

3-1/4

(83)

5/16

(9)

Single-Phase Ratings
Standard Hermetic

Compressor

120

VAC

208

VAC

240

VAC

208/240

VAC

Motor Horsepower 2 3 3
Motor Full-Load A 24 18.7 17 20
Motor Locked-Rotor A 144 112.2 102 120
Non-Inductive A 22 22 22
Pilot Duty 125 VA, 120 to 600 VA; 57.5 VA,

120 to 300 VDC

5/16

(8)

3-1/4 (83)

1-11/16 (43)

5/16 (8)

1

(25)

1-1/8

(29)

1-7/8

13/16 (20)

1-3/4

(44)

Capillary or Connector as Specified

(48)

3/8

X 3/16 (5)

15/16

(24)

3/16 Diameter (5)

1-5/16 (34)

3-1/16

3/16 (5)

1-1/4 (32)

3/16 Diameter

(5) Mounting Hole

Standard Single-Phase Ratings
120

VAC

208

VAC

240

VAC

277

VAC1

Motor Full Load A 16.0 9.2 8.0 7.0
Motor Locked Rotor A 96.0 55.2 48.0 42.0
Non-Inductive A 16.0 9.2 8.0
Pilot Duty 125 VA at

120 to 600 VAC

125 VA at

24 to 600 VAC

Diameter

SPDT Electrical Ratings 1hp Switch (P70E Models)

1/16

(77)

4

7/8 or 1-1/8

(1/2 in. or 3/4 in. Trade Size)

(22) (28)

Conduit Hole

Dimensions for Low Pressure Controls with NEMA 1 Enclosure, in. (mm)*

p70_low_NEMA1_dims.eps

1. Rating for P70EC models only

SPDT Electrical Ratings 1/4 hp Switch (P70F Models)

5/8 (16)

79)

Standard Single-Phase Ratings
120 VAC 208 VAC 240 VAC
Motor Full Load A 6.0 3.3 3.0
Motor Locked Rotor A 36.0 19.8 18.0
Non-Inductive A 6.0 6.0 6.0
Pilot Duty 125 VA at 24 to 240 VAC

4-1/16

(103) (

5/8 (16)

4-1/16

1/2

Four-Wire, Two-Circuit Electrical Ratings

7/16 (11)

(103)

2-11/16

3/8 (10)

3/4-NPSM

Threaded

Standard Single-Phase Ratings
Line-M2

(Main Contacts)

Line-M1

(Auxiliary Contacts)

120

VAC

208

VAC

240

VAC

277

VAC

120

VAC

208

VAC

240

VAC

277

VAC

Motor Full Load A 16.0 9.2 8.0 6.0 3.3 3.0
Motor Locked Rotor A 96.0 55.2 48.0 36.0 19.8 18.0
Non-Inductive A 16.0 9.2 8.0 7.2 6.0 6.0 6.0 6.0
Pilot Duty

for both sets of contacts

125 VA at 24 to 600 VAC; 57.5 VA at 120 to 300 VDC

(13)

(70)

2-15/16 3/16

(P70G, H, J, and K, and P170K Models)

1-1/4 (32)

(68)

(25)

1-9/16

Rigid Conduit

Connector

Four Mounting Holes

(74)

5/16 (8)

Diameter

(5)

1-3/4 (44)

1/2 (13)

p70_low_NEMA3R_dims.eps

Dimensions for Low Pressure Controls with NEMA 3R Enclosure, in. (mm)*

* These dimensions are nominal and are subject to accepted manufacturing tolerances and application variables.

DPST Electrical Ratings (P72A, B, C, and D Models)

Standard Ratings Hermetic Compressor Ratings
120 VAC,

Single-Phase

208 VAC,

Single-Phase

240 VAC,

Single-Phase

208 VAC,

Three-Phase

220 VAC,

Three-Phase

208 VAC,

Single-Phase

240 VAC,

Single-Phase

Motor Horsepower 2 3 3 5 5
Motor Full-Load A 24 18.7 17 15.9 15 24 24
Motor Locked-Rotor A 144 112.2 102 95.4 90 144 144
AC Non-Inductive A 24 24 24 24 24
DC Non-Inductive A 3 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5
Pilot Duty 125 VA at 120 to 600 VAC; 57.5 VA at 120 to 300 VDC

Standard Electromechanical Pressure Controls Code No. LIT-1900171

P70, P72, and P170 Series Controls for High Pressure Applications

Description

The P70, P72, and P170 Controls for high pressure applications are designed primarily for high pressure cut-out control,

head-pressure control, and condenser fan cycling control on commercial refrigeration and air conditioning applications.

Controls are available in several pressure ranges and are compatible with most common refrigerants. They may also be used on other non-corrosive fluid applications. Ammonia compatible models are also available.

Several different electrical ratings and switch configurations are available. The P72 models provide direct control of 208-240 volt

single-phase motors up to 3 horsepower, and 208-220 volt 3-phase motors up to

5 horsepower.

Refer to the P70, P72, and P170 Series Controls for High Pressure Applications Product/Technical Bulletin (LIT-125454) for important product application information.

Features

• all-steel case and cover provides long lasting, rugged protection for internal components

• sight-set calibrated pressure adjustment displays a visible pressure scale, fully adjustable through the range without removing the cover (on NEMA 1 enclosure models)

Selection Chart (Part 1 of 2)

• manual reset lockout option provides

trip-free lockout that cannot be overridden or reset until pressure returns to specified level

• variety of available pressure connection styles allows greater flexibility when mounting control and adapting pressure connections to field application requirements

Applications

P70C, P70D P170C and P170D models with single-pole, single-throw (SPST) Open High switch action are the most popular models, and are typically used for high-pressure cutout. The C models are automatic reset. The D models have a manual reset lockout mechanism. Some P70C, P70D P170C and P170D models are UL Listed as refrigeration pressure limiting controls.

P70A and P170A models are available with SPST Open Low switch action, and typically are used for condenser fan cycling control.

P70 and P170 models with single-pole, double-throw (SPDT), or four-wire,

two-circuit switch action allow users to install alarm devices or other control circuits.

P70CA-3 High Pressure Cutout Control

P72 models have a double-pole, single-throw (DPST) switch with

load-carrying contacts that can provide direct control of 208-240 V single-phase motors up to 3 horsepower, and 208-220 V 3-phase motors up to 5 horsepower. See the DPST Electrical Ratings (P72A, B, C, and D Models) that follow.

NEMA 1 enclosures are standard on most models.

Repair Information

If the P70, P72, and P170 Series Controls for High Pressure Applications fail to operate within their specifications, replace the units. For a replacement control, contact the nearest Johnson Controls® representative.

Product Code

Number

Switch

Action

Range

psi (kPa)

Differential

psi (kPa)

Pressure

Connection

Max. Working

Pressure

Condenser Fan Cycling Controls (for Non-Corrosive Refrigerants)
P70AA-118C SPST Open Low 100 to 400

(690 to 2,758)

Minimum 35 (241) Maximum 200 (1,379) 36 in. Capillary

with 1/4 in. Flare Nut

475 psig

(3,275 kPa)

P72AA-27C DPST Open Low
P170AA-118C SPST Open Low 1/4 in. External Flare Connector
All Range Controls (for Non-Corrosive Refrigerants)
P70CA-2C1 SPST Open High 50 to 500

(345 to 3,448)

Minimum 60 (414); Maximum 150 (1,034) 1/4 in. External Flare Connector 525 psig

(3,620 kPa)

P70CA-3C1 36 in. Capillary

with 1/4 in. Flare Nut

P70DA-1C1 Manual Reset Lockout
P70KA-1C Four-wire, Two-circuit

Line-M1 Close High Line-M2 Open High

P72CA-2C1 DPST Open-high Minimum 60 (414); Maximum 150 (1,034)
P72DA-1C1 Manual Reset Lockout
P170CA-3C1 SPST Open High Minimum 60 (414); Maximum 150 (1,034) 1/4 in. External Flare Connector
P170DA-1C Manual Reset Lockout
P170KA-1C Four-wire, Two-circuit

Line-M1 Close High Line-M2 Open High

Standard Electromechanical Pressure Controls

P70, P72, and P170 Series Controls for High Pressure Applications (Continued)

Selection Chart (Part 2 of 2)

Product Code

Number

Switch

Action

Range

psi (kPa)

Differential

psi (kPa)

Pressure

Connection

Max. Working

Pressure

Models for High Pressure Non-Corrosive Refrigerants2
P70AA-2C SPST Open Low 0 to 150 (0 to 1,034) Minimum 10 (69); Maximum 70 (483) 36 in. Cap. with 1/4 in. Flare Nut 325 psig

(2,241 kPa)

P170AA-2C 1/4 in. External Flare Connector
P70AA-400C 100 to 470

(689 to 3,241)

Minimum 35 (241); Maximum 200 (1,379) 36 in. Cap. with 1/4 in. Flare Nut 690 psig

(4,757 kPa)

P170AA-400C 1/4 in. External Flare Connector
P70CA-400C1 SPST Open High 200 to 610

(1,379 to 4,206)

Minimum 60 (414); Maximum 150 (1,034) 36 in. Cap. with 1/4 in. Flare Nut
P170CA-400C1 1/4 in. External Flare Connector
P70DA-400C1 Manual Reset Lockout 36 in. Cap. with 1/4 in. Flare Nut
P170DA-400C1 1/4 in. External Flare Connector
Ammonia Compatible Models
P70AA-119C SPST Open Low 50 to 300 (345 to 2,068) Minimum 20 (138); Maximum 120 (827) 1/4 in. SS Internal NPT 400 psig

(2,758 kPa)

P70CA-5C1 SPST Open-High 50 to 500

(345 to 3,448)

Minimum 60 (414); Maximum 150 (1,034) 525 psig

(3,620 kPa)

P70DA-2C1 Manual Reset Lockout
P70KA-7C Four-wire, Two-circuit

Line-M1 Close-high Line-M2 Open High

  1. UL Listed as refrigeration pressure limiting controls
  2. Compatible with R410A refrigerant.

Note: To order models not listed in the selection chart, please contact

Johnson Controls/PENN Refrigeration Application Engineering at 1-800-275-5676.

Technical Specifications

Single Pressure Controls Switch Action, Low Event, High Event, and Models

Switch and Action Low Event High Event Models
SPST Open Low Cut-Out (Opens Line to M1) Cut-In (Closes Line to M1) P70A, P70B, P170A
SPST Open High Cut-In (Closes Line to M1) Cut-Out (Opens Line to M1) P70C, P70D, P170C, P170D
SPDT Opens 1 to 2 and closes 1 to 3 Closes 1 to 2 and Opens 1 to 3 P70E, P70F
Four-wire, Two-circuits, 1 N.O., 1 N.C. Open Low Cut-Out

(Opens M2 to Line and Closes M1 to Line)

Cut-In

(Closes M2 to Line and Opens M1 to Line)

P70G, P70H
Four-wire, Two-circuits,

1 N.O., 1 N.C. Open High

Cut-In

(Closes M2 to Line and Opens M1 to Line)

Cut-Out

(Opens M2 to Line and Closes M1 to Line)

P70J, P70K, P170K
DPST Open Low Cut-Out (Opens M1 to Line and M2 to Line) Cut-In (Closes M1 to Line and M2 to Line) P72A, P72B
DPST Open High Cut-In (Closes M1 to Line and M2 to Line) Cut-Out (Opens M1 to Line and M2 to Line) P72C, P72D

Standard Electromechanical Pressure Controls

P70, P72, and P170 Series Controls for High Pressure Applications (Continued)

L1 L1

Alarm

Load

2

1

3

L2 L2

Load

Line

M1

Open-Low switch action: opens on pressure drop. (A and B Models)

p7s_wir_spdt.eps

L1 L2

Load

1 to 3 opens, and 1 to 2 closes on pressure rise.

Typical Wiring for SPDT Switch (P70E, F Models)

M1

p7s_wir_spst.eps

Line

Open-High switch action: opens on pressure rise. (C and D Models)

L1 L2

*L3

Line

M2

Load

Line

M1

Typical Wiring for SPST

(P70A, B, C, D, and P170A, C, D, Models)

L1 L2

Alarm

Alarm

Circuit Power

M1

Line

Load

Line

M2

p7s_wir_dpst.eps

Line to M1, and Line to M2 open on pressure rise.

*(L3 is third supply line in 3-phase applications.)

Typical Wiring for DPST Switch (P72C, and D Models)

Main circuit (Line to M2) opens and auxiliary circuit (Line to M1) closes on pressure rise.

p7s_wir-4-2.eps

Typical Wiring for Four-Wire Two-Circuit Switch used for a High Pressure Cutout Application with an Alarm Circuit (P70J, K, and P170K Models)

Standard Electromechanical Pressure Controls

P70, P72, and P170 Series Controls for High Pressure Applications (Continued)

Technical Specifications (Continued)

2-15/16

Two Mounting Holes 10-32 UNF-2B Thread

3-1/4

(83)

5/16

(8)

5/16

(8)

3-1/4 (83)

1-11/16 (43)

5/16

1

(25)

1-1/16 (29)

15/16 (24)

15/16 (24)

Capillary or Connector as speci?ed

3/16 (5)

3/8 X 3/16

3/16 Diameter

(5)

(48)

(10) (5)

Mounting Hole

Diameter Mounting Hole

3/16 Diameter

(5)

2-1/16

(53) 15/16

(24)

1-5/16

1-1/4 (33)

1/16 (2)

(34) 3-1/16

(77) 4

101

(22) (28)

7/8 or 1-1/8 (1/2 in. or 3/4 in. Trade Size)

1-7/8

Dimensions for High Pressure Controls with NEMA 1 Enclosure, in. (mm)*

p7shi_dim1.eps

SPST Electrical Ratings

(P70A, B, C, and D, and P170A, C, and D Models)

Single-Phase Ratings
Standard Hermetic

Compressor

120

VAC

208

VAC

240

VAC

208/240

VAC

Motor Horsepower 2 3 3
Motor Full-Load A 24 18.7 17 24
Motor Locked-Rotor A 144 112.2 102 144
Non-Inductive A 22 22 22
Pilot Duty 125 VA at 120 to 600 VAC; 57.5 VA at

120 to 300 VDC

SPDT Electrical Ratings 1hp Switch (P70E Models)

Standard Single-Phase Ratings
120

VAC

208

VAC

240

VAC

277

VAC1

Motor Full Load A 16.0 9.2 8.0 7.0
Motor Locked Rotor A 96.0 55.2 48.0 42.0
Non-Inductive A 16.0 9.2 8.0
Pilot Duty 125 VA at

120 to 600 VAC

125 VA at

24 to 600 VAC

1. Rating for P70EC models only

Dimensions for High Pressure Controls with NEMA 3R Enclosure, in. (mm)*

5/8 (16)

4-1/16 (104)

3-1/8 (79)

5/8

5/8 (15)

4-1/16 (104)2-11/16

(68) 1

(25)

3/8 (10)

1/2 (12)

3/4-NPSM

Threaded Rigid Conduit

2-3/4

(70)

2-15/16

(74)

3/16 (5)

Connector

Four Mounting Holes

5/16 Diameter

(8)

1-1/4 (31)

1-9/16 (40)

15/16 (24)

1/2 (13)

(16)

p7shi_dim3.eps

* These dimensions are nominal and are subject to accepted manufacturing tolerances and application variables.

SPDT Electrical Ratings1/4 hp Switch (P70F Models)

Standard Single-Phase Ratings
120 VAC 208 VAC 240 VAC
Motor Full Load A 6.0 3.3 3.0
Motor Locked Rotor A 36.0 19.8 18.0
Non-Inductive A 6.0 6.0 6.0
Pilot Duty 125 VA at 24 to 240 VAC

Four-wire, Two-circuit Electrical Ratings (P70G, H, J, and K, and P170K Models)

Standard Single-Phase Ratings
Line-M2

(Main Contacts)

Line-M1

(Auxiliary Contacts)

120

VAC

208

VAC

240

VAC

277

VAC

120

VAC

208

VAC

240

VAC

277

VAC

Motor Full Load A 16.0 9.2 8.0 6.0 3.3 3.0
Motor Locked Rotor A 96.0 55.2 48.0 36.0 19.8 18.0
Non-Inductive A 16.0 9.2 8.0 7.2 6.0 6.0 6.0 6.0
Pilot Duty for both

sets of contacts

125 VA at 24 to 600 VAC; 57.5 VA at 120 to 300 VDC

DPST Electrical Ratings (P72A, B, C, and D Models)

Standard Ratings Hermetic Compressor Ratings
120 VAC,

Single-Phase

208 VAC,

Single-Phase

240 VAC,

Single-Phase

208 VAC,

Three-Phase

220 VAC,

Three-Phase

208 VAC,

Single-Phase

240 VAC,

Single-Phase

Motor Horsepower 2 3 3 5 5
Motor Full-Load A 24 18.7 17 15.9 15 24 24
Motor Locked-Rotor A 144 112.2 102 95.4 90 144 144
AC Non-Inductive A 24 24 24 24 24
DC Non-Inductive A 3 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5
Pilot Duty 125 VA at 120 to 600 VAC; 57.5 VA at 120 to 300 VDC

Standard Electromechanical Pressure Controls Code No. LIT-1900172

P70, P72, and P170 Series Controls for Dual Pressure Applications

Description

The P70, P72, and P170 Controls for Dual Pressure Applications are designed primarily for use as combination high and low pressure controls on commercial refrigeration and air conditioning applications.

These controls are available in several pressure ranges and are compatible with most common refrigerants. Ammonia compatible models are also available.

These controls respond directly to system pressure changes on both high and low sides, and can provide single-device control of the compressor.

Controls are available in several different electrical ratings and switch configurations, including independent high and low pressure switches (on P70S and P170S models). The P72 models provide direct control of

208 to 240 volt, single-phase motors up to three horsepower, and 208 to 220 volt, three-phase motors up to five horsepower.

Refer to the P70, P72, and P170 Series Controls for Dual Pressure Applications Product Bulletin (LIT-125455) for important product application information.

Features

• all-steel case and cover built to provide long lasting, rugged protection for internal components

• sight-set calibrated pressure adjustment displays a visible pressure scale, fully adjustable through the range without removing the cover (on NEMA 1 enclosure models)

Selection Chart (Part 1 of 2)

• MICRO-SET™ differential option allows for precise control on low pressure applications

• independent high and low pressure switches (P70S and P170S Models) satisfies a variety of dual pressure application wiring requirements with a single versatile control

• convertible high pressure reset–auto reset or manual reset lockout (P70S and P170S Models) reduces inventory—one control can be adapted to several dual pressure applications in the field

Applications

P70S and P170S models have independently operated high and low pressure single-pole, double-throw (SPDT) switches that can be wired to satisfy a variety of control requirements. These adaptable controls also come with a high pressure manual reset lockout mechanism that may be converted to automatic reset.

P70L, M, N, and P170L, M, N models have a single-pole, single-throw (SPST) switch. Models are available with automatic or manual reset lockout options. Models with manual reset are available with either high-side-only manual reset, or low-side and high-side manual reset. Ammonia-compatible models are also available (P70L and P70M only).

P72 models have a double-pole, single-throw (DPST) switch with

load-carrying contacts that can provide direct control of 208 to 240 VAC,

single-phase motors up to 3 hp, and 208 to 220 VAC, three-phase motors up to 5 hp. See the DPST Electrical Ratings (P72L, M, and N Types) that follow.

P70MA-1 Dual Pressure Control

Some models are available with Limited Knob Adjustment, which restricts adjustment of the pressure settings and deters

over-adjustment or tampering.

NEMA 1 enclosures are standard on most models. NEMA 3R enclosures are also available.

Repair Information

If the P70, P72, and P170 Series Controls for Dual Pressure Applications fail to operate within its specifications, replace the unit. For a replacement control, contact the nearest Johnson Controls® representative.

Product Code

Number

Switch

Action

Low Pressure Side psi (kPa) High Pressure Side psi (kPa) Pressure

Connector

Limited Knob

Adjustment

Range Differential Range Differential (Non-Adjustable)
MICRO-SET Controls for Non-Corrosive Refrigerants
P70LB-6C1 SPST 12 in.Hg

to 80

(-41 to 552)

Minimum 5 (34)

Maximum 35 (241)

100 to 500

(690 to 3,447)

Fixed approx. 65 (448) 36 in.

capillary with 1/4 in. flare nut

Low cut-out
P70MA-1C1 Lockout requires manual reset None
P70SA-1C1 Two independent

SPDT

Fixed at 65 (448) or

Lockout requires manual reset

P170LB-6C1 SPST Fixed approx. 65 (448) 1/4 in.

external flare connector

Low cut-out
P170MA-18C1 Lockout requires manual reset None
P170SA-1C1 Two independent

SPDT

Fixed at 65 (448) or

Lockout requires manual reset

All Range Controls for Non-Corrosive Refrigerants
P70LB-1C1 SPST 20 in.Hg

to 100

(-68 to 690)

Minimum 6 (41)

Maximum 50 (345)

100 to 500

(690 to 3,447)

Fixed Approx. 65 (448) 36 in.

capillary with 1/4 in. flare nut

Low cut-out
P70MA-1C1 Lockout Requires Manual Reset None
P70NA-1C Fixed (manual reset)
P72LA-1C1 DPST Minimum 7 (48)

Maximum 50 (345)

Fixed approx. 65 (448)
P72LB-1C1 Low cut-out
P72MA-1C1 Lockout requires manual reset None
P72NA-1C1 Fixed (manual reset)

Standard Electromechanical Pressure Controls

P70, P72, and P170 Series Controls for Dual Pressure Applications (Continued)

Selection Chart (Part 2 of 2)

Product Code

Number

Switch

Action

Low Pressure Side psi (kPa) High Pressure Side psi (kPa) Pressure

Connector

Limited Knob

Adjustment

Range Differential Range Differential (Non-Adjustable)
All Range Controls for Non-Corrosive Refrigerants
P170LB-1C1 SPST 20 in.Hg

to 100

(-68 to 690)

Minimum 7 (48)

Maximum 50 (345)

100 to 500

(690 to 3,447)

Fixed approx. 65 (448) 1/4 in.

External flare connector

Low cut-out
P170MA-1C1 Lockout requires manual reset None
P170NA-1C Fixed (manual reset)
All Range Ammonia Compatible Controls
P70LA-2C1 SPST 20 in. Hg to

100

(-68 to 690)

Minimum 7 (48)

Maximum 50 (345)

100 to 500

(690 to 3,447)

Fixed approx. 65 (448) 1/4 in.

Internal NPT connector

None
P70MA-2C1 Lockout requires manual reset

1. Control models with high pressure side (only) that are UL Listed as Refrigeration Pressure Limiting Controls.

Note: For information on models not listed, please contact Johnson Controls/PENN® Refrigeration Application Engineering at 1-800-275-5676.

Technical Specifications

Maximum Pressures

Pressure Low Side High Side
All Range MICRO-SET
Maximum Working Pressure 100 psi (552 kPa) 80 psi (690 kPa) 500 psi (3,447 kPa)
Maximum Overpressure 325 psi (2,241 kPa) 525 psi (3,620 kPa) 525 psi (3,620 kPa)

L1 L1

L2 L2

L1 L2

L3*

High side opens Line to M1 on pressure rise.

High

c

Load a

c o

p7sdual_wir_spst.eps

t High

r

Line

M2

High side opens Main ircuit (Line to M2), nd closes auxiliary ircuit (Line to M1)

n pressure rise.

ow side opens Main

Alarm Alarm Circui

Powe

High

Load

Line M1

High side opens

Line to M1 and Line to M2 on pressure rise.

M1

p7sdual_wir_pst.eps

M1

Line L

Line M2

Line

p7sdual_wir_4-2.eps

Load

Low side opens Line

to M1 on pressure drop.

Low

circuit (Line to M2), and closes auxiliary circuit (Line to M1)

Low

Low side opens Line to M1 and Line to M2 on pressure drop.

Typical Wiring for SPST Switch

on pressure drop.

Low

*(L3 is third supply line in 3-phase applications.)

(P70L, M, and N, and P170L, M, and N Models)

Typical Wiring for Four-Wire, Two-Circuit Switch (P70P, Q and R Models)

Typical Wiring for DPST Switch (P72L, M, and N Models)

L1 L2

Low

Alarm

High

Alarm

Load

2

3

1 1

3

2

Low

High

L1 L2

1

High side switch opens 1 to 2 and closes 1 to 3 on pressure rise.

1

High

High Alarm

3

2

2

Low Load

High Load

Low Alarm

p7sdual_wir_2spdt_-diff.eps

Low side switch opens 1 to 2 and closes 1 to 3 on pressure drop.

High side switch opens 1 to 2 and closes 1 to 3 on pressure rise.

Low side switch opens 1 to 2 and closes 1 to 3 on pressure drop.

3

Low

Two SPDT Switches Wired as a Dual Pressure Control (Switching a Single Load with Optional High Side Alarm and Low Side Alarm) (P70S and P170S Models)

p7sdual_wir_2spdt_asdual.eps

Two SPDT Switches Wired to Control Two Different Loads (Optional High Side Alarm and Low Side Alarm) (P70S and P170S Models)

Standard Electromechanical Pressure Controls

P70, P72, and P170 Series Controls for Dual Pressure Applications (Continued)

Technical Specifications (Continued)

DPST Electrical Ratings (P72L, M, and N Types)

Standard Ratings Hermetic Compressor Ratings
120 VAC,

Single-Phase

208 VAC,

Single-Phase

240 VAC,

Single-Phase

208 VAC,

Three-Phase

220 VAC,

Three-Phase

208 VAC,

Single-Phase

240 VAC,

Single-Phase

Motor Horsepower 2 3 3 5 5
Motor Full-Load A 24 18.7 17 15.9 15 24 24
Motor Locked-Rotor A 144 112.2 102 95.4 90 144 144
AC Non-Inductive A 24 24 24 24 24
DC Non-Inductive A 3 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5
Pilot Duty 125 VA at 120 to 600 VAC; 57.5 VA at 120 to 300 VDC

SPST Electrical Ratings (P70L, M, and N, and P170L, M, and N Types)

5/16

(15) 2-7/8

(73)

Reset Button for Controls with both High and Low Side Reset

Two Mounting Holes 10-32 UNF-28 Thread

5

5/16

3/16 Diameter

Single-Phase Ratings
Standard Hermetic

Compressor

120

VAC

208

VAC

240

VAC

208/240

VAC

Motor Horsepower 2 3 3
Motor Full-Load A 24 18.7 17 24
Motor Locked-Rotor A 144 112.2 102 144
Non-Inductive A 22 22 22
Pilot Duty 125 VA at 120 to 600 VAC; 57.5 VA at

120 to 300 VDC

(5) Mounting Hole

(127)

5/16

(8)

(9)

3-1/4

(83)

13/16

(20)

1-11/16 (43)

15/16

(95)

11/16 15/16

1

(25)

1-1/8 (29)

1-3/4

(17)

(95)

(44)

3/16 (4)

1-11/16 (43)

Reset Lever for Controls

with High Side Only Manual Reset (Except P70S and P170S Models)

1-15/16

(48)

2-1/16

5/16

3/16

3/8 X 3/16 Diameter

(53) 1 5/16

(33) 15/16

(24)

(8)

(5)

(10) (5) Mounting Hole

SPDT Electrical Ratings

1-5/16

(33) 3

3-3/16 (80)

11/16 (18)

p7sdual_dim1.eps

1/16

(76)

5-11/16

7/8 or 1-1/8 (1/2 in. or 3/4 in. Trade Size)

(P70S and P170S Types)

(2)

(144)

(22) (28) Conduit Hole

Dimensions for P70, P72, and P170 Dual Pressure Controls with NEMA 1 Enclosure, in. (mm)*

Standard Single-Phase Ratings
120

VAC

208

VAC

240

VAC

277

VAC

Motor Full Load A 16.0 9.2 8.0 7.0
Motor Locked Rotor A 96.0 55.2 48.0 42.0
Non-Inductive A 16.0 9.2 8.0
Pilot Duty 125 VA at 24 VAC; 720 VA at 120 to

277 VAC

Four-Wire, Two-Circuit Electrical Ratings (P70P, Q, and R Types)

5/8 (16)

5/8 (16)

3-1/8 (79)

4-13/16 (122)

5-13/16

Standard Single-Phase Ratings
Line-M2

(Main Contacts)

Line-M1

(Auxiliary Contacts)

120

VAC

208

VAC

240

VAC

277

VAC

120

VAC

208

VAC

240

VAC

277

VAC

Motor Full

Load A

16.0 9.2 8.0 6.0 3.3 3.0
Motor Locked Rotor A 96.0 55.2 48.0 36.0 19.8 18.0
Non- Inductive A 16.0 9.2 8.0 7.2 6.0 6.0 6.0 6.0
Pilot Duty for both sets of contacts 125 VA at 24 to 600 VAC; 57.5 VA at 120 to 300 VDC

(148) 4-7/16

(112) 2-3/4

(69)

1-1/4

(32)

3/8

(10)

2-3/4

(70)

3-3/8 (86)

Four Mounting Holes 5/16 Diameter

(8)

1/16 (2)

1-3/8

3/4-NPSM Threaded Rigid Conduit Connector

1-1/8 1-3/4

p7sdual_dim3.eps

(35)

Element as Specified

7/16 (10)

(29)

(44)

Dimensions for P70, P72, and P170 Dual Pressure Control with NEMA 3R Enclosure, in. (mm)*

*These dimensions are nominal and are subject to accepted manufacturing tolerances and application variables.

Single-Stage Electronic Pressure Controls Code No. LIT-1900109

P470 Electronic Pressure Control with Display

Description

The P470 Electronic Pressure Control with Display is a single-stage, On/Off, electronic pressure control with a single-pole,

double-throw (SPDT) output relay. The control may be field set to operate in one of

three pressure ranges (0 to 100 psi, 0 to 500 psi, or 50 to 750 psi), as either an open high or open low control.

The P470 Control features a large LCD that displays the sensed pressure and other system-status indicators, as well as the adjustable setpoints in the programming mode. The P470 Control has a lockable, three-button touchpad for adjusting setpoints, and a front-panel LED that indicates the output relay status.

The P470 Control uses a P499 Electronic Pressure Transducer in conjunction with a WHA-PDK3 Wiring Harness to sense system pressure. This arrangement virtually eliminates the chance of a refrigerant leak because there are no capillaries or bellows to break or fail.

Refer to the P470 Electronic Pressure Control with Display Product Bulletin (LIT-125528) for important product application information.

Selection Chart

Features

• easy-to-read LCD

• three field-selectable pressure ranges between 0 to 750 psi

• 24 VAC, and 120 or 208/240 VAC models

• lockable, three-button, front-panel touchpad

• built-in, adjustable, anti-short cycle time-delay

• uses an economical and versatile transducer and wiring harness

Repair Information

The P470 pressure control and

P499 transducer are not field repairable. Perform the following procedures, in the order they are presented, to determine the problem. If the problem is with the control or transducer, contact a Johnson Controls/PENN® sales representative for a replacement.

P470 Pressure Control with Transducer and Wiring Harness (Control, Transducer, and Harness Must be Purchased Separately)

Item Product Code Number Description
P470 (Low-Voltage) Electronic

Pressure Control with Display

P470FB-1C Low Voltage (less than 30 VAC) Electronic Pressure Control with Display

Supply Voltage: 24 VAC Class 2 Transformer

(See Technical Specifications for complete Relay Electrical Ratings.)

P470 (Line-Voltage) Electronic Pressure Control with Display P470EB-1C Line Voltage Electronic Pressure Control with Display Supply Voltage: 120 or 208/240 VAC

(See Technical Specifications for complete Relay Electrical Ratings.)

P499 Electronic Pressure Transducers P499RAP-101C P499RAP-101K 0 to 100 psi Pressure Transducer with 1/8 in. NPT External Fitting
P499RCP-101C P499RCP-101K 0 to 100 psi Pressure Transducer with 1/4 in. SAE (Schrader®) Internal Fitting with integral valve depressor
P499RAP-105C P499RAP-105K 0 to 500 psi Pressure Transducer with 1/8 in. NPT External Fitting
P499RCP-105C P499RCP-105K 0 to 500 psi Pressure Transducer with 1/4 in. SAE (Schrader) Internal Fitting with integral valve depressor
P499RAP-107C P499RAP-107K 0 to 750 psi Pressure Transducer with 1/8 in. NPT External Fitting
P499RCP-107C P499RCP-107K 0 to 750 psi Pressure Transducer with 1/4 in. SAE (Schrader) Internal Fitting with integral valve depressor
Wiring Harnesses for P499 Transducers WHA-PKD3-200C 6 ft 6-1/2 in. (2 m) 3-Wire Cable with Plug-in Connector for P499 Transducer
WHA-PKD3-400C 13 ft 3 in. (4 m) 3-Wire Cable with Plug-in Connector for P499 Transducer
WHA-PKD3-600C 19 ft 8 in. (6 m) 3-Wire Cable with Plug-in Connector for P499 Transducer

Note: P470 Controls do not include a transducer or wiring harness. P499 Transducer and wiring harness must be purchased separately. Transducer must be matched to the selected pressure range.

Single-Stage Electronic Pressure Controls

P470 Electronic Pressure Control with Display (Continued)

Technical Specifications

Output Relay Contacts Electrical Ratings

P470EB-1 P470 FB-1
120 VAC 208 VAC 240 VAC 24 VAC
Horsepower N.O. (N.C.) 1 (1/4) 1 (1/3) 1 (1/2) 100 VA,

30 VAC maximum,

Class 2

Full Load Ampere N.O. (N.C.) 16 (5.8) 9.2 (4.0) 8.0 (4.9)
Locked Rotor Ampere N.O. (N.C.) 96 (34.8) 55.2 (24) 498 (29.4)
Non-Inductive Ampere N.O. (N.C.) 15 (10) 10 (10) 10 (10)
Pilot Duty 125 VA (N.O.) at 24 to 240 VAC

125 VA (N.C.) at 120 to 240 VAC

50 VA (N.C.) at 24 VAC

P470 Electronic Pressure Control with Display
Operating Pressure Ranges 0 to 100 psi 0 to 500 psi 50 to 750 psi
Minimum Differential Pressure 5 psig 20 psig 20 psig
Displayed Resolution 1 psig 3 psig 5 psig
Control Accuracy + 1.5% of selected Operating Pressure Range plus transducer accuracy
Supply Voltage P470FB-1:24 VAC, 50/60 Hz, Class 2 P470EB-1:120 or 208/240 VAC, 50/60 Hz
Power Consumption 1.8 VA maximum
Transducer Type P499 Electronic Pressure Transducer
Ambient Temperature at Control Operating: -30 to 140°F (-34 to 60°C) Shipping: -40 to 185°F (-40 to 85°C)
Ambient Humidity at Operating Control 0 to 95% RH noncondensing; Maximum dew point: 85°F (29°C)
Enclosure Case and cover: NEMA 1 High-impact thermoplastic
Agency Information UL: File SA516; CCN SDFY Canadian UL: File SA516; CCN SDFY7

FCC/DOC Part 15, Class A

Electromechanical Lube Oil and Differential Pressure Controls Code No. LIT-1927185

P28 Series Lube Oil Pressure Cutout Control with Time Delay

Description

The P28 series provides dependable lube oil protection on pressure of lubricated refrigeration compressors by sensing low lube oil pressure. A built-in time delay switch, accurately compensated for ambient temperature, allows for pressure pick up on start and avoids nuisance shutdowns on pressure drops of short duration during the running cycle.

Refer to the P28 and P128 Series Lube Oil Controls with Built-in Time Delay Relay Product Bulletin (LIT-125420) for important product application information.

Features

• direct-reading scale indication

• adjustable setpoint

• trip-free manual reset

• replacement timing relays available

• dust-protected switch

Applications

• semi-hermetic compressors

• P28 Control measures pressure available to circulate oil though the lubrication system (Net oil pressure is the difference between oil gauge and crankcase pressure.)

Accessories

• all models listed on this page include a universal mounting bracket

• replacement timing relays— refer to Replacement Timing Relays for P28 and P29 Lube Oil Controls Catalog Page (LIT-1927395)

Repair Information

If the P28 Series Lube Oil Pressure Cutout Control with Time Delay fails to operate within its specifications, replace the unit. For a replacement control, contact the nearest Johnson Controls® representative.

P28AA Lube Oil Pressure Cutout Control

Selection Chart

Product Code

Number

Time

Delay

Time Delay

Heater Circuit VAC

Type of

Reset

Range1 psi (kPa) Refrigerant

(R)

Pressure

Connection

P28AA-1C2 90 seconds 120/240 Manual 8 to 70 (55 to 483) Non-corrosive3 36 in. capillary with

1/4 in. flare nut

P28AA-2C4 60 seconds
P28AA-17C5 120 seconds
P28AA-18C 45 seconds
P28AN-1C 90 seconds 120/240 Manual 8 to 70 (55 to 483) Ammonia 1/4 in. internal NPT
P28DN-1C 90 seconds

With Runlight and Alarm Terminals

P28DA-1C 120/240 Manual 8 to 70 (55 to 483) Non-corrosive3 36 in. capillary with 1/4 in. flare nut
P28GA-2C 90 seconds Automatic
P28NA-5C 120 seconds 24 VAC

or VDC

Manual
  1. Switch differential approximately 5 psig (34 kPa). Time delay relay energizes at 9 psig (61 kPa) pressure difference, de-energized at 14 psig (97 kPa) difference
  2. Replaces Ranco® P30-3701
  3. Non-corrosive refrigerants include R-12, R-22, R-134A, R-500, R-502 (R)
  4. Replaces Ranco P30-3601
  5. Replaces Ranco P30-3801

Technical Specifications

The maximum bellows pressure is 180 psig (2,241 kPa).

Electrical Ratings – Pilot Duty

Time Delay

Heater Circuit

Pilot Circuit Alarm Circuit

(must be same voltage as pilot circuit)

P28DA-1 Contact Rating 2 to 1: 2 to 3

(must be same voltage as time delay circuit)

Crankcase Heater: Term 2 to 1 Runlight: Term 2 to 3
120/240 VAC 750 VA, 120/240 VAC 125 VA, 120/240 VAC 10 A 120 VAC, 5 A 240 VAC 10 W
24 VAC or VDC 125 VA, 24 VAC

57.5 VA, 24 VDC

125 VA, 24 VAC

57.5 VA, 24 VDC

Electromechanical Lube Oil and Differential Pressure Controls Code No. LIT-1927195

P32 Series Sensitive Pressure Switch

Description

This differential pressure switch is used to sense pressure/air flow in ducts.

Refer to the P32 Series Sensitive Differential Pressure Switch Product Bulletin

(LIT-125435) for important product application information.

P32 Series

Y

R

B

Action on Increase of Pressure

p32.eps

P28 Action Diagram

Selection Chart

Product

Code Number

Ambient

Temperature Min./Max.

Connector

Maximum

Over- pressure psig (kPa)1

Contact

Action

Range

in. WC (kPa)

Sensitivity

at Min.

Setpoint

in. WC (kPa)

Setpoint

Scale

Plate

Mounting Bracket

(Included)

P32AC-1C

-40°F (-40°C)

min.

167°F (75°C)

max.

High Pressure connectors are metal 1/8 in. internal NPT inside, 1/2 in. NPSM outside for mounting

Low pressure connectors are molded,

1/8 in. internal NPT

1

(6.895)

SPDT

0.15 to 12 (0.037 to 2.99)

0.07

(0.017)

Adjustable

Yes

L

BKT182-1

P32AC-2C2

0.05 to 5 (0.012 to 1.24)

0.04

(0.01)

U

BKT229-1

P32AF-1C

0.025

(0.006)

L

BKT182-1

P32AF-2C2

U

BKT229-1

bracket1.eps bracket2.eps bracket1.eps

bracket2.eps

Features

• easy-to-read setpoint scale

• versatile mounting options

Applications

• pressure/air flow proving with electric duct heaters, humidifiers, and other equipment

• maximum pressure/air flow control for variable volume systems

• reheat duct powered systems

• clogged filter detection

• detection of icing of air conditioning coils and initiation of defrost cycle

• sensitive pressure settings

• dust-tight snap switch

Repair Information

If the P32 Series Sensitive Pressure Switch fails to operate within its specifications, replace the unit. For a replacement switch, contact the nearest Johnson Controls® representative.

P32 Sensitive Pressure Switch

  1. Maximum overpressure at either connection
  2. Supplied with 1/4 in. compression fitting, 4 in. extension tube, two mounting screws, and O-gasket (angle barbed fitting installed)

Accessories

The switch can be mounted directly or with the supplied mounting bracket.

Technical Specifications

Electrical Ratings

Motor Ratings VAC 120 208 240
Type P32AC (Standard Differential, 1/2 hp)
AC Full Load A 9.8 5.65 4.9
AC Locked Rotor A 58.8 33.9 29.4
Non-Inductive or Resistive Load 15 A, 24 to 277 VAC
Pilot Duty 125 VA, 24 VAC; 360 VA,

120 to 277 VAC

Type P32AF (Close Differential, 1/4 hp)
AC Full Load A 5.8 3.3 2.9
AC Locked Rotor A 34.8 19.8 17.4
Non-Inductive or Resistive Load 10 A, 24 to 277 VAC
Pilot Duty 125 VA, 24 VAC; 360 VA,

120 to 277 VAC

Product Code

Number

Description
FTG18A-600R Remote Mounting Kit: 4 in. flanged sensing tube,

two barbed fittings, two No. 10 screws, and a gasket

Electromechanical Lube Oil and Differential Pressure Controls Code No. LIT-1927200

P45 Series Lube Oil Pressure Cutout Control with Time Delay

Description

The P45 Control provides dependable, low lube oil pressure protection for refrigeration compressors. The low-adjustable factory-set pressure setting provides operation to the compressor manufacturer’s specification. A built-in time delay relay, compensated for ambient temperature, allows for pressure pick-up on start and avoids nuisance shutdowns on short duration pressure losses during the running cycle.

Refer to the P45 Series Oil Pressure Cutout Controls with Built-in Time Delay Relay Product Bulletin (LIT-125445) for important product application information.

Features

• universal mounting

• trip-free manual reset

• ambient compensated time delay

Selection Chart

Accessories

These controls are supplied without mounting brackets. If brackets are required, order kit number BKT38A-600R, which contains five 271-51 Angle Mounting Brackets with screws.

Applications

The P45 control is used on semi-hermetic compressors. It measures net oil pressure available to circulate oil through the compressor’s lubrication system. (Net oil pressure is the difference between oil pump pressure and the crank case pressure.)

Repair Information

If the P45 Series Lube Oil Pressure Cutout Control with Time Delay fails to operate within its specifications, replace the unit. For a replacement control, contact the nearest Johnson Controls® representative.

P45NCALube Oil Pressure Cutout Control

Technical Specifications For all non-corrosive refrigerants. Electrical Rating – Pilot Duty

Time Delay

Heat Circuit

Pilot Duty
120/240 VAC 750 VA, 120/240 VAC
24 VAC 125 VA, 24 VAC
Product Code

Number

Time

Delay1

Heater Circuit

VAC

Type of

Reset

Maximum Bellows

Pressure, psig (kPa)

Factory Setting, psi (kPa)

Fixed

Pressure

Connection

Copeland® Compressors
P45NAA-5C 120 seconds 24 Manual 425 (2,390) 9 (62)2 36 in. capillary with

1/4 in. flare nut

P45NAA-10C 90 seconds 48 in. capillary with

1/4 in. flare nut

P45NCA-12C3 120 seconds 120/240 36 in. capillary with

1/4 in. flare nut

P145NCA-12C4 1/4 in. external flare (Style 5)
P145NCB-12C5
Carlyle® Compressors
P45NCA-82C6 45 seconds 120/240 Manual 425 (2,390) 6.5 (45)7 36 in. capillary with

1/4 in. flare nut

P145NCA-82C8 1/4 in. external flare (Style 5)
P145NCB-82C9
  1. Relay is not field-replaceable
  2. Switch differential is approximately 5 psi (34 kPa). Time delay relay energizes at 9 psi (61 kPa) pressure difference, de-energizes at 14 psi (97 kPa) difference.
  3. Replaces Ranco® P30-5826
  4. Replaces Ranco P30-5827
  5. Replaces Ranco P30-5827 (Includes alarm wire)
  6. Replaces Carlyle/Carrier® Code No. HKCA-500, 6342050
  7. Switch differential is approximately 4.5 psi (34 kPa). Time delay relay energizes at 6.5 psi (45 kPa) pressure difference, de-energizes at 11 psi (76 kPa) difference.
  8. Replaces Carlyle/Carrier Part No. HKCA-500, 6342050 with 36” SEC99A UltraCap®
  9. Replaces Carlyle/Carrier Part No. HKCA-500, 6342050 with 36” SEC99A UltraCap (Includes alarm wire)

Electromechanical Lube Oil and Differential Pressure Controls Code No. LIT-1927260

P74 Series Differential Pressure Control

Description

Series P74 measures the pressure difference between two sources: supply lines and return lines. A change in differential pressure will reposition the switching mechanism to cause corrective action of the supplementary control equipment.

Refer to the P47 Series Steam Pressure Controls Product Bulletin (LIT-125450) for important product application information.

Features

• field-proven Penn switch with a completely enclosed contact mechanism

• pressure differential setting is easily changed without removing the cover

Selection Chart

Applications

• differential pressure sensing on chillers or water-cooled condensers

• lube oil failure cutout for refrigeration compressors (same as the P28, but does not incorporate time delay)

• positioning M100 Series motor-actuated valves (P74JA-2)

• to prove pump operation

Accessories

All models on this page include a universal mounting bracket.

Repair Information

If the P74 Series Differential Pressure Control fails to operate within its specifications, replace the unit. For a replacement control, contact the nearest Johnson Controls® representative.

P74EA-8 Differential Pressure Control

Product Code

Number

Switch

Action

Range Pressure Differential

psig (kPa)1

Switch

Differential

Pressure

Connections

Bellows

Material

For All Non-Corrosive Liquids
P74AA-1C Single-Pole, Single-Throw (SPST) closes on

decreases in pressure difference

8 to 70 Adjustable

(55 to 483)

8 to 30 Adjustable 36 in. capillary with

1/4 in. flare nut

Stainless

steel

P74BA-1C SPST opens on decrease in pressure difference
P74EA-8C Single-Pole, Double-Throw (SPDT) (snap-acting) 2 to 26 Adjustable

(14 to 207)

3.5 Fixed 36 in. capillary with 1/4 in. flare nut Brass
P74EA-10C 1/4 in. external flare
P74FA-1C 8 to 60 Adjustable

(55 to 414)

1.5 Fixed
P74FA-5C 1/4 in. FNPT
P74FA-10C 2 to 26 Adjustable

(14 to 207)

36 in. capillary with

1/4 in. flare nut

P74JA-2C SPDT (floating) 8 to 60 Adjustable

(55 to 414)

2.5 Fixed 1/4 in. external flare

1. Maximum continuous pressure to low pressure bellows – 180 psig (1,241 kPa)

Technical Specifications

Electrical Ratings

Motor Ratings 120 V 208 V 240 V 277 V
P74AA, P74BA – 1 Phase
AC Full Load A 20.0 18.7 17.0
AC Locked Rotor A 120.0 112.2 102.0
AC Non-Inductive A 22.0 22.0 22.0
Pilot Duty 125 VA, 120 to 600 VAC; 57.5 VA, 120 to 300 VDC
P74EA
AC Full Load A 16.0 9.2 8.0
AC Locked Rotor A 96.0 55.2 48.0
AC Non-Inductive A 16.0 16.0 16.0 16.0
Pilot Duty 125 VA, 120 to 600 VAC
P74FA
AC Full Load A 6.0 3.4 3.0
AC Locked Rotor A 36.0 20.4 18.0
AC Non-Inductive A 10.0 10.0 10.0 10.0
Pilot Duty 125 VA, 120 to 277 VAC
P74JA
1 A; 24 VAC Class 2; 50/60 Hz

Electromechanical Lube Oil and Differential Pressure Controls Code No. LIT-1927280

P128 and P145 Series Lube Oil Pressure Controls

Description

The P128 and P145 Series Controls provide dependable low pressure lube oil cut-out for pressure lubricated refrigeration compressors. The P128 Series offer adjustable range settings.

The P128 and P145 controls feature a 1/4 in. external flare pressure connection which may be used with a refrigerant hose or cap tube such as SEC99 UltraCap.

Refer to the P28 and P128 Series Lube Oil Control with Built-in Time Delay Relay Product Bulletin (LIT-125420) for important product application information.

Features

• ambient compensated time delay relay

• trip-free manual reset

• industry standard

• P128 is fully adjustable throughout its range

• P145 is factory set to compressor manufacturer’s specifications

Applications

Use these controls for lube oil cutout on hermetic and semi-hermetic compressors used in commercial air-conditioning and commercial and industrial refrigeration systems.

Selection Chart

P128AA Lube Oil Pressure Control

Technical Specifications

Pressure controls P128 and P145 are designed to be used with SEC99 UltraCap. Product specifications for P128 are the same as P28 model. Refer to P28 Series Lube Oil Pressure Cutout Control (With Time Delay) (LIT-1927185). Product specifications for P145 are the same as P45 model. Refer to P45 Series Lube Oil Pressure Cutout Control (With Time Delay) (LIT-1927185).

Also note the selection chart below.

P145NCA Lube Oil Pressure Control

Accessories

Some controls are supplied less mounting brackets. If brackets are required, order kit number BKT38A-600, which contains

five 271-51 angle mounting brackets with screws; or BKT38A-601 which contains one mounting bracket with screws.

Repair Information

If the P128 and the P145 Series Lube Oil Pressure Control fails to operate within its specifications, replace the unit. For a replacement control, contact the nearest Johnson Controls® representative.

Product Code

Number

Time

Delay

Heater Circuit

VAC

Type of

Reset

Range psig (kPa) Refrigerant Pressure

Connection

Adjustable Non-Adjustable
P128AA-1C1 90 seconds 120/240 Manual 8 to 70 (55 to 483) Non-corrosive 1/4 in. external flared

connection

P128AA-2C2 60 seconds
P128AA-17C3 120 seconds
P145NCA-12C4 Factory Set 9 (62) Non-corrosive
P145NCA-82C5 45 seconds Factory Set 6.5 (45)
P145NCB-12C6 120 seconds Factory Set 9 (62)
P145NCB-82C7 45 seconds Factory Set 6.5 (45)
  1. Replacement for P28AA-1*. Replaces Ranco® P30-3701.
  2. Replacement for P28AA-2*. Replaces Ranco P30-3601.
  3. Replacement for P28AA-17*. Replaces Ranco P30-3801.
  4. Replacement for P45NCA-12*. (Copeland Model) Replaces Ranco P30-5826.
  5. Replacement for P45NCA-82*. (Carlyle Model).
  6. Copeland model with alarm circuit
  7. Carlyle model with alarm circuit

* SEC99 UltraCap Hose must be ordered separately.

Electromechanical Lube Oil and Differential Pressure Controls Code No. LIT-1900115

P12 Series Differential Pressure Controls

Description

The P12 Series Differential Pressure Controls are suitable for use with oil and/or

non-corrosive refrigerants. The switch is actuated by a difference in pressure between the two sensing elements. The control is factory-set to open the switch (COM to 1) at a differential pressure of 18 psi (124 kPa) and close the switch (COM to 1) at a differential pressure of 12 psi (83 kPa). The control is not field-adjustable.

This control may be connected to a P28 Lube Oil Control, with time delay, to give complete monitoring of lubrication on two refrigeration compressors driven by one motor.

Refer to the P12 Series Differential Pressure Control Product Bulletin (LIT-997452) for important product application information.

Repair Information

If the P12 Series Differential Pressure Control fails to operate within its specifications, replace the unit. For a replacement control, contact the nearest Johnson Controls® representative.

P12AA

Differential Pressure Control

Selection Chart

Product Code

Number

Differential Pressure Maximum

Overpressure, psi (kPa)

Enclosure Fitting
COM to 1 OPENS COM to 1 CLOSES
P12AA-3C 18 psi (124 kPa) 12 psi (83 kPa) 500 (3,447) NEMA1 Enclosure 1/4 in. external SAE flare fitting

Electronic Lube Oil and Differential Pressure Controls Code No. LIT-1900355

P545 Series Electronic Lube Oil Control

Description

The P545 Series Electronic Lube Oil Control is designed for use on refrigeration compressors equipped with an oil pump that accepts a single-point differential pressure switch. The P400 switch continuously monitors net lube oil pressure and the P545 control locks out the compressor if lube oil pressure falls below the manufacturer’s recommended net pressure for longer than the recommended lube oil time delay. Front-mount LEDs indicate the status of the lubrication system, and a user-selectable, minimum-off time delay can be set to minimize compressor short cycling.

A Johnson Controls/PENN® R310AD Current Sensing Switch, sold separately, may be used to disable the P545 control lockout circuit during abnormal compressor shutdowns.

Refer to the P545 Series Electronic Lube Oil Control Product Bulletin (LIT-12011012) for important product application information.

Features

• single-pole, double-throw (SPDT) relay contacts for liquid line solenoid and alarm applications allow liquid line solenoid to be closed if the P545 control shuts off the compressor due to low oil pressure and provides alarm indication, including circuits that use neon lights

Selection Charts

P545 Series Electronic Lube Oil Control

• relay contact output for compressor provides reliable, long-lasting operation

• built-in test circuit verifies proper control operation quickly, without additional tools or equipment

• improved noise immunity exceeds immunity requirements of UL 991 for transient overvoltage: IEC 61000-4-3 for radiated Radio Frequency (RF) and IEC 61000-4-6 for RF-induced conducted disturbances

• jumper-selectable anti-short cycle time delays provide for a wide range of

anti-short cycle strategies that meet most equipment requirements— the anti-short cycle delay feature may allow for the elimination of an external short-cycle timer

• user-friendly display panel displays the status of the compressor lubrication system continuously

• backwards compatibility allows easy replacement of existing electronic lube oil controls

Repair Information

If the P545 Series Electronic Lube Oil Control fails to operate within its specifications, replace the unit. For a replacement control, contact the nearest Johnson Controls® representative.

P545 Control with P400 Switch

Product Code Number Lube Oil Delay (Seconds) P400 Switch Wiring Harness Fits Compressors Manufactured by
P545NCB-22C1 120 P400AD-2 WHA-P400-100 Copeland
P545NCB-25C1 90 P400BD-1 WHA-P400-125 Bitzer
P545NCB-82C1 120 P400AD-1 WHA-P400-100 Carlyle

1. Switch and wiring harness included

Control and Sensor/Switch Compatibility

Test P345 or P445 Control

with P400 Switch

P545 Control and

P400 Switch

Wiring Harness1 WHA-P400-xxx WHA-P400-xxx
Test Switch Does not function2 Immediate
  1. WHA-P400-xxx is the two-wire harness supplied with the P545 control and the P400 switch.
  2. When the P445 Control is wired to a P400 Switch, the Test button may operate when first powered up; however, after a couple minutes of operation, the Test Switch function no longer works. All other control functions operate normally.

Electronic Lube Oil and Differential Pressure Controls

P545 Series Electronic Lube Oil Control (Continued)

Accessories

P400 Single-Point Differential Lube Oil Pressure Switch

Product Code

Number1

Open Point

(Differential Pressure)

Close Point

(Differential Above Open Point)

Threads Wiring

Harness

P400AD-1C 7.0 ±1.0 psi less than or equal to 2.0 psi 3/4-16 UNF WHA-P400-100
P400AD-2C 12.75 ±0.75 psi less than or equal to 1.5 psi
P400BD-1C 10.0 ±1.5 psi less than or equal to 3.0 psi M20 x 1.5 WHA-P400-125

1. Wiring harness included

Wiring Harnesses and Other Accessories

Product Code Number Description
KITP545-82C1 CST29A-600C Sensor Block;

P545NCB-82 Control;

P400AD-1C Switch;

WHA-P400-100C Wiring Harness

WHA-P400-100C 3-1/3 ft (1 m) length wiring harness
WHA-P400-125C 4 ft (1-1/4 m) length wiring harness
WHA-P400-250C 8 ft (2-1/2 m) length wiring harness
WHA-P400-430C 14 ft (4-1/3 m) length wiring harness
R310AD-1C Low-voltage Current Sensing Switch
271-51 Universal Mounting Bracket

1. Contact Carlyle Compressor Co. at 1-800-462-2759 to order Sensor Block Gasket 06DA680063.

Technical Specifications

P545NCB Electronic Lube Oil Control
Power Requirements 120 or 240 VAC, 50/60 Hz +10%, -15%; power consumption: 3 VA
Open Point (Differential Pressure) P545NCB-22/P400AD-2: 12.75 ± 0.75 psi (87.9 ± 5.17 kPa)

P545NCB-25/P400BD-1: 10 ± 1.5 psi (68.9 ± 10.3 kPa)

P545NCB-82 P400AD-1: 7 ± 1.0 psi (48.2 ± 6.9 kPa)

Lube Oil Time Delay (Factory Settings) P545NCB-22: 120 ± 15 seconds

P545NCB-25: 90 ± 12 seconds

P545NCB-82: 120 ± 15 seconds

Anti-Short Cycle Timer Four selectable positions: 0, 35, 65, and 100 seconds (nominal times)
Type of Refrigerant Non-corrosive refrigerants only
Electrical Connections Control: Screw type terminals on a barrier terminal strip

Sensor: Snap-connect at sensor end, three-pin plug at control end

Maximum Electrical Rating Isolated relay output to compressor contactor (M-1 and M-2) Pilot duty 375 VA at 120 VAC, 750 VA at 240 VAC
Alarm Circuit (Relay) NOA contact: Pilot duty 125 VA at 120/240 VAC; 60 W tungsten at 120/240 VAC NCA contact: Pilot duty 125 VA at 120 VAC, 250 VA at 240 VAC
Backplate Material

Case and Cover Material

0.062 in. (1 mm) cold rolled steel High impact thermoplastic
Ambient Operating Conditions -40 to 131°F (-40 to 5°C)
Ambient Storage Conditions -40 to 185°F (-40 to 85°C)
Approximate Shipping Weight 1.80 lb (0.82 kg)
Agency Listings UL Listed, File SA516, CCN SDFY

UL Listed for Canada, File SA516, CCN SDFY7

Electronic Lube Oil and Differential Pressure Controls Code No. LIT-1900111

CST29A Adaptor Block for Carlyle® Compressors

Description

The Johnson Controls/PENN® CST29A Adaptor Block is designed for use on Carlyle® compressors (models O6CC, O6D, and O6E) equipped with an oil pump. The adaptor block allows for the installation of the P400 single point differential pressure switch for use with the P545NCB-82 electronic lube oil control.

Refer to the CST29A Adapter Block for Carlyle Compressors Product Bulletin (LIT-125730) for important product application information.

Selection Chart

Product Code Number Description
CST29A-600C Adaptor Block for Carlyle Compressor Series O6CC, O6D, and O6E;

Includes Allen-head bolts.

Accessories

Features

• simple installation— provides easy conversion of electromechanical lube oil control system to electronic equivalent

• designed specifically for Carlyle applications— applies to Carlyle compressor models O6CC, O6D, and O6E

Repair Information

If the CST29A Adaptor Block for Carlyle® Compressors fails to operate within its specifications, replace the unit. For a replacement adaptor, contact the nearest Johnson Controls® representative.

CST29A Adaptor Block

Product Code Number Description
P545NCB-82C Electronic Lube Oil Pressure Control, 120 second delay before lockout, with P400AD-1 switch and WHA-P400-100 switch cable
P400AD-1C Replacement Differential Pressure Switch with WHA-P400-100 Wire Harness Open at 7 ±1.0 psi, Close Less than or Equal to 2.0 psig above Open Point
KITP545-82C Single Pack P545 with Adaptor Block and Allen-head Bolts
WHA-P400-100C 3-1/3 ft (1 m) Length Wiring Harness
WHA-P400-125C 4 ft (1-1/4 m) Length Wiring Harness
WHA-P400-250C 8 ft (2-1/2 m) Length Wiring Harness
WHA-P400-400C 14 ft (4-1/3 m) Length Wiring Harness
Carlyle Supplied Parts
06DA6800631 Adaptor Block Gasket for Carlyle Compressor Series O6CC, O6D, and O6E
  1. Order this part from a Carlyle distributor. For information on the nearest Carlyle distributor, contact Carlyle at 1-800-462-2759.

Pressure Sensors and Accessories Code No. LIT-1927395

Replacement Timing Relays for P28 and P29 Lube Oil Controls

Selection Chart

Product Code Number Voltage Reset Alarm Circuit Timing (Seconds)
RLY13A-616R 120/240 VAC Manual No 120
RLY13A-613R 12 VAC Manual No 120
RLY13A-609R 24 VAC or DC Manual No 120
RLY13A-608R 120/240 VAC Automatic No 90
RLY13A-602R 120/240 VAC Manual No 90
RLY13A-600R 120/240 VAC Manual No 60
RLY13A-617R 120/240 VAC Manual No 45
RLY13A-610R 120/240 VAC Manual No 30

Pressure Sensors and Accessories Code No. LIT-1927275

P100 Series Encapsulated Pressure Switches

Description

P100 Series switches are encapsulated, nonadjustable, single-pole, single-throw (SPST), direct-mount switches for use with non-corrosive refrigerants. The switches are available with automatic reset in both open low and open high configurations and manual reset with open high action.

Refer to the P100 Series Encapsulated Pressure Controls Product Bulletin (LIT-121485) for important product application information.

Features

• compact size and light weight allow for direct mounting

• trip-free manual reset (manual reset models); contacts cannot be overridden by continued depression of the reset button

• use with all non-corrosive refrigerants

• encapsulated switch, dust tight

• 1/4 in. Internal flare fitting with built-in Schrader type depressor is standard

• electrical connections are made to 48 in. leads

Applications

• low limit, high limit, and fan cycling control in commercial refrigeration

• ice machines

• food service equipment

Repair Information

If the P100 Series Encapsulated Pressure Switches fails to operate within its specifications, replace the unit. For a replacement switch, contact the nearest Johnson Controls® representative.

P100 Series Encapsulated Pressure Switch

Technical Specifications

Standard Duty Electrical Contact Ratings

Switch Action-Model

Numbers

SPST-P100AA, AC, AG, AJ, CA, CC, CG, CJ, DA, and

DC

SPST-P100AP, CP
Motor Ratings 120V 240V 120V 240V
AC Full Load Ampere 5.8 2.9 6.0 6.0
AC Locked Rotor Ampere 34.8 15.0 36.0 36.0
Non-Inductive Ampere
Inductive Ampere
Pilot Duty 375 VA 375 VA

Heavy Duty Electrical Contact Ratings

Switch Action-Model

Numbers

SPST-P100AE and CE SPDT-P100EE
Motor Ratings 120V 240V 120V 240V
Contact Type N.O. N.C. N.O. N.C. N.O. N.C. N.O. N.C.
AC Full Load Ampere 13.0 13.0 10.0 10.0 5.8 13.0 2.9 10.0
AC Locked Rotor Ampere 65.0 60.0 45.0 45.0 34.8 60.0 17.4 45.0
Non-Inductive Ampere 13.0 25.0 10.0 25.0 10.0 25.0 5.0 25.0
Inductive Ampere 15.0 15.0 15.0 15.0 15.0 15.0 15.0 15.0
Pilot Duty 278 VA 125 VA 278 VA 125 VA 278 VA 125 VA 278 VA 125 VA

Pressure Sensors and Accessories

www.johnsoncontrols.com

Johnson Controls, Inc. shall not be liable for damages resulting from misapplication or misuse of its products. © 2015 Johnson Controls, Inc.

R-116

Selection Chart (Part 1 of 3)

P100 Series Encapsulated Pressure Switches (Continued)

The performance specifications are nominal and conform to acceptable industry standards. For applications at conditions beyond these specifications, consult the local Johnson Controls office.

Product Code Number Switch Action Setpoints – psig (kPa) Replaces:
Opens Closes Ranco Robert- shaw Saginomiya Danfoss Klixon Supco Wilspec International

Refrigeration Products

Gemline
P100AC-1C2 Open on Pressure Drop 5 (34) 20 (138) MPL-7001 ACB-2UA318W PS80-K2-F0305- 020-005 SLP0520 HR201A020005D SLP0520
P100AP-354C 5 (34) 30 (207) 3100-002 SLP0530
P100AP-15C 10 (69) 25 (172) HR00011A1R702 3100-050 ACB-2UA97W 061F7523 PS80-K2-F0307- 025-005 SLP1025 HR201A025010D SLP1025
P100AP-201C 10 (69) 32 (221) MPL-7011 3100-050 ACB-2UA101 SLP1032 SLP1032
P100AC-2C2 15 (103) 30 (207) MPL-7002
P100AP-356C 20 (138) 45 (310) 3100-003 ACB-2UA40W SLP2045
P100AP-12C 25 (172) 50 (345) ACB-2UA143 PS80-K2-F0316- 050-005 SLP2550 HR201A050025D SLP2550
P100AP-9C 25 (172) 80 (551) MPL-7003 3101-003 PS80-K2-F0325- 080-005 SLP2580 HR201A080025D SLP2580
P100AP-105C 30 (207) 60 (413) 3100-004 ACB-2UA94 SLP3560
P100AP-2C 35 (241) 60 (414) MPL-7004 3100-004 SLP3560 SLP3560
P100AP-10C 40 (276) 60 (413) HR00011A1R704
P100AP-357C 40 (276) 80 (551) 3100-052 ACB-2UA354W PS80-K2-F0326- 080-005 SLP4080 HR201A080040D SLP4080
P100AP-361C 50 (345) 90 (620) PS80-KS-F0328- 090-005 SLP5090 HR201A090050D SLP5090
P100AP-358C 75 (517) 100 (689) ACB-2UA441W SLP75100
P100AP-351C1 75 (517) 120 (827) SFC75120
P100AP-352C1 110 (758) 170

(1,171)

SFC110170
P100AP-353C1 126 (868) 264

(1,819)

SFC125265
P100AP-3C1 150

(1,034)

225

(1,551)

MPF-7008 ACB-2UA685W SFC150225
P100AP-359C1 165

(1,137)

215

(1,481)

3100-215 ACB-2UA48W
P100AP-4C1 170

(1,172)

250

(1,724)

ACB-2UA631W SFC170250
P100AP-362C1 195

(1,344)

240

(1,654)

3100-080
P100AP-200C1 195

(1,344)

275

(1,895)

Pressure Sensors and Accessories

www.johnsoncontrols.com

Johnson Controls, Inc. shall not be liable for damages resulting from misapplication or misuse of its products. © 2015 Johnson Controls, Inc.

R-117

Selection Chart (Part 2 of 3)

P100 Series Encapsulated Pressure Switches (Continued)

The performance specifications are nominal and conform to acceptable industry standards. For applications at conditions beyond these specifications, consult the local Johnson Controls office.

Product Code Number Switch Action Setpoints – psig (kPa) Replaces:
Opens Closes Ranco Robert- shaw Saginomiya Danfoss Klixon Supco Wilspec International Refrigeration Products Gemline
P100AP-354C1 Open on Pressure Drop 210

(1,447)

275

(1,895)

ACB-2UA319W SFC210275 SFC210275
P100EE-79C 300

(2,068)

370

(2,551)

P100AP-332C1 300

(2,068)

400

(2,758)

MPF7010 ACB-2UA627W 061F7514 SFC300400
P100CP-157C Open on Pressure Rise 225

(1,550)

150

(1,034)

P100CP-158C 250

(1,723)

150

(1,034)

PS80-K1-0336- 250-150 SHP250150 HR202A250150D SHP250150
P100CP-159C 270

(1,860)

200

(1,378)

P100CC-9C2 275

(1,896)

175

(1,207)

3100-112 ACB-2UB724W
P100CP-91C 300

(2,067)

200

(1,378)

ACB-2UB723W PS80-K1-0341- 300-200 HR202A300200D SHP300200
P100CP-166C 325

(2,239)

225

(1,550)

061F6080 PS80-K1-0346- 320-230 SHP325225 HR202A325230D
P100CP-140C 350

(2,412)

245

(1,688)

3100-150 ACB-2UB273W 061F3212 PS80-K1-0348- 350-245 HR202A350245D SHP350250
P100CP-160C 375

(2,584)

275

(1,895)

ACB-2UB191 061F7509 SHP375265
P100CP-161C 400

(2,756)

200

(1,378)

3100-152 PS80-K1-0357- 400-200 SHP400200 HR202A400200D SHP400200
P100CP-162C 400

(2,756)

280

(1,929)

PS80-K1-0358- 400-280 SHP400280 HR202A400280D SHP400280
P100EE-78C 400

(2,756)

300

(2,068)

P100CP-1C 400

(2,758)

300

(2,068)

MPH-7107 3100-151 ACB-2UB35 061FS14 PS80-K1-0359- 400-300 SHP400300 HR202A400300D SHP400300 PC 151
P100CP-156C 410

(2,825)

290

(1,998)

P100CP-163C 425

(2,928)

300

(2,067)

PS80-K1-0360- 425-300 SHP425300 HR202A425300D SHP425300
P100CP-2C 425

(2,930)

325

(2,241)

MPH-7108 3100-100 ACB-2UB282W SHP425325 PC 100
P100CP-164C 450

(3,101)

250

(1,723)

PS80-K1-0363- 450-250 SHP450250 HR202A450250D SHP450250
P100CP-38C 500

(3,447)

325

(2,241)

P100CP-165C 600

(4,134)

475

(3,273)

HR00011B1R704 061F7517 SHP600475
P100CP-85C 665

(4,585)

565

(3,895)

SHP665565

www.johnsoncontrols.com

Johnson Controls, Inc. shall not be liable for damages resulting from misapplication or misuse of its products. © 2015 Johnson Controls, Inc.

R-118

Selection Chart (Part 3 of 3)

P100 Series Encapsulated Pressure Switches (Continued)

The performance specifications are nominal and conform to acceptable industry standards. For applications at conditions beyond these specifications, consult the local Johnson Controls office.

Product Code Number Switch Action Setpoints – psig (kPa) Replaces:
Opens Closes Ranco Robert- shaw Saginomiya Danfoss Klixon Supco Wilspec International Refrigeration Products Gemline
P100DA-35C 350

(2,413)

Lockout Manual Reset ACBPC45M
P100DC-3C3 375

(2,586)

Lockout Manual Reset SMR375
P100DA-1C 410

(2,827)

Lockout Manual Reset 3100-103 ACBPB115M 29PSL012-24 SMR410 HM202A410000D SMR410 PC 103
P100DA-100C Open on 415

(2,859)

Lockout Manual Reset 3100-103 29PSL004-1 HM202A415000D SMR410
Pressure
P100DA-101C 440

(3,032)

Lockout Manual Reset SMR440 SMR440
Rise
P100DA-2C 475

(3,275)

Lockout Manual Reset 3100-106 HM202A475000D
P100DA-86C 575

(3,964)

Lockout Manual Reset SMR575
P100DA-81C 630

(4,343)

Lockout Manual

Reset

SMR630
    1. Models are designed for condenser fan cycling.

Pressure Sensors and Accessories

    1. Includes conduit clamp for 3/8 in. flexible metal conduit.
    2. Includes conduit box with opening for 1/2 in. conduit connector.

Pressure Sensors and Accessories Code No. LIT-1900405

P499 Series Electronic Pressure Transducers

Description

The P499 Series Electronic Pressure Transducers are compact, economical, rugged, direct-mount pressure transducers designed for use in commercial refrigeration and air conditioning applications.

These transducers produce an analog signal based on the sensed pressure.

The P499 Series transducers feature environmentally protected electronics with stainless steel construction. The digitally compensated P499 transducers are highly accurate over a broad temperature range, resisting the effects of wide ambient temperature swings, high humidity, condensation, and icing.

The pressure port is machined from a solid piece of 17-4PH stainless steel. No O-rings, organic materials, or welds are exposed to the pressure media, allowing for a leak-proof, all-metal, sealed pressure system.

The P499 Series transducers operate with any corrosive or non-corrosive pressure medium that is compatible with 17-4PH

stainless steel, including water, condensate, carbon dioxide, glycol, most refrigerants (including ammonia), and many other compatible fluids and gases.

The P499 Series provides transducers in a variety of pressure ranges, covering most common refrigeration and air conditioning applications.

Features

• single-piece machined 17-4PH stainless steel pressure port provides a durable assembly that eliminates refrigerant loss due to O-ring or weld failures; resists damage due to physical shock, vibration, and pressure pulsations; enables use with non-corrosive or corrosive pressure media that is compatible with 17-4PH stainless steel.

• environmentally protected electronics withstand the effects of adverse conditions associated with typical HVAC/R applications, including freeze/thaw applications on suction lines.

• reliable, repeatable performance and long operating life minimizes service and replacement costs.

• many available pressure ranges provide a single line of transducers for all refrigeration and air conditioning application needs.

• 1% total error band provides high-accuracy performance.

• slender body design facilitates use of deep-socket wrenches for ease of installation; requires zero turning radius.

• CE and UL agency listings allow for global applications.

P499 Electronic Pressure Transducers; Style 47 Fitting Shown on the Left and Style 49 Fitting Shown on the Right

Refer to the P449 Series Electronic Pressure Transducer Product/Technical Bulletin (LIT-12011190) for important product application information.

Repair Information

If the P499 Series Electronic Pressure Transducer fails to operate within its specifications, replace the unit. For a replacement transducer, contact the nearest Johnson Controls® representative.

Accessories

P499 transducers require wire harnesses for all models that do not have an integral cable.

Wire Harnesses with Packard Electrical Connectors

Product Code Number1 Length
WHA-PKD3-200C 6-1/2 ft (2.0 m)
WHA-PKD3-400C 13 ft (4.0 m)
WHA-PKD3-600C 19-5/8 ft (6.0 m)

1. Wire harnesses for P399 transducers and P499 transducers are interchangeable.

Selection Chart

0.5 to 4.5 VDC Ratiometric P499 Transducer Models with Packard Electrical Connections, psis

Product Code Number Pressure Connection Pressure Range1 Individual or Kit2
Minimum Pressure (Pmin) Maximum Pressure (Pmax)
P499RAPS100C 1/8 in. 27 NPT External Thread (Style 49) -10 psis (-0.7 bar)

[20 in. Hg]

100 psis (6.9 bar) Individual
P499RAPS100K Kit
P499RAPS102C 0 psis (0 bar) 200 psis (13.8 bar) Individual
P499RAPS102K Kit
P499RCPS100C 1/4 in. SAE 45 Flare Internal Thread

(7/16-20 UNF) with Depressor (Style 47)

-10 psis (-0.7 bar)

[20 in. Hg]

100 psis (6.9 bar) Individual
P499RCPS100K Kit
P499RAPS102C 0 psis (0 bar) 200 psis (13.8 bar) Individual
P499RAPS102K Kit
  1. Transducer sealed and rated for IP67 harsh environments.
  2. The Individual pack comes with a transducer only – you must order the wire harness separately. The Kit is packaged with a transducer, 6-1/2 ft (2 m) wire harness, and technical documentation.

Pressure Sensors and Accessories

P499 Series Electronic Pressure Transducers (Continued)

0.5 to 4.5 VDC Ratiometric P499 Transducer Models with Integral 2 m (6-1/2 ft) Shielded Cable, psis

Product Code Number Pressure Connection Pressure Range1
Minimum Pressure (Pmin) Maximum Pressure (Pmax)
P499RCSS101C 1/4 in. SAE 45 Flare Internal Thread

(7/16-20 UNF) with Depressor (Style 47)

0 psis (0 bar) 100 psis (6.9 bar)

1. Transducer sealed and rated for IP67 harsh environments.

0.5 to 4.5 VDC Ratiometric P499 Transducer Models with Packard Electrical Connections, psi

Product Code Number Pressure Connection Pressure Range Individual or Kit1
Minimum Pressure (Pmin) Maximum Pressure (Pmax)
P499RAP-101C 1/8 in. 27 NPT External Thread (Style 49) 0 psi (0 bar) 100 psi (6.9 bar) Individual
P499RAP-101K Kit
P499RAP-102C 0 psi (0 bar) 200 psi (13.8 bar) Individual
P499RAP-105C 0 psi (0 bar) 500 psi (34.5 bar) Individual
P499RAP-105K Kit
P499RAP-107C 0 psi (0 bar) 750 psi (51.7 bar) Individual
P499RAP-107K Kit
P499RCP-101C 1/4 in. SAE 45 Flare Internal Thread (7/16-20 UNF) with Depressor (Style 47) 0 psi (0 bar) 100 psi (6.9 bar) Individual
P499RCP-101K Kit
P499RCP-105C 0 psi (0 bar) 500 psi (34.5 bar) Individual
P499RCP-105K Kit
P499RCP-107C 0 psi (0 bar) 750 psi (51.7 bar) Individual
P499RCP-107K Kit

1. The Individual pack comes with a transducer only – you must order the wire harness separately. The Kit is packaged with a transducer, 6-1/2 ft (2 m) wire harness, and technical documentation.

0 to 10 VDC P499 Transducer Models with Packard Electrical Connections, psi

Product Code

Number

Pressure Connection Pressure Range Individual or Kit1
Minimum Pressure

(Pmin)

Maximum Pressure

(Pmax)

P499VAP-101C 1/8 in. 27 NPT External Thread (Style 49) 0 psi (0 bar) 100 psi (6.9 bar) Individual
P499VAP-101K Kit
P499VAP-105C 0 psi (0 bar) 500 psi (34.5 bar) Individual
P499VAP-105K Kit
P499VAP-107C 0 psi (0 bar) 750 psi (51.7 bar) Individual
P499VAP-107K Kit
P499VCP-101C 1/4 in. SAE 45 Flare Internal Thread (7/16-20 UNF) with Depressor (Style 47) 0 psi (0 bar) 100 psi (6.9 bar) Individual
P499VCP-101K Kit
P499VCP-105C 0 psi (0 bar) 500 psi (34.5 bar) Individual
P499VCP-105K Kit
P499VCP-107C 0 psi (0 bar) 750 psi (51.7 bar) Individual
P499VCP-107K Kit

1. The Individual pack comes with a transducer only, you must order the wire harness separately. The Kit is packaged with a transducer, 6-1/2 ft (2 m) wire harness, and technical documentation.

4 to 20 mA P499 Transducer Models with Packard Electrical Connections, psi (Part 1 of 2)

Product Code

Number

Pressure Connection Pressure Range Individual or Kit1
Minimum Pressure (Pmin) Maximum Pressure (Pmax)
P499AAP-101C 1/8 in. 27 NPT External Thread (Style 49) 0 psi

(0 bar)

100 psi

(6.9 bar)

Individual
P499AAP-101K Kit
P499AAP-105C 0 psi

(0 bar)

500 psi

(34.5 bar)

Individual
P499AAP-105K Kit
P499AAP-107C 0 psi

(0 bar)

750 psi

(51.7 bar)

Individual
P499AAP-107K Kit

Pressure Sensors and Accessories

P499 Series Electronic Pressure Transducers (Continued)

4 to 20 mA P499 Transducer Models with Packard Electrical Connections, psi (Part 2 of 2)

Product Code

Number

Pressure Connection Pressure Range Individual or Kit1
Minimum Pressure (Pmin) Maximum Pressure (Pmax)
P499ACP-101C 1/4 in. SAE 45 Flare Internal Thread

(7/16-20 UNF) with Depressor (Style 47)

0 psi

(0 bar)

100 psi

(6.9 bar)

Individual
P499ACP-101K Kit
P499ACP-105C 0 psi

(0 bar)

500 psi

(34.5 bar)

Individual
P499ACP-105K Kit
P499ACP-107C 0 psi

(0 bar)

750 psi

(51.7 bar)

Individual
P499ACP-107K Kit
  1. The Individual pack comes with a transducer only, you must order the wire harness separately. The Kit is packaged with a transducer, 6-1/2 ft (2 m) wire harness, and technical documentation.

Technical Specifications

P499 Series Electronic Pressure Transducers
Pressure Ranges -10 to 100 psis, 0 to 100 psi, 0 to 200 psi, 0 to 500 psi, 0 to 750 psi
Maximum Working Pressure 2x Pressure Range; short duration; infrequent, abnormal condition
Burst Pressure 5x Pressure Range
Vacuum 30 microns (0.03 mm Hg); short term
Media Compatibility All media compatible with 17-4PH stainless steel, including ammonia
Output Signal 0.5 to 4.5 VDC, 0 to 10 VDC, or 4 to 20 mA
Supply Voltage 0.5 to 4.5 VDC Ratiometric Output 5.0 ±0.25 VDC, Safety Extra-Low Voltage (SELV) or Class 2
4 to 20 mA Output 9 to 30 VDC, SELV or Class 2
0 to 10 VDC Output 12 to 30 VDC, SELV or Class 2
Direct-Mount Pressure Connections 1/8 in. 27 NPT External Thread (Style 49),

1/4 in. SAE 45 Flare Internal Thread (7/16-20 UNF) with Depressor (Style 47)

Temperature and Humidity Storage -40 to 257F (-40 to 125C)
Operating -40 to 185F (-40 to 85C)
Compensated Range -4 to 185F (-20 to 85C)
Humidity 0 to 100% RH
Linearity ±0.25% Full Span best fit straight line
Accuracy ±1% Full Span (maximum) over compensated temperature range
Materials Pressure Port 17-4PH stainless steel construction
Packard Connector 40% glass-filled Polyetherimide (PEI)
Vibration 20G, 20 to 200 Hz
Shock 200G/11 ms
Compliance

United States UL Listed, File E29374, CCN NKPZ

UL Recognized for Use in Class I, Division 2 Hazardous Locations, File E322274

Canada UL Listed, File E29374, CCN NKPZ7

UL Recognized for Use in Class I, Division 2 Hazardous Locations, File E322274

Europe CE Mark – Johnson Controls, Inc., declares that this product is in compliance with the essential

requirements and other relevant provisions of the EMC Directive 2004/108/EC.

Australia/

New Zealand

C-Tick Mark, Emissions Compliant

Pressure Sensors and Accessories Code No. LIT-1900005

R310A Series Current Sensing Switch

Description

The R310A Series Current Sensing Switch detects alternating current (AC) flow in a single circuit without being connected to that circuit. It may be used in any application where current detection is required.

The R310A replaces the R10A used with Johnson Controls/PENN® time delay oil failure cutout controls such as the P28, P45, and P445. These applications incorporate internal line breaking overload protection, where lockout due to overload cycling is unacceptable or undesirable. The

R310A switch is not intended to detect breakage of belts.

The R310A is molded in a high dielectric material, which permits mounting inside a starter or contactor.

Refer to the R310A Series Current Sensing Switch Product Bulletin (LIT-121536) for important product application information.

Features

• small size allows mounting in small enclosure

• solid-state switching contains no moving parts to fail

• low 0.5 ampere activation allows monitoring of most small equipment circuit loads

• high 200 ampere monitoring capacity allows monitoring of heavy duty equipment

• large 0.70 in. (18 mm) diameter sensor hole accepts large diameter wire sizes and multiple coilings of smaller diameter wire sizes

Applications

The R310A Current Sensing Switch is designed to sense alternating current in a conductor that passes through its opening. The R310A sensor closes an electronic switch if the alternating current in the conductor exceeds 0.5 amperes. Thus, the R310A switch may be used for several purposes:

• switch a pilot circuit

• energize a run signal on a device such as a fan, motor, or pump

• monitor motors and electrical loads for proper operation

• monitor on/off status of process motors

The R310A Series Current Sensing Switch is available in two models. The R310AD-1 switch is for use in low-voltage applications, such as with the P445 Electronic Lube Oil Control. The R310AE-2 switch is for use in high-voltage applications, such as with the P28 and

P45 Electromechanical Lube Oil Controls.

The R310A switch avoids nuisance lockouts by sensing the lack of current flow to the motor. Regardless of the reason for motor shutdown, the lube oil control time delay circuit is de-energized when the current flow in the motor supply line drops below 0.5 amperes.

In a typical application, the lube oil control does not lock out when the control circuit shuts off the compressor. However, if the compressor overheats and the internal thermal overload circuits open,

the compressor shuts itself down, which causes the oil pressure to drop. This drop in oil pressure will energize the lube oil control heater (P28, P45) or timer (P445), causing a

R310A Series Current Sensing Switch

nuisance lockout. In this situation, the

R310 switch senses the lack of current to the motor, and is used to de-energize the time delay heater (P28, P45) or electronic timer (P445) before a nuisance lockout occurs.

Repair Information

If the R310A Series Current Sensing Switch fails to operate within its specifications, replace the unit. For a replacement switch, contact the nearest Johnson Controls® representative.

Selection Chart Technical Specifications

Product Code Number Description
R310AD-1C Current Sensing Switch

Voltage switching capacity: 0 to 30 VAC Used with: P445 Electronic Lube Oil Control

R310AE-2C Current Sensing Switch

Voltage switching capacity: 120 to 240 VAC Used with: P28 and P45 Electromechanical Lube Oil Controls

R310A Series Current Sensing Switch
Switch Action SPST, normally open
Current Sensing Range R310AD-1C 0.5 to 200 Amperes
R310AE-2C 0.75 to 200 Amperes
Switch Threshold R310AD-1C 0.5 Amperes
R310AE-2C 0.75 Amperes
Sensor Supply Voltage Induced from monitored conductor, isolation 600 VAC RMS
Switching Capacity (General Purpose) R310AD-1C 0.1A at 30 VAC/DC
R310AE-2C 0.5 at 250 VAC/DC
Output Polarity Non-polarity sensitive output
Enclosure NEMA 1
Ambient Operating Conditions 5 to 140°F (-15 to 60°C);

0 to 95% RH, noncondensing

Ambient Storage Conditions -40 to 158°F (-40 to 70°C);

0 to 95% RH

Dimensions (H x W x D) 2.34 x 1.85 x 0.875 in.

(59 x 46 x 22 mm)

Sensor Hole Size 7/10 in. (17 mm) Diameter
Agency Listings UL Guide NRNT cUL Guide NRNT7

Pressure Sensors and Accessories Code No. LIT-1900108

Universal Mounting Brackets

Description

The 271-51 is the universal mounting bracket used with many Johnson Controls/PENN® products. BKT38A-601R contains one mounting bracket with screws. BKT38A-600R contains five 271-51 angle mounting brackets with screws.

Selection Chart

Product Code

Number

Description
271-51 Universal Mounting Bracket
BKT38A-600R Five Universal Mounting Brackets with ten screws

271-51

Universal Mounting Bracket

Pressure Sensors and Accessories Code No. LIT-1900131

SEC99A UltraCap Armored Capillary

Description

The SEC99A UltraCap Armored Capillary is designed for use as a pressure connection in refrigeration and air conditioning applications. This small-orifice capillary minimizes pressure pulsation, and the brass armor sleeve improves resistance to abrasion caused by vibration. The copper capillary inside the armored sleeve allows no effusion of refrigerant to the environment.

Selection Chart

Product Code

Number

Description
Schrader Depressor in One End
SEC99AA-18C Two straight fittings

Length: 18 in. (457 mm)

SEC99AA-24C Two straight fittings Length: 24 in. (610 mm)
SEC99AA-36C Two straight fittings Length: 36 in. (914 mm)
SEC99AA-48C Two straight fittings Length: 48 in. (1,219 mm)
SEC99AA-60C Two straight fittings Length: 60 in. (1,524 mm)
Schrader Depressor in Both Ends
SEC99AB-18C One straight and one 90° fitting

Length: 18 in. (457 mm)

SEC99AB-24C One straight and one 90° fitting Length: 24 in. (610 mm)
SEC99AB-36C One straight and one 90° fitting Length: 36 in. (914 mm)
SEC99AB-48C One straight and one 90° fitting Length: 48 in. (1,219 mm)
SEC99AB-60C One straight and one 90° fitting Length: 60 in. (1,524 mm)

UltraCap is designed for use with 1/4 in. SAE external flare fitting connectors, such as those found on the Johnson Controls/PENN® lines of pressure-actuated controls. Integral Schrader valve depressors are available.

UltraCap Armored Capillary is compatible with all common non-corrosive refrigerants. The UltraCap capillary is available in a variety of lengths, and in models with two straight fittings or with one straight fitting and one 90° elbow fitting.

Repair Information

If the SEC99A UltraCap Armored Capillary fails to operate within its specifications, replace the unit. For a replacement capillary, contact the nearest Johnson Controls® representative.

Technical Specifications

SEC99AB and SEC99AA UltraCap Armored Capillaries

SEC99A UltraCap Armored Capillary
Capillary Diameters Inside: 0.062 in. (1 mm); Outside: 0.125 in. (3 mm)
Temperature Range -50 to 350°F (-46 to 177°C)
Burst Pressure 3,000 psig (20,685 kPa)
Maximum Working Pressure 600 psig (4,137 kPa)
Suggested Torque to Seal 8 to 10 lbft (10.9 to 13.6 Nm)
Fittings: Straight

90° Elbow Material

1/4 in. Internal Flare Connector with Schrader Depressor 1/4 in. Internal Flare Connector with Schrader Depressor Forged Brass Nut with Copper Stem
Agency Listings UL Recognized: File SA9457, CCN SFCS2

UL Recognized for Canada: SA9457, CCN SFCS8

Refrigerant Sensors/Monitors Code No. LIT-1900954

RLD-H10PRO Refrigerant Leak Detector

Description

The RLD-H10PRO is a professional-grade leak detector for use by refrigeration and air conditioning technicians. This detector senses all CFC, HCFC, and HFC refrigerants and blends, such as R12, R22, R134a, R404a, R410a, R502, and R507 among others. The RLD-H10PRO is self-powered with a rechargeable battery and provides both manual and automatic compensation for background levels of refrigerant. A full line of accessories and maintenance kits are also available, including replacement sensors, tuneup kits, probe extensions, battery chargers, and leak vial bottles.

Refer to the RLD-H10PRO Refrigerant Leak Detector Product Bulletin (LIT-12012073) for important product application information.

Features

  • positive ion emission heated diode sensor provides the most sensitivity available today, while still detecting all halogenated refrigerant gases

Selection Chart

Product Code

Number

Description
RLD-H10PRO-1 Refrigerant leak detector and

charger

Accessories

• rechargeable battery with low and full charge LEDs enhances portability—no external power required

• high quality air pump supplies constant airflow to the sensor so it responds quickly to leaks; also helps the sensor recover quickly after exposure to a refrigerant so the leak can be verified

• switchable adjustment for manual or automatic balance allows users to choose their preferred method of compensation for background refrigerant levels

• visual and audible signal facilitates sensing in noisy equipment rooms with 360° visibility and a piercing tone. Frequency of noise and light indicates the magnitude of the leak.

• headset jack allows users to hear the leak detector response in noisy environments

• external calibration source and calibration indicators indicate when the sensor is working properly and serves as a reference point to judge leak size

Technical Specifications

RLD-H10PRO Refrigerant Leak Detector
Power Requirements 12 VDC internal battery, or 100 to 240 VAC input/18 V output wall adaptor

(included) (RLD-H10-101).

Sensing Element Type Positive ion emission heated diode
Approximate Sensitivity1 Stationary 0.006 oz./yr
Moving (Per SAE J2791) 0.1 oz./yr
Automatic Background Adjustment Mode selection for automatic or manual background zeroing Manual background zeroing provides the best sensitivity.
Leak Alarm Audible alarm (through internal beeper or stereo headphone jack), visible red LED
Response Time Approximately 1 second
Warmup Time Approximately 2 minutes
Probe Length Approximately 4-1/2 ft (1.4 m)
Ambient Operating Conditions 32 to 104°F (0 to 40°C); 5-90% RH, noncondensing
Ambient Storage Conditions 14 to 140°F (-10 to 60°C); 5-90% RH, noncondensing
Case Rugged high-density polyethylene
Dimensions (H x W x D) 5-2/5 x 10-1/2 x 8-3/10 in. (137 x 267 x 211 mm)
Compliance Europe: CE Mark Johnson Controls, Inc. declares that this product is in compliance with the essential requirements and other relevant provisions of the EMC Directive 2004/108/EC.
Shipping Weight 5.1 lb (2.3 kg)

RLD-H10PRO Refrigerant Leak Detector

Repair Information

If the RLD-H10PRO Refrigerant Leak Detector fails to operate within its specifications, contact Johnson Controls® application engineering at (414) 524-5535.

Product Code

Number

Description
RLD-H10-100 14 inch flexible probe extension
RLD-H10-101 120 VAC power supply adaptor
RLD-H10-102 Cigarette lighter adaptor
RLD-H10-103 Replacement battery charger
RLD-H10-105 Belt pack battery
RLD-H10-600R Tuneup kit: includes sensor, 100 filters, three airflow balls, three rubber probe tips, and leak vial
RLD-H10-601R Replacement sensor
RLD-H10-602R Maintenance kit: includes 100 filters, three airflow balls, three rubber probe tips, and leak vial
RLD-H10-603R Replacement leak vial
RLD-H10-604R Replacement for RLD-H10PRO internal battery
RLD-H10-606R Clear plastic probe tip
RLD-H10-607R Probe replacement assembly
    1. Sensitivity for R12, R22, R134a, R410a, R404a, and R507 when unit is set to small leak setting, manual mode.

Refrigerant Sensors/Monitors Code No. LIT-1900116

RLD Refrigerant Leak Detector Accessories and Replacement Parts

Description

These parts are used on the RLD-H10G-1 and on the RLD-H10PRO-1.

Selection Chart

Product Code Number Description Figure
RLD-H10-100 14 in. Flexible Probe Extension
RLD-H10-600R Tune-up Kit; Includes: One Sensor,

100 Filters,

Three Airflow Indicator Balls, Three Probe Tips,

One Leak Vial

RLD-H10-601R Replacement Sensor
RLD-H10-602R Maintenance Kit; Includes: 100 Replacement Filters, Three Airflow Indicator Balls, Three Probe Tips
RLD-H10-603R Replacement Leak Vial
RLD-H10-606R Replacement Clear Plastic Probe Tip
RLD-H10-607R Replacement Probe Assembly

Liquid Level and Flow Controls Code No. LIT-1922325

F59 Series Sump Pump Switch

Description

The F59 Series Controls are designed to start an electric motor on liquid level rise and stop the motor on liquid level drop. The control cuts in when upper weight is submerged approximately halfway, and cuts out when lower weight is approximately half-exposed.

Each switch includes 36 in. cable and two weights.

Refer to the F59 Series Liquid Level Switch for Sump Operations Product Bulletin

(LIT-125215) for important product application information.

Type F59A, F59H

F59A-2 Sump Pump Switch F59H-1 Sump Pump Switch

Line

Line

M2

M1

Action on Rise in Liquid Level

f59.eps

F59 Series Action Diagram

Features

F59D-5 is equipped with a power cord and a piggyback style plug. The external prongs plug into the wall outlet, and the sump pump cord plugs into the internal end of the plug.

Applications

Use for On/Off control of sump pumps.

Technical Specifications

Electrical Ratings

Selection Charts

Product Code

Number

Contact

Action

Mounting Range

Adjuster

F59A-1C Double-Pole,

Single-Throw (DPST)

External mounting bracket Drop cord wiring
F59A-2C DPST External mounting – includes universal mounting bracket and 24 in. strap for quick, easy mounting on the motor, on the pedestal or on the discharge pipe. Drop cord wiring
F59H-1C DPST External mounting bracket Conduit wiring –7/8 in. conduit openings in case

Replacement Parts

Product Code

Number

Replacement Weight Kit for F59 Series
WGT11A-600R Two Weights (Floats), 40 in. Plastic Cable, Weights with 3 in. Polyethylene Cable
WGT11A-604R Two Weights (Floats), 36 in. Monel Wire, Two Float Support Plates, Weights with 3 in. Monel Cable
Volts Horsepower
F59A-1
120 VAC 1 hp
240 VAC 1 hp
32 VDC 1/4 hp
F59A-2
120 VAC 1 hp
240 VAC 1 hp
32 VDC 1/4 hp
F59D-5
120 VAC 1/2 hp
F59H-1
120 VAC 1 hp
240 VAC 1 hp
32 VDC 1/4 hp

Liquid Level and Flow Controls Code No. LIT-1900948

F261 Series Fluid Flow Switches

Description

The F261 Series Flow Switches respond to fluid flow in lines carrying water, ethylene glycol, or other nonhazardous fluids. These models also work in applications with swimming pool water and lubricating oils.

F261 Series Standard Flow Switches use a variety of paddle sizes to respond to fluid flow rates in applications with pipe sizes greater than 1 inch trade size.

Refer to the F261 Series Fluid Flow Switches Product Bulletin (LIT-12011987) for important product application information.

Selection Chart

F261 Series Standard Model Flow Switches

Features

  • Type 3R (NEMA) or Type 4 (NEMA) enclosure allows use in indoor or outdoor applications.
  • Viton® diaphragms allow use in fluid lines carrying chlorinated water, treated water, or other nonhazardous fluids.
  • low-flow operation on low-flow models actuates switch with less than

1.0 GPM (3.8 L/min) flow for water applications or 9.0 GPM (34.1 L/min) flow for steam applications.

  • maximum fluid pressure of 290 psig (20 bar) permits use in a wide range of pressure flow conditions.

Repair Information

If the F261 Series Flow Switch fails to operate within its specifications, replace the unit. For a replacement F261 Series Flow Switch, contact the nearest Johnson Controls® representative.

F261 Flow Switch

Product Code Number Description
F261KAH-V01C Standard model flow switch with Type 3R (NEMA) enclosure; 1 in., 2 in., 3 in., and 6 in. stainless steel paddles, lock-tooth washer,

and stainless steel paddle screw supplied uninstalled

F261MAH-V01C Standard model flow switch with Type 4 (NEMA) enclosure; 1 in., 2 in., 3 in., and 6 in. stainless steel paddles, lock-tooth washer, and stainless steel paddle screw supplied uninstalled
F261MAL-V01C Standard model flow switch with Type 4 (NEMA) enclosure; 1 in., 2 in., 3 in., and 6 in. stainless steel paddles, lock-tooth washer, and stainless steel paddle supplied uninstalled.

F261 Series Low-Flow Model Flow Switches

Product Code Number Description
F261KEH-V01C Low-flow model flow switch with Type 3R (NEMA) enclosure; 1/2 in. x 1/2 in. External NPTF inlet and outlet
F261KFH-V01C Low-flow model flow switch with Type 3R (NEMA) enclosure; 3/4 in. x 3/4 in. External NPTF inlet and outlet
F261KFH-V02C Low-flow model flow switch with Type 3R (NEMA) enclosure; 3/4 in. x 3/4 in. External NPTF inlet and outlet
F261MEH-V01C Low-flow model flow switch with Type 4 (NEMA) enclosure; 1/2 in. x 1/2 in. External NPTF inlet and outlet
F261MFH-V01C Low-flow model flow switch with Type 4 (NEMA) enclosure; 3/4 in x 3/4 in. External NPTF inlet and outlet

Replacement Paddle Parts

Product Code Number Description
KIT21A-600 Stainless steel three-piece paddle (3 in., 2 in., and 1 in. segments)
KIT21A-601 Stainless steel 6 in. paddle
PLT52A-600R Stainless steel three-piece paddle (3 in., 2 in., and 1 in. segments) and Stainless steel 6 in. paddle

Technical Specifications

F261xxH Series Standard Controls Electrical Ratings

Volts, 50/60 Hz UL60730/UL1059 EN60730
24 120 208 240 24 230
Horsepower 1 1 1
Full Load Amperes 16 10 10 8
Locked Rotor Amperes 96 60 60 48
Resistive Amperes 16 16 10 10 16 16
Pilot Duty VA 125 720 720 720 77 720

Liquid Level and Flow Controls

F261 Series Fluid Flow Switches (Continued)

UL Conformity Declaration Information

Information Description
Purpose of Control F261 Fluid Flow Switch
Construction of Control Electronic independently mounted control
Number of Cycles 100,000 cycles
Method of Mounting Control Mounting to sensed media vessel/orientation
Type 1 or Type 2 Action Type 1.C (Microinterruption)
External Pollution Situation Pollution degree 4
Internal Pollution Situation Pollution degree 2
Rated Impulse Voltage 4,000 VAC
Ball Pressure Temperature Enclosure: 266°F (130°C)

Switch Component: 252°F (122°C)

Control Adjustment Instruction
Field Wiring Rating Wire/Cord Temperature Ratings:

140°F (60°C) only permitted when ambient air and media are less than 113°F (45°C) 167°F (75°C) only permitted when ambient air and media are less than 140°F (60°C)

194°F (90°C) only permitted when ambient air is less than 140°F (60°C) and media is less than 167°F (75°C) 302°F (150°C) permitted when ambient air is less than 140°F (60°C) and media is less than 249°F (121°C)

Vessel Pressure F261 Fluid Flow Switch: 290 psi (20 Bar)
F261 Series Fluid Flow Switches
Switch Single-Pole, Double-Throw (SPDT)
Enclosure UL: Type 3R or Type 4

CE: IP43 (IP23 with drain hole plug removed) or IP67

Wiring Connections Three color-coded screw terminals and one ground terminal
Conduit Connection One 7/8 in. (22 mm) hole for 1/2 in. trade size (or PG16) conduit
Pipe Connector Standard: 1 in. 11-1/2 NPT Threads
Maximum Fluid Pressure 290 psi (20 bar)
Minimum Fluid Temperature1 -20°F (-29°C)
Maximum Fluid Temperature2 250°F (121°C)
Ambient Conditions -40 to 140°F (-40 to 60°C)
Compliance

North America: cULus Listed; UL 60730, File E6688; FCC Compliant to CFR47, Part 15, Subpart B, Class B

Industry Canada (IC) Compliant to Canadian ICES-003, Class B limits

Europe: CE Mark – Johnson Controls, Inc. declares that this product is in compliance with the essential requirements and

other relevant provisions of the EMC Directive and the Low Voltage Directive.

Australia/New Zealand Mark: RCM Compliant
  1. Ensure that the low liquid temperature combined with the low ambient temperature does not lead to the freezing the liquid inside the body (or bellows, where appropriate). Please observe the liquid freezing point.
  2. At higher ambient temperatures, the maximum allowed liquid temperature becomes lower. The temperature of the electrical switch inside should not exceed 158°F (70°C).

Liquid Level and Flow Controls Code No. LIT-1900949

F262 Airflow Switch

Description

The F262 Airflow Switch detects airflow or the absence of airflow by responding only to the velocity of air movement within a duct. The single-pole, double-throw (SPDT) control can be wired to open one circuit and close a second circuit for either signaling or interlock purposes.

Airflow failure during the normal operation of air handling systems may cause overheating, coil icing, or other conditions that may be detrimental to the equipment.

Refer to the F262 Airflow Switch Product Bulletin (LIT-12011988) for important product application information.

Application

The F262 switch detects airflow or the absence of airflow by responding only to the velocity of air movement within a duct. The SPDT control can be wired to open one circuit and close a second circuit for either signaling or interlock purposes.

Failure of airflow during the normal operation of air handling systems may cause overheating, coil icing, and other conditions that may be detrimental to the equipment.

Typical applications include:

  • Make-up air systems
  • Air cooling or heating processes
  • Exhaust systems

The control has a Type 3R (NEMA) enclosure with an integral mounting plate. A mounting plate gasket is supplied with each switch.

Features

  • Type 3R (NEMA) Polycarbonate enclosure allows use in indoor applications and provides dust protection and is approved for use in a plenum according to NEC
  • dependable dust-protected SPDT snap-acting PENN switch detects the presence or absence of airflow
  • large wiring space makes wiring convenient and easily accessible
  • easily accessible range adjustment screw allows easy field adjustment

F262 Airflow Control

Repair Information

If the F262 Airflow Switch fails to operate within its specifications, replace the unit. For a replacement F262 Airflow Switch, contact the nearest Johnson Controls® representative.

Selection Charts

F262 Airflow Switch

Product Code Number Description
F262KDH-01C Airflow switch with a 2-1/8 in. wide x 6-7/8 in. long (54 mm x 175 mm) paddle installed and a

3-1/8 in. wide x 6-7/8 in. long (79 mm x 175 mm) paddle supplied with the control

Replacement Paddle Kits for F262 Switch

Product Code Number Description
PLT112-1R 2-1/8 in. wide x 6-7/8 in. long (54 mm x 175 mm) paddle
PLT112-2R 3-1/8 in. wide x 6-7/8 in. long (79 mm x 175 mm) paddle

Technical Specifications

F262 Switch Electrical Ratings

Volts 50/60 Hz UL60730 EN60730
24 120 208 240 24 230
Horsepower 1 1 1
Full Load Amperes 16 10 10 8
Locked Rotor Amperes 96 60 60 48
Resistive Amperes 16 16 10 10 16 16
Plot Duty VA 125 720 720 720 125 720

Liquid Level and Flow Controls

F262 Airflow Switch (Continued)

F262 Series Airflow Switch
Switch SPDT
Enclosure UL: Type 3R CE: IP43
Wiring Connections Three color-coded screw terminals and one ground terminal
Conduit Connection One 7/8 in. (22 mm) hole for 1/2 in. trade size (or PG16) conduit
Paddle Material 0.006 in. (0.15 mm) stainless spring steel
Maximum Air Velocity 2,000 FPM (10.16 m/s)
Maximum Duct Air Temperature 176°F (80°C)
Ambient Conditions 32 to 104°F (0 to 40°C)
Compliance

North America: cULus Listed; UL 60730, File E6688; FCC Compliant to CFR47, Part 15, Subpart B, Class B

Industry Canada (IC) Compliant to Canadian ICES-003, Class B limits

Europe: CE Mark – Johnson Controls, Inc. declares that this product is in compliance with the essential

requirements and other relevant provisions of the EMC Directive and the Low Voltage Directive.

Australia/New Zealand Mark: RCM Compliant

Liquid Level and Flow Controls Code No. LIT-1900950

F263 Series Liquid Level Float Switches

Description

The F263 Series Liquid Level Float Switches are designed to maintain a liquid level in indoor or outdoor closed tanks that hold water or other nonhazardous liquids. When the liquid level in the tank rises above or falls below the required level, the single-pole, double-throw (SPDT) switch closes one circuit and opens a second circuit.

Refer to the F263 Series Liquid Level Float Switches Product Bulletin (LIT-12011989) for important product application information.

Application

Use F263 Series Float Switches in closed tanks where a liquid level is to be maintained. A change in the liquid level opens or closes an electrical circuit.

Use F263MAP switches on indoor or outdoor tanks that hold water or other nonhazardous liquids at temperatures greater than the liquid’s freezing point and between -20°F

(-29°C) and 212°F (100°C). The maximum allowable liquid pressure is 150 psig (1,035 kpa).

Use F263MAC switches on indoor or outdoor tanks that hold water or other nonhazardous liquids at temperatures greater than the liquid’s freezing point and between -20°F

(-29°C) and 250°F (121°C). The maximum allowable liquid pressure is 100 psig

(690 kpa).

Note: Do not use these float switches with liquids that are lighter than water.

Features

  • Viton® diaphragm allows use in fluid lines carrying chlorinated water, treated water, or other nonhazardous liquids.
  • single-pole, double-throw switch provides control where liquid levels rise and fall
  • sturdy Type 4 (NEMA) enclosure allows for use in indoor or outdoor applications; inhibits the formation of moisture in low temperature applications.
  • solid polycarbonate float

(F263MAP models) provides greater resistance to corrosion

F263 Liquid Level Float Switch

Repair Information

If the F263 Series Liquid Level Float Switch fails to operate within its specifications, replace the unit. For a replacement

F263 Switch, contact the nearest Johnson Controls® representative.

Selection Chart

Product Code Number Description
F263MAC-V01C SPDT float switch with Type 4 (NEMA) enclosure and copper float for liquid temperatures

-20 to 250°F (-29 to 121°C); maximum liquid pressure 100 psig (690 kPa)

F263MAP-V01C SPDT float switch with Type 4 (NEMA) enclosure and polycarbonate float for liquid temperatures

-20 to 212°F (-29 to 100°C); maximum liquid pressure 150 psig (1,035 kPa)

Technical Specifications

F263 Switch Electrical Ratings

Volts 50/60 Hz UL60730 EN60730
24 120 208 240 24 230
Horsepower 1 1 1
Full Load Amperes 16 10 10 8
Locked Rotor Amperes 96 60 60 48
Resistive Amperes 16 16 10 10 16 16
Plot Duty VA 125 720 720 720 125 720

Liquid Level and Flow Controls

F263 Series Liquid Level Float Switches (Continued)

F263 Series Liquid Level Float Switches
Switch SPDT
Enclosure UL: Type 4 (NEMA) CE: IP67
Wiring Connections Three color-coded screw terminals and one ground terminal
Conduit Connection One 7/8 in. (22 mm) hole for 1/2 in. trade size (or PG16) conduit
Pipe Connector 1 in. 11-1/2 NPT threads
Minimum Tank Diameter 9 in. (229 mm)
Maximum Liquid Pressure 100 psig (690 kPa) for copper float

150 psig (1,035 kPa) for polycarbonate float

Liquid Temperature Range Minimum: -20°F (-29°C) or liquid freezing point

Maximum: 212°F (100°C) polycarbonate, 250°F (121°C) copper

Ambient Conditions Minimum: -40°F (-40°C) Maximum: 140°F (60°C)
Compliance

North America: cULus Listed; UL 60730, File E6688; FCC Compliant to CFR47, Part 15, Subpart B, Class B

Industry Canada (IC) Compliant to Canadian ICES-003, Class B limits

Europe: CE Mark – Johnson Controls, Inc. declares that this product is in compliance with the essential

requirements and other relevant provisions of the EMC Directive and the Low Voltage Directive.

Australia/New Zealand Mark: RCM Compliant

Liquid Level and Flow Controls Code No. LIT-1922525

F61 and F62 Series Replacement Paddles

Selection Chart

Replacement Kit Number Description
KIT21A-600 3-in-1 stainless steel paddle kit for F61 Series
KIT21A-601 6 in. stainless steel paddle kit for F61 Series
PLT112-1 Replacement paddle for F62AA-8
PLT112-2 Replacement paddle for F62AA-9

Liquid Level and Flow Controls Code No. LIT-1922350

F92 Series Air Volume Controls for Shallow Wells

Description

The F92 Series Air Volume Controls for Shallow Wells control the amount of air in the residential water storage tanks of shallow well water systems. Shallow wells are less than 25 ft. (7.6 m) deep.

F92 Series Controls automatically maintain air volume in the storage tanks of shallow well water systems by allowing room air to enter into the air charging section of the pump when the water level in the tank rises (loss of air volume).

F92 Controls open the air valve on a rise in tank water level to permit charging air into the storage tank with pressures up to

80 psig (552 kPa).

Refer to the F92 Series Air Volume Controls for Shallow Wells Product Bulletin (Part No. 24-7664-2993) for important product application information.

Features

  • sturdy Noryl (high performance thermoplastic) body resists mechanical damage and corrosion.
  • brass internal operating parts minimize corrosion.
  • pressure tested plastic float provides long operating life.
  • optional pressure gauge tapping allows mounting of a pressure gauge.

Selection Chart

Product Code

Number

Description
F92A-4C Air Volume Control for Shallow Wells, opens on pressure rise, barbed fitting on charger valve
F92B-1C Air Volume Control for Shallow Wells, opens on pressure rise, 1/4-18 PTF SAE short gage tap, 0.016 in. (0.5 mm) valve orifice. Use this model in applications where excessive airflow may reduce water pumping capacity.
F92B-2C Air Volume Control for Shallow Wells, opens on pressure rise, 1/4-18 PTF SAE short gage tap

Technical Specifications

F92 Series Air Volume Control for Shallow Wells

Application

Water storage tanks in residential water systems rely on a volume of air in the tank to provide system pressure, making it important to control the amount of air in the tank:

  • Too little air in the tank results in rapid pump cycling — a problem common in shallow well systems (less than 25 ft [7.6 m] deep).
  • Too much air in the tank results in air entering the distribution system — a problem common in deep well systems

(more than 25 ft [7.6 m] deep).

Repair Information

If the F92 Series Air Volume Controls for Shallow Wells fails to operate within its specifications, replace the unit. For a replacement F92 Series control, contact the nearest Johnson Controls® representative.

F92 Series Air Volume Control for Shallow Wells
Body Material 30% glass-filled Noryl thermoplastic
Float Material Plastic with brass rod
Maximum Tank Pressure 80 psig (552 kPa)
Shipping Weight Individual: 0.25 lb (0.11 kg)

Bulk pack (30): 30.9 lb (4.08 kg)

Tank Connector Size 1-1/4 in. external NPT
Air Flow Restrictor Orifice F92B-1C Model: 0.016 in. (0.5 mm)
Snifter Line Connection Flare fitting for 3/16 in. (5 mm) tubing

Liquid Level and Flow Controls Code No. LIT-1922355

F93 Series Air Volume Controls for Deep Wells

Description

The F93 Series Air Volume Controls for Deep Wells control the amount of air in the residential water storage tanks of deep well water systems. Deep wells are more than 25 ft (7.6 m) deep.

F93 Series Controls automatically maintain air volume in the storage tanks of deep well water systems by allowing air to escape from the tank and into the surrounding room when the water level in the tank drops (increase of air volume).

F93 deep well controls open the air valve on a fall in tank water level to bleed excess air from the tank at pressures up to 100 psig (690 kPa).

The F93H has a minimum pressure release valve to avoid lowering tank pressure below 25 psig (172 kPa). Use this model on applications where water may be rapidly drained.

Refer to the F93 Series Air Volume Controls for Deep Wells Product Bulletin (Part No. 24-7664-3000) for important product application information.

Features

  • sturdy Noryl (high performance thermoplastic) body resists mechanical damage and corrosion.
  • brass internal operating parts minimize corrosion.
  • pressure tested plastic float provides long operating life.
  • optional pressure gauge tapping allows mounting of a pressure gauge.
  • certification for Federal Safe Drinking Water Act (SDWA) meets the US Federal standards of the Reduction of Lead in Drinking Water Act.

Selection Chart

Product Code

Number

Description
F93A-1C Air Volume Control for Deep Wells, opens on pressure drop, no gage tap, no pressure release valve
F93B-1C Air Volume Control for Deep Wells, opens on pressure drop, 1/4-18 PTF SAE short gage tap, no pressure release valve
F93H-1C Air Volume Control for Deep Wells, opens on pressure drop, 1/4-18 PTF SAE short gage tap, with

25 psig (172 kPa) minimum air pressure release valve. Use this model in applications where water may be rapidly drawn from the system.

Technical Specifications

F93 Series Air Volume Control for Deep Wells

Application

Water storage tanks in residential water systems rely on a volume of air in the tank to provide system pressure, making it important to control the amount of air in the tank:

  • Too little air in the tank results in rapid pump cycling – a problem common in shallow well systems (less than 7.6 m [25 ft] deep).
  • Too much air in the tank results in air entering the distribution system — a problem common in deep well systems

(more than 7.6 m [25 ft] deep).

Repair Information

If the F93 Series Air Volume Controls for Deep Wells fails to operate within its specifications, replace the unit. For a replacement F93 Series control, contact the nearest Johnson Controls® representative.

F93 Series Air Volume Control for Deep Wells
Body Material 30% glass-filled Noryl thermoplastic
Float Material Plastic with brass rod
Maximum Tank Pressure 100 psig (690 kPa)
Shipping Weight Individual: 0.25 lb (0.11 kg)

Bulk pack (30): 30.9 lb (4.08 kg)

Tank Connector Size 1-1/4 in. external NPT
Compliance United States Federal Safe Drinking Water Act (SDWA) Compliant,

Underwriters Laboratories Classified in Accordance with NSF/ANSI 372 (File MH59894)

Motor Speed Controls Code No. LIT-1900595

P266 Series Single-Phase Condenser Fan Speed Control

Description

The P266 Series Single-Phase Condenser Fan Speed Control is a cost-effective, weather-resistant, durable motor speed control. The P266 Series Controls are designed for approved single-phase, Permanent Split-Capacitor (PSC) motors commonly used in a wide variety of refrigeration and air conditioning condenser fan applications.

The P266 Series Controls are designed to replace the Johnson Controls® P66 Series and P215 Series fan speed controls, providing additional features and flexibility, greater energy efficiency, and longer motor life in a compact, rugged, weather-resistant package.

P266 Series Controls are available for 208 through 575 VAC 50/60 Hz range applications. P266 Series controls have

current ratings from 4 to 12 A, depending on the voltage and model.

Some P266 Series Controls provide optional control of up to three auxiliary (fixed-speed) fans or fan stages. In addition, some models provide two additional high-voltage triacs that allow you to split the source power to the main and auxiliary windings, and connect a

low-speed capacitor to increase efficiency at low-speed operation.

Refer to the P266 Series Single-Phase Condenser Fan Speed Control Product Bulletin (LIT-12011534) for important product application information.

Features

  • one or two durable, accurate, stainless steel, remote-mount pressure transducers
  • available in 208/240 VAC (8 or 12 A), 380/460 VAC (4 A), or 460/575 VAC (4 A)
  • wide, adjustable pressure throttling range
  • optional auxiliary fan control
  • optional low-speed capacitor mode
  • NEMA 3R, (IP54) enclosure with integral metal heat-sink and stand-off mounting feet

Application

The P266 Series Single-Phase Condenser Fan Speed Control, in conjunction with a P266 Series Electronic Pressure Transducer, is a pressure-actuated, digital electronic motor speed control designed for approved

single-phase, PSC motors used in a wide variety of HVAC/R applications.

The P266 Series Fan Speed Control regulates supply voltage to the fan motor in response to the condenser refrigerant pressure and maintains the appropriate fan speed (air movement) through the condenser regardless of the ambient temperature or air delivery variations.

The P266 Series control is housed in a NEMA 3R (IP54) rainproof enclosure for outdoor applications.

The P266 Series control is an energy efficient and effective alternative to On/Off fan-cycling controls, multiple-speed motors, temperature fan-speed controls, modulating air-damper systems, condenser flood-back systems, and other condenser pressure control methods.

P266 Series Single-Phase Condenser Fan Speed Control

P266 Series Fan Speed Control applications include:

  • computer room air conditioning
  • commercial refrigeration
  • commercial air conditioning

Repair Information

If a P266 Series Single-Phase Condenser Fan Speed Control fails to operate within its specifications, replace the unit. For a replacement P266 Series control, contact the nearest Johnson Controls® representative.

Selection Charts

P266 Series Fan Speed Control Model and Kit Product Code Numbers, Descriptions, and Details (Part 1 of 2)

Product Code

Number

Description Transducer

Model Included in Kit

Voltage

(VAC)

Maximum

Output Amperes

High

VAC

Triacs

Available

Auxiliary Fan Control Circuits1

P266AAA-100C2 P266 Fan Speed Control (only) N/A 208/240 8 3 0
P266ABA-100C2 P266 Fan Speed Control (only) N/A 208/240 8 3 3
P266ACA-100C2 P266 Fan Speed Control (only) N/A 208/240 8 1 0
P266ADA-100C2 P266 Fan Speed Control (only) N/A 208/240 8 1 3
P266BGA-100C2 P266 Fan Speed Control (only) N/A 460/575 4 2 0
P266BHA-100C2 P266 Fan Speed Control (only) N/A 460/575 4 2 3
P266BCA-100C2 P266 Fan Speed Control (only) N/A 460/575 4 1 0
P266BDA-100C2 P266 Fan Speed Control (only) N/A 460/575 4 1 3
P266CHA-100C2 P266 Fan Speed Control (only) N/A 380/460 4 2 3
P266ABA-1K2 P266 Fan Speed Control with one P266 Pressure Transducer and one 2 m (6.6 ft) cable P266SNR-1C, 0 to 35 bar

(0 to 508 psig)

208/240 8 3 3
P266ABA-3K2 P266 Fan Speed Control with one P266 Pressure Transducer and one 2 m (6.6 ft) cable P266SNR-2C, 0 to 52 bar

(0 to 754 psig)

208/240 8 3 3

Motor Speed Controls

P266 Series Single-Phase Condenser Fan Speed Control (Continued)

P266 Series Fan Speed Control Model and Kit Product Code Numbers, Descriptions, and Details (Part 2 of 2)

Product Code

Number

Description Transducer

Model Included in Kit

Voltage

(VAC)

Maximum

Output Amperes

High

VAC

Triacs

Available

Auxiliary Fan Control Circuits1

P266ABA-2K2 P266 Fan Speed Control with two P266 Pressure Transducers

and two 2 m (6 ft 7-1/5 in.) cables

P266SNR-1C, 0 to 35 bar

(0 to 508 psi)

208/240 8 3 3
P266ABA-4K2 P266 Fan Speed Control with two P266 Pressure Transducers and two 2 m (6 ft 7-1/5 in.) cables P266SNR-2C, 0 to 52 bar

(0 to 754 psi)

208/240 8 3 3
P266BHA-1K2 P266 Fan Speed Control with one P266 Pressure Transducer and one 2 m (6 ft 7-1/5 in.) cable P266SNR-1C, 0 to 35 bar

(0 to 508 psi)

460/575 4 2 3
P266BHA-3K2 P266 Fan Speed Control with one P266 Pressure Transducer and one 2 m (6 ft 7-1/5 in.) cable P266SNR-2C, 0 to 52 bar

(0 to 754 psi)

460/575 4 2 3
P266BHA-2K2 P266 Fan Speed Control with two P266 Pressure Transducers and two 2 m (6 ft 7-1/5 in.) cables P266SNR-1C, 0 to 35 bar

(0 to 508 psi)

460/575 4 2 3
P266BHA-4K2 P266 Fan Speed Control with two P266 Pressure Transducers and two 2 m (6 ft 7-1/5 in.) cables P266SNR-2C, 0 to 52 bar

(0 to 754 psi)

460/575 4 2 3
P266EAA-1K2 P266 Fan Speed Control with Internal Transformer and one

P266 Pressure Transducer and one 2 m (6 ft 7-1/5 in.) cable

P266SNR-1C, 0 to 35 bar

(0 to 508 psi)

208/240 8 3 0
P266EAA-3K2 P266 Fan Speed Control with Internal Transformer and one

P266 Pressure Transducer and one 2 m (6 ft 7-1/5 in.) cable

P266SNR-2C, 0 to 52 bar

(0 to 754 psi)

208/240 8 3 0
P266EBA-1K2 P266 Fan Speed Control with Internal Transformer and one

P266 Pressure Transducer and one 2 m (6 ft 7-1/5 in.) cable

P266SNR-1C, 0 to 35 bar

(0 to 508 psi)

208/240 8 3 3
P266EBA-3K2 P266 Fan Speed Control with Internal Transformer and one

P266 Pressure Transducer and one 2 m (6 ft 7-1/5 in.) cable

P266SNR-2C, 0 to 52 bar

(0 to 754 psi)

208/240 8 3 3
P266ECA-1K2 P266 Fan Speed Control with Internal Transformer and one

P266 Pressure Transducer and one 2 m (6 ft 7-1/5 in.) cable

P266SNR-1C, 0 to 35 bar

(0 to 508 psi)

208/240 8 1 0
P266ECA-3K P266 Fan Speed Control with Internal Transformer and one

P266 Pressure Transducer and one 2 m (6 ft 7-1/5 in.) cable

P266SNR-2C, 0 to 52 bar

(0 to 754 psi)

208/240 8 1 0
P266EDA-1K2 P266 Fan Speed Control with Internal Transformer and one

P266 Pressure Transducer and one 2 m (6 ft 7-1/5 in.) cable

P266SNR-1C, 0 to 35 bar

(0 to 508 psi)

208/240 8 1 3
P266EDA-3K2 P266 Fan Speed Control with Internal Transformer and one

P266 Pressure Transducer and one 2 m (6 ft 7-1/5 in.) cable

P266SNR-2C, 0 to 52 bar

(0 to 754 psi)

208/240 8 1 3
P266EEA-1K2 P266 Fan Speed Control with Internal Transformer and one

P266 Pressure Transducer and one 2 m (6 ft 7-1/5 in.) cable

P266SNR-1C, 0 to 35 bar

(0 to 508 psi)

208/240 12 1 0
P266EEA-3K2 P266 Fan Speed Control with Internal Transformer and one

P266 Pressure Transducer and one 2 m (6 ft 7-1/5 in.) cable

P266SNR-2C,

0 to 52 bar (0 to 754 psi)

208/240 12 1 0
P266EFA-1K2 P266 Fan Speed Control with Internal Transformer and one

P266 Pressure Transducer and one 2 m (6 ft 7-1/5 in.) cable

P266SNR-1C, 0 to 35 bar

(0 to 508 psi)

208/240 12 1 3
  1. 24 VAC Class 2 at 1/4 A.
  2. Factory default settings: Start Voltage is set to 40% of the supply line-voltage. End Voltage is set to 95% of the supply line-voltage. Start Pressure is set to 44% of the P266 Transducer’s total pressure range. End Pressure is set to 51% of the P266 Transducer’s total pressure range.

P266 Series SNR Electronic Pressure Transducers

Product Code

Number

Description
P266SNR-1C Electronic Pressure Transducer: 0 to 35 bar (0 to 508 psi) total range with a 1/4 in. SAE Internal Flare connection and a 2 meter

(6 ft 7-1/5 in.) cable.

P266SNR-2C Electronic Pressure Transducer: 0 to 52 bar (0 to 754 psi) total range with a 1/4 in. SAE Internal Flare connection and a 2 meter (6 ft 7-1/5 in.) cable.

Motor Speed Controls

P266 Series Single-Phase Condenser Fan Speed Control (Continued)

Technical Specifications

P266xxx-x Series Single Phase Condenser Fan Speed Controls
Input Supply Power 208/240 VAC 50/60 Hz, 380/460 VAC 50/60 Hz, or 460/575 VAC 50/60 Hz, depending on model (Refer to the label inside the

P266 Series control housing cover for rated voltage range and model-specific wiring diagram.)

Short Circuit Current Rating Suitable for use on a circuit capable of delivering not more than 5,000 rms symmetrical amperes, 600 Volts maximum when protected by Class H Fuses.
Low-Voltage Power Supply P266A, P266B, and P266C Types: External 24 VAC Class 2, 20 VA Supply Transformer P266E Types: Low-voltage power for P266 control is provided by an onboard transformer.

Note: When auxiliary fan starters are connected to P266E type controls, you must provide an external Safety Extra-Low Voltage (SELV) AC supply to power the fan starters.

Ambient Operating Conditions Temperature: -40 to 60C (-40 to 140F)

Humidity: Up to 95% RH noncondensing; maximum dew point 29C (85F)

Ambient Shipping and Storage Conditions Temperature: -40 to 85C (-40 to 185F)

Humidity: Up to 95% RH noncondensing; maximum dew point 29C (85F)

Low-Voltage Connections 1/4 in. Quick-Connect terminals, 30 m (100 ft) maximum wiring runs
Input Transducer P266SNR-x Pressure Transducer: 5 VDC for 0.5 to 4.5 VDC ratiometric analog signal
Enclosure Type NEMA 3R, IP54
Case Construction Aluminum die casting
Cover Construction UV Stabilized Polycarbonate
Dimensions (HxWxD) 159 x 177 x 70 mm (6-1/4 x 7 x 2-3/4 in.)
Weight Heaviest model weight: 1.0 kg (2.2 lb) Approximate shipping weight: 1.2 kg (2.6 lb)
Compliance

North America: cULus, File E244421; FCC Compliant to CFR47, Part 15, Subpart B, Class A Industry Canada (IC) Compliant to Canadian ICES-003, Class A limits
Europe: CE Mark – Johnson Controls, Inc., declares that this product is in compliance with the essential requirements and

other relevant provisions of the EMC Directive 2004/108/EC and the Low Voltage Directive 2006/95/EC.

Australia: C-Tick Compliant (N1813)

Motor Speed Controls Code No. LIT-1900622

P66/S66 Series Controls to P266 Series Controls Replacement Guide

P66/S66 to P266 Series Controls Cross-Reference (Part 1 of 4)

P66/S66 to P266 Series Controls Cross-Reference (Part 2 of 4)

Product

Code Number

Operating

Range (psig)

ETR

(psig)

Start

Voltage (%)

Replacement

Control1 (see notes)

Transducer

Sold Separately (see notes)

P66AAB-1 190/250 60 10 P266ACA-100C2

P266BCA-100C3

P266SNR-1C4
P66AAB-2 190/250 60 10 P266ACA-100C2

P266BCA-100C3

P266SNR-1C4
P66AAB-3 180/240 60 16 P266ACA-100C2

P266BCA-100C3

P266SNR-1C4
P66AAB-4 135/165 30 10 P266ACA-100C2

P266BCA-100C3

P266SNR-1C4
P66AAB-5 90/120 30 16 P266ACA-100C2

P266BCA-100C3

P266SNR-1C4
P66AAB-6 170/230 60 16 P266ACA-100C2

P266BCA-100C3

P266SNR-1C4
P66AAB-7 85/115 30 16 P266ACA-100C2

P266BCA-100C3

P266SNR-1C4
P66AAB-8 190/250 60 16 P266ACA-100C2

P266BCA-100C3

P266SNR-1C4
P66AAB-9 170/230 60 40 P266ACA-100C2

P266BCA-100C3

P266SNR-1C4
P66AAB-10 190/250 60 16 P266ACA-100C2

P266BCA-100C3

P266SNR-1C4
P66AAB-11 140/200 60 16 P266ACA-100C2

P266BCA-100C3

P266SNR-1C4
P66AAB-12 220/280 60 16 P266ACA-100C2

P266BCA-100C3

P266SNR-1C4
P66AAB-13 60/90 30 16 P266ACA-100C2

P266BCA-100C3

P266SNR-1C4
P66AAB-14 220/280 60 40 P266ACA-100C2

P266BCA-100C3

P266SNR-1C4
P66AAB-15 190/250 60 40 P266ACA-100C2

P266BCA-100C3

P266SNR-1C4
P66AAB-16 140/170 30 40 P266ACA-100C2

P266BCA-100C3

P266SNR-1C4
P66AAB-17 160/190 30 40 P266ACA-100C2

P266BCA-100C3

P266SNR-1C4
P66AAB-18 180/240 60 10 P266ACA-100C2

P266BCA-100C3

P266SNR-1C4
P66AAB-19 115/145 30 40 P266ACA-100C2

P266BCA-100C3

P266SNR-1C4
P66AAB-20 220/280 60 16 P266ACA-100C2

P266BCA-100C3

P266SNR-1C4
P66AAB-21 220/280 60 16 P266ACA-100C2

P266BCA-100C3

P266SNR-1C4
P66AAB-22 140/170 30 40 P266ACA-100C2

P266BCA-100C3

P266SNR-1C4
P66AAB-23 160/190 30 40 P266ACA-100C2

P266BCA-100C3

P266SNR-1C4
P66AAB-24 160/190 30 10 P266ACA-100C2

P266BCA-100C3

P266SNR-1C4
Product

Code Number

Operating

Range (psig)

ETR

(psig)

Start

Voltage (%)

Replacement

Control1 (see notes)

Transducer

Sold Separately (see notes)

P66AAB-25 180/240 60 10 P266ACA-100C2 P266BCA-100C3 P266SNR-1C4
P66AAB-26 220/280 60 40 P266ACA-100C2

P266BCA-100C3

P266SNR-1C4
P66AAB-27 85/115 30 40 P266ACA-100C2

P266BCA-100C3

P266SNR-1C4
P66AAB-28 135/165 30 10 P266ACA-100C2

P266BCA-100C3

P266SNR-1C4
P66AAB-29 190/250 60 10 P266ACA-100C2

P266BCA-100C3

P266SNR-1C4
P66AAB-30 170/230 60 16 P266ACA-100C2

P266BCA-100C3

P266SNR-1C4
P66AAB-31 115/145 30 40 P266ACA-100C2

P266BCA-100C3

P266SNR-1C4
P66AAB-32 140/200 60 40 P266ACA-100C2

P266BCA-100C3

P266SNR-1C4
P66AAB-33 115/215 60 40 P266ACA-100C2

P266BCA-100C3

P266SNR-1C4
P66AAB-34 320/410 90 40 P266ACA-100C2

P266BCA-100C3

P266SNR-2C4
P66AAB-35 230/320 90 40 P266ACA-100C2

P266BCA-100C3

P266SNR-1C4
P66AAB-36 190/250 60 10 P266ACA-100C2

P266BCA-100C3

P266SNR-1C4
P66AAB-37 320/410 90 10 P266ACA-100C2

P266BCA-100C3

P266SNR-2C4
P66AAB-38 360/450 90 40 P266ACA-100C2

P266BCA-100C3

P266SNR-2C4
P66AAD-1 160/220 60 25 P266ACA-100C2

P266BCA-100C3

P266SNR-1C4
P66AAD-2 190/250 60 10 P266ACA-100C2

P266BCA-100C3

P266SNR-1C4
P66AAD-3 190/250 60 10 P266ACA-100C2

P266BCA-100C3

P266SNR-1C4
P66AAD-4 180/240 60 10 P266ACA-100C2

P266BCA-100C3

P266SNR-1C4
P66AAD-5 160/190 30 10 P266ACA-100C2

P266BCA-100C3

P266SNR-1C4
P66ABB-20 220/280 60 16 P266ACA-100C2

P266BCA-100C3

P266SNR-1C4
P66ABB-21 220/280 60 16 P266ACA-100C2

P266BCA-100C3

P266SNR-1C4
P66ABB-22 140/170 30 40 P266ACA-100C2

P266BCA-100C3

P266SNR-1C4
P66ABB-23 160/190 30 40 P266ACA-100C2

P266BCA-100C3

P266SNR-1C4
P66ABB-24 190/250 60 16 P266ACA-100C2

P266BCA-100C3

P266SNR-1C4

Motor Speed Controls

P66/S66 Series Controls to P266 Series Controls Replacement Guide (Continued)

P66/S66 to P266 Series Controls Cross-Reference (Part 3 of 4)

Product

Code Number

Operating

Range (psig)

ETR

(psig)

Start

Voltage (%)

Replacement

Control1 (see notes)

Transducer

Sold Separately (see notes)

P66ABB-25 190/250 60 16 P266ACA-100C2 P266BCA-100C3 P266SNR-1C4
P66ABB-26 170/230 60 40 P266ACA-100C2

P266BCA-100C3

P266SNR-1C4
P66ABB-27 190/250 60 40 P266ACA-100C2

P266BCA-100C3

P266SNR-1C4
P66ABB-28 320/410 60 16 P266ACA-100C2

P266BCA-100C3

P266SNR-2C4
P66BAB-1 190/250 60 10 P266ACA-100C2

P266BCA-100C3

P266SNR-1C5
P66BAB-2 190/250 60 10 P266ACA-100C2

P266BCA-100C3

P266SNR-1C5
P66BAB-3 170/230 60 16 P266ACA-100C2

P266BCA-100C3

P266SNR-1C5
P66BAB-4 190/250 60 16 P266ACA-100C2

P266BCA-100C3

P266SNR-1C5
P66BAB-5 190/250 60 40 P266ACA-100C2

P266BCA-100C3

P266SNR-1C5
P66BAB-6 220/280 60 40 P266ACA-100C2

P266BCA-100C3

P266SNR-1C5
P66BAB-7 190/250 60 10 P266ACA-100C2

P266BCA-100C3

P266SNR-1C5
  1. Factory default start voltage is 40%.
  2. For 208/240 Volt applications
  3. For 460/480 Volt applications
  4. Use one transducer.
  5. Use two transducers.
  6. 0 to 5 VDC input, not 0 to 10 VDC
  7. Hard start not available.

NA = Not applicable

NR = No replacement available

P66/S66 to P266 Series Controls Cross-Reference (Part 4 of 4)

Product

Code Number

Operating

Range (psig)

ETR

(psig)

Start

Voltage (%)

Replacement

Control1 (see notes)

Transducer

Sold Separately (see notes)

P66BAB-8 170/230 60 16 P266ACA-100C2 P266BCA-100C3 P266SNR-1C5
P66BAB-9 320/410 90 40 P266ACA-100C2

P266BCA-100C3

P266SNR-2C5
P66BAB-10 360/450 90 40 P266ACA-100C2

P266BCA-100C3

P266SNR-2C5
P66BBB-1 190/250 60 16 P266ACA-100C2

P266BCA-100C3

P266SNR-1C5
P66BAD-1 160/220 60 25 P266ACA-100C2

P266BCA-100C3

P266SNR-1C5
P66BAD-2 190/250 60 10 P266ACA-100C2

P266BCA-100C3

P266SNR-1C5
P66BAD-3 190/250 60 10 P266ACA-100C2

P266BCA-100C3

P266SNR-1C5
S66AA-1 NA NA 50 P266ACA-100C6 NA
S66DC-1 NA NA 40 NR NA
S66FA-1 NA NA 50 P266ACA-100C6,7 NA

Motor Speed Controls Code No. LIT-1900956

VFD68 Variable Frequency Drives

Description

The VFD68 Variable Frequency Drive provides three-phase motor speed control in a variety of HVAC/R applications. The

VFD68 drive is designed primarily for condenser fan speed control on HVAC and refrigeration condensing units, but can also be set up to control a variety of pumps, blowers, and fans.

The VFD68 drive accepts an input signal from P499 Electronic Pressure Transducer, or other devices that provide a 0 to 5 VDC,

0 to 10 VDC, or 4 to 20 mA signal.

The application-specific design of the VFD68 drive provides a simple interface, which makes the drive easy to understand and operate.

You can quickly and easily reconfigure the VFD68 drive to control variable speed pumps in cooling and heating applications, or to control variable speed supply fans in VAV applications.

The VFD68 drive is an RS485, RTU-compliant ModBus® slave device and can be integrated into a ModBus network.

Refer to the VFD68 Variable Frequency Drives Product Bulletin (LIT-12012068) for important product application information.

Features

  • Selectable input types allows use with

0 to 5 VDC (ratiometric), 0 to 10 VDC, or 4 to 20 mA input signals from transducers, sensors, and controllers.

  • High input signal selection of two similar inputs (230 or 460 volt models only) provides fan speed control of dual circuit condensing units, based on the highest pressure circuit.
  • Compact design provides for easy and flexible installation.
  • Three-phase, 230, 460, or 575 VAC models can control a wide variety of three-phase motors ranging up to 10hp.
  • Simple and advanced end-user settings provide quick and simple application setup and operation, as well as advanced setup parameters for custom applications.

Applications

The VFD68 drive accepts input signals from a variety of pressure transducers, temperature sensors, and low-voltage controllers to provide continuous response to changing condenser load conditions.

The VFD68 drive allows the system to:

  • maintain optimum condenser head pressure
  • operate in low ambient temperature conditions down to -40ºC (-40ºF)
  • reduce short-cycling, which occurs when using
  • use On/Off fan controls
  • maintain a more stable evaporator temperature
  • operate more efficiently, reducing electricity cost.

The VFD68 drive can also:

  • help optimize compressor operation, reduce wear, and extend compressor life by stabilizing the condenser head pressures
  • reduce motor repair and replacement costs by eliminating the condenser fan

short-cycling

  • extend refrigerated product life and provide more consistent comfort cooling by stabilizing evaporator temperatures

Selecting a Motor

IMPORTANT: When selecting the motor, do not exceed the maximum output current rating of the VFD68 drive

Motors used with the VFD68 drive must:

  • be AC induction three-phase motors that are UL Recognized and CSA Certified, or equivalent
  • be rated for: 230 VAC at 50/60 Hz;

460 VAC at 50/60 Hz; or 575 VAC at 60 Hz

  • have an Inverter Rating (460 VAC motors)
  • have Insulation Class F or better

The VFD68 drive is intended for use with variable speed motors that are rated for 40:1 operation.

VFD68BBB Variable Frequency Drive

A VFD68 drive can control multiple motors wired in parallel; however, the sum of the Full Load Amperes (FLA) ratings for the motors must not exceed the maximum output current rating of the VFD68 drive, including any

de-rating due to altitude, temperature, or a combination of both.

IMPORTANT: Do not control both

single-phase and three-phase motors with the same VFD68 drive.

Repair Information

If the VFD68 Variable Frequency Drive fails to operate within its specifications, replace the unit. For a replacement VFD68 Drive, contact the nearest Johnson Controls® representative.

Motor Speed Controls

VFD68 Variable Frequency Drives (Continued)

Selection Charts

230 VAC ±10% Production Models

Product Code

Number

Description
VFD68BBB-2C VFD68 Drive; 0.1 kw (1/8 hp); 128 x 68 x 81 mm (5 x 2-11/16 x 3-3/16 in.)
VFD68BCB-2C VFD68 Drive; 0.2 kw (1/4 hp); 128 x 68 x 81 mm (5 x 2-11/16 x 3-3/16 in.)
VFD68BDC-2C VFD68 Drive; 0.4 kw (1/2 hp); 128 x 68 x 113 mm (5 x 2-11/16 x 4-7/16 in.)
VFD68BFD-2C VFD68 Drive; 0.75 kw (1 hp); 128 x 68 x 133 mm (5 x 2-11/16 x 5-1/4 in.)
VFD68BGG-2C VFD68 Drive; 0.5 kw (2 hp); 128 x 108 x 136 mm (5 x 4-1/4 x 5-5/16 in.)
VFD68BHG-2C VFD68 Drive; 2.2 kw (3 hp); 128 x 108 x 136 mm (5 x 4-1/4 x 5-5/16 in.)
VFD68BJK-2C VFD68 Drive; 3.7 kw (5 hp); 128 x 170 x 142 mm (5 x 6-11/16 x 5-5/8 in.)
VFD68BKL-2C VFD68 Drive; 5.5 kw (7-1/2 hp); 150 x 220 x 155 mm (5-15/16 x 8-11/16 x 6-1/8 in.)
VFD68BLL-2C VFD68 Drive; 7.5 kw (10 hp); 150 x 220 x 155 mm (5-15/16 x 8-11/16 x 6-1/8 in.)
VFD68BMP-2C VFD68 Drive; 11 kw (15 hp); 260 x 220 x 190 (10-1/4 x 8-11/16 x 7-1/2)
VFD68BNP-2C VFD68 Drive; 15 kw (20 hp); 260 x 220 x 190 (10-1/4 x 8-11/16 x 7-1/2)

460 VAC ±10% Production Models

Product Code

Number

Description
VFD68CDF-2C VFD68 Drive; 0.4 kw (1/2 hp); 128 x 108 x 130 mm (5 x 4-1/4 x 5-1/8 in.)
VFD68CFF-2C VFD68 Drive; 0.75 kw (1 hp); 128 x 108 x 130 mm (5 x 4-1/4 x 5-1/8 in.)
VFD68CGG-2C VFD68 Drive; 1.5 kw (2 hp); 128 x 108 x 136 mm (5 x 4-1/4 x 5-5/16 in.)
VFD68CHH-2C VFD68 Drive; 2.2 kw (3 hp); 128 x 108 x 156 mm (5 x 4-1/4 x 6-1/8 in.)
VFD68CJJ-2C VFD68 Drive; 3.7 kw (5 hp); 128 x 108 x 166 mm (5 x 4-1/4 x 6-1/2 in.)
VFD68CKL-2C VFD68 Drive; 5.5 kw (7-1/2 hp); 150 x 220 x 155 mm (5-15/16 x 8-11/16 x 6-1/8 in.)
VFD68CLL-2C VFD68 Drive; 7.5 kw (10 hp); 150 x 220 x 155 mm (5-15/16 x 8-11/16 x 6-1/8 in.)
VFD68CMP-2C VFD68 Drive; 11 kw (15 hp); 260 x 220 x 190 (10-1/4 x 8-11/16 x 7-1/2)
VFD68CNP-2C VFD68 Drive; 15 kw (20 hp); 260 x 220 x 190 (10-1/4 x 8-11/16 x 7-1/2)

575 VAC +5/-10% Production Models

Product Code

Number

Description
VFD68DFM-2C VFD68 Drive; 0.75 kw (1 hp); 150 x 140 x 136 mm (5-15/16 x 5-1/2 x 5-5/16 in.)
VFD68DGM-2C VFD68 Drive;1.5 kw (2 hp); 150 x 140 x 136 mm (5-15/16 x 5-1/2 x 5-5/16 in.)
VFD68DHM-2C VFD68 Drive; 2.2 kw (3 hp); 150 x 140 x 136 mm (5-15/16 x 5-1/2 x 5-5/16 in.)
VFD68DJN-2C VFD68 Drive; 3.7 kw (5 hp); 150 x 220 x 148 mm (5-15/16 x 8-11/16 x 5-13/16 in.)
VFD68DKN-2C VFD68 Drive; 5.5 kw (7-1/2 hp); 150 x 220 x 148 mm (5-15/16 x 8-11/16 x 5-13/16 in.)
VFD68DLN-2C VFD68 Drive; 7.5 kw (10 hp); 150 x 220 x 148 mm (5-15/16 x 8-11/16 x 5-13/16 in.)

Accessories

Product Code

Number

Description Accessory Information
P499RAPS100K

P499RCPS100K

Electronic Pressure Transducer (-10 to 100 psis [sealed for wet

and freeze/thaw applications] Range) and WHA-PKD3-200C Wire Harness

  • Product code numbers ending in K are P499 kit models that

include one P499 Pressure Transducer model and a

WHA-PKD3-200C (6-1/2 ft [2 m]) Wire Harness. To order a single P499 Pressure Transducer model (without a

WHA-PKD3-200C Wire Harness), replace the K with a C at the end of the P499 product code number.

  • P499RxP type models are 0.5 to 4.5 VDC ratiometric pressure transducers with Packard style electrical connections.
  • P499RAP type models have a 1/8 in. 27 NPT external thread (Style 49) pressure connection.
  • P499RCP type models have a 1/4 in. SAE 45° flare internal thread (7/16-20 UNF) with depressor (Style 47) pressure connection.
  • Refer to the P499 Series Electronic Pressure Transducers Product/Technical Bulletin (LIT-12011190) for more information on P499 Pressure Transducer models and the associated wire harnesses.
P499RAPS102K

P499RCPS102K

Electronic Pressure Transducer (0 to 200 psis [sealed for wet and

freeze/thaw applications] Range) and one WHA-PKD3-200C Wire Harness

P499RAP-101K

P499RCP-101K

Electronic Pressure Transducer (0 to 100 psig Range) and

WHA-PKD3-200C Wire Harness

P499RAP-102C Electronic Pressure Transducer (0 to 200 psig Range)
P499RAP-105K

P499RCP-105K

Electronic Pressure Transducer (0 to 500 psig Range) and

WHA-PKD3-200C Wire Harness

P499RAP-107K

P499RCP-107K

Electronic Pressure Transducer (0 to 750 psig Range) and

WHA-PKD3-200C Wire Harness

WHA-PKD3-200C Wire Harness with Pigtail Leads, 6-1/2 ft (2 m)
WHA-PKD3-400C Wire Harness with Pigtail Leads, 13 ft (4 m)
WHA-PKD3-400C Wire Harness with Pigtail Leads, 19-5/8 ft (6 m)

Motor Speed Controls

VFD68 Variable Frequency Drives (Continued)

Technical Specifications

VFD68 Variable Frequency Drive
Input Power Voltage/Frequency 230 VAC, 50 HZ (208/230 VAC, 60 Hz);

400 VAC, 50 Hz (460 VAC, 60 Hz);

575 VAC, 50 Hz;

Continuous Duty

Output Voltage/Frequency 230 VAC, 50 HZ (208/230 VAC, 60 Hz);

400 VAC, 50 Hz (460 VAC, 60 Hz);

575 VAC, 50 Hz;

Continuous Duty

Input Devices Johnson Controls/PENN® P499 Electronic Pressure Transducers
PWM Carrier Frequency Adjustable 0.7 to 15 kHz
Motor Requirements Three-phase NEMA Design B motors required; Inverter-rated motors recommended
Overload Capacity 150% of ampere rating for 1 minute
Start/Stop Use STF input to start or stop the motor
Ambient Conditions Storage: -40 to 65ºC (-40 to 149ºF), 0 to 95% RH noncondensing
Operating: -40 to 50ºC (-40 to 122ºF), 0 to 95% RH noncondensing
Altitude: 1,000 m (3,300 ft) maximum without derating
Enclosures UL Type 1 (NEMA) fan cooled

(230 VAC 1 hp and lower models do not have a fan)

Maximum High Voltage Wire Length Up to 100 m (328 ft) between the VFD68 drive and the motor (using the appropriate wire gauge)
Compliance North America: cULus Listed, UL 508C, CSA-C22.2 No. 14, File E244421; Industry Canada (IC) Compliant to Canadian ICES-003, Class B limits

Europe: CE Mark- Johnson Controls Inc. declares that this product is in compliance with the essential requirements and other relevent provisions of the EMC Directive and the Low Voltage Directive.

Australia: Regulatory Compliance Mark (RCM)

Dimensions (H x W x D) Minimum: 128 x 68 x 81 mm (5 x 2-11/16 x 3-3/16 in.)

Maximum: 260 x 220 x 190 mm (10-1/4 x 8-11/16 x 7-1/2 in.)

Shipping Weight 0.5 to 3.8 kg (1.1 to 8.38 lb)

Valves and Valve Accessories Code No. LIT-1927325

V43/V243 Series Pressure-Actuated Water-Regulating Valves

Description

The V43/V243 Pressure Actuated Water Regulating Valves are designed to regulate water flow through the condenser of large refrigerated cooling systems. These

pilot-operated valves open on an increase in refrigerant head pressure and provide modulating operation.

The V43/V243 water regulating valves are available for commercial and maritime applications.

V43 valves are available for non-corrosive low- and medium-pressure refrigerants such as R-134A, R-404A, R-502, and R-507.

Specially designed V43 valves are also available for ammonia service (R-717).

V243 valves are available for non-corrosive high-pressure refrigerants such as R410A.

Commercial V43/V243 valves are constructed with a cast iron body, brass internal parts, and bronze seat material.

Valve Construction and Pressure Type

Designator Construction and Pressure Type
A Commercial Service with Iron Body, Open on Pressure Increase, V43
B Maritime Service with Brass Body, Open on Pressure Increase, V43
C Navy Service with Brass Body, Open on Pressure Increase, V43
G Commercial Service with Iron Body, Open on Pressure Increase, V243
H Maritime Service with Brass Body, Open on Pressure Increase, V243

Flange Size

To resist the corrosive action of sea water, the V43/V243 maritime and navy models are constructed with a red brass body, bronze and monel interior parts, and monel seat material.

Refer to the V43/V243 Pressure Actuated Water Regulating Valves Product/Technical Bulletin (LIT-125683) for important product information.

Features

  • built-in pilot valve allows more precise throttling
  • easy adjustment allows service and adjustment without breaking line connections
  • drain plug allows water to be drained during shutdown to reduce the possibility of freeze-up
  • mesh monel screen protects pilot valve from items such as dirt and scale and is easily removed for cleaning and servicing without breaking any line connections

V43 Pressure Actuated Valve

Selection Charts

When ordering V43 valves, specify the complete product code number including an optional companion flange and gasket kit. A companion flange and gasket kit is required to mount the water lines to commercial type V43/V243 water-regulating valves.

Designator Flange Size
S 2 in.
T 2-1/2 in.
V 3 in.
W 4 in.

V43 Series Pressure Actuated Water Valves (except NAVSEA valves)

Product Code Number Pipe Size (in.) Inlet and Outlet Opening Point Adjustment Range psig (kPa) Shipping Wt. lb (kg)
Commercial Type – Non-Corrosive Refrigerants (R)
V43AS-1C 2 Four Hole ASME Flanged 70 to 150 (483 to 1,034) 59 (26.76)
V43AS-2C 160 to 260 (1,103 to 1,793)
V43AT-1C 2-1/2 70 to 150 (483 to 1,034) 65 (29.48)
V43AT-2C 140 to 260 (1,103 to 1,793)
V43AV-1C 3 70 to 150 (483 to 1,034) 90 (40.82)
V43AV-2C 160 to 260 (1,103 to 1,793) 90 (40.82)
V43AW-2C 4 Eight Hole ASME Flanged 142 (64.41)
Commercial Type – Ammonia (R)
V43AV-5C 3 160 to 260 (1,103 to 1,793) 90 (40.82)
Maritime Type – Non-Corrosive Refrigerants (R)
V43BS-6C 2 Four Hole ASME Flanged 70 to 150 (483 to 1,034) 59 (26.76)
V43BS-7C 160 to 260 (1,103 to 1,793)
V43BT-6C 2-1/2 70 to 150 (483 to 1,034) 65 (29.48)
V43BT-7C 140 to 260 (1,103 to 1,793)
V43BV-10C 3 70 to 150 (483 to 1,034) 90 (40.82)
V43BV-7C 140 to 260 (1,103 to 1,793)

Valves and Valve Accessories

V43/V243 Series Pressure-Actuated Water-Regulating Valves (Continued)

Selection Charts (Continued)

V43 Series Pressure Actuated Water valves, Navy NAVSEA Certified

Product Code Number Pipe Size (in.) Inlet and Outlet Pressure Connector Opening Point Adjustment Range – psig (kPa) Shipping Wt, lb (kg)
Navy NAVSEA Certified – Non-Corrosive Refrigerants (R)
V43BS-3C 2 Four Hole ASME Flange 1/4 in. External Flared Connector 70 to 150 (483 to 1,034) 59 (26.76)
V43CS-1C Six Hole Navy Flange
V43CS-2C Internal Sweat Connector
V43BT-3C 2-1/2 Four Hole ASME Flange 1/4 in. External Flared Connector 65 (29.48)
V43CT-2C Six Hole Navy Flange
V43BV-4C 3 Four Hole ASME Flange Internal Sweat Connector 90 (40.82)
V43CV-1C Eight Hole Navy Flange 1/4 in. External Flared Connector
V43CV-2C Internal Sweat Connector
V43BW-7C 4 Eight Hole ASME Flange 1/4 in. External Flared Connector 142 (64.41)
V43BW-2C 140 to 260 (1,103 to 1,793)

V243 Series Pressurized Actuated Water Valves

Product Code Number Pipe Size (in.) Inlet and Outlet Opening Point Adjustment Range – psig (kPa) Shipping Weight, lb (kg)
Commercial Type – High Pressure Refrigerants
V243GS-1C 2 Four Hole ASME Flange 200 to 400 (1,379 to 2,758) 59 (26.76)
V243GT-1C 2-1/2 65 (29.48)
V243GV-1C 3 90 (40.82)
V243GW-1C 4 Eight Hole ASME Flange 142 (64.41)
Maritime Type – High Pressure Refrigerants
V243HS-1C 2 Four Hole ASME Flange 200 to 400 (1,379 to 2,758) 59 (26.76)
V243HT-1C 2-1/2 65 (29.48)
V243HV-1C 3 90 (40.82)
V243HW-1C 4 Eight Hole ASME Flange 142 (64.41)

Accessories

Kit Code Number Water Valve Size (in.) Shipping Weight, lb (kg)
KIT14A-6131, 2 2 11.8 (5.4)
KIT14A-6141, 2 2-1/2 16.5 (7.5)
FLG15A-6001, 3 3 20 (9.1)
FLG15A-6011, 3 4 34 (15.4)
  1. Commercial valves only.
  2. These are the parts included in the flange and gasket kit for the 2-inch and 2-1/2 inch valves.
  3. These are the parts included in the flange and gasket kit for the 3-inch and 4-inch valves.

A companion flange and gasket kit is required to mount the water lines to commercial type V43/V243 water-regulating valves.

Ring Gasket (Two)

Cast Iron Flange (Two)

Cast Iron Flange (Two) Machine Bolt (Eight)

Hex Nut (Eight)

Machine Bolt (Eight)

Hex Nut (Eight)

FIG:FLG15A

KIT14A FLG15A

Valves and Valve Accessories

V43/V243 Series Pressure-Actuated Water-Regulating Valves (Continued)

Repair and Replacement Information

If a V43/V243 Pressure-Actuated Water-Regulating Valve fails to operate within its specifications, replacement sensing elements, internal parts, and diaphragms are available for valve repair.

To obtain replacement parts, kits, instructions, and details, contact your nearest Johnson Controls® distributor at

http://cgproducts.johnsoncontrols.com/dist_locate/locateDIST.asp. For replacement parts, see Repair Parts and Parts Kits.

Repair Parts (Part 1 of 2)

Model Diaphragm

Kit

Seat Disc and

Diaphragm Kit

Seat Repair

Kit

Screen

Repair Kit

Push Rod

Kit1

Sensing

Element Kit

Disc Body

Kit

V43AS-1C DPM18A-600R DSC16A-600R STT19A-602R SCN10A-600R ROD18A-600R SEP88A-600R DBK11A-600R
V43AS-2C DPM18A-600R DSC16A-600R STT19A-602R SCN10A-600R ROD18A-600R SEP88A-601R DBK11A-600R
V43AS-5C DPM18A-600R DSC16A-600R STT19A-602R SCN10A-600R ROD18A-600R SEP87A-600R DBK11A-600R
V43AT-1C DPM18A-601R DSC16A-601R STT19A-603R SCN10A-600R ROD18A-601R SEP88A-600R DBK11A-601R
V43AT-2C DPM18A-601R DSC16A-601R STT19A-603R SCN10A-600R ROD18A-601R SEP88A-601R DBK11A-601R
V43AT-5C DPM18A-601R DSC16A-601R STT19A-603R SCN10A-600R ROD18A-601R SEP87A-600R DBK11A-601R
V43AV-1C DPM18A-602R DSC16A-602R STT19A-606R SCN10A-600R ROD18A-601R SEP88A-600R DBK11A-602R
V43AV-2C DPM18A-602R DSC16A-602R STT19A-606R SCN10A-600R ROD18A-601R SEP88A-601R DBK11A-602R
V43AV-5C DPM18A-602R DSC16A-602R STT19A-606R SCN10A-600R ROD18A-601R SEP87A-600R DBK11A-602R
V43AW-1C DPM18A-603R DSC16A-603R STT19A-608R SCN10A-600R ROD18A-602R SEP88A-600R DBK11A-603R
V43AW-2C DPM18A-603R DSC16A-603R STT19A-608R SCN10A-600R ROD18A-602R SEP88A-601R DBK11A-603R
V43AW-5C DPM18A-603R DSC16A-603R STT19A-608R SCN10A-600R ROD18A-602R SEP87A-600R DBK11A-603R
V43BS-1C1 DPM18A-600R DSC16A-600R STT19A-602R SCN10A-601R ROD18A-602R SEP88A-600R DBK11A-600R
V43BS-2C1 DPM18A-600R DSC16A-600R STT19A-602R SCN10A-601R ROD18A-602R SEP88A-601R DBK11A-600R
V43BS-3C DPM18A-600R DSC16A-600R STT19A-600R SCN10A-601R ROD18A-602R SEP88A-600R DBK10A-600R
V43BS-6C DPM18A-600R DSC16A-600R STT19A-600R SCN10A-601R ROD18A-602R SEP88A-600R DBK10A-600R
V43BS-7C DPM18A-600R DSC16A-600R STT19A-600R SCN10A-601R ROD18A-602R SEP88A-601R DBK10A-600R
V43BT-1C1 DPM18A-601R DSC16A-601R STT19A-603R SCN10A-601R ROD18A-603R SEP88A-600R DBK11A-601R
V43BT-2C1 DPM18A-601R DSC16A-601R STT19A-603R SCN10A-601R ROD18A-603R SEP88A-601R DBK11A-601R
V43BT-3C DPM18A-601R DSC16A-601R STT19A-605R SCN10A-601R ROD18A-603R SEP88A-600R DBK10A-602R
V43BT-6C DPM18A-601R DSC16A-601R STT19A-605R SCN10A-601R ROD18A-603R SEP88A-600R DBK10A-602R
V43BT-7C DPM18A-601R DSC16A-601R STT19A-605R SCN10A-601R ROD18A-603R SEP88A-601R DBK10A-602R
V43BV-1C1 DPM18A-602R DSC16A-602R STT19A-606R SCN10A-601R ROD18A-603R SEP88A-600R DBK11A-602R
V43BV-2C1 DPM18A-602R DSC16A-602R STT19A-606R SCN10A-601R ROD18A-603R SEP88A-601R DBK11A-602R
V43BV-4C DPM18A-602R DSC16A-602R STT19A-607R SCN10A-601R ROD18A-603R SEP88A-600R DBK10A-601R
V43BV-5C1 DPM18A-602R DSC16A-602R STT19A-606R SCN10A-601R ROD18A-603R SEP88A-600R DBK11A-602R
V43BV-6C1 DPM18A-602R DSC16A-602R STT19A-606R SCN10A-601R ROD18A-603R SEP88A-601R DBK11A-602R
V43BV-7C DPM18A-602R DSC16A-602R STT19A-607R SCN10A-601R ROD18A-603R SEP88A-601R DBK10A-601R
V43BV-8C DPM18A-602R DSC16A-602R STT19A-607R SCN10A-601R ROD18A-603R SEP88A-600R DBK10A-601R
V43BV-9C DPM18A-602R DSC16A-602R STT19A-607R SCN10A-601R ROD18A-603R SEP88A-601R DBK10A-601R
V43BV-10C DPM18A-602R DSC16A-602R STT19A-607R SCN10A-601R ROD18A-603R SEP88A-600R DBK10A-601R
V43BW-1C DPM18A-603R DSC16A-603R STT19A-609R SCN10A-601R ROD18A-602R SEP88A-600R DBK10A-603R
V43BW-2C DPM18A-603R DSC16A-603R STT19A-609R SCN10A-601R ROD18A-602R SEP88A-601R DBK10A-603R
V43BW-5C DPM18A-603R DSC16A-603R STT19A-609R SCN10A-601R ROD18A-602R SEP88A-600R DBK10A-603R
V43BW-6C DPM18A-603R DSC16A-603R STT19A-609R SCN10A-601R ROD18A-602R SEP88A-601R DBK10A-603R
V43BW-7C DPM18A-603R DSC16A-603R STT19A-609R SCN10A-601R ROD18A-602R SEP88A-600R DBK10A-603R
V43CS-1C DPM18A-600R DSC16A-600R STT19A-600R SCN10A-601R ROD18A-602R SEP88A-600R DBK10A-600R
V43CS-2C DPM18A-600R DSC16A-600R STT19A-600R SCN10A-601R ROD18A-602R SEP88A-600R DBK10A-600R
V43CS-3C DPM18A-600R DSC16A-600R STT19A-600R SCN10A-601R ROD18A-604R SEP88A-600R DBK10A-600R
V43CT-1C DPM18A-601R DSC16A-601R STT19A-605R SCN10A-601R ROD18A-603R SEP88A-600R DBK10A-602R
V43CT-2C DPM18A-601R DSC16A-601R STT19A-605R SCN10A-601R ROD18A-603R SEP86A-600R DBK10A-602R
V43CV-1C DPM18A-602R DSC16A-602R STT19A-607R SCN10A-601R ROD18A-603R SEP86A-600R DBK10A-601R
V43CV-2C DPM18A-602R DSC16A-602R STT19A-607R SCN10A-601R ROD18A-603R SEP88A-600R DBK10A-601R

Valves and Valve Accessories

V43/V243 Series Pressure-Actuated Water-Regulating Valves (Continued)

Repair Parts (Part 2 of 2)

Model Diaphragm

Kit

Seat Disc and

Diaphragm Kit

Seat Repair

Kit

Screen

Repair Kit

Push Rod

Kit1

Sensing

Element Kit

Disc Body

Kit

V243GS-1C DPM18A-600R DSC16A-600R STT19A-602R SCN10A-600R ROD18A-600R SEP90A-600R DBK11A-600R
V243GT-1C DPM18A-601R DSC16A-601R STT19A-603R SCN10A-600R ROD18A-601R SEP90A-600R DBK11A-601R
V243GV-1C DPM18A-602R DSC16A-602R STT19A-606R SCN10A-600R ROD18A-601R SEP90A-600R DBK11A-602R
V243GW-1C DPM18A-603R DSC16A-603R STT19A-608R SCN10A-600R ROD18A-600R SEP90A-600R DBK11A-603R
V243HS-1C DPM18A-600R DSC16A-600R STT19A-600R SCN10A-601R ROD18A-602R SEP90A-600R DBK10A-600R
V243HT-1C DPM18A-601R DSC16A-601R STT19A-605R SCN10A-601R ROD18A-603R SEP90A-600R DBK10A-601R
V243HV-1C DPM18A-602R DSC16A-602R STT19A-607R SCN10A-601R ROD18A-603R SEP90A-600R DBK10A-602R
V243HW-1C DPM18A-603R DSC16A-603R STT19A-609R SCN10A-601R ROD18A-602R SEP90A-600R DPK10A-603R

1. Replacement push rod kit requires a seat repair kit and/or a diaphragm kit when replaced.

Parts Kits

The following valves, manufactured after date code 8702, contain monel interior trim. Order replacement kits as listed in Repair Parts or

V43xx and V243xx Series Repair Parts Kits Technical Bulletin (LIT-121690).

Parts Kits

Valve Model Order Parts Kits for:
V43BS-1C V43BS-6C
V43BS-2C V43BS-7C
V43BT-1C V43BT-6C
V43BT-2C V43BT-7C
V43BV-1C V43BV-10C
V43BV-2C V43BV-7C
V43BV-5C V43BV-10C
V43BV-6C V43BV-9C

Dimensions

Symbol 2 Inch 2-1/2 Inch 3 Inch 4 Inch
A1 9-1/2 in. (241 mm) 10-3/4 in.(273 mm) 11-3/4 in. (298 mm) 14 in. (356 mm)
B 7-1/2 in. (191 mm) 8 in. (203 mm) 9 in. (229 mm) 10-3/4 in. (273 mm)
C 4-3/4 in. (121 mm) 5-1/2 in. (140 mm) 6 in. (152 mm) 7-1/2 in. (191 mm)
D 6 in. (152 mm) 7 in. (178 mm) 7-1/2 in. (191 mm) 9 in. (229 mm)
E 2-1/8 in. (54 mm) 2-5/8 in. (67 mm) 3-1/8 in. (80 mm) 4-1/8 in. (105 mm)
F2 15-1/4 in. (387 mm) 15-9/16 in. (395 mm) 16-9/16 in. (421 mm) 18-7/32 in. (462 mm)
F3 15-29/32 in. (404 mm) 16-7/32 in. (412 mm) 17-7/32 in. (437 mm) 18-7/8 in. (479 mm)
G 3/4 in. (19 mm) Diameter (Four) 3/4 in. (19 mm) Diameter (Four) 3/4 in. (19 mm) Diameter (Four) 3/4 in. (19 mm) Diameter (Eight)
H 3-5/8 in. (92 mm) 3-15/16 in. (100 mm) 4-1/4 in. (108 mm) 5-1/16 in. (128 mm)
  1. Flange face to flange face.
  2. These are the measurements for the V43 valves.
  3. These are the measurements for the V243 valves.

Valves and Valve Accessories

V43/V243 Series Pressure-Actuated Water-Regulating Valves (Continued)

Six- and Eight- Flange Hole Configurations

G

E

D

F

D

C

G

H

B

A

E

E

G

D

V43/V243 Pressure Actuated Water Regulating Valves Dimensions

FIG:Dimensions

V43 Capacity Flow Charts

CAPACITY CHART FOR 2 in. VALVE

Low Pressure Refrigerants

CAPACITY CHART FOR 3 in. VALVE

Low Pressure Refrigerants

Water Pressure Available Across Valve (psi) Water Pressure Available Across Valve (psi)

Refrigerant Head Pressure Rise Above Valve Opening Point (psig)

Refrigerant Head Pressure Rise Above Valve Opening Point (psig)

10 20 30 50

50 40

40 30

30

20

20

10 10

0 0

50 40

40 30

30

20

20

10 10

0 0

10 20 30 50

50 100 150 200 250 300 350 400 450

Water Flow (GPM)

Medium Pressure Refrigerants

100 200 300 400 500 600 700 800 900

Water Flow (GPM)

Medium Pressure Refrigerants

CAPACITY CHART FOR 2-1/2 in. VALVE

Low Pressure Refrigerants

Water Pressure Available Across Valve (psi)

Refrigerant Head Pressure Rise Above Valve Opening Point (psig)

CAPACITY CHART FOR 4 in. VALVE

Low Pressure Refrigerants

Water Pressure Available Across Valve (psi)

Refrigerant Head Pressure Rise Above Valve Opening Point (psig)

10 20 30 50

50 40

40 30

30

20

20

10 10

0 0

50 40

40 30

30

20

20

10 10

0 0

5 10 20 30 50

50 100 150 200 250 300 350 400 450

Water Flow (GPM)

Medium Pressure Refrigerants

150 300 450 600 750 900 1050 1200 1350

Water Flow (GPM)

Medium Pressure Refrigerants

Valves and Valve Accessories

V43/V243 Series Pressure-Actuated Water-Regulating Valves (Continued)

V243 Capacity Flow Charts

CAPACITY CHART FOR 2 in. VALVE

CAPACITY CHART FOR 3 in. VALVE

Refrigerant Head Pressure Rise Above Valve Opening Point (psig)

Water Pressure Available Across Valve (psi)

Refrigerant Head Pressure Rise Above Valve Opening Point (psig)

Water Pressure Available Across Valve (psi)

2 5 10 14.5 20 2530

60

40

20

40 50 60

2 5 10 14.5

60

40

20

20 25 30 40 50 60

0

50 100 150 200 250 300 350 400 450

Water Flow (GPM)

0

100 200 300 400 500 600 700 800 900

Water Flow (GPM)

CAPACITY CHART FOR 2-1/2 in. VALVE

CAPACITY CHART FOR 4 in. VALVE

Water Pressure Available Across Valve (psi) Water Pressure Available Across Valve (psi)

Refrigerant Head Pressure Rise Above Valve Opening Point (psig)

Refrigerant Head Pressure Rise Above Valve Opening Point (psig)

2 5 1014.5 20 2530 40

60

40

20

50 60

2 5 10

60

40

20

14.5

20 25 30

40 50 60

0

100 200 300 400 500 600 700 800 900

Water Flow (GPM)

0

100 200 300 400 500 600 700 800 900 1000 1100 1200 1300

Water Flow (GPM)

Technical Specifications

V43/V243 Pressure-Actuated Water-Regulating Valves
Maximum Water Supply Pressure 150 psig (1,034 kPa)
V43 Maximum Head Pressure 300 psig (2,068 kPa)
V243 Maximum Head Pressure 630 psig (4,344 kPa)
Head Pressure Range (Opening Points) V43 Low Pressure Refrigerants R-134A – 70 to 150 psig (482 to 1,034 kPa)
Medium Pressure Refrigerants R-22, R-502, R404A – 160 to 260 psig (1,103 to 1,793 kPa)
Ammonia 160 to 260 psig (1,103 to 1,793 kPa)
V243 High Pressure 200 to 400 psig (1,379 to 2,758 kPa)
Factory Settings1 V43 Low Pressure Refrigerants 90 psig (621 kPa)
Medium Pressure Refrigerants 180 psig (1,241 kPa)
Ammonia 180 psig (1,241 kPa)
V243 High Pressure 200 psig (1,379 kPa)
Maximum Water Supply Temperature 160°F (71°C)
Valve Body Material Commercial Cast iron
Maritime Red brass
Internal Parts Material Commercial Brass
Maritime Bronze, Monel
Seat Material Pilot Monel
Main Valve Commercial – Bronze, Maritime – Monel
Seat Disc Material Buna N™
Packing – Bellows Assembly Brass stem, stainless steel spring, synthetic rubber boot
Pressure Connection Refrigerant Side Non-Corrosive 1/4 in. SAE External Flare
Ammonia 1/4 in. FNPT

1. Factory opening setpoint for the valve is adjustable.

Valves and Valve Accessories Code No. LIT-1927350

V46 Series Pressure Actuated Water Regulating Valve

Description

The V46 is a pressure actuated modulating valve that is suitable for use either on closed or open systems. Direct acting valves open on pressure increase. This type of valve is primarily used to regulate the flow of water or glycol to a water cooled condenser on a refrigeration system.

Refer to the V46 Pressure-Actuated Water-Regulating Valve Product Bulletin (LIT-125687) for important product application information.

Features

  • no close fitting or sliding parts in water passages
  • minimizes chatter or water hammer
  • free movement of all parts provides smooth pressure modulation
  • refrigerant adjustment is not affected by water pressure
  • withstands high hydraulic shock without damage
  • range spring does not come in contact with cooling water
  • easy manual flushing, if required
  • 3/8, 1/2, and 3/4 in. valves may be disassembled and reassembled without detaching from the refrigeration system or

V46AA-1 Water Regulating Valve

Repair Information

V46AT-1 Water Regulating Valve

without pumping down

Applications

This valve is designed to modulate flow of water or glycol to a water cooled condenser on a refrigeration system.

If the V46 Series Pressure Actuated Water Regulating Valve fails to

operate within its specifications, replace the unit. For a replacement valve, contact the nearest Johnson Controls® representative.

  • ice machines
  • computer room air conditioning units

Selection Chart

  • ice cream machines
  • refrigeration cases
Product Code

Number1

Pipe

Size (In.)

Inlet and

Outlet

Opening Point

Range – psig (kPa)

Pressure Element

Style2

Seat Repair

Kit

Replacement

Power Elements

Commercial Type, Standard Flow – Non-Corrosive Refrigerant
V46AA-1C 3/8 NPT Threaded 70 to 260 (483 to 1,793) 30 in Capillary; 1/4 in. Flare Nut (Style 45) STT14A-600R SEP91A-600R and SEC99AA-36C3
V46AA-50C 1/4 in. External Flare Fitting (Style 5) SEP91A-600R
V46AB-1C 1/2 NPT 30 in Capillary; 1/4 in. Flare Nut (Style 45) STT15A-602R SEP91A-602R and SEC99AA-36C3
V46AB-25C 1/4 in. External Flare Fitting (Style 5) SEP91A-602R
V46AC-1C 3/4 NPT 30 in Capillary; 1/4 in. Flare Nut (Style 45) STT16A-601R SEP91A-601R and SEC99AA-36C3
V46AC-26C 1/4 in. External Flare Fitting (Style 5) SEP91A-601R
V46AD-1C 1 NPT 30 in Capillary; 1/4 in. Flare Nut (Style 45) STT17A-609R SEP91A-603R and SEC99AA-36C3
V46AD-13C 1/4 in. External Flare Fitting (Style 5) SEP91A-603R
V46AE-1C 1 1/4 NPT 30 in Capillary; 1/4 in. Flare Nut (Style 45) STT17A-610R SEP91A-603R and SEC99AA-36C3
V46AE-17C 1/4 in. External Flare Fitting (Style 5) SEP91A-603R
V46AJ-2C 1/2 Union 48 in Capillary; 1/4 in. Flare Nut (Style 46) STT15A-602R SEP77A-605R
V46EK-2C 3/4 STT16A-601R SEP127A-600R
V46AL-2C 1 STT17A-609R SEP107A-602R
V46AM-2C 1-1/4 STT17A-610R
V46AR-1C 1 1/2 Four Hole ASME Flange 30 in Capillary; 1/4 in. Flare Nut (Style 45) SEP91A-603R and SEC99AA-36C3
V46AR-10C 1/4 in. External Flare

Fitting (Style 5) (see Note below)

SEP91A-603R
V46AS-1C 2 70 to 170 (483 to 1,172) STT18A-600R SEP81A-602R
V46AS-2C 2 160 to 260 (1,103 to 1,793) SEP81A-601R
V46AT-1C 2-1/2 70 to 170 (483 to 1,172) STT18A-601R SEP81A-602R
V46AT-2C 2-1/2 160 to 260 (1,103 to 1,793) SEP81A-601R

Valves and Valve Accessories

V46 Series Pressure Actuated Water Regulating Valve (Continued)

Product Code

Number1

Pipe

Size (In.)

Inlet and

Outlet

Opening Point

Range – psig (kPa)

Pressure Element

Style2

Seat Repair

Kit

Replacement

Power Elements

Commercial Type, Low Flow – Non-Corrosive Refrigerants4
V46DA-2C 3/8 NPT Threaded 70 to 260 (483 to 1,793) 30 in Capillary; 1/4 in. Flare Nut (Style 45) STT14A-603R SEP91A-600R and SEC99AA-36C5
Commercial Type – Ammonia
V46AC-8C 3/4 NPT Threaded 100 to 200 (690 to 1,379) 1/4 in. Internal NPT (Style 15) STT16A-601R SEP70A-601R
V46AD-4C 1 NPT STT17A-609R SEP70A-604R
V46AE-4C 1-1/4 NPT STT17A-610R
V46AR-2C 1-1/2 Four Hole

ASME Flange

V46AS-3C 2 STT18A-600R SEP70A-605R
V46AT-3C 2 1/2 STT18A-601R
Maritime Type – Non-Corrosive Refrigerants
V46BA-2C 3/8 NPT Threaded 70 to 260 (483 to 1,793) 30 in. Capillary with Sweat Connection

(Style 34)

STT14A-601R SEP13A-602R
V46BB-2C 1/2 NPT STT15A-603R SEP13A-600R
V46BC-2C 3/4 NPT STT17A-613R SEP13A-603R
V46BD-2C 1 NPT STT17A-611R SEP50A-600R
V46BE-2C 1-1/4 NPT STT17A-612R
V46BS-4C 2 Four Hole

ASME Flange

160 to 260 (1,103 to 1,793) STT18A-602R SEP50A-601R
V46BT-4C 2-1/2
NAVSEA Certified – Non-Corrosive Refrigerants
V46CG-1C 3/8 Threaded 70 to 260 (483 to 1,793) 30 in. Capillary with Sweat Connection

(Style 34)

STT14A-601R SEP13A-602R
V46CH-2C 3/8 Sweat Connector
V46CH-4C 3/8
V46CH-5C 3/8
V46CJ-2C 1/2 Sweat Connector STT15A-603R SEP13A-600R
V46CN-2C 3/4 Four Hole

Navy Flange

STT17A-613R SEP13A-603R
V46CP-2C 1 STT17A-611R SEP50A-600R
V46CQ-2C 1-1/4 STT17A-612R
V46BR-2C 1-1/2 Four Hole

ASME Flange

V46CR-2C 1-1/2 Six Hole Navy Flange
V46BS-3C 2 Four Hole

ASME Flange

70 to 170 (483 to 1,172) STT18A-602R SEP50A-601R
V46CS-3C 2 Six Hole Navy Flange
V46CS-4C 2 160 to 260 (1,103 to 1,793)
V46BT-3C 2-1/2 Four Hole

ASME Flange

70 to 170 (483 to 1,172)
V46CT-3C 2-1/2 Six Hole Navy Flange
V46CT-4C 2-1/2 160 to 260 (1,103 to 1,793)
  1. Refer to V46 Series Valve Sizing Information — 90% Open Method (LIT-1927400). Then specify the code number from this chart. Refer to the Accessories chart on the following page for companion flange kit code numbers.
  2. Standard capillary length on Style 45 and Style 34 elements is 30 inches
  3. Replacement element supplied with 1/4 in. external SAE connector. Order SEC99AA Capillary Kit with 2 flare nuts separately, if needed.
  4. Low water flow valve – 2.5 GPM max.
  5. Replacement element supplied with 1/4 in. external SAE connector. Order SEC99AA Capillary Kit with 2 flare nuts separately, if needed.

Note: Use only on valves specified.

Valves and Valve Accessories

V46 Series Pressure Actuated Water Regulating Valve (Continued)

Accessories (Companion Flanges and Gaskets)

Ring Gasket (Two)

Cast Iron Flange (Two)

Hex

Machine

Product Code Number Water Valve

Size (in.)

Flange Gasket

(One Gasket per Package)

Companion Flange Kit

(See Diagram)

246-423 KIT14A-6121 1-1/2 in.
246-424 KIT14A-6131 2 in.
246-425 KIT14A-6141 2-1/2 in.

Nut (Eight) Bolt (Eight)

1. For commercial valves only

Note: Flange has NPT (National Pipe Thread)

Companion Flange Kit

Technical Specifications

V46 Series Pressure Actuated Water Regulating Valves
Maximum Water Temperature 170°F (77°C)
Valve Body Commercial 3/8 to 3/4 in. cast brass, 1 in. and larger cast iron with a special finish
Navy and Maritime Cast naval bronze with Monel® interior parts

Pressure Range Specification

Refrigerant Opening Point Range1 – psig (kPa)

V46A B, C, D

Maximum Permissible Pressure

psig (kPa)

Water Refrigerant
Static P Across Valve
Non-Corrosive Refrigerants (R12, R22, R134a, R502, R404a, R507)
All Range Valve 70 to 260 (483 to 1,793) 150 (1,034) 60 PST 320 (2,206)
All Range with High Overpressure 370 (2,551)
3/8 in. Extended All Range 70 to 300 (483 to 2,068) 440 (3,034)
Valves 2 in. or Larger
R12, R134a – 2 and 2-1/2 in. Low Range 70 to 170 (483 to 1,172) 150 (1,034) 60 PST 230 (1,586)
R22, R502, R404a, R507 – 2 and 2-1/2 in. High Range 160 to 260 (1,103 to 1,793) 320 (2,206)
Other Refrigerants
Ammonia R717 100 to 200 (690 to 1,379) 150 (1,034) 60 PST 320 (2,206)

1. Direct acting valve ranges indicate the valve opening point.

Valves and Valve Accessories Code No. LIT-1927335

V46N Series Reverse Acting Valve

Description

The V46N Series are reverse acting pressure actuated modulating valves used on either open or closed loop coolant systems.

Reverse acting valves open on a refrigerant pressure decrease. They are generally used in parallel with a direct acting valve for heat pump applications or for bypass operation.

Refer to the V46 Pressure-Actuated Water-Regulating Product Bulletin (LIT-125687) for important product application information.

Selection Chart

Applications

  • bypass systems
  • water cooled heat pumps in parallel with direct acting valve

Repair Information

If the V46N Series Reverse Acting Valve fails to operate within its specifications, replace the unit. For a replacement valve, contact the nearest Johnson Controls® representative.

V46 Series Reverse Acting Valve

Product Code

Number1

Pipe Size

In.

Inlet and

Outlet

Opening Point

Range psig (kPa)

Pressure Element

Style

Seat Repair Kit Replacement

Power Elements

Commercial Type – Non-Corrosive Refrigerants (R)
V46NA-1C 3/8 NPT Threaded 90 to 280 (621 to 1,931) 30 in. capillary with

1/4 in. flare nut

+ Schrader Valve depressor

(Style 45)

STT14A-600R SEP91A-600R & SEC99AA-36C2
V46NA-4C 40 to 1003 (276 to 690)
V46NB-1C 1/2 NPT 90 to 280 (621 to 1,931) STT15A-602R SEP91A-602R & SEC99AA-36C2
V46NB-2C 40 to 1003 (276 to 690)
V46NC-1C 3/4 NPT 90 to 280 (621 to 1,931) STT16A-601R SEP91A-601R & SEC99AA-36C2
V46NC-2C 40 to 1003 (276 to 690)
V46ND-1C 1 NPT 90 to 280 (621 to 1,931) STT17A-609R SEP91A-603R & SEC99AA-36C2
V46ND-2C 40 to 1003 (276 to 690)
V46NE-1C 1-1/4 NPT 90 to 280 (621 to 1,931) STT17A-610R
V46NE-2C 40 to 1003 (276 to 690)
  1. Refer to V46 Series Valve Sizing Information — 90% Open Method (LIT-1927400), and then specify the code number from this chart.
  2. Maximum bellows overpressure is 320 psig (2,206 kPa). Replacement element provided with 1/4 in. external SAE connector. Order SEC37A capillary kit with two flare nuts, separately if needed. Use only on valves specified.
  3. For heat pump application.

Valves and Valve Accessories Code No. LIT-1927400

V46 Series Valve Sizing Information—90% Open Method

To Select Water Valve Size:

300 Flow Chart 1136

See the Flow Chart for selection of water valves. Carefully follow the steps as outlined below.

  1. Determine maximum water flow required. The manufacturer of the condensing unit will usually provide tables, or calculations can be made from the following:
    1. Maximum Btu per hour to be removed. (Be sure to add heat gains in refrigeration equipment and heat of compression. If figures are not available, it is customary to add 25% to the load for these heat gains.)

Water Flow In Gallons/Minute

    1. Incoming water temperature at time of maximum load.
    2. Outlet water temperature; this must be lower than condensing temperature of the refrigerant

– use condensing unit manufacturer’s data, or assume 10° difference.

v46size.eps

    1. Flow (gallons/min) =

l 6 L 6L9l ln

Onll6l l6Wb6L9lnL6 – l l6l l6Wb6L9lnL6

  1. Draw horizontal line across upper half of flow chart through flow required as determined by Step 1d above.
  2. Determine the available system pressure for use with the valve by the following appropriate method:

Open System:

Available System Pressure = Inlet Pressure – condenser pressure drop – friction losses in piping.

200

100

90

80

70

60

50

40

30

20

10

9

8

7

6

5

4

3

2

1

Refrig. Head Press. Above Opening PT. (PSI)

Valve Size

3/8 in. thru 1-1/2 in.

2 in., 2-1/2 in.

Refrigerant

All-range R-12, R-500, R-22, R-502,

Ammonia, R-12, R-500

2-1/2

1-1/2

1

1-1/4

2

3/4

1/2

757

379

341

303

256

227

Water Flow In Liters/Minute

189

151

114

76

3/8

38

34

30

26

23

19

15

11

7

3.8

Closed System:

Available System Pressure = Inlet Pressure – static head – condenser pressure drop – friction

(14)

60 414

losses in piping.

50 2

5 10

20 30

40 50 6

345

The available system pressure is represented by the curve in the lower half of the flow chart.

4 Draw a horizontal line from 55 psi head pressure

rise above opening point (valve approximately 40 276
90% open) to the available system pressure. If the
point falls between two curves, use the curve to
the left (this gives an automatic safety factor).

5 From the point where the horizontal line intersects

30 207
the available system pressure curve, draw a

(34)

(69)

(138)

(207)

(276)

(345) (414)

vertical line upwards until it intersects with the horizontal line from Step 2.

  1. If the intersection falls on a valve size curve, this is the valve size.
  2. If the intersection falls between two curves, use the curve to the left for the required valve size.

20 138

10 69

0 0

Water Pressure Drop Through Valve PSI (kPa)

Flow Chart, V46 Valve

flowch1

Refrig. Head Press. Above Opening PT. (kPa)

Example:

  1. The required flow of an R404A system is found to be 40 GPM (151 l/m).

City water pressure is 40 psig (276 kPa) and manufacturer’s table gives drop through condenser and accompanying piping and valves at 15 psi (103 kPa) drop through installed piping approximately 5 psi (35 kPa), leaving a net pressure drop available of 20 psi.

  1. Draw a line through 40 GPM (151 l/m) – see dotted line, upper half of flow chart.
  2. Size valves at 55 psi head pressure rise above opening point (valve is approximately 90% open).
  3. Draw a line through 55 psi (375 kPa) – see dotted line, lower half of flow chart.
  4. Available water pressure drop through valve

= 40 – 20 = 20 psi (276 – 137 = 137 kPa).

  1. Draw vertical line upward from this point to flow line – circle on flow chart marks this intersection.
  2. Since the intersection falls between curves for 1 in. and 1-1/4 in. valves, choose the larger size. A 1-1/4 in. valve is required.

V46 Series Valve Dimensions

Valves and Valve Accessories

Code No. LIT-1927410

Roughing-in Dimensions

(A)

(E)

(D)

(C)

(B)

(G)

(F)

Commercial Service: V46 Threaded Connection Dimensions

Valve

Size

Dimensions in Inches
A B C D E F G
3/8 in. 2-5/8 6-3/4 3-1/8 1-1/2 1-1/4 13/32 3-7/32
1/2 in. 3-1/8 (3-1/4)1 7-13/32 3-3/8 1-27/32 1-1/2 13/32 3-5/8
3/4 in. 3-3/8 (3-5/8)1 7-7/8 3-7/8 2-1/32 1-3/4 13/32 3-21/32
1 in. 4-1/2 (4-7/8)1 10-3/4 5-1/2 2-25/32 2 1/2 4-3/4
1-1/4 in. 4-7/8 11-1/8 5-3/4 2-5/8 2-3/8 1/2 4-29/32

1. Values in parenthesis are for maritime valves. All other dimensions remain the same.

V46 Series Threaded Type Valves

(E)

(G)

(H)

(A)

(D)

(C)

(B)

(I)

v46tbfg4.eps

(F)

Flange Type Valves

v46tbfg5.eps

Commercial Service: V46 Flange Connection Dimensions

Valve

Size

Dimensions in Inches V46 Flange Specifications
A B C D E F G H I No. of Holes Hole Size Bolt Circle
1-1/2 in. 5-5/16 11-1/8 5-3/4 9/16 5 1-7/8 2-5/8 1/2 4-29/32 4 5/8 3-7/8
2 in. 6-5/8 13 6-15/32 5/8 6 2-1/4 3-1/2 1/2 6-1/8 4 3/4 4-3/4
2-1/2 in. 6-3/4 13-1/2 6-3/8 3/4 7 2-23/32 3-1/2 1-1/32 6-3/32 4 3/4 5-1/2

Maritime Service: ASME Flange Connection Dimensions

Valve

Size

Dimensions in Inches ASME Flange Specifications
A B C D E F G H I No. of Holes Hole Size Bolt Circle
1-1/2 in. 5-5/16 10-1/2 5-5/8 9/16 5 1-7/8 2-5/8 1/2 5 4 5/8 3-7/8
2 in. 6-3/8 13-1/8 6-1/2 1/2 6 2-3/4 3-1/2 5/8 6 4 3/4 4-3/4
2-1/2 in. 6-3/4 13-1/8 6-1/2 11/16 7 2-3/4 3-1/2 5/8 6 4 3/4 5-1/2

Navy BuShips Service: Navy Flange Connection Dimensions

Valve

Size

Dimensions in Inches Navy Flange Specifications
A B C D E F G H I No. of Holes Hole Size Bolt Circle
3/4 in. 4-3/16 7-3/4 4 7/16 3-13/16 1-1/8 2-1/32 1/2 3-5/16 4 9/16 2-11/16
1 in 5-5/16 9 4-1/2 1/2 4-1/4 1-1/4 2-5/8 1/2 4 4 9/16 3-1/8
1-1/4 in. 5-5/16 9-11/32 4-11/16 1/2 4-1/2 1-5/8 2-5/8 1/2 4-5/32 4 9/16 3-3/8
1-1/2 in. 5-5/16 10-7/32 5-3/4 1/2 5-1/16 1-7/8 2-5/8 1/2 4 6 9/16 3-15/16
2 in. 6-3/8 14-1/8 6-13/32 1/2 5-9/16 2-3/4 3-1/2 7/16 7-9/32 6 9/16 4-7/16
2-1/2 in. 6-3/8 14-5/16 6-1/2 1/2 6-1/8 2-3/4 3-1/2 5/8 7-3/16 6 9/16 5

Valves and Valve Accessories Code No. LIT-1927330

V47 Series Temperature Actuated Modulating Valve

Description

The V47 is a temperature actuated modulating valve that regulates the flow of water or glycol to maintain a desired temperature. Three temperature ranges for each valve size are available.

Many valves come with a removable bypass plug that can be replaced by the bypass orifice provided separately with each valve.

Valve action is open on temperature increase. For open on temperature decrease models, contact Application Engineering.

Refer to the V47 Series Temperature Actuated Modulating Water Valves Product Bulletin (LIT-125690) for important product application information.

Selection Chart

Features

  • no close fitting sliding parts in water passages
  • range spring does not come in contact with the cooling water
  • easy manual flushing, if required
  • valve design minimizes chatter and water hammer

Repair Information

If the V47 Series Temperature Actuated Modulating Valve fails to operate within its specifications, replace the unit. For a replacement valve, contact the nearest Johnson Controls® representative.

V47 Series Valve

Product Code

Number1

Pipe Size, in. Range

(Opening Point) °F

Bulb Size, in. (Dia. length) Std Bypass Orifice Dia., in. Seat Repair Kit Replacement Sensing Element Bulb Well Number Order Separately
V47AA-1C 3/8 115 to 180 Heating 11/16 x 3-1/4 0.062 STT14A-600R SET29A-622R WEL18A-602R
V47AA-2C 3/8 160 to 230 Heating 11/16 x 3-1/4 0.062 STT14A-600R SET29A-623R WEL18A-602R
V47AA-3C 3/8 75 to 135 Cross Ambient 11/16 x 6 0.062 STT14A-600R SET29A-601R WEL17A-601R
V47AA-26C2 3/8 20 to 65 Cross Ambient 11/16 x 63 STT14A-600R WEL17A-601R
V47AB-2C 1/2 75 to 135 Cross Ambient 11/16 x 103 STT15A-602R SET29A-602R WEL17A-600R
V47AB-3C 1/2 115 to 180 Heating 11/16 x 3-1/4 0.062 STT15A-602R SET29A-624R WEL18A-602R
V47AB-4C 1/2 160 to 230 Heating 11/16 x 3-1/4 0.062 STT15A-602R SET29A-625R WEL18A-602R
V47AB-5C 1/2 75 to 135 Cross Ambient 11/16 x 10 0.062 STT15A-602R SET29A-602R WEL17A-600R
V47AB-27C4 1/2 40 to 85 Cross Ambient 11/16 x 103 Yes5 STT15A-602R WEL17A-600R
V47AC-3C 3/4 115 to 180 Heating 11/16 x 3-1/4 0.062 STT16A-601R SET29A-626R WEL18A-602R
V47AC-4C 3/4 160 to 230 Heating 11/16 x 3-1/4 0.062 STT16A-601R SET29A-627R WEL18A-602R
V47AC-6C 3/4 75 to 135 Cross Ambient 11/16 x 10 0.062 STT16A-601R SET29A-604R WEL17A-600R
V47AC-8C 3/4 75 to 135 Heating 11/16 x 3-1/4 STT16A-601R SET98A-621R WEL18A-602R
V47AC-40C 3/4 40 to 85 Cross Ambient 11/16 x 10 Yes5 STT16A-601R WEL17A-600R
V47AD-1C 1 75 to 135 Cross Ambient 11/16 x 16-1/4 0.093 STT17A-609R SET29A-605R
V47AD-2C 1 115 to 180 Heating 11/16 x 6 0.093 STT17A-609R SET29A-629R WEL17A-601R
V47AD-3C 1 160 to 230 Heating 11/16 x 6 0.093 STT17A-609R SET29A-630R WEL17A-601R
V47AD-19C 1 40 to 85 Cross Ambient 11/16 x 16-1/4 0.093 STT17A-609R
V47AE-1C 1-1/4 75 to 135 Cross Ambient 11/16 x 16-1/4 0.093 STT17A-610R SET29A-605R
V47AE-2C 1-1/4 115 to 180 Heating 11/16 x 6 0.093 STT17A-610R SET29A-629R WEL17A-601R
V47AE-3C 1-1/4 160 to 230 Heating 11/16 x 6 0.093 STT17A-610R SET29A-630R WEL17A-601R
V47AE-13C 1-1/4 40 to 85 Cross Ambient 11/16 x 16-1/4 Yes5 STT17A-610R
V47AR-1 1-1/26 75 to 135 Cross Ambient 11/16 x 16-1/4 0.093 STT17A-610R SET29A-605R
V47AR-2 1-1/26 115 to 180 Heating 11/16 x 6 0.093 STT17A-610R SET29A-629R WEL17A-601R
V47AR-3 1-1/26 160 to 230 Heating 11/16 x 6 0.093 STT17A-610R SET29A-630R WEL17A-601R
V47AS-1 26 115 to 160 Heating 11/16 x 10 0.125 STT18A-600R SET29A-632R WEL17A-600R
V47AS-2 26 160 to 205 Heating 11/16 x 10 0.125 STT18A-600R SET29A-633R WEL17A-600R
V47AS-3 26 75 to 115 Cross Ambient 11/16 x 43 0.125 STT18A-600R SET29A-606R
V47AS-13C 26 40 to 85 Cross Ambient 11/16 x 43 Yes5 STT18A-600R
V47AT-1 2-1/26 115 to 160 Heating 11/6 x 10 0.125 STT18A-601R SET29A-632R WEL17A-600R
V47AT-2 2-1/26 160 to 205 Heating 11/6 x 10 0.125 STT18A-601R SET29A-633R WEL17A-600R
V47AT-3 2-1/26 75 to 115 Cross Ambient 11/16 x 43 0.125 STT18A-601R SET29A-606R
  1. Standard capillary is 6 ft (Style 4)
  2. 2 ft capillary
  3. Style 1 bulb (does not include 1/2 in. external NPT fitting)
  4. 4 ft capillary
  5. Solid plug installed, orifice available separately
  6. ASME Flange

Note: For more information on Bulb Wells, refer to Bulb Wells (LIT-1922135).

Valves and Valve Accessories

V47 Series Temperature Actuated Modulating Valve (Continued)

Accessories (Companion Flanges and Gaskets)

Product Code Number Water Valve

Size (in.)

Flange Gasket

(One Gasket per Package)

Companion Flange Kit

(See Diagram)

246-423 KIT14A-612 1-1/2 in.
246-424 KIT14A-613 2 in.
246-425 KIT14A-614 2-1/2 in.

Ring Gasket (Two)

Cast Iron Flange (Two)

Hex Nut (Eight)

Machine Bolt (Eight)

Note: Flanges have NPT (National Pipe Thread).

Technical Specifications

V47 Series Temperature Actuated Modulating Valves
Maximum Bulb Temperature 20F° (-6.7 C°) above temperature range
Maximum Water Temperature 170°F (77°C)
Maximum Supply Water Pressure 150 psig (1,034 kPa)
Capillary Nylon Armor1
Temperature Bulb Style 42 (pictured) (1/2 in. NPT closed tank immersion)

Companion Flange Kit Metric Conversion

  1. For capillary length, refer to the selection chart on the previous page.
°F °C
20 to 65 -6 to 18
40 to 85 4 to 29
75 to 115 24 to 46
75 to 135 24 to 57
115 to 160 46 to 71
115 to 180 46 to 82
160 to 205 71 to 96
160 to 230 71 to 110
  1. V47AA-26, V47AB-2, V47AB-27 — Temperature Bulb Style 1 (no 1/2 in. NPT external fitting)

V47 Valve Sizing Information

To Select Water Valve Size, see the flow chart for

300 1136

2-1/2

selection of water valves. Carefully follow the steps as outlined below.

  1. Determine the maximum water flow required. Draw a horizontal line through this flow across the upper half of the flow chart.
  2. Use the following method to determine the temperature rise above the opening point.
    1. Valve closing point is the highest temperature at which it is desired to have no flow through the valve.
    2. Valve opening point is about 5F° above the closing point.
    3. Determine the temperature the valve is to maintain, this is the operating temperature.
    4. Subtract the opening temperature from the operating temperature. This is the temperature rise above the opening point.
  3. Determine the available system pressure for use with the valve by the following appropriate method:

Open System:

Available System Pressure = Inlet Pressure – condenser pressure drop – friction losses in piping. Closed System:

Available System Pressure = Inlet Pressure –

200

100

90

80

70

60

50

40

30

20

Water Flow Gal. / Min.

10

9

8

7

6

5

4

3

2

36

2 5 10

2

1-1/2

1-1/4

1

3/4

1/2

3/8

50

20 30 40 (345)

757

379

349

303

265

227

189

151

114

76

Water Flow L/Min.

38

34

30

26

23

19

15

11

7

3.8

2

static head – condenser pressure drop-friction losses in piping.

The available system pressure is represented by

the curve in the lower half of the flow chart.

30

Temperature

(14)

(34)

(69)

(138)

(207)

(276)

-1

60 Temperature

  1. In the lower half of the flow curve, draw a horizontal line from the temperature above the opening point (Step 2d) to the available system pressure (Step 3). If the point falls between two pressure drop curves, use the curve to the left (this gives an automatic factor of safety).
  2. From this point, draw a vertical line until it intersects the flow line from Step 1.
  3. If the intersection falls on a valve size curve, this is the valve size.
  4. If the intersection falls between two curves, use the curve to the left for the required valve size.

Rise 24 Above

Opening Point o

( F)

18

12

6

0

Flow Chart, V47 Valve

(414)

-4 Rise Above

Opening Point o

( C)

-8

-11

v47_flowchart.eps

-14

-18

Valves and Valve Accessories Code No. LIT-1900107

V47N Series Reverse Acting Valve

Description

The V47N Series are reverse-acting, temperature-actuated, modulating valves that regulate the flow of water or glycol to maintain a desired temperature. Reverse-acting valves open on a drop in temperature. They are generally used in parallel with direct-acting valves for hand pump applications or for bypass operation.

Refer to the V47 Series Temperature Actuated Modulating Water Valves Product Bulletin (LIT-125690) for important product application information.

Applications

• bypass systems

• water-cooled heat pumps in parallel with a direct-acting valve

V47N Series Reverse Acting Valve

Selection Charts

V47N Series Reverse Acting Valve

Product Code

Number1

Pipe Size & Connector Opening Point

Range

Factory-set

Opening Point

Bulb Size,

In.

Standard Bypass

Orifice

V47NB-1C 1/2 in. Screw 85 to 155°F 105°F 11/16 x 3-1/4
V47NC-1C 3/4 in. Screw
V47NR-1C 1-1/2 in. Flange 45 to 85°F 55°F 11/16 x 16-1/4

1. Refer to sizing information in V47 Series Temperature Actuated Modulating Valve (LIT-1927330), then specify the code number from this chart.

Repair Parts and Accessories

Parts For: Product Code Number
Seat Repair Kit Replacement Sensing

Element

Bulb Well Number

(Order Separately)

V47NB-1C STT15A-602R WEL18A-602R (Brass)
V47NC-1C STT16A-601R
V47NR-1C STT17A-610R SET29A-605R

Valves and Valve Accessories Code No. LIT-1927345

V48 Series Three-Way Water Regulating Valve

Description

V48 Series valves are designed specifically for condensing units cooled either by atmospheric or forced draft cooling towers.

Refer to the V48 Series 3-Way Water Regulating Valves for Cooling Tower Systems Product Bulletin (LIT-121705) for important product application information.

Applications

V48 Series valves are used on single or multiple condenser hook-ups to the tower to provide the most economical and efficient use of the tower.

Repair Information

If the V48 Series Three-Way Water Regulating Valve fails to operate within its specifications, replace the unit. For a replacement valve, contact the nearest Johnson Controls® representative.

Selection Chart (Non-Corrosive Refrigerants)

V48 Series Three-Way Water Regulating Valve

Product

Code Number

Pipe

Size, In.

Range Opening Point

of

Normally Closed Side psi (kPa)

Pressure

Element Style

Water

Supply Pressure

Inlet

and Outlet Ports

Max

Bellows Overpressure

Seat Repair

Kit

Replacement

Sensing Element

V48AB-1C 1/2 85 to 110

(586 to 758)

30 in. capillary

with 1/4 in. flare nut (Style 45)1

150 psig

(1,034 kPa)

Threaded 230 psig

(1,586 kPa)

STT15A-605R SEP91A-602R SEC99AA-36C2
V48AB-2C 1/2 145 to 190

(1,000 to 1,310)

320 psig

(2,206 kPa)

V48AC-1C 3/4 85 to 110

(586 to 758)

230 psig

(1,586 kPa)

STT16A-604R SEP91A-601R SEC99AA-36C2
V48AC-2C 3/4 145 to 190

(1,000 to 1,310)

320 psig

(2,206 kPa)

V48AD-1C 1 85 to 110

(586 to 758)

230 psig

(1,586 kPa)

STT17A-616R SEP91A-603R SEC99AA-36C2
V48AD-2C 1 145 to 190

(1,000 to 1,310)

320 psig

(2,206 kPa)

V48AE-1C 1-1/4 85 to 110

(586 to 758)

230 psig

(1,586 kPa)

STT17A-617R
V48AE-2C 1-1/4 145 to 190

(1,000 to 1,310)

320 psig

(2,206 kPa)

V48AF-1C 1-1/2 85 to 110

(586 to 758)

1/4 in. External Flare

Fitting (Style 5)

230 psig

(1,586 kPa)

STT17A-604R SEP81A-602R
V48AF-2C 1-1/2 145 to 190

(1,000 to 1,310)

320 psig

(2,206 kPa)

SEP81A-601R
V48AJ-2C 1/2 30 in. capillary

with 1/4 in. flare nut (Style 45)

Union 320 psig

(2,206 kPa)

STT15A-605R SEP77A-605R
V48EK-2C 3/4 30 in. capillary

with 1/4 in. flare nut (Style 46)

370 psig

(2,551 kPa)

STT16A-604R SEP127A-600R
V48AL-2C 1 320 psig

(2,206 kPa)

STT17A-616R SEP107A-602R
V48AM-2C 1-1/4 STT17A-617R
  1. Standard capillary length on Style 45 elements is 30 inches
  2. Replacement element supplied with 1/4 in. external SAE connector. Order SEC99AA capillary kit with two flare nuts separately if needed. Use only on valves specified.

Technical Specifications

V48 Series Factory Settings

Refrigerant (R) Factory Settings psig (kPa)
Opening Press.

Port 1 to Port 2

Closing Press.

Port 1 to Port 3

Low Pressure (R-12, R134a, etc.) 95 (655) 120 (896)
Medium Pressure (R-22, R404A, etc.) 165 (1,138) 215 (1,482)

Valves and Valve Accessories Code No. LIT-1900163

V146 Series Two-Way Pressure-Actuated Water-Regulating Valves

Description

The V146 Series Two-Way Pressure- Actuated Water-Regulating Valves regulate water flow to control refrigerant head pressure in systems with water-cooled condensers. The V146 valves are ideal for applications with system water pressures of up to 350 psig (24.1 bar), such as high-rise buildings.

V146EK and V146AL valves have an adjustable opening point in a refrigerant pressure range of 70 to 260 psi (4.8 to

17.9 bar). V146EK and V146AL valves are available in a 3/4 in. and 1 in. size. Use these valves with standard, non-corrosive refrigerants.

V146GK1 and V146GL1 valves have an adjustable opening point in a refrigerant pressure range of 200 to 400 psi (13.8 to

27.6 bar). The V146GK1 and V146GL1 valves are available in 3/4 in. and 1 in. size for use with standard, non-corrosive, high-pressure refrigerants.

Refer to the V146 Series 2-Way

Pressure-Actuated Water-Regulating Valves Product Bulletin (LIT-121709) for important product application information.

Features

• no close-fitting or sliding parts in water passages

• high-pressure design

• pressure-balanced design

• corrosion-resistant material for internal parts

• accessible range spring

• take-apart construction

Applications

Each application is unique and requires specific engineering data to properly size and design a system to fulfill the appropriate requirements. Typically, a valve is replaced with another valve of the same size in a properly sized and engineered system.

V146 Series Valve

A

B

D

C

Port 1

Port 2

E

Pressure connection and capillary

as specified

3/4 in. V146EK Valves

High Refrigerant Pressure 3/4 in. V146GK1 Valves

A

B

D

C

Port 1

Port 2

E

FIG:V146_rnddim

FIG:V146GK_dim

Valves and Valve Accessories

V146 Series Two-Way Pressure-Actuated Water-Regulating Valves (Continued)

Valve Dimensions, Inches (Millimeters)

Product Code

Number

Nominal Valve

Size

A B C D E
V146EK-1C 3/4 in. 3-3/8 (86) 2-3/16 (55) 7-3/16 (183) 4-3/16 (106) 3 (76)
V146GK1-001C 3/4 in. 3-3/8 (86) 2-3/16 (55) 8 (204) 4-3/16 (106) 3-13/16 (98)
V146AL-1C 1 in. 4-3/4 (121) 2-13/16 (72) 10 (254) 5-15/16 (151) 4-1/16 (103)
V146GL1-001C 1 in. 4-3/4 (121) 2-13/16 (72) 10-1/2 (267) 5-15/16 (151) 4-9/16 (116)

A

B

D

C

Port 1

Port 2

E

A

B

D

C

Port 1

Port 2

E

Pressure connection and capillary as specified.

FIG:V146AL_dim

FIG:V146GL_dim

1 in. V146AL Valves

High Refrigerant Pressure 1 in. V146GL1 Valves

Selection

To make a rough field estimate of the size of valve for an application, find the valve size by locating a point on a flow chart that satisfies these requirements:

• water flow required by the condenser (Flow)

• refrigerant head pressure rise (PRISE)

• available water pressure (PAVAIL)

Follow these steps, and use the information obtained to locate a point on one of the flowcharts that satisfies all three steps.

  1. Take the water flow required by the condenser (Flow) from information provided by the manufacturer of the condensing unit. If the manufacturer’s information is unavailable, use the following information to make a rough approximation of maximum water flow in gallons per minute (gpm) (cubic meters per hour [m3/hr]):

• System Capacity (Tons of Refrigeration)

• Outlet Water Temperature (Temp. Outlet)

• Inlet Water Temperature (Temp. Inlet)

Calculate the flow using the following formula:

Flow = Tons of Refrigeration x 30 (Temp.Outlet – Temp.Inlet )

FIG:flw_eqn

Flow Required

Note: If the outlet temperature is unknown, assume it to be 10F (5.6C) above the inlet temperature.

  1. Determine refrigerant head pressure rise above the valve opening point (PRISE) using the following steps:
    1. The Valve Closing Pressure (PCLOSE) is equal to the refrigerant pressure at the highest ambient temperature the refrigeration equipment experiences in the Off cycle. Use a

Pressure-Temperature Chart for the refrigerant selected to find this pressure.

    1. To approximate the Valve Opening Pressure (POPEN), add about 7 psi (0.5 bar) for EK and AL models or 10 psi (0.7 bar) for GL1 or GK1 models to the Valve Closing Pressure.

Valves and Valve Accessories

V146 Series Two-Way Pressure-Actuated Water-Regulating Valves (Continued)

POPEN = PCLOSE +7 psi (0.5 bar)

P = P +10 psi (0.7 bar)

FIG:V14x_eqn_opn_prssr

The maximum recommended differential water pressure across a valve is 60 psi (4.1 bar).

Flow (gpm)

45

Pressure Drop Through Valve (psi)

OPEN CLOSE

Valve Opening Pressure, EK and AL Models (Top) or GK1 and GL1 Models (Bottom)

    1. From the Pressure-Temperature Chart for the refrigerant selected, read the Refrigerant Condensing Pressure (PCOND) (operating head pressure) corresponding to the selected

condensing temperature.

    1. Subtract the Valve Opening Pressure from the Refrigerant Condensing Pressure. This gives the head pressure rise.

FIG:eqn_hd_prssr_rs

PRISE = PCOND – POPEN

40

35

30

25

20

15

10

5

010 15 20 25

30 35

40 45 50

60

50

40

30

20

10

FIG:V146EK_chrt

55 60

Figure 1: Refrigerant Head Pressure Rise

  1. Determine the available water pressure to the valve (PAVAIL) using the following steps. This is the actual water pressure available to force water through the valve.
    1. Determine the minimum inlet pressure (PIN). This is the water pressure from city water mains, pumps, or other sources.
    2. Pressure drop through condenser (PCOND) is the difference in water pressure between the condenser inlet and the condenser outlet. Obtain this information from the condenser manufacturer.
    3. Estimate or calculate the pressure drop through all associated piping (PLOSS).
    4. Subtract the PCOND and PLOSS from PIN. The result is PAVAIL.

Flow (gpm)

75

70

65

60

55

50

45

40

35

30

25

20

15

10

5

0

Cooling Tower

Pump

P2

P1

2-Way Valve

oss 2

P

Loss

Condenser

FIG:2wy_prss_drp

FIG:V146AL_chrt

Refrigerant Head Pressure Rise (psi)

3/4 in. V146EK Valve

60

Pressure Drop Through Valve (psi)

50

40

30

20

10

10 15 20 25 30 35 40 45 50 55 60

P Refrigerant Head Pressure Rise (psi)

IN

1 in. V146AL Valve

P

L 1

PCOND = P1 – P2 + P + …

P = PLoss 1 Loss 2 LOSS

PAVAIL = PIN – ( PCOND + PLOSS)

Available Water Pressure

  1. Select the proper valve size from the flowcharts by locating a point on a chart that satisfies the flow, the head pressure rise above opening point, and the pressure drop across the valve.

Use these equations to convert between U.S. and S.I. units.

• 1 dm3/s = 3.6 m3/h = 15.9 U.S. gal. /min. = 13.2 U.K. gal. /min.

• 1 bar = 100 kPa = 0.1 MPa  1.02 kg/cm2 = 0.987 atm  14.5 psi

Valves and Valve Accessories

V146 Series Two-Way Pressure-Actuated Water-Regulating Valves (Continued)

Refrigerant Head Pressure Rise (bar)

0.7

Flow

10 (0.7)

Pressure Drop Through Valve, psi (bar)

5 (0.3)

2 (0.1)

60 (4.1)

50 (3.4)

40 (2.8)

30 (2.1)

25 (1.7)

20 (1.4)

1.7

2.7

3.7

4.7

5.7

6.7

Flow

(GPM)

45

40

35

30

25

20

15

10

5

(m3/hr) 10

8

6

4

2

0

10 20 30 40

50 60 70 80

0

90 100

FIG:V146GK1_chrt

Refrigerant Head Pressure Rise (psig)

High Refrigerant Pressure 3/4 in. V146GK1 Valves

Flow GPM

70

60

50

40

30

20

10

Refrigerant Head Pressure Rise (bar)

Flow m3/hr

1.3

2.3

3.3

4.3

5.3

6.3

7.3

60 (4.1)

50 (3.4)

40 (2.8)

30 (2.1)

25 (1.7)

20 (1.4)

10 (1.0)

5 (0.3)

2 (0.1)

Pressure Drop Through Valve psig (m3/hr)

16.2

14.2

12.2

10.2

8.2

6.2

4.2

2.2

0

10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90

Refrigerant Head Pressure Rise (psig)

0.2

High Refrigerant Pressure 1 in. V146GL1 Valves

FIG:V146GL_chrt

Valves and Valve Accessories

V146 Series Two-Way Pressure-Actuated Water-Regulating Valves (Continued)

Style 5 Style 46

1/4-in. SAE External Flare Connector

Copper Capillary with

1/4-in. SAE Internal Flare Connector (Includes Valve Stem Depressor)

Pressure Connection Styles

Selection Chart

Product Code Number Nominal Valve Size Inlet and Outlet Ports Pressure Connection

Style

Shipping Weight, lb (kg)
V146EK-1C 3/4 in. Union (Sweat) 46 4.3 (2.0)
V146GK1-001C 3/4 in. Union (Sweat) 5 4.3 (2.0)
V146AL-1C 1 in. Union (Sweat) 46 9.3 (4.0)
V146GL1-001C 1 in. Union (Sweat) 5 9.3 (4.0)

Repair Information

If the V146 Series Two-Way Pressure-Actuated Water-Regulating Valve fails to operate within its specifications, refer to the V146 Series Two-Way Pressure-Actuated Water-Regulating Valves Product Bulletin (LIT-1201709) for a list of repair parts available.

Technical Specifications

V146 Series 2-Way Pressure-Actuated Water-Regulating Valves
Maximum Refrigerant Pressure V146EK: 370 psi (25.5 bar)

V146AL: 320 psi (22.1 bar)

Maximum Working Pressure V146GK1, V146GL1: 630 psi (43.4 bar)
Opening Point Adjustment Range V146EK, V146AL: 70 to 260 psi (4.8 to 17.9 bar)

V146GK1, V146GL1: 200 to 400 psi (13.8 to 27.6 bar)

Factory-Set Opening Point V146EK, V146AL: 165 psi (11.4 bar)

V146GK1, V146GL1: 275 psi (19.0 bar)

Media 350 psi (24.1 bar) maximum,

-4F to 170F (-20C to 77C) glycol/water or liquids with low freezing points that are compatible with valve materials

Valves and Valve Accessories Code No. LIT-1900164

V148 Series Three-Way Pressure-Actuated Water-Regulating Valves

Description

The V148 Series Three-Way

Pressure-Actuated Water-Regulating Valves regulate water flow to control refrigerant head pressure in systems with single or multiple water-cooled condensers. The V148 valves are designed for applications with system water pressures of up to 350 psi (24.1 bar), such as high-rise buildings.

V148EK and V148AL valves have an adjustable opening point in a refrigerant pressure range of 145 to 190 psi (10.0 to

13.1 bar). V148EK and V148AL valves are available in 3/4 in. and 1 in. sizes. Use these valves with standard, non-corrosive refrigerants.

V148GK1 and V148GL1 valves have an adjustable opening point in a refrigerant pressure range of 200 to 400 psi (13.8 to

    1. bar). The V148GK1 and V148GL1 Valves are available in 3/4 in. and 1 in. sizes for use with standard, non-corrosive,

high-pressure refrigerants.

Refer to the V148 Series 3-Way

Pressure-Actuated Water-Regulating Valves Product Bulletin (LIT-121712) for important product application information.

Features

• no close-fitting or sliding parts in water passages

• high water pressure design

• pressure-balanced design

• corrosion-resistant material for internal parts

• accessible range spring

• take-apart construction

Applications

Each application is unique and requires specific engineering data to properly size and design a system to fulfill the appropriate requirements. Typically, a valve is replaced with another valve of the same size in a properly sized and engineered system.

V148 Series Valve

A

B

C

Port 1

Port 2

D

E

Port 3

Plugged

F

Pressure connection and capillary as specified

A

B

C

Port 1

Port 2

D

E

Port 3

Plugged

F

Pressure connection and capillary as specified

3/4 in. V148EK Valve 1 in. V148AL Valve

FIG:V148EK_075_dim

FIG:V148AL_100_dim

Valves and Valve Accessories

V148 Series Three-Way Pressure-Actuated Water-Regulating Valves (Continued)

Valve Dimensions, Inches (Millimeters)

Model Nominal

Valve Size

A B C D E F
V148EK-1C 3/4 in. 3-3/8 (86) 2-3/16 (56) 9 (229) 4-3/16 (106) 1-3/4 (44) 3 (76)
V148GK1-001C 3/4 in. 3-3/8 (86) 2-3/16 (56) 9-13/16 (249) 4-3/16 (106) 1-3/4 (44) 3-13/16 (97)
V148AL-1C 1 in. 4-3/4 (121) 2-3/4 (71) 12 (305) 5-15/16 (151) 2 (51) 4 (102)
V148GL1-001C 1 in. 4-3/4 (121) 2-3/4 (71) 12-1/2 (318) 5-15/16 (151) 2 (51) 4-1/2 (115)

3/4 in. High Refrigerant Pressure V148GK1 Valves

A

B

C

Port 1

Port 2

D

Port 3

Plugged

F

E

A

B

C

Port 1

Port 2

D

E

Port 3

Plugged

F

FIG:V148GK1_075_dim

FIG:V148GL1_100_dim

1 in. High Refrigerant Pressure V148GL1 Valves

Selection

To make a rough field estimate of the size of valve for an application, find the valve size by locating a point on a flow chart that satisfies these requirements:

• water flow required by the condenser (Flow)

• refrigerant head pressure rise (PRISE)

• available water pressure (PAVAIL)

Follow these steps, and use the information obtained to locate a point on one of the flowcharts that satisfies all three steps.

  1. Take the water flow required by the condenser (Flow) from information provided by the manufacturer of the condensing unit. If the manufacturer’s information is unavailable, use the following information to make a rough approximation of maximum water flow in gallons per minute (gpm) (cubic meters per hour [m3/hr]):

• System Capacity (Tons of Refrigeration)

• Outlet Water Temperature (Temp. Outlet)

• Inlet Water Temperature (Temp. Inlet)

Calculate the flow using the following formula:

Flow = Tons of Refrigeration x 30 (Temp.Outlet – Temp.Inlet )

FIG:flw_eqn

Flow Required

Note: If the outlet temperature is unknown, assume it to be 10F (5.6C) above the inlet temperature.

  1. Determine refrigerant head pressure rise above the valve opening point (PRISE) using the following steps:
    1. The Valve Closing Pressure (PCLOSE) is equal to the refrigerant pressure at the highest ambient temperature the

refrigeration equipment experiences in the Off cycle. Use a Pressure-Temperature Chart for the refrigerant selected to find this pressure.

    1. To approximate the Valve Opening Pressure (POPEN), add about 7 psi (0.5 bar) for EK and AL models or 10 psi (0.7 bar) for GK1 and GL1 models to the Valve Closing Pressure.

Valves and Valve Accessories

V148 Series Three-Way Pressure-Actuated Water-Regulating Valves (Continued)

POPEN = PCLOSE +7 psi (0.5 bar) POPEN = PCLOSE +10 psi (0.7 bar)

FIG:V14x_eqn_opn_prssr

Valve Opening Pressure, EK and AL Models (Top) or GK1 and GL1 Models (Bottom)

    1. From the Pressure-Temperature Chart for the refrigerant

Use these equations to convert between U.S. and S.I. units.

  • 1 dm3/s = 3.6 m3/h = 15.9 U.S. gal. /min. = 13.2 U.K. gal. /min.
  • 1 bar = 100 kPa = 0.1 MPa  1.02 kg/cm2 = 0.987 atm  14.5 psi

Flow (gpm)

Pressure Drop Through Valve (psi)

selected, read the Refrigerant Condensing Pressure (PCOND) 30 30

(operating head pressure) corresponding to the selected

condensing temperature. 25 20

    1. Subtract the Valve Opening Pressure from the Refrigerant

Condensing Pressure. This gives the head pressure rise. 20 15

10

FIG:eqn_hd_prssr_rs

15

7

PRISE = PCOND – POPEN

10

FIG:V148EK_chrt

Refrigerant Head Pressure Rise

  1. Determine the available water pressure to the valve (PAVAIL) using the following steps. This is the actual water pressure available to force water through the valve.
    1. Determine the minimum inlet pressure (PIN). This is the water pressure from city water mains, pumps, or other sources.
    2. Pressure drop through condenser (PCOND) is the difference in water pressure between the condenser inlet and the condenser outlet. Obtain this information from the condenser manufacturer.
    3. Estimate or calculate the pressure drop through all associated

5

0

Flow

10 15 20 25 30 35 40 45 50 55 60

Refrigerant Head Pressure Rise (psi)

3/4 in. V148EK Valve

piping (PLOSS).

    1. Subtract the PCOND and PLOSS from PIN. The result is PAVAIL.

FIG:3wy_prss_drp

Cooling Tower

Pump

P

IN

3-Way

(gpm)

55 30

Pressure Drop Through Valve (psi)

50

45 20

40 15

35

30 10

25 7

20

15

FIG:V148AL_chrt

Valve

P2 P1 10

Condenser

P P 5

Loss 2

Loss 1

Balancing Valve Bypass Line

P

=

LOSS

P

Loss 1 Loss 2

+ P

+ …

PCOND = P1 – P2

0

10 15 20 25 30 35 40 45 50 55 60

Refrigerant Head Pressure Rise (psi)

1 in. V148AL Valve

PAVAIL= PIN – ( PCOND + PLOSS)

Available Water Pressure

  1. Select the proper valve size from the flowcharts by locating a point on a chart that satisfies the flow, the head pressure rise above opening point, and the pressure drop across the valve.

Valves and Valve Accessories

V148 Series Three-Way Pressure-Actuated Water-Regulating Valves (Continued)

Flow (GPM)

45

40

35

30

25

20

15

10

5

Refrigerant Head Pressure Rise (bar)

0.7 1.7 2.7 3.7 4.7 5.7 6.7

Flow (m3/hr)

60 (4.1)

50 (3.4)

Pressure Drop Through Valve psi (bar)

40 (2.8)

30 (2.1)

25 (1.7)

20 (1.4)

10 (0.7)

5 (0.3)

2 (0.1)

10

8

6

4

2

0 0

10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 100

FIG:V148GK1

Refrigerant Head Pressure Rise (psig)

High Refrigerant Pressure 3/4 in. V148GK1 Valve

Flow GPM

70

60

Refrigerant Head Pressure Rise (bar)

1.3 2.3 3.3 4.3 5.3 6.3 7.3

60 (4.1)

50 (3.4)

40 (2.8)

Flow m3/hr 16.2

14.2

30 (2.1)

50 25 (1.7)

20 (1.4)

40

10 (1.0)

30

5 (0.3)

20

2 (0.1)

10

Pressure Drop Through Valve psig (m3/hr)

0

10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 100 110

FIG:V148GL_chrt

Refrigerant Head Pressure Rise (psig)

12.2

10.2

8.2

6.2

4.2

2.2

0.2

High Refrigerant Pressure 1 in. V148GL1 Valve

Valves and Valve Accessories

V148 Series Three-Way Pressure-Actuated Water-Regulating Valves (Continued)

Style 5

Style 46

Copper Capillary with

1/4-in. SAE External Flare Connector 1/4-in. SAE Internal Flare Connector

(Includes Valve Stem Depressor)

Pressure Connection Styles

Selection Chart

Product Code Number Nominal Valve

Size

Inlet and Outlet Ports Pressure Connection Style Shipping Weight, lb (kg)
V148EK-1C 3/4 in. Union (Sweat) 46 7 (3.2)
V148GK1-001C 3/4 in. Union (Sweat) 5 7 (3.2)
V148AL-1C 1 in. Union (Sweat) 46 12 (5.4)
V148GL1-001C 1 in. Union (Sweat) 5 12 (5.4)

Repair Information

If the V148 Series Three-Way Pressure-Actuated Water-Regulating Valve fails to operate within its specifications, refer to the V148 Series Three-Way Pressure-Actuated Water-Regulating Valves Product Bulletin (LIT-121712) for a list of repair parts available.

Technical Specifications

V148 Series 3-Way Pressure-Actuated Water-Regulating Valves
Maximum Refrigerant Pressure V148EK: 370 psig (25.5 bar)

V148AL: 320 psig (22.1 bar)

Maximum Working Pressure V148GK1, V148GL1: 630 psig (43.4 bar)
Factory-Set Opening Point (Port 1 to Port 2) V148EK, V148AL: 165 psig (11.4 bar)

V148GK1, V148GL1: 275 psig (19.0 bar)

Opening Point Adjustment Range (Port 1 to Port 2) V148EK, V148AL: 145 to 190 psi (10.0 to 13.1 bar)

V148GK1, V148GL1: 200 to 400 psi (13.8 to 27.6 bar)

Throttling Range V148EK, V148AL: 70 psig (4.8 bar)

V148GK1, V148GL1: 100 psig (6.9 bar)

Media 350 psi (24.1 bar) maximum,

-4F to 170F (-20C to 77C) glycol/water or liquids with low freezing points that are compatible with valve materials

Valves and Valve Accessories Code No. LIT-1900575

V246 Series Two-Way Pressure-Actuated Water-Regulating Valves for High-Pressure Refrigerants

Description

The V246 Series Two-Way

Pressure-Actuated Water-Regulating Valves for High-Pressure Refrigerants come in two types of control action: direct acting and reverse acting. V246 valves regulate water flow to control refrigerant head pressure in systems with water-cooled condensers.

The V246 Series Valves are available in 3/8 in. through 2 in. sizes and have a maximum allowable water pressure of 150 psig

(10.3 bar). Direct acting V246 valves have an adjustable opening point in a refrigerant pressure range of 200 to 400 psi

(13.8 to 27.6 bar), and reverse acting valves have a range of 135 to 300 psi

(9.3 to 20.7 bar). V246 valves may be used with standard non-corrosive refrigerants.

Maritime models, which have nickel copper (Monel®) internal parts, are available for applications where the media may be corrosive to the internal parts.

Selection Charts

Refer to the V246 Series 2-Way

Pressure-Actuated Water-Regulating Valves for High-Pressure Refrigerants Product Bulletin (LIT-12011514) for important product application information.

Features

• no close fitting or sliding parts in water passages

• accessible range spring

• take-apart construction

• pressure-balanced design

• corrosion-resistant material for internal parts

Repair Information

If the V246 Series Two-Way

Pressure-Actuated Water-Regulating Valve for High Pressure Refrigerants fails to operate within its specifications, refer to the V246 Series Two-Way Pressure-Actuated

Water-Regulating Valves for High Pressure Refrigerants Product Bulletin (LIT-12011514) for a list of repair parts available.

V246 Series Water-Regulating Valve

North American Standard Production Models

Product Code Number Construction Valve Size and Connection Element Style Shipping Weight,

lb (kg)

V246GA1-001C Direct Acting1, Commercial 3/8 in. NPT Screw Style 5 1.8 (0.8)
V246GB1-001C Direct Acting1, Commercial 1/2 in. NPT Screw Style 5 3.0 (1.4)
V246GC1-001C Direct Acting1, Commercial 3/4 in. NPT Screw Style 5 3.7 (1.7)
V246GD1-001C Direct Acting1, Commercial 1 in. NPT Screw Style 5 9.3 (4.2)
V246GE1-001C Direct Acting1, Commercial 1-1/4 in. NPT Screw Style 5 10 (4.5)
V246GM1-001C Direct Acting1, Commercial 1-1/4 in. Union Sweat Style 5 10 (4.5)
V246GR1-001C Direct Acting1, Commercial 1-1/2 in. Flange Style 5 13.6 (6.2)
V246GS1-001C Direct Acting1, Commercial 2 in. Flange Style 5 27 (12.3)
V246HA1-001C Direct Acting1, Maritime 3/8 in. NPT Screw Style 5 1.8 (0.8)
V246HB1-001C Direct Acting1, Maritime 1/2 in. NPT Screw Style 5 3.0 (1.4)
V246HC1-001C Direct Acting1, Maritime 3/4 in. NPT Screw Style 5 4.3 (2.0)
V246HD1-001C Direct Acting1, Maritime 1 in. NPT Screw Style 5 9.5 (4.3)
V246HE1-001C Direct Acting1, Maritime 1-1/4 in. NPT Screw Style 5 10.3 (4.7)
V246HR1-001C Direct Acting1, Maritime 1-1/2 in. ASME Flange Style 5 13.6 (6.2)
V246HS1-001C Direct Acting1, Maritime 2 in. ASME Flange Style 5 27 (12.3)
V246KA1-001C Direct Acting1, Commercial, Low Flow 3/8 in. NPT Screw Style 5 1.8 (0.8)
V246NA1-001C Reverse Acting2, Commercial 3/8 in. NPT Screw Style 5 1.8 (0.8)
V246NB1-001C Reverse Acting2, Commercial 1/2 in. NPT Screw Style 5 3.0 (1.4)
V246NC1-001C Reverse Acting2, Commercial 3/4 in. NPT Screw Style 5 3.7 (1.7)
V246ND1-001C Reverse Acting2, Commercial 1 in. NPT Screw Style 5 9.3 (4.2)
  1. The range is 200 to 400 psi (13.8 to 27.6 bar).
  2. The range is 135 to 300 psi (9.3 to 20.7 bar).

European Standard Production Models (Part 1 of 2)

Product Code Number Construction Valve Size and Connection Element Style Shipping Weight,

kg (lb)

V246GA1A001C Direct Acting, Commercial 3/8 in. BSPP Screw, ISO 228 Style 5 0.8 (1.8)
V246GB1A001C Direct Acting, Commercial 1/2 in. BSPP Screw, ISO 228 Style 5 1.4 (3.0)
V246GC1A001C Direct Acting, Commercial 3/4 in. BSPP Screw, ISO 228 Style 5 1.7 (3.7)
V246GD1B001C Direct Acting, Commercial 1 in. BSPT Screw, ISO 7 Style 5 4.2 (9.3)
V246GE1B001C Direct Acting, Commercial 1-1/4 in. BSPT Screw, ISO 7 Style 5 4.5 (10)

Valves and Valve Accessories

V246 Series Two-Way Pressure-Actuated Water-Regulating Valves for High-Pressure Refrigerants (Continued)

European Standard Production Models (Part 2 of 2)

Product Code Number Construction Valve Size and Connection Element Style Shipping Weight,

kg (lb)

V246GR1B001C Direct Acting, Commercial 1-1/2 in. Flange, DIN2533 Style 5 6.2 (13.6)
V246GS1B001C Direct Acting, Commercial 2 in. Flange, DIN2533 Style 5 12.3 (27)
V246HA1B001C Direct Acting, Maritime 3/8 in. BSPP Screw, ISO 228 Style 5 0.8 (1.8)
V246HB1B001C Direct Acting, Maritime 1/2 in. BSPP Screw, ISO 228 Style 5 1.4 (3.0)
V246HC1B001C Direct Acting, Maritime 3/4 in. BSPP Screw, ISO 228 Style 5 2.0 (4.3)
V246HD1B001C Direct Acting, Maritime 1 in. BSPP Screw, ISO 228 Style 5 4.3 (9.5)
V246HE1B001C Direct Acting, Maritime 1-1/4 in. BSPP Screw, ISO 228 Style 5 4.7 (10.3)
V246HR1B001C Direct Acting, Maritime 1-1/2 in. Flange, DIN86021 Style 5 6.2 (13.6)
V246HS1B001C Direct Acting, Maritime 2 in. Flange, DIN86021 Style 5 12.3 (27)

Valve Sizing Information

Each application is unique and requires specific engineering data to properly size and design a system to fulfill the appropriate requirements. Typically, a valve is replaced with another valve of the same size in a properly sized and engineered system. In North America, contact Johnson Controls/PENN® Refrigeration Application Engineering at 1-800-275-5676 to obtain specific engineering data. In other areas, contact the local Johnson Controls® sales office to obtain specific engineering data.

To make a rough field estimate of the size of valve for an application, find the valve size needed by locating a point on a flow chart that satisfies these requirements:

• water flow required by the condenser (Flow)

• refrigerant head pressure rise (PRISE)

• available water pressure (PAVAIL)

Follow these steps, and use the information obtained to locate a point on one of the flowcharts that satisfies all three steps.

1. Take the water flow required by the condenser (Flow) from information provided by the manufacturer of the condensing unit. If the manufacturer’s information is unavailable, use the following information to make a rough approximation of water flow in gallons per minute (gpm) [cubic meters per hour (m3/hr)]:

• System Capacity (Tons of Refrigeration)

• Outlet Water Temperature (Temp. Outlet)

• Inlet Water Temperature (Temp. Inlet) Calculate the flow using the following formula:

Tons of Refrigeration x 30

.

POPEN = PCLOSE +10 psi (0.7 bar)

FIG:eqn_opn_pr

Valve Opening Pressure

    1. From the Pressure-Temperature Chart for the refrigerant selected, read the Refrigerant Condensing Pressure (PCOND) (operating head pressure) corresponding to the selected

condensing temperature.

    1. Subtract the Valve Opening Pressure from the Refrigerant Condensing Pressure. This gives the head pressure rise.

FIG:eqn_hd_prssr_rs

PRISE = PCOND – POPEN

Refrigerant Head Pressure Rise

  1. Determine the available water pressure to the valve (PAVAIL) using the following steps. This is the actual water pressure available to force water through the valve.
    1. Determine the inlet pressure (PIN). This is the water pressure from city water mains, pumps, or other sources.
    2. Pressure drop through condenser (PCOND) is the difference in water pressure between the condenser inlet and the condenser outlet. Obtain this information from the condenser manufacturer.
    3. Estimate or calculate the pressure drop through all associated piping (PLOSS).
    4. Subtract the PCOND and PLOSS from PIN. The result is PAVAIL.

FIG:2wy_prss_drp

Flow =

(Temp.Outlet – Temp.Inlet)

Pump

P2

2-Way Valve

Condenser

P1

oss 2

P

Loss

Cooling Tower

FIG:flw_eqn

P

IN

Flow Required

Note: If the outlet temperature is unknown, assume it to be 10F (6C) above the inlet temperature.

  1. Determine refrigerant head pressure rise above the valve opening point (PRISE) using the Refrigerant Head Pressure Rise figure and the following steps:
    1. The Valve Closing Pressure (PCLOSE) is equal to the refrigerant pressure at the highest ambient temperature the refrigeration equipment experiences in the Off cycle. Use a

Pressure-Temperature Chart for the refrigerant selected to find this pressure.

    1. To approximate the Valve Opening Pressure (POPEN), add about 10 psi (0.7 bar) to the Valve Closing Pressure.

Note: Add about 20 psi (1.4 bar) for 3/8 in. valves.

P

L 1

PCOND= P1 – P2 P = P + P + …

LOSS Loss 1 Loss 2

PAVAIL= PIN – ( PCOND + PLOSS)

Available Water Pressure

4. Select the proper valve size from the flowcharts by locating a point on a chart that satisfies the flow, the head pressure rise above opening point, and the pressure drop across the valve.

Metric Conversions

Use these equations to convert between U.S. and S.I. units.

• 1 dm3/s = 3.6 m3/h = 15.9 U.S. gal. /min. = 13.2 U.K. gal. /min.

• 1 bar = 100 kPa = 0.1 MPa  1.02 kg/cm2 = 0.987 atm  14.5 psi

Valves and Valve Accessories

V246 Series Two-Way Pressure-Actuated Water-Regulating Valves for High-Pressure Refrigerants (Continued)

V246 Flowcharts

The maximum recommended differential water pressure across a valve is 60 psig (4.1 bar).

Refrigerant Head Pressure Above Opening PRise ( bar )

Flow (gpm)

3.0

0.7 1.4 2.1 2.8 3.5 4.2 4.9 5.5 6.2 6.9 7.6 8.3

Flow (m3/hr)

5 (0.3)

60 (4.1)

50 (3.4)

40 (2.8)

30 (2.1)

20 (1.4)

1

4.5 (1.0)

10 (0.7)

Pre

ssure Dro

PAvail p Throug

h Valve p

2 (0.1)

sig (bar)

2.5 0.6

2.0 0.5

1.5 0.3

1.0 0.2

0.5 0.1

0.0 0.0

FIG:V246_3.8 in. Low graph

10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 100 110 120 130

Refrigerant Head Pressure Above Opening PRise ( psig )

3/8 in. Direct Acting Low-Flow Valve Flowchart

Refrigerant Head Pressure Above Opening PRise ( bar )

Flow (gpm)

0.7 1.4 2.1 2.8 3.5 4.2 4.9 5.5 6.2 6.9 7.6 8.3

18

g

60 (4.1)

50 (3.4)

40 (2.8)

30 (2.1)

20 (1.4)

1

4.5 (1.0)

10 (0.7)

5 (0.3)

2 (0.1)

Pre

ssure Dr

PAvail op Throu

h Valve p

sig (bar)

Flow (m3/hr)

16 3.6

14 3.2

12 2.7

10 2.3

8 1.8

6 1.4

4 0.9

2 0.5

FIG:V246_3.8 in. graph

0

10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 100 110 120 130

Refrigerant Head Pressure Above Opening PRise ( psig )

3/8 in. Direct Acting Valve Flowchart

0.0

Valves and Valve Accessories

V246 Series Two-Way Pressure-Actuated Water-Regulating Valves for High-Pressure Refrigerants (Continued)

Refrigerant Head Pressure Above Opening PRise ( bar )

Flow (gpm)

0.7 1.4 2.1 2.8 3.5 4.2 4.9 5.5 6.2 6.9 7.6 8.3

30

60 (4.1)

50 (3.4)

40 (2.8)

5 (0.3)

2 (0.1)

ig (bar)

30 (2.1)

20 (1.4)

1

4.5 (1.0)

10 (0.7)

Pres

sure Dro

PAvail p Through

Valve ps

Flow (m3/hr)

25 5.7

20 4.5

15 3.4

10 2.3

5 1.1

FIG:V246_0.5 in. graph

0

10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 100 110 120 130

Refrigerant Head Pressure Above Opening PRise ( psig )

1/2 in. Direct Acting Valve Flowchart

0.0

Refrigerant Head Pressure Above Opening PRise ( bar )

Flow (gpm)

0.7 1.4 2.1 2.8 3.5 4.2 4.9 5.5 6.2 6.9 7.6 8.3

35

e

60 (4.1)
50 (3.4)

40 (2.8)

30 (2.1)
1 20 (1.4)

4.5 (1.0)

10 (0.7)
5 (0.3)

2 (0.1)

Pr ssure Dr PAvai op Throu l

gh Valve p

sig (bar)

30

25

20

15

10

5

0

10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 100 110 120 130

Refrigerant Head Pressure Above Opening PRise ( psig )

3/4 in. Direct Acting Valve Flowchart

Flow (m3/hr)

6.8

5.7

4.5

3.4

2.3

1.1

0.0

FIG:V246_0.75 in. graph

Valves and Valve Accessories

V246 Series Two-Way Pressure-Actuated Water-Regulating Valves for High-Pressure Refrigerants (Continued)

Refrigerant Head Pressure Above Opening PRise ( bar )

Flow (gpm)

60

50

40

30

20

10

FIG:V246_1.0 in. graph

0.7 1.4 2.1 2.8 3.5 4.2 4.9 5.5 6.2 6.9 7.6 8.3

Flow (m3/hr)

13.6

11.4

9.1

6.8

4.5

2.3

0

60 (4.1)

50 (3.4)

40 (2.8)

30 (2.1)

20 (1.4)
1 4.5 (1.0)

10 (0.7)

5 (0.3)

2 (0.1)

Pre ssure Dro PAvail p Throug h Valve p sig (bar)

10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 100 110 120 130

Refrigerant Head Pressure Above Opening PRise ( psig )

1 in. Direct Acting Valve Flowchart

0.0

Refrigerant Head Pressure Above Opening PRise ( bar )

Flow (gpm)

120

100

80

60

40

20

0

0.7 1.4 2.1 2.8 3.5 4.2 4.9 5.5 6.2 6.9 7.6 8.3

60 (4.1)

50 (3.4)

40 (2.8)

30 (2.1)

20 (1.4)
1 4.5 (1.0)

10 (0.7)

5 (0.3)

2 (0.1)

Pre ssure Dro PAvail p Throug h Valve p sig (bar)

10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 100 110 120 130

FIG:V246_1.25 in. graph

Refrigerant Head Pressure Above Opening PRise ( psig )

1-1/4 in. Direct Acting Valve Flowchart

27.3

22.7

18.2

13.6

9.1

4.5

0.0

Flow (m3/hr)

Valves and Valve Accessories

V246 Series Two-Way Pressure-Actuated Water-Regulating Valves for High-Pressure Refrigerants (Continued)

Refrigerant Head Pressure Above Opening PRise ( bar )

Flow (gpm)

120

100

80

60

40

20

0

0.7 1.4 2.1 2.8 3.5 4.2 4.9 5.5 6.2 6.9 7.6 8.3

60 (4.1)

50 (3.4)

40 (2.8)

30 (2.1)

20 (1.4)
14.5 (1.0)

10 (0.7)

5 (0.3)

2 (0.1)

Pre ssure Dro PAvail p Throug h Valve p sig (bar)

10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 100 110 120 130

Refrigerant Head Pressure Above Opening PRise ( psig )

1-1/2 in. Direct Acting Valve Flowchart

Flow (m3/hr)

27.3

22.7

18.2

13.6

9.1

4.5

0.0

FIG:V246_1.5 in. graph

Refrigerant Head Pressure Above Opening PRise ( bar )

Flow (gpm)

120

0.7 1.4 2.1 2.8 3.5 4.2 4.9 5.5 6.2 6.9 7.6 8.3

27.3

60 (4.1)

50 (3.4)

40 (2.8)

30 (2.1)

20 (1.4)

1

4.5 (1.0)

10 (0.7)

5 (0.3)

2 (0.1)

P

ressure D

PAvai rop Throu

l

gh Valve

psi (bar)

Flow (m3/hr)

100 22.7

80 18.2

60 13.6

40 9.1

20 4.5

FIG:V246_2 in. graph

0

10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 100 110 120 130

Refrigerant Head Pressure Above Opening PRise ( psig )

2 in. Direct Acting Valve Flowchart

0.0

Valves and Valve Accessories

Dimensions

V246 Series Two-Way Pressure-Actuated Water-Regulating Valves for High-Pressure Refrigerants (Continued)

B

A B

D

D C

C

E

Port 1 Port 2

E

A

FIG:V246_thrdd

FIG:V246_anglbdy

V246 Screw Connection Valves Dimensions

V246 Angle-Body Screw Connection Valves Dimensions

V246 Screw Connection Valves Dimensions
Valve Size Dimensions in Inches (Millimeters)
A B C D E
3/8 in. 2-5/8 (67) 1-5/8 (41) 6-1/2 (166) 3-1/2 (89) 3 (77)
1/2 in. 3-1/16 (78) 2 (51) 7-3/16 (182) 3-13/16 (96) 3-3/8 (86)
3/4 in. 3-3/8 (86) 2-3/16 (55) 8 (203) 4-3/16 (106) 3-13/16 (98)
1 in. 4-3/4 (121) 2-13/16 (71) 10-1/2 (267) 5-15/16 (151) 4-9/16 (116)
1-1/4 in. 4-3/4 (121) 2-13/16 (71) 10-7/8 (276) 6-1/8 (156) 4-3/4 (121)
V246 Angle-Body Screw Connection Valves Dimensions
Valve Size Dimensions in Inches (Millimeters)
A B C D E
3/8 in. 2-3/4 (70) 1-5/8 (41) 6-15/16 (176) 3-5/8 (92) 3-1/8 (80)
1/2 in. 3-1/8 (80) 2 (51) 7-1/2 (191) 3-7/8 (98) 3-1/2 (88)
3/4 in. 3-9/16 (90) 2-1/8 (55) 8-9/16 (217) 4-5/16 (110) 4 (101)

FIG:V246_unnbdy

Valves and Valve Accessories

V246 Series Two-Way Pressure-Actuated Water-Regulating Valves for High-Pressure Refrigerants (Continued)

A

B

D

C

Port 1

Port 2

E

V246 Union Sweat Connection Valves Dimensions

V246 Union Sweat Connection Valves Dimensions

F

G

H

FIG:flng_bdy

Valve Size Dimensions in Inches (Millimeters)
A B C D E
1-1/4 in. 4-3/4 (121) 2-13/16 (71) 10-7/8 (276) 6-1/8 (156) 4-3/4 (121)

A

B

C

E

D

V246 Flange Valve Dimensions

Valves and Valve Accessories

V246 Series Two-Way Pressure-Actuated Water-Regulating Valves for High-Pressure Refrigerants (Continued)

V246 Flange Valve, Commercial Service – Dimensions

Valve

Size

Dimensions in Inches (Millimeters)
A B C D E F G H
1-1/2 in. 5-5/16 (135) 9/16 (14) 6-1/8 (156) 4-3/4 (121) 10-7/8 (276) 5-1/4 (133)1 2-5/8 (67) 1-7/8 (48)
2 in. 6-5/8 (168) 5/8 (16) 7-1/8 (181) 6-1/8 (156) 13-1/4 (336) 6-3/16 (157)2 3-1/2 (89) 2-1/4 (57)
  1. The dimensions on the European versions are 5-29/32 in. (150 mm).
  2. The dimensions on the European versions are 6-1/2 in. (165 mm).

V246 Flange Valve, Commercial Service – Flange Specifications

Valve Size Regional Version Number of Holes Hole Size Bolt Circle
1-1/2 in. North American 4 5/8 in. (16 mm) 3-7/8 in. (98 mm)
2 in. 3/4 in. (19 mm) 4-3/4 in. (121 mm)
1-1/2 in. European, DIN2533 Flanges 4 18 mm 110 mm
2 in. 125 mm

V246 Flange Valve, Maritime Service – Dimensions

Valve

Size

Dimensions in Inches (Millimeters)
A B C D E F G H
1-1/2 in. 5-5/16 (135) 9/16 (14) 6-1/8 (156) 4-3/4 (121) 10-7/8 (276) 5-1/4 (133)1 2-5/8 (67) 1-7/8 (48)
2 in. 6-3/8 (162) 5/8 (16) 7-1/8 (181) 6-1/8 (156) 13-1/4 (337) 6

(152)2

3-1/2 (89) 2-3/4 (70)
  1. The dimensions on the European versions are 5-29/32 in. (150 mm).
  2. The dimensions on the European versions are 6-1/2 in. (165 mm).

V246 Flange Valve, Maritime Service – Flange Specifications

Valve Size Regional Version Number of Holes Hole Size Bolt Circle
1-1/2 in. North American 4 5/8 in. (16 mm) 3-7/8 in. (98 mm)
2 in. 3/4 in. (19 mm) 4-3/4 in. (121 mm)
1-1/2 in. European, DIN86021 Flanges 4 18 mm 110 mm
2 in. 125 mm

Materials

North American V246 Materials

Nominal Valve Size: 3/8 in. to 3/4 in.

(Commercial)

1 in. to 2 in.

(Commercial)

Maritime (All Sizes)
Material
Body Cast brass Cast iron/rust resisting finish Cast bronze
Seat Aluminum Bronze Aluminum bronze Monel
Disc BUNA-N BUNA-N BUNA-N
Disc Cup Brass Brass Monel
Disc Stud Brass Brass Monel
Stem/Extension Sleeve Brass Brass Monel
Diaphragms Nylon reinforced BUNA-N Nylon reinforced BUNA-N Nylon reinforced BUNA-N
Refrigerant Contact
Pressure Element Cup 300 Series stainless steel 300 Series stainless steel 300 Series stainless steel
Bellows 300 Series stainless steel 300 Series stainless steel 300 Series stainless steel
Bellows Ring Steel/nickel plated Steel/nickel plated Steel/nickel plated

Valves and Valve Accessories

V246 Series Two-Way Pressure-Actuated Water-Regulating Valves for High-Pressure Refrigerants (Continued)

European V246 Materials

Nominal Valve Size: 3/8 in. to 3/4 in.

(Commercial)

1 in. to 2 in.

(Commercial)

Maritime (All sizes)
Material
Body Hot forged brass Cast iron/rust resisting finish Cast bronze
Seat Aluminum bronze Aluminum bronze Monel
Disc BUNA-N BUNA-N BUNA-N
Disc Cup Brass Brass Monel
Disc Stud Brass Brass Monel
Stem/Extension Sleeve Brass Brass Monel
Diaphragms Nylon reinforced BUNA-N Nylon reinforced BUNA-N Nylon reinforced BUNA-N
Refrigerant Contact
Pressure Element Cup 300 Series stainless steel 300 Series stainless steel 300 Series stainless steel
Bellows 300 Series stainless steel 300 Series stainless steel 300 Series stainless steel
Bellows Ring Steel/nickel plated Steel/nickel plated Steel/nickel plated

Technical Specifications

V246 Series 2-Way Pressure-Actuated Water-Regulating Valves for High-Pressure Refrigerants
Factory-Set Opening Point Direct Acting 200 psig (13.8 bar), Reverse Acting 165 psig (11.4 bar)
Maximum Working Pressure 630 psig (43.4 bar)
Opening Point Adjustment Range Direct Acting 200 to 400 psi (13.8 to 27.6 bar), Reverse Acting 135 to 300 psi (9.3 to 20.7 bar)
Media 150 psig (10.3 bar) Maximum,

-4F to 170F (-20C to 77C) glycol/water or liquids with low freezing points that are compatible with valve materials

Valves and Valve Accessories Code No. LIT-1900576

Description

V248 Series Three-Way Pressure-Actuated Water-Regulating Valves for High-Pressure Refrigerants

Features

The V248 Series Three-Way

Pressure-Actuated Water-Regulating Valves for High-Pressure Refrigerants regulate water flow and control refrigerant head pressure in systems with single or multiple water-cooled condensers.

V248 valves have an adjustable opening point in a refrigerant pressure range of 200 to

400 psi (13.8 to 27.6 bar). V248 valves are available in 1/2 in. through 1-1/2 in. size for use with standard, non-corrosive,

high-pressure refrigerants.

Maritime models, which have nickel copper (Monel®) internal parts, are available for applications where the media may be corrosive to the internal parts.

Refer to the V248 Series 3-Way

Pressure-Actuated Water-Regulating Valves for High-Pressure Refrigerants Product Bulletin (LIT-12011515) for important product application information.

• no close fitting or sliding parts in water passages

• accessible range spring

• take-apart construction

• pressure-balanced design

• corrosion-resistant material for internal parts

Repair Information

If the V248 Series Three-Way

Pressure-Actuated Water-Regulating Valves for High-Pressure Refrigerants fails to operate within its specifications, refer to the V248 Series 3-Way Pressure-Actuated

Water-Regulating Valves for High-Pressure Refrigerants Product Bulletin (LIT-12011515) for a list of repair parts available.

Selection Charts

North American Standard Production Models – Range 200 to 400 psi

V248 Screw Connection Valve

Product Code Number Construction Valve Size and Connection Element Style Shipping Weight, lb (kg)
V248GB1-001C Direct Acting, Commercial 1/2 in. NPT Screw Style 5 5.0 (2.3)
V248GC1-001C Direct Acting, Commercial 3/4 in. NPT Screw Style 5 6.5 (3.0)
V248GD1-001C Direct Acting, Commercial 1 in. NPT Screw Style 5 12.0 (5.4)
V248GE1-001C Direct Acting, Commercial 1-1/4 in. NPT Screw Style 5 16.0 (7.2)
V248GF1-001C Direct Acting, Commercial 1-1/2 in. NPT Screw Style 5 25.0 (11.3)
V248GK1-001C Direct Acting, Commercial 3/4 in. Union Sweat Style 5 7.0 (3.2)
V248GL1-001C Direct Acting, Commercial 1 in. Union Sweat Style 5 12.0 (5.4)
V248GM1-001C Direct Acting, Commercial 1-1/4 in. Union Sweat Style 5 13.7 (6.2)

European Standard Production Models – Range 13.8 to 27.8 bar

Product Code Number Construction Valve Size and Connection Element Style Shipping Weight, lb (kg)
V248GB1B001C Direct Acting, Commercial 1/2 in. BSPT Screw, ISO 7 Style 5 5.0 (2.3)
V248GC1B001C Direct Acting, Commercial 3/4 in. BSPT Screw, ISO 7 Style 5 6.5 (3.0)
V248GD1B001C Direct Acting, Commercial 1 in. BSPT Screw, ISO 7 Style 5 12.1 (5.5)
V248GE1B001C Direct Acting, Commercial 1-1/4 in. BSPT Screw, ISO 7 Style 5 16.0 (7.2)
V248GF1B001C Direct Acting, Commercial 1-1/2 in. BSPT Screw, ISO 7 Style 5 25.0 (11.3)
V248HC1B001C Direct Acting, Maritime 3/4 in. BSPP Screw, ISO 228 Style 5 6.5 (3.0)

Valves and Valve Accessories

V248 Series Three-Way Pressure-Actuated Water-Regulating Valves for High-Pressure Refrigerants (Continued)

Applications

Each application is unique and requires specific engineering data to properly size and design a system to fulfill the appropriate requirements. Typically, a valve is replaced with another valve of the same size in a properly sized and engineered system. In North America, contact Johnson Controls/PENN® Refrigeration Application Engineering at 1-800-275-5676 to obtain specific engineering data. In other areas, contact the local Johnson Controls® sales office to obtain specific engineering data.

To make a rough field estimate of the size of valve for an application, find the valve size needed by locating a point on a flow chart that satisfies these requirements:

• water flow required by the condenser (Flow)

• refrigerant head pressure rise (PRISE)

• available water pressure (PAVAIL)

Follow these steps, and use the information obtained to locate a point on one of the flowcharts that satisfies all three steps.

1. Take the water flow required by the condenser (Flow) from information provided by the manufacturer of the condensing unit. If the manufacturer’s information is unavailable, use the following information to make a rough approximation of water flow in gallons per minute (gpm) [cubic meters per hour (m3/hr)]:

• System Capacity (Tons of Refrigeration)

• Outlet Water Temperature (Temp. Outlet)

• Inlet Water Temperature (Temp. Inlet)

PRISE = PCOND – POPEN

Refrigerant Head Pressure Rise

FIG:eqn_hd_prssr_rs

  1. Determine the available water pressure to the valve (PAVAIL) using the following steps. This the actual water pressure available to force water through the valve.
    1. Determine the minimum inlet pressure (PIN). This is the water pressure from city water mains, pumps, or other sources.
    2. Pressure drop through condenser (PCOND) is the difference in water pressure between the condenser inlet and the condenser outlet. Obtain this information from the condenser manufacturer.
    3. Estimate or calculate the pressure drop through all associated piping (PLOSS).
    4. Subtract the PCOND and PLOSS from PIN. The result is PAVAIL.

FIG:3wy_prss_drp

Cooling Tower

Pump

P

Calculate the flow using the following formula:

Tons of Refrigeration x 30

P2 P1

Condenser

IN

  1. Way

Valve

Flow = P P

FIG:flw_eqn

(Temp.Outlet – Temp.Inlet)

Flow Required

Note: If the outlet temperature is unknown, assume it to be 10F (6C) above the inlet temperature.

  1. Determine refrigerant head pressure rise above the valve opening point (PRISE) using the following steps:
    1. The Valve Closing Pressure (PCLOSE) is equal to the

Loss 2

Loss 1

Balancing Valve Bypass Line

PCOND= P1 – P2

P

=

LOSS

P

Loss 1 Loss 2

+ P

+ …

Available Water Pressure

PAVAIL= PIN – ( PCOND + PLOSS)

refrigerant pressure at the highest ambient temperature the refrigeration equipment experiences in the Off cycle. Use a Pressure-Temperature Chart for the refrigerant selected to find this pressure.

    1. To approximate the Valve Opening Pressure (POPEN), add about 10 psig (0.7 bar) to the Valve Closing Pressure.

POPEN = PCLOSE +10 psi (0.7 bar)

FIG:eqn_opn_prssr

4. Select the proper valve size from the flowcharts by locating a point on a chart that satisfies the flow, the head pressure rise above opening point, and the pressure drop across the valve.

Metric Conversions

Use these equations to convert between U.S. and S.I. units.

    • 1 dm3/s = 3.6 m3/h = 15.9 U.S. gal. /min. = 13.2 U.K. gal. /min.
    • 1 bar = 100 kPa = 0.1 MPa  1.02 kg/cm2 = 0.987 atm  14.5 psig

Valve Opening Pressure

    1. From the Pressure-Temperature Chart for the refrigerant selected, read the Refrigerant Condensing Pressure (PCOND) (operating head pressure) corresponding to the selected

condensing temperature.

    1. Subtract the Valve Opening Pressure from the Refrigerant Condensing Pressure. This gives the head pressure rise.

Valves and Valve Accessories

V248 Series Three-Way Pressure-Actuated Water-Regulating Valves for High-Pressure Refrigerants (Continued)

V248 Flowcharts

The maximum recommended differential water pressure across a valve is 20 psig (1.4 bar).

Refrigerant Head Pressure Above Opening PRise (bar)

Flow (gpm) 18

15

0.7 1.4 2.1 2.8 3.5 4.1 4.8 5.5 6.2 6.9

4.1

Pressure Drop Through Valve, psig (bar)

20 (1.4)

14.5 (1.0)

10 (0.7)

5 (0.3)

2 (0.1)

3.4

Flow (m³/hr)

12 2.7

9 2.0

6 1.4

3 0.7

FIG:V248_0.5 in. graph

0

10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 100 110

Refrigerant Head Pressure Above Opening PRise ( psig )

1/2 in. Direct Acting Valve Flowchart

0.0

Flow (gpm)

Refrigerant Head Pressure Above Opening PRise (bar)

0.7 1.4 2.1 2.8 3.5 4.1 4.8 5.5 6.2 6.9

25

20 (1.4)

Pressure Drop Through Valve, psig (bar)

14.5 (1.0)

10 (0.7)

5 (0.3)

2 (0.1)

5.7

Flow (M³/hr)

20 4.5

15 3.4

10 2.3

5 1.1

FIG:V248_0.75 in. graph

0

10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 100 110

Refrigerant Head Pressure Above Opening PRise ( psig )

3/4 in. Direct Acting Valve Flowchart

0.0

Valves and Valve Accessories

V248 Series Three-Way Pressure-Actuated Water-Regulating Valves for High-Pressure Refrigerants (Continued)

Flow 50 (gpm)

40

30

20

Refrigerant Head Pressure Above Opening PRise (bar)

0.7 1.4 2.1 2.8 3.5 4.1 4.8 5.5 6.2 6.9

11.4

Pressu

re Drop

20 (1.4)

Throug

psig

h Valve,

(bar)

14.5 (1.0)

10 (0.7)

5 (0.3)

2 (0.1)

9.1

6.8

4.5

Flow (m³/hr)

10 2.3

FIG:V248_1.0 in. graph

0

10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 100 110

Refrigerant Head Pressure Above Opening PRise ( psig )

1 in. Direct Acting Valve Flowchart

0.0

Flow (gpm)

70

60

50

Refrigerant Head Pressure Above Opening PRise (bar)

0.7 1.4 2.1 2.8 3.5 4.1 4.8 5.5 6.2 6.9

15.9

Pressu

re Drop

20 (1.4)

Throug

psig

h Valve,

(bar)

14.5 (1.0)

10 (0.7)

5 (0.3)

2 (0.1)

13.6

11.4

Flow (m³/hr)

40 9.1

30 6.8

20 4.5

10 2.3

FIG:V248_1.25 in. graph

0

10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 100 110

Refrigerant Head Pressure Above Opening PRise ( psig )

1-1/4 in. Direct Acting Valve Flowchart

0.0

Flow (gpm)

Refrigerant Head Pressure Above Opening PRise (bar)

0.7 1.4 2.1 2.8 3.5 4.1 4.8 5.5 6.2 6.9

80

Pressu Throug

re Drop h Valve,

20 (1.4)

psig

(bar)

14.5 (1.0)

10 (0.7)

5 (0.3)

2 (0.1)

70

60

50

40

30

20

10

0

18.2

15.9

13.6

11.4

9.1

6.8

4.5

2.3

0.0

Flow (m³/hr)

10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 100 110

FIG:V248_1.5 in. graph

Refrigerant Head Pressure Above Opening PRise ( psig )

1-1/2 in. Direct Acting Valve Flowchart

Valves and Valve Accessories

V248 Series Three-Way Pressure-Actuated Water-Regulating Valves for High-Pressure Refrigerants (Continued)

A

B

D

Port 1

Port 2 C

E

Port 3

Plugged

F

A

B

C

Port 1

Port 2

D

E

Port 3

Plugged

F

V248 1/2 in. Through 1-1/4 in. Screw Connection Valves Dimensions

FIG:V248_thdd

FIG:V248_unbdy

V248 Union Sweat Connection Valves Dimensions

V248 1-1/2 in. Screw Connection Valves Dimensions

E

PORT 3

PORT 1

PORT 2

FIG:V248_3 way valve

Valves and Valve Accessories

V248 Series Three-Way Pressure-Actuated Water-Regulating Valves for High-Pressure Refrigerants (Continued)

V248 1/2 in. Through 1-1/4 in. Screw Connection Valves Dimensions

Valve Size Dimensions in Inches (Millimeters)
A B C D E F
1/2 in. 3-1/16 (78) 2 (51) 8-11/16 (220) 3-13/16 (96) 1-1/2 (38) 3-3/8 (86)
3/4 in. 3-3/8 (86) 2-3/16 (55) 9-3/4 (248) 4-3/16 (106) 1-3/4 (44) 3-13/16 (98)
1 in. 4-3/4 (121) 2-13/16 (71) 12-1/2 (318) 5-15/16 (151) 2-1/16 (52) 4-1/2 (114)
1-1/4 in. 4-3/4 (121) 2-13/16 (71) 13-1/4 (336) 6-1/8 (156) 2-3/8 (60) 4-3/4 (121)

V248 Union Sweat Connection Valves Dimensions

Valve Size Dimensions in Inches (Millimeters)
A B C D E F
3/4 in. 3-3/8 (86) 2-3/16 (55) 9-3/4 (248) 4-3/16 (106) 1-3/4 (44) 3-13/16 (98)
1 in. 4-3/4 (121) 2-13/16 (71) 12-1/2 (318) 5-15/16 (151) 2-1/16 (52) 4-1/2 (114)
1-1/4 in. 4-3/4 (121) 2-13/16 (71) 13-1/4 (336) 6-1/8 (156) 2-3/8 (60) 4-3/4 (121)

V248 1-1/2 in. Screw Connection Valves Dimensions

Valve Size Dimensions in Inches (Millimeters)
A B C D E F
1-1/2 in. 6 (152) 3-1/2 (89) 15-1/4 (382) 8 (203) 9-5/16 (237) 6-7/8 (175)

Valves and Valve Accessories

Materials

V248 Series Three-Way Pressure-Actuated Water-Regulating Valves for High-Pressure Refrigerants (Continued)

North American V248 Materials

Nominal Valve Size: 3/8 in. to 3/4 in.

(Commercial)

1 in. to 1-1/2 in.

(Commercial)

Maritime (All Sizes)
Material
Body Cast brass Cast iron/rust resisting finish Cast bronze
Seat Aluminum bronze Aluminum bronze Monel
Disc BUNA-N BUNA-N BUNA-N
Disc Cup Brass Brass Monel
Disc Stud Brass Brass Monel
Stem/Extension Sleeve Brass Brass Monel
Diaphragms Nylon reinforced BUNA-N Nylon reinforced BUNA-N Nylon reinforced BUNA-N
Refrigerant Contact
Pressure

Element

Cup 300 Series stainless steel 300 Series stainless steel 300 Series stainless steel
Bellows 300 Series stainless steel 300 Series stainless steel 300 Series stainless steel
Bellows Ring Steel/nickel plated Steel/nickel plated Steel/nickel plated

European V248 Materials

Nominal Valve Size: 3/8 in. to 3/4 in.

(Commercial)

1 in. to 1-1/2 in.

(Commercial)

Maritime (All Sizes)
Material
Body Hot forged brass Cast iron/rust resisting finish Cast bronze
Seat Aluminum bronze Aluminum bronze Monel
Disc BUNA-N BUNA-N BUNA-N
Disc Cup Brass Brass Monel
Disc Stud Brass Brass Monel
Stem/Extension Sleeve Brass Brass Monel
Diaphragms Nylon reinforced BUNA-N Nylon reinforced BUNA-N Nylon reinforced BUNA-N
Refrigerant Contact
Pressure Element Cup 300 Series stainless steel 300 Series stainless steel 300 Series stainless steel
Bellows 300 Series stainless steel 300 Series stainless steel 300 Series stainless steel
Bellows Ring Steel/nickel plated Steel/nickel plated Steel/nickel plated

Technical Specifications

V248 Series Pressure-Actuated Water-Regulating Valves for High-Pressure Refrigerants
Maximum Working Pressure 630 psig (43.4 bar)
Factory-Set Opening Point (Port 1 to Port 2) 275 psig (19.0 bar)
Opening Point Adjustment Range (Port 1 to Port 2) 200 to 400 psi (13.8 to 27.6 bar)
Throttling Range 120 psi (8.3 bar) for 1/2 in. size

100 psi (6.9 bar) for 3/4 in., 1 in., and 1-1/4 in. sizes 140 psi (9.6 bar) for 1-1/2 in. size

Media 150 psig (10.3 bar) maximum,

-4F to 170F (-20C to 77C) glycol/water or liquids with low freezing points that are compatible with valve materials

Valves and Valve Accessories Code No. LIT-1927340

STT Water Valve Renewal Kit for V46, V47, and V48 Series Valves

Description

These renewal kits include a seat, disc, diaphragms, and all additional internal parts required to recondition the valves.

Selection Chart

Valve

Size (in.)

Commercial Kit Monel Kit Diaphragm Kits Only

for All Types

For Series V46A, V46N, V47A,

V47N Product Code Numbers

For Series V48

Product Code Numbers

For Series V46B, V46C, V47B,

V47C Product Code Number

3/8 STT14A-600R STT14A-601R
1/2 STT15A-602R STT15A-605R STT15A-603R
3/4 STT16A-601R STT16A-604R STT17A-613R
1 STT17A-609R STT17A-616R STT17A-611R DPM17A-600R
1-1/4 STT17A-610R STT17A-617R STT17A-612R
1-1/2 STT17A-604R DPM17A-601R
2 STT18A-600R STT18A-602R
2-1/2 STT18A-601R

Valves and Valve Accessories Code No. LIT-1900112

Companion Flanges and Gaskets for V43, V46, and V47 Series Valves

Description

Companion flanges and gaskets are sold individually or in kits. The kits contain two flange gaskets, two cast iron flanges with NPT (National Pipe Thread), eight hex nuts, and eight machine bolts.

Cast Iron Flange (Two)

Valve Size Valve Series
V43 Series V46 Series V47 Series
Flange Gaskets (One gasket per package)
1-1/2 in. 246-423
2 in. 246-424
2-1/2 in. 246-425
Companion Flange Kits (See diagram)
1-1/2 in. KIT14A-6121 KIT14A-612
2 in. KIT14A-6131 KIT14A-6131 KIT14A-613
2-1/2 in. KIT14A-6141 KIT14A-6141 KIT14A-614
3 in. FLG15A-6001
4 in. FLG15A-6011

Selection Chart

Flange

Gasket (Two)

Hex Nut (Eight)

Companion Flange Kit

Machine Bolt (Eight)

      1. Commercial valves only

Repair Information

If the Companion Flanges and Gaskets for V43, V46, and V47 Series Valves fail to operate within its specifications, replace the unit. For a replacement flange or gasket, contact the nearest Johnson Controls® representative.

Relays and Transformers

Code No. LIT-1922175

Y63, Y64, Y65, Y66, and Y69 Series Transformers

Description

The Y63, Y64, Y65, Y66, and Y69 Series Transformers provide 24 VAC power for loads of 40 VA through 300 VA. These transformers are designed for use on digital controllers, gas controls, ignition systems, motor actuators, staging controls, and most other 24 VAC HVAC/R control systems.

The Y6x Series meets the requirements of UL 1585, UL 506, and CSA C22.2 No. 66,

providing compliance in both the United States and Canada. The Y63, Y64, Y65, and Y66 transformers are listed as Class 2 transformers (UL 1585, CSA C22.2 No. 66). The Y69 is listed as a general purpose transformer (UL 506, CSA C22.2 No. 66).

Refer to the Series Y63, Y64, Y65, Y66, and Y69 Transformers Product Bulletin

(LIT-125755) for important product application information.

Features

    • split-bobbin design provides best primary/secondary isolation
    • multi-tap primaries reduce stocking requirements and offer application flexibility
    • choice of foot, plate, or conduit hub mounting provides mounting flexibility
    • choice of primary voltages meets a wide range of power requirements from 24 VAC through 480 VAC
    • color-coded lead wires provide simplicity and standardization
    • cULus listed or cURus recognized meets US and Canadian requirements for Class 2 transformers (Y63, Y64, Y65, and Y66) and general purpose transformers (Y69)
    • built-in, easy-reset circuit breakers eliminate replacement time and cost caused by burn-out (Y63, Y64, Y66, and Y69)
    • open frame Y65 models serve as ideal models when end bells are not required

Y65 Series Transformer

Repair Information

Do not make any field repairs to transformers. For a replacement transformer, contact the nearest Johnson Controls® distributor or sales representative.

Selection Chart

Y63, Y64, Y65, Y66, and Y69 Series Transformers (Part 1 of 2)

Product Code

Number

Primary

Voltage VAC

Secondary

Voltage VAC

Primary

Connection

Secondary

Connection

Mounting Agency

Requirement

40 VA Capacity Transformers with Energy Limiting Type Overload Protection
Y65G13-0 24 24 External Fitting

8 in. primary leads

External Fitting

30 in. secondary leads

Foot cULus Class 2
Y65A13-0 120 24 External Fitting

8 in. primary leads

External Fitting

30 in. secondary leads

Foot cULus Class 2
Y65A21-0 120 24 End bell holes

8 in. primary leads

Three screw terminals (one is blind) 4 in. x 4 in. plate cULus Class 2
Y65T31-0 120/208/240 24 External Fitting

8 in. primary leads

Three screw terminals (one is blind) Foot

4 in. x 4 in. plate1

cULus Class 2
Y65T42-0 120/208/240 24 Common External Fitting 8 in. primary leads Common External Fitting 8 in. secondary leads Hub

4 in. x 4 in. plate1

cURus Class 2
Y65T54-0 120/208/240 24 8 in. primary leads 8 in. secondary leads Foot-skeleton cURus Class 2
Y65S13-0 208/240 24 External Fitting

8 in. primary leads

External Fittings

30 in. secondary leads

Foot cULus Class 2
Y65F13-0 277/480 24 External Fitting

8 in. primary leads

External Fitting

30 in. secondary leads

Foot cULus Class 2
Y65F42-0 277/480 24 Common External Fitting 8 in. primary leads Common External Fitting 8 in. secondary leads Hub

4 in. x 4 in. plate1

cURus Class 2
50 VA Capacity Transformers with Circuit Breakers
Y63T22-0 120/208/240 24 End bell Hole

8 in. primary leads

End bell Hole

8 in. secondary leads

4 in. x 4 in. plate cURus Class 2
Y63T31-0 120/208/240 24 External Fitting

8 in. primary leads

Three screw terminals (one is blind) Foot

4 in. x 4 in. plate1

cULus Class 2
Y63F22-0 277/480 24 End bell Hole

8 in. primary leads

End bell Hole

8 in. secondary leads

4 in. x 4 in. plate cURus Class 2

Relays and Transformers

Y63, Y64, Y65, Y66, and Y69 Series Transformers (Continued)

Y63, Y64, Y65, Y66, and Y69 Series Transformers (Part 2 of 2)

Product Code

Number

Primary

Voltage VAC

Secondary

Voltage VAC

Primary

Connection

Secondary

Connection

Mounting Agency

Requirement

75 VA Capacity Transformers with Circuit Breakers
Y66T12-0 120/208/240 24 Common External Fitting

8 in. primary leads

Common External Fitting

8 in. secondary leads

Foot cURus Class 2
Y66T13-0 120/208/240 24 External Fitting

8 in. primary leads

External Fitting

30 in. secondary leads

Foot cULus Class 2
Y66F12-0 277/480 24 Common External Fitting 8 in. primary leads Common External Fitting 8 in. secondary leads Foot cURus Class 2
Y66F13-0 277/480 24 External Fitting

8 in. primary leads

External Fitting

30 in. secondary leads

Foot cULus Class 2
92 VA Capacity Transformers with Circuit Breakers
Y64T15-0 120/208/240 24 External Fitting

8 in. primary leads

Internal Fitting

30 in. secondary leads

Foot cULus Class 2
Y64T21-0 120/208/240 24 End bell holes

8 in. primary leads

Three screw terminals (one is blind) Plate cULus Class 2
Y64T22-0 120/208/240 24 End bell Hole

8 in. primary leads

End bell Hole

8 in. secondary leads

Plate cURus Class 2
300 VA Capacity Transformers with Circuit Breakers
Y69T15-0 120/208/240 24 External Fitting

8 in. primary leads

Internal Fitting

30 in. secondary leads

Foot cULus

Power Transformer

1. 4 in. x 4 in. plate and nut packed with transformer.

Technical Specifications

Series Y63, Y64, Y65, Y66, Y69 Transformers
Input Power Requirements 24 to 480 VAC at 60 Hz
Full Load Secondary Voltage 23.5 VAC (Nominal)
Open Circuit Secondary Voltage (No Load) 27.0 VAC (Nominal)
Full Load Secondary VA Rating Series Y63 Y64 Y65 Y66 Y69 Volt-Amperes

50 VA

92 VA

40 VA

75 VA

300 VA

Finish End bells, frame, feet, and mounting plates are corrosion resistant
Ambient Operating Temperature -40 to 104°F (-40 to 40°C)
Ambient Storage Temperature -40 to 140°F (-40 to 60°C)
Shipping Weight Y63 Y64 Y65 Y66 Y69 3.0 lb/1.4 kg

4.0 lb/1.8 kg

2.0 lb/0.9 kg

3.0 lb/1.4 kg

11.0 lb/5.0 kg

Agency Compliance UL Listed Y63, Y64, Y65, Y66; File E95575, CCN’s XOKV (US) and XOKV7 (Canada)

UL Recognized Y63, Y64, Y65, Y66; File E95575, CCN’s XOKV2 (US) and XOKV8 (Canada) UL Listed Y69; File E95138, CCN’s XPTQ (US) and XPTQ7 (Canada)

All transformers are Class 2 except the Y69 (300 VA), which is listed as a power transformer.

System 450 Control Series

Code No. LIT-1900549

System 450™ Series Modular Controls

Description

System 450™ is a family of modular, digital electronic controls that is easily assembled and set up to provide reliable temperature, pressure, and humidity control for a wide variety of HVAC/R applications, commercial process applications, and industrial process applications.

The System 450 control system is designed to replace System 350™ and System 27 control systems, and to provide many additional features and benefits with fewer than twenty model variations.

System 450 control modules provide a field-configurable

out-of-the-box solution. Most System 450 control modules can control temperature, pressure, and humidity systems simultaneously.

System 450 Control Modules with Communications enable you to connect System 450 control systems to Modbus® or Ethernet networks for remote monitoring and setup. The Modbus communications control module is an RS485, RTU-compliant slave device. The Ethernet communications control module has an integral web server that can deliver web pages by means of a direct connection, on your LAN, or across the Internet.

System 450 Reset Control Modules provide many of the features of the standard models for temperature and humidity control. In addition, these modules provide setpoint reset, real-time setback scheduling, and run-time balancing (equal run time) capability.

The System 450 Control Module with Hybrid Analog Output has a single self-selecting analog output to optimize and extend the controlled speed range of variable speed electronically commutated (EC) motors.

Refer to the following documents for important product application information.

    • System 450™ Series Modular Controls Product Bulletin (LIT-12011458)
    • System 450™ Series Modular Control Systems with Standard Control Modules Technical Bulletin (LIT-12011459)
  • System 450™ Series Modular Control Systems with Reset Control Modules Technical Bulletin (LIT-12011842)
  • System 450™ Series Modular Control Systems with Communications Control Modules Technical Bulletin (LIT-12011826)

Features

  • durable, compact, interchangeable modular components with

plug-together connectors and DIN rail or direct wall mount capability eliminate field wiring between modules and allow you to quickly and easily design, assemble, install, and upgrade your control systems.

  • versatile, multipurpose, field-configurable control modules and expansion modules designed for global use allow you to create a wide variety of application-specific control systems capable of controlling temperature, pressure, or humidity, or all three conditions simultaneously, with only a small suite of module models.
  • up to three hard-wired input sensors and up to ten relay or analog outputs (in any combination) per control system allow you to build complex custom control systems while reducing your control system cost to only the cost of the required components.
  • control Modules with bright backlit LCDs and four-button touch pad user interfaces provide quick, clear, visual status of your

System 450 control system inputs and outputs with the touch of a button and enable you to quickly and easily set up and adjust your control system.

System 450 Control System with a Control, Power, and Expansion Module

  • multipurpose, all-in-one control modules enable simple

stand-alone, single-module control systems that are temperature, pressure, and humidity capable out of the box and easy to set up in the field to replace a wide variety of OEM HVAC/R and process controls.

  • an extensive suite of compatible temperature and humidity sensors, and pressure transducers allows you to monitor and control a wide range of HVAC/R and process conditions in a variety of standard and global units of measurement.
  • high input signal selection enables your control system to monitor a temperature, pressure, or humidity condition with two or three sensors (of the same type) and control your system outputs based on the highest condition value sensed by the referenced sensors.
  • differential control enables your control system to monitor and maintain a temperature, pressure, or humidity differential between two sensor points within a system, process, or space.

The Reset Control modules have additional features:

  • adjustable minimum and maximum setpoint temperatures (reset control modules only) enable compliance with the manufacturer’s specifications for your controlled HVAC/R and process equipment.
  • selectable shutdown-high and shutdown-low temperature settings (reset control modules only) saves you energy by shutting down controlled equipment when the ambient temperature either rises or drops to a point where heating or cooling is no longer required.
  • real time clock and adjustable setback temperature (reset control modules only) save you energy by setting back heating, cooling, or humidity setpoints during scheduled unoccupied periods (24-hour day, 7-day week schedule).
  • user-defined reset control capability (reset control modules only) saves you energy in a wide variety of temperature and humidity reset control applications by adjusting the temperature or humidity control loop, based on changes in ambient outdoor temperature or other uncontrolled condition.

System 450 Control Series

System 450™ Series Modular Controls (Continued)

The Control Modules with Communications have additional features:

  • Ethernet communication capability through a built-in web server (Ethernet Control Modules only) allows you to monitor your control system status and set up or change the parameters by means of a direct Ethernet cable connection, through a LAN connection, or over the Internet. The built in web server delivers user-friendly web pages to client browsers on a desktop, laptop, tablet, or smart device.
  • The Web page server on Ethernet communication modules provides a simple, intuitive web interface for easy remote monitoring, setup, adjustment and remote monitoring of your control systems across Ethernet networks.
  • RS485, RTU-compliant Modbus® network communication capability (Modbus control modules only) enables a head-end RS485 Modbus master controller to read and write control system status and setup parameters to the System 450 Modbus communication control module.
  • Password protection for local access (Ethernet and Modbus control modules only) and password protection for remote access (Ethernet control module only) deters unauthorized changes to the control system settings, but allows local and remote monitoring of your control system status.
  • Analog output signal limiting features (communication control modules only) allow you to select the rate and condition range at which the control updates the analog output signal, potentially reducing wear on the controlled equipment.
  • Binary input with time delay (communication control modules only) allows you to use an external set of dry contacts and selectable time delays to control relay outputs.

Applications

You can create a wide variety of custom, application-specific control systems with System 450 modules. The following are some common control application examples:

  • Temperature control
  • Pressure control
  • Humidity control
  • Multipurpose control
  • Reset and setback control
  • High input-signal selection
  • Differential control

Temperature Control

  • Temperature monitoring and alarming
  • On/Off staged control of boilers and chillers
  • Proportional stage control of boilers and chillers
  • Boiler and chiller pump control
  • Heating and cooling control with deadband
  • Floating temperature control of damper and valve actuators
  • Cooling tower fan speed/stage control based on water temperature
  • Supply, make-up, and mixed air temperature control
  • Temperature actuated valve control
  • Supply and make-up air damper and fan control
  • Condenser fan staging or speed control based on condenser temperature

Refrigerant Pressure Control

  • Condenser fan cycling and stage control
  • Multispeed condenser fan control
  • Floating pressure control of damper and valve actuators
  • Condenser fan speed and damper control
  • High and low pressure cutout control
  • Staged compressor control
  • Cooling tower fan speed control based on high-side pressure
  • Direct speed control of electronically commutated (EC) condenser fan motors (C450CPW-100 model)

Other Pressure Control

  • Relief damper and fan control for building pressurization
  • Constant static pressure control

Humidity Control

  • On/Off humidification and dehumidification control
  • Proportional humidification and dehumidification control
  • Multistage humidification and dehumidification control
  • Humidity monitoring and alarming

Multipurpose Control

  • Temperature and pressure based refrigeration rack control
  • Temperature and humidity control of wine cellars and greenhouses
  • Temperature, humidity, and static pressure control of clean rooms and greenhouses
  • Dehumidification with reheat control

Reset Control

  • Boiler supply water temperature reset control based on outside air temperature
  • Chiller supply water temperature reset control based on outside air temperature
  • VAV zone temperature control based on outside air temperature
  • Humidity reset based on outside air temperature
  • Staged applications with runtime balancing
  • Real-time Occupied/Unoccupied Setback

High Input Signal Selection

  • Pressure-based fan speed or fan cycling control on multi-circuit condensers
  • Temperature-based fan speed or fan cycling control on multi-circuit condensers

Differential Control

  • Air and fluid pump-flow monitoring and alarming
  • Air and fluid filter status monitoring and alarming
  • Chiller barrel flow monitoring, control, and alarming
  • Solar air and water heating applications

Note: Communications modules add network communication to any application of your choosing, except those requiring reset, setback, or EC motor control.

Repair Information

If a System 450 module fails to operate within its specifications, replace the module. For a replacement module, contact your Johnson Controls® representative.

System 450 Control Series

System 450™ Series Modular Controls (Continued)

System 450 Control Module Capabilities

Control by System 450 Control Modules
Standard Communications Reset Hybrid
C450CPN-3C

C450CQN-3C C450CBN-3C C450CCN-3C

C450CEN-1C

C450CRN-1C

C450RBN-3C

C450RCN-3C

C450CPW-100C
Controlled Condition
Temperature
Pressure
Humidity
Combination of Conditions
Control Capabilities
On/Off Relay Control
Analog Proportional Control (Direct and Reverse Action)
Analog Proportional Plus Integral Control (Direct and Reverse Action)
Combination of On/Off Relay and Analog Output Control
Stand-Alone Control
Multi-Stage Control (Relay or Analog)
Network Communications
High Input Signal Selection
Differential Control
Output Signal Limiting Output Signal Update Rate Output Signal Deadband
Binary Input Control for Relay Outputs
On/Off Duration Time Control
Temperature and Humidity Reset Control
Scheduling and Temperature Setback Control
Reset Setpoint Control
Setback Scheduling
Run-Time Balancing
Hybrid Analog Output Control 1

1. Only on output OUTA1.

System 450 Control Series

System 450™ Series Modular Controls (Continued)

Selection Charts

System 450 Modules and Accessories Ordering Information

Product Code

Number

Product Description
C450CBN-3C Standard Control Module with LCD, Four-Button Touchpad UI, and Relay Output; provides one relay output (SPDT line-voltage relay) for

SPDT control.

C450CCN-3C Standard Control Module with LCD, Four-Button Touchpad UI, and Relay Output; provides two relay outputs (SPDT line-voltage relays) for SPDT control.
C450CEN-1C Control Module with Ethernet Communications, LCD, and Four-Button Touchpad UI. (No onboard outputs available on control modules with network communications capabilities.)
C450CPN-3C Standard Control Module with LCD, Four-Button Touchpad UI, and Analog Output; provides one analog output (0 to 10 VDC or 4 to 20 mA self-selecting signal) for proportional control.
C450CPW-100C Hybrid Analog Output Control Module with LCD, Four-Button Touchpad UI, Hybrid Analog Output and Optional High Input Signal Select; provides one hybrid analog output and optional high input signal select primarily used for variable-speed EC motor speed control.

Only Analog Output 1 (OUTA1) can be configured as a hybrid analog output and/or use the High Input Signal Selection feature. These features are not available for any of the other outputs in a System 450 control system that uses the C450CPW-100C as the control module.

C450CQN-3C Standard Control Module with LCD and Four-Button Touchpad UI, and Analog Output; provides two analog outputs (0 to 10 VDC or 4 to 20 mA self-selecting signals) for proportional control.
C450CRN-1C Control Module with RS485 Modbus Communications, LCD, and Four-Button Touchpad UI. (No onboard outputs available on control modules with network communications capabilities.)
C450RBN-3C Reset Control Module with LCD, Four-Button Touchpad UI, and SPDT relay output; provides one SPDT output relay. One A99BC-25C temperature sensor with 0.25 m (9-1/4 in.) silicon leads and one A99BC-300C temperature sensor with 3 m (9 ft 10 in.) silicon leads are included in the box with the Reset Control Module.
C450RCN-3C Reset Control Module with LCD, Four-Button Touchpad UI, and SPDT relay output; provides two SPDT output relays. One A99BC-25C temperature sensor with 0.25 m (9-1/4 in.) silicon leads and one A99BC-300C temperature sensor with 3 m (9 ft 10 in.) silicon leads are included in the box with the Reset Control Module.
C450SBN-3C Relay Output Expansion Module; provides one SPDT line-voltage relay output.
C450SCN-3C Relay Output Expansion Module; provides two SPDT line-voltage relay outputs.
C450SPN-1C Analog Output Expansion Module; provides one analog output (0 to 10 VDC or 4 to 20 mA self-selecting signal) for proportional control.
C450SQN-1C Analog Output Expansion Module; provides two analog outputs (0 to 10 VDC or 4 to 20 mA self-selecting signals) for proportional control.
C450YNN-1C Power Module; provides 24 V to System 450 Module Assembly; 120 VAC or 240 VAC supply power input terminals.
BKT287-1R DIN Rail; 0.30 m (12 in.) long
BKT287-2R DIN Rail; 1 m (39-1/3 in.) long
BKT287-3R DIN Rail; 0.61 m (24 in.) long
BKT287-4R DIN Rail; 0.36 m (14 in.) long
PLT344-1R DIN Rail End Clamps (2 clamps)
WHA-C450-100C System 450 module connection extension cable, 100 cm (3.3 ft) long

System 450 Compatible A99B Temperature Sensors and Accessories Ordering Information1 (Part 1 of 2)

Product Code

Number

Product Description
A99BA-200C PTC Silicon Sensor with Shielded Cable; Cable Length 2 m (6-1/2 ft); Sensor Temperature Range: -40 to 120°C (-40 to 250°F)

Cable Jacket Temperature Range: -40 to 100°C (-40 to 212°F)

A99BB-25C PTC Silicon Sensor with PVC Cable; Cable Length 0.25 m (9-3/4 in.); Sensor Temperature Range: -40 to 120°C (-40 to 250°F) Cable Jacket Temperature Range: -40 to 100°C (-40 to 212°F)
A99BB-200C PTC Silicon Sensor with PVC Cable; Cable Length 2 m (6-1/2 ft); Sensor Temperature Range: -40 to 120°C (-40 to 250°F) Cable Jacket Temperature Range: -40 to 100°C (-40 to 212°F)
A99BB-300C PTC Silicon Sensor with PVC Cable; Cable Length 3 m (9-3/4 ft); Sensor Temperature Range: -40 to 120°C (-40 to 250°F) Cable Jacket Temperature Range: -40 to 100°C (-40 to 212°F)
A99BB-500C PTC Silicon Sensor with PVC Cable; Cable Length 5 m (16-3/8 ft); Sensor Temperature Range: -40 to 120°C (-40 to 250°F) Cable Jacket Temperature Range: -40 to 100°C (-40 to 212°F)
A99BB-600C PTC Silicon Sensor with PVC Cable; Cable Length 6 m (19-1/2 ft); Sensor Temperature Range: -40 to 120°C (-40 to 250°F) Cable Jacket Temperature Range: -40 to 100°C (-40 to 212°F)
A99BC-25C PTC Silicon Sensor with High Temperature Silicon Cable; Cable Length 0.25 m (9-3/4 in.);

Sensor Temperature Range: -40 to 120°C (-40 to 250°F) Cable Jacket Rated for Full Sensor Temperature Range.

A99BC-300C PTC Silicon Sensor with High Temperature Silicon Cable; Cable Length 3 m (9-3/4 ft) Sensor Temperature Range: -40 to 120°C (-40 to 250°F)

Cable Jacket Rated for Full Sensor Temperature Range.

A99BC-1500C PTC Silicon Sensor with High Temperature Silicon Cable; Cable Length 15 m (49 ft) Sensor Temperature Range: -40 to 120°C (-40 to 250°F)

Cable Jacket Rated for Full Sensor Temperature Range.

BOX10A-600R PVC Enclosure for A99 Sensor; Includes Wire Nuts and Conduit Connector (for Outdoor Sensor)

System 450 Control Series

System 450™ Series Modular Controls (Continued)

System 450 Compatible A99B Temperature Sensors and Accessories Ordering Information1 (Part 2 of 2)

Product Code

Number

Product Description
WEL11A-601R Immersion Well for A99 Sensor Liquid Sensing Applications
A99-CLP-1 Mounting Clip for A99 Temperature Sensor
ADP11A-600R Conduit Adaptor, 1/2 in. Snap-Fit EMT Conduit Adaptor (box of 10)
TE-6001-1 Duct Mounting Hardware with Handy Box for A99 Sensor
TE-6001-11 Duct Mounting Hardware without Handy Box for A99 Sensor
SHL10A-603R Sun Shield (for Use with Outside A99 Sensors in Sunny Locations)

1. Refer to the A99B Series Temperature Sensors Product/Technical Bulletin (LIT-125186) on the Johnson Controls® Product Literature website for more information.

System 450 Compatible TE-6000 Series 1,000 Ohm Nickel Temperature Sensors and Accessories Ordering Information

Product Code

Number

Product Description
TE-6000-x TE6000 Series 1,000 ohm at 70F nickel temperature sensors (only). Only the TE-6000-6 sensor can be used for the entire HIC and HIF

temperature range. Different sensing element packages are available for various applications. For a complete list of compatible 1,000 ohm nickel sensors, including sensor descriptions, technical specifications, and mounting accessories, refer to the

TE-6000 Series Temperature Sensing Elements Product Bulletin (LIT-216288). (System 450 Sensor Types HIC and HIF)

System 450 Compatible TE-6300 Series 1,000 Ohm Nickel Temperature Sensors and Accessories Ordering Information

Product Code

Number

Product Description
TE-631xx-x TE6300 Series 1,000 ohm at 70F nickel averaging and 1,000 ohm thin-film nickel temperature sensors (only). For a complete list of

compatible 1,000 ohm nickel averaging and thin-film nickel sensors, including sensor descriptions, technical specifications, and mounting accessories, refer to the TE-6300 Series Temperature Sensors Product Bulletin (LIT-216320). (System 450 Sensor Types HIC and HIF)

System 450 Compatible TE-68NT-0N00S 1,000 Ohm Nickel Temperature Sensor Ordering Information

Product Code

Number

Product Description
TE-68NT-0N00S TE6800 Series 1,000 ohm nickel temperature sensor for wall-mount applications. For more information, including sensor description,

technical specifications, and mounting accessories, refer to the TE-6800 Series Temperature Sensors Product Bulletin (LIT-12011542). (System 450 Sensor Types HIC and HIF)

System 450 Compatible HE67S3 Type Humidity Sensors with Integral A99B Temperature Sensor Ordering Information1

Product Code

Number

Product Description
HE-67S3-0N0BT Wall Mount Humidity Sensor with A99B Type Temperature Sensor: 10 to 90% RH; 0 to 60C (32 to 140F)
HE-67S3-0N00P Duct Mount Humidity Sensor with A99B Type Temperature Sensor: 10 to 90% RH; 0 to 60C (32 to 140F)

1. The HE-67S3 sensors require 24 VAC input and must use the 0–5 VDC output. Refer to the TrueRH Series HE-67xx Humidity Element with Temperature Sensors Product Bulletin (LIT-216245) on the Johnson Controls Product Literature website for more information, including technical specifications and mounting accessories.

System 450 Compatible HE6800 Series Humidity Transmitters with Temperature Sensor Ordering Information1

Product Code

Number

Product Description
HE-68N2-0N00WS Wall Mount Humidity Transmitter with Nickel Temperature Sensor: 10 to 90 ±2% RH; 0 to 55C (32 to 131F)
HE-68N3-0N00WS Wall Mount Humidity Transmitter with Nickel Temperature Sensor: 10 to 90 ±3% RH; 0 to 55C (32 to 131F)

1. The HE-6800 transmitters require 24 VAC input and must use the 0–5 VDC output. Refer to the HE-6800 Series Humidity Transmitters with Temperature Sensor Product Bulletin (LIT-12011625) on the Johnson Controls Product Literature website for more information, including technical specifications and mounting accessories.

System 450 Compatible Low Pressure Differential Transducer Ordering Information1 2

Product Code

Number

Product Description
DPT2650-R25B-AB Low Pressure Differential Transducer: -0.25 to 0.25 in. W.C. (System 450 Sensor Type: P 0.25)3
DPT2650-0R5D-AB Low Pressure Differential Transducer: 0 to 0.5 in. W.C. (System 450 Sensor Type: P 0.5)
DPT2650-2R5D-AB Low Pressure Differential Transducer: 0 to 2.5 in. W.C. (System 450 Sensor Type: P 2.5)
DPT2650-005D-AB Low Pressure Differential Transducer: 0 to 5.0 in. W.C. (System 450 Sensor Type: P 5)
DPT2650-10D-AB Low Pressure Differential Transducer: 0 to 10 in. W.C. (System 450 Sensor Type: P 10)
  1. Refer to the Setra Systems Model DPT265 Very Low Differential Pressure Transducer Catalog Page on the Johnson Controls Product Literature website for more information.
  2. The DPT265 sensors require 24 VAC input and must use the 0–5 VDC output. Refer to the Setra Systems Model DPT265 Very Low Differential Pressure Transducer Catalog Page on the Johnson Controls Product Literature website for more information.
  3. Used only with Communications Control Modules.

System 450 Control Series

System 450™ Series Modular Controls (Continued)

System 450 Compatible P499 Series Transducers with 1/4 in. SAE 45 Flare Internal Thread with Depressor (Style 47) Ordering Information1

Product Code

Number

Product Description
P499RCP-401C -1 to 8 bar; order WHA-PKD3 type wire harness separately
P499RCP-402C -1 to 15 bar; order WH A-PKD3 type wire harness separately
P499RCP-404C 0 to 30 bar; order WHA-PKD3 type wire harness separately
P499RCP-405C 0 to 50 bar; order WHA-PKD3 type wire harness separately
P499RCPS100C -10 to 100 psis (sealed for wet and freeze/thaw applications); order WHA-PKD3 type wire harness separately
P499RCPS100K -10 to 100 psis (sealed for wet and freeze/thaw applications); WHA-PKD3-200C wire harness included
P499RCPS102C 0 to 200 psis (sealed for wet and freeze/thaw applications); order WHA-PKD3 type wire harness separately
P499RCPS102K 0 to 200 psis (sealed for wet and freeze/thaw applications); WHA-PKD3-200C wire harness included
P499RCP-101C 0 to 100 psi; order WHA-PKD3 type wire harness separately
P499RCP-101K 0 to 100 psi; WHA-PKD3-200C wire harness included
P499RCP-105C 0 to 500 psi; order WHA-PKD3 type wire harness separately
P499RCP-105K 0 to 500 psi; WHA-PKD3-200C wire harness included
P499RCP-107C 0 to 750 psi; order WHA-PKD3 type wire harness separately
P499RCP-107K 0 to 750 psi; WHA-PKD3-200C wire harness included

1. The P499 sensors must be powered with the +5 VDC and C terminals and the output is 0.5 to 4.5 VDC. Refer to the P499 Series Electronic Pressure Transducers Product/Technical Bulletin (LIT-12011190) on the Johnson Controls Product Literature website for more information.

System 450 Compatible P499 Series Transducers with 1/8 in. 27 NPT External Thread (Style 49) Ordering Information1

Product Code

Number

Product Description
P499RAPS100C -10 to 100 psis (sealed for wet and freeze/thaw applications); order WHA-PKD3 type wire harness separately
P499RAPS100K -10 to 100 psis (sealed for wet and freeze/thaw applications); WHA-PKD3-200C wire harness included
P499RAPS102C 0 to 200 psis (sealed for wet and freeze/thaw applications); order WHA-PKD3 type wire harness separately
P499RAPS102K 0 to 200 psis (sealed for wet and freeze/thaw applications); WHA-PKD3-200C wire harness included
P499RAP-101C 0 to 100 psi; order WHA-PKD3 type wire harness separately
P499RAP-101K 0 to 100 psi; WHA-PKD3-200C wire harness included
P499RAP-102C 0 to 200 psi; order WHA-PKD3 type wire harness separately
P499RAP-105C 0 to 500 psi; order WHA-PKD3 type wire harness separately
P499RAP-105K 0 to 500 psi; WHA-PKD3-200C wire harness included
P499RAP-107C 0 to 750 psi; order WHA-PKD3 type wire harness separately
P499RAP-107K 0 to 750 psi; WHA-PKD3-200C wire harness included

1. The P499 sensors must be powered with the +5 VDC and C terminals and the output is 0.5 to 4.5 VDC. Refer to the P499 Series Electronic Pressure Transducers Product/Technical Bulletin (LIT-12011190) on the Johnson Controls Product Literature website for more information.

WHA-PKD3 Wire Harnesses Ordering Information1

Product Code

Number

Product Description
WHA-PKD3-200C Plug and Three-Wire Harness for P499 Electronic Pressure Transducers: 2.0 m (6-1/2 ft) cable
WHA-PKD3-400C Plug and Three-Wire Harness for P499 Electronic Pressure Transducers: 4.0 m (13 ft) cable
WHA-PKD3-600C Plug and Three-Wire Harness for P499 Electronic Pressure Transducers: 6.0 m (19-5/8 ft) cable

1. Refer to the P499 Series Electronic Pressure Transducers Product/Technical Bulletin (LIT-12011190) on the Johnson Controls Product Literature website for more information.

Technical Specifications

C450CPN-3C and C450CQN-3C Control Modules with Analog Output (Part 1 of 2)
Product C450CPN-3C and C450CQN-3C: System 450 Control Module models are sensing controls and operating controls with

LCD, four-button touchpad, and SPDT analog output C450CPN-3C: Control Module with one analog output C450CQN-3C: Control Module with two analog outputs

Power Consumption C450CPN-3C: 1.3 VA maximum using 0 to 10 V out; 1.5 VA maximum using 4 to 20 mA out

C450CQN-3C: 2.0 VA maximum using 0 to 10 V out; 2.4 VA maximum using 4 to 20 mA out

Supply Power Internal Supply Power: C450YNN-1C Power Supply Module

External Supply Power: 24 VAC (20 to 30 VAC) Safety Extra-Low Voltage (SELV) (Europe), Class 2 (North America), 50/60 Hz, 10 VA minimum

Note: A System 450 control module or module assembly can use an internal or an external supply power source, but must not be connected to both simultaneously.

System 450 Control Series

System 450™ Series Modular Controls (Continued)

C450CPN-3C and C450CQN-3C Control Modules with Analog Output (Part 2 of 2)
Ambient Operating Conditions Temperature: -40 to 66C (-40 to 150F) when using 0–10 VDC outputs;

-40 to 40C (-40 to 104F) when using 4–20 mA outputs

Humidity: Up to 95% RH noncondensing; maximum dew point 29C (85F)

Ambient Shipping and Storage Conditions Temperature: -40 to 80C (-40 to 176F)

Humidity: Up to 95% RH noncondensing; maximum dew point 29C (85F)

Input Signal 0 to 5 VDC for humidity sensors and static pressure transducers

0.5 to 4.5 VDC for ratiometric pressure transducers

1,035 ohms at 25C (77F) for A99 PTC temperature sensors

1,000 ohms at 21.1C (70F) for TE-6xxx Nickel temperature sensors

Analog Output Voltage Mode (0–10 VDC):

10 VDC maximum output voltage 10 mA maximum output current

Requires an external load of 1,000 ohms or more

The AO operates in Voltage Mode when connected to devices with impedance greater than 1,000 ohms. Devices that fall below 1,000 ohms may not operate as intended with Voltage Mode applications.

Current Mode (4–20 mA):

Requires an external load between 0 to 300 ohms

The AO operates in Current Mode when connected to devices with impedance less than 300 ohms. Devices that rise above 300 ohms may not operate as intended with Current Mode applications.

Analog Input Accuracy Resolution: 14 bits
Control Construction Independently mounted control, surface mounted with Lexan® 950 enclosure suitable for DIN rail mounting or direct mounting to a hard, even surface.
Dimensions (H x W x D) 127 x 61 x 61 mm (5 x 2-3/8 x 2-3/8 in.)
Weight C450CPN-3C: 195 g (0.43 lb)

C450CQN-3C: 195 g (0.43 lb)

Compliance

North America: cULus Listed; UL 60730, File E27734; FCC Compliant to CFR47, Part 15, Subpart B, Class B

Industry Canada (IC) Compliant to Canadian ICES-003, Class B limits

Europe: CE Mark – Johnson Controls, Inc. declares that this product is in compliance with the essential requirements

and other relevant provisions of the EMC Directive and the Low Voltage Directive.

Australia: Mark: C-Tick Compliant (N1813)
C450CEN-1C Control Module with Ethernet Communications
Product C450CEN: System 450 control modules are sensing controls and operating controls with LCD and four-button

touchpad UI, Ethernet communications capability, and no outputs. C450CEN-1C: Control module with Ethernet communications capability

Supply Power Internal Supply Power: C450YNN-1C Power Supply Module

External Supply Power: 24 VAC (20 to 30 VAC) Safety Extra-Low Voltage (SELV) (Europe), Class 2 (North America), 50/60 Hz, 10 VA minimum

Note: A System 450 control module or module assembly can use an internal or an external supply power source, but must not be connected to both simultaneously.

Ambient Operating Conditions Temperature: -40 to 66C (-40 to 150F)

Humidity: Up to 95% RH noncondensing; maximum dew point 29C (85F)

Ambient Shipping and Storage Conditions Temperature: -40 to 80C (-40 to 176F)

Humidity: Up to 95% RH noncondensing; maximum dew point 29C (85F)

Input Signal 0 to 5 VDC; 1,035 ohms at 25C (77F) for an A99 PTC Temperature Sensor
Analog Input Accuracy Resolution: 16 bits
Control Construction Independently mounted control, surface mounted with Lexan® 950 enclosure suitable for DIN rail mounting or direct mounting to a hard, even surface.
Dimensions (H x W x D) 127 x 63 x 63 mm (5 x 2-3/8 x 2-3/8 in.)
Weight C450CEN-1C: 207 g (0.46 lb)
Compliance

North America: cULus Listed; UL 60730, File E27734; FCC Compliant to CFR47, Part 15, Subpart B, Class B

Industry Canada (IC) Compliant to Canadian ICES-003, Class B limits

Europe: CE Mark – Johnson Controls, Inc. declares that this product is in compliance with the essential requirements

and other relevant provisions of the EMC Directive; Low Voltage Directive; CISPR22, class B.

Australia: Mark: C-Tick Compliant (N1813)

System 450 Control Series

System 450™ Series Modular Controls (Continued)

C450CRN-1C Control Module with RS485 Modbus Communications
Product C450CRN-1C: System 450 control modules are sensing controls and operating controls with LCD and four-button

touchpad UI and no outputs. This control module is an RS485, RTU compliant Modbus slave device.

Supply Power Internal Supply Power: C450YNN-1C Power Supply Module

External Supply Power: 24 VAC (20 to 30 VAC) Safety Extra-Low Voltage (SELV) (Europe), Class 2 (North America), 50/60 Hz, 10 VA minimum

Note: A System 450 control module or module assembly can use an internal or an external supply power source, but must not be connected to both simultaneously.

Ambient Operating Conditions Temperature: -40 to 66C (-40 to 150F)

Humidity: Up to 95% RH noncondensing; maximum dew point 29C (85F)

Ambient Shipping and Storage Conditions Temperature: -40 to 80C (-40 to 176F)

Humidity: Up to 95% RH noncondensing; maximum dew point 29C (85F)

Input Signal 0 to 5 VDC; 1,035 ohms at 25C (77F) for an A99 PTC Temperature Sensor
Analog Input Accuracy Resolution: 16 bits
Control Construction Independently mounted control, surface mounted with Lexan® 950 enclosure suitable for DIN rail mounting or direct mounting to a hard, even surface.
Dimensions (H x W x D) 127 x 63 x 63 mm (5 x 2-3/8 x 2-3/8 in.)
Weight C450CRN-1C: 207 g (0.46 lb)
Compliance

North America: cULus Listed; UL 60730, File E27734: FCC Compliant to CFR47, Part 15, Subpart B, Class B

Industry Canada (IC) Compliant to Canadian ICES-003, Class B limits

Europe: CE Mark – Johnson Controls, Inc. declares that this product is in compliance with the essential requirements

and other relevant provisions of the EMC Directive; Low Voltage Directive; CISPR22, class B

Australia: Mark: C-Tick Compliant (N1813)
C450CPW-100C Control Module with Hybrid Analog Output (Part 1 of 2)
Product C450CPW-100C System 450 control module is a sensing control and operating control with LCD, four-button

touchpad, and analog output with pulse-width modulation capability.

Power Consumption C450CPW-100C: 1.3 VA maximum using 0 to 10 V out; 1.5 VA maximum using 4 to 20 mA out
Supply Power Internal Supply Power: C450YNN-1C Power Supply Module

External Supply Power: 24 VAC (20 to 30 VAC) Safety Extra-Low Voltage (SELV) (Europe), Class 2 (North America), 50/60 Hz, 10 VA minimum

Note: A System 450 control module or module assembly can use an internal or an external supply power source, but must not be connected to both simultaneously.

Ambient Operating Conditions Temperature: -40 to 66C (-40 to 150F) when using 0 to 10 VDC outputs;

-40 to 40C (-40 to 104F) when using 4 to 20 mA outputs

Humidity: Up to 95% RH noncondensing; maximum dew point 29C (85F)

Ambient Shipping and Storage Conditions Temperature: -40 to 80C (-40 to 176F)

Humidity: Up to 95% RH noncondensing; maximum dew point 29C (85F)

Input Signal 0 to 5 VDC for humidity sensors and static pressure transducers

0.5 to 4.5 VDC for ratiometric pressure transducers

1,035 ohms at 25C (77F) for A99 PTC temperature sensors

1,000 ohms at 21.1C (70F) for TE-6xxx Nickel temperature sensors

Analog Output Voltage Mode (0–10 VDC):

10 VDC maximum output voltage 10 mA maximum output current

Requires an external load of 1,000 ohms or more

The AO operates in Voltage Mode when connected to devices with impedance greater than 1,000 ohms. Devices that fall below 1,000 ohms may not operate as intended with Voltage Mode applications.

Current Mode (4–20 mA):

Requires an external load between 0 to 300 ohms

The AO operates in Current Mode when connected to devices with impedance less than 300 ohms. Devices that rise above 300 ohms may not operate as intended with Current Mode applications.

Analog Input Accuracy Resolution: 14 bits
Control Construction Independently mounted control, surface mounted with Lexan® 950 enclosure suitable for DIN rail mounting or direct mounting to a hard, even surface.
Dimensions (H x W x D) 127 x 61 x 61 mm (5 x 2-3/8 x 2-3/8 in.)
Weight C450CPW-100C: 195 g (0.43 lb)

System 450 Control Series

System 450™ Series Modular Controls (Continued)

C450CPW-100C Control Module with Hybrid Analog Output (Part 2 of 2)
Compliance

North America: cULus Listed; UL 60730, File E27734;

FCC Compliant to CFR47, Part 15, Subpart B, Class B

Industry Canada (IC) Compliant to Canadian ICES-003, Class B limits

Europe: CE Mark – Johnson Controls, Inc. declares that this product is in compliance with the essential requirements

and other relevant provisions of the EMC Directive and the Low Voltage Directive.

Australia: Mark: C-Tick Compliant (N1813)
C450CBN-3C and C450CCN-3C Control Modules with Relay Output
Product C450CBN-3C and C450CCN-3C: System 450 Control Module models are sensing controls and operating controls with

LCD, four-button touchpad, and SPDT relay output C450CBN-3C: Control Module with one SPDT output relay C450CCN-3C: Control Module with two SPDT output relays

Power Consumption C450CBN-3C: 0.9 VA maximum C450CCN-3C: 1.3 VA maximum
Supply Power Internal Supply Power: C450YNN-1C Power Supply Module

External Supply Power: 24 VAC (20 to 30 VAC) Safety Extra-Low Voltage (SELV) (Europe), Class 2 (North America), 50/60 Hz, 10 VA minimum

Note: A System 450 control module or module assembly can use an internal or an external supply power source, but must not be connected to both simultaneously.

Ambient Operating Conditions Temperature: -40 to 66C (-40 to 150F)

Humidity: Up to 95% RH noncondensing; maximum dew point 29C (85F)

Ambient Shipping and Storage Conditions Temperature: -40 to 80C (-40 to 176F)

Humidity: Up to 95% RH noncondensing; maximum dew point 29C (85F)

Input Signal 0 to 5 VDC for humidity sensors and static pressure transducers

0.5 to 4.5 VDC for ratiometric pressure transducers

1,035 ohms at 25C (77F) for A99 PTC temperature sensors

1,000 ohms at 21.1C (70F) for TE-6xxx Nickel temperature sensors

Output Relay Contacts General: 1/2 HP at 120/240 VAC, SPDT
Specific: AC Motor Ratings 120 VAC 208/240 VAC AC Full-load Amperes: 9.8 A 4.9 A Locked-Rotor Amperes: 58.8 A 29.4 A

10 Amperes AC Non-inductive at 24/240 VAC Pilot Duty: 125 VA at 24/240 VAC

Analog Input Accuracy Resolution: 14 bits
Control Construction Independently mounted control, surface mounted with Lexan® 950 enclosure suitable for DIN rail mounting or direct mounting to a hard, even surface.
Dimensions (H x W x D) 127 x 61 x 61 mm (5 x 2-3/8 x 2-3/8 in.)
Weight C450CBN-3C: 209 g (0.46 lb)

C450CCN-3C: 222 g (0.49 lb)

Compliance

North America: cULus Listed; UL 60730, File E27734; FCC Compliant to CFR47, Part 15, Subpart B, Class B;

Industry Canada (IC) Compliant to Canadian ICES-003, Class B limits

Europe: CE Mark – Johnson Controls, Inc. declares that this product is in compliance with the essential requirements

and other relevant provisions of the EMC Directive and the Low Voltage Directive.

Australia: Mark: C-Tick Compliant (N1813)
C450RBN-3C and C450RCN-3C Reset Control Modules with Real-Time Clock and Relay Output (Part 1 of 2)
Product C450RBN-3C and C450RCN-3C: System 450 Reset Control Module models are sensing controls and operating

controls with LCD, four-button touchpad, and SPDT relay output C450RBN-3C: Control Module with one SPDT output relay C450RCN-3C: Control Module with two SPDT output relays

Power Consumption C450RBN-3C: 0.9 VA maximum C450RCN-3C: 1.3 VA maximum
Supply Power Internal Supply Power: C450YNN-1C Power Supply Module

External Supply Power: 24 VAC (20 to 30 VAC) Safety Extra-Low Voltage (SELV) (Europe), Class 2 (North America), 50/60 Hz, 10 VA minimum

Note: A System 450 control module or module assembly can use an internal or an external supply power source, but must not be connected to both simultaneously.

Ambient Operating Conditions Temperature: -40 to 66C (-40 to 150F)

Humidity: Up to 95% RH noncondensing; maximum dew point 29C (85F)

Ambient Shipping and Storage Conditions Temperature: -40 to 80C (-40 to 176F)

Humidity: Up to 95% RH noncondensing; maximum dew point 29C (85F)

System 450 Control Series

System 450™ Series Modular Controls (Continued)

C450RBN-3C and C450RCN-3C Reset Control Modules with Real-Time Clock and Relay Output (Part 2 of 2)
Input Signal 0 to 5 VDC for humidity sensors

1,035 ohms at 25C (77F) for A99 PTC temperature sensors

Output Relay Contacts General: 1/2 HP at 120/240 VAC, SPDT
Specific: AC Motor Ratings 120 VAC 208/240 VAC AC Full-load Amperes: 9.8 A 4.9 A AC Locked-Rotor Amperes: 58.8 A 29.4 A

10 Amperes AC Non-inductive at 24/240 VAC Pilot Duty: 125 VA at 24/240 VAC

Clock Accuracy ±4 minutes per year
Clock Backup Power 12 hours (capacitor reserve)
Setback Events One occupied and one unoccupied event per day; 7 day schedule
Analog Input Accuracy Resolution: 14 bits
Control Construction Independently mounted control, surface mounted with Lexan® 950 enclosure suitable for DIN rail mounting or direct mounting to a hard, even surface.
Dimensions (H x W x D) 127 x 61 x 61 mm (5 x 2-3/8 x 2-3/8 in.)
Weight C450RBN-3C: 209 g (0.46 lb)

C450RCN-3C: 222 g (0.49 lb)

Compliance

North America: cULus Listed; UL 60730, File E27734; FCC Compliant to CFR47, Part 15, Subpart B, Class B;

Industry Canada (IC) Compliant to Canadian ICES-003, Class B limits

Europe: CE Mark – Johnson Controls, Inc. declares that this product is in compliance with the essential requirements

and other relevant provisions of the EMC Directive and the Low Voltage Directive.

Australia: Mark: C-Tick Compliant (N1813)
C450SPN-1C and C450SQN-1C Expansion Modules with Analog Output
Product C450SPN-1C: System 450 Expansion Module with one Analog output

C450SQN-1C: System 450 Expansion Module with two Analog outputs

Power Consumption C450SPN-1C: 1.1 VA max using 0 to 10 V out; 1.3 VA maximum using 4 to 20 mA out

C450SQN-1C: 1.8 VA max using 0 to 10 V out; 2.2 VA maximum using 4 to 20 mA out

Supply Power Internal Supply Power: C450YNN-1C Power Supply Module

External Supply Power: 24 VAC (20 to 30 VAC) Safety Extra-Low Voltage (SELV) (Europe), Class 2 (North America), 50/60 Hz, 10 VA minimum

Note: A System 450 control module or module assembly can use an internal or an external supply power source, but must not be connected to both simultaneously.

Ambient Operating Conditions Temperature: -40 to 66C (-40 to 150F) when using 0 to 10 VDC outputs;

-40 to 40C (-40 to 104F) when using 4 to 20 mA outputs

Humidity: Up to 95% RH noncondensing; maximum dew point 29C (85F)

Ambient Shipping and Storage Conditions Temperature: -40 to 80C (-40 to 176F)

Humidity: Up to 95% RH noncondensing; maximum dew point 29C (85F)

Analog Output Voltage Mode (0 to 10 VDC):

10 VDC maximum output voltage 10 mA maximum output current

Requires an external load of 1,000 ohms or more

The AO operates in Voltage Mode when connected to devices with impedance greater than 1,000 ohms. Devices that drop below 1,000 ohms may not operate as intended with Voltage Mode applications.

Current Mode (4 to 20 mA):

Requires an external load between 0 to 300 ohms

The AO operates in Current Mode when connected to devices with impedances less than 300 ohms. Devices that exceed 300 ohms may not operate as intended with Current Mode applications.

Control Construction Independently mounted control, surface mounted with Lexan® 950 enclosure suitable for DIN rail mounting or direct mounting to a hard, even surface.
Dimensions (H x W x D) 127 x 61 x 61 mm (5 x 2-3/8 x 2-3/8 in.)
Weight C450SPN-1C: 150 g (0.33 lb)

C450SQN-1C: 150 g (0.33 lb)

Compliance

North America: cULus Listed; UL 60730, File E27734, Vol. 1; FCC Compliant to CFR47, Part 15, Subpart B, Class B Industry Canada (IC) Compliant to Canadian ICES-003, Class B limits
Europe: CE Mark – Johnson Controls, Inc., declares that this product is in compliance with the essential requirements

and other relevant provisions of the Low Voltage Directive and the EMC Directive.

Australia: Mark: C-Tick Compliant (N1813)

System 450 Control Series

System 450™ Series Modular Controls (Continued)

C450SBN-3C and C450SCN-3C Expansion Modules with Relay Output
Product C450SBN-3C: System 450 Expansion Module with one SPDT output relay

C450SCN-3C: System 450 Expansion Module with two SPDT output relays

Power Consumption C450SBN-3C: 0.8 VA maximum C450SCN-3C: 1.2 VA maximum
Supply Power Internal Supply Power: C450YNN-1C Power Supply Module

External Supply Power: 24 VAC (20 to 30 VAC) Safety Extra-Low Voltage (SELV) (Europe), Class 2 (North America), 50/60 Hz, 10 VA minimum

Note: A System 450 control module or module assembly can use an internal or an external supply power source, but must not be connected to both simultaneously.

Ambient Operating Conditions Temperature: -40 to 66C (-40 to 150F)

Humidity: Up to 95% RH noncondensing; maximum dew point 29C (85F)

Ambient Shipping and Storage Conditions Temperature: -40 to 80C (-40 to 176F)

Humidity: Up to 95% RH noncondensing; maximum dew point 29C (85F)

Output Relay Contacts General: 1/2 HP at 120/240 VAC, SPDT
Specific: AC Motor Ratings 120 VAC 208/240 VAC AC Full-Load Amperes: 9.8 A 4.9 A

AC Locked-Rotor Amperes: 58.8 A 29.4 A

10 Amperes AC Noninductive at 24/240 VAC Pilot Duty: 125 VA at 24/240 VAC

Control Construction Independently mounted control, surface mounted with Lexan® 950 enclosure suitable for DIN rail mounting or direct mounting to a hard, even surface.
Dimensions (H x W x D) 127 x 61 x 61 mm (5 x 2-3/8 x 2-3/8 in.)
Weight C450SBN-3C: 172 g (0.38 lb)

C450SCN-3C: 186 g (0.41 lb)

Compliance

North America: cULus Listed; UL 60730, File E27734; FCC Compliant to CFR47, Part 15, Subpart B, Class B

Industry Canada (IC) Compliant to Canadian ICES-003, Class B limits

Europe: CE Mark – Johnson Controls, Inc. declares that this product is in compliance with the essential requirements

and other relevant provisions of the EMC Directive and the Low Voltage Directive.

Australia: Mark: C-Tick Compliant (N1813)
C450YNN-1C Power Supply Module
Product C450YNN-1C: System 450 Power Supply Module; 120 or 240 VAC stepdown to 24 VAC Class 2 (North America) or

SELV (Europe)

Supply Power 110/120 VAC or 220/240 VAC at 50/60 Hz (100 mA maximum)
Secondary Power 24 VAC, 10 VA
Ambient Operating Conditions Temperature: -40 to 66C (-40 to 150F)

Humidity: Up to 95% RH noncondensing; maximum dew point 29C (85F)

Ambient Shipping and Storage Conditions Temperature: -40 to 80C (-40 to 176F)

Humidity: Up to 95% RH noncondensing; maximum dew point 29C (85F)

Control Construction Independently mounted control, surface mounted with Lexan® 950 enclosure suitable for DIN rail mounting or direct

mounting to a hard, even surface.

Dimensions (H x W x D) 127 x 61 x 61 mm (5 x 2-3/8 x 2-3/8 in.)
Weight C450YNN-1C: 390 gm (0.86 lb)
Compliance

North America: cULus Listed; UL 60730, File E27734: FCC Compliant to CFR47, Part 15, Subpart B, Class B

Industry Canada (IC) Compliant to Canadian ICES-003, Class B limits

Europe: CE Mark – Johnson Controls, Inc. declares that this product is in compliance with the essential requirements

and other relevant provisions of the EMC Directive and the Low Voltage Directive.

Australia: Mark: C-Tick Compliant (N1813)

System 450 Control Series

Code No. LIT- 1900861

System 450™ Series Control Module with Network Communications

Description

System 450™ is a family of modular, digital electronic controls that is easily assembled and set up to provide reliable temperature, pressure, and humidity control for a wide variety of HVAC/R applications, commercial process applications, and industrial process applications.

The System 450 control system is designed to replace System 350™ and System 27 control systems and to provide many additional features and benefits with fewer than twenty model variations.

System 450 control modules provide a field-configurable

out-of-the-box solution. Most System 450 control modules can control temperature, pressure, and humidity systems simultaneously.

A single C450 control module can be set up as a stand-alone control or connected to expansion modules to control up to ten On/Off relay and proportional analog outputs, based on any of the three available inputs.

System 450 Control Modules with Communications enable you to connect System 450 control systems to Modbus® or Ethernet networks for remote monitoring and setup. The Modbus communications control module is an RS485, RTU-compliant slave device. The Ethernet communications control module has an integral web server that can deliver web pages through a direct connection, on your LAN, or across the Internet.

Refer to the following documents for important product application information, as well as detailed information on designing, installing, setting up, and troubleshooting:

  • System 450™ Series Modular Controls Product Bulletin (LIT-12011458)
  • System 450™ Series Modular Control Systems with Communications Control Modules Technical Bulletin (LIT-12011826)
  • System 450™ Series Control Module with RS485 Modbus® Communications Installation Instructions (Part No. 24-7664-2926)
  • System 450™ Series Control Module with Ethernet Communications Installation Instructions (Part No. 24-7664-2934)

Features

  • Durable, compact, interchangeable modular components with plug-together connectors and DIN rail or direct wall mount capability eliminate field wiring between modules and allow you to quickly and

easily design, assemble, install, and upgrade your control systems.

  • Versatile, multipurpose, field-configurable control modules and expansion modules designed for global use allow you to create a wide variety of application-specific control systems capable of controlling temperature, pressure, or humidity, or all three conditions simultaneously, with only a small suite of module models.
  • Up to three hard-wired input sensors and up to ten relay or analog outputs (in any combination) per control system allow you to build complex custom control systems while reducing your control system cost to only the cost of the required components.
  • Control modules with bright backlit LCDs and four-button touch pad user interfaces provide quick, clear, visual status of your

System 450 control system inputs and outputs with the touch of a button and enable you to quickly and easily set up and adjust your control system.

  • An extensive suite of compatible temperature and humidity sensors, and pressure transducers allows you to monitor and control a wide range of HVAC/R and process conditions in a variety of standard and global units of measurement.
  • High input signal selection enables your control system to monitor a temperature, pressure, or humidity condition with two or three sensors (of the same type) and control your system outputs based on the highest condition value sensed by the referenced sensors.

C450CEN Control Module with Communication

  • Differential control enables your control system to monitor and maintain a temperature, pressure, or humidity differential between two sensor points within a system, process, or space.
  • Ethernet communication capability through a built-in web server (Ethernet control modules only) allows you to monitor your control system status and set up or change the parameters by means of a direct Ethernet cable connection, through a LAN connection, or over the Internet. The built in web server delivers user-friendly web pages to client browsers on a desktop, laptop, tablet, or smart device.
  • The web page server on Ethernet communication modules provides a simple, intuitive web interface for easy remote monitoring, setup, adjustment and remote monitoring of your control systems across Ethernet networks.
  • RS485, RTU-compliant Modbus® network communication capability (Modbus control modules only) enables a head-end RS485 Modbus master controller to read and write control system status and setup parameters to the System 450 Modbus communication control module.
  • Password protection for local access (Ethernet and Modbus control modules only) and password protection for remote access (Ethernet control module only) deters unauthorized changes to the control system settings, but allows local and remote monitoring of your control system status.
  • Analog output signal limiting features (communication control modules only) allow you to select the rate and condition range at which the control updates the analog output signal, potentially reducing wear on the controlled equipment.
  • Binary input with time delay (communication control modules only) allows you to use an external set of dry contacts and selectable time delays to control relay outputs.

System 450 Control Series

System 450™ Series Control Module with Network Communications (Continued)

Selection Chart

Refer to the System 450 Compatible Sensors, Transducers, and Accessories Catalog Page (LIT-1900662) for temperature sensors, humidity sensors, and pressure transducers compatible with the System 450 Control Modules.

Communications System 450 Modules and Accessories Ordering Information

Product Code

Number

Product Description
C450CEN-1C Control Module with Ethernet Communications, LCD, and Four-Button Touchpad UI. (No onboard outputs available on control modules

with network communications capabilities.)

C450CRN-1C Control Module with RS485 Modbus Communications, LCD, and Four-Button Touchpad UI. (No onboard outputs available on control modules with network communications capabilities.)
BKT287-1R DIN Rail; 0.30 m (12 in.) long
BKT287-2R DIN Rail; 1 m (39-1/3 in.) long
BKT287-3R DIN Rail; 0.61 m (24 in.) long
BKT287-4R DIN Rail; 0.36 m (14 in.) long
PLT344-1R DIN Rail End Clamps (Two clamps)
WHA-C450-100C System 450 module connection extension cable, 100 cm (3.3 ft) long

Repair Information

If the System 450™ Control Module with Ethernet or RS485 Modbus Communication fails to operate within its specifications, replace the unit. For a replacement System 450™ Control Module, contact a Johnson Controls® representative.

Technical Specifications

C450CEN-1C Control Module with Ethernet Communications
Product C450CEN: System 450 control modules are sensing controls and operating controls with LCD and four-button

touchpad UI, Ethernet communications capability, and no outputs. C450CEN-1C: Control module with Ethernet communications capability

Supply Power Internal Supply Power: C450YNN-1C Power Supply Module

External Supply Power: 24 VAC (20 to 30 VAC) Safety Extra-Low Voltage (SELV) (Europe), Class 2 (North America), 50/60 Hz, 10 VA minimum

Note: A System 450 control module or module assembly can use an internal or an external supply power source, but must not be connected to both simultaneously.

Ambient Operating Conditions Temperature: -40 to 66C (-40 to 150F)

Humidity: Up to 95% RH noncondensing; maximum dew point 29C (85F)

Ambient Shipping and Storage Conditions Temperature: -40 to 80C (-40 to 176F)

Humidity: Up to 95% RH noncondensing; maximum dew point 29C (85F)

Input Signal 0 to 5 VDC; 1,035 ohms at 25C (77F) for an A99 PTC Temperature Sensor
Analog Input Accuracy Resolution: 16 bits
Control Construction Independently mounted control, surface mounted with Lexan® 950 enclosure suitable for DIN rail mounting or direct mounting to a hard, even surface.
Dimensions (H x W x D) 127 x 63 x 63 mm (5 x 2-3/8 x 2-3/8 in.)
Weight C450CEN-1C: 207 g (0.46 lb)
Compliance

North America: cULus Listed; UL 60730, File E27734; FCC Compliant to CFR47, Part 15, Subpart B, Class B

Industry Canada (IC) Compliant to Canadian ICES-003, Class B limits

Europe: CE Mark – Johnson Controls, Inc. declares that this product is in compliance with the essential requirements

and other relevant provisions of the EMC Directive; Low Voltage Directive; CISPR22, class B.

Australia: Mark: C-Tick Compliant (N1813)

System 450 Control Series

System 450™ Series Control Module with Network Communications (Continued)

C450CRN-1C Control Module with RS485 Modbus Communications
Product C450CRN-1C: System 450 control modules are sensing controls and operating controls with LCD and four-button

touchpad UI and no outputs. This control module is an RS485, RTU compliant Modbus slave device.

Supply Power Internal Supply Power: C450YNN-1C Power Supply Module

External Supply Power: 24 VAC (20 to 30 VAC) Safety Extra-Low Voltage (SELV) (Europe), Class 2 (North America), 50/60 Hz, 10 VA minimum

Note: A System 450 control module or module assembly can use an internal or an external supply power source, but must not be connected to both simultaneously.

Ambient Operating Conditions Temperature: -40 to 66C (-40 to 150F)

Humidity: Up to 95% RH noncondensing; maximum dew point 29C (85F)

Ambient Shipping and Storage Conditions Temperature: -40 to 80C (-40 to 176F)

Humidity: Up to 95% RH noncondensing; maximum dew point 29C (85F)

Input Signal 0 to 5 VDC; 1,035 ohm at 25C (77F) for an A99 PTC Temperature Sensor
Analog Input Accuracy Resolution: 16 bit
Control Construction Independently mounted control, surface mounted with Lexan® 950 enclosure suitable for DIN rail mounting or direct mounting to a hard, even surface.
Dimensions (H x W x D) 127 x 63 x 63 mm (5 x 2-3/8 x 2-3/8 in.)
Weight C450CRN-1C: 207 g (0.46 lb)
Compliance

North America: cULus Listed; UL 60730, File E27734: FCC Compliant to CFR47, Part 15, Subpart B, Class B

Industry Canada (IC) Compliant to Canadian ICES-003, Class B limits

Europe: CE Mark – Johnson Controls, Inc. declares that this product is in compliance with the essential requirements

and other relevant provisions of the EMC Directive; Low Voltage Directive; CISPR22, class B

Australia: Mark: C-Tick Compliant (N1813)

System 450 Control Series

Code No. LIT-1900658

System 450™ Reset Control Modules with Real-Time Clock and Relay Output

Description

System 450™ is a family of modular, digital electronic controls that is easily assembled and set up to provide reliable temperature, pressure, and humidity control for a wide variety of HVAC/R applications, commercial process applications, and industrial process applications.

System 450 Reset Control Modules provide many of the features of the standard models for temperature and humidity control. In addition, these modules provide setpoint reset, real-time setback scheduling, and run-time balancing (equal run time) capability.

The System 450 control system is designed to replace System 350™ and System 27 control systems, and to provide many additional features and benefits with fewer than twenty model variations.

System 450 control modules provide a field-configurable

out-of-the-box solution. Most System 450 control modules can control temperature, pressure, and humidity systems simultaneously.

A single C450 control module can be set up as a stand-alone control or connected to expansion modules to control up to ten On/Off relay and proportional analog outputs, based on any of the three available inputs.

Refer to the following documents for important product application information:

  • System 450™ Series Modular Controls Product Bulletin (LIT-12011458)
  • System 450™ Series Modular Control Systems with Reset Control Modules Technical Bulletin (LIT-12011842)
  • System 450™ Series Reset Control Modules with Real-Time Clock and Relay Output Installation Instructions (Part No. 24-7664-2888)

Features

  • Durable, compact, interchangeable modular components with

plug-together connectors and DIN rail or direct wall mount capability eliminate field wiring between modules and allow you to quickly and easily design, assemble, install, and upgrade your control systems.

  • Versatile, multipurpose, field-configurable control modules and expansion modules designed for global use allow you to create a wide variety of application-specific control systems capable of controlling temperature, pressure, or humidity, or all three conditions simultaneously, with only a small suite of module models.
  • Up to three hard-wired input sensors and up to ten relay or analog outputs (in any combination) per control system allow you to build complex custom control systems while reducing your control system cost to only the cost of the required components.
  • Control Modules with bright backlit LCDs and four-button touch pad user interfaces provide quick, clear, visual status of your

System 450 control system inputs and outputs with the touch of a button and enable you to quickly and easily set up and adjust your control system.

  • Multipurpose, all-in-one control modules enable simple stand-alone, single-module control systems that are temperature, pressure, and humidity capable out of the box and easy to set up in the field to replace a wide variety of OEM HVAC/R and process controls.
  • An extensive suite of compatible temperature and humidity sensors, and pressure transducers allows you to monitor and control a wide range of HVAC/R and process conditions in a variety of standard and global units of measurement.
  • High input signal selection enables your control system to monitor a temperature, pressure, or humidity condition with two or three sensors (of the same type) and control your system outputs based on the highest condition value sensed by the referenced sensors.

C450RCN-3 Reset Control Module with Real-Time Clock and Relay Output

  • Differential control enables your control system to monitor and maintain a temperature, pressure, or humidity differential between two sensor points within a system, process, or space.

Reset Control Features

  • Adjustable minimum and maximum setpoint temperatures (reset control modules only) enable compliance with the manufacturer’s specifications for your controlled HVAC/R and process equipment.
  • Selectable shutdown-high and shutdown-low temperature settings (reset control modules only) saves you energy by shutting down controlled equipment when the ambient temperature either rises or drops to a point where heating or cooling is no longer required.
  • Real time clock and adjustable setback temperature (reset control modules only) save you energy by setting back heating, cooling, or humidity setpoints during scheduled unoccupied periods (24-hour day, 7-day week schedule).
  • User-defined reset control capability (reset control modules only) saves you energy in a wide variety of temperature and humidity reset control applications by adjusting the temperature or humidity control loop, based on changes in ambient outdoor temperature or other uncontrolled condition.

Repair Information

If the System 450 Reset Control Module fails to operate within its specifications, replace the unit. For a replacement System 450 Reset Control Module, contact the nearest Johnson Controls® representative.

System 450 Control Series

System 450™ Reset Control Modules with Real-Time Clock and Relay Output (Continued)

Selection Chart

Refer to the System 450 Compatible Sensors, Transducers, and Accessories Catalog Page (LIT-1900662) for temperature sensors and humidity sensors compatible with the System 450 Reset Control Modules. Reset Control Modules control temperature and humidity, but not pressure.

Reset System 450 Modules and Accessories Ordering Information

Product Code

Number

Product Description
C450RBN-3C Reset Control Module with LCD, Four-Button Touchpad UI, and SPDT relay output; provides one SPDT output relay. One A99BC-25C

temperature sensor with 0.25 m (9-1/4 in.) silicon leads and one A99BC-300C temperature sensor with 3 m (9 ft 10 in.) silicon leads are included in the box with the Reset Control Module.

C450RCN-3C Reset Control Module with LCD, Four-Button Touchpad UI, and SPDT relay output; provides two SPDT output relays. One A99BC-25C temperature sensor with 0.25 m (9-1/4 in.) silicon leads and one A99BC-300C temperature sensor with 3 m (9 ft 10 in.) silicon leads are included in the box with the Reset Control Module.
BKT287-1R DIN Rail; 0.30 m (12 in.) long
BKT287-2R DIN Rail; 1 m (39-1/3 in.) long
BKT287-3R DIN Rail; 0.61 m (24 in.) long
BKT287-4R DIN Rail; 0.36 m (14 in.) long
PLT344-1R DIN Rail End Clamps (Two clamps)
WHA-C450-100C System 450 module connection extension cable, 100 cm (3.3 ft) long

Technical Specifications

C450RBN-3C and C450RCN-3C Reset Control Modules with Real-Time Clock and Relay Output
Product C450RBN-3C and C450RCN-3C: System 450 Reset Control Module models are sensing controls and operating

controls with LCD, four-button touchpad, and SPDT relay output C450RBN-3C: Control Module with one SPDT output relay C450RCN-3C: Control Module with two SPDT output relays

Power Consumption C450RBN-3C: 0.9 VA maximum C450RCN-3C: 1.3 VA maximum
Supply Power Internal Supply Power: C450YNN-1C Power Supply Module

External Supply Power: 24 VAC (20 to 30 VAC) Safety Extra-Low Voltage (SELV) (Europe), Class 2 (North America), 50/60 Hz, 10 VA minimum

Note: A System 450 control module or module assembly can use an internal or an external supply power source, but must not be connected to both simultaneously.

Ambient Operating Conditions Temperature: -40 to 66C (-40 to 150F)

Humidity: Up to 95% RH noncondensing; maximum dew point 29C (85F)

Ambient Shipping and Storage Conditions Temperature: -40 to 80C (-40 to 176F)

Humidity: Up to 95% RH noncondensing; maximum dew point 29C (85F)

Input Signal 0 to 5 VDC for humidity sensors

1,035 ohms at 25C (77F) for A99 PTC temperature sensors

Output Relay Contacts General: 1/2 HP at 120/240 VAC, SPDT
Specific: AC Motor Ratings 120 VAC 208/240 VAC AC Full-load Amperes: 9.8 A 4.9 A AC Locked-Rotor Amperes: 58.8 A 29.4 A

10 Amperes AC Non-inductive at 24/240 VAC Pilot Duty: 125 VA at 24/240 VAC

Clock Accuracy ±4 minutes per year
Clock Backup Power 12 hours (capacitor reserve)
Setback Events One occupied and one unoccupied event per day; 7 day schedule
Analog Input Accuracy Resolution: 14 bits
Control Construction Independently mounted control, surface mounted with Lexan® 950 enclosure suitable for DIN rail mounting or direct mounting to a hard, even surface.
Dimensions (H x W x D) 127 x 61 x 61 mm (5 x 2-3/8 x 2-3/8 in.)
Weight C450RBN-3C: 209 g (0.46 lb)

C450RCN-3C: 222 g (0.49 lb)

Compliance

North America: cULus Listed; UL 60730, File E27734; FCC Compliant to CFR47, Part 15, Subpart B, Class B;

Industry Canada (IC) Compliant to Canadian ICES-003, Class B limits

Europe: CE Mark – Johnson Controls, Inc. declares that this product is in compliance with the essential

requirements and other relevant provisions of the EMC Directive and the Low Voltage Directive.

Australia: Mark: C-Tick Compliant (N1813)

System 450 Control Series

Code No. LIT-1900656

System 450™ Control Modules with Analog Output

Description

System 450™ is a family of modular, digital electronic controls that is easily assembled and set up to provide reliable temperature, pressure, and humidity control for a wide variety of HVAC/R applications, commercial process applications, and industrial process applications.

The System 450 control system is designed to replace System 350™ and System 27 control systems, and to provide many additional features and benefits with fewer than twenty model variations.

System 450 control modules provide a field-configurable out-of-the-box solution. Most System 450 control modules can control temperature, pressure, and humidity systems simultaneously.

A single C450 control module can be set up as a stand-alone control or connected to expansion modules to control up to ten On/Off relay and proportional analog outputs, based on any of the three available inputs.

Refer to the following documents for important product application information:

  • System 450™ Series Modular Controls Product Bulletin (LIT-12011458)
  • System 450™ Series Modular Control Systems with Standard Control Modules Technical Bulletin (LIT-12011459)
  • System 450™ Series Control Modules with Analog Outputs Installation Instructions (Part No. 24-7664-2853)

Features

  • Durable, compact, interchangeable modular components with

plug-together connectors and DIN rail or direct wall mount capability eliminate field wiring between modules and allow you to quickly and easily design, assemble, install, and upgrade your control systems.

  • Versatile, multipurpose, field-configurable control modules and expansion modules designed for global use allow you to create a wide variety of application-specific control systems capable of controlling temperature, pressure, or humidity, or all three conditions simultaneously, with only a small suite of module models.
  • Up to three hard-wired input sensors and up to ten relay or analog outputs (in any combination) per control system allow you to build complex custom control systems while reducing your control system cost to only the cost of the required components.
  • Control Modules with bright backlit LCDs and four-button touch pad user interfaces provide quick, clear, visual status of your

System 450 control system inputs and outputs with the touch of a button and enable you to quickly and easily set up and adjust your control system.

Selection Chart

C450CPN-3C Control Module with Analog Output

  • Multipurpose, all-in-one control modules enable simple

stand-alone, single-module control systems that are temperature, pressure, and humidity capable out of the box and easy to set up in the field to replace a wide variety of OEM HVAC/R and process controls.

  • An extensive suite of compatible temperature and humidity sensors, and pressure transducers allows you to monitor and control a wide range of HVAC/R and process conditions in a variety of standard and global units of measurement.
  • High input signal selection enables your control system to monitor a temperature, pressure, or humidity condition with two or three sensors (of the same type) and control your system outputs based on the highest condition value sensed by the referenced sensors.
  • Differential control enables your control system to monitor and maintain a temperature, pressure, or humidity differential between two sensor points within a system, process, or space.

Repair Information

If the System 450™ Control Module with Analog Outputs fails to operate within its specifications, replace the unit. For a replacement System 450™ Control Module with Analog Outputs, contact your Johnson Controls® representative.

Refer to the System 450 Compatible Sensors, Transducers, and Accessories Catalog Page (LIT-1900662) for temperature sensors, humidity sensors, and pressure transducers compatible with the System 450 Control Modules with Analog Outputs.

Standard System 450 Modules and Accessories Ordering Information

Product Code

Number

Product Description
C450CPN-3C Standard Control Module with LCD, Four-Button Touchpad UI, and Analog Output; provides one analog output (0 to 10 VDC or 4 to 20

mA self-selecting signal) for proportional control.

C450CQN-3C Standard Control Module with LCD and Four-Button Touchpad UI, and Analog Output; provides two analog outputs (0 to 10 VDC or 4 to 20 mA self-selecting signals) for proportional control.
BKT287-1R DIN Rail; 0.30 m (12 in.) long
BKT287-2R DIN Rail; 1 m (39-1/3 in.) long
BKT287-3R DIN Rail; 0.61 m (24 in.) long
BKT287-4R DIN Rail; 0.36 m (14 in.) long
PLT344-1R DIN Rail End Clamps (Two clamps)
WHA-C450-100C System 450 module connection extension cable, 100 cm (3.3 ft) long

System 450 Control Series

System 450™ Control Modules with Analog Output (Continued)

Technical Specifications

C450CPN-3C and C450CQN-3C Control Modules with Analog Output
Product C450CPN-3C and C450CQN-3C: System 450 Control Module models are sensing controls and operating controls

with LCD, four-button touchpad, and SPDT analog output C450CPN-3C: Control Module with one analog output C450CQN-3C: Control Module with two analog outputs

Power Consumption C450CPN-3C: 1.3 VA maximum using 0 to 10 V out; 1.5 VA maximum using 4 to 20 mA out

C450CQN-3C: 2.0 VA maximum using 0 to 10 V out; 2.4 VA maximum using 4 to 20 mA out

Supply Power Internal Supply Power: C450YNN-1C Power Supply Module

External Supply Power: 24 VAC (20 to 30 VAC) Safety Extra-Low Voltage (SELV) (Europe), Class 2 (North America), 50/60 Hz, 10 VA minimum

Note: A System 450 control module or module assembly can use an internal or an external supply power source, but must not be connected to both simultaneously.

Ambient Operating Conditions Temperature: -40 to 66C (-40 to 150F) when using 0 to 10 VDC outputs;

-40 to 40C (-40 to 104F) when using 4 to 20 mA outputs

Humidity: Up to 95% RH noncondensing; maximum dew point 29C (85F)

Ambient Shipping and Storage Conditions Temperature: -40 to 80C (-40 to 176F)

Humidity: Up to 95% RH noncondensing; maximum dew point 29C (85F)

Input Signal 0 to 5 VDC for humidity sensors and static pressure transducers

0.5 to 4.5 VDC for ratiometric pressure transducers

1,035 ohms at 25C (77F) for A99 PTC temperature sensors

1,000 ohms at 21.1C (70F) for TE-6xxx Nickel temperature sensors

Analog Output Voltage Mode (0–10 VDC):

10 VDC maximum output voltage 10 mA maximum output current

Requires an external load of 1,000 ohms or more

The AO operates in Voltage Mode when connected to devices with impedance greater than 1,000 ohms. Devices that fall below 1,000 ohms may not operate as intended with Voltage Mode applications.

Current Mode (4–20 mA):

Requires an external load between 0 to 300 ohms

The AO operates in Current Mode when connected to devices with impedance less than 300 ohms. Devices that rise above 300 ohms may not operate as intended with Current Mode applications.

Analog Input Accuracy Resolution: 14 bits
Control Construction Independently mounted control, surface mounted with Lexan® 950 enclosure suitable for DIN rail mounting or direct mounting to a hard, even surface.
Dimensions (H x W x D) 127 x 61 x 61 mm (5 x 2-3/8 x 2-3/8 in.)
Weight C450CPN-3C: 195 g (0.43 lb)

C450CQN-3C: 195 g (0.43 lb)

Compliance

North America: cULus Listed; UL 60730, File E27734; FCC Compliant to CFR47, Part 15, Subpart B, Class B

Industry Canada (IC) Compliant to Canadian ICES-003, Class B limits

Europe: CE Mark – Johnson Controls, Inc. declares that this product is in compliance with the essential

requirements and other relevant provisions of the EMC Directive and the Low Voltage Directive.

Australia: Mark: C-Tick Compliant (N1813)

System 450 Control Series

Code No. LIT-1900657

System 450™ Control Modules with Relay Output

Description

System 450™ is a family of modular, digital electronic controls that is easily assembled and set up to provide reliable temperature, pressure, and humidity control for a wide variety of HVAC/R applications, commercial process applications, and industrial process applications.

The System 450 control system is designed to replace System 350™ and System 27 control systems, and to provide many additional features and benefits with fewer than twenty model variations.

System 450 control modules provide a field-configurable out-of-the-box solution. Most System 450 control modules can control temperature, pressure, and humidity systems simultaneously.

A single C450 control module can be set up as a stand-alone control or connected to expansion modules to control up to ten On/Off relay and proportional analog outputs, based on any of the three available inputs.

Refer to the following documents for important product application information:

  • System 450™ Series Modular Controls Product Bulletin (LIT-12011458)
  • System 450™ Series Modular Control Systems with Standard Control Modules Technical Bulletin (LIT-12011459)
  • System 450™ Series Control Modules with Relay Outputs Installation Instructions (Part No. 24-7664-2896)

Features

  • Durable, compact, interchangeable modular components with

plug-together connectors and DIN rail or direct wall mount capability eliminate field wiring between modules and allow you to quickly and easily design, assemble, install, and upgrade your control systems.

  • Versatile, multipurpose, field-configurable control modules and expansion modules designed for global use allow you to create a wide variety of application-specific control systems capable of controlling temperature, pressure, or humidity, or all three conditions simultaneously, with only a small suite of module models.
  • Up to three hard-wired input sensors and up to ten relay or analog outputs (in any combination) per control system allow you to build complex custom control systems while reducing your control system cost to only the cost of the required components.
  • Control Modules with bright backlit LCDs and four-button touch pad user interfaces provide quick, clear, visual status of your

System 450 control system inputs and outputs with the touch of a button and enable you to quickly and easily set up and adjust your control system.

Selection Chart

C450CCN-3C Control Module with Relay Output

  • Multipurpose, all-in-one control modules enable simple stand-alone, single-module control systems that are temperature, pressure, and humidity capable out of the box and are easy to set up in the field to replace a wide variety of OEM HVAC/R and process controls.
  • An extensive suite of compatible temperature and humidity sensors and pressure transducers allows you to monitor and control a wide range of HVAC/R and process conditions in a variety of standard and global units of measurement.
  • High input signal selection enables your control system to monitor a temperature, pressure, or humidity condition with two or three sensors (of the same type) and control your system outputs based on the highest condition value sensed by the referenced sensors.
  • Differential control enables your control system to monitor and maintain a temperature, pressure, or humidity differential between two sensor points within a system, process, or space.

Repair Information

If the System 450™ Control Module with Relay Outputs fails to operate within its specifications, replace the unit. For a replacement System 450™ Control Module with Relay Outputs, contact a Johnson Controls® representative.

Refer to the System 450 Compatible Sensors, Transducers, and Accessories Catalog Page (LIT-1900662) for temperature sensors, humidity sensors, and pressure transducers compatible with the System 450 Control Modules with Relay Outputs.

Standard System 450 Modules and Accessories Ordering Information

Product Code

Number

Product Description
C450CBN-3C Standard Control Module with LCD, Four-Button Touchpad UI, and Relay Output; provides one relay output (SPDT line-voltage relay) for

SPDT control.

C450CCN-3C Standard Control Module with LCD, Four-Button Touchpad UI, and Relay Output; provides two relay outputs (SPDT line-voltage relays) for SPDT control.
BKT287-1R DIN Rail; 0.30 m (12 in.) long
BKT287-2R DIN Rail; 1 m (39-1/3 in.) long
BKT287-3R DIN Rail; 0.61 m (24 in.) long
BKT287-4R DIN Rail; 0.36 m (14 in.) long
PLT344-1R DIN Rail End Clamps (Two clamps)
WHA-C450-100C System 450 module connection extension cable, 100 cm (3.3 ft) long

System 450 Control Series

System 450™ Control Modules with Relay Output (Continued)

Technical Specifications

C450CBN-3C and C450CCN-3C Control Modules with Relay Output
Product C450CBN-3C and C450CCN-3C: System 450 Control Module models are sensing controls and operating controls

with LCD, four-button touchpad, and SPDT relay output C450CBN-3C: Control Module with one SPDT output relay C450CCN-3C: Control Module with two SPDT output relays

Power Consumption C450CBN-3C: 0.9 VA maximum C450CCN-3C: 1.3 VA maximum
Supply Power Internal Supply Power: C450YNN-1C Power Supply Module

External Supply Power: 24 VAC (20 to 30 VAC) Safety Extra-Low Voltage (SELV) (Europe), Class 2 (North America), 50/60 Hz, 10 VA minimum

Note: A System 450 control module or module assembly can use an internal or an external supply power source, but must not be connected to both simultaneously.

Ambient Operating Conditions Temperature: -40 to 66C (-40 to 150F)

Humidity: Up to 95% RH noncondensing; maximum dew point 29C (85F)

Ambient Shipping and Storage Conditions Temperature: -40 to 80C (-40 to 176F)

Humidity: Up to 95% RH noncondensing; maximum dew point 29C (85F)

Input Signal 0 to 5 VDC for humidity sensors and static pressure transducers

0.5 to 4.5 VDC for ratiometric pressure transducers

1,035 ohms at 25C (77F) for A99 PTC temperature sensors

1,000 ohms at 21.1C (70F) for TE-6xxx Nickel temperature sensors

Output Relay Contacts General: 1/2 HP at 120/240 VAC, SPDT
Specific: AC Motor Ratings 120 VAC 208/240 VAC AC Full-load Amperes: 9.8 A 4.9 A Locked-Rotor Amperes: 58.8 A 29.4 A

10 Amperes AC Non-inductive at 24/240 VAC Pilot Duty: 125 VA at 24/240 VAC

Analog Input Accuracy Resolution: 14 bits
Control Construction Independently mounted control, surface mounted with Lexan® 950 enclosure suitable for DIN rail mounting or direct mounting to a hard, even surface.
Dimensions (H x W x D) 127 x 61 x 61 mm (5 x 2-3/8 x 2-3/8 in.)
Weight C450CBN-3C: 209 g (0.46 lb)

C450CCN-3C: 222 g (0.49 lb)

Compliance

North America: cULus Listed; UL 60730, File E27734; FCC Compliant to CFR47, Part 15, Subpart B, Class B;

Industry Canada (IC) Compliant to Canadian ICES-003, Class B limits

Europe: CE Mark – Johnson Controls, Inc. declares that this product is in compliance with the essential

requirements and other relevant provisions of the EMC Directive and the Low Voltage Directive.

Australia: Mark: C-Tick Compliant (N1813)

System 450 Control Series

Code No. LIT-1900806

System 450™ Control Module with Hybrid Analog Output

Description

System 450™ is a family of modular, digital electronic controls that is easily assembled and set up to provide reliable temperature, pressure, and humidity control for a wide variety of HVAC/R applications, commercial process applications, and industrial process applications.

System 450 control modules provide a field-configurable out-of-the-box solution. Most System 450 control modules can control temperature, pressure, and humidity systems simultaneously.

A single C450 control module can be set up as a stand-alone control or connected to expansion modules to control up to ten On/Off relay and proportional analog outputs, based on any of the three available inputs.

The System 450 Control Module with Hybrid Analog Output has a single self-selecting analog output to optimize and extend the controlled speed range of variable speed electronically commutated (EC) motors.

Refer to the following documents for important product application information:

  • System 450™ Series Modular Controls Product Bulletin (LIT-12011458)
  • System 450™ Series Modular Control Systems with Standard Control Modules Technical Bulletin (LIT-12011459)
  • System 450™ Series Control Module with Hybrid Analog Output and High Input Signal Selection Installation Instructions

(Part No. 24-7664-2802)

Features

  • Durable, compact, interchangeable modular components with

plug-together connectors and DIN rail or direct wall mount capability eliminate field wiring between modules and allow you to quickly and easily design, assemble, install, and upgrade your control systems.

  • Versatile, multipurpose, field-configurable control modules and expansion modules designed for global use allow you to create a wide variety of application-specific control systems capable of controlling temperature, pressure, or humidity, or all three conditions simultaneously, with only a small suite of module models.
  • Up to three hard-wired input sensors and up to ten relay or analog outputs (in any combination) per control system allow you to build complex custom control systems while reducing your control system cost to only the cost of the required components.
  • Control Modules with bright backlit LCDs and four-button touch pad user interfaces provide quick, clear, visual status of your

System 450 control system inputs and outputs with the touch of a button and enable you to quickly and easily set up and adjust your control system.

  • Multipurpose, all-in-one control modules enable simple stand-alone, single-module control systems that are temperature, pressure, and humidity capable out of the box and easy to set up in the field to replace a wide variety of OEM HVAC/R and process controls.

C450CPW-100 Control Module with Hybrid Analog Output

  • An extensive suite of compatible temperature and humidity sensors, and pressure transducers allows you to monitor and control a wide range of HVAC/R and process conditions in a variety of standard and global units of measurement.
  • High input signal selection enables your control system to monitor a temperature, pressure, or humidity condition with two or three sensors (of the same type) and control your system outputs based on the highest condition value sensed by the referenced sensors.
  • Differential control enables your control system to monitor and maintain a temperature, pressure, or humidity differential between two sensor points within a system, process, or space.

Repair Information

If the System 450™ Control Module with Hybrid Analog Output fails to operate within its specifications, replace the unit. For a replacement System 450™ Control Module with Hybrid Analog Output, contact a Johnson Controls® representative.

System 450 Control Series

System 450™ Control Module with Hybrid Analog Output (Continued)

Selection Chart

Refer to the System 450 Compatible Sensors, Transducers, and Accessories Catalog Page (LIT-1900662) for temperature sensors, humidity sensors, and pressure transducers compatible with the System 450 Control Modules.

Hybrid System 450 Modules and Accessories Ordering Information

Product Code

Number

Product Description
C450CPW-100C Hybrid Analog Output Control Module with LCD, Four-Button Touchpad UI, Hybrid Analog Output and Optional High Input Signal Select;

provides one hybrid analog output and optional high input signal select primarily used for variable-speed EC motor speed control. Only Analog Output 1 (OUTA1) can be configured as a hybrid analog output and/or use the High Input Signal Selection feature. These features are not available for any of the other outputs in a System 450 control system that uses the C450CPW-100C as the control module.

BKT287-1R DIN Rail; 0.30 m (12 in.) long
BKT287-2R DIN Rail; 1 m (39-1/3 in.) long
BKT287-3R DIN Rail; 0.61 m (24 in.) long
BKT287-4R DIN Rail; 0.36 m (14 in.) long
PLT344-1R DIN Rail End Clamps (Two clamps)
WHA-C450-100C System 450 module connection extension cable, 100 cm (3.3 ft) long

Technical Specifications

C450CPW-100C Control Module with Hybrid Analog Output
Product C450CPW-100C System 450 control module is a sensing control and operating control with LCD, four-button

touchpad, and analog output with pulse-width modulation capability.

Power Consumption C450CPW-100C: 1.3 VA maximum using 0 to 10 V out; 1.5 VA maximum using 4 to 20 mA out
Supply Power Internal Supply Power: C450YNN-1C Power Supply Module

External Supply Power: 24 VAC (20–30 VAC) Safety Extra-Low Voltage (SELV) (Europe), Class 2 (North America), 50/ 60 Hz, 10 VA minimum

Note: A System 450 control module or module assembly can use an internal or an external supply power source, but must not be connected to both simultaneously.

Ambient Operating Conditions Temperature: -40 to 66C (-40 to 150F) when using 0 to 10 VDC outputs;

-40 to 40C (-40 to 104F) when using 4 to 20 mA outputs

Humidity: Up to 95% RH noncondensing; maximum dew point 29C (85F)

Ambient Shipping and Storage Conditions Temperature: -40 to 80C (-40 to 176F)

Humidity: Up to 95% RH noncondensing; maximum dew point 29C (85F)

Input Signal 0 to 5 VDC for humidity sensors and static pressure transducers

0.5 to 4.5 VDC for ratiometric pressure transducers

1,035 ohms at 25C (77F) for A99 PTC temperature sensors

1,000 ohms at 21.1C (70F) for TE-6xxx Nickel temperature sensors

Analog Output Voltage Mode (0–10 VDC):

10 VDC maximum output voltage 10 mA maximum output current

Requires an external load of 1,000 ohms or more

The AO operates in Voltage Mode when connected to devices with impedance greater than 1,000 ohms. Devices that fall below 1,000 ohms may not operate as intended with Voltage Mode applications.

Current Mode (4–20 mA):

Requires an external load between 0 to 300 ohms

The AO operates in Current Mode when connected to devices with impedance less than 300 ohms. Devices that rise above 300 ohms may not operate as intended with Current Mode applications.

Analog Input Accuracy Resolution: 14 bits
Control Construction Independently mounted control, surface mounted with Lexan® 950 enclosure suitable for DIN rail mounting or direct mounting to a hard, even surface.
Dimensions (H x W x D) 127 x 61 x 61 mm (5 x 2-3/8 x 2-3/8 in.)
Weight C450CPW-100C: 195 g (0.43 lb)
Compliance

North America: cULus Listed; UL 60730, File E27734; FCC Compliant to CFR47, Part 15, Subpart B, Class B

Industry Canada (IC) Compliant to Canadian ICES-003, Class B limits

Europe: CE Mark – Johnson Controls, Inc. declares that this product is in compliance with the essential requirements

and other relevant provisions of the EMC Directive and the Low Voltage Directive.

Australia: Mark: C-Tick Compliant (N1813)

System 450 Control Series

Code No. LIT-1900659

System 450™ Expansion Modules with Analog Output

Description

System 450 expansion modules allow you to increase the number of outputs in your control system to meet your application requirements. The following models are available:

  • C450SPN-1C: Analog Expansion Module with one analog output (each 0 to 10 VDC or 4 to 20 mA)
  • C450SQN-1C: Analog Expansion Module with two analog outputs (each 0 to 10 VDC or 4 to 20 mA)

Refer to the following documents for important product application information:

  • System 450™ Series Modular Controls Product Bulletin (LIT-12011458)
  • System 450™ Series Expansion Modules with Analog Outputs Installation Instructions (Part No. 24-7664-2799)

Features

  • Durable, compact, interchangeable modular components with

plug-together connectors and DIN rail or direct wall mount capability eliminate field wiring between modules and allow you to quickly and easily design, assemble, install, and upgrade your control systems.

  • Versatile, multipurpose, field-configurable control modules and expansion modules designed for global use allow you to create a wide variety of application-specific control systems capable of controlling temperature, pressure, or humidity, or all three conditions simultaneously, with only a small suite of module models.
  • Up to three hard-wired input sensors and up to ten relay or analog outputs (in any combination) per control system allow you to build complex custom control systems while reducing your control system cost to only the cost of the required components.

Selection Chart

C450SQN-1C Expansion Module with Analog Output

Repair Information

If the System 450™ Expansion Module with Analog Output fails to operate within its specifications, replace the unit. For a replacement System 450™ Expansion Module with Analog Output, contact a Johnson Controls® representative.

Product Code

Number

Product Description
C450SPN-1C Analog Output Expansion Module; provides one analog output (0 to 10 VDC or 4 to 20 mA self-selecting signal) for proportional control.
C450SQN-1C Analog Output Expansion Module; provides two analog outputs (0 to 10 VDC or 4 to 20 mA self-selecting signals) for proportional control.
BKT287-1R DIN Rail; 0.30 m (12 in.) long
BKT287-2R DIN Rail; 1 m (39-1/3 in.) long
BKT287-3R DIN Rail; 0.61 m (24 in.) long
BKT287-4R DIN Rail; 0.36 m (14 in.) long
PLT344-1R DIN Rail End Clamps (Two clamps)
WHA-C450-100C System 450 module connection extension cable, 100 cm (3.3 ft) long

System 450 Control Series

System 450™ Expansion Modules with Analog Output (Continued)

Technical Specifications

C450SPN-1C and C450SQN-1C Expansion Modules with Analog Output
Product C450SPN-1C: System 450 Expansion Module with one analog output

C450SQN-1C: System 450 Expansion Module with two analog outputs

Power Consumption C450SPN-1C: 1.1 VA maximum using 0 to 10 V out; 1.3 VA maximum using 4 to 20 mA out

C450SQN-1C: 1.8 VA maximum using 0 to 10 V out; 2.2 VA maximum using 4 to 20 mA out

Supply Power Internal Supply Power: C450YNN-1C Power Supply Module

External Supply Power: 24 VAC (20 to 30 VAC) Safety Extra-Low Voltage (SELV) (Europe), Class 2 (North America), 50/60 Hz, 10 VA minimum

Note: A System 450 control module or module assembly can use an internal or an external supply power source, but must not be connected to both simultaneously.

Ambient Operating Conditions Temperature: -40 to 66C (-40 to 150F) when using 0 to 10 VDC outputs;

-40 to 40C (-40 to 104F) when using 4 to 20 mA outputs

Humidity: Up to 95% RH noncondensing; maximum dew point 29C (85F)

Ambient Shipping and Storage Conditions Temperature: -40 to 80C (-40 to 176F)

Humidity: Up to 95% RH noncondensing; maximum dew point 29C (85F)

Analog Output Voltage Mode (0 to 10 VDC):

10 VDC maximum output voltage 10 mA maximum output current

Requires an external load of 1,000 ohms or more

The AO operates in Voltage Mode when connected to devices with impedance greater than 1,000 ohms. Devices that drop below 1,000 ohms may not operate as intended with Voltage Mode applications.

Current Mode (4 to 20 mA):

Requires an external load between 0 to 300 ohms

The AO operates in Current Mode when connected to devices with impedances less than 300 ohm. Devices that exceed 300 ohms may not operate as intended with Current Mode applications.

Control Construction Independently mounted control, surface mounted with Lexan® 950 enclosure suitable for DIN rail mounting or direct mounting to a hard, even surface.
Dimensions (H x W x D) 127 x 61 x 61 mm (5 x 2-3/8 x 2-3/8 in.)
Weight C450SPN-1C: 150 g (0.33 lb)

C450SQN-1C: 150 g (0.33 lb)

Compliance

North America: cULus Listed; UL 60730, File E27734, Vol. 1; FCC Compliant to CFR47, Part 15, Subpart B, Class B Industry Canada (IC) Compliant to Canadian ICES-003, Class B limits
Europe: CE Mark – Johnson Controls, Inc., declares that this product is in compliance with the essential requirements

and other relevant provisions of the Low Voltage Directive and the EMC Directive.

Australia: Mark: C-Tick Compliant (N1813)

System 450 Control Series

Code No. LIT-1900660

System 450™ Expansion Modules with Relay Output

Description

System 450 expansion modules allow you to increase the number of outputs in your control system to meet your application requirements. The following models are available:

  • C450SBN-3C: Relay Expansion Module with one relay output
  • C450SCN-3C: Relay Expansion Module with two relay outputs

Refer to the following documents for important product application information:

  • System 450™ Series Modular Controls Product Bulletin (LIT-12011458)
  • System 450™ Series Expansion Modules with Relay Outputs Installation Instructions (Part No. 24-7664-2896)

Features

  • Durable, compact, interchangeable modular components with

plug-together connectors and DIN rail or direct wall mount capability eliminate field wiring between modules and allow you to quickly and easily design, assemble, install, and upgrade your control systems.

  • Versatile, multipurpose, field-configurable control modules and expansion modules designed for global use allow you to create a wide variety of application-specific control systems capable of controlling temperature, pressure, or humidity, or all three conditions simultaneously, with only a small suite of module models.
  • Up to three hard-wired input sensors and up to ten relay or analog outputs (in any combination) per control system allow you to build complex custom control systems while reducing your control system cost to only the cost of the required components.

Selection Chart

C450SCN-3C Expansion Module with Relay Output

Repair Information

If the System 450™ Expansion Module with Relay Output fails to operate within its specifications, replace the unit. For a replacement System 450™ Expansion Module with Relay Output, contact a Johnson Controls® representative.

Product Code

Number

Product Description
C450SBN-3C Reset Control Module with LCD, Four-Button Touchpad UI, and SPDT relay output; provides one SPDT output relay. One A99BC-25C

temperature sensor with 0.25 m (9-1/4 in.) silicon leads and one A99BC-300C temperature sensor with 3 m (9 ft 10 in.) silicon leads are included in the box with the Reset Control Module.

C450SCN-3C Reset Control Module with LCD, Four-Button Touchpad UI, and SPDT relay output; provides two SPDT output relays. One A99BC-25C temperature sensor with 0.25 m (9-1/4 in.) silicon leads and one A99BC-300C temperature sensor with 3 m (9 ft 10 in.) silicon leads are included in the box with the Reset Control Module.
BKT287-1R DIN Rail; 0.30 m (12 in.) long
BKT287-2R DIN Rail; 1 m (39-1/3 in.) long
BKT287-3R DIN Rail; 0.61 m (24 in.) long
BKT287-4R DIN Rail; 0.36 m (14 in.) long
PLT344-1R DIN Rail End Clamps (Two clamps)
WHA-C450-100C System 450 module connection extension cable, 100 cm (3.3 ft) long

System 450 Control Series

System 450™ Expansion Modules with Relay Output (Continued)

Technical Specifications

C450SBN-3C and C450SCN-3C Expansion Modules with Relay Output
Product C450SBN-3C: System 450 Expansion Module with one SPDT output relay

C450SCN-3C: System 450 Expansion Module with two SPDT output relays

Power Consumption C450SBN-3C: 0.8 VA maximum C450SCN-3C: 1.2 VA maximum
Supply Power Internal Supply Power: C450YNN-1C Power Supply Module

External Supply Power: 24 VAC (20 to 30 VAC) Safety Extra-Low Voltage (SELV) (Europe), Class 2 (North America), 50/60 Hz, 10 VA minimum

Note: A System 450 control module or module assembly can use an internal or an external supply power source, but must not be connected to both simultaneously.

Ambient Operating Conditions Temperature: -40 to 66C (-40 to 150F)

Humidity: Up to 95% RH noncondensing; maximum dew point 29C (85F)

Ambient Shipping and Storage Conditions Temperature: -40 to 80C (-40 to 176F)

Humidity: Up to 95% RH noncondensing; maximum dew point 29C (85F)

Output Relay Contacts General: 1/2 HP at 120/240 VAC, SPDT
Specific: AC Motor Ratings 120 VAC 208/240 VAC AC Full-Load Amperes: 9.8 A 4.9 A

AC Locked-Rotor Amperes: 58.8 A 29.4 A

10 Amperes AC Noninductive at 24/240 VAC Pilot Duty: 125 VA at 24/240 VAC

Control Construction Independently mounted control, surface mounted with Lexan® 950 enclosure suitable for DIN rail mounting or direct mounting to a hard, even surface.
Dimensions (H x W x D) 127 x 61 x 61 mm (5 x 2-3/8 x 2-3/8 in.)
Weight C450SBN-3C: 172 g (0.38 lb)

C450SCN-3C: 186 g (0.41 lb)

Compliance

North America: cULus Listed; UL 60730, File E27734; FCC Compliant to CFR47, Part 15, Subpart B, Class B

Industry Canada (IC) Compliant to Canadian ICES-003, Class B limits

Europe: CE Mark – Johnson Controls, Inc. declares that this product is in compliance with the essential requirements and

other relevant provisions of the EMC Directive and the Low Voltage Directive.

Australia: Mark: C-Tick Compliant (N1813)

Description

System 450 Control Series

Code No. LIT-1900661

System 450™ Power Module

System 450modules require 24 VAC, Class 2 power. In applications where 24 VAC power is not available, the C450YNN-1C Power Module provides a convenient modular solution for transforming 120/240 VAC to 24 VAC power for your System 450 control systems.

Refer to the following documents for important product application information:

  • System 450™ Series Modular Controls Product Bulletin (LIT-12011458)
  • System 450™ Series Power Module Installation Instructions (Part No. 24-7664-2691)

Features

  • Durable, compact, interchangeable modular components with

plug-together connectors and DIN rail or direct wall mount capability eliminate field wiring between modules and allow you to quickly and easily design, assemble, install, and upgrade your control systems.

Repair Information

If the System 450 Power Module fails to operate within its specifications, replace the unit. For a replacement System 450 Power Module, contact a Johnson Controls® representative.

Selection Chart

C450YNN-1C Power Module

Product Code

Number

Product Description
C450YNN-1C Power Module; provides 24 V to System 450 Module Assembly; 120 VAC or 240 VAC supply power input terminals.
BKT287-1R DIN Rail; 0.30 m (12 in.) long
BKT287-2R DIN Rail; 1 m (39-1/3 in.) long
BKT287-3R DIN Rail; 0.61 m (24 in.) long
BKT287-4R DIN Rail; 0.36 m (14 in.) long
PLT344-1R DIN Rail End Clamps (Two clamps)
WHA-C450-100C System 450 module connection extension cable, 100 cm (3.3 ft) long

Technical Specifications

C450YNN-1C Power Supply Module
Product C450YNN-1C: System 450 Power Supply Module; 120 or 240 VAC stepdown to 24 VAC Class 2 (North America) or

SELV (Europe)

Supply Power 110/120 VAC or 220/240 VAC at 50/60 Hz (100 mA maximum)
Secondary Power 24 VAC, 10 VA
Ambient Operating Conditions Temperature: -40 to 66C (-40 to 150F)

Humidity: Up to 95% RH noncondensing; maximum dew point 29C (85F)

Ambient Shipping and Storage Conditions Temperature: -40 to 80C (-40 to 176F)

Humidity: Up to 95% RH noncondensing; maximum dew point 29C (85F)

Control Construction Independently mounted control, surface mounted with Lexan® 950 enclosure suitable for DIN rail mounting or direct mounting to a hard, even surface.
Dimensions (H x W x D) 127 x 61 x 61 mm (5 x 2-3/8 x 2-3/8 in.)
Weight C450YNN-1C: 390 gm (0.86 lb)
Compliance

North America: cULus Listed; UL 60730, File E27734: FCC Compliant to CFR47, Part 15, Subpart B, Class B

Industry Canada (IC) Compliant to Canadian ICES-003, Class B limits

Europe: CE Mark – Johnson Controls, Inc. declares that this product is in compliance with the essential requirements

and other relevant provisions of the EMC Directive and the Low Voltage Directive.

Australia: Mark: C-Tick Compliant (N1813)

System 450 Control Series

Code No. LIT-1900662

System 450™ Compatible Sensors, Transducers, and Accessories

Description

System 450 control modules are designed to operate with a variety of compatible sensors and transducers. The System 450 compatible sensors and transducers cover a wide range of temperature, pressure, and humidity conditions, allowing you to select the sensor or transducer that best fits your control system requirements.

For ease of installation and setup, the Sensor Type that you select in the UI for a sensor or transducer automatically determines the sensed condition, unit of measurement, minimum differential, setup value ranges, and the default setup values for each control system output that references the sensor or transducer.

Refer to the System 450™ Series Modular Controls Product Bulletin (LIT-12011458) for important product application information on System 450 Controls.

Refer to the following documents for important product application information on sensors used with System 450 Controls:

  • A99B Series Temperature Sensors Product Technical Bulletin (LIT-125186)
  • TrueRH™ Series HE-67xx Humidity Element with Temperature Sensors Product Bulletin (LIT-216245)
  • HE-6800 Series Humidity Transmitters with Temperature Sensor Product Bulletin (LIT-12011625)
  • P499 Series Electronic Pressure Transducers Product/Technical Bulletin (LIT-12011190)
  • TE-6000 Series Temperature Sensing Elements Product Bulletin (LIT-216288)
  • TE-6300 Series Temperature Sensors Product Bulletin (LIT-216320)
  • TE-6800 Series Temperature Sensors Product Bulletin (LIT-12011542)
  • Setra Systems Model DPT265 Very Low Differential Pressure Transducer Catalog Page

Duct-Mount HE67S3 Humidity Sensor

Wall-Mount HE67S3 Humidity Sensor

DPT265 Series Low Pressure Differential Pressure Transducers

A99 Temperature Sensors

TE-6300 Series Temperature Sensors

TE-6000-1 Temperature Sensing Element

System 450 Control Series

System 450™ Compatible Sensors, Transducers, and Accessories (Continued)

TE-6800 Series Wall Mount Temperature Sensors and HE-6800 Series Humidity Transmitters

with Temperature Sensors

Selection Charts

P499 Series Electronic Pressure Transducers

Use these tables to order System 450 compatible sensors, transducers, and accessories.

System 450 Compatible A99B Temperature Sensors and Accessories Ordering Information1

Product Code Number Product Description
A99BA-200C PTC Silicon Sensor with Shielded Cable; Cable Length 2 m (6-1/2 ft); Sensor Temperature Range: -40 to 120°C (-40 to 250°F)

Cable Jacket Temperature Range: -40 to 100°C (-40 to 212°F)

A99BB-25C PTC Silicon Sensor with PVC Cable; Cable Length 0.25 m (9-3/4 in.); Sensor Temperature Range: -40 to 120°C (-40 to 250°F) Cable Jacket Temperature Range: -40 to 100°C (-40 to 212°F)
A99BB-200C PTC Silicon Sensor with PVC Cable; Cable Length 2 m (6-1/2 ft); Sensor Temperature Range: -40 to 120°C (-40 to 250°F) Cable Jacket Temperature Range: -40 to 100°C (-40 to 212°F)
A99BB-300C PTC Silicon Sensor with PVC Cable; Cable Length 3 m (9-3/4 ft); Sensor Temperature Range: -40 to 120°C (-40 to 250°F) Cable Jacket Temperature Range: -40 to 100°C (-40 to 212°F)
A99BB-500C PTC Silicon Sensor with PVC Cable; Cable Length 5 m (16-3/8 ft); Sensor Temperature Range: -40 to 120°C (-40 to 250°F) Cable Jacket Temperature Range: -40 to 100°C (-40 to 212°F)
A99BB-600C PTC Silicon Sensor with PVC Cable; Cable Length 6 m (19-1/2 ft); Sensor Temperature Range: -40 to 120°C (-40 to 250°F) Cable Jacket Temperature Range: -40 to 100°C (-40 to 212°F)
A99BC-25C PTC Silicon Sensor with High Temperature Silicon Cable; Cable Length 0.25 m (9-3/4 in.); Sensor Temperature Range: -40 to 120°C (-40 to 250°F)

Cable Jacket Rated for Full Sensor Temperature Range.

A99BC-300C PTC Silicon Sensor with High Temperature Silicon Cable; Cable Length 3 m (9-3/4 ft) Sensor Temperature Range: -40 to 120°C (-40 to 250°F)

Cable Jacket Rated for Full Sensor Temperature Range.

A99BC-1500C PTC Silicon Sensor with High Temperature Silicon Cable; Cable Length 15 m (49 ft) Sensor Temperature Range: -40 to 120°C (-40 to 250°F)

Cable Jacket Rated for Full Sensor Temperature Range.

BOX10A-600R PVC Enclosure for A99 Sensor; Includes Wire Nuts and Conduit Connector (for Outdoor Sensor)
WEL11A-601R Immersion Well for A99 Sensor Liquid Sensing Applications
A99-CLP-1 Mounting Clip for A99 Temperature Sensor
ADP11A-600R Conduit Adaptor, 1/2 in. Snap-Fit EMT Conduit Adaptor (box of 10)
TE-6001-1 Duct Mounting Hardware with Handy Box for A99 Sensor
TE-6001-11 Duct Mounting Hardware without Handy Box for A99 Sensor
SHL10A-603R Sun Shield (for Use with Outside A99 Sensors in Sunny Locations)

1. Refer to the A99B Series Temperature Sensors Product/Technical Bulletin (LIT-125186) on the Johnson Controls® Product Literature website for more information.

System 450 Compatible TE-6000 Series 1,000 Ohm Nickel Temperature Sensors and Accessories Ordering Information

Product Code Number Product Description
TE-6000-x TE6000 Series 1,000 ohm at 70F nickel temperature sensors (only). Only the TE-6000-6 sensor can be used for the entire HIC

and HIF temperature range. Different sensing element packages are available for various applications.For a complete list of compatible 1,000 ohm nickel sensors, including sensor descriptions, technical specifications, and mounting accessories, refer to the TE-6000 Series Temperature Sensing Elements Product Bulletin (LIT-216288). (System 450 Sensor Types HIC and HIF)

System 450 Compatible TE-6300 Series 1,000 Ohm Nickel Temperature Sensors and Accessories Ordering Information

Product Code Number Product Description
TE-631xx-x TE6300 Series 1,000 ohm at 70F nickel averaging and 1,000 ohm thin-film nickel temperature sensors (only). For a complete list

of compatible 1,000 ohm nickel averaging and thin-film nickel sensors, including sensor descriptions, technical specifications, and mounting accessories, refer to the TE-6300 Series Temperature Sensors Product Bulletin (LIT-216320). (System 450 Sensor Types HIC and HIF)

System 450 Control Series

System 450™ Compatible Sensors, Transducers, and Accessories (Continued)

System 450 Compatible TE-68NT-0N00S 1,000 Ohm Nickel Temperature Sensor Ordering Information

Product Code Number Product Description
TE-68NT-0N00S TE6800 Series 1,000 ohm nickel temperature sensor for wall-mount applications. For more information, including sensor

description, technical specifications, and mounting accessories, refer to the TE-6800 Series Temperature Sensors Product Bulletin (LIT-12011542). (System 450 Sensor Types HIC and HIF)

System 450 Compatible HE67S3 Type Humidity Sensors with Integral A99B Temperature Sensor Ordering Information1

Product Code Number Product Description
HE-67S3-0N0BT Wall Mount Humidity Sensor with A99B Type Temperature Sensor: 10 to 90% RH; 0 to 60C (32 to 140F)
HE-67S3-0N00P Duct Mount Humidity Sensor with A99B Type Temperature Sensor: 10 to 90% RH; 0 to 60C (32 to 140F)

1. The HE-67S3 sensors require 24 VAC input and must use the 0 to 5 VDC output. Refer to the TrueRH Series HE-67xx Humidity Element with Temperature Sensors Product Bulletin (LIT-216245) on the Johnson Controls Product Literature website for more information, including technical specifications and mounting accessories.

System 450 Compatible HE6800 Series Humidity Transmitters with Temperature Sensor Ordering Information1

Product Code Number Product Description
HE-68N2-0N00WS Wall Mount Humidity Transmitter with Nickel Temperature Sensor: 10 to 90 ±2% RH; 0 to 55C (32 to 131F)
HE-68N3-0N00WS Wall Mount Humidity Transmitter with Nickel Temperature Sensor: 10 to 90 ±3% RH; 0 to 55C (32 to 131F)

1. The HE-6800 transmitters require 24 VAC input and must use the 0 to 5 VDC output. Refer to the HE-6800 Series Humidity Transmitters with Temperature Sensor Product Bulletin (LIT-12011625) on the Johnson Controls Product Literature website for more information, including technical specifications and mounting accessories.

System 450 Compatible Low Pressure Differential Transducer Ordering Information1 2

Product Code Number Product Description
DPT2650-R25B-AB Low Pressure Differential Transducer: -0.25 to 0.25 in. W.C. (System 450 Sensor Type: P 0.25)3
DPT2650-0R5D-AB Low Pressure Differential Transducer: 0 to 0.5 in. W.C. (System 450 Sensor Type: P 0.5)
DPT2650-2R5D-AB Low Pressure Differential Transducer: 0 to 2.5 in. W.C. (System 450 Sensor Type: P 2.5)
DPT2650-005D-AB Low Pressure Differential Transducer: 0 to 5.0 in. W.C. (System 450 Sensor Type: P 5)
DPT2650-10D-AB Low Pressure Differential Transducer: 0 to 10 in. W.C. (System 450 Sensor Type: P 10)
  1. Refer to the Setra Systems Model DPT265 Very Low Differential Pressure Transducer Catalog Page on the Johnson Controls Product Literature website for more information.
  2. The DPT265 sensors require 24 VAC input and must use the 0 to 5 VDC output. Refer to the Setra Systems Model DPT265 Very Low Differential Pressure Transducer Catalog Page on the Johnson Controls Product Literature website for more information.
  3. Used only with Communications Control Modules.

System 450 Compatible P499 Series Transducers with 1/4 in. SAE 45 Flare Internal Thread with Depressor (Style 47) Ordering Information1

Product Code Number Product Description
P499RCP-401C -1 to 8 bar; order WHA-PKD3 type wire harness separately
P499RCP-402C -1 to 15 bar; order WH A-PKD3 type wire harness separately
P499RCP-404C 0 to 30 bar; order WHA-PKD3 type wire harness separately
P499RCP-405C 0 to 50 bar; order WHA-PKD3 type wire harness separately
P499RCPS100C -10 to 100 psis (sealed for wet and freeze/thaw applications); order WHA-PKD3 type wire harness separately
P499RCPS100K -10 to 100 psis (sealed for wet and freeze/thaw applications); WHA-PKD3-200C wire harness included
P499RCPS102C 0 to 200 psis (sealed for wet and freeze/thaw applications); order WHA-PKD3 type wire harness separately
P499RCPS102K 0 to 200 psis (sealed for wet and freeze/thaw applications); WHA-PKD3-200C wire harness included
P499RCP-101C 0 to 100 psi; order WHA-PKD3 type wire harness separately
P499RCP-101K 0 to 100 psi; WHA-PKD3-200C wire harness included
P499RCP-105C 0 to 500 psi; order WHA-PKD3 type wire harness separately
P499RCP-105K 0 to 500 psi; WHA-PKD3-200C wire harness included
P499RCP-107C 0 to 750 psi; order WHA-PKD3 type wire harness separately
P499RCP-107K 0 to 750 psi; WHA-PKD3-200C wire harness included

1. The P499 sensors must be powered with the +5 VDC and C terminals and the output is 0.5 to 4.5 VDC. Refer to the P499 Series Electronic Pressure Transducers Product/Technical Bulletin (LIT-12011190) on the Johnson Controls Product Literature website for more information.

System 450 Control Series

System 450™ Compatible Sensors, Transducers, and Accessories (Continued)

System 450 Compatible P499 Series Transducers with 1/8 in. 27 NPT External Thread (Style 49) Ordering Information1

Product Code Number Product Description
P499RAPS100C -10 to 100 psis (sealed for wet and freeze/thaw applications); order WHA-PKD3 type wire harness separately
P499RAPS100K -10 to 100 psis (sealed for wet and freeze/thaw applications); WHA-PKD3-200C wire harness included
P499RAPS102C 0 to 200 psis (sealed for wet and freeze/thaw applications); order WHA-PKD3 type wire harness separately
P499RAPS102K 0 to 200 psis (sealed for wet and freeze/thaw applications); WHA-PKD3-200C wire harness included
P499RAP-101C 0 to 100 psig; order WHA-PKD3 type wire harness separately
P499RAP-101K 0 to 100 psig; WHA-PKD3-200C wire harness included
P499RAP-102C 0 to 200 psig; order WHA-PKD3 type wire harness separately
P499RAP-105C 0 to 500 psig; order WHA-PKD3 type wire harness separately
P499RAP-105K 0 to 500 psig; WHA-PKD3-200C wire harness included
P499RAP-107C 0 to 750 psig; order WHA-PKD3 type wire harness separately
P499RAP-107K 0 to 750 psig; WHA-PKD3-200C wire harness included

1. The P499 sensors must be powered with the +5 VDC and C terminals and the output is 0.5 to 4.5 VDC. Refer to the P499 Series Electronic Pressure Transducers Product/Technical Bulletin (LIT-12011190) on the Johnson Controls Product Literature website for more information.

WHA-PKD3 Wire Harnesses Ordering Information1

Product Code Number Product Description
WHA-PKD3-200C Plug and Three-Wire Harness for P499 Electronic Pressure Transducers: 2.0 m (6-1/2 ft) cable
WHA-PKD3-400C Plug and Three-Wire Harness for P499 Electronic Pressure Transducers: 4.0 m (13 ft) cable
WHA-PKD3-600C Plug and Three-Wire Harness for P499 Electronic Pressure Transducers: 6.0 m (19-5/8 ft) cable

1. Refer to the P499 Series Electronic Pressure Transducers Product/Technical Bulletin (LIT-12011190) on the Johnson Controls Product Literature website for more information.

Cross-Reference Code No. LIT-1900120

Ranco® Refrigeration Cross-Reference

Temperature Controls (Part 1 of 2)

Product # Range Differential Switch Capillary Bulb Cover Notes
Ranco ETC111000-000 -30/220F 1/30F ADJ SPDT 96” Lead 0.5×2 NEMA 1
PENN A419ABC-1C -30/212F 1/30F ADJ SPDT 78” Lead 0.5X2 NEMA 1 (14)
Ranco 3130-101 35/45F 12F FXD Open LO None 240” NEMA 1
PENN A11B-1C 35/45F 12F FXD Open LO 48” 240″ NEMA 1
Ranco 3130-201 35/45F Manual Open LO None 240” NEMA 1
PENN A11A-1C 35/45F Manual Open LO 48” 240″ NEMA 1
Ranco 3311-651 37F FXD Manual Open LO 180″ 0.5×4.25 NEMA 1
PENN A70BA-17C 35/80F ADJ Manual Open LO 72″ 3/8×3 NEMA 1
Ranco 3311-701 30F FXD 15F FXD Open LO 120″ 3/8×6.5 NEMA 1
PENN A70AA-15C -10/65F ADJ 4/40F ADJ Open LO 72″ 3/8×3 NEMA 1
Ranco A22-2237 41F FXD 6F FXD Open HI None 48″ NEMA 1
PENN A11E-6C 35/45F 12F FXD SPDT 48″ 240″ NEMA 1
Ranco O10-1010 0/55F 7/55F ADJ Open LO None 48″ NEMA 1
PENN A11B-1C 35/45F 12F FXD Open LO 48″ 240″ NEMA 1
Ranco O10-1409 0/55F 3/20F ADJ Open LO 72″ Yes NEMA 1
PENN A19ABA-1C -30/50F 5/20F ADJ Open LO 72″ 3/8×4 NEMA 1 (1)
Ranco O10-1410 25/75F 3/20F ADJ Open LO 72″ Yes NEMA 1
PENN A19ABA-4C 20/80F 3.5/14F ADJ Open LO 72″ 3/8×5 NEMA 1 (1)
Ranco O10-1416 0/55F 3/20F ADJ Open LO None 72″ NEMA 1
PENN A11B-1C 35/45F 12F FXD Open LO 48″ 240″ NEMA 1
Ranco

PENN

O10-1418

A19BBA-1C

0/55F

-30/50F

3/20F ADJ

5/20F ADJ

Open LO

Open LO

None

None

Coiled

Coiled

NEMA 1

NEMA 1

(1)
Ranco O10-1473 0/55F 7/55F ADJ Open LO 72″ Yes NEMA 1
PENN A19ABA-1C -30/50F 5/20F ADJ Open LO 72″ 3/8×4 NEMA 1 (1)
Ranco O10-1490 0/55F 2F FXD Open LO 72″ Yes NEMA 1
PENN A19ABA-1C -30/50F 5/20F ADJ Open LO 72″ 3/8×4 NEMA 1 (1)
Ranco O10-1491 25/75F 2F FXD Open LO 72″ Yes NEMA 1
PENN A19ABA-4C 20/80F 3.5/14F ADJ Open LO 72″ 3/8×5 NEMA 1 (1)
Ranco O10-1802 25/75F 3/20F ADJ Open LO None Coiled NEMA 1
PENN A19BAC-1C 30/110F 3.5F FXD SPDT None Coiled NEMA 1 (1)
Ranco O10-301 30/95F 2F FXD Open LO None Coiled NEMA 1
PENN A19BAA-5C 30/110F 3.5F FXD Open LO None Coiled NEMA 1 (1)
Ranco O16-104 0/55F 3/20F ADJ SPDT 72″ Yes NEMA 1
PENN A19ABC-24C -30/100F 3/12F ADJ SPDT 96″ 3/8×4 NEMA 1 (1)
Ranco O16-111 0/55F 3/20F ADJ SPDT None 72″ NEMA 1
PENN A11E-6C 35/45F 12F FXD SPDT 48″ 240″ NEMA 1
Ranco O16-165 30/90F 2.5F FXD SPDT None Coiled NEMA 1
PENN A19BAC-1C 30/110F 3.5F FXD SPDT None Coiled NEMA 1 (1)
Ranco O16-263 0/55F Manual SPDT 72″ Yes NEMA 1
PENN A19ACC-6C -30/100F Manual SPDT 72″ 3/8×4 NEMA 1
PENN A70BA-17C 35/80F Manual Open LO 72″ 3/8×3 NEMA 1 (12)
Ranco O16-264 0/55F Manual SPDT None 96″ NEMA 1
PENN A11D-1C 35/45F Manual SPDT 48″ 240″ NEMA 1
PENN A70BA-18C 15/55F Manual Open LO None 240″ NEMA 1 (12)
Ranco O16-588 -15/40F 1.5F FXD SPDT None 72″ NEMA 1
PENN A11E-6C 35/45F 12F FXD SPDT 48″ 240″ NEMA 1 (1)
PENN A70AA-16C 15/55F 5F FXD Open LO None 240″ NEMA 1
Ranco

PENN

O16-594

A19BBC-2C

0/55F

-30/100F

2F FXD

3/12F ADJ

SPDT

SPDT

None

None

Coiled

Coiled

NEMA 1

NEMA 1

(1)
Ranco O16-595 50/100F 3/20F ADJ SPDT 96″ 3/8×6 NEMA 1
PENN A19ABC-4C 50/130F 3.5/14F ADJ SPDT 96″ 3/8×5 NEMA 1 (1)
Ranco O16-601 22.5/47.5F 2.5F FXD SPDT 36″ 3/8×6 NEMA 1
PENN A19ABC-2C 20/80F 3.5/14F ADJ SPDT 72″ 3/8×5 NEMA 1 (1)
PENN A70AA-15C -10/65F ADJ 10F FXD Open LO 72″ 3/8×3 NEMA 1 (12)
Ranco O20-7041 0/100F 6/20F ADJ DPST Open LO 96″ 3/8×6 NEMA 1
PENN A72AA-3C 50/90F ADJ DPST Open LO 72″ 11/16×6 3/4 NEMA 1
PENN A72AA-2C 15/55F ADJ DPST Open LO 72″ 3/8×3 NEMA 1

Cross-Reference

Ranco® Refrigeration Cross-Reference (Continued)

Temperature Controls (Part 2 of 2)

Product # Range Differential Switch Capillary Bulb Cover Notes
Ranco O52-6910 30/95F 2F FXD SPDT None Coiled NEMA 4X
PENN A19PRC-1C 30/110F 3/12F ADJ SPDT None Coiled NEMA 4X
Ranco O60-100 -35/95F 4/50F ADJ SPDT 96″ 3/8×6 NEMA 1
PENN A19ABC-24C -30/100F 3/12F ADJ SPDT 96″ 3/8×4 NEMA 1 (1)
Ranco O60-101 -35/95F 4/50F ADJ SPDT None Coiled NEMA 1
PENN A19BBC-2C -30/100F 3/12F ADJ SPDT None Coiled NEMA 1 (1)
Ranco O60-1072 -15/40F 3/20F ADJ Open LO None Coiled NEMA 1
PENN A19BBA-1C -30/50F 5/20F ADJ Open LO None Coiled NEMA 1 (1)
Ranco O60-120 -35/95F 4/50F ADJ SPDT 240″ 3/8×6 NEMA 1
PENN A19ABC-36C -30/100F 3/12F ADJ SPDT 240″ 3/8×4 NEMA 1 (1)
Ranco O60-1408 -15/40F 3/20F ADJ Open LO 72″ Yes NEMA 1
PENN A19ABA-1C -30/50F 5/20F ADJ Open LO 72″ 3/8×4 NEMA 1 (1)
Ranco O60-200 95/240F 6/50F ADJ SPDT 96″ 3/8×6 NEMA 1
PENN A19ABC-12C 100/240F 6/24F ADJ SPDT 96″ .29×2.5 NEMA 1 (1)

Defrost/Fan Delay Temperature Controls

Product # Range Differential Switch Capillary Bulb Cover Notes
Ranco F25-107 40/75F 20F FXD SPDT 60″ 3/8×4 Open
PENN A19ZBC-2C 45/85 25F ADJ SPDT 72″ 0.3×3.125 NEMA 1 (10)
Ranco F25-114 43/73F 24F FXD SPDT 60″ 3/8×4 Open
PENN A19ZBC-2C 45/85 25F ADJ SPDT 72″ 0.3×3.125 NEMA 1 (10)

Pressure Controls (Ranco Series 3126-3161, G20-G23, and O10-O20) (Part 1 of 3)

Product # Range Differential Switch Capillary Connection Cover Notes
Ranco 3126-116 7/125 25 FXD SPDT 60″ Sweat Open
PENN P20EB-1C 7/150 29/32 FXD SPDT 36″ Sweat Open (6)
Ranco 3126-117 7/27 12 FXD SPDT 60″ Sweat Open
PENN P70AB-2C 20″/100 7/50 ADJ Open LO 36″ w/ Flare NEMA 1 (5)(4)
Ranco 3126-216 7/125 Manual Open LO 60″ Sweat Open
PENN P70BA-1C 20″/100 Manual Open LO 36″ w/ Flare NEMA 1 (5)(4)
Ranco 3126-412 7/77 23/70 SPDT 60″ Sweat Open
PENN P20EB-1C 7/150 29/32 FXD SPDT 36″ Sweat Open (6)
Ranco 3127-140 125/450 70 FXD Open HI 60″ Sweat Open
PENN P20EB-2C 100/425 60/77 FXD SPDT 36″ Sweat Open (6)
Ranco 3127-220 125/450 Manual SPDT 60″ Sweat Open
PENN P70DA-1C 50/450 Manual Open HI 36″ w/ Flare NEMA 1 (5)(4)
Ranco 3127-414 150/450 70/125 SPDT 60″ Sweat Open
PENN P20EB-2C 100/425 60/77 FXD SPDT 36″ Sweat Open (6)
Ranco 3160-012 5/110 25 FXD SPDT 60″ Sweat Open
PENN P20EB-1C 7/150 29/32 FXD SPDT 36″ Sweat Open (6)
Ranco 3160-014 5/125 25 FXD Open LO 60″ Sweat Open
PENN P20EB-1C 7/150 29/32 FXD SPDT 36″ Sweat Open (6)
Ranco 3160-212 5/110 Manual Open LO 60″ Sweat Open
PENN P70BA-1C 20″/100 Manual Open LO 36″ w/ Flare NEMA 1 (5)(4)
Ranco 3160-406 5/125 12/50 SPDT 60″ Sweat Open
PENN P20EB-1C 7/150 29/32 FXD SPDT 36″ Sweat Open (6)
Ranco 3161-002 200/475 75 FXD Open HI 60″ Sweat Open
PENN P20EB-2C 100/425 60/77 FXD SPDT 36″ Sweat Open (6)
Ranco 3161-003 200/475 110 FXD Open HI 60″ Sweat Open
PENN P20EB-2C 100/425 60/77 FXD SPDT 36″ Sweat Open (6)
Ranco 3161-004 200/475 50 FXD Open HI 60″ Sweat Open
PENN P20EB-2C 100/425 60/77 FXD SPDT 36″ Sweat Open (6)
Ranco 3161-009 125/285 50 FXD SPDT 60″ Sweat Open
PENN P20EB-2C 100/425 60/77 FXD SPDT 36″ Sweat Open (6)

Cross-Reference

Ranco® Refrigeration Cross-Reference (Continued)

Pressure Controls (Ranco Series 3126-3161, G20-G23, and O10-O20) (Part 2 of 3)

Product # Range Differential Switch Capillary Connection Cover Notes
Ranco 3161-201 200/475 Manual SPDT 60″ Sweat Open
PENN P70DA-1C 50/450 Manual Open HI 36″ w/ Flare NEMA 1 (5)(4)
Ranco 3161-205 125/285 Manual Open HI 60″ w/ Flare Open
PENN P70DA-1C 50/450 Manual Open HI 36″ w/ Flare NEMA 1 (5)
Ranco 3161-403 200/475 50/150 SPDT 60″ Sweat Open
PENN P20EB-2C 100/425 60/77 FXD SPDT 36″ Sweat Open (6)
Ranco G20-4050 7/27 12 FXD Open LO 60″ Sweat Open
PENN P70AB-2C 20″/100 7/50 ADJ Open LO 36″ w/ Flare NEMA 1 (5)(4)
Ranco G20-4051 7/77 19/70 Open LO 60″ Sweat Open
PENN P20EB-1C 7/150 29/32 FXD SPDT 36″ Sweat Open (6)
Ranco G20-4412 7/70 Manual Open LO 60″ Sweat Open
PENN P70BA-1C 20″/100 Manual Open LO 36″ w/ Flare NEMA 1 (5)(4)
Ranco G23-5052 150/450 50/125 Open HI 60″ Sweat Open
PENN P20EB-2C 100/425 60/77 FXD SPDT 36″ Sweat Open (6)
Ranco G23-5253 50/450 Manual Open HI 60″ Sweat Open
PENN P70DA-1C 50/450 Manual Open HI 36″ w/ Flare NEMA 1 (5)(4)
Ranco O10-1093 10″/100 10/40 Open LO 48″ w/ Flare NEMA 1
PENN P70AB-2C 20″/100 7/50 Open LO 36″ w/ Flare NEMA 1
Ranco O10-1401 12″/50 5/35 Open LO None External Flare NEMA 1
PENN P170AB-12C 12″/80 5/35 Open LO None External Flare NEMA 1
Ranco O10-1402 12″/50 535 Open LO 36″ w/ Flare NEMA 1
PENN P70AB-12C 12″/80 5/35 Open LO 36″ w/ Flare NEMA 1
Ranco O10-1483 10″/100 10/40 Open LO 36″ w/ Flare NEMA 1
PENN P70AB-2C 20″/100 7/50 Open LO 36″ w/ Flare NEMA 1
Ranco O10-1807 100/250 20/100 Open LO None External Flare NEMA 1
PENN P70AA-151C 50/300 20/120 Open LO None External Flare NEMA 1
Ranco O10-1831 10″/100 10/40 Open LO None External Flare NEMA 1
PENN P70AB-12C 12″/80 5/35 Open LO 36″ w/ Flare NEMA 1
Ranco O10-1842 12″/50 5/35 Open LO 48″ w/ Flare NEMA 1
PENN P70AB-12C 12″/80 5/35 Open LO 36″ w/ Flare NEMA 1
Ranco O10-2000 100/250 20/100 Open LO 48″ w/ Flare NEMA 1
PENN P70AA-3C 100/300 25/75 Open LO 36″ w/ Flare NEMA 1
Ranco O10-2054 100/400 40/150 Open LO 36″ w/ Flare NEMA 1
PENN P70AA-118C 100/400 35/200 Open LO 36″ w/ Flare NEMA 1
Ranco O11-1711 150/450 40/150 Open HI 36″ w/ Flare NEMA 1
PENN P70CA-3C 50/450 60/150 Open HI 36″ w/ Flare NEMA 1
Ranco O11-1713 150/450 40/150 Open HI None External Flare NEMA 1
PENN P70CA-2C 50/450 60/150 Open HI None External Flare NEMA 1
Ranco O11-1799 10″/100 10/40 Open HI None External Flare NEMA 1
PENN P170CA-1C 20″/100 6/70 Open HI None External Flare NEMA 1
Ranco O11-3099 10″/100 10/40 Open HI 36″ w/ Flare NEMA 1
PENN P70CA-1C 20″/100 6/70 Open HI 36″ w/ Flare NEMA 1
Ranco O16-107 10″/100 10/40 ADJ SPDT None External Flare NEMA 1
PENN P70EA-10C 20″/100 5 FXD SPDT None External Flare NEMA 1
Ranco O16-120 12″/50 5/35 ADJ SPDT None External Flare NEMA 1
PENN P70EA-10C 20″/100 5 FXD SPDT None External Flare NEMA 1
Ranco O16-142 100/400 17 FXD SPDT 36″ w/ Flare NEMA 1
PENN P70EA-6C 100/300 14 FXD SPDT 36″ Sweat NEMA 1 (4)
Ranco O16-166 50/150 10/40 SPDT 36″ w/ Flare NEMA 1
PENN P70GA-2C 20″/100 7/50 NO/NC 36″ w/ Flare NEMA 1 (12)
Ranco O16-200 150/450 Manual SPDT 48″ w/ Flare NEMA 1
PENN P70KA-1C 50/450 Manual NO/NC 36″ w/ Flare NEMA 1 (12)
Ranco O16-209 150/450 Manual SPDT None External Flare NEMA 1
PENN P170KA-1C 50/450 Manual NO/NC None External Flare NEMA 1 (12)
Ranco O16-261 10″/100 Manual SPDT 48″ w/ Flare NEMA 1
PENN P70HA-2C 20″/100 Manual NO/NC 36″ w/ Flare NEMA 1 (12)
Ranco O16-503 150/450 40/150 SPDT None External Flare NEMA 1
PENN P70JA-18C 50/450 60/150 NO/NC None External Flare NEMA 1 (12)

Cross-Reference

Ranco® Refrigeration Cross-Reference (Continued)

Pressure Controls (Ranco Series 3126-3161, G20-G23, and O10-O20) (Part 3 of 3)

Product # Range Differential Switch Capillary Connection Cover Notes
Ranco O16-527 10″/100 10/40 ADJ SPDT 36″ w/ Flare NEMA 1
PENN P70EA-10C 20″/100 5 FXD SPDT None External Flare NEMA 1 (3)
Ranco O16-557 12″/50 5/35 ADJ SPDT 36″ w/ Flare NEMA 1
PENN P70EA-10C 20″/100 5 FXD SPDT None External Flare NEMA 1 (3)
Ranco O16-585 10″/100 Manual SPDT None External Flare NEMA 1
PENN P70HA-3C 20″/100 Manual NO/NC None Internal NPT NEMA 1 (4)(12)
Ranco O20-1894 100/400 40/150 Open LO None External Flare NEMA 1
PENN P170AA-118C 100/400 35/200 Open LO None External Flare NEMA 1
Ranco O20-7002 12″/50 5/35 DPST-LO 36″ w/ Flare NEMA 1
PENN P72AA-1C 20″/100 7/50 DPST-LO 36″ w/ Flare NEMA 1
Ranco O20-7006 100/400 40/150 DPST-LO 36″ w/ Flare NEMA 1
PENN P72AA-27C 100/400 35/200 DPST-LO 36″ w/ Flare NEMA 1

Pressure Controls (Ranco Series 3100, MPF, MPH, and MPL) (Part 1 of 3)

Product # Cut-Out Cut-In Range Switch Electrical Pressure Notes
Ranco

PENN

3100-001

P100AA-1C

15

10

40

40

None

None

SPST

SPST

30″ Leads

48″ Leads

1/4″ Sweat

1/4″ Internal Flare

Ranco

PENN

3100-002

P20EB-1C

5

ADJ.

30

N/A

None

7/150

SPST

SPDT

72″ Leads

Arkles

1/4″ Internal Flare

36″ Cap, Sweat

(4)(5)(6)(7)(8)
Ranco

PENN

3100-003

P20EB-1C

20

ADJ.

45

N/A

None

7/150

SPST

SPDT

72″ Leads

Arkles

1/4″ Internal Flare

36″ Cap, Sweat

(4)(5)(6)(7)(8)
Ranco

PENN

3100-004

P100AA-2C

35

35

60

60

None

None

SPST

SPST

QC

48″ Leads

1/4″ Internal Flare

1/4″ Internal Flare

(8)
Ranco

PENN

3100-005

P70AB-1C

15″ VAC

ADJ.

17.5

N/A

None

20″/100

SPDT

SPST

QC

Screw Terms.

1/4″ Internal Flare

1/4″ External Flare

(4)(5)(7)(8)
Ranco

PENN

3100-006

P20EB-1C

48

ADJ.

80

N/A

None

7/150

SPDT

SPDT

36″ Leads

Arkles

1/4″ Sweat

36″ Cap, Sweat

(4)(5)(6)(7)(8)
Ranco

PENN

3100-007

P100AA-1C

15

10

40

40

None

None

SPST

SPST

30″ Leads

48″ Leads

1/4″ Internal Flare

1/4″ Internal Flare

Ranco

PENN

3100-009

P70AB-1C

0

ADJ.

20

N/A

None

20″/100

SPST

SPST

QC

Screw Terms.

1/4″ Internal Flare

1/4″ External Flare

(4)(5)(7)(8)
Ranco

PENN

3100-010

P20EB-1C

45

ADJ.

70

N/A

None

7/150

SPDT

SPDT

QC

Arkles

1/4″ Internal Flare

36″ Cap, Sweat

(4)(5)(6)(7)
Ranco

PENN

3100-050

P100AA-1C

10

10

30

40

None

None

SPST

SPST

18″ Leads

48″ Leads

1/4″ Internal Flare

1/4″ Internal Flare

Ranco

PENN

3100-051

P20EB-1C

25

ADJ.

80

N/A

None

7/150

SPST

SPDT

18″ Leads

Arkles

1/4″ Internal Flare

36″ Cap, Sweat

(4)(5)(6)(7)(8)
Ranco

PENN

3100-052

P100AA-2C

40

35

80

60

None

None

SPST

SPST

18″ Leads

48″ Leads

1/4″ Internal Flare

1/4″ Internal Flare

Ranco

PENN

3100-075

P70AA-119C

85

ADJ.

135

N/A

None

50/300

SPDT

SPST

QC

Screw Terms.

1/4″ Internal Flare

1/4″ Internal Flare

(5)(7)(8)(12)
Ranco

PENN

3100-076

P20EB-1C

108

ADJ.

135

N/A

None

7/150

SPST

SPDT

QC

Arkles

1/4″ Internal Flare

36″ Cap, Sweat

(4)(5)(6)(7)(12)
Ranco

PENN

3100-077

P170AA-118C

115

ADJ.

165

N/A

None

100/400

SPST

SPST

QC

Screw Terms.

1/4″ Internal Flare

1/4″ External Flare

(4)(5)(7)(8)
Ranco

PENN

3100-078

P170AA-118C

135

ADJ.

185

N/A

None

100/400

SPDT

SPST

QC

Screw Terms.

1/4″ Internal Flare

1/4″ External Flare

(4)(5)(7)(8)(12)
Ranco

PENN

3100-079

P100AA-4C

165

170

215

250

None

None

SPST

SPST

QC

48″ Leads

1/4″ Internal Flare

1/4″ Internal Flare

(8)
Ranco

PENN

3100-080

P170AA-118C

200

ADJ.

240

N/A

None

100/400

SPDT

SPST

QC

Screw Terms.

1/4″ Internal Flare

1/4″ External Flare

(4)(5)(7)(8)(12)
Ranco

PENN

3100-081

P170AA-118C

250

ADJ.

300

N/A

None

100/400

SPDT

SPST

QC

Screw Terms.

1/4″ Internal Flare

1/4″ External Flare

(4)(5)(7)(8)(12)
Ranco

PENN

3100-100

P100CA-2C

425

425

325

325

None

None

SPST

SPST

72″ Leads

48″ Leads

1/4″ Internal Flare

1/4″ Internal Flare

Ranco

PENN

3100-101

P100CA-1C

400

400

300

300

None

None

SPST

SPST

18″ Leads

48″ Leads

1/4″ Internal Flare

1/4″ Internal Flare

Cross-Reference

Ranco® Refrigeration Cross-Reference (Continued)

Pressure Controls (Ranco Series 3100, MPF, MPH, and MPL) (Part 2 of 3)

Product # Cut-Out Cut-In Range Switch Electrical Pressure Notes
Ranco

PENN

3100-102

P100CA-2C

220

425

170

325

None

None

SPST

SPST

QC

48″ Leads

1/4″ Internal Flare

1/4″ Internal Flare

(8)
Ranco

PENN

3100-103

P100DA-1C

410

410

Manual

Manual

None

None

SPST

SPST

42″ Leads

48″ Leads

1/4″ Internal Flare

1/4″ Internal Flare

Ranco

PENN

3100-104

P70DA-1C

420

ADJ.

Manual

Manual

None

50/450

SPST

SPST

48″ Leads

Screw Terms.

1/4″ Internal Flare

36″ Cap, Flare

(4)(5)(7)(8)
Ranco

PENN

3100-105

P70DA-1C

440

ADJ.

Manual

Manual

None

50/450

SPST

SPST

36″ Leads

Screw Terms.

.093 Cap. Tube

36″ Cap, Flare

(4)(5)(7)(8)
Ranco

PENN

3100-106

P100DA-2C

475

475

Manual

Manual

None

None

SPST

SPST

42″ Leads

48″ Leads

1/4″ Sweat w/ Cap.

1/4″ Internal Flare

(4)
Ranco

PENN

3100-107

P70DA-1C

232

ADJ.

Manual

Manual

None

50/450

SPST

SPST

84″ Leads

Screw Terms.

1/4″ Internal Flare

36″ Cap, Flare

(4)(5)(7)(8)
Ranco

PENN

3100-108

P20EB-2C

280

ADJ.

Manual

N/A

None

100/425

SPST

SPDT

12″ Leads

Arkles

1/4″ NPTF

36″ Cap, Sweat

(4)(5)(6)(7)(8)
Ranco

PENN

3100-110

P20EB-2C

375

ADJ.

275

N/A

None

100/425

SPDT

SPDT

QC

Arkles

1/4″ Sweat

36″ Cap, Sweat

(4)(5)(6)(7)
Ranco

PENN

3100-111

P20EB-2C

375

ADJ.

275

N/A

None

100/425

SPST

SPDT

QC

Arkles

1/4″ Internal Flare

36″ Cap, Sweat

(4)(5)(6)(7)
Ranco

PENN

3100-112

P20EB-2C

275

ADJ.

175

N/A

None

100/425

SPST

SPDT

24″ Leads

Arkles

1/4″ Internal Flare

36″ Cap, Sweat

(4)(5)(6)(7)(8)
Ranco

PENN

3100-113

P20EB-2C

395

ADJ.

295

N/A

None

100/425

SPST

SPDT

QC

Arkles

1/4″ Sweat

36″ Cap, Sweat

(4)(5)(6)(7)
Ranco

PENN

3100-115

P20EB-2C

350

ADJ.

250

N/A

None

100/425

SPDT

SPDT

36″ Leads

Arkles

1/4″ Sweat

36″ Cap, Sweat

(4)(5)(6)(7)(8)
Ranco

PENN

3100-116

P20EB-2C

213

ADJ.

113

N/A

None

100/425

SPST

SPDT

QC

Arkles

1/4″ Internal Flare

36″ Cap, Sweat

(4)(5)(6)(7)
Ranco

PENN

3100-117

P20EB-2C

140

ADJ.

190

N/A

None

100/425

SPST

SPDT

12″ Leads

Arkles

.093 Cap. Tube

36″ Cap, Sweat

(4)(5)(6)(7)(8)
Ranco

PENN

3100-118

P20EB-2C

295

ADJ.

395

N/A

None

100/425

SPST

SPDT

QC

Arkles

1/4″ Internal Flare

36″ Cap, Sweat

(4)(5)(6)(7)
Ranco

PENN

3100-120

P20EB-2C

420

ADJ.

320

N/A

None

100/425

SPST

SPDT

QC

Arkles

1/4″ Internal Flare

36″ Cap, Sweat

(4)(5)(6)(7)
Ranco

PENN

3100-121

P20EB-2C

426

ADJ.

272

N/A

None

100/425

SPST

SPDT

QC

Arkles

1/4″ Sweat

36″ Cap, Sweat

(4)(5)(6)(7)
Ranco

PENN

3100-150

P20EB-2C

350

ADJ.

250

N/A

None

100/425

SPST

SPDT

18″ Leads

Arkles

1/4″ Internal Flare

36″ Cap, Sweat

(4)(5)(6)(7)(8)
Ranco

PENN

3100-151

P100CA-1C

400

400

300

300

None

None

SPST

SPST

18″ Leads

48″ Leads

1/4″ Internal Flare

1/4″ Internal Flare

Ranco

PENN

3100-152

P100CA-1C

400

400

200

300

None

None

SPST

SPST

18″ Leads

48″ Leads

1/4″ Internal Flare

1/4″ Internal Flare

Ranco

PENN

3100-153

P20EB-2C

450

ADJ.

250

N/A

None

100/425

SPST

SPDT

18″ Leads

Arkles

1/4″ Internal Flare

36″ Cap, Sweat

(4)(5)(6)(7)(8)
Ranco

PENN

3100-154

P70LB-1C

500

ADJ.

400

N/A

None

100/500

SPST

SPST

18″ Leads

Screw Terms.

1/4″ Internal Flare

36″ Cap, Flare

(4)(5)(7)(8)(9)
Ranco

PENN

3100-155

P70LB-1C

500

ADJ.

300

N/A

None

100/500

SPST

SPST

18″ Leads

Screw Terms.

1/4″ Internal Flare

36″ Cap, Flare

(4)(5)(7)(8)(9)
Ranco

PENN

MPF-7006

P20EB-1C

75

ADJ.

120

N/A

None

7/150

SPST

SPDT

18″ Leads

Arkles

1/4″ Internal Flare

36″ Cap, Sweat

(6)(7)(8)
Ranco

PENN

MPF-7007

P20EB-1C

110

ADJ.

170

N/A

None

7/150

SPST

SPDT

18″ Leads

Arkles

1/4″ Internal Flare

36″ Cap, Sweat

(6)(7)(8)
Ranco

PENN

MPF-7008

P100AA-3C

150

150

225

225

None

None

SPST

SPST

18″ Leads

48″ Leads

1/4″ Internal Flare

1/4″ External Flare

Ranco

PENN

MPF-7009

P20EB-2C

190

ADJ.

275

N/A

None

100/425

SPST

SPDT

18″ Leads

Arkles

1/4″ Internal Flare

36″ Cap, Sweat

(6)(7)(8)
Ranco

PENN

MPF-7010

P20EB-2C

300

ADJ.

400

N/A

None

100/425

SPST

SPDT

18″ Leads

Arkles

1/4″ Internal Flare

36″ Cap, Sweat

(6)(7)(8)
Ranco

PENN

MPH-7101

P20EB-2C

250

ADJ.

180

N/A

None

100/425

SPST

SPDT

18″ Leads

Arkles

1/4″ Internal Flare

36″ Cap, Sweat

(6)(7)(8)

Cross-Reference

Ranco® Refrigeration Cross-Reference (Continued)

Pressure Controls (Ranco Series 3100, MPF, MPH, and MPL) (Part 3 of 3)

Product # Cut-Out Cut-In Range Switch Electrical Pressure Notes
Ranco

PENN

MPH-7102

P20EB-2C

270

ADJ.

200

N/A

None

100/425

SPST

SPDT

18″ Leads

Arkles

1/4″ Internal Flare

36″ Cap, Sweat

(6)(7)(8)
Ranco

PENN

MPH-7103

P20EB-2C

300

ADJ.

200

N/A

None

100/425

SPST

SPDT

18″ Leads

Arkles

1/4″ Internal Flare

36″ Cap, Sweat

(6)(7)(8)
Ranco

PENN

MPH-7104

P20EB-2C

325

ADJ.

225

N/A

None

100/425

SPST

SPDT

18″ Leads

Arkles

1/4″ Internal Flare

36″ Cap, Sweat

(6)(7)(8)
Ranco

PENN

MPH-7105

P20EB-2C

350

ADJ.

250

N/A

None

100/425

SPST

SPDT

18″ Leads

Arkles

1/4″ Internal Flare

36″ Cap, Sweat

(6)(7)(8)
Ranco

PENN

MPH-7106

P20EB-2C

375

ADJ.

275

N/A

None

100/425

SPST

SPDT

18″ Leads

Arkles

1/4″ Internal Flare

36″ Cap, Sweat

(6)(7)(8)
Ranco

PENN

MPH-7107

P100CA-1C

400

400

300

300

None

None

SPST

SPST

18″ Leads

48″ Leads

1/4″ Internal Flare

1/4″ External Flare

Ranco

PENN

MPH-7108

P100CA-2C

425

425

325

325

None

None

SPST

SPST

18″ Leads

48″ Leads

1/4″ Internal Flare

1/4″ External Flare

Ranco

PENN

MPL-7001

P100AC-1C

5

5

20

20

None

None

SPST

SPST

18″ Leads

48″ Leads

1/4″ Internal Flare

1/4″ External Flare

Ranco

PENN

MPL-7002

P100AA-1C

15

10

35

40

None

None

SPST

SPST

18″ Leads

48″ Leads

1/4″ Internal Flare

1/4″ External Flare

Ranco

PENN

MPL-7003

P20EB-1C

25

ADJ.

80

N/A

None

7/150

SPST

SPDT

18″ Leads

Arkles

1/4″ Internal Flare

36″ Cap, Sweat

(6)(7)(8)
Ranco

PENN

MPL-7004

P100AA-2C

35

35

60

60

None

None

SPST

SPST

18″ Leads

48″ Leads

1/4″ Internal Flare

1/4″ External Flare

Ranco

PENN

MPL-7005

P20EB-1C

45

ADJ.

60

N/A

None

7/150

SPST

SPDT

18″ Leads

Arkles

1/4″ Internal Flare

36″ Cap, Sweat

(6)(7)(8)
Ranco

PENN

MPL-7011

P20EB-1C

10

ADJ.

25

N/A

None

7/150

SPST

SPDT

18″ Leads

Arkles

1/4″ Internal Flare

36″ Cap, Sweat

(6)(7)(8)
Ranco

PENN

MPL-7012

P20EB-1C

20

ADJ.

45

N/A

None

7/150

SPST

SPDT

18″ Leads

Arkles

1/4″ Internal Flare

36″ Cap, Sweat

(6)(7)(8)
Ranco

PENN

MPL-7014

P20EB-1C

40

ADJ.

80

N/A

None

7/150

SPST

SPDT

18″ Leads

Arkles

1/4″ Internal Flare

36″ Cap, Sweat

(6)(7)(8)

Dual Pressure Controls (Part 1 of 2)

Product # LO Side Differential HI Side Differential Capillary Connection Notes
Ranco O12-1502 12″/50 5/35 150/450 70 FXD 36″ W/ Flare
PENN P70LB-6C 12″/80 5/35 100/500 60 FXD 36″ W/ Flare
Ranco O12-1505 12″/50 5/35 100/250 50 FXD None External Flare
PENN P170LB-6C 12″/80 5/35 100/500 60 FXD None External Flare
Ranco O12-1506 12″/50 5/35 100/250 50 FXD 36″ W/ Flare
PENN P70LB-6C 12″/80 5/35 100/500 60 FXD 36″ W/ Flare
Ranco O12-1549 10″/100 10/40 150/450 70 FXD 36″ W/ Flare
PENN P70LB-1C 20″/100 7/50 100/500 60 FXD 36″ W/ Flare
Ranco O12-1550 10″/100 10/40 150/450 70 FXD None External Flare
PENN P170LB-1C 20″/100 7/50 100/500 60 FXD None External Flare
Ranco O12-1554 12″/50 5/35 100/250 50 FXD 48″ W/ Flare
PENN P70LB-6C 12″/80 5/35 100/500 60 FXD 36″ W/ Flare
Ranco O12-1594 10″/100 Manual 150/450 Manual 36″ W/ Flare
PENN P70NA-1C 20″/100 Manual 100/500 Manual 36″ W/ Flare
Ranco O12-4139 12″/50 5/35 150/450 70 FXD None External Flare
PENN P170LB-6C 12″/80 5/35 100/500 60 FXD None External Flare
Ranco O12-4833 12″/50 5/35 150/450 70 FXD/Man 48″ W/ Flare
PENN P70SA-1C 12″/80 5/35 100/500 60 FXD 36″ W/ Flare
Ranco O12-4834 10″/100 10/40 150/450 70 FXD/Man 48″ W/ Flare
PENN P70SA-1C 12″/80 5/35 100/500 60 FXD 36″ W/ Flare
Ranco O12-4842 12″/50 5/35 150/450 70 FXD/Man None External Flare
PENN P170SA-1C 12″/80 5/35 100/500 60 FXD None External Flare
Ranco O12-4846 10″/100 10/40 150/450 70 FXD/Man None External Flare
PENN P170SA-1C 12″/80 5/35 100/500 60 FXD None External Flare
Ranco O22-7702 12″/50 5/35 100/250 50 FXD/Man 36″ W/ Flare
PENN P72LB-1C 20″/100 7/50 100/500 60 FXD 36″ W/ Flare (2)

Cross-Reference

Ranco® Refrigeration Cross-Reference (Continued)

Dual Pressure Controls (Part 2 of 2)

Product # LO Side Differential HI Side Differential Capillary Connection Notes
Ranco O22-7706 10″/100 10/40 150/450 70 FXD 36″ W/ Flare
PENN P72LB-1C 20″/100 7/50 100/500 60 FXD 36″ W/ Flare (2)

Low Pressure Cutout with Time Delay

Product # Range Differential Time Delay Capillary Connection Cover Notes
Ranco 3341-161 0/100 5 FXD 120 Secs. 36″ W/ Flare NEMA 1
PENN P29NC-38C 20″/100 2.2 FXD 120 Secs. 36″ W/ Flare NEMA 1

Lube Oil Pressure Controls

Product # Range Reset Delay Capillary Connection Cover Notes
Ranco

PENN

3321-001

P128AA-**C

9 FXD

8/70 ADJ

Manual

Manual

45,60,90,120

Note (11)

None

None

External Flare

External Flare

NEMA 1

NEMA 1

(11)
Ranco

PENN

3321-009

P28AA-**C

5 FXD

8/70 ADJ

Manual

Manual

45,60,90,120

Note (11)

36″

36″

W/ Flare

W/ Flare

NEMA 1

NEMA 1

(11)
Ranco

PENN

3321-010

P28AA-**C

9 FXD

8/70 ADJ

Manual

Manual

45,60,90,120

Note (11)

36″

36″

W/ Flare

W/ Flare

NEMA 1

NEMA 1

(11)
Ranco

PENN

3321-014

P28AA-**C

15 FXD

8/70 ADJ

Manual

Manual

45,60,90,120

Note (11)

36″

36″

W/ Flare

W/ Flare

NEMA 1

NEMA 1

(11)
Ranco

PENN

3321-015

P28AA-**C

30 FXD

8/70 ADJ

Manual

Manual

45,60,90,120

Note (11)

36″

36″

W/ Flare

W/ Flare

NEMA 1

NEMA 1

(11)
Ranco

PENN

P30-3601

P28AA-2C

8/60 ADJ

8/70 ADJ

Manual

Manual

60

60

36″

36″

W/ Flare

W/ Flare

NEMA 1

NEMA 1

Ranco

PENN

P30-3701

P28AA-1C

8/60 ADJ

8/70 ADJ

Manual

Manual

90

90

36″

36″

W/ Flare

W/ Flare

NEMA 1

NEMA 1

Ranco

PENN

P30-3801

P28AA-17C

8/60 ADJ

8/70 ADJ

Manual

Manual

120

120

36″

36″

W/ Flare

W/ Flare

NEMA 1

NEMA 1

Ranco

PENN

P30-5826

P45NCA-12C

9 FXD

9 FXD

Manual

Manual

120

120

36″

36″

W/ Flare

W/ Flare

NEMA 1

NEMA 1

Ranco

PENN

P30-5827

P145NCA-12C

9 FXD

9 FXD

Manual

Manual

120

120

None

None

External Flare

External Flare

NEMA 1

NEMA 1

Lube Oil Pressure Controls without Time Delay

Product # Range Differential Cut-In Switch Capillary Connection Notes
Ranco

PENN

3311-101

P74AA-1C

14 FXD

8/70 ADJ

5 FXD

8/30 ADJ

9 FXD

ADJ

SPDT

Open Hi

36″

36″

1/4″ Internal Flares

1/4″ Internal Flares

(12)
Ranco

PENN

3311-103

P74EA-8C

4/6 ADJ

2/26 ADJ

5/6

3.5 FXD

9/12

N/A

SPDT

SPDT

24″

36″

W/1/4″ Sweats

1/4″ Internal Flares

(4)
Ranco

PENN

3311-111

P74EA-8C

4/6 FXD

2/26 ADJ

5/6

3.5 FXD

9/12

N/A

SPDT

SPDT

84″

36″

1/4″ Internal Flares

1/4″ Internal Flares

Ranco

PENN

3311-115

P74BA-1C

6 FXD

8/70 ADJ

5 FXD

7/30 ADJ

11 FXD

ADJ

Open LO

Open LO

24″

36″

1/4″ Internal Flares

1/4″ Internal Flares

Ranco

PENN

3311-118

P74BA-1C

40 FXD

8/70 ADJ

5 FXD

7/30 ADJ

45 FXD

ADJ

Open LO

Open LO

25″ & 24″

36″

W/1/4″ Sweats

1/4″ Internal Flares

(4)
Ranco

PENN

3311-201

P74AB-1C

7 FXD

8/70 ADJ

Manual

Manual

Manual

Manual

SPDT

Open Hi

49″ & 72″

None

W/1/4″ Sweats

1/4″ Internal NPT

(4)(12)
Ranco

PENN

3315-101

P74AA-1C

14 FXD

8/70 ADJ

5 FXD

8/30 ADJ

9 FXD

ADJ

SPDT

Open Hi

36″

36″

1/4″ Internal Flares

1/4″ Internal Flares

(12)
Ranco

PENN

3315-801

P74BA-1C

11/14 ADJ

8/70 ADJ

5 FXD

7/30 ADJ

16/19

ADJ

SPDT

Open LO

None

36″

External Flares

1/4″ Internal Flares

(4)(12)

Cross-Reference

Transformers

Ranco® Refrigeration Cross-Reference (Continued)

Product # VA Prim. Volt. Prim. Lead Sec. Volt. Sec. Lead Mounting Notes
Ranco 620-205 20 120 8″ Leads 24 8″ Leads Foot
PENN Y65A13-0 40 120 8″ Leads 24 30″ Leads Foot w/ Hubs
Ranco 620-206 20 208/240 8″ Leads 24 8″ Leads Foot
PENN Y65T31-0 40 120/208/240 8″ Leads 24 3 Terminals Universal (8)
Ranco 620-403 40 120 8″ Leads 24 8″ Leads Universal
PENN Y65T31-0 40 120/208/240 8″ Leads 24 3 Terminals Universal (8)
Ranco 620-404 40 208/240 8″ Leads 24 8″ Leads Universal
PENN Y65T31-0 40 120/208/240 8″ Leads 24 3 Terminals Universal (8)
Ranco 620-405 40 120 8″ Leads 24 8″ Leads Foot
PENN Y65A13-0 40 120 8″ Leads 24 30″ Leads Foot w/ Hubs
Ranco 620-406 40 208/240 8″ Leads 24 8″ Leads Foot
PENN Y65T31-0 40 120/208/240 8″ Leads 24 3 Terminals Universal (8)
Ranco 620-482 40 120/208/240 8″ Leads 24 8″ Leads Foot
PENN Y65A13-0 40 120 8″ Leads 24 30″ Leads Foot w/ Hubs (13)
PENN Y65T31-0 40 120/208/240 8″ Leads 24 3 Terminals Universal
Ranco 620-502 50 120/208/240 8″ Leads 24 8″ Leads Universal
PENN Y63T22-0 50 120/208/240 8″ Leads 24 8″ Leads Universal (13)
Ranco 620-752 75 120/208/240 8″ Leads 24 8″ Leads Foot
PENN Y66T12-0 75 120/208/240 8″ Leads 24 8″ Leads Foot (13)
Ranco 620-758 75 480 8″ Leads 24 8″ Leads Foot
PENN Y66F12-0 75 277/480 8″ Leads 24 8″ Leads Foot

Notes:

  1. Can use A419ABC-1, -30/212F range, 1/30F differential, SPDT, 78” lead, 0.25 x 2 PTC sensor, NEMA 1.
  2. Convertible
  3. Add Ecosafe hose.
  4. Different pressure element.
  5. Not as compact.
  6. Differential depends on setting.
  7. Not an encapsulated switch as Ranco’s is.
  8. Different electrical connection.
  9. Dual control, ignore lo side.
  10. Range is Defrost Termination for both.
  11. Choose correct one below based on timing required and pressure connection:
P28AA-1 8/70 90 Secs. 36″ W/ Flare
P28AA-2 8/70 60 Secs. 36″ W/ Flare
P28AA-17 8/70 120 Secs. 36″ W/ Flare
P28AA-18 8/70 45 Secs. 36″ W/ Flare
P128AA-1 8/70 90 Secs. None External Flare
P128AA-2 8/70 60 Secs. None External Flare
P128AA-17 8/70 120 Secs. None External Flare
(12) Different switch.
  1. Choose which transformer based on primary voltage desired.
  2. May be extended up to 800 feet.

Cross-Reference Code No. LIT-1900211

ALCO® Cross Reference

Temperature Controls

Product # Range Differential Switch Capillary Bulb Cover Notes
ALCO TF115-S2 AE00 -20/60F 3/30F ADJ SPDT NONE COILED NEMA 1
ALCO TSI-X2E 30/40 -20/60F 3/30F ADJ SPDT NONE COILED NEMA 1
PENN A19BBC-2C -30/100F 3/12F ADJ SPDT None Coiled NEMA 1 (1)
PENN A19BBC-6C -30/100F 3/12F ADJ SPDT None Coiled NEMA 1 (1)(2)
ALCO TF115-S3 AE00 15/95F 3/30F ADJ SPDT NONE COILED NEMA 1
ALCO TSI-X3E 64/48 15/95F 3/30F ADJ SPDT NONE COILED NEMA 1
PENN A19BBC-2C -30/100F 3/12F ADJ SPDT None Coiled NEMA 1 (1)
PENN A19BBC-6C -30/100F 3/12F ADJ SPDT None Coiled NEMA 1 (1)(2)
ALCO TF115-S4 AF10 -20/95F 5/35F ADJ SPDT 120″ 3/8×2-3/4 NEMA 1
ALCO TSI-X4F 32/41 -20/95F 5/35F ADJ SPDT 120″ 3/8×2-3/4 NEMA 1
PENN A19ABC-24C -30/100F 3/12F ADJ SPDT 96″ 3/8×4 NEMA 1 (1)
PENN A19ABC-36C -30/100F 3/12F ADJ SPDT 240″ 3/8×4 NEMA 1 (1)

Notes:

    1. Can use A419ABC-1, -30/212F range, 1/30F differential, SPDT, 78” lead, 0.25 x 2 PTC sensor, NEMA 1.
    2. Knob assembly/concealed adjustment packed separately.

Pressure Controls

Product # Range Differential Switch Capillary Connection Cover Notes
ALCO FF115-S1 BAK 24″/42 3/30 ADJ SPDT 36″ w/ Flare NEMA 1
ALCO PS1-X1K 7/15 24″/42 3/30 ADJ SPDT 36″ w/ Flare NEMA 1
PENN P70AB-12C 12″/80 5/35 ADJ Open LO 36″ w/ Flare NEMA 1
ALCO FF115-S3 BAK 15″/100 7/70 ADJ SPDT 36″ w/ Flare NEMA 1
ALCO PS1-X3K 50/65 15″/100 7/70 ADJ SPDT 36″ w/ Flare NEMA 1
PENN P70AB-2C 20″/100 7/50 ADJ Open LO 36″ w/ Flare NEMA 1
ALCO FF115-S3 BAA 15″/100 7/70 ADJ SPDT None External Flare NEMA 1
ALCO PS1-X3A 50/65 15″/100 7/70 ADJ SPDT None External Flare NEMA 1
PENN P170AB-2C 20″/100 7/50 ADJ Open LO None External Flare NEMA 1
ALCO FF115-S4 BAK 15/290 15/145 ADJ SPDT 36″ w/ Flare NEMA 1
ALCO PS1-X4K 115/145 15/290 15/145 ADJ SPDT 36″ w/ Flare NEMA 1
PENN P70AA-2C 0/150 12/40 ADJ Open LO 36″ w/ Flare NEMA 1
PENN P70AA-3C 100/300 25/75 ADJ Open LO 36″ w/ Flare NEMA 1
ALCO FF115-S5 BAK 90/450 30/220 SPDT 36″ w/ Flare NEMA 1
ALCO PS1-X5K 230/290 90/450 30/220 SPDT 36″ w/ Flare NEMA 1
PENN P70AA-118C 100/400 35/200 Open LO 36″ w/ Flare NEMA 1
PENN P70CA-3C 50/450 60/150 Open HI 36″ w/ Flare NEMA 1
ALCO FF115-S5 BAA 90/450 30/220 SPDT None External Flare NEMA 1
ALCO PS1-X5A 140/280 90/450 30/220 SPDT None External Flare NEMA 1
PENN P170AA-118C 100/400 35/200 Open LO None External Flare NEMA 1
PENN P170CA-3C 50/450 60/150 Open HI None External Flare NEMA 1
ALCO FF115-S5 BRK 90/450 Manual SPDT 36″ w/ Flare NEMA 1
ALCO PS1-Y5K 230/290 90/450 Manual SPDT 36″ w/ Flare NEMA 1
PENN P70DA-1C 50/450 Manual Open HI 36″ w/ Flare NEMA 1
PENN P70KA-1C 50/450 Manual M-Block 36″ w/ Flare NEMA 1 (3)
ALCO FF115-S5 BRA 90/450 Manual SPDT None External Flare NEMA 1
ALCO PS1-Y5A 330/390 90/450 Manual SPDT None External Flare NEMA 1
PENN P170DA-1C 50/450 Manual Open HI None External Flare NEMA 1

Notes:

    1. Main opens HI, auxilliary opens LO (primarily used for alarm circuit).

Cross-Reference

ALCO® Cross Reference (Continued)

Dual Pressure Controls

Product # LO Side Differential HI Side Differential Capillary Connection Notes
ALCO FF215-S9 BAUK 24″/42 3/30 90/450 60 FXD 48″ W/ Flare
ALCO PS2-Y9K 24″/42 3/30 90/450 60 FXD 48″ W/ Flare
PENN P70SA-1C 12″/80 5/35 100/500 60 FXD 36″ W/ Flare
ALCO FF215-S7 BAUK 15″/100 7/70 90/450 60 FXD 48″ W/ Flare
ALCO PS2-Y7K 15″/100 7/70 90/450 60 FXD 48″ W/ Flare
PENN P70SA-1C 12″/80 5/35 100/500 60 FXD 36″ W/ Flare
ALCO FF215-S7 BAUA 15″/100 7/70 90/450 60 FXD None External Flare
ALCO PS2-Y7A 15″/100 7/70 90/450 60 FXD None External Flare
PENN P170SA-1C 12″/80 5/35 100/500 60 FXD None External Flare

Lube Oil Pressure Controls

Product # Range Reset Delay Capillary Connection Cover Notes
ALCO FD113-ZUK 4/65 ADJ Manual 20-150 secs. 36″ W/ Flare NEMA 1
PENN P28AA-**C 8/70 ADJ Manual Note (4) 36″ W/ Flare NEMA 1 (4)
PENN P45NCA-12C 9.0 FXD Manual 120 secs. 36″ W/ Flare NEMA 1 (5)
PENN P45NCA-82C 6.5 FXD Manual 45 secs. 36″ W/ Flare NEMA 1 (5)
ALCO FD113-ZU 4/65 ADJ Manual 20-150 secs. None External Flare NEMA 1
PENN P128AA-**C 8/70 ADJ Manual Note (4) None External Flare NEMA 1 (4)
PENN P145NCA-12C 9.0 FXD Manual 120 secs. None External Flare NEMA 1 (5)
PENN P145NCA-82C 6.5 FXD Manual 45 secs. None External Flare NEMA 1 (5)

Notes:

    1. Choose correct control below based on timing required and desired pressure connection:
P28AA-1 8/70# 90 Secs. 36″ W/ Flare
P28AA-2 8/70# 60 Secs. 36″ W/ Flare
P28AA-17 8/70# 120 Secs. 36″ W/ Flare
P28AA-18 8/70# 45 Secs. 36″ W/ Flare
P128AA-1 8/70# 90 Secs. None External Flare
P128AA-2 8/70# 60 Secs. None External Flare
P128AA-17 8/70# 120 Secs. None External Flare
    1. Verify timing specifications.

NOTES

NOTES

NOTES

NOTES

Johnson Controls offers a broad line of innovative, high performing and energy-saving HVAC and refrigeration controls

REFRIGERATION CONTROLS

VARIABLE SPEED DRIVES

VALVES

ACTUATORS

SENSORS & THERMOSTATS

HVAC CONTROL PANEL PRODUCTS

DAMPERS, LOUVERS & AIR MEASURING PRODUCTS

PNEUMATICS

We are in the business of building efficiency. We create buildings

and environments that help people achieve and enterprises succeed. We do that by delivering energy savings. Operational savings. And sustainable solutions. In fact,

PENN commercial refrigeration controls by Johnson Controls have been serving the cooling needs of millions of customers worldwide for more than 95 years.

For more information, or to purchase Johnson Controls products, call 1-800-275-5676 or 1-800-482-2778.

Johnson Controls, the Johnson Controls logo and the PENN by Johnson Controls logo are registered trademarks of Johnson Controls, Inc. in the United States of America and other countries. Other trademarks used herein may be trademarks or registered trademarks of other companies.

© 2015 Johnson Controls, Inc. P.O. Box 423, Milwaukee, WI 53201 Printed in USA PUBL-5510 (Rev. 10/15) www.johnsoncontrols.com

Johnson Controls Online Parts Catalog


ONLINE PARTS CATALOG



REV 1119

2019

Upgrading From 7000 Series to ZEC Direct Digital Controls (DDC)

The ZEC Series offers innovative and intuitive control solutions for DDC BACnet, and DDC non-communicating configurations. An integrated VAV Terminal Unit with DDC eliminates the coordination and difficulties associated with field-mounting.

All ZEC Retrofit Kit controllers are pre-installed in a control enclosure for quick and easy startup. The ZEC Controller requires a Wall Sensor, which is sold separately.

Sensor choices range from simple thermistor, up to models with warmer/cooler push buttons and an LCD display.

Also available through Web-Select is the Mobile Access Portal (MAP) Gateway Tool [sold separately]. MAP Gateway is a pocket-sized web server that leverages the power of Wi-Fi enabled devices such as smart phones, tablets, and laptops to allow for ZEC DDC commissioning, configuration, and access to building automation equipment.

Please see below for detailed Wall Sensor information, as well as 7000 Series to ZEC Cross-Reference information.

ZEC Direct Digital Control (DDC) MAP Gateway Tool (Sold Separately)

NS-8000 Series Network Sensors

For Use With Verasys DDC Non-Communicating and Verasys DDC BACnet Controllers

PC-01-0209

Vertical Wall Box or Surface-Mount Zone Temperature Sensor

3.4” x 5” x 1.1”

No Display

Screw Terminal Connectors No Logo

White Finish

PC-01-0210

Capacitive Touch Buttons

Warmer/Cooler Mode Interface

LED Setpoint Indicators

Temporary Occupancy Feature

PC-01-0211

Backlit LCD Display Touch Adjust Capability

Field-Selectable Default Display

Fahrenheit (F) / Celsius (C) Display Capability

Humidity and CO2 Sensors Screen Lockout

WALL SENSORS FOR ZEC500 and ZEC510 CONTROLLERS

OBSOLETED SEPTEMBER

2019

PC-01-0191

VERTICAL WALL BOX OR SURFACE MOUNT
  • NO LOGO ON FRONT FACE
  • LCD TEMPERATURE DISPLAY
  • TEMPERATURE SET POINT CAPABILITY WITH ROUND DIAL
  • F/C TOGGLE SWITCH FOR TEMPERATURE DISPLAY
  • SCREW TERMINAL CONNECTORS

PC-01-0194

  • VERTICAL WALL BOX OR SURFACE MOUNT
  • NO LOGO ON FRONT FACE
  • NO TEMPERATURE DISPLAY
  • WITHOUT F/C TOGGLE SWITCH FOR TEMPERATURE DISPLAY
  • SCREW TERMINAL CONNECTORS

NS_BTB_7003-2 NS_BTN_7003-2

NS_BTJ_7002-2

PC-01-0192

VERTICAL WALL BOX OR SURFACE MOUNT
  • NO LOGO ON FRONT FACE
  • LCD TEMPERATURE DISPLAY
  • TEMPERATURE SET POINT CAPABILITY WITH UP/DOWN PUSH BUTTONS
  • F/C TOGGLE SWITCH FOR TEMPERATURE DISPLAY
  • SCREW TERMINAL CONNECTORS

NS_BTP_7002-2

PC-01-0195

VERTICAL WALL BOX OR SURFACE MOUNT
  • NO LOGO ON FRONT FACE
  • NO TEMPERATURE DISPLAY
  • WITH WARMER/COOLER ADJUST
  • OCCUPANCY OVERRIDE BUTTON
  • WITHOUT F/C TOGGLE SWITCH FOR TEMPERATURE DISPLAY
  • SCREW TERMINAL CONNECTORS
  • THERMOSTAT ADDRESS SWITCH

NS_BTJ_7003-2

PC-01-0193

VERTICAL WALL BOX OR SURFACE MOUNT
  • NO LOGO ON FRONT FACE
  • DIGITAL TEMPERATURE DISPLAY
  • TEMPERATURE SET POINT CAPABILITY WITH UP/DOWN PUSH BUTTONS
  • F/C TOGGLE SWITCH FOR TEMPERATURE DISPLAY
  • SCREW TERMINAL CONNECTORS
  • THERMOSTAT ADDRESS SWITCH

ZEC RETROFIT KITS – 700 & 7000 SERIES REFERENCE GUIDE

700 Series Sequence 7000 Series Sequence Description ZEC Communication Comments
Standalone BACnet Verasys
SD701 SD7000 Single Duct Variable Air Volume Cooling 66-13070-01 thru -05 66-13071-01 thru -05 66-13076-01 thru -05
SD702, SD703, SD704, SD713, SD714, SD715, SD724, SD725, SD726 SD7001 Up to 3 Stages of Electric or Hot Water Reheat and Dual Minimum Setpoints 66-13070-11 66-13071-11 66-13076-11
SD7003 Proportional Modulating Hot Water Reheat and Dual Minimum Setpoints 66-13070-12 66-13071-12 66-13076-12
SD7004 Floating Modulating Hot Water Reheat and Dual Minimum Setpoints 66-13070-06 thru -10 66-13071-06 thru -10 66-13076-06 thru -10
SD7005 Proportional Modulating Electric (SSR) Reheat and Dual Minimum Setpoints 66-13070-12 66-13071-12 66-13076-12
SD705 SD7100 Summer/Winter Changeover and/or Morning Warmup 66-13070-01 thru -05 66-13071-01 thru -05 66-13076-01 thru -05 Morning Warmup Flow and Changeover changed through MAP or network connection
SD706, SD707, SD708, SD716, SD717, SD718 SD7101 Up to 3 Stages of Electric or Hot Water Reheat, Summer/Winter Changeover and/or Morning Warmup, and Dual Heating Minimum Setpoints 66-13070-11 66-13071-11 66-13076-11 Morning Warmup Flow and Changeover changed through MAP or network connection
SD7103 Proportional Modulating Hot Water Reheat, Summer/Winter Changeover and/or Morning Warmup, and Dual Heating Minimum Setpoints 66-13070-12 66-13071-12 66-13076-12 Morning Warmup Flow and Changeover changed through MAP or network connection
SD7104 Floating Modulating Hot Water Reheat, Summer/Winter Changeover and/or Morning Warmup, and Dual Heating Minimum Setpoints 66-13070-06 thru -10 66-13071-06 thru -10 66-13076-06 thru -10 Morning Warmup Flow and Changeover changed through MAP or network connection
SD7105 Proportional Modulating Electric (SSR) Reheat, Summer/Winter Changeover and/or Morning Warmup, and Dual Heating Minimum Setpoints 66-13070-12 66-13071-12 66-13076-12 Morning Warmup Flow and Changeover changed through MAP or network connection
SD7300 Morning Warmup 66-13070-01 thru -05 66-13071-01 thru -05 66-13076-01 thru -05 Morning Warmup Flow and Changeover changed through MAP or network connection
SD7301 Up to 3 Stages of Electric or Hot Water Reheat, Morning Warmup, and Dual Heating Minimum Setpoints 66-13070-11 66-13071-11 66-13076-11 Morning Warmup Flow and Changeover changed through MAP or network connection
SD7303 Modulating Hot Water Reheat, Morning Warmup, and Dual Heating Minimum Setpoints 66-13070-12 66-13071-12 66-13076-12 Morning Warmup Flow and Changeover changed through MAP or network connection
SD7304 Floating Modulating Hot Water Reheat, Morning Warmup, and Dual Heating Minimum Setpoints 66-13070-06 thru -10 66-13071-06 thru -10 66-13076-06 thru -10 Morning Warmup Flow and Changeover changed through MAP or network connection
SD7305 Proportional Modulating Electric (SSR) Reheat, Morning Warmup, and Dual Heating Minimum Setpoints 66-13070-12 66-13071-12 66-13076-12 Morning Warmup Flow and Changeover changed through MAP or network connection
SD723 SD7600 Single Duct Dual Flow Constant Volume Cooling 66-13070-01 thru -05 66-13071-01 thru -05 66-13076-01 thru -05 Set All Airflows Constant
SD727, SD728 SD7606 / SD7607 Static Pressure Control Contact Factory Contact Factory Contact Factory
DT7100 / DD7100 Dual Duct Constant or Variable Volume Discharge Control Contact Factory Contact Factory Contact Factory
DD7200 Dual Duct Variable Volume Discharge Controls Contact Factory Contact Factory Contact Factory
DD7300 Single Duct Variable Air Volume Cooling With Constant Outside Air Volume Contact Factory Contact Factory Contact Factory
FC701, FC702, FC703 FC7001 Up to 2 Stages of Electric or Hot Water Heat 66-13072-01 thru -05, or -11 66-13073-01 thru -05, or -11 66-13077-01 thru -05, or -11
FC704 FC7002 3 Stages of Electric Heat 66-13072-11 66-13073-11 66-13077-11
FC7003 Proportional Modulating Hot Water Heat 66-13072-12 66-13073-12 66-13077-12
FC7004 Floating Modulating Hot Water Heat 66-13072-06 thru -10 66-13073-06 thru -10 66-13077-06 thru -10
FC7005 Proportional Modulating Electric (SSR) Heat 66-13072-12 66-13073-12 66-13077-12
FC713, FC714, FC715 FC7101 Summer/Winter Changeover and/or Morning Warmup and Up to 2 Stages of Electric or Hot Water Heat 66-13072-01 thru -05, or -11 66-13073-01 thru -05, or -11 66-13077-01 thru -05, or -11 Morning Warmup Flow and Changeover changed through MAP or network connection
FC716 FC7102 Summer/Winter Changeover and/or Morning Warmup and 3 Stages of Electric Heat 66-13072-11 66-13073-11 66-13077-11 Morning Warmup Flow and Changeover changed through MAP or network connection
FC7103 Summer/Winter Changeover and/or Morning Warmup and Proportional Modulating Hot Water Heat 66-13072-12 66-13073-12 66-13077-12 Morning Warmup Flow and Changeover changed through MAP or network connection
FC7104 Summer/Winter Changeover and/or Morning Warmup and Floating Modulating Hot Water Heat 66-13072-06 thru -10 66-13073-06 thru -10 66-13077-06 thru -10 Morning Warmup Flow and Changeover changed through MAP or network connection
FC7105 Summer/Winter Changeover and/or Morning Warmup and Proportional Modulating Electric (SSR) Heat 66-13072-12 66-13073-12 66-13077-12 Morning Warmup Flow and Changeover changed through MAP or network connection
FC705, FC706, FC707 FC7201 Up to 2 Stages of Electric or Hot Water Heat and Night Setback 66-13072-01 thru -05, or -11 66-13073-01 thru -05, or -11 66-13077-01 thru -05, or -11 Night Setback Setpoints changed through MAP or network connection
FC708 FC7202 3 Stages of Electric Heat and Night Setback 66-13072-11 66-13073-11 66-13077-11 Night Setback Setpoints changed through MAP or network connection
FC7203 Proportional Modulating Hot Water Heat and Night Setback 66-13072-12 66-13073-12 66-13077-12 Night Setback Setpoints changed through MAP or network connection
FC7204 Floating Modulating Hot Water Heat and Night Setback 66-13072-06 thru -10 66-13073-06 thru -10 66-13077-06 thru -10 Night Setback Setpoints changed through MAP or network connection
FC7205 Proportional Modulating Electric (SSR) Heat and Night Setback 66-13072-12 66-13073-12 66-13077-12 Night Setback Setpoints changed through MAP or network connection
FC7301 Morning Warmup and Up to 2 Stages of Electric or Hot Water Heat 66-13072-01 thru -05, or -11 66-13073-01 thru -05, or -11 66-13077-01 thru -05, or -11 Morning Warmup Flow changed through MAP or network connection
FC7302 Morning Warmup and 3 Stages of Electric Heat 66-13072-11 66-13073-11 66-13077-11 Morning Warmup Flow changed through MAP or network connection
FC7303 Morning Warmup and Proportional Modulating Hot Water Heat 66-13072-12 66-13073-12 66-13077-12 Morning Warmup Flow changed through MAP or network connection
FC7304 Morning Warmup and Floating Modulating Hot Water Heat 66-13072-06 thru -10 66-13073-06 thru -10 66-13077-06 thru -10 Morning Warmup Flow changed through MAP or network connection
FC7305 Morning Warmup and Proportional Modulating Electric (SSR) Heat 66-13072-12 66-13073-12 66-13077-12 Morning Warmup Flow changed through MAP or network connection
FC717, FC718, FC719 FC7401 Up to 2 Stages of Electric or Hot Water Heat, Night Setback and Morning Warmup 66-13072-01 thru -05, or -11 66-13073-01 thru -05, or -11 66-13077-01 thru -05, or -11 Night Setback Setpoints and Morning Warmup Flow changed through MAP or network connection
FC720 FC7402 3 Stages of Electric Heat, Night Setback and Morning Warmup 66-13072-11 66-13073-11 66-13077-11 Night Setback Setpoints and Morning Warmup Flow changed through MAP or network connection
FC7403 Proportional Modulating Hot Water Heat, Night Setback and Morning Warmup 66-13072-12 66-13073-12 66-13077-12 Night Setback Setpoints and Morning Warmup Flow changed through MAP or network connection
FC7404 Floating Modulating Hot Water Heat, Night Setback and Morning Warmup 66-13072-06 thru -10 66-13073-06 thru -10 66-13077-06 thru -10 Night Setback Setpoints and Morning Warmup Flow changed through MAP or network connection
FC7405 Floating Modulating Electric (SSR) Heat, Night Setback and Morning Warmup 66-13072-12 66-13073-12 66-13077-12 Night Setback Setpoints and Morning Warmup Flow changed through MAP or network connection
FC7501 Up to 2 Stages of Electric or Hot Water Heat, Night Setback and Summer Winter Changeover and/or Morning Warmup 66-13072-01 thru -05, or -11 66-13073-01 thru -05, or -11 66-13077-01 thru -05, or -11 Night Setback Setpoints, Morning Warmup Flow and Changeover changed through MAP or network connection
FC7502 3 Stages of Electric Heat, Night Setback and Summer/Winter Changeover and/or Morning Warmup 66-13072-11 66-13073-11 66-13077-11 Night Setback Setpoints, Morning Warmup Flow and Changeover changed through MAP or network connection
FC7503 Proportional Modulating Hot Water Heat, Night Setback and Summer/Winter Changeover and/or Morning Warmup 66-13072-12 66-13073-12 66-13077-12 Night Setback Setpoints, Morning Warmup Flow and Changeover changed through MAP or network connection
FC7504 Floating Modulating Hot Water Heat, Night Setback and Summer/Winter Changeover and/or Morning Warmup 66-13072-06 thru -10 66-13073-06 thru -10 66-13077-06 thru -10 Night Setback Setpoints, Morning Warmup Flow and Changeover changed through MAP or network connection
FC7505 Floating Modulating Electric (SSR) Heat, Night Setback and Summer/Winter Changeover and/or Morning Warmup 66-13072-12 66-13073-12 66-13077-12 Night Setback Setpoints, Morning Warmup Flow and Changeover changed through MAP or network connection
FV701, FV702, FV703 FV7001 Up to 2 Stages of Electric or Hot Water Heat 66-13074-01 thru -05, or -11 66-13075-01 thru -05, or -11 66-13078-01 thru -05, or -11
FV704 FV7002 3 Stages of Electric Heat 66-13074-11 66-13075-11 66-13078-11
FV7003 Proportional Modulating Hot Water Heat 66-13074-12 66-13075-12 66-13078-12
FV7004 Floating Modulating Hot Water Heat 66-13074-06 thru -10 66-13075-06 thru -10 66-13078-06 thru -10
FV7005 Proportional Modulating Electric (SSR) Heat 66-13074-12 66-13075-12 66-13078-12
FV717, FV718, FV719 FV7101 Up to 2 Stages of Electric or Hot Water Heat and Summer/Winter Changeover and/or Morning Warmup 66-13074-01 thru -05, or -11 66-13075-01 thru -05, or -11 66-13078-01 thru -05, or -11 Morning Warmup Flow and Changeover changed through MAP or network connection
FV720 FV7102 3 Stages of Electric Heat and Summer/Winter Changeover and/or Morning Warmup 66-13074-11 66-13075-11 66-13078-11 Morning Warmup Flow and Changeover changed through MAP or network connection
FV7103 Proportional Modulating Hot Water Heat and Summer/Winter Changeover and/or Morning Warmup 66-13074-12 66-13075-12 66-13078-12 Morning Warmup Flow and Changeover changed through MAP or network connection
FV7104 Floating Modulating Hot Water Heat and Summer/Winter Changeover and/or Morning Warmup 66-13074-06 thru -10 66-13075-06 thru -10 66-13078-06 thru -10 Morning Warmup Flow and Changeover changed through MAP or network connection
FV7105 Proportional Electric (SSR) Heat and Summer/Winter Changeover and/or Morning Warmup 66-13074-12 66-13075-12 66-13078-12 Morning Warmup Flow and Changeover changed through MAP or network connection
FV705, FV706, FV707 FV7201 Up to 2 Stages of Electric or Hot Water Heat and Night Setback 66-13074-01 thru -05, or -11 66-13075-01 thru -05, or -11 66-13078-01 thru -05, or -11 Night Setback Setpoints changed through MAP or network connection
FV708 FV7202 3 Stages of Electric Heat and Night Setback 66-13074-11 66-13075-11 66-13078-11 Night Setback Setpoints changed through MAP or network connection
FV7203 Proportional Modulating Hot Water Heat and Night Setback 66-13074-12 66-13075-12 66-13078-12 Night Setback Setpoints changed through MAP or network connection
FV7204 Floating Modulating Hot Water Heat and Night Setback 66-13074-06 thru -10 66-13075-06 thru -10 66-13078-06 thru -10 Night Setback Setpoints changed through MAP or network connection
FV7205 Proportional Modulating Electric (SSR) Heat and Night Setback 66-13074-12 66-13075-12 66-13078-12 Night Setback Setpoints changed through MAP or network connection
FV7301 Up to 2 Stages of Electric or Hot Water Heat and Morning Warmup 66-13074-01 thru -05, or -11 66-13075-01 thru -05, or -11 66-13078-01 thru -05, or -11 Morning Warmup Flow changed through MAP or network connection
FV7302 3 Stages of Electric Heat and Morning Warmup 66-13074-11 66-13075-11 66-13078-11 Morning Warmup Flow changed through MAP or network connection
FV7303 Proportional Modulating Hot Water Heat and Morning Warmup 66-13074-12 66-13075-12 66-13078-12 Morning Warmup Flow changed through MAP or network connection
FV7304 Floating Modulating Hot Water Heat and Morning Warmup 66-13074-06 thru -10 66-13075-06 thru -10 66-13078-06 thru -10 Morning Warmup Flow changed through MAP or network connection
FV7305 Proportional Modulating Electric (SSR) Heat and Morning Warmup 66-13074-12 66-13075-12 66-13078-12 Morning Warmup Flow changed through MAP or network connection
FV721, FV722, FV723 FV7401 Up to 2 Stages of Electric or Hot Water Heat, Night Setback and Morning Warmup 66-13074-01 thru -05, or -11 66-13075-01 thru -05, or -11 66-13078-01 thru -05, or -11 Night Setback Setpoints and Morning Warmup Flow changed through MAP or network connection
FV724 FV7402 3 Stages of Electric Heat, Night Setback and Morning Warmup 66-13074-11 66-13075-11 66-13078-11 Night Setback Setpoints and Morning Warmup Flow changed through MAP or network connection
FV7403 Proportional Modulating Hot Water Heat, Night Setback and Morning Warmup 66-13074-12 66-13075-12 66-13078-12 Night Setback Setpoints and Morning Warmup Flow changed through MAP or network connection
FV7404 Floating Modulating Hot Water Heat, Night Setback and Morning Warmup 66-13074-06 thru -10 66-13075-06 thru -10 66-13078-06 thru -10 Night Setback Setpoints and Morning Warmup Flow changed through MAP or network connection
FV7405 Proportional Modulating Electric (SSR) Heat, Night Setback and Morning Warmup 66-13074-12 66-13075-12 66-13078-12 Night Setback Setpoints and Morning Warmup Flow changed through MAP or network connection
FV7501 Up to 2 Stages of Electric or Hot Water Heat, Night Setback and Summer/Winter Changeover and/or Morning Warmup 66-13074-01 thru -05, or -11 66-13075-01 thru -05, or -11 66-13078-01 thru -05, or -11 Night Setback Setpoints, Morning Warmup Flow and Changeover changed through MAP or network connection
FV7502 3 Stages of Electric Heat, Night Setback and Summer/Winter Changeover and/or Morning Warmup 66-13074-11 66-13075-11 66-13078-11 Night Setback Setpoints, Morning Warmup Flow and Changeover changed through MAP or network connection
FV7503 Proportional Modulating Hot Water Heat, Night Setback and Summer/Winter Changeover and/or Morning Warmup 66-13074-12 66-13075-12 66-13078-12 Night Setback Setpoints, Morning Warmup Flow and Changeover changed through MAP or network connection
FV7504 Floating Modulating Hot Water Heat, Night Setback and Summer/Winter Changeover and/or Morning Warmup 66-13074-06 thru -10 66-13075-06 thru -10 66-13078-06 thru -10 Night Setback Setpoints, Morning Warmup Flow and Changeover changed through MAP or network connection
FV7505 Proportional Modulating Electric (SSR) Heat, Night Setback and Summer/Winter Changeover and/or Morning Warmup 66-13074-12 66-13075-12 66-13078-12 Night Setback Setpoints, Morning Warmup Flow and Changeover changed through MAP or network connection

070319 – REV 1.0

ZEC RETROFIT KITS – UNIT TYPE REFERENCE GUIDE

ZEC Communication Unit Type Heating Type ZEC Sequence (Info Only) Transformer Assembly Number
Standalone (ZEC500) Single Duct None SDCZEC101 None 66-13070-01
120V 66-13070-02
208-240V 66-13070-03
277V 66-13070-04
480V 66-13070-05
HW Incremental SDCZEC102 None 66-13070-06
120V 66-13070-07
208-240V 66-13070-08
277V 66-13070-09
480V 66-13070-10
Staged EH SDCZEC103 None 66-13070-11
Proportional EH SDCZEC104 None 66-13070-12
Series Flow None FPCZEC101 None 66-13072-01
120V 66-13072-02
208-240V 66-13072-03
277V 66-13072-04
480V 66-13072-05
HW Incremental FPCZEC102 None 66-13072-06
120V 66-13072-07
208-240V 66-13072-08
277V 66-13072-09
480V 66-13072-10
Staged EH FPCZEC103 None 66-13072-11
Proportional EH FPCZEC104 None 66-13072-12
Parallel Flow None FPCZEC101 None 66-13074-01
120V 66-13074-02
208-240V 66-13074-03
277V 66-13074-04
480V 66-13074-05
HW Incremental FPCZEC102 None 66-13074-06
120V 66-13074-07
208-240V 66-13074-08
277V 66-13074-09
480V 66-13074-10
Staged EH FPCZEC103 None 66-13074-11
Proportional EH FPCZEC104 None 66-13074-12
BACnet (ZEC510) Single Duct None SDCZEC201 None 66-13071-01
120V 66-13071-02
208-240V 66-13071-03
277V 66-13071-04
480V 66-13071-05
HW Incremental SDCZEC202 None 66-13071-06
120V 66-13071-07
208-240V 66-13071-08
277V 66-13071-09
480V 66-13071-10
Staged EH SDCZEC203 None 66-13071-11
Proportional EH SDCZEC204 None 66-13071-12
Series Flow None FPCZEC201 None 66-13073-01
120V 66-13073-02
208-240V 66-13073-03
277V 66-13073-04
480V 66-13073-05
HW Incremental FPCZEC202 None 66-13073-06
120V 66-13073-07
208-240V 66-13073-08
277V 66-13073-09
480V 66-13073-10
Staged EH FPCZEC203 None 66-13073-11
Proportional EH FPCZEC204 None 66-13073-12
Parallel Flow None FPCZEC201 None 66-13075-01
120V 66-13075-02
208-240V 66-13075-03
277V 66-13075-04
480V 66-13075-05
HW Incremental FPCZEC202 None 66-13075-06
120V 66-13075-07
208-240V 66-13075-08
277V 66-13075-09
480V 66-13075-10
Staged EH FPCZEC203 None 66-13075-11
Proportional EH FPCZEC204 None 66-13075-12

070319 – REV 1.0

Blower Coil Parts Price List

All List Prices Subject to Change Revision Date: February 2014



©2014 Johnson Controls, Inc.

Blower Coil Parts Price List

All List Prices Subject to Change Revision Date: February 2014





©2014 Johnson Controls, Inc.

Blower Coil Parts Price List

All List Prices Subject to Change Revision Date: February 2014





©2014 Johnson Controls, Inc.

Blower Coil Parts Price List

All List Prices Subject to Change Revision Date: February 2014





©2014 Johnson Controls, Inc.

COILS

Blower Coil Parts Price List

All List Prices Subject to Change Revision Date: February 2014

TAPERED BUSHINGS
PART # DESCRIPTION LIST
PM-01-0612 H1 x 1″
PM-01-0614 1 x 1 3/16″
PM-01-0610 H1 x 3/4″
PM-01-0620 Q1 x 1 7/16″
PM-01-0624 Q1 x 1 11/16″
BEARINGS
PART # DESCRIPTION LIST
PM-11-0000 3/4″ 0.75 BORE x 2.50 O.D.
PM-11-0001 1″ 1.00 BORE x 2.50 O.D.
PM-11-0002 1 3/16″ 1.18 BORE x 2.50 O.D.
PM-11-0008 1 7/16″ BROWNING VPE-123
PM-11-0009 1 11/16″ BROWNING VPE-127
BEARING MOUNTING FRAMES (Spider Bracket)
PART # DESCRIPTION LIST
PM-06-0050 9″ 04-08101
PM-06-0051 10″ 04-08102
PM-06-0052 15″ 04-08105
FILTERS
2″ Pleated 25 – 30 %
PM-04-2002 16 x 20 x 2
PM-04-2004 16 x 25 x 2
PM-04-2010 20 x 20 x 2
PM-04-2012 20 x 25 x 2
4″ High Efficiency 65%
PM-04-2104 16 x 20 x 4
PM-04-2105 16 x 25 x 4
PM-04-2108 20 x 25 x 4
4″ High Efficiency 85%
PM-04-2124 16 x 20 x 4
PM-04-2125 16 x 25 x 4
PM-04-2128 20 x 25 x 4
4″ High Efficiency 95%
PM-04-2144 16 x 20 x 4
PM-04-2145 16 x 25 x 4
PM-04-2148 20 x 25 x 4

Contact the Parts Department for coil part numbers and prices. Please have the customer order number, line number, and unit tag number available.

BLOWERS
PART # DESCRIPTION LIST
PM-06-0105 Blower, FC DWDI, Tight Housing, 9″Ø By 4″ Wide Wheel w/ 0.75″ Bore & 2, 5/16-18 setscrews, Class I
PM-06-0047 Blower, FC DWDI, 9″Ø By 6″ Wide Wheel w/ 0.75″ Bore & 2, 5/16-18 setscrews, Class I
PM-06-0106 Blower, FC DWDI, 9″Ø By 9″ Wide Wheel w/ 0.75″ Bore & 2, 5/16-18 setscrews, Class I
PM-06-0107 Blower, FC DWDI, 10″Ø By 8″ Wide Wheel w/ 0.75″ Bore & 2, 5/16-18 setscrews, Class I
PM-06-0108 Blower, FC DWDI, 10″Ø By 8″ Wide Wheel w/ 1.00″ Bore & 2, 5/16-18 setscrews, Class I
PM-06-0109 Blower, FC DWDI, 10″Ø By 10″ Wide Wheel w/ 0.75″ Bore & 2, 5/16-18 setscrews, Class I
PM-06-0110 Blower, FC DWDI, 10″Ø By 10″ Wide Wheel w/ 1.00″ Bore & 2, 5/16-18 setscrews, Class I
PM-06-0111 Blower, FC DWDI, 15″Ø By 9″ Wide Wheel w/ 1.00″ Bore & 2, 5/16-18 setscrews, Class I
PM-06-0112 Blower, FC DWDI, 15″Ø By 9″ Wide Wheel w/ 1.19″ Bore & 2, 5/16-18 setscrews, Class I
PM-06-0113 Blower, FC DWDI, 15″Ø By 9″ Wide Wheel w/ 1.44″ Bore & 2, 5/16-18 setscrews, Class I
PM-06-0104 Blower, FC DWDI, 15″Ø By 11″ Wide Wheel w/ 1.0″ Bore & 1, 5/16-18 setscrew w/ 1/4 x 1/8 keyway, Class I No Frame
PM-06-0114 Blower, FC DWDI, 15″Ø By 11″ Wide Wheel w/ 1.19″ Bore & 2, 5/16-18 setscrews, Class I
PM-06-0115 Blower, FC DWDI, 15″Ø By 11″ Wide Wheel w/ 1.44″ Bore & 2, 5/16-18 setscrews, Class I
PM-06-0116 Blower, FC DWDI, 15″Ø By 15″ Wide Wheel w/ 1.19″ Bore & 2, 5/16-18 setscrews, Class I
PM-06-0117 Blower, FC DWDI, 15″Ø By 15″ Wide Wheel w/ 1.69″ Bore & 2, 5/16-18 setscrews, Class I
SHEAVE PRICING (All Blower Coil Units)
PART # DESCRIPTION VENDOR # LIST
PM-01-0002 SHEAVE, ADJ, 1VL44 X 1/2 1VL 44 X 1/2
PM-01-0004 SHEAVE, ADJ, 1VL 44 X 5/8 1VL 44 X 5/8
PM-01-0006 SHEAVE, ADJ, 1VL 44 X 7/8 1VL 44 X 7/8
PM-01-0008 SHEAVE, ADJ, 1VM 50 X 1/2 1VM 50 X 1/2
PM-01-0010 SHEAVE, ADJ, 1VM 50 X 5/8 1VM 50 X 5/8
PM-01-0012 SHEAVE, ADJ, 1VM 50 X 7/8 1VM 50 X 7/8
PM-01-0014 SHEAVE, ADJ, 1VP56 X 5/8 1VP 56 X 5/8
PM-01-0016 SHEAVE, ADJ, 1VP 56 X 1-1/8 1VP 56 X 1-1/8
PM-01-0017 SHEAVE, ADJ, 1VP62 X 1-1/8 1VP 62 X 1-1/8
PM-01-0018 SHEAVE, ADJ, 2VP 62 X 1-3/8 2VP 62 X 1-3/8
PM-01-0020 SHEAVE, ADJ, 1VP62 X 5/8 1VP 62 X 5/8
PM-01-0022 SHEAVE, ADJ, 1VP62 X 7/8 1VP 62 X 7/8
PM-01-0108 SHEAVE, FIXED, AK44 X 3/4 AK44 X 3/4
PM-01-0110 SHEAVE, FIXED, AK49 X 3/4 AK49 X 3/4
PM-01-0112 SHEAVE, FIXED, AK51 X 3/4 AK51 X 3/4
PM-01-0114 SHEAVE, FIXED, AK54 X 3/4 AK54 X 3/4
PM-01-0116 SHEAVE, FIXED, AK56 X 3/4 AK56 X 3/4
PM-01-0118 SHEAVE, FIXED, AK59 X 3/4 AK59 X 3/4
PM-01-0120 SHEAVE, FIXED, AK64 X 3/4 AK64 X 3/4
PM-01-0122 SHEAVE, FIXED, AK69 X 3/4 AK69 X 3/4
PM-01-0124 SHEAVE, FIXED AK74 X 3/4 AK74 X 3/4
PM-01-0126 SHEAVE, FIXED, AK79 X 3/4 AK79 X 3/4
PM-01-0128 SHEAVE, FIXED, AK84 X 3/4 AK84 X 3/4
PM-01-0130 SHEAVE, FIXED, AK89 X 3/4 AK89 X 3/4
PM-01-0132 SHEAVE, FIXED, AK94 X 3/4 AK94 X 3/4
PM-01-0134 SHEAVE, FIXED, AK99 X 3/4 AK99 X 3/4
PM-01-0136 SHEAVE, FIXED, AK104 X 3/4 AK104 X 3/4
PM-01-0138 SHEAVE, FIXED, AK109 X 3/4 AK109 X 3/4
PM-01-0140 SHEAVE, FIXED, AK114 X 3/4 AK114 X 3/4
PM-01-0210 SHEAVE, FIXED, AK44H AK44H
PM-01-0212 SHEAVE, FIXED, AK49H AK49H
PM-01-0214 SHEAVE, FIXED, AK54H AK54H
PM-01-0216 SHEAVE, FIXED, AK59H AK59H
PM-01-0218 SHEAVE, FIXED, AK64H AK64H
PM-01-0222 SHEAVE, FIXED AK69H AK69H
PM-01-0224 SHEAVE, FIXED, AK74H AK74H
PM-01-0226 SHEAVE, FIXED AK79H AK79H
PM-01-0228 SHEAVE, FIXED, AK89H AK89H
PM-01-0230 SHEAVE, FIXED, AK94H AK94H
PM-01-0232 SHEAVE, FIXED, AK99H AK99H
PM-01-0234 SHEAVE, FIXED, AK104H AK104H
PM-01-0236 SHEAVE, FIXED, AK109H AK109H
PM-01-0238 SHEAVE, FIXED, AK114H AK114H
PM-01-0240 SHEAVE, FIXED, AK124H AK124H
PM-01-0306 SHEAVE, FIXED, BK55H BK55H
PM-01-0308 SHEAVE, FIXED, BK62H BK62H
PM-01-0310 SHEAVE, FIXED, BK70H BK70H
PM-01-0312 SHEAVE, FIXED, BK80H BK80H
PM-01-0314 SHEAVE, FIXED, BK90H BK90H
PM-01-0316 SHEAVE, FIXED, BK100H BK100H
PM-01-0318 SHEAVE, FIXED, BK110H BK110H
PM-01-0320 SHEAVE, FIXED, BK120H BK120H
PM-01-0322 SHEAVE, FIXED, BK130H BK130H
PM-01-0324 SHEAVE, FIXED, BK140H BK140H
PM-01-0326 SHEAVE, FIXED, BK150H BK150H
PM-01-0328 SHEAVE, FIXED, BK160H BK160H
PM-01-0410 SHEAVE, FIXED, 2BK70H 2BK70H
PM-01-0412 SHEAVE, FIXED, 2BK80H 2BK80H
PM-01-0414 SHEAVE, FIXED, 2BK90H 2BK90H
PM-01-0416 SHEAVE, FIXED, 2BK100H 2BK100H
PM-01-0418 SHEAVE, FIXED, 2BK110H 2BK110H
PM-01-0420 SHEAVE, FIXED, 2BK120H 2BK120H
PM-01-0422 SHEAVE, FIXED, 2BK130H 2BK130H
PM-01-0424 SHEAVE, FIXED, 2BK140H 2BK140H
PM-01-0426 SHEAVE, FIXED, 2BK160H 2BK160H
PM-01-0508 SHEAVE, FIXED, 2TB64Q 2TP64Q
PM-01-0510 SHEAVE, FIXED, 2TB70Q 2TB70Q
PM-01-0512 SHEAVE, FIXED, 2TB80Q 2TB80Q
PM-01-0514 SHEAVE, FIXED, 2TB90Q 2TB90Q
PM-01-0515 SHEAVE, FIXED, 2TB94Q 2TB94Q
PM-01-0516 SHEAVE, FIXED, 2TB110Q 2TB110Q
PM-01-0518 SHEAVE, FIXED, 2TB124Q 2TB124Q
PM-01-0520 SHEAVE, FIXED, 2TB136Q 2TB136Q
PM-01-0522 SHEAVE, FIXED, 2TB154Q 2TB154Q
PM-01-0524 SHEAVE, FIXED, 2TB160Q 2TB160Q

BELT PRICING (All Blower Coil Units)

PART # DESCRIPTION TYPE LIST
PM-05-0010 BELT, V-TYPE, 4L300 BELT
PM-05-0011 BELT, V-TYPE, 4L310 BELT
PM-05-0012 BELT, V-TYPE, 4L320 BELT
PM-05-0013 BELT, V-TYPE, 4L330 BELT
PM-05-0014 BELT, V-TYPE, 4L340 BELT
PM-05-0015 BELT, V-TYPE, 4L350 BELT
PM-05-0016 BELT, V-TYPE, 4L360 BELT
PM-05-0017 BELT, V-TYPE, 4L370 BELT
PM-05-0018 BELT, V-TYPE, 4L380 BELT
PM-05-0019 BELT, V-TYPE, 4L390 BELT
PM-05-0020 BELT, V-TYPE, 4L400 BELT
PM-05-0021 BELT, V-TYPE, 4L410 BELT
PM-05-0022 BELT, V-TYPE, 4L420 BELT
PM-05-0023 BELT, V-TYPE, 4L430 BELT
PM-05-0024 BELT, V-TYPE, 4L440 BELT
PM-05-0025 BELT, V-TYPE, 4L450 BELT
PM-05-0026 BELT, V-TYPE, 4L460 BELT
PM-05-0027 BELT, V-TYPE, 4L470 BELT
PM-05-0028 BELT, V-TYPE, 4L480 BELT
PM-05-0029 BELT, V-TYPE, 4L490 BELT
PM-05-0030 BELT, V-TYPE, 4L500 BELT
PM-05-0031 BELT, V-TYPE, 4L510 BELT
PM-05-0032 BELT, V-TYPE, 4L520 BELT
PM-05-0033 BELT, V-TYPE, 4L530 BELT
PM-05-0034 BELT, V-TYPE, 4L540 BELT
PM-05-0035 BELT, V-TYPE, 4L550 BELT
PM-05-0036 BELT, V-TYPE, 4L560 BELT
PM-05-0037 BELT, V-TYPE, 4L570 BELT
PM-05-0038 BELT, V-TYPE, 4L580 BELT
PM-05-0039 BELT, V-TYPE, 4L590 BELT
PM-05-0040 BELT, V-TYPE, 4L600 BELT
PM-05-0100 BELT, V-TYPE, 3L280 BELT
PM-05-0101 BELT, V-TYPE, 3L290 BELT
PM-05-0102 BELT, V-TYPE, 3L300 BELT
PM-05-0103 BELT, V-TYPE, 3L310 BELT
PM-05-0104 BELT, V-TYPE, 3L320 BELT
PM-05-0105 BELT, V-TYPE, 3L330 BELT
PM-05-0106 BELT, V-TYPE, 3L340 BELT
PM-05-0107 BELT, V-TYPE, 3L350 BELT
PM-05-0108 BELT, V-TYPE, 3L360 BELT
PM-05-0208 BELT,V-SUPER, A28 BELT
PM-05-0209 BELT, V-SUPER, A29 BELT
PM-05-0210 BELT, V-SUPER, A30 BELT
PM-05-0211 BELT, V-SUPER, A31 BELT
PM-05-0212 BELT, V-SUPER, A32 BELT
PM-05-0213 BELT, V-SUPER, A33 BELT
PM-05-0214 BELT, V-SUPER, A34 BELT
PM-05-0215 BELT, V-SUPER, A35 BELT
PM-05-0216 BELT, V-SUPER, A36 BELT
PM-05-0217 BELT, V-SUPER, A37 BELT
PM-05-0218 BELT, V-SUPER, A38 BELT
PM-05-0219 BELT, V-SUPER, A39 BELT
PM-05-0220 BELT, V-SUPER, A40 BELT
PM-05-0221 BELT, V-SUPER, A41 BELT
PM-05-0222 BELT, V-SUPER, A42 BELT
PM-05-0223 BELT, V-SUPER, A43 BELT
PM-05-0224 BELT, V-SUPER, A44 BELT
PM-05-0225 BELT, V-SUPER, A45 BELT
PM-05-0226 BELT, V-SUPER, A46 BELT
PM-05-0227 BELT, V-SUPER, A47 BELT
PM-05-0228 BELT, V-SUPER, A48 BELT
PM-05-0229 BELT, V-SUPER, A49 BELT
PM-05-0230 BELT, V-SUPER, A50 BELT
PM-05-0231 BELT, V-SUPER, A51 BELT
PM-05-0232 BELT, V-SUPER, A52 BELT
PM-05-0233 BELT, V-SUPER, A53 BELT
PM-05-0234 BELT, V-SUPER, A54 BELT
PM-05-0235 BELT, V-SUPER, A55 BELT
PM-05-0236 BELT, V-SUPER, A56 BELT
PM-05-0237 BELT, V-SUPER, A57 BELT
PM-05-0238 BELT, V-SUPER, A58 BELT
PM-05-0239 BELT, V-SUPER, A59 BELT
PM-05-0240 BELT, V-SUPER, A60 BELT
PM-05-0241 BELT,V-SUPER, A61 BELT
PM-05-0242 BELT, V-SUPER, A62 BELT
PM-05-0407 BELT, V-SUPER, B27 BELT
PM-05-0408 BELT,V-SUPER, B28 BELT
PM-05-0409 BELT, V-SUPER, B29 BELT
PM-05-0410 BELT, V-SUPER, B30 BELT
PM-05-0411 BELT, V-SUPER, B31 BELT
PM-05-0412 BELT, V-SUPER, B32 BELT
PM-05-0413 BELT, V-SUPER, B33 BELT
PM-05-0414 BELT, V-SUPER, B34 BELT
PM-05-0415 BELT, V-SUPER, B35 BELT
PM-05-0416 BELT, V-SUPER, B36 BELT
PM-05-0417 BELT, V-SUPER, B37 BELT
PM-05-0418 BELT, V-SUPER, B38 BELT
PM-05-0419 BELT, V-SUPER, B39 BELT
PM-05-0420 BELT, V-SUPER, B40 BELT
PM-05-0421 BELT, V-SUPER, B41 BELT
PM-05-0422 BELT, V-SUPER, B42 BELT
PM-05-0423 BELT, V-SUPER, B43 BELT
PM-05-0424 BELT, V-SUPER, B44 BELT
PM-05-0425 BELT, V-SUPER, B45 BELT
PM-05-0426 BELT, V-SUPER, B46 BELT
PM-05-0427 BELT, V-SUPER, B47 BELT
PM-05-0428 BELT, V-SUPER, B48 BELT
PM-05-0429 BELT, V-SUPER, B49 BELT
PM-05-0430 BELT, V-SUPER, B50 BELT
PM-05-0431 BELT, V-SUPER, B51 BELT
PM-05-0432 BELT, V-SUPER, B52 BELT
PM-05-0433 BELT, V-SUPER, B53 BELT
PM-05-0434 BELT, V-SUPER, B54 BELT
PM-05-0435 BELT, V-SUPER, B55 BELT
PM-05-0436 BELT, V-SUPER, B56 BELT
PM-05-0437 BELT, V-SUPER, B57 BELT
PM-05-0438 BELT, V-SUPER, B58 BELT
PM-05-0439 BELT, V-SUPER, B59 BELT
PM-05-0440 BELT, V-SUPER, B60 BELT
PM-05-0441 BELT, V-SUPER, B61 BELT
PM-05-0442 BELT, V-SUPER, B62 BELT
PM-05-0443 BELT, V-SUPER, B63 BELT
PM-05-0444 BELT, V-SUPER, B64 BELT
PM-05-0445 BELT, V-SUPER, B65 BELT
PM-05-0446 BELT, V-SUPER, B66 BELT
PM-05-0447 BELT, V-SUPER, B67 BELT
PM-05-0448 BELT, V-SUPER, B68 BELT
PM-05-0449 BELT, V-SUPER, B69 BELT
PM-05-0450 BELT, V-SUPER, B70 BELT
PM-05-0451 BELT, V-SUPER, B71 BELT
PM-05-0452 BELT, V-SUPER, B72 BELT
PM-05-0453 BELT, V-SUPER, B73 BELT
PM-05-0454 BELT, V-SUPER, B74 BELT
PM-05-0455 BELT, V-SUPER, B75 BELT
PM-05-0456 BELT, V-SUPER, B76 BELT
PM-05-0457 BELT, V-SUPER, B77 BELT
PM-05-0458 BELT, V-SUPER, B78 BELT
PM-05-0459 BELT, V-SUPER, B79 BELT
PM-05-0460 BELT, V-SUPER, B80 BELT
PM-05-0461 BELT, V-SUPER, B81 BELT
PM-05-0462 BELT, V-SUPER, B82 BELT
PM-05-0463 BELT, V-SUPER, B83 BELT
PM-05-0464 BELT, V-SUPER, B84 BELT
PM-05-0465 BELT, V-SUPER, B85 BELT
PM-05-0466 BELT, V-SUPER, B86 BELT
PM-05-0467 BELT, V-SUPER, B87 BELT
PM-05-0468 BELT, V-SUPER, B88 BELT
PM-05-0469 BELT, V-SUPER, B89 BELT
PM-05-0470 BELT, V-SUPER, B90 BELT

©2014 Johnson Controls, Inc.

Blower Coil Parts Price List

All List Prices Subject to Change Revision Date: February 2014

MODEL “AVI” ARRANGEMENT PANEL CONVERSION
UNIT SIZE UNIT ARGT TOP PANEL TOP PANEL LIST PRICE FRONT PANEL FRONT PANEL LIST PRICE REAR TOP FILLER PANEL REAR TOP FILLER LIST PRICE
08 1 B37-08A-298 B37-08-286 B37-08-285
2 B37-08A-298 B37-08-286 B37-08-285
3 B37-08-284 B37-08A-397 B37-08-285
7 B37-08-284 B37-08-286 B37-08A-406
12 1 B37-12C-298 B37-12-286 B37-12-285
2 B37-12C-298 B37-12-286 B37-12-285
3 B37-12-284 B37-12C-397 B37-12-285
7 B37-12-284 B37-12-286 B37-12C-406
16 1 B37-16-305 B37-16-286 B37-16-285
2 B37-16-305 B37-16-286 B37-16-285
3 B37-16-284 B37-16-279 B37-16-285
7 B37-16-284 B37-16-286 B37-16-281
20 1 B37-20-305 B37-20-286 B37-20-285
2 B37-20-305 B37-20-286 B37-20-285
3 B37-20-284 B37-20-279 B37-20-285
7 B37-20-284 B37-20-286 B37-20-281
30 1 B37-30B-208 B37-30-239 B37-30-240
2 B37-30B-208 B37-30-239 B37-30-240
3 B37-25/30-283 B37-30B-395 B37-30-240
7 B37-25/30-283 B37-30-239 B37-30B-404
40 1 B37-40C-208 B37-40-239 B37-40-240
2 B37-40C-208 B37-40-239 B37-40-240
3 B37-40-283 B37-40C-395 B37-40-240
7 B37-40-283 B37-40-239 B37-40C-404
MODEL “AHI” ARRANGEMENT PANEL CONVERSION
UNIT SIZE UNIT ARGT TOP PANEL TOP PANEL LIST PRICE FRONT PANEL FRONT PANEL LIST PRICE
08 1 B35-08A-832 B35-08-511
2 B35-08A-814 B35-08-511
3 B35-08-126 B35-08A-956
4 B35-08-126 B35-08A-956
12 1 B35-12A-832 B35-12-511
2 B35-12A-814 B35-12-511
3 B35-12-126 B35-12C-956
4 B35-12-126 B35-12C-956
16 1 B35-16A-832 B35-16-511
2 B35-16A-814 B35-16-511
3 B35-16-126 B35-16-744
4 B35-16-126 B35-16-744
20 1 B35-20A-832 B35-20-511
2 B35-20A-814 B35-20-511
3 B35-20-126 B35-20-744
4 B35-20-126 B35-20-744
1 B35-25/30A-832 B35-25/30-511
2 B35-25/30A-814 B35-25/30-511
30 3 B35-25/30-126 B35-30B-954
4 B35-25/30-126 B35-30B-954
40 1 B35-40A-832 B35-40-511
2 B35-40A-814 B35-40-511
3 B35-40-126 B35-40C-954
4 B35-40-126 B35-40C-954

©2014 Johnson Controls, Inc.

Blower Coil Parts Price List

All List Prices Subject to Change Revision Date: February 2014

BELT DRIVE MOTORS 1/3 – 3/4 HP
Motor Size HP Motor Type Voltage Speed Max Amps Min Eff. Part No. List
Single Phase Three Phase
ODP TEFC E+ 115 208 230 277 208 230 460 575 Single Dual
1/3 X X X 6.3 57 PM-02-1010
X 3.5 PM-02-1010
X 3.2 PM-02-1010
X X X 2.6 57 PM-02-1014
X X X 1.7 65 PM-02-1016
X 1.5 PM-02-1016
X 0.8 PM-02-1016
X X X 3.9/5.3 PM-02-1020
X X X 6 57 PM-02-1022
X 3.3 PM-02-1022
X 3 PM-02-1022
X X X 1.3 72 PM-02-1024
X 1.2 PM-02-1024
X 0.6 PM-02-1024
1/2 X X X 7.8 64.5 PM-02-1032
X 4.3 PM-02-1032
X 3.9 PM-02-1032
X X X 3.6 64.5 PM-02-1036
X X X 2.2 67 PM-02-1038
X 2.1 PM-02-1038
X 1.1 PM-02-1038
X X X 0.9 67 PM-02-1040
X X X 5.5/8.4 60.4 PM-02-1042
X X X 1.2/1.9 PM-02-1041
X 1.2/1.9 PM-02-1041
X X X 0.7/0.9 PM-02-1043
X X X 8 63 PM-02-1044
X 4 PM-02-1044
X 4 PM-02-1044
X X X 2.2 70 PM-02-1046
X 2.1 PM-02-1046
X 1.1 PM-02-1046
X X X 0.9 70 PM-02-1048
3/4 X X X 10.6 68 PM-02-1054
X 5.4 PM-02-1054
X 5.3 PM-02-1054
X X X 5 64.5 PM-02-1058
X X X 6.1/8.9 PM-02-1064
X X X 3.1/4.5 PM-02-1066
X X X 3.2 69 PM-02-1060
X 3 PM-02-1060
X 1.5 PM-02-1060
X X X 1.2 69 PM-02-1062
X 11.2 PM-02-1068
X X X 6.2 65 PM-02-1068
X 5.6 PM-02-1068
X X X 3.2 75.5 PM-02-1070
X 3 PM-02-1070
X 1.5 PM-02-1070
X X X 1.2 75.5 PM-02-1072

X 3.4 PM-02-1100

BELT DRIVE MOTORS 1 – 1.5 HP
Motor Size HP Motor Type Voltage Speed Max Amps Min Eff. Part No. List
Single Phase Three Phase
ODP TEFC E+ 115 208 230 277 208 230 460 575 Single Dual
1 X X X 15 64.6 PM-02-1078
X 8.3 PM-02-1078
X 7.5 PM-02-1078
X X X 5.5 64.6 PM-02-1081
X X X 4 66 PM-02-1080
X 3.6 PM-02-1080
X 1.8 PM-02-1080
X X X 1.4 82.5 PM-02-1082
X X X 10/12.4 70 PM-02-1083
X X X PM-02-1085
X PM-02-1085
X X X 4.1/4.6 68.5 PM-02-1088
X 3.7/4.2 PM-02-1088
X X X 1.0/1.9 79 PM-02-1090
X X X 14 67 PM-02-1098
X 7.7 PM-02-1098
X 7 PM-02-1098
X X X 3.7 78.5 PM-02-1100
X 3.4 PM-02-1100
X 1.7 PM-02-1100
X X X 1.5 75 PM-02-1102
X X X 3.3 82.5 PM-02-1525
X 3.1 PM-02-1525
X 1.6 PM-02-1525
X X X 1.2 82.5 PM-02-1096
1 1/2 X X X 21 68 PM-02-0508
X 11.6 PM-02-0508
X 10.5 PM-02-0508
X X X 7.9 68 PM-02-1111
X X X 5.3 78.5 PM-02-1110
X 5 PM-02-1110
X 2.5 PM-02-1110
X X X 1.9 80 PM-02-1112
X X X 3.1/5.0 80 PM-02-1118
X 2.9/4.8 PM-02-1118
X X X 1.4/2.3 79 PM-02-1120
X X X 18 72 PM-02-1128
X 10 PM-02-1128
X 9 PM-02-1128
X X X 4.8 80 PM-02-1130
X 4.8 PM-02-1130
X 2.4 PM-02-1130
X X X 1.8 84 PM-02-1132
X X X 4.6 84 PM-02-1527
X 4.2 PM-02-1527
X 2.1 PM-02-1527
X X X 1.8 84 PM-02-1126
BELT DRIVE MOTORS 2 – 5 HP
Motor Size HP Motor Type Voltage Speed Max Amps Min Eff. Part No. List
Single Phase Three Phase
ODP TEFC E+ 115 208 230 277 208 230 460 575 Single Dual
2 X X X 7 75 PM-02-1140
X 6.4 PM-02-1140
X 3.2 PM-02-1140
X X X 2.5 84 PM-02-1142
X X X 3.5/6.5 80 PM-02-1148
X 3.5/6.3 PM-02-1148
X X X 1.7/3 81 PM-02-1150
X X X 6 84 PM-02-1529
X 5.6 PM-02-1529
X 2.8 PM-02-1529
X X X 2.2 84 PM-02-1160
X X X 6 84 PM-02-1528
X 5.6 PM-02-1528
X 2.8 PM-02-1528
X X X 2.2 84 PM-02-1156
3 X X X 8.8 86.5 PM-02-1166
X 8 PM-02-1166
X 4 PM-02-1166
X X X 3.7 86.5 PM-02-1168
X X X 5.6/9.3 82.5 PM-02-1174
X 5.1/8.5 PM-02-1174
X X X 3.8/4.6 80 PM-02-1172
X X X 8.6 87.5 PM-02-1531
X 7.8 PM-02-1531
X 3.9 PM-02-1531
X X X 3.4 87.5 PM-02-1186
X X X 9.1 87 PM-02-1530
X 9 PM-02-1530
X 4.5 PM-02-1530
X X X 3.2 86.5 PM-02-1182
5 X X X 14.1 87.5 PM-02-1532
X 13.2 PM-02-1532
X 6.6 PM-02-1532
X X X 5.3 87.5 PM-02-1194
X X X 14.3 87.5 PM-02-1533
X 13 PM-02-1533
X 6.5 PM-02-1533
X X X 5.4 87.5 PM-02-1212
X X X 14.2 87.5 PM-02-1207
X 12.8 PM-02-1207
X 6.4 PM-02-1207
X X X 5.2 87.5 PM-02-1208

Motor Type Speed

BELT DRIVE MOTORS 7.5 – 20 HP
Voltage
Motor

Size HP

Single Phase Three Phase Max

Amps

Min Eff. Part No. List
ODP TEFC E+ 115 208 230 277 208 230 460 575 Single Dual
7 1/2 X X X 22.2 88.5 PM-02-1534
X 21.6 PM-02-1534
X 10.8 PM-02-1534
X X X 8.2 88.5 PM-02-1220
X X X 21.4 89.5 PM-02-1535
X 20.4 PM-02-1535
X 10.2 PM-02-1535
X X X 8.2 89.5 PM-02-1238
X X X 22.1 91 PM-02-1535
X 20 PM-02-1535
X 10 PM-02-1535
X X X 7.6 91 PM-02-1310
10 X X X 28.6 89.5 PM-02-1258
X 28 PM-02-1258
X 14 PM-02-1258
X X X 11 89.5 PM-02-1246
X X X 28.5 89.5 PM-02-1536
X 28.4 PM-02-1536
X 14.2 PM-02-1536
X X X 11.4 89.5 PM-02-1264
X X X 28.5 91.7 PM-02-1536
X 26 PM-02-1536
X 13 PM-02-1536
X X X 10.3 89.5 PM-02-1311
15 X X X 44.9 91 PM-02-1537
X 40.6 PM-02-1537
X 20.3 PM-02-1537
X X X 16.2 91 PM-02-1292
X X X 41 82.4 PM-02-1538
X 38 PM-02-1538
X 19 PM-02-1538
X X X 15.6 91 PM-02-1295
X X X 40.6 93 PM-02-1538
X 37 PM-02-1538
X 18.5 PM-02-1538
15 92.4 PM-02-1312
20 X X X 55.7 91 PM-02-1539
X 52 PM-02-1539
X 26 PM-02-1539
X X X 20.8 91 PM-02-1297
X X X 53.1 91 PM-02-1540
X 51 PM-02-1540
X 25.5 PM-02-1540
X X X 19.3 91 PM-02-1300
X X X 53 93 PM-02-1298
X 48.6 PM-02-1298
X 24.3 PM-02-1298
19.3 93 PM-02-1313

CF = Contact Factory

©2014 Johnson Controls, Inc.

Blower Coil Parts Price List

All List Prices Subject to Change Revision Date: February 2014

BELT DRIVE 3 PHASE MOTOR STARTERS
Part # Description Obsolete Vendor # Current Vendor # List
PE-03-3091 STARTER 9A 3POLE 24V LC1D0910B7 LC1D09B7
PE-03-3092 STARTER 9A 3POLE 120V LC1D0910F7 LC1D09F7
PE-03-3094 STARTER 9A 3POLE 240V LC1D0910U7 LC1D09U7
PE-03-3096 STARTER 9A 3POLE 208V LC1D0910L6 LC1D09L6
PE-03-3121 STARTER 12A 3POLE 24V LC1D1210B7 LC1D12B7
PE-03-3122 STARTER 12A 3POLE 120V LC1D1210F7 LC1D12F7
PE-03-3124 STARTER 12A 3POLE 240V LC1D1210U7 LC1D12U7
PE-03-3126 STARTER 12A 3POLE 208V LC1D1210L6 LC1D12L6
PE-03-3181 STARTER 18A 3POLE 24V LC1D1810B7 LC1D18B7
PE-03-3182 STARTER 18A 3POLE 120V LC1D1810F7 LC1D18F7
PE-03-3184 STARTER 18A 3POLE 240V LC1D1810U7 LC1D18U7
PE-03-3186 STARTER 18A 3POLE 208V LC1D1810L6 LC1D18L6
PE-03-3251 STARTER 25A 3POLE 24V LC1D2510B7 LC1D25B7
PE-03-3252 STARTER 25A 3POLE 120V LC1D2510F7 LC1D25F7
PE-03-3254 STARTER 25A 3POLE 240V LC1D2510U7 LC1D25U7
PE-03-3256 STARTER 25A 3POLE 208V LC1D2510L6 LC1D25L6
PE-03-3321 STARTER 32A 3POLE 24V LC1D3210B7 LC1D32B7
PE-03-3322 STARTER 32A 3POLE 120V LC1D3210F7 LC1D32F7
PE-03-3324 STARTER 32A 3POLE 240V LC1D3210U7 LC1D32U7
PE-03-3326 STARTER 32A 3POLW 208V LC1D3210L6 LC1D32L6
PE-03-3401 STARTER 40A 3POLE 24V LC1D4011B7 LC1D40B7
PE-03-3402 STARTER 40A 3POLE 120V LC1D4010F7 LC1D40F7
PE-03-3404 STARTER 40A 3POLE 240V LC1D4010U7 LC1D40U7
PE-03-3406 STARTER 40A 3POLE 208V LC1D4010L6 LC1D40L6
PE-03-3501 STARTER 50A 3POLE 24V LC1D5010B7 LC1D50B7
PE-03-3502 STARTER 50A 3POLE 120V LC1D5010F7 LC1D50F7
PE-03-3506 STARTER 50A 3POLE 208V LC1D5010L6 LC1D50L6
PE-03-3651 STARTER 65A 3POLE 24V LC1D6510B7 LC1D65B7
PE-03-3652 STARTER 65A 3POLE 120V LC1D6510F7 LC1D65F7
PE-03-3654 STARTER 65A 3POLE 240V LC1D6510U7 LC1D65U7
PE-03-3656 STARTER 65A 3POLE 208V LC1D6510L6 LC1D65L6
PE-03-3801 STARTER 80 A 3POLE 24V LC1D8010B7 LC1D80B7
PE-03-3802 STARTER 80A 3POLE 120V LC1D8010F7 LC1D80F7
PE-03-3804 STARTER 80A 3POLE 240V LC1D8010U7 LC1D80U7

Note:

1. Obsolete Vendor Number must be converted to Current Vendor Number. A complete mounted set or starter and overload must be ordered for these cases due to compatibility.

BELT DRIVE STARTER OVERLOAD RELAY
Part # Description Obsolete Vendor # Current Vendor # List
PE-04-0000 OVERLOAD RELAY, .40 – .63 AMP LR2D1304 LRD04
PE-04-0001 OVERLOAD RELAY, .63 – 1.0 AMP LR2D1305 LRD05
PE-04-0014 OVERLOAD RELAY, 17 – 25 AMP LR2D3322 LRD3322
PE-04-0100 OVERLOAD RELAY, 1.25 – 2.0 AMP LR2D13X6 N/A
PE-04-0101 OVERLOAD RELAY, 1.0 – 1.7 AMP LR2D1306 LRD06
PE-04-0102 OVERLOAD RELAY, 1.6 – 2.5 AMP LR2D1307 LRD07
PE-04-0204 OVERLOAD RELAY, 2.5 – 4.0 AMP LR2D1308 LRD08
PE-04-0406 OVERLOAD RELAY, 4.0 – 6.0 AMP LR2D1310 LRD10
PE-04-0508 OVERLOAD RELAY, 5.5 – 8.0 AMP LR2D1312 LRD12
PE-04-0710 OVERLOAD RELAY, 7 – 10 AMP LR2D1314 LRD14
PE-04-0913 OVERLOAD RELAY, 9 – 13 AMP LR2D1316 LRD16
PE-04-1218 OVERLOAD RELAY, 12 – 18 AMP LR2D1321 LRD21
PE-04-1725 OVERLOAD RELAY, 16 – 24 AMP LR2D1322 LRD22
PE-04-2836 OVERLOAD RELAY, 30 – 38 AMP LR2D2355 LRD35
PE-04-3040 OVERLOAD RELAY, 30 – 40 AMP LR2D3355 LRD3355
PE-04-3750 OVERLOAD RELAY, 37 – 50 AMP LR2D3357 LRD3357
PE-04-4865 OVERLOAD RELAY, 48 – 65 AMP LR2D3359 LRD3359
PE-04-5570 OVERLOAD RELAY, 55 – 70 AMP LR2D3361 LRD3361
PE-04-6380 OVERLOAD RELAY, 63 – 80 AMP LR2D3363 LRD3363

Note:

  1. Obsolete Vendor Number must be converted to Current Vendor Number. A complete mounted set or starter and overload must be ordered for these cases due to compatibility.

©2014 Johnson Controls, Inc.

0

1

P

M

0

1

L

S

B

L

W

R

1

1

C

L

S

T

E

E

M

-0

B

L

W

R

L

OW

E

R

0

1

6-

0

1

15

B

LOW

E

M

P

L

T

E

5

L

OW

0

1

6

L

O

W

P

T

E

2

0

W

E

E

B

H

B

L

W

R

B

C

1

5

D

.

6

M

0

8

W

E

1

P

M

B

RT

B

E

R

G,

B

AL

C

RT

9

X

M

8

B

E

R

BE

N

3













Blower Coil Parts Price List

All List Prices Subject to Change Revision Date: February 2014




AHI/AVI & ACB/ACR BELT DRIVE “SERIES B” BLOWER ASSEMBLIES AND PARTS
BLOWER ASSEMBLY
UNIT SIZE COMPONENT QTY PER UNIT PART NUMBER DESCRIPTION LIST PRICE EACH
08 BLOWER 1 PM-06-0047 SNG FAN BLWR ASSY,9-6,3/4 SHFT
12 BLOWER 1 PM-06-0106 BLOWER,9X9,CLASS I, SEE ITEM DTL
16 BLOWER 1 PM-06-0107 SNG FAN BLWR ASSY,10-8,3/4 SHFT
20 BLOWER 1 PM-06-0109 SNG FAN BLWR ASSY,10-10,3/4 SHFT
25 BLOWER 1 PM-06-0111 SNG FAN BLWR ASSY,15-9,1 SHFT
30 BLOWER 1 PM-06-0104 SNG FAN BLWR ASSY,15-11,1 SHFT
40 BLOWER 1 PM-06-0116 BLOWER,15X15,CLASS I, SEE ITEM DTL
50 BLOWER 2 PM-06-0112 BLOWER,15X9,CLASS I, EE ITEM DTL
60 BLOWER 2 PM-06- 14 O E ,15X , A S I, SEE I M DTL
80 BLOWER 2 06- 16 BLOWER,15X15,CLASS I, SEE ITEM DTL
40 (HD) B OWER 1 PM-06-0117 BLOWER,15X15,CLASS I, S E ITEM DTL
50 (HD) BLOWER 2 P 6-0113 O E ,15X9,CLASS I, SEE ITEM DTL
60 (HD) B 2 PM-06-0115 BLOWER,15X11,CLASS I, SEE ITEM DTL
80 (HD) BLOWER 2 PM-06-0117 BLOWER,15X15,CLASS I, SEE ITEM DTL
BLOWER ASSEMBLY SHEET METAL MOUNTING PLATE
UNIT SIZE COMPONENT QTY PER UNIT PART NUMBER DESCRIPTION LIST PRICE EACH
08 PLATE 1 16-00-245 BLOWER TEMPLATE,9-6 BLOWERS
12 PLATE 1 16-00009-01 BLWR TEMP 11.25HX12.00W 9-9BLWR
16 PLATE 1 16-00-246 BLOWER TEMPLATE,10-8 BLOWERS
20 PLATE 1 16-00-247 BLOWER TEMPLATE,10-10 BLOWERS
25 PLATE 1 16-00-248 BLOWER TEMPLATE,15-9 BLOWERS
30 PLATE 1 16-00-249 BLOWER TEMPLATE,15-11 BLOWERS
40 PLATE 1 16-00010-01 BLWR TEMP 16.00HX19.00W 15-15BLWR
50 PLATE 2 16-00-248 BLOWER TEMPLATE, -9 BLOWERS
60 PLATE 2 16-0 249 ER T A ,1 -11 B ERS
80 PLATE 2 00 0-01 BLWR TEMP 16.00HX19.00W 15-15BLWR
40 (HD) PLATE 1 16-00010-01 BLWR TEMP 16.00HX19.0 W 15-15BLWR
50 (HD) PLATE 2 -00-248 B ER TEMPLATE,15-9 BLOWERS
60 (HD) LA 16-00-249 BLOWER TEMPLATE,15-11 BLOWERS
80 (HD) PLATE 2 16-00010-01 BLWR TEMP 16.00HX19.00W 15-15BLWR
FAN WHEEL ONLY
UNIT SIZE COMPONENT QTY PER UNIT PART NUMBER DESCRIPTION LIST PRICE EACH
08 WHEEL 1 PM-00-0101 WHL, BLWR FC, 09-06 BD, 3/4 BORE
12 WHEEL 1 PM-00-0102 WHL, BLWR FC, 09-09 BD, 3/4 BORE
16 WHEEL 1 PM-00-0103 WHL, BLWR FC, 10-08 BD, 3/4 BORE
20 WHEEL 1 PM-00-0104 WHL, BLWR FC, 10-10 BD, 3/4 BORE
25 WHEEL 1 PM-00-0106 WHL, BLWR FC, 15-09 BD, 1.00 BORE
30 WHEEL 1 PM-00-0109 WHL, BLWR FC, 15-11 BD, 1.00 BORE
40 WHEEL 1 PM-00-0112 WHL, BLWR FC, 15-15 BD, 1.18 BORE
50 WHEEL 2 PM-00-0107 WHL, BLWR FC, 15-09 D, 1.18 BORE
60 WHEEL 2 PM-0 0110 W L, FC, 15-11 BD, 1.18 BORE
80 H L 2 PM-00-0112 WHL, BLWR FC, 15-15 BD, 1.18 BORE
40 (HD) WHEEL 1 PM-00-0113 WHL, LWR F , 5-1 B , 1 9 BORE
50 (HD) WHEEL 2 P -00-01 WHL, BLWR FC, 15-09 BD, 1.44 BORE
60 (HD) HE L 2 PM-00-0111 WHL, BLWR FC, 15-11 BD, 1.44 BORE
80 (HD) WHEEL 2 PM-00-0113 WHL, BLWR FC, 15-15 BD, 1.69 BORE
FAN BEARINGS
UNIT SIZE COMPONENT QTY PER UNIT PART NUMBER DESCRIPTION LIST PRICE EACH
08 BEARINGS 2 PM-11-0000 BEARING, BALL, CART. 0.75 X 2.50
12 BEARINGS 2 PM-11-0000 BEARING, BALL, CART. 0.75 X 2.50
16 BEARINGS 2 PM-11-0000 BEARING, BALL, CART. 0.75 X 2.50
20 BEARINGS 2 PM-11-0000 BEARING, BALL, CART. 0.75 X 2.50
25 BEARINGS 2 PM-11-0001 BEARING, BALL, CART. 1.00 X 2.50
30 BEARINGS 2 PM-11-0001 BEARING, BALL, CART. 1.00 X 2.50
40 BEARINGS 2 PM-11-0002 BEARING, BALL, CART. 1.19 X 2.50
50 BEARINGS 3 PM-11-0002 BEARING, BALL, CA . 1.19 X 2.50
60 BEARINGS 3 PM-1 0002 A IN L, A . 1.1 2.50
80 BEARINGS 3 -11-0002 BEARING, BALL, CART. 1.19 X 2.50
40 (HD) EARINGS 2 PM-11-0009 BEARING, BALL, PILLOW BLK, 1.69
50 (HD) BEARINGS 3 P -11-000 A ING, BALL, PILLOW BLK, 1.44
60 (HD) ARI GS PM-11-0008 BEARING, BALL, PILLOW BLK, 1.44
80 (HD) BEARINGS 3 PM-11-0008 BEARING, BALL, PILLOW BLK, 1.44
FAN BEARING BRACKETS
UNIT SIZE COMPONENT QTY PER UNIT PART NUMBER DESCRIPTION LIST PRICE EACH
08 BRACKETS 2 PM-06-0050 FRAME, BEARING MOUNT, 9
12 BRACKETS 2 PM-06-0050 FRAME, BEARING MOUNT, 9
16 BRACKETS 2 PM-06-0051 FRAME, BEARING MOUNT, 10
20 BRACKETS 2 PM-06-0051 FRAME, BEARING MOUNT, 10
25 BRACKETS 2 PM-06-0052 FRAME, BEARING MOUNT, 15
30 BRACKETS 2 PM-06-0052 FRAME, BEARING MOUNT, 15
40 BRACKETS 2 PM-06-0052 FRAME, BEARING MOUNT, 15
50 BRACKETS 3 PM-06-0052 FRAME, BEARING OUNT, 15
60 BRACKETS 3 PM-0 0052 F AME B R G OUN 15
80 BRACKETS 3 -0 0052 FRAME, BEARING MOUNT, 15
40 (HD) ACKETS 2 N/A INCLUDED W/ PILLOW BL CK BEARING
50 (HD) BRACKETS 3 N/A C ED W/ PILLOW BLOCK BEARING
60 (HD) B AC TS N/A INCLUDED W/ PILLOW BLOCK BEARING
80 (HD) BRACKETS 3 N/A INCLUDED W/ PILLOW BLOCK BEARING
FAN / MOTOR SHAFTS
UNIT SIZE LENGTH DIAMETER PART NUMBER DESCRIPTION LIST PRICE EACH
08 15″ 3/4″ 16-576-072 AHU SINGLE FAN BLOWER SHAFT
12 19″ 3/4″ 16-579-072 AHU SINGLE FAN BLOWER SHAFT
16 17″ 3/4″ 16-888-072 AHU SINGLE FAN BLOWER SHAFT
20 20″ 3/4″ 16-880-072 AHU SINGLE FAN BLOWER SHAFT
25 20″ 1″ 16-090-072 AHU SINGLE FAN BLOWER SHAFT
30 22″ 1″ 16-110-072 AHU SINGLE FAN BLOWER SHAFT
40 26″ 1-3/16″ 16-150-072 AHU SINGLE FAN BLOWER SHAFT
50 46″ 1-3/16″ 16-090A-090 AHU DUAL FAN BLO ER SHAFT
60 51″ 1-3/16″ 16-11 -090 H DU N LOWER AFT
80 60″ -3/ “ -1 -090 AHU DUAL FAN BLOWER SHAFT
40 (HD) 29″ 1-11/16″ 16-150A-072 AHU SINGLE FAN BLO ER SHAFT
50 (HD) 46″ 1-7/16 1 090B-09 H DUAL FAN BLOWER SHAFT
60 (HD) 51 1 7/ 16-110B-090 AHU DUAL FAN BLOWER SHAFT
80 (HD) 63″ 1-11/16″ 16-150A-090 AHU DUAL FAN BLOWER SHAFT



6

P

M

6

BR

M

R

,

E

A

I

N

M

T

,

O

I

N

L

U

D

R

K

E

3

0

A

1

1

6

1

6

50

W

A

U

A

L

FA

B

S

H

W

6

0

A

U

1

6









Notes:

    1. Contact factory for alternate blower assembly configurations for these units and alternate blower assembly parts.
    2. For older units and to determine blower assembly part number, contact factory with the above blower dimensions.

©2014 Johnson Controls, Inc.

Blower Coil Parts Price List

All List Prices Subject to Change Revision Date: February 2014

AHI/AVI, ACB/ACR BELT DRIVE SELECTION
MOTOR SHEAVES (ADJUSTABLE)
PART # DRIVE PKG. RPM RANGE MOTOR SHEAVES BLOWER SHEAVES
PM-01-0004 1VL44
PM-01-0010 1VM50
PM-01-0016 1VP56 x 1 1/8″
PM-01-0018 2VP62 x 1 3/8″
BLOWER SHEAVES
SIZES 08 –

20

PM-01-0140 5 445 – 605 1VL44 AK114 x 3/4″
PM-01-0138 6 467 – 633 1VL44 AK109 x 3/4″
PM-01-0136 7 490 – 665 1VL44 AK104 x 3/4″
PM-01-0134 8 516 – 700 1VL44 AK99 x 3/4″
PM-01-0132 9 544 – 739 1VL44 AK94 x 3/4″
PM-01-0130 10 576 – 782 1VL44 AK89 x 3/4″
PM-01-0138 11 613 – 831 1VL44 AK84 x 3/4″
PM-01-0126 12 653 – 887 1VL44 AK79 x 3/4″
PM-01-0124 13 700 – 950 1VL44 AK74 x 3/4″
PM-01-0123 14 754 – 1023 1VL44 AK69 x 3/4″
PM-01-0120 15 817 – 1108 1VL44 AK64 x 3/4″
PM-01-0118 16 891 – 1209 1VL44 AK59 x 3/4″
PM-01-0114 17 980 – 1330 1VL44 AK54 x 3/4″
PM-01-0110 18 1089 – 1478 1VL44 AK49 x 3/4″
PM-01-0108 19 1225 – 1663 1VL44 AK44 x 3/4″
PM-01-0130 20 700 – 906 1VM50 AK89 x 3/4″
PM-01-0128 21 744 – 963 1VM50 AK84 x 3/4″
PM-01-0126 22 793 – 1027 1VM50 AK79 x 3/4″
PM-01-0124 23 850 – 1100 1VM50 AK74 x 3/4″
PM-01-0122 24 915 – 1185 1VM50 AK69 x 3/4″
PM-01-0120 25 992 – 1283 1VM50 AK64 x 3/4″
PM-01-0118 26 1082 – 1400 1VM50 AK59 x 3/4″
PM-01-0114 27 1190 – 1540 1VM50 AK54 x 3/4″
PM-01-0110 28 1322 – 1711 1VM50 AK49 x 3/4″
PM-01-0108 29 1488 – 1925 1VM50 AK44 x 3/4″
SIZES 25 –

80

PM-01-0238 5 445 – 605 1VL44 AK114H
PM-01-0236 6 467 – 633 1VL44 AK109H
PM-01-0234 7 490 – 665 1VL44 AK104H
PM-01-0232 8 516 – 700 1VL44 AK99H
PM-01-0230 9 544 – 739 1VL44 AK94H
PM-01-0228 10 576 – 782 1VL44 AK89H
PM-01-0226 11 613 – 831 1VL44 AK84H
PM-01-0224 12 653 – 887 1VL44 AK79H
PM-01-0222 13 700 – 950 1VL44 AK74H
PM-01-0220 14 754 – 1023 1VL44 AK69H
PM-01-0218 15 817 – 1108 1VL44 AK64H
PM-01-0216 16 891 – 1209 1VL44 AK59H
PM-01-0214 17 980 – 1330 1VL44 AK54H
PM-01-0212 18 1089 – 1478 1VL44 AK49H
PM-01-0210 19 1225 – 1663 1VL44 AK44H
PM-01-0228 20 700 – 906 1VM50 AK89H
PM-01-0226 21 744 – 963 1VM50 AK84H
PM-01-0224 22 793 – 1027 1VM50 AK79H
PM-01-0222 23 850 – 1100 1VM50 AK74H
PM-01-0220 24 915 – 1185 1VM50 AK69H
PM-01-0218 25 992 – 1283 1VM50 AK64H
PM-01-0216 26 1082 – 1400 1VM50 AK59H
PM-01-0214 27 1190 – 1540 1VM50 AK54H
PM-01-0212 28 1322 – 1711 1VM50 AK49H
PM-01-0210 29 1488 – 1925 1VM50 AK44H
AHI/AVI, ACB/ACR BELT DRIVE SELECTION (continued)
BLOWER SHEAVES 3 – 5 HP
PART # DRIVE PKG. RPM RANGE MOTOR SHEAVES BLOWER SHEAVES
PM-01-0328 30 489 – 602 1VP56 x 1 1/8″ BK160H
PM-01-0326 31 523 – 644 1VP56 x 1 1/8″ BK150H
PM-01-0324 32 562 – 692 1VP56 x 1 1/8″ BK140H
PM-01-0322 33 607 – 748 1VP56 x 1 1/8″ BK130H
PM-01-0320 34 660 – 814 1VP56 x 1 1/8″ BK120H
PM-01-0318 35 724 – 892 1VP56 x 1 1/8″ BK110H
PM-01-0316 36 801 – 987 1VP56 x 1 1/8″ BK100H
PM-01-0314 37 896 – 1104 1VP56 x 1 1/8″ BK90H
PM-01-0312 38 1017 – 1253 1VP56 x 1 1/8″ BK80H
PM-01-0310 39 1176 – 1449 1VP56 x 1 1/8″ BK70H
BLOWER SHEAVES 7 1/2 – 10 HP
PM-01-0524 40 536 – 645 2VP62 x 1 3/8″ 2TB160Q
PM-01-0522 41 557 – 670 2VP62 x 1 3/8″ 2TB154Q
PM-01-0520 42 631 – 759 2VP62 x 1 3/8″ 2TB136Q
PM-01-0518 43 692 – 833 2VP62 x 1 3/8″ 2TB124Q
PM-01-0516 44 780 – 939 2VP62 x 1 3/8″ 2TB110Q
PM-01-0514 45 953 – 1147 2VP62 x 1 3/8″ 2TB90Q
PM-01-0512 46 1072 – 1291 2VP62 x 1 3/8″ 2TB80Q
PM-01-0510 47 1225 – 1475 2VP62 x 1 3/8″ 2TB70Q

©2014 Johnson Controls, Inc.

Blower Coil Parts Price List

All List Prices Subject to Change Revision Date: February 2014

AMI (OBSOLETE) 02 – 03 SHEAVE SELECTION
Unit Blower Size Driven Sheave Driver Sheave RPM –

Minimum

RPM –

Average

RPM –

Maximum

02 9-4 1AK44H PM-01-0210 1VP56 x 0.625 PM-01-0014 1750 1959 2169
PM-01-0210 1VP56 x 0.875 PM-01-0527 1750 1959 2169
1AK46H PM-01-0547 1VL44 x 0.625 PM-01-0004 1193 1392 1591
PM-01-0547 1VP56 x 0.875 PM-01-0527 1670 1869 2068
PM-01-0547 1VL44 x 0.625 PM-01-0004 1193 1392 1591
PM-01-0547 1VP56 x 0.625 PM-01-0014 1670 1869 2068
PM-01-0547 1VP68 x 0.625 PM-01-0630
PM-01-0547 1VP56 x 0.875 PM-01-0527 1670 1869 2068
PM-01-0547 1VP68 x 0.875 PM-01-0528
PM-01-0547 1VP68 x 1.125 PM-01-0531
1AK51H PM-01-0548 1VP56 x 0.625 PM-01-0014 1500 1679 1857
PM-01-0548 1VP68 x 0.625 PM-01-0630 1929 2108 2286
PM-01-0548 1VP56 x 0.875 PM-01-0527 1500 1679 1857
PM-01-0548 1VP68 x 0.875 PM-01-0528 1929 2108 2286
PM-01-0548 1VP68 x 1.125 PM-01-0531 1929 2108 2286
1AK54H PM-01-0214 1VL44 x 0.625 PM-01-0004 1010 1178 1346
PM-01-0214 1VP56 x 0.875 PM-01-0527 1361 1523 1685
1AK56H PM-01-0550 1VL44 x 0.625 PM-01-0004 972 1134 1296
PM-01-0550 1VP56 x 0.625 PM-01-0014 1361 1523 1685
1AK61H PM-01-0549 1VL44 x 0.625 PM-01-0004 890 1038 1186
03 9-6 1AK44H PM-01-0210 1VP56 x 0.625 PM-01-0014 1750 1959 2169
PM-01-0210 1VP56 x 0.875 PM-01-0527 1750 1959 2169
PM-01-0210 1VP56 x 1.125 PM-01-0016 1750 1959 2169
1AK46H PM-01-0547 1VL44 x 0.625 PM-01-0004 1193 1392 1591
PM-01-0547 1Vl44 x 0.875 PM-01-0006 1193 1392 1591
PM-01-0547 1VP56 x 0.875 PM-01-0527 1670 1869 2068
PM-01-0547 1VP56 x 1.125 PM-01-0016 1670 1869 2068
1AK49H PM-01-0212 1VL44 x 0.625 PM-01-0004 1117 1303 1489
PM-01-0212 1VP56 x 0.625 PM-01-0014 1564 1750 1936
PM-01-0212 1Vl44 x 0.875 PM-01-0006 1117 1303 1489
PM-01-0212 1VP56 x 0.875 PM-01-0527 1564 1750 1936
PM-01-0212 1VP56 x 1.125 PM-01-0016 1564 1750 1936
1AK51H PM-01-0548 1VP56 x 0.625 PM-01-0014 1500 1679 1857
PM-01-0548 1VP68 x 0.625 PM-01-0630 1929 2108 2286
PM-01-0548 1VP56 x 0.875 PM-01-0527 1500 1679 1857
PM-01-0548 1VP68 x 0.875 PM-01-0528 1929 2108 2286
PM-01-0548 1VP68 x 1.125 PM-01-0531 1929 2108 2286
1AK54H PM-01-0214 1VL44 x 0.625 PM-01-0004 1010 1178 1346
PM-01-0214 1VP56 x 0.875 PM-01-0527 1750 1959 2169
1AK56H PM-01-0550 1VL44 x 0.625 PM-01-0004 972 1134 1296
PM-01-0550 1VP56 x 0.625 PM-01-0014 1361 1523 1685
1AK61H PM-01-0549 1VL44 x 0.625 PM-01-0004 890 1038 1186

AMI (OBSOLETE) 04 – 06 SHEAVE SELECTION

Unit Blower Size Driven Sheave Driver Sheave RPM –

Minimum

RPM –

Average

RPM –

Maximum

04 10-7 1AK46H PM-01-0547 1VL44 x 0.625 PM-01-0004 1193 1392 1591
PM-01-0547 1VL44 x 0.875 PM-01-0006 1193 1392 1591
PM-01-0547 1VP56 x 0.875 PM-01-0527 1670 1869 2068
PM-01-0547 1VP56 x 1.125 PM-01-0016 1670 1869 2068
1AK49H PM-01-0212 1VL44 x 0.625 PM-01-0004 1117 1303 1489
PM-01-0212 1VP56 x 0.625 PM-01-0014 1564 1750 1936
PM-01-0212 1VL44 x 0.875 PM-01-0006 1117 1303 1489
PM-01-0212 1VP56 x 0.875 PM-01-0527 1564 1750 1936
PM-01-0212 1VP56 x 1.125 PM-01-0016 1564 1750 1936
1AK51H PM-01-0548 1VP56 x 0.625 PM-01-0014 1500 1679 1857
PM-01-0548 1VP56 x 0.875 PM-01-0527 1500 1679 1857
PM-01-0548 1VP56 x 1.125 PM-01-0016 1500 1679 1857
1AK54H PM-01-0214 1VL44 x 0.625 PM-01-0004 1010 1178 1346
PM-01-0214 1VL44 x 0.875 PM-01-0006 1010 1178 1346
PM-01-0214 1VP56 x 0.875 PM-01-0527 1750 1959 2169
1AK56H PM-01-0550 1VL44 x 0.625 PM-01-0004 972 1134 1296
PM-01-0550 1VP56 x 0.625 PM-01-0014 1361 1523 1685
PM-01-0550 1VL44 x 0.875 PM-01-0006 972 1134 1296
PM-01-0550 1VP56 x 1.125 PM-01-0016 1361 1523 1685
1AK61H PM-01-0549 1VL44 x 0.625 PM-01-0004 890 1038 1186
PM-01-0549 1VL44 x 0.875 PM-01-0006 890 1038 1186
1AK66H PM-01-0551 1VL44 x 0.625 PM-01-0004 820 957 1094
1AK69H PM-01-0220 1VP65 x 1.125 PM-01-0530 1280 1411 1541
1AK74H PM-01-0222 1VL44 x 0.625 PM-01-0004 729 851 972
06 12-9 1AK104H PM-01-0541 1VP65 x 1.125 PM-01-0530 841 927 1012
1AK46H PM-01-0547 1VL44 x 0.625 PM-01-0004 1193 1392 1591
PM-01-0547 1Vl44 x 0.875 PM-01-0006 1193 1392 1591
1AK49H PM-01-0212 1VL44 x 0.625 PM-01-0004 1117 1303 1489
PM-01-0212 1Vl44 x 0.875 PM-01-0006 1117 1303 1489
1AK54H PM-01-0214 1VL44 x 0.625 PM-01-0004 1010 1178 1346
PM-01-0214 1Vl44 x 0.875 PM-01-0006 1010 1178 1346
1AK56H PM-01-0550 1VL44 x 0.625 PM-01-0004 972 1134 1296
PM-01-0550 1Vl44 x 0.875 PM-01-0006 972 1134 1296
PM-01-0550 1VP56 x 1.125 PM-01-0016 1361 1523 1685
1AK61H PM-01-0549 1VL44 x 0.625 PM-01-0004 890 1038 1186
PM-01-0549 1Vl44 x 0.875 PM-01-0006 890 1038 1186
1AK66H PM-01-0551 1VL44 x 0.625 PM-01-0004 820 957 1094
PM-01-0551 1Vl44 x 0.875 PM-01-0006 820 957 1094
1AK69H PM-01-0220 1VP65 x 1.125 PM-01-0530 1280 1411 1541
1AK74H PM-01-0222 1VL44 x 0.625 PM-01-0004 729 851 972
PM-01-0222 1Vl44 x 0.875 PM-01-0006 729 851 972
PM-01-0222 1VP65 x 1.125 PM-01-0530 1167 1313 1410
1AK79H PM-01-0224 1VP60 x 1.125 PM-01-0529 1000 1114 1227
1AK84H PM-01-0226 1VL44 x 0.625 PM-01-0004 640 747 854
PM-01-0226 1VP60 x 1.125 PM-01-0529 939 1046 1152
PM-01-0226 1VP65 x 1.125 PM-01-0530 1046 1153 1259
AMI (OBSOLETE) 08 – 10 SHEAVE SELECTION
Unit Blower Size Driven Sheave Driver Sheave RPM –

Minimum

RPM –

Average

RPM –

Maximum

1AK104H PM-01-0541 1VP65 x 1.125 PM-01-0530 841 927 1012
08 12-12 1AK114H PM-01-0542 1VP65 x 1.125 PM-01-0530 766 844 922
1AK49H PM-01-0212 1VL44 x 0.625 PM-01-0004 1117 1303 1489
PM-01-0212 1Vl44 x 0.875 PM-01-0006 1117 1303 1489
1AK54H PM-01-0214 1VL44 x 0.625 PM-01-0004 1010 1178 1346
PM-01-0214 1Vl44 x 0.875 PM-01-0006 1010 1178 1346
1AK56H PM-01-0550 1VL44 x 0.625 PM-01-0004 972 1134 1296
PM-01-0550 1Vl44 x 0.875 PM-01-0006 972 1134 1296
PM-01-0550 1VP56 x 1.125 PM-01-0016 1361 1523 1685
1AK61H PM-01-0549 1VL44 x 0.625 PM-01-0004 890 1038 1186
PM-01-0549 1Vl44 x 0.875 PM-01-0006 890 1038 1186
1AK66H PM-01-0551 1VL44 x 0.625 PM-01-0004 820 957 1094
PM-01-0551 1Vl44 x 0.875 PM-01-0006 820 957 1094
1AK69H PM-01-0220 1VP65 x 1.125 PM-01-0530 1280 1411 1541
1AK74H PM-01-0222 1VL44 x 0.625 PM-01-0004 729 851 972
PM-01-0222 1Vl44 x 0.875 PM-01-0006 729 851 972
PM-01-0222 1VP65 x 1.125 PM-01-0530 1167 1313 1410
1AK79H PM-01-0224 1VP60 x 1.125 PM-01-0529 1000 1114 1227
1AK84H PM-01-0226 1VL44 x 0.625 PM-01-0004 640 747 854
PM-01-0226 1Vl44 x 0.875 PM-01-0006 640 747 854
PM-01-0226 1VP60 x 1.125 PM-01-0529 939 1046 1152
PM-01-0226 1VP65 x 1.125 PM-01-0530 1046 1153 1259
2AK51H PM-01-0558 2VP56 x 1.125 PM-01-0533 1500 1679 1857
2AK56H PM-01-0559 2VP56 x 1.125 PM-01-0533 1361 1523 1685
2AK69H PM-01-0560 2VP65 x 1.125 PM-01-0535 1280 1411 1541
2AK74H PM-01-0561 2VP65 x 1.125 PM-01-0535 1167 1313 1410
2AK84H PM-01-0563 2VP65 x 1.125 PM-01-0535 1046 1153 1259
10 15-11 1AK104H PM-01-0541 1VP65 x 1.125 PM-01-0530 841 927 1012
1AK114H PM-01-0542 1VL44 x 0.625 PM-01-0004 469 547 625
PM-01-0542 1Vl44 x 0.875 PM-01-0006 469 547 625
PM-01-0542 1VP65 x 1.125 PM-01-0530 766 844 922
1AK134H PM-01-0543 1VP65 x 1.125 PM-01-0530 650 716 782
1AK154H PM-01-0545 1VP65 x 1.125 PM-01-0530 564 622 679
1AK66H PM-01-0551 1VL44 x 0.625 PM-01-0004 820 957 1094
PM-01-0551 1Vl44 x 0.875 PM-01-0006 820 957 1094
1AK74H PM-01-0222 1VL44 x 0.625 PM-01-0004 729 851 972
PM-01-0222 1Vl44 x 0.875 PM-01-0006 729 851 972
1AK84H PM-01-0226 1VL44 x 0.625 PM-01-0004 640 747 854
PM-01-0226 1Vl44 x 0.875 PM-01-0006 640 747 854
PM-01-0226 1VP60 x 1.125 PM-01-0529 939 1046 1152
1AK99H PM-01-0232 1VL44 x 0.625 PM-01-0004 541 631 722
PM-01-0232 1Vl44 x 0.875 PM-01-0006 541 631 722
2AK104H PM-01-0552 2VP65 x 1.125 PM-01-0535 841 927 1012
2AK114H PM-01-0553 2VP65 x 1.125 PM-01-0535 766 844 922
2AK79H PM-01-0562 2VP60 x 1.125 PM-01-0534 1000 1114 1227
2AK84H PM-01-0563 2VP60 x 1.125 PM-01-0534 939 1046 1152
PM-01-0563 2VP65 x 1.125 PM-01-0535 1046 1153 1259
AMI (OBSOLETE) 12 – 17 SHEAVE SELECTION
Unit Blower Size Driven Sheave Driver Sheave RPM –

Minimum

RPM –

Average

RPM –

Maximum

1AK114H PM-01-0542 1VL44 x 0.625 PM-01-0004 469 547 625
PM-01-0542 1Vl44 x 0.875 PM-01-0006 469 547 625
PM-01-0542 1VP65 x 1.125 PM-01-0530 766 844 922
12 18-13 1AK134H PM-01-0543 1VP65 x 1.125 PM-01-0530 650 716 782
1AK144H PM-01-0544 1Vl44 x 0.875 PM-01-0006 370 432 493
1AK154H PM-01-0545 1VP56 x 1.125 PM-01-0016 484 542 599
PM-01-0545 1VP65 x 1.125 PM-01-0530 564 622 679
1AK84H PM-01-0226 1VL44 x 0.625 PM-01-0004 640 747 854
PM-01-0226 1Vl44 x 0.875 PM-01-0006 640 747 854
1AK99H PM-01-0232 1VL44 x 0.625 PM-01-0004 541 631 722
PM-01-0232 1Vl44 x 0.875 PM-01-0006 541 631 722
2AK104H PM-01-0552 2VP65 x 1.125 PM-01-0535 841 927 1012
PM-01-0552 2VP65 x 1.375 PM-01-0537 841 927 1012
2AK114H PM-01-0553 2VP65 x 1.125 PM-01-0535 766 844 922
PM-01-0553 2VP65 x 1.375 PM-01-0537 766 844 922
2AK134H PM-01-0554 2VP65 x 1.125 PM-01-0535 650 716 782
PM-01-0554 2VP65 x 1.375 PM-01-0537 650 716 782
2AK154H PM-01-0555 2VP56 x 1.125 PM-01-0533 484 542 599
PM-01-0555 2VP65 x 1.125 PM-01-0535 564 622 679
2AK84H PM-01-0563 2VP60 x 1.125 PM-01-0534 939 1046 1152
PM-01-0563 2VP60 x 1.375 PM-01-0536 939 1046 1152
14 18-18 1AK144H PM-01-0544 1VL44 x 0.625 PM-01-0004 370 432 493
PM-01-0544 1Vl44 x 0.875 PM-01-0006 370 432 493
1AK114H PM-01-0542 1VL44 x 0.625 PM-01-0004 469 547 625
PM-01-0542 1Vl44 x 0.875 PM-01-0006 469 547 625
1AK134H PM-01-0543 1VP65 x 1.125 PM-01-0530 650 716 782
1AK154H PM-01-0545 1VP56 x 1.125 PM-01-0016 484 542 599
PM-01-0545 1VP65 x 1.125 PM-01-0530 564 622 679
1AK184H PM-01-0546 1VP56 x 1.125 PM-01-0016 404 452 500
1AK99H PM-01-0232 1VL44 x 0.625 PM-01-0004 541 631 722
PM-01-0232 1Vl44 x 0.875 PM-01-0006 541 631 722
2AK104H PM-01-0552 2VP65 x 1.125 PM-01-0535 841 927 1012
PM-01-0552 2VP65 x 1.375 PM-01-0537 841 927 1012
2AK114H PM-01-0553 2VP65 x 1.125 PM-01-0535 766 844 922
PM-01-0553 2VP65 x 1.375 PM-01-0537 766 844 922
2AK134H PM-01-0554 2VP65 x 1.125 PM-01-0535 650 716 782
2AK184H PM-01-0556 2VP56 x 1.125 PM-01-0533 650 716 782
2AK154H PM-01-0555 2VP56 x 1.125 PM-01-0533 484 542 599
PM-01-0555 2VP65 x 1.125 PM-01-0535 564 622 679
2AK84H PM-01-0563 2VP60 x 1.375 PM-01-0536 939 1046 1152
17 18-18 1AK144H PM-01-0544 1VL44 x 0.625 PM-01-0004 370 432 493
1AK104H PM-01-0541 1VP65 x 1.125 PM-01-0530 841 927 1012
1AK114H PM-01-0542 1VL44 x 0.625 PM-01-0004 469 547 625
PM-01-0542 1Vl44 x 0.875 PM-01-0006 469 547 625
PM-01-0542 1VP65 x 1.125 PM-01-0530 766 844 922
1AK134H PM-01-0543 1VP65 x 1.125 PM-01-0530 650 716 782
1AK144H PM-01-0544 1Vl44 x 0.875 PM-01-0006 370 432 493
1AK154H PM-01-0545 1VP56 x 1.125 PM-01-0016 484 542 599
PM-01-0545 1VP65 x 1.125 PM-01-0530 564 622 679
1AK84H PM-01-0226 1VL44 x 0.625 PM-01-0004 640 747 854
PM-01-0226 1Vl44 x 0.875 PM-01-0006 640 747 854
1AK99H PM-01-0232 1VL44 x 0.625 PM-01-0004 541 631 722
PM-01-0232 1Vl44 x 0.875 PM-01-0006 541 631 722
2AK104H PM-01-0552 2VP65 x 1.125 PM-01-0535 841 927 1012
PM-01-0552 2VP65 x 1.375 PM-01-0537 841 927 1012
2AK114H PM-01-0553 2VP65 x 1.125 PM-01-0535 766 844 922
2AK134H PM-01-0554 2VP65 x 1.125 PM-01-0535 650 716 782
2AK84H PM-01-0563 2VP60 x 1.125 PM-01-0534 939 1046 1152
PM-01-0563 2VP60 x 1.375 PM-01-0536 939 1046 1152
2BK110H PM-01-0418 2VP71A x 1.625 PM-01-0538 949 1047 1145

©2014 Johnson Controls, Inc.

PE-07-1030 1 POLE 30 AMP 600 VOLT MINI FUSE BLOCK CLASS CC
PE-07-7060 1 POLE 60 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE BLOCK CLASS K
PE-07-5100 2 POLE 100 AMP 250 VOLT FUSE BLOCK CLASS K
PE-07-5030 2 POLE 30 AMP 250 VOLT FUSE BLOCK CLASS K
PE-07-2030 2 POLE 30 AMP 600 VOLT MINI FUSE BLOCK CLASS CC
PE-07-5060 2 POLE 60 AMP 250 VOLT FUSE BLOCK CLASS K
PE-07-9100 3 POLE 100 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE BLOCK CLASS K
PE-07-6030 3 POLE 30 AMP 250 VOLT FUSE BLOCK CLASS K
PE-07-9030 3 POLE 30 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE BLOCK CLASS K
PE-07-3030 3 POLE 30 AMP 600 VOLT MINI FUSE BLOCK CLASS CC
PE-07-6060 3 POLE 60 AMP 250 VOLT FUSE BLOCK CLASS K
PE-07-9060 3 POLE 60 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE BLOCK CLASS K
PE-07-1001 2 POLE 30 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE BLOCK CLASS CC, MR
PE-07-1002 3 POLE 30 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE BLOCK CLASS CC, MR
PE-07-8061 2 POLE 60 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE BLOCK CLASS CC, MR
PE-07-9061 3 POLE 60 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE BLOCK CLASS CC, MR
PE-07-8101 2 POLE 100 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE BLOCK CLASS CC, MR
PE-07-9101 3 POLE 100 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE BLOCK CLASS CC, MR
PE-07-8201 2 POLE 200 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE BLOCK CLASS CC, MR
PE-07-9201 3 POLE 200 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE BLOCK CLASS CC, MR
FUSES
250V
PE-06-1002 2 AMP 250 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
PE-06-1003 3 AMP 250 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
PE-06-1004 4 AMP 250 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
PE-06-1006 6 AMP 250 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
PE-06-1010 10 AMP 250 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
PE-06-1015 15 AMP 250 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
PE-06-1020 20 AMP 250 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
PE-06-1025 25 AMP 250 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
PE-06-1030 30 AMP 250 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
PE-06-1035 35 AMP 250 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
PE-06-1040 40 AMP 250 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
PE-06-1045 45 AMP 250 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
PE-06-1050 50 AMP 250 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
PE-06-1060 60 AMP 250 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
600 VOLT
PE-06-2001 1 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
PE-06-2002 2 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
PE-06-2003 3 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
PE-06-2006 6 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
PE-06-2010 10 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
PE-06-2015 15 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
PE-06-2020 20 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
PE-06-2025 25 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
PE-06-2030 30 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
PE-06-2035 35 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
PE-06-2040 40 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
PE-06-2045 45 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
PE-06-2050 50 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
PE-06-2060 60 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
PE-06-0031 1/2 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-0032 8/10 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-0033 1 1/4 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-0034 1 1/2 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-0035 2 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-0036 2 1/2 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-0037 3 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-0038 3 1/2 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-0039 4 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-0040 5 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-0041 6 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-0042 7 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-0043 9 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-0044 10 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-0045 12 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-0046 15 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-0047 20 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-0048 25 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-0049 30 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-3000 35 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS J, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-3001 40 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS J, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-3002 50 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS J, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-3003 60 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS J, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-3004 70 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS J, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-3005 80 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS J, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-3006 90 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS J, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-3007 100 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS J, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-3008 110 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS J, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-3009 125 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS J, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-3010 150 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS J, TIME DELAY, MR
MINIATURE FUSES
PE-06-0001 1 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC
PE-06-0002 2 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC
PE-06-0003 3 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC
PE-06-0006 6 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC
PE-06-0010 10 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC
PE-06-0015 15 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC
PE-06-0020 20 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC
PE-06-0025 25 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC
PE-06-0030 30 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC
MAGNETIC CONTACTORS/RELAYS
24 VOLT CONTROL
PE-05-1301 1 POLE 30 AMP CONTACTOR 24 VOLT
PE-05-1501 1 POLE 50 AMP CONTACTOR 24 VOLT
PE-08-0004 2 Pole 25 AMP RELAY 24 VOLT
PE-05-2301 2 POLE 30 AMP CONTACTOR 24 VOLT
PE-05-2401 2 POLE 40 AMP CONTACTOR 24 VOLT
PE-05-2501 2 POLE 50 AMP CONTACTOR 24 VOLT
PE-05-3301 3 POLE 30 AMP CONTACTOR 24 VOLT
PE-05-3401 3 POLE 40 AMP CONTACTOR 24 VOLT
PE-05-3501 3 POLE 50 AMP CONTACTOR 24 VOLT
120 VOLT CONTROL
PE-05-1302 1 POLE 30 AMP CONTACTOR 120 VOLT
PE-05-1402 1 POLE 40 AMP CONTACTOR 120 VOLT
PE-05-2302 2 POLE 30 AMP CONTACTOR 120 VOLT
PE-05-2402 2 POLE 40 AMP CONTACTOR 120 VOLT
PE-05-2502 2 POLE 50 AMP CONTACTOR 120 VOLT
PE-05-3302 3 POLE 30 AMP CONTACTOR 120 VOLT
PE-05-3402 3 POLE 40 AMP CONTACTOR 120 VOLT
PE-05-3502 3 POLE 50 AMP CONTACTOR 120 VOLT
208 – 240 VOLT CONTROL
PE-05-1306 1 POLE 30 AMP CONTACTOR 208-240 VOLT
PE-05-1406 1 POLE 40 AMP CONTACTOR 208-240 VOLT
PE-05-1506 1 POLE 50 AMP CONTACTOR 208-240 VOLT
PE-05-2306 2 POLE 30 AMP CONTACTOR 208-240 VOLT
PE-05-2406 2 POLE 40 AMP CONTACTOR 208-240 VOLT
PE-05-2506 2 POLE 50 AMP CONTACTOR 208-240 VOLT
PE-05-3306 3 POLE 30 AMP CONTACTOR 208-240 VOLT
PE-05-3406 3 POLE 40 AMP CONTACTOR 208-240 VOLT
PE-05-3506 3 POLE 50 AMP CONTACTOR 208-240 VOLT
277 VOLT CONTROL
PE-05-1305 1 POLE 30 AMP CONTACTOR 277 VOLT
PE-05-1405 1 POLE 40 AMP CONTACTOR 277 VOLT
PE-05-2305 2 POLE 30 AMP CONTACTOR 277 VOLT
PE-05-2405 2 POLE 40 AMP CONTACTOR 277 VOLT
PE-05-2505 2 POLE 50 AMP CONTACTOR 277 VOLT
PE-05-3305 3 POLE 30 AMP CONTACTOR 277 VOLT
PE-05-3405 3 POLE 40 AMP CONTACTOR 277 VOLT
PE-05-3505 3 POLE 50 AMP CONTACTOR 277 VOLT
SOLID STATE RELAYS (SSR)
PE-02-0010 ETSR15 – SOLID STATE RELAY 50 AMP/1 PHASE
n/a ETSR32 – SOLID STATE RELAY 25 AMP/3 PHASE (Obsolete)
PE-02-0025 ETSR35 – SOLID STATE RELAY 50 AMP/3 PHASE
PE-02-0030 SSR,1PH,48-660VAC,18A,120V
PE-02-0031 SSR,1PH,48-660VAC,18A,24V
PE-02-0032 SSR,1PH,42-660VAC, 25A, 280V
PE-02-0033 SSR,1PH,42-660VAC, 50A, 280V
PE-02-0034 SSR,1PH,42-660VAC, 60A, 280V
INTERFACE BOARDS FOR SSR RELAY
ETPHCC SWITCH GROUND SIDE PWM INPUT, CLOSE TO CONTROLLER COM
ETPHCC1 SWITCH HOT SIDE PWM INPUT, CLOSE TO CONTROLLER 24 VAC
ETPHCI SSR 4-20ma INPUT
ETPHCR SSR 135 OHM INPUT
ETPHCT SSR TTAT INPUT
ETPHCV1 SSR 6-9 VDC INPUT
ETPHCV2 SSR 2-10 VDC INPUT

MERCURY CONTACTORS

PE-26-1351 1 POLE 35 AMP 24 VOLT
PE-26-1501 1 POLE 50 AMP 24 VOLT
PE-26-2351 2 POLE 35 AMP 24 VOLT
PE-26-2501 2 POLE 50 AMP 24 VOLT
PE-26-3351 3 POLE 35 AMP 24 VOLT
PE-26-3501 3 POLE 50 AMP 24 VOLT
PE-26-1355 1 POLE 35 AMP 277 VOLT
PE-26-2355 2 POLE 35 AMP 277 VOLT
SECONDARY LIMITS
PE-09-6140 140°F ONE TIME SEC LIMIT 48A 600VAC ONETIME (RING TERMINAL) 61F 322803
PE-09-6240 240°F ONE TIME SEC LIMIT 48A 600VAC ONETIME (RING TERMINAL) 61F 322802
PE-09-8140 140°F ONE TIME SEC LIMIT 25A 600VAC ONETIME (QUICK CONN) 60F 311722
PE-09-8240 240°F ONE TIME SEC LIMIT 25A 600VAC ONETIME (QUICK CONN) 60F 311723
PE-09-8160 160°F MANUAL RESET SEC LIMIT 48A 480VAC (RING TERMINAL) 20413L7-912
PE-09-8300 TUTCO ONE-TIME LIMIT SWITCH 160 DEG (RING TERMINAL) 08-3098-00
PE-09-8301 TUTCO ONE-TIME LIMIT SWITCH 140 DEG (RING TERMINAL) 08-3043-00
PE-09-8302 TUTCO ONE-TIME LIMIT SWITCH 125 -140 DEG (QUICK CONN) 08-3090-00
PRIMARY LIMITS
PE-09-1105 105°F AUTO RESET PRIMARY LIMIT 12.5A 600VAC (QUICK CONN) 60T 313287
PE-09-0125 125°F AUTO RESET PRIMARY LIMIT 13A 600V 312894-60TX11
TRANSFORMERS
PE-10-1105 24 PRIMARY 24 SECONDARY 50VA ISOLATION TRANSFORMER
PE-10-2105 120 PRIMARY 24 SECONDARY 50VA TRANSFORMER
PE-10-2107 120 PRIMARY 24 SECONDARY 75VA TRANSFORMER
PE-10-5105 277 PRIMARY 24 SECONDARY 50VA TRANSFORMER
PE-10-5107 277 PRIMARY 24 SECONDARY 75VA TRANSFORMER
PE-10-6105 208-240 PRIMARY 24 SECONDARY 50VA TRANSFORMER
PE-10-6107 208-240 PRIMARY 24 SECONDARY 75VA TRANSFORMER
PE-10-7105 480 PRIMARY 24 SECONDARY 50VA TRANSFORMER
PE-10-7107 480 PRIMARY 24 SECONDARY 75VA TRANSFORMER
TRANSFORMER WIRING
B61-01-084 ASSY,WIRE,TERM CONNECTOR TO PWR WHT
B61-01-085 ASSY,WIRE,TERM CONNECTOR TO PWR BLK

Note:

  1. Both of the above Tranformer wires are required by code for field chage-out of transformers.
  2. Note on parts orders for tansformers to attached transformer wireing prior to shipping.
FAN SPEED CONTROLLERS
VAV & DIRECT DRIVE FAN SCR – SPEED CONTROLLERS – 120V
66-001-1000 ETFC120-4
66-002-1000 ETFC120-10
ETFC120-20 ETFC120-20
ETFC120-30 ETFC120-30
66-001-1000 ETFC115VF-A
66-003-1000 ETFC115VF-B
VAV & DIRECT DRIVE FAN SCR – SPEED CONTROLLERS – 208V
66-009-1000 ETFC208CF-A
66-010-1000 ETFC208CF-B
66-009-1000 ETFC208VF-A
66-011-1000 ETFC208VF-B
VAV & DIRECT DRIVE FAN SCR – SPEED CONTROLLERS – 277V
66-004-1000 ETFC277-4S
66-005-1000 ETFC277-8
66-006-1000 ETFC277VF-A
66-007-1000 ETFC277VF-B
VAV & DIRECT DRIVE FAN SCR – SPEED CONTROLLERS ECM MOTORS
B63-001-2063 ETPWM – Single ECM motor speed controller
B63-003-2063 ETPWM – Dual ECM motor master speed controller1
B63-004-2063 ETPWM – Dual ECM motor slave speed controller1
29-00-269 All model ETPWM* mounting bracket

Note:

1. Speed adjustment is located on master speed controller

MOTOR CABLES
B61-02-069 CFRHW 53″ MOTOR POWER CABLE (INLET SIZES 14 AND LARGER AND/OR FAN SIZE 21
B61-02-092 CFRHW 77″ MOTOR POWER CABLE (INLET SIZES 14 AND LARGER AND/OR FAN SIZE 21
B61-02-029 CFREH 53″ MOTOR POWER CABLE (INLET SIZES 14 AND LARGER AND/OR FAN SIZE 21
B61-02-024 CFRHW 53″ MOTOR SIGNAL CABLE (INLET SIZES 14 AND LARGER AND/OR FAN SIZE 21
B61-01-086 CFRHW 89″ MOTOR SIGNAL CABLE FOR DUAL MOTOR APPLICATIONS

©2014 Johnson Controls, Inc.

Electrical Parts Price List

All List Prices Subject to Change Revision Date: February 2014

INLINE MOTOR FUSE AND FUSE HOLDER SELECTION CHART
120 Volt 208 Volt
Motor HP Fuse AMP Fuse Qty.

Required

Fuse Part # Fuse Holder

Part #

Fuse AMP Fuse Qty.

Required

Fuse Part # Fuse Holder

Part #

1/13 6 AMP 1 PE-06-0006 PE-07-1030 N/A N/A N/A N/A
1/6 15 AMP 1 PE-06-0015 PE-07-1030 6 AMP 2 PE-06-0006 PE-07-2030
1/4 20 AMP 1 PE-06-0020 PE-07-1030 15 AMP 2 PE-06-0015 PE-07-2030
1/2 30 AMP 1 PE-06-0030 PE-07-1030 15 AMP 2 PE-06-0015 PE-07-2030
3/4 30 AMP 1 PE-06-0030 PE-07-1030 20 AMP 2 PE-06-0020 PE-07-2030
(2) 1/13 10 AMP 1 PE-06-0010 PE-07-1030 N/A N/A N/A N/A
(2) 1/6 20 AMP 1 PE-06-0020 PE-07-1030 10 AMP 2 PE-06-0010 PE-07-2030
(2) 1/4 30 AMP 1 PE-06-0030 PE-07-1030 20 AMP 2 PE-06-0020 PE-07-2030
(2) 1/2 30 AMP 1 PE-06-3030 PE-07-A030 30 AMP 2 PE-06-0030 PE-07-2030
(2) 3/4 30 AMP 1 PE-06-3030 PE-07-A030 20 AMP 2 PE-06-3020 PE-07-A030
1 20 AMP 1 PE-06-3020 PE-07-A030 N/A N/A N/A N/A
(2) 1 35 AMP 1 PE-06-3035 PE-07-A060 N/A N/A N/A N/A
277 Volt 480 Volt
Motor HP Fuse AMP Fuse Qty.

Required

Fuse Part # Fuse Holder

Part #

Fuse AMP Fuse Qty.

Required

Fuse Part # Fuse Holder

Part #

1/13 3 AMP 1 PE-06-0003 PE-07-1030 N/A N/A N/A N/A
1/6 6 AMP 1 PE-06-0006 PE-07-1030 N/A N/A N/A N/A
1/4 10 AMP 1 PE-06-0010 PE-07-1030 6 AMP 2 PE-06-0006 PE-07-2030
1/2 15 AMP 1 PE-06-0015 PE-07-1030 10 AMP 2 PE-06-0010 PE-07-2030
3/4 15 AMP 1 PE-06-0015 PE-07-1030 10 AMP 2 PE-06-0010 PE-07-2030
(2) 1/13 6 AMP 1 PE-06-0006 PE-07-1030 N/A N/A N/A N/A
(2) 1/6 10 AMP 1 PE-06-0010 PE-07-1030 N/A N/A N/A N/A
(2) 1/4 15 AMP 1 PE-06-0015 PE-07-1030 10 AMP 2 PE-06-0010 PE-07-2030
(2) 1/2 25 AMP 1 PE-06-0025 PE-07-1030 20 AMP 2 PE-06-0020 PE-07-2030
(2) 3/4 25 AMP 1 PE-06-0025 PE-07-1030 20 AMP 2 PE-06-0020 PE-07-2030
1 15 AMP 1 PE-06-0015 PE-07-1030 N/A N/A N/A N/A
(2) 1 30 AMP 1 PE-06-0030 PE-07-1030 N/A N/A N/A N/A

Notes:

  1. All fuse holder part numbers shown reflect the quantity of fuses required.
  2. See Fuse Blocks and Fuses tables for pricing.

©2014 Johnson Controls, Inc.

Fan Coil Parts Price List

All List Prices Subject to Change Revision Date: February 2014



©2014 Johnson Controls, Inc.

Fan Coil Parts Price List

All List Prices Subject to Change Revision Date: February 2014



©2014 Johnson Controls, Inc.

Fan Coil Parts Price List

All List Prices Subject to Change Revision Date: February 2014



©2014 Johnson Controls, Inc.

Fan Coil Parts Price List

All List Prices Subject to Change Revision Date: February 2014



©2014 Johnson Controls, Inc.

Fan Coil Parts Price List

All List Prices Subject to Change Revision Date: February 2014





©2014 Johnson Controls, Inc.

Fan Coil Parts Price List

All List Prices Subject to Change Revision Date: February 2014



©2014 Johnson Controls, Inc.

Fan Coil Parts Price List

All List Prices Subject to Change Revision Date: February 2014



©2014 Johnson Controls, Inc.

Fan Coil Parts Price List

All List Prices Subject to Change Revision Date: February 2014



©2014 Johnson Controls, Inc.

Fan Coil Parts Price List

All List Prices Subject to Change Revision Date: February 2014





©2014 Johnson Controls, Inc.

Fan Coil Parts Price List

All List Prices Subject to Change Revision Date: February 2014





©2014 Johnson Controls, Inc.

Fan Coil Parts Price List

All List Prices Subject to Change Revision Date: February 2014



©2014 Johnson Controls, Inc.

Fan Coil Parts Price List

All List Prices Subject to Change Revision Date: February 2014



©2014 Johnson Controls, Inc.

Fan Coil Parts Price List

All List Prices Subject to Change Revision Date: February 2014


Filters

FAN COIL UNIT FILTERS
UNIT MODEL SERIES UNIT SIZE NOMINAL FILTER

SIZE

QTY. /

UNIT

THROWAWAY

FILTER PART #

FILTER DESCRIPTION LIST
FHP C 20 20 X 8.5 X 1 1 PM-04-0180 1″ THROWAWAY
FHP C 25 26 X 8.5 X 1 1 PM-04-0202 1″ THROWAWAY
FHP C 30 30 X 8.5 X 1 1 PM-04-0182 1″ THROWAWAY
FHP C 40 20 X 8.5 X 1 2 PM-04-0180 1″ THROWAWAY
FHP C 50 20 X 8.5 X 1 1 PM-04-0180 1″ THROWAWAY
FHP C 50 30 X 8.5 X 1 1 PM-04-0182 1″ THROWAWAY
FHP C 60 30 X 8.5 X 1 2 PM-04-0182 1″ THROWAWAY
FHX C 20 30 X 8.5 X 1 1 PM-04-0182 1″ THROWAWAY
FHX C 25 20 X 8.5 X 1 2 PM-04-0180 1″ THROWAWAY
FHX C 30 20 X 8.5 X 1 2 PM-04-0180 1″ THROWAWAY
FHX C 40 20 X 8.5 X 1 1 PM-04-0180 1″ THROWAWAY
FHX C 40 30 X 8.5 X 1 1 PM-04-0182 1″ THROWAWAY
FHX C 50 30 X 8.5 X 1 2 PM-04-0182 1″ THROWAWAY
FHX C 60 20 X 8.5 X 1 2 PM-04-0180 1″ THROWAWAY
FHX C 60 30 X 8.5 X 1 1 PM-04-0182 1″ THROWAWAY
FHP C 20 20 X 8.5 X 1 1 PM-04-0189 1″ PERMANENT
FHP C 25 26 X 8.5 X 1 1 PM-04-0200 1″ PERMANENT
FHP C 30 30 X 8.5 X 1 1 PM-04-0191 1″ PERMANENT
FHP C 40 20 X 8.5 X 1 2 PM-04-0189 1″ PERMANENT
FHP C 50 20 X 8.5 X 1 1 PM-04-0189 1″ PERMANENT
FHP C 50 30 X 8.5 X 1 1 PM-04-0191 1″ PERMANENT
FHP C 60 30 X 8.5 X 1 2 PM-04-0191 1″ PERMANENT
FHX C 20 30 X 8.5 X 1 1 PM-04-0191 1″ PERMANENT
FHX C 25 20 X 8.5 X 1 2 PM-04-0189 1″ PERMANENT
FHX C 30 20 X 8.5 X 1 2 PM-04-0189 1″ PERMANENT
FHX C 40 20 X 8.5 X 1 1 PM-04-0189 1″ PERMANENT
FHX C 40 30 X 8.5 X 1 1 PM-04-0191 1″ PERMANENT
FHX C 50 30 X 8.5 X 1 2 PM-04-0191 1″ PERMANENT
FHX C 60 20 X 8.5 X 1 2 PM-04-0189 1″ PERMANENT
FHX C 60 30 X 8.5 X 1 1 PM-04-0191 1″ PERMANENT
FHP C 20 20 X 8.5 X 1 1 PM-04-1992 1″ PLEATED
FHP C 25 26 X 8.5 X 1 1 PM-04-1994 1″ PLEATED
FHP C 30 30 X 8.5 X 1 1 PM-04-1993 1″ PLEATED
FHP C 40 20 X 8.5 X 1 2 PM-04-1992 1″ PLEATED
FHP C 50 20 X 8.5 X 1 1 PM-04-1992 1″ PLEATED
FHP C 50 30 X 8.5 X 1 1 PM-04-1993 1″ PLEATED
FHP C 60 30 X 8.5 X 1 2 PM-04-1993 1″ PLEATED
FHX C 20 30 X 8.5 X 1 1 PM-04-1993 1″ PLEATED
FHX C 25 20 X 8.5 X 1 2 PM-04-1992 1″ PLEATED
FHX C 30 20 X 8.5 X 1 2 PM-04-1992 1″ PLEATED
FHX C 40 20 X 8.5 X 1 1 PM-04-1992 1″ PLEATED
FHX C 40 30 X 8.5 X 1 1 PM-04-1993 1″ PLEATED
FHX C 50 30 X 8.5 X 1 2 PM-04-1993 1″ PLEATED
FHX C 60 20 X 8.5 X 1 2 PM-04-1992 1″ PLEATED
FHX C 60 30 X 8.5 X 1 1 PM-04-1993 1″ PLEATED
FWC, FWX, FWI C 02 9.25 X 21.75 X 1 1 PM-04-0232 1″ THROWAWAY
FWC, FWX, FWI C 03 9.25 X 25.75 X 1 1 PM-04-0233 1″ THROWAWAY
FWC, FWX, FWI C 04 9.25 X 31.75 X 1 1 PM-04-0234 1″ THROWAWAY
FWC, FWX, FWI C 06 9.25 X 41.75 X 1 1 PM-04-0235 1″ THROWAWAY
FWC, FWX, FWI C 08 9.25 X 21.75 X 1 2 PM-04-0232 1″ THROWAWAY
FWC, FWX, FWI C 10 9.25 X 25.75 X 1 1 PM-04-0233 1″ THROWAWAY
FWC, FWX, FWI C 10 9.25 X 31.75 X 1 1 PM-04-0234 1″ THROWAWAY
FWC, FWX, FWI C 12 9.25 X 21.75 X 1 3 PM-04-0232 1″ THROWAWAY
FWC, FWX, FWI C 02 9.25 X 21.75 X 1 1 PM-04-0236 1″ MERV 7 (PLEATED)
FWC, FWX, FWI C 03 9.25 X 25.75 X 1 1 PM-04-0237 1″ MERV 7 (PLEATED)
FWC, FWX, FWI C 04 9.25 X 31.75 X 1 1 PM-04-0238 1″ MERV 7 (PLEATED)
FWC, FWX, FWI C 06 9.25 X 41.75 X 1 1 PM-04-0239 1″ MERV 7 (PLEATED)
FWC, FWX, FWI C 08 9.25 X 21.75 X 1 2 PM-04-0236 1″ MERV 7 (PLEATED)
FWC, FWX, FWI C 10 9.25 X 25.75 X 1 1 PM-04-0237 1″ MERV 7 (PLEATED)
FWC, FWX, FWI C 10 9.25 X 31.75 X 1 1 PM-04-0238 1″ MERV 7 (PLEATED)
FWC, FWX, FWI C 12 9.25 X 21.75 X 1 3 PM-04-0236 1″ MERV 7 (PLEATED)
FWC, FWX, FWI C 02 9.25 X 21.75 X 1 1 PM-04-0240 1″ MERV 8 (PLEATED)
FWC, FWX, FWI C 03 9.25 X 25.75 X 1 1 PM-04-0241 1″ MERV 8 (PLEATED)
FWC, FWX, FWI C 04 9.25 X 31.75 X 1 1 PM-04-0242 1″ MERV 8 (PLEATED)
FWC, FWX, FWI C 06 9.25 X 41.75 X 1 1 PM-04-0243 1″ MERV 8 (PLEATED)
FWC, FWX, FWI C 08 9.25 X 21.75 X 1 2 PM-04-0240 1″ MERV 8 (PLEATED)
FWC, FWX, FWI C 10 9.25 X 25.75 X 1 1 PM-04-0241 1″ MERV 8 (PLEATED)
FWC, FWX, FWI C 10 9.25 X 31.75 X 1 1 PM-04-0242 1″ MERV 8 (PLEATED)
FWC, FWX, FWI C 12 9.25 X 21.75 X 1 3 PM-04-0240 1″ MERV 8 (PLEATED)
FWC, FWX, FWI C 02 9.25 X 21.75 X 1 1 PM-04-0244 1″ MERV 13 (PLEATED)
FWC, FWX, FWI C 03 9.25 X 25.75 X 1 1 PM-04-0245 1″ MERV 13 (PLEATED)
FWC, FWX, FWI C 04 9.25 X 31.75 X 1 1 PM-04-0246 1″ MERV 13 (PLEATED)
FWC, FWX, FWI C 06 9.25 X 41.75 X 1 1 PM-04-0247 1″ MERV 13 (PLEATED)
FWC, FWX, FWI C 08 9.25 X 21.75 X 1 2 PM-04-0244 1″ MERV 13 (PLEATED)
FWC, FWX, FWI C 10 9.25 X 25.75 X 1 1 PM-04-0245 1″ MERV 13 (PLEATED)
FWC, FWX, FWI C 10 9.25 X 31.75 X 1 1 PM-04-0246 1″ MERV 13 (PLEATED)
FWC, FWX, FWI C 12 9.25 X 21.75 X 1 3 PM-04-0244 1″ MERV 13 (PLEATED)
FWC, FWX, FWI B 20 26.5 X 8.5 X 1 1 PM-04-0017 1″ THROWAWAY
FWC, FWX, FWI B 25 32.5 X 8.5 X 1 1 PM-04-0203 1″ THROWAWAY
FWC, FWX, FWI B 30 36.5 X 8.5 X 1 1 PM-04-0018 1″ THROWAWAY
FWC, FWX, FWI B 40 20 X 8.5 X 1 1 PM-04-0180 1″ THROWAWAY
FWC, FWX, FWI B 40 26.5 X 8.5 X 1 1 PM-04-0017 1″ THROWAWAY
FWC, FWX, FWI B 50 20 X 8.5 X 1 1 PM-04-0180 1″ THROWAWAY
FWC, FWX, FWI B 50 36.5 X 8.5 X 1 1 PM-04-0018 1″ THROWAWAY
FWC, FWX, FWI B 60 30 X 8.5 X 1 1 PM-04-0182 1″ THROWAWAY
FWC, FWX, FWI B 60 36.5 X 8.5 X 1 1 PM-04-0018 1″ THROWAWAY
FWC, FWX, FWI B 20 26.5 X 8.5 X 1 1 PM-04-0190 1″ PERMANENT
FWC, FWX, FWI B 25 32.5 X 8.5 X 1 1 PM-04-0201 1″ PERMANENT
FWC, FWX, FWI B 30 36.5 X 8.5 X 1 1 PM-04-0192 1″ PERMANENT
FWC, FWX, FWI B 40 20 X 8.5 X 1 1 PM-04-0189 1″ PERMANENT
FWC, FWX, FWI B 40 26.5 X 8.5 X 1 1 PM-04-0190 1″ PERMANENT
FWC, FWX, FWI B 50 20 X 8.5 X 1 1 PM-04-0189 1″ PERMANENT
FWC, FWX, FWI B 50 36.5 X 8.5 X 1 1 PM-04-0192 1″ PERMANENT
FWC, FWX, FWI B 60 30 X 8.5 X 1 1 PM-04-0191 1″ PERMANENT
FWC, FWX, FWI B 60 36.5 X 8.5 X 1 1 PM-04-0192 1″ PERMANENT
FWC, FWX, FWI B 20 26.5 X 8.5 X 1 1 PM-04-1990 1″ PLEATED
FWC, FWX, FWI B 25 32.5 X 8.5 X 1 1 PM-04-1995 1″ PLEATED
FWC, FWX, FWI B 30 36.5 X 8.5 X 1 1 PM-04-1991 1″ PLEATED
FWC, FWX, FWI B 40 20 X 8.5 X 1 1 PM-04-1992 1″ PLEATED
FWC, FWX, FWI B 40 26.5 X 8.5 X 1 1 PM-04-1990 1″ PLEATED
FWC, FWX, FWI B 50 20 X 8.5 X 1 1 PM-04-1992 1″ PLEATED
FWC, FWX, FWI B 50 36.5 X 8.5 X 1 1 PM-04-1991 1″ PLEATED
FWC, FWX, FWI B 60 30 X 8.5 X 1 1 PM-04-1993 1″ PLEATED
FWC, FWX, FWI B 60 36.5 X 8.5 X 1 1 PM-04-1991 1″ PLEATED
FLX, FLC A 02 7.5 X 21.5 X 1 1 PM-04-4149 1″ THROWAWAY
FLX, FLC A 03 7.5 X 26.5 X 1 1 PM-04-4150 1″ THROWAWAY
FLX, FLC A 04 7.5 X 34.5 X 1 1 PM-04-4151 1″ THROWAWAY
FLX, FLC A 06 7.5 X 48.5 X 1 1 PM-04-4152 1″ THROWAWAY
FLX, FLC A 02 7.5 X 21.5 X 1 1 PM-04-4153 1″ PLEATED
FLX, FLC A 03 7.5 X 26.5 X 1 1 PM-04-4154 1″ PLEATED
FLX, FLC A 04 7.5 X 34.5 X 1 1 PM-04-4155 1″ PLEATED
FLX, FLC A 06 7.5 X 48.5 X 1 1 PM-04-4156 1″ PLEATED
FS A 03/04 13.25 X 14 X 1 1 PM-04-0174 1″ THROWAWAY
FS A 06/08 15.25 X 24 X 1 1 PM-04-0176 1″ THROWAWAY
FS A 10/12 19.25 X 29 X 1 1 PM-04-0178 1″ THROWAWAY
FS A 03/04 13.25 X 14 X 1 1 PM-04-0221 1″ PERMANENT
FS A 06/08 15.25 X 24 X 1 1 PM-04-0222 1″ PERMANENT
FS A 10/12 19.25 X 29 X 1 1 PM-04-0223 1″ PERMANENT
FS B 03/04 13.75 X 24 X 1 1 PM-04-0175 1″ THROWAWAY
FS B 06/08 15.75 X 26.5 X 1 1 PM-04-0177 1″ THROWAWAY
FS B 10/12 19.75 X 29 X 1 1 PM-04-0179 1″ THROWAWAY
FS B 03/04 13.75 X 24 X 1 1 PM-04-0225 1″ PERMANENT
FS B 06/08 15.75 X 26.5 X 1 1 PM-04-0226 1″ PERMANENT
FS B 10/12 19.75 X 29 X 1 1 PM-04-0227 1″ PERMANENT
FS B 03/04 13.75 X 24 X 1 1 PM-04-1996 1″ PLEATED
FS B 06/08 15.75 X 26.5 X 1 1 PM-04-1997 1″ PLEATED
FS B 10/12 19.75 X 29 X 1 1 PM-04-1998 1″ PLEATED
FS PERIMETER

INTAKE

B 03/04 13-1/2 X 11-7/8 X 1 2 PM-04-9137 1″ THROWAWAY
B 06/08 15-1/2 X 13-1/8 X 1 2 PM-04-9138 1″ THROWAWAY
B 10/12 19-1/2 X 14-1/4 X 1 2 PM-04-9139 1″ THROWAWAY
FS RETURN AIR

FILTER

B 03/04 Contact Factory 1 PM-04-0508 1″ SYNTHETIC
B 06/08 Contact Factory 1 PM-04-0509 1″ SYNTHETIC
B 10/12 Contact Factory 1 PM-04-0510 1″ SYNTHETIC
FS BYPASS

FILTER

B 03/04 Contact Factory 1 PM-04-0511 1″ SYNTHETIC
B 06/08 Contact Factory 1 PM-04-0512 1″ SYNTHETIC
B 10/12 Contact Factory 1 PM-04-0513 1″ SYNTHETIC
FNP, FNX A 06 16 X 16 1 PM-04-0096 1″ THROWAWAY
FNP, FNX A 08 16 X 20 1 PM-04-0098 1″ THROWAWAY
FNP, FNX A 10 16 X 25 1 PM-04-0106 1″ THROWAWAY
FNP, FNX A 12 16 X 16 2 PM-04-0096 1″ THROWAWAY
FNP, FNX A 14 16 X 16 1 PM-04-0096 1″ THROWAWAY
FNP, FNX A 14 16 X 20 1 PM-04-0098 1″ THROWAWAY
FNP, FNX A 16 16 X 20 2 PM-04-0098 1″ THROWAWAY
FNP, FNX A 18 16 X 20 1 PM-04-0098 1″ THROWAWAY
FNP, FNX A 18 16 X 25 1 PM-04-0106 1″ THROWAWAY
FNP, FNX A 20 16 X 25 2 PM-04-0106 1″ THROWAWAY
FNP, FNX A 06 16 X 16 1 PM-04-1999 1″ PLEATED
FNP, FNX A 08 16 X 20 1 PM-04-2001 1″ PLEATED
FNP, FNX A 10 16 X 25 1 PM-04-2003 1″ PLEATED
FNP, FNX A 12 16 X 16 2 PM-04-1999 1″ PLEATED
FNP, FNX A 14 16 X 16 1 PM-04-1999 1″ PLEATED
FNP, FNX A 14 16 X 20 1 PM-04-2001 1″ PLEATED
FNP, FNX A 16 16 X 20 2 PM-04-2001 1″ PLEATED
FNP, FNX A 18 16 X 20 1 PM-04-2001 1″ PLEATED
FNP, FNX A 18 16 X 25 1 PM-04-2003 1″ PLEATED
FNP, FNX A 20 16 X 25 2 PM-04-2003 1″ PLEATED
FNP, FNX A 06 16 X 16 1 PM-04-2000 2″ PLEATED
FNP, FNX A 08 16 X 20 1 PM-04-2002 2″ PLEATED
FNP, FNX A 10 16 X 25 1 PM-04-2004 2″ PLEATED
FNP, FNX A 12 16 X 16 2 PM-04-2000 2″ PLEATED
FNP, FNX A 14 16 X 16 1 PM-04-2000 2″ PLEATED
FNP, FNX A 14 16 X 20 1 PM-04-2002 2″ PLEATED
FNP, FNX A 16 16 X 20 2 PM-04-2002 2″ PLEATED
FNP, FNX A 18 16 X 20 1 PM-04-2002 2″ PLEATED
FNP, FNX A 18 16 X 25 1 PM-04-2004 2″ PLEATED
FNP, FNX A 20 16 X 25 2 PM-04-2004 2″ PLEATED
FCC (FRONT) A 04,06,08 16 X 22 X 1 1 PM-04-0100 1″ THROWAWAY
FCC (FRONT) A 10,12 16 X 29 X 1 1 PM-04-0108 1″ THROWAWAY
FCC (FRONT) A 16,20 16 X 23 X 1 2 PM-04-0102 1″ THROWAWAY
FCC (FRONT) A 04,06,08 16 X 22 X 1 1 PM-04-4100 2″ THROWAWAY
FCC (FRONT) A 10,12 16 X 29 X 1 1 PM-04-4108 2″ THROWAWAY
FCC (FRONT) A 16,20 16 X 23 X 1 2 PM-04-4102 2″ THROWAWAY
FCCB (BOTTOM) A 04,06,08 14 X 10.5 X 1 2 PM-04-0020 1″ THROWAWAY
FCCB (BOTTOM) A 10,12 14 X 17 X 1 2 PM-04-0062 1″ THROWAWAY
FCCB (BOTTOM) A 16,20 17 X 22.5 X 1 2 PM-04-0118 1″ THROWAWAY
FCCB (BOTTOM) A 04,06,08 14 X 10.5 X 2 2 PM-04-4054 2″ THROWAWAY
FCCB (BOTTOM) A 10,12 14 X 17 X 2 2 PM-04-4113 2″ THROWAWAY
FCCB (BOTTOM) A 16,20 17 X 22.5 X 2 2 PM-04-4118 2″ THROWAWAY
(For Obsolete Model) A 04,06,08 18 X 22 X 1 1 PM-04-0140 1″ THROWAWAY
(For Obsolete Model) A 10,12 18 X 29 X 1 1 PM-04-0134 1″ THROWAWAY
(For Obsolete Model) A 16,20 18 X 23 X 1 2 PM-04-0130 1″ THROWAWAY
(For Obsolete Model) A 04,06,08 18 X 22 X 2 1 PM-04-4140 2″ THROWAWAY
(For Obsolete Model) A 10,12 18 X 29 X 2 1 PM-04-4134 2″ THROWAWAY
(For Obsolete Model) A 16,20 18 X 23 X 2 2 PM-04-4130 2″ THROWAWAY

©2014 Johnson Controls, Inc.


Fan Coil Parts Price List

All List Prices Subject to Change Revision Date: February 2014

Model FS, FCC & FN PSC Motors

Capacitor (Purchase Separately)

FCU MOTOR SELECTION: FAN MOUNTED PERMANENT SPLIT CAPACITOR (PSC)
Product UNIT SIZE QTY. / UNIT VOLTAGE PSC

Motor HP

PSC Motor Part # List Capacitor Part # Capacitor List
FS 03 1 120 1/35 PM-02-1390 PE-12-0499 3 MFD
1 208-230 1/35 PM-02-1391 PE-12-0499 3 MFD
1 277 1/35 PM-02-1392 PE-12-0499 3 MFD
FS 04 1 120 1/25 PM-02-1393 PE-12-0501 5 MFD
1 208-230 1/25 PM-02-1394 PE-12-0499 3 MFD
1 277 1/25 PM-02-1395 PE-12-0499 3 MFD
FS 06 1 120 1/15 PM-02-1396 PE-12-0500 4 MFD
1 208-230 1/15 PM-02-1397 PE-12-0500 4 MFD
1 277 1/15 PM-02-1398 PE-12-0500 4 MFD
FS 08 1 120 1/6 PM-02-0026 PE-12-0500 4 MFD
1 208-230 1/6 PM-02-0030 PE-12-0500 4 MFD
1 277 1/6 PM-02-0032 PE-12-0502 6 MFD
FS 10 1 120 1/5 PM-02-1399 PE-12-0501 5 MFD
1 208-230 1/5 PM-02-1400 PE-12-0501 5 MFD
1 277 1/5 PM-02-1401 PE-12-0501 5 MFD
FS 12 1 120 1/4 PM-02-0046 PE-12-0500 4 MFD
1 208-230 1/4 PM-02-0051 PE-12-0500 4 MFD
1 277 1/4 PM-02-0052 PE-12-0500 4 MFD
FCC 04, 06 1 120 1/6 PM-02-0026 PE-12-0500 4 MFD
1 208-230 1/6 PM-02-0030 PE-12-0500 4 MFD
1 277 1/6 PM-02-0032 PE-12-0502 6 MFD
FCC 08, 10 1 120 1/4 PM-02-0046 PE-12-0500 4 MFD
1 208-230 1/4 PM-02-0051 PE-12-0500 4 MFD
1 277 1/4 PM-02-0052 PE-12-0500 4 MFD
FCC 12 1 120 1/2 PM-02-0068 PE-12-0503 7.5 MFD
1 208-230 1/2 PM-02-0072 PE-12-0503 7.5 MFD
1 277 1/2 PM-02-0076 PE-12-0503 7.5 MFD
FCC 16, 20 2 120 1/4 PM-02-0046 PE-12-0500 4 MFD
2 208-230 1/4 PM-02-0051 PE-12-0500 4 MFD
2 277 1/4 PM-02-0052 PE-12-0500 4 MFD
FN 06 1 120 1/6 PM-02-0026 PE-12-0500 4 MFD
1 208-230 1/6 PM-02-0030 PE-12-0500 4 MFD
1 277 1/6 PM-02-0032 PE-12-0502 6 MFD
FN 08 1 120 1/4 PM-02-1353 PE-12-0500 4 MFD
1 208-230 1/4 PM-02-1354 PE-12-0500 4 MFD
1 277 1/4 PM-02-1355 PE-12-0500 4 MFD
FN 10 1 120 1/4 PM-02-0046 PE-12-0500 4 MFD
1 208-230 1/4 PM-02-0051 PE-12-0500 4 MFD
1 277 1/4 PM-02-0052 PE-12-0500 4 MFD
FN 12 2 120 1/6 PM-02-0026 PE-12-0500 4 MFD
2 208-230 1/6 PM-02-0030 PE-12-0500 4 MFD
2 277 1/6 PM-02-0032 PE-12-0502 6 MFD
FN 14 2 120 1/4 PM-02-1353 PE-12-0500 4 MFD
2 208-230 1/4 PM-02-1354 PE-12-0500 4 MFD
2 277 1/4 PM-02-1355 PE-12-0500 4 MFD
FN 16, 18, 20 2 120 1/4 PM-02-0046 PE-12-0500 4 MFD
2 208-230 1/4 PM-02-0051 PE-12-0500 4 MFD
2 277 1/4 PM-02-0052 PE-12-0500 4 MFD
Notes:

  1. Purchase of any PSC motor from this table must include the purchase of the associated capacitor.
  2. Contact Factory for high static applications.
  3. For FS PSC motors on units prior to 2004 include p/n 00-13095-01 Qty:1 (Motor adapter plate) on parts order.

FS MOTOR ADAPTOR PLATE FOR PRE-2004 UNITS WITH 4-POSITION FAN MOUNTING PATTERN
Product UNIT SIZE QTY. / UNIT VOLTAGE PSC

Motor HP

ADAPTER PLATE PART NUMBER DESCRIPTION List
FS PRIOR TO 2004 OLD 42 FRAME

MOTORS

1 120 ANY 00-13095-01 MOTOR ADAPTER PLATE ASSEMBLY
1 208-230 ANY 00-13095-01 MOTOR ADAPTER PLATE ASSEMBLY
1 277 ANY 00-13095-01 MOTOR ADAPTER PLATE ASSEMBLY

Single Shaft PSC Motors

Model FH, FW & FL

Model FH, FW & FL


Model FH, FW & FL Model FH, FW & FL Single Shaft PSC Motors Dual Shaft PSC Motors
FCU MOTOR SELECTION: SURFACE MOUNTED PERMANENT SPLIT CAPACITOR (PSC)
Product UNIT SIZE QTY. / UNIT VOLTAGE PSC

Motor HP

PSC Motor Part # List Motor Shaft Type Capacitor List
FH 20 1 120 1/30 PM-02-1505 SINGLE SHAFT Included
1 208-230 1/30 PM-02-1504 SINGLE SHAFT Included
1 277 1/30 PM-02-1506 SINGLE SHAFT Included
FH 25 1 120 1/15 PM-02-1510 SINGLE SHAFT Included
1 208-230 1/15 PM-02-1511 SINGLE SHAFT Included
1 277 1/15 PM-02-1512 SINGLE SHAFT Included
FH 30 1 120 1/10 PM-02-1518 DUAL SHAFT Included
1 208-230 1/10 PM-02-1519 DUAL SHAFT Included
1 277 1/10 PM-02-1520 DUAL SHAFT Included
FH 40 1 120 1/6 PM-02-0012 DUAL SHAFT Included
1 208-230 1/6 PM-02-0014 DUAL SHAFT Included
1 277 1/6 PM-02-1517 DUAL SHAFT Included
FH 50 2 1 120 1/6 PM-02-0012 DUAL SHAFT Included
1 120 1/8 PM-02-0001 SINGLE SHAFT Included
1 208-230 1/6 PM-02-0014 DUAL SHAFT Included
1 208-230 1/8 PM-02-0003 SINGLE SHAFT Included
1 277 1/6 PM-02-1517 DUAL SHAFT Included
1 277 1/8 PM-02-1516 SINGLE SHAFT Included
FH 60 2 120 1/6 PM-02-0012 DUAL SHAFT Included
2 208-230 1/6 PM-02-0014 DUAL SHAFT Included
2 277 1/6 PM-02-1517 DUAL SHAFT Included
FW (SERIES C) 02 1 120 1/50 PM-02-0414 SINGLE SHAFT Included
1 208-230 1/50 PM-02-0414 SINGLE SHAFT Included
1 277 1/50 PM-02-0414 SINGLE SHAFT Included
FW (SERIES C) 03 1 120 1/20 PM-02-0417 SINGLE SHAFT Included
1 208-230 1/20 PM-02-0417 SINGLE SHAFT Included
1 277 1/20 PM-02-0417 SINGLE SHAFT Included
FW (SERIES C) 04 1 120 1/20 PM-02-0411 DUAL SHAFT Included
1 208-230 1/20 PM-02-0412 DUAL SHAFT Included
1 277 1/20 PM-02-0413 DUAL SHAFT Included
FW (SERIES C) 06 1 120 1/20 PM-02-0411 DUAL SHAFT Included
1 208-230 1/20 PM-02-0412 DUAL SHAFT Included
1 277 1/20 PM-02-0413 DUAL SHAFT Included
FW (SERIES C) 08 1 120 1/10 PM-02-0420 DUAL SHAFT Included
1 208-230 1/10 PM-02-0421 DUAL SHAFT Included
1 277 1/10 PM-02-0422 DUAL SHAFT Included
FW (SERIES C) 10 2 120 1/20 PM-02-0411 DUAL SHAFT Included
2 208-230 1/20 PM-02-0412 DUAL SHAFT Included
2 277 1/20 PM-02-0413 DUAL SHAFT Included
FW (SERIES C) 12 2 120 1/20 PM-02-0411 DUAL SHAFT Included
2 208-230 1/20 PM-02-0412 DUAL SHAFT Included
2 277 1/20 PM-02-0413 DUAL SHAFT Included
FW (SERIES B) 20 1 120 1/30 PM-02-1505 SINGLE SHAFT Included
1 208-230 1/30 PM-02-1504 SINGLE SHAFT Included
1 277 1/30 PM-02-1506 SINGLE SHAFT Included
FW (SERIES B) 25 1 120 1/15 PM-02-1510 SINGLE SHAFT Included
1 208-230 1/15 PM-02-1511 SINGLE SHAFT Included
1 277 1/15 PM-02-1512 SINGLE SHAFT Included
FW (SERIES B) 30 1 120 1/10 PM-02-1518 DUAL SHAFT Included
1 208-230 1/10 PM-02-1519 DUAL SHAFT Included
1 277 1/10 PM-02-1520 DUAL SHAFT Included
FW (SERIES B) 40 1 120 1/6 PM-02-0012 DUAL SHAFT Included
1 208-230 1/6 PM-02-0014 DUAL SHAFT Included
1 277 1/6 PM-02-1517 DUAL SHAFT Included
FW (SERIES B) 50 1 120 1/6 PM-02-0012 DUAL SHAFT Included
1 120 1/8 PM-02-0001 SINGLE SHAFT Included
1 208-230 1/6 PM-02-0014 DUAL SHAFT Included
1 208-230 1/8 PM-02-0003 SINGLE SHAFT Included
1 277 1/6 PM-02-1517 DUAL SHAFT Included
1 277 1/8 PM-02-1516 SINGLE SHAFT Included
FW (SERIES B) 60 2 120 1/6 PM-02-0012 DUAL SHAFT Included
2 208-230 1/6 PM-02-0014 DUAL SHAFT Included
2 277 1/6 PM-02-1517 DUAL SHAFT Included
FL 02 1 120 1/30 PM-02-1415 SINGLE SHAFT Included
1 208-230 1/30 PM-02-1416 SINGLE SHAFT Included
1 277 1/30 PM-02-1417 SINGLE SHAFT Included
FL 03 1 120 1/15 PM-02-1418 DUAL SHAFT Included
1 208-230 1/15 PM-02-1419 DUAL SHAFT Included
1 277 1/15 PM-02-1420 DUAL SHAFT Included
FL 04 1 120 1/10 PM-02-1418 DUAL SHAFT Included
1 208-230 1/10 PM-02-1419 DUAL SHAFT Included
1 277 1/10 PM-02-1420 DUAL SHAFT Included
FL 06 1 120 1/30 PM-02-1415 SINGLE SHAFT Included
1 208-230 1/30 PM-02-1416 SINGLE SHAFT Included
1 277 1/30 PM-02-1417 SINGLE SHAFT Included
1 120 1/6 PM-02-1418 DUAL SHAFT Included
1 208-230 1/6 PM-02-1419 DUAL SHAFT Included
1 277 1/6 PM-02-1420 DUAL SHAFT Included
Notes:

1. PSC motors from this table have the capacitors included.


Model FS, FCC & FN ECM Motors

FCU ECM 2.3 MOTOR SELECTION
Product UNIT SIZE QTY. / UNIT VOLTAGE ECM

Motor HP

ECM Motor Part # ECM Motor List Price ECM Motor Program
FS 03 1 120 1/3 PM-02-1334
1 208-230 1/3 PM-02-1334
1 277 1/3 PM-02-1302
FS 04 1 120 1/3 PM-02-1334
1 208-230 1/3 PM-02-1334
1 277 1/3 PM-02-1302
FS 06 1 120 1/3 PM-02-1334
1 208-230 1/3 PM-02-1334
1 277 1/3 PM-02-1302
FS 08 1 120 1/3 PM-02-1334 E0069V02
1 208-230 1/3 PM-02-1334 E0069V02
1 277 1/3 PM-02-1302 E0064V02
FS 10 1 120 1/3 PM-02-1334 E0067V01
1 208-230 1/3 PM-02-1334 E0067V01
1 277 1/3 PM-02-1302 E0062V01
FS 12 1 120 1/2 PM-02-1335 E0068V01
1 208-230 1/2 PM-02-1335 E0068V01
1 277 1/2 PM-02-1303 E0063V01
FCC 04, 06 1 120 Contact Factory
1 208-230 Contact Factory
1 277 Contact Factory
FCC 08, 10 1 120 1/3 PM-02-1334 E0079V01
1 208-230 1/3 PM-02-1334 E0079V01
1 277 1/3 PM-02-1302 E0073V01
FCC 12 1 120 1/2 PM-02-1335 E0080V01
1 208-230 1/2 PM-02-1335 E0080V01
1 277 1/2 PM-02-1303 E0074V01
FCC 16, 20 2 120 Contact Factory
2 208-230 Contact Factory
2 277 Contact Factory
FN 06 1 120 1/3 PM-02-1334 E0041V01
1 208-230 1/3 PM-02-1334 E0041V01
1 277 1/3 PM-02-1302 E0040V01
FN 08 1 120 1/3 PM-02-1334 E0051V01
1 208-230 1/3 PM-02-1334 E0051V01
1 277 1/3 PM-02-1302 E0050V01
FN 10 1 120 1/3 PM-02-1334 E0051V01
1 208-230 1/3 PM-02-1334 E0051V01
1 277 1/3 PM-02-1302 E0050V01
FN 12 2 120 1/3 PM-02-1334 E0041V01
2 208-230 1/3 PM-02-1334 E0041V01
2 277 1/3 PM-02-1302 E0040V01
FN 14 2 120 1/3 PM-02-1334 E0051V01
2 208-230 1/3 PM-02-1334 E0051V01
2 277 1/3 PM-02-1302 E0050V01
FN 16, 18, 20 2 120 1/3 PM-02-1334 E0051V01
2 208-230 1/3 PM-02-1334 E0051V01
2 277 1/3 PM-02-1302 E0050V01
Notes:

  1. Purchase of any ECM motor must include the associated ECM program number from this table.
  2. List price for ECM 2.3 Motors include complete motor and controller assembly.

©2014 Johnson Controls, Inc.

Fan Coil Parts Price List


All List Prices Subject to Change Revision Date: February 2014

Note: Use this table for lookup purposes only to locate and order the correct associated PM-02-xxxx part number.

MOTOR MANUFACTURER PART NUMBER CROSS REFERENCE TABLE
Motor Part

Number

Old/Obsolete P/N Description Drawing

Number

Manufacturer Part # Capacitor Part # Capacitor Motor List

Price

Capacitor

List Price

PM-02-1390 MTR,1/35HP,120V,ODP 3 SPD 7187-0233 PE-12-0499 3 MFD
PM-02-1391 MTR,1/35HP,208/230V,ODP 3 SPD 7187-0256 PE-12-0499 3 MFD
PM-02-1392 MTR,1/35HP,277V,ODP 3 SPD 7187-0238 PE-12-0499 3 MFD
PM-02-1393 MTR,1/25HP,120V, ODP 3 SPD 7187-0239 PE-12-0501 5 MFD
PM-02-1394 MTR,1/25HP,208/230V, ODP 3 SPD 7187-0257 PE-12-0499 3 MFD
PM-02-1395 MTR,1/25HP,277V, ODP 3 SPD 7187-0258 PE-12-0499 3 MFD
PM-02-1396 MTR,1/15HP,120V, ODP 3 SPD 7187-0260 PE-12-0500 4 MFD
PM-02-1397 MTR,1/15HP,208/230V, ODP 3 SPD 7187-0261 PE-12-0500 4 MFD
PM-02-1398 MTR,1/15HP,277V, ODP 3 SPD 7187-0259 PE-12-0500 4 MFD
PM-02-0026 MTR 1/6HP, 1PH, 120/60 ODP 44-189 7126-1290 PE-12-0500 4 MFD
PM-02-0030 MTR 1/6HP, 1PH, 208-230/60 ODP 44-189 7126-3389 PE-12-0500 4 MFD
PM-02-0032 MTR 1/6HP, 1PH, 240-277/50-60 ODP 44-189 7126-1291 PE-12-0502 6 MFD
PM-02-1399 MTR,1/5HP,120V,ODP 3 SPD 7187-0242 PE-12-0501 5 MFD
PM-02-1400 MTR,1/5HP,208/230V, ODP 3SPD 7187-0243 PE-12-0501 5 MFD
PM-02-1401 MTR,1/5HP,277V, ODP 3SPD 7187-0241 PE-12-0501 5 MFD
PM-02-0046 MTR 1/4HP, 1PH, 120/60 ODP 44-189 7126-3992 PE-12-0500 4 MFD
PM-02-0051 MTR 1/4HP, 1PH, 208-230/60 ODP D-FR 7126-3390 PE-12-0500 4 MFD
PM-02-0052 MTR 1/4HP, 1PH, 240-277/50-60 ODP 44-189 7126-1033 PE-12-0500 4 MFD
PM-02-0068 MTR 1/2HP, 1PH, 120/60 ODP 44-189 7126-1031 PE-12-0503 7.5 MFD
PM-02-0072 MTR 1/2HP, 1PH, 208-230/60 ODP 7126-3391 PE-12-0503 7.5 MFD
PM-02-0076 MTR 1/2HP, 1PH, 240-277/50-60 ODP 44-189 7126-1034 PE-12-0503 7.5 MFD
PM-02-1353 MTR,1/4HP,120V 48 FRAME 7126-4890 PE-12-0500 4 MFD
PM-02-1354 MTR,1/4HP,208/230,48 FRAME 7126-4889 PE-12-0500 4 MFD
PM-02-1355 MTR,1/4HP,277V 48 FRAME 7126-4888 PE-12-0500 4 MFD
PM-02-1505 PM-02-0000 MTR,1/30 HP,120 V, SINGLE SHAFT,42411 44-113 7187-0322 included w/ motor n/a
PM-02-1504 PM-02-0002 MTR,1/30HP,208/230V,42FR,SINGLE 44-113 7187-0319 included w/ motor n/a
PM-02-1506 PM-02-0004 MTR,1/30 HP,277 V, SINGLE SHAFT,42FRM 44-113 7187-0323 included w/ motor n/a
PM-02-1510 PM-02-0007 MTR,1/15HP, 120/1/60 SGL SHAFT 7185-0330 included w/ motor n/a
PM-02-1511 PM-02-0009 MTR, 1/15HP, 230/1/60 SGL SHAFT 7185-0331 included w/ motor n/a
PM-02-1512 PM-02-0011 MTR, 1/15HP, 277/1/60 SGL SHAFT 7185-0332 included w/ motor n/a
PM-02-1518 PM-02-0006 MTR 1/10HP,42FRM,DL SHFT,1.6A,115V 7185-0344 included w/ motor n/a
PM-02-1519 PM-02-0008 MTR 1/10H,42FRM,DL SHFT,.7A,208/230 7185-0345 included w/ motor n/a
PM-02-1520 PM-02-0010 MTR 1/10HP,42FRM,DL SHFT,.6A,277V 7185-0343 included w/ motor n/a
PM-02-0012 MTR, 1/6 HP, 120/1/60 DUAL SHAFT 44-116 7185-0114 included w/ motor n/a
PM-02-0014 MTR, 1/6 HP, 230/1/60 DUAL SHAFT 44-116 7185-0117 included w/ motor n/a
PM-02-1517 MTR 1/6HP,42FRM,DUAL SHFT,.85A,277V 7185-0333 included w/ motor n/a
PM-02-0001 MTR, 1/8 HP, 115/1/60 SGL SHAFT 44-127 7184-0275 included w/ motor n/a
PM-02-0003 MTR, 1/8 HP, 230/1/60 SGL SHAFT 44-127 7184-0276 included w/ motor n/a
PM-02-1516 MTR,1/8HP,42FRM,S SHAFT,.68AMP,277V included w/ motor n/a
PM-02-0414 MTR,1/50HP,115/1/60SNGLSHAFT 44-00080 DF3C001 included w/ motor n/a
PM-02-0417 MTR,1/20HP,115/1/60SNGLSHAFT 44-00079 DF3D021 included w/ motor n/a
PM-02-0411 MTR,1/20HP,115/1/60 DBL SHAFT 44-00081 DF3M001 included w/ motor n/a
PM-02-0412 MTR,1/20HP,208/230/1/60DBLSHAFT 44-00095 DF3M002N included w/ motor n/a
PM-02-0413 MTR,1/20HP,277/1/60DBLSHAFT 44-00096 DF3M003N included w/ motor n/a
PM-02-0420 MTR,1/10HP,115/1/60DBLSHAFT 44-00082 DF2E065N included w/ motor n/a
PM-02-0421 MTR,1/10HP,208/230/1/60DBLSHAFT 44-00097 DF2E066N included w/ motor n/a
PM-02-0422 MTR,1/10HP,277/1/60DBLSHAFT 44-00098 DF2E067N included w/ motor n/a
PM-02-1415 MTR,1/25HP,120V,0.6A,1315RPM,SS 7185-0290 included w/ motor n/a
PM-02-1416 MTR,1/25HP,208/280V,0.3,1315RPM 7185-0299-A included w/ motor n/a
PM-02-1417 MTR,1/25HP,277V,0.3,1315RPM 7185-0302 included w/ motor n/a
PM-02-1418 MTR,1/25HP,120V,0.6A,1115RPM,DS 7187-0285 included w/ motor n/a
PM-02-1419 MTR,1/25HP,208/280V,0.3,1115RPM 7187-0295-A included w/ motor n/a
PM-02-1420 MTR,1/25HP,277V,0.3,1115RPM 7187-0296-A included w/ motor n/a
PM-02-1501 MTR.1/12HP,115V,42FR,ODP,3SPD 7185-0324 REV A PE-12-0501 5 MFD
PM-02-0098 MTR 3/4HP, 1PH, 120/60 ODP 44-189 7126-1032 PE-12-0504 10 MFD
PM-02-0124 MTR 1 HP, 1PH, 115/60 ODP 44-189 7126-2655 PE-12-0506 15 MFD
PM-02-1502 MTR,1/12HP,208/230V,42FR,ODP,3SPD 7185-0323 REV A PE-12-0501 5 MFD
PM-02-0104 MTR 3/4HP, 1PH, 208-230/60 ODP 44-189 7126-3392 PE-12-0504 10 MFD
PM-02-0126 MTR 1HP, 1PH, 208-230/60 ODP D-FR 7126-0797 PE-12-0508 20 MFD
PM-02-1338 MTR,1/6HP,220/240,50HZ,48FR 7126-4810 PE-12-0502 6 MFD
PM-02-1339 MTR,1/4HP,220/240,50HZ,48FR 7126-4807 PE-12-0503 7.5 MFD
PM-02-1340 MTR,1/2HP,220/240,50HZ,48FR 7126-4808 PE-12-0504 10 MFD
PM-02-1341 MTR,3/4HP,220/240,50HZ,48FR 7126-4809 PE-12-0505 12.5 MFD
PM-02-1342 MTR,1HP,220/240,50HZ,48FR 7126-4811 PE-12-0508 20 MFD
PM-02-1503 MTR,1/12HP,277V,42FR,ODP,3SPD 7185-0325 REV A PE-12-0509 3 MFD
PM-02-0106 MTR 3/4HP, 1PH, 240-277/50-60 ODP 44-189 7126-1035 PE-12-0504 10 MFD
PM-02-0128 MTR 1 HP, 1PH, 240-277/50-60 ODP 44-189 7126-3142 PE-12-0506 15 MFD
PM-02-0056 MTR 1/4HP, 1PH, 480/60 ODP 44-189 7126-1351 PE-12-0500 4 MFD
PM-02-0086 MTR 1/2HP, 1PH, 480/60 ODP 44-189 7126-1350 PE-12-0503 7.5 MFD
PM-02-0116 MTR 3/4 HP, 1PH, 480/60 ODP 44-189 7126-1386 PE-12-0504 10 MFD
PM-02-1404 MTR,1/4HP,115V,48FRAME, ODP 3SPD 7126-5020 PE-12-0500 4 MFD
PM-02-1403 MTR,1/4HP, 208/230V,48FRAME,ODP3SPD 7126-5019 PE-12-0500 4 MFD
PM-02-1402 MTR,1/4HP,277V 48FRAME ODP 3 SPD 7126-5018 PE-12-0500 4 MFD
PM-02-1350 MTR,1/6HP,3SPD,480V,48FRAME 7126-3577 PE-12-0502 6 MFD
PM-02-1507 MTR,1/3 HP, 115 V, D FRAME MTR,BB REQD 7126-5228 PE-12-0500 4 MFD
PM-02-1508 MTR,1/3 HP,208-230 V, D FRAME MTR,BB REQD 7126-5262 PE-12-0500 4 MFD
PM-02-1509 MTR,1/3 HP, 277 V, D FRAME MTR,BB REQD 7126-5263 PE-12-0500 4 MFD
PM-02-0001 MTR, 1/8 HP, 115/1/60 SGL SHAFT 44-127 7184-0275 included w/ motor 5 MFD
PM-02-1367 MTR,1/4HP,115V,42FR,3SPD,ODP DS 7185-0263 included w/ motor 5 MFD
PM-02-1376 MTR,1/2HP,115V,42FR,3SPD,ODP DS 7124-2336 included w/ motor 5 MFD
PM-02-0003 MTR, 1/8 HP, 230/1/60 SGL SHAFT 44-127 7184-0276 included w/ motor 5 MFD
PM-02-1368 MTR,1/4HP,208/230,42FR 3SPD ODP DS 7185-0247 included w/ motor 5 MFD
PM-02-1377 MTR,1/2HP,208/230V,48FR,3SPD,ODP DS 7124-2337 included w/ motor 5 MFD
PM-02-1516 MTR,1/8HP,42FRM,S SHAFT,.68AMP,277V included w/ motor 4 MFD
PM-02-1369 MTR,1/4HP,277V,42FR.3SPD,ODP DS 7185-0248 included w/ motor 5 MFD
PM-02-1378 MTR,1/2HP,277V,48FR,3SPD,ODP, DS 7124-2338 included w/ motor 5 MFD

©2014 Johnson Controls, Inc.

Fan Coil Parts Price List

All List Prices Subject to Change Revision Date: February 2014

FS FAN ASSEMBLY
UNIT SIZE QTY. / UNIT FAN ASSEMBLY LIST BLOWER ONLY LIST EACH
03 1 B74-03-009 PM-06-0158
04 1 B74-04-009 PM-06-0159
06 1 B74-06-009 PM-06-0160
08 1 B74-08-009 PM-06-0122
10 1 B74-10-009 PM-06-0161
12 1 B74-12-009 PM-06-0126

Notes:

    1. Motors not included – See Motor Table to order motor(s) separately.
    2. Blower Only includes fan housing, fan cutoff and fan wheel.
    3. Blower Only is not reccomended since the guide plate is spot welded in place.


FS Fan Assembly with Fan Runners, Capacitor Bracket and Guide Plate.

FCC FAN ASSEMBLY
UNIT SIZE QTY. / UNIT FAN ASSEMBLY LIST BLOWER ONLY LIST EACH
04 1 16-13003-02 PM-06-0120
06 1 16-13003-02 PM-06-0120
08 1 16-13003-04 PM-06-0162
10 1 16-13003-04 PM-06-0162
12 1 16-13003-05 PM-06-0129
16 2 16-13003-04 PM-06-0162
20 2 16-13003-04 PM-06-0162

Notes:

  1. Motors not included – See Motor Table to order motor(s) separately.
  2. Blower Only includes fan housing, fan cutoff and fan wheel.
  3. Blower Only is not reccomended since the guide plate is spot welded in place.



FCC Fan Assembly with Fan Runners, Capacitor Bracket and Guide Plate.

FN FAN ASSEMBLY PART #
UNIT SIZE QTY. / UNIT FAN ASSEMBLY LIST BLOWER ONLY LIST EACH
06 1 82-10029-01 PM-06-0118
08 1 82-10029-02 PM-06-0138
10 1 82-10029-02 PM-06-0138
12 2 82-10029-01 PM-06-0118
14 2 82-10029-02 PM-06-0138
16 2 82-10029-02 PM-06-0138
18 2 82-10029-02 PM-06-0138
20 2 82-10029-02 PM-06-0138

Notes:

  1. Motors not included – See Motor Table to order motor(s) separately.
  2. Blower only includes fan housing, fan cutoff and fan wheel.


FN Fan Assembly with Fan Runners & Capacitor Bracket.

FW SERIES “C” FAN DECK ASSEMBLY (INCLUDES BLOWERS)
UNIT SIZE BLOWER

QTY.

FAN ASSEMBLY LIST BLOWER ONLY LIST EACH
02 1 Contact Factory Contact Factory
03 1 Contact Factory Contact Factory
04 2 Contact Factory Contact Factory
06 2 Contact Factory Contact Factory
08 2 Contact Factory Contact Factory
10 4 Contact Factory Contact Factory
12 4 Contact Factory Contact Factory

Notes:

  1. Motors not included – See Motor Table to order motor(s) separately.
  2. Fan Deck Assembly includes complete Blower/Fan assembly(s) mounted on deck.

  3. Blower only includes fan housing, fan cutoff and fan wheel.

FW Series “C” Fan Deck Assembly

FW SERIES “B” FAN DECK ASSEMBLY (INCLUDES BLOWERS)
UNIT SIZE BLOWER

QTY.

FAN ASSEMBLY LIST BLOWER ONLY LIST EACH
20 1 CONTACT FACTORY PM-06-0006
25 1 CONTACT FACTORY PM-06-0006
30 2 CONTACT FACTORY PM-06-0006
40 2 CONTACT FACTORY PM-06-0006
50 3 CONTACT FACTORY PM-06-0006
60 4 CONTACT FACTORY PM-06-0006

Notes:

  1. Motors not included – See Motor Table to order motor(s) separately.
  2. Fan Deck Assembly includes complete Blower/Fan assembly(s) mounted on deck.

  3. Blower only includes fan housing, fan cutoff and fan wheel.

FW Series “B” Fan Deck Assembly

FH FAN DECK ASSEMBLY (INCLUDES BLOWERS)
UNIT SIZE BLOWER

QTY.

FAN ASSEMBLY LIST BLOWER ONLY LIST EACH
20 1 B47-20-551 PM-06-0006
25 1 B47-25-551 PM-06-0006
30 2 B47-30-551 PM-06-0006
40 2 B47-40-551 PM-06-0006
50 3 B47-50-551 PM-06-0006
60 4 B47-60-551 PM-06-0006

Notes:

  1. Motors not included – See Motor Table to order motor(s) separately.
  2. Fan Deck Assembly includes complete Blower/Fan assembly(s) mounted on deck.

  3. Blower only includes fan housing, fan cutoff and fan wheel.

FH Fan Deck Assembly

FL FAN DECK ASSEMBLY
UNIT SIZE BLOWER

QTY

FAN ASSEMBLY LIST BLOWER ONLY LIST EACH
02 1 Contact Factory PM-06-0163
03 2 Contact Factory PM-06-0163
04 2 Contact Factory PM-06-0163
06 3 Contact Factory PM-06-0163

Notes:

  1. Motors not included – See Motor Table to order motor(s) separately.
  2. Blower only includes fan housing, fan cutoff and fan wheel.

  3. Contact Factory with CO# and Line# for complete replacement fan deck assemblies.

FL Fan Deck Assembly

©2014 Johnson Controls, Inc.

Fan Coil Parts Price List

All List Prices Subject to Change Revision Date: February 2014

FAN COIL UNIT WATER COIL ASSEMBLIES

Please contact Customer Service with the original equipment order number (CO# or ET#) and the order Line#. The factory will be able to provide the replacement coil information based on the specific order.

FN COIL ASSEMBLY LIST PRICES
WATER COOLING / HEATING COILS
ROWS UNIT SIZE
06 08 10 12 14 16 18 20
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8

Notes:

  1. Coil Prices are for base coils with .016″ wall tubes and .0045″ aluminum fins spaced 10 per inch. Actual price may vary.
  2. All water coils are furnished with manual air vents, auto air vents are an additional charge.
  3. Contact Factory for specific part numbers for the above coils or for DX or steam coil configurations.
WATER COIL ASSEMBLIES, MODEL FCC
AUX HOT WATER CHILLED WATER
UNIT SIZE 1 ROW 2 ROW 3 ROW 4 ROW
PART # LIST PART # LIST PART # LIST PART # LIST
04 B50-2003(L/R)-BG B50-2004(L/R)-BG B50-2000(L/R)-BG B50-2001(L/R)-BG
06 B50-2003(L/R)-BG B50-2004(L/R)-BG B50-2010(L/R)-BG B50-2011(L/R)-BG
08 B50-2023(L/R)-BG B50-2024(L/R)-BG B50-2020(L/R)-BG B50-2021(L/R)-BG
10 B50-2043(L/R)-BG B50-2044(L/R)-BG B50-2030(L/R)-BG B50-2031(L/R)-BG
12 B50-2043(L/R)-BG B50-2044(L/R)-BG B50-2040(L/R)-BG B50-2041(L/R)-BG
16 B50-2063(L/R)-BG B50-2064(L/R)-BG B50-2050(L/R)-BG B50-2051(L/R)-BG
20 B50-2063(L/R)-BG B50-2064(L/R)-BG B50-2060(L/R)-BG B50-2061(L/R)-BG

Notes:

    1. Cooling and heating coils must be ordered separately.
    2. Coil hand must be specified at time of order.
    3. All coils are .016″ wall tubes and .0045″ aluminum fins spaced 10 per inch.
    4. All water coils are furnished with manual air vent unless otherwise specified.
    5. Contact Factory for DX or steam coils.
FW SERIES “C” COIL ASSEMBLY LIST PRICES
WATER COOLING / HEATING COILS
ROWS UNIT SIZE
02 03 04 06 08 10 12
1
2
3
4

Notes:

  1. Coil Prices are for base coils with .016″ wall tubes and .0045″ aluminum fins spaced 10 per inch. Actual price may vary.
  2. All water coils are furnished with manual air vents, auto air vents are an additional charge.
  3. Contact Factory for specific part numbers for the above coils or for DX or steam coil configurations.
  4. Purchase of FW Series “C” coils for units built prior to 2013 require additional coil mounting bracket p/n: 51-00723-01 $15 List QTY: 1 per coil.
FW SERIES “B” COIL ASSEMBLY LIST PRICES
WATER COOLING / HEATING COILS
ROWS UNIT SIZE
20 25 30 40 50 60
1
2
3
4
5
6

Notes:

  1. Coil Prices are for base coils with .016″ wall tubes and .0045″ aluminum fins spaced 10 per inch. Actual price may vary.
  2. All water coils are furnished with manual air vents, auto air vents are an additional charge.
  3. Contact Factory for specific part numbers for the above coils or for DX or steam coil configurations.
FH COIL ASSEMBLY LIST PRICES
WATER COOLING / HEATING COILS
ROWS UNIT SIZE
20 25 30 40 50 60
1
2
3
4
5
6

Notes:

  1. Coil Prices are for base coils with .016″ wall tubes and .0045″ aluminum fins spaced 10 per inch. Actual price may vary.
  2. All water coils are furnished with manual air vents, auto air vents are available for an additional charge.
  3. Contact Factory for specific part numbers for the above coils or for DX or steam coil configurations.
FL COIL ASSEMBLY LIST PRICES
WATER COOLING / HEATING COILS
ROWS UNIT SIZE
02 03 04 06
1
2
3
4
5

Notes:

  1. Coil Prices are for base coils with .016″ wall tubes and .0045″ aluminum fins spaced 10 per inch. Actual price may vary.
  2. All water coils are furnished with manual air vents, auto air vents are an additional charge.
  3. Contact Factory for specific part numbers for the above coils or for DX or steam coil configurations.
WATER COIL ASSEMBLIES, MODEL (FS Series A)
UNIT SIZE COIL ROWS PART # LIST
03 / 04 3 ROW COOLING B74-2009-DG
4 ROW COOLING B74-2006-DG
3 ROW COOLING / 1 ROW HEATING 1 B74-2018-DG
3 ROW COOLING / 2 ROW HEATING 1 B74-2015-DG
4 ROW COOLING / 1 ROW HEATING 1 B74-2012-DG
06 / 08 3 ROW COOLING B74-2010-DG
4 ROW COOLING B74-2007-DG
3 ROW COOLING / 1 ROW HEATING 1 B74-2019-DG
3 ROW COOLING / 2 ROW HEATING 1 B74-2016-DG
4 ROW COOLING / 1 ROW HEATING 1 B74-2013-DG
10 / 12 3 ROW COOLING B74-2011-DG
4 ROW COOLING B74-2008-DG
3 ROW COOLING / 1 ROW HEATING 1 B74-2020-DG
3 ROW COOLING / 2 ROW HEATING 1 B74-2017-DG
4 ROW COOLING / 1 ROW HEATING 1 B74-2014-DG

Notes:

  1. Must specify Right or Left handed coil.
WATER COIL ASSEMBLIES, MODEL FS (Series B)
UNIT SIZE COIL ROWS CLG CKTS PART # LIST
03 / 04 3 ROW COOLING 1 B74-2109-DG
3 ROW COOLING 2 B74-2124-DG
4 ROW COOLING 1 B74-2106-DG
4 ROW COOLING 2 B74-2121-DG
3 ROW COOLING /

1 ROW HEATING 1

1 B74-2118-DG
3 ROW COOLING /

1 ROW HEATING 1

2 B74-2133-DG
3 ROW COOLING /

2 ROW HEATING 1

1 B74-2115-DG
3 ROW COOLING /

2 ROW HEATING 1

2 B74-2130-DG
4 ROW COOLING /

1 ROW HEATING 1

1 B74-2112-DG
4 ROW COOLING /

1 ROW HEATING 1

2 B74-2127-DG
06 / 08 3 ROW COOLING 2 B74-2110-DG
3 ROW COOLING 3 B74-2125-DG
3 ROW COOLING 4 B74-2136-DG
4 ROW COOLING 2 B74-2107-DG
4 ROW COOLING 3 B74-2122-DG
4 ROW COOLING 4 B74-2137-DG
3 ROW COOLING /

1 ROW HEATING 1

2 B74-2119-DG
3 ROW COOLING /

1 ROW HEATING 1

3 B74-2134-DG
3 ROW COOLING /

1 ROW HEATING 1

4 B74-2138-DG
3 ROW COOLING /

2 ROW HEATING 1

2 B74-2116-DG
3 ROW COOLING /

2 ROW HEATING 1

3 B74-2131-DG
3 ROW COOLING /

2 ROW HEATING 1

4 B74-2139-DG
4 ROW COOLING /

1 ROW HEATING 1

2 B74-2113-DG
4 ROW COOLING /

1 ROW HEATING 1

3 B74-2128-DG
4 ROW COOLING /

1 ROW HEATING 1

4 B74-2140-DG
10 / 12 3 ROW COOLING 3 B74-2111-DG
3 ROW COOLING 4 B74-2126-DG
4 ROW COOLING 3 B74-2108-DG
4 ROW COOLING 4 B74-2123-DG
3 ROW COOLING /

1 ROW HEATING 1

3 B74-2120-DG
3 ROW COOLING /

1 ROW HEATING 1

4 B74-2135-DG
3 ROW COOLING /

2 ROW HEATING 1

3 B74-2117-DG
3 ROW COOLING /

2 ROW HEATING 1

4 B74-2132-DG
4 ROW COOLING /

1 ROW HEATING 1

3 B74-2114-DG
4 ROW COOLING /

1 ROW HEATING 1

4 B74-2129-DG

Notes:

    1. Combination coils have common casing parts and must be ordered as an assembly, unless unit is 2 pipe.
    2. All 4-pipe coils have the heating coil in the “re-heat” position only.
    3. All water coils are furnished with manual air vent unless otherwise specified.
    4. Replacement coils are furnished with connection tubes only. Existing valve package must be removed and reattached to new coil in the field.

FS RISER-TO-COIL HOSE / BALL VALVE ASSEMBLY
PART # DESCRIPTION LIST
PC-00-0283 BRAIDED HOSE, 1/2″, w/ 1/2″ FEM

SWIVEL X 3/4″ FEM SWIVEL

PC-00-0282 BALL VALVE, RISER TO HOSE, WITH

MEMORY STOP

PR-07-0115 COMMON HOSE TO BALL VALVE O-

RING

PR-07-0116 1/2″ ADAPTER FITTING TO HOSE

BLACK GASKET

2-POSITION CONTROL VALVE BODY
PART # DESCRIPTION LIST
PC-00-0243 2 WAY, 1/2″
PC-00-0244 3 WAY, 1/2″
PC-00-0245 2 WAY, 3/4″
PC-00-0246 3 WAY, 3/4″
PC-00-0247 2 WAY, 1″
PC-00-0248 3 WAY, 1″
2 POSITION VALVE ACTUATORS, STD POP-TOP
PART # VOLTAGE Wire Length (in.) CW / HW LIST
PC-00-0249 24 VOLT
PC-00-0735 24 VOLT 44 Chilled Water
PC-00-0736 24 VOLT 44 Hot Water
PC-00-0761 24 VOLT 56 Chilled Water
PC-00-0762 24 VOLT 56 Hot Water
PC-00-0773 24 VOLT 86 Chilled Water
PC-00-0774 24 VOLT 86 Hot Water
PC-00-0250 120 VOLT
PC-00-0737 120 VOLT 44 Chilled Water
PC-00-0738 120 VOLT 44 Hot Water
PC-00-0763 120 VOLT 56 Chilled Water
PC-00-0764 120 VOLT 56 Hot Water
PC-00-0775 120 VOLT 86 Chilled Water
PC-00-0776 120 VOLT 86 Hot Water
PC-00-0251 208 VOLT
PC-00-0739 208 VOLT 44 Chilled Water
PC-00-0740 208 VOLT 44 Hot Water
PC-00-0765 208 VOLT 56 Chilled Water
PC-00-0766 208 VOLT 56 Hot Water
PC-00-0777 208 VOLT 86 Chilled Water
PC-00-0778 208 VOLT 86 Hot Water
PC-00-0252 240 VOLT
PC-00-0741 240 VOLT 44 Chilled Water
PC-00-0742 240 VOLT 44 Hot Water
PC-00-0767 240 VOLT 56 Chilled Water
PC-00-0768 240 VOLT 56 Hot Water
PC-00-0779 240 VOLT 86 Chilled Water
PC-00-0780 240 VOLT 86 Hot Water
PC-00-0253 277 VOLT
PC-00-0743 277 VOLT 44 Chilled Water
PC-00-0744 277 VOLT 44 Hot Water
PC-00-0769 277 VOLT 56 Chilled Water
PC-00-0770 277 VOLT 56 Hot Water
PC-00-0781 277 VOLT 86 Chilled Water
PC-00-0782 277 VOLT 86 Hot Water
MODULATING CONTROL VALVE BODY
PART # DESCRIPTION LIST
CONTACT FACTORY 2 WAY, 1/2″
CONTACT FACTORY 3 WAY, 1/2″
CONTACT FACTORY 2 WAY, 3/4″
CONTACT FACTORY 3 WAY, 3/4″
CONTACT FACTORY 2 WAY, 1″
CONTACT FACTORY 3 WAY, 1″
MODULATING 3-WIRE ACTUATORS, STD POP-TOP
PART # VOLTAGE Wire Length (in.) CW / HW LIST
CONTACT FACTORY CF CF
CONTACT FACTORY CF CF
CONTACT FACTORY CF CF
CONTACT FACTORY CF CF
MISCELLANEOUS COMPONENTS
PART # DESCRIPTION LIST
PC-00-0272 ACTUATOR,PT,HIGH PRESSURE CLOSE-OFF,24V
PC-00-0273 ACTUATOR,PT,HIGH PRESSURE CLOSE-OFF,120V
PC-00-0274 ACTUATOR,PT,HIGH PRESSURE CLOSE-OFF,208V
PC-00-0275 ACTUATOR,PT,HIGH PRESSURE CLOSE-OFF,240V
PC-00-0276 ACTUATOR,PT,HIGH PRESSURE CLOSE-OFF,277V
PC-00-0283 1/2Braided Hose W/1/2 & 3/4 Swivel
PR-04-0203 1/2 OD Swaged Crossover 3.75 X 2.375
PC-00-0373 Act Pt 3Wire Fltg Non -Sprg Rtn
PR-04-0118 Adaptor, Copper, 1/4 Fpt X 1/4 Ods
PR-04-0247 Assy Coil Vent Automatic
PR-04-0246 Assy Coil Vent Manual
PR-04-0024 Connector Tube .625 X .025
PR-04-0178 Connector Tube 5/8 X 4.925 X .025
PM-07-0073 Drain Pan Adapter 3/4″ Abs
PM-07-0075 Drain Pan Aux D61 Wall Plastic
PC-00-0264 Drain Valve W/ 1/4Mnptx3/4Hose Con
PM-07-0006 Fitting, Press/Temp Port, Std Ht
PC-00-0301 Flow Cntrl,1/2 Swt,0.55 Gpm
PC-00-0325 Flow Cntrl,1/2 Swt,0.55 Gpm W/Scrn
PC-00-0302 Flow Cntrl,1/2 Swt,1.00 Gpm
PC-00-0326 Flow Cntrl,1/2 Swt,1.00 Gpm W/Scrn
PC-00-0303 Flow Cntrl,1/2 Swt,1.50 Gpm
PC-00-0327 Flow Cntrl,1/2 Swt,1.50 Gpm W/Scrn
PC-00-0304 Flow Cntrl,1/2 Swt,2.00 Gpm
PC-00-0328 Flow Cntrl,1/2 Swt,2.00 Gpm W/Scrn
PC-00-0305 Flow Cntrl,1/2 Swt,2.50 Gpm
PC-00-0329 Flow Cntrl,1/2 Swt,2.50 Gpm W/Scrn
PC-00-0306 Flow Cntrl,1/2 Swt,3.00 Gpm
PC-00-0330 Flow Cntrl,1/2 Swt,3.00 Gpm W/Scrn
PC-00-0307 Flow Cntrl,1/2 Swt,3.50 Gpm
PC-00-0331 Flow Cntrl,1/2 Swt,3.50 Gpm W/Scrn
PC-00-0308 Flow Cntrl,1/2 Swt,4.00 Gpm
PC-00-0332 Flow Cntrl,1/2 Swt,4.00 Gpm W/Scrn
PC-00-0309 Flow Cntrl,1/2 Swt,5.00 Gpm
PC-00-0333 Flow Cntrl,1/2 Swt,5.00 Gpm W/Scrn
PC-00-0310 Flow Cntrl,1/2 Swt,6.00 Gpm
PC-00-0334 Flow Cntrl,1/2 Swt,6.00 Gpm W/Scrn
PC-00-0311 Flow Cntrl,1/2 Swt,7.00 Gpm
PC-00-0335 Flow Cntrl,1/2 Swt,7.00 Gpm W/Scrn
PC-00-0312 Flow Cntrl,1/2 Swt,8.00 Gpm
PC-00-0336 Flow Cntrl,1/2 Swt,8.00 Gpm W/Scrn
PC-00-0505 Flow Control 2517 1/2In 3.0 Gpm
PC-00-0524 Flow Control 2517 1/2In 1.75 Gpm
PC-00-0525 Flow Control 2517 1/2In 2.25 Gpm
PC-00-0526 Flow Control 2517 1/2In 3.25 Gpm
PC-00-0500 Flow Control, 2517, 1/2In, 0.5 Gpm
PC-00-0501 Flow Control, 2517, 1/2In, 1.0 Gpm
PC-00-0502 Flow Control, 2517, 1/2In, 1.5 Gpm
PC-00-0503 Flow Control, 2517, 1/2In, 2.0 Gpm
PC-00-0504 Flow Control, 2517, 1/2In, 2.5 Gpm
PC-00-0506 Flow Control, 2517, 1/2In, 3.5 Gpm
PC-00-0507 Flow Control, 2517, 1/2In, 4.0 Gpm
PC-00-0508 Flow Control, 2517, 1/2In, 5.0 Gpm
PC-00-0509 Flow Control, 2517, 1/2In, 6.0 Gpm
PC-00-0510 Flow Control, 2517, 1/2In, 7.0 Gpm
PC-00-0511 Flow Control, 2517, 1/2In, 8.0 Gpm
PC-00-0512 Flow Control, 2517, 3/4In, 0.5 Gpm
PC-00-0513 Flow Control, 2517, 3/4In, 1.0 Gpm
PC-00-0514 Flow Control, 2517, 3/4In, 1.5 Gpm
PC-00-0515 Flow Control, 2517, 3/4In, 2.0 Gpm
PC-00-0516 Flow Control, 2517, 3/4In, 2.5 Gpm
PC-00-0517 Flow Control, 2517, 3/4In, 3.0 Gpm
PC-00-0518 Flow Control, 2517, 3/4In, 3.5 Gpm
PC-00-0519 Flow Control, 2517, 3/4In, 4.0 Gpm
PC-00-0520 Flow Control, 2517, 3/4In, 5.0 Gpm
PC-00-0521 Flow Control, 2517, 3/4In, 6.0 Gpm
PC-00-0522 Flow Control, 2517, 3/4In, 7.0 Gpm
PC-00-0523 Flow Control, 2517, 3/4In, 8.0 Gpm
PC-00-0192 Flow Control, Fixed, 1/2 – 5.0 Gpm
PC-00-0196 Flow Control, Fixed, 1/2 – 9.0 Gpm
PC-00-0210 Flow Control, Fixed, 3/4 – 10.0 Gpm
PC-00-0211 Flow Control, Fixed, 3/4 – 11.0 Gpm
PC-00-0212 Flow Control, Fixed, 3/4 – 12.0 Gpm
PC-00-0209 Flow Control, Fixed, 3/4 – 9.0 Gpm
PM-07-0072 Nut Lock Black 3/4″
PR-04-0183 Reducing Coupling 5/8X3/8 Cxc
PR-04-0145 Return Bend, Cu. 1/2 X 1 1/4 C-C
PR-04-0144 Rtrn Bnd Cu. 1/2X1-1/4 C-C Nonswtch
PR-04-0176 Swaged H-Feeder
PR-04-0175 Swaged Y-Feeder
PR-04-0504 Union Bronze Ring Nut 1/2
PR-04-0503 Union Bronze Threaded End 1/2
PR-04-0505 Union Copper Bottom End 1/2
PR-04-0506 Union Bronze Threaded End 3/4
PR-04-0507 Union Bronze Ring Nut 3/4
PR-04-0508 Union Copper Bottom End 3/4

©2014 Johnson Controls, Inc.

Fan Coil Parts Price List





T-Series

SOLID STATE THERMOSTATS
T-Stat Code REMOTE MOUNTED4
Part No. Description List
T03H PC-01-0003 T-STAT,ON-OFF,3SPD,H/C
T03C PC-01-0003 T-STAT,ON-OFF,3SPD,H/C
T05 PC-01-0003 T-STAT,ON-OFF,3SPD,H/C
T06 PC-01-0001 T-STAT, H/C, W/ 3 SPD FAN SWITCH
T07 PC-01-0000 T-STAT AUTO/OFF, W/3 SPD FAN SWITCH
T08 PC-01-0000 T-STAT AUTO/OFF, W/3 SPD FAN SWITCH
T09 PC-01-0001 T-STAT, H/C, W/ 3 SPD FAN SWITCH
T10 PC-01-0005 T-STAT,NO SWITCHING, H/0
T11 PC-01-0000 T-STAT AUTO/OFF, W/3 SPD FAN SWITCH
T12 PC-01-0001 T-STAT, H/C, W/ 3 SPD FAN SWITCH

Notes:

  1. Aquastat may be required for 2 pipe changeover applications
  2. Includes thermostat, complete plug, unit wiring harness and sensor.
  3. Vendor numbers subject to change
  4. Includes Model VH unit surface mount
  5. VF Series “B” unit mounted T-Stat bracket: 51-00067-01 $10 List
  6. Aux Relay PN is PE-05-2261 $40 List
  7. All thermostat series with the exception of the Erie offering must be configured.
  8. Configurations are listed in instructional drawings below by sales code.

D-Series P-Series

ADDITIONAL THERMOSTATS
Sales Code T-Stat Part Number Description List
ALL “D” SERIES T-STAT CODES PC-01-0058 THERMOSTAT,NON-PROG,DIGITAL
ALL “P” SERIES T-STAT CODES PC-01-0059 THERMOSTAT,PROGRAMMABLE,DIGITAL


N-Series F-Series

ADDITIONAL THERMOSTATS
Sales Code T-Stat Part Number Description List
ALL “N” SERIES T-STAT CODES PC-01-2841 STAT, NO LOGO COVER,ON/OFF,FLT,RV
ALL “N” SERIES T-STAT CODES PC-01-2801 STAT,JCI COVER,ON/OFF,FLT,RV
ALL “F” SERIES T-STAT CODES PC-01-2841 STAT,NO LOGO COVER,ON/OFF,FLT,RV
ALL “F” SERIES T-STAT CODES PC-01-2801 STAT,JCI COVER,ON/OFF,FLT,RV

©2014 Johnson Controls, Inc.

Fan Coil Parts Price List

All List Prices Subject to Change Revision Date: February 2014

MODEL FH CEILING PANEL
UNIT SIZE TELESCOPING PANEL ASSEMBLY LIST CEILING PANEL ASSEMBLY

ONLY

LIST
20 B47-20-1012 B47-20-175
25 B47-25-1012 B47-25-175
30 B47-30-1012 B47-30-175
40 B47-40-1012 B47-40-175
50 B47-50-1012 B47-50-175
60 B47-60-1012 B47-60-175

Note:

1. Telescoping bottom panel assembly includes collar/sleeve assembly.

MODEL FH SOLID BOTTOM ACCESS CEILING PANEL
UNIT SIZE SOLID BOTTOM ACCESS PANEL LIST
20 B47-20-255
25 B47-25-255
30 B47-30-255
40 B47-40-255
50 B47-50-255
60 B47-60-255
MODEL FN TELESCOPING COLLAR CEILING PANEL ASSEMBLY
UNIT SIZE 3″ – 6″ TELESCOPING PANEL ASSY LIST 6″ – 10″

TELESCOPING PANEL ASSY

LIST
06 82-10074-01 82-10075-01
08 82-10074-02 82-10075-02
10 82-10074-03 82-10075-03
12 82-10074-04 82-10075-04
14 82-10074-05 82-10075-05
16 82-10074-06 82-10075-06
18 82-10074-07 82-10075-07
20 82-10074-08 82-10075-08

Note:

1. Telescoping bottom panel assembly includes collar/sleeve assembly.

UNIT SIZE BOTTOM GRILLE PANEL ASSY LIST LIST

MODEL FN BOTTOM CEILING PANEL ASSEMBLY
UNIT SIZE BOTTOM GRILLE PANEL ASSY LIST SOLID BOTTOM ACCESS

PANEL

LIST
06 82-10076-01 82-10077-01
08 82-10076-02 82-10077-02
10 82-10076-03 82-10077-03
12 82-10076-04 82-10077-04
14 82-10076-05 82-10077-05
16 82-10076-06 82-10077-06
18 82-10076-07 82-10077-07
20 82-10076-08 82-10077-08

Note:

1. Telescoping bottom panel assembly includes collar/sleeve assembly.

MODEL FN REPLACEMENT / ADD-ON MIXING BOX ASSEMBLY
UNIT SIZE MIXING BOX ASSY LIST OPTIONAL MIXING BOX DAMPER

ACTUATOR

LIST
06 82-10002-01 PC-02-0400
08 82-10002-02 PC-02-0400
10 82-10002-03 PC-02-0400
12 82-10002-04 PC-02-0400
14 82-10002-05 PC-02-0400
16 82-10002-06 PC-02-0400
18 82-10002-07 PC-02-0400
20 82-10002-08 PC-02-0400

Note:

1. Contact factory for pricing if foil face or closed cell foam (CCF) insulation is required for this assembly.

MODEL FN PLENUM BOX SIDE ACCESS FILTER RACK ASSEMBLY
UNIT SIZE SIDE ACCESS FILTER RACK ASSEMBLY DECRIPTION LIST
06 82-10063-01 ASSY,FILTER RACK,SIDE ACCESS,06
08 82-10063-02 ASSY,FILTER RACK,SIDE ACCESS,08
10 82-10063-03 ASSY,FILTER RACK,SIDE ACCESS,10
12 82-10063-04 ASSY,FILTER RACK,SIDE ACCESS,12
14 82-10063-05 ASSY,FILTER RACK,SIDE ACCESS,14
16 82-10063-06 ASSY,FILTER RACK,SIDE ACCESS,16
18 82-10063-07 ASSY,FILTER RACK,SIDE ACCESS,18
20 82-10063-08 ASSY,FILTER RACK,SIDE ACCESS,20
MODEL FN PLENUM BOX BOTTOM FILTER TRAY COVER ASSEMBLY
UNIT SIZE BOTTOM FILTER COVER DECRIPTION LIST
06 82-10030-01 ASSY,FILTER ,BOTTOM,COVER TRAY,06
08 82-10030-02 ASSY,FILTER ,BOTTOM,COVER TRAY,08
10 82-10030-03 ASSY,FILTER ,BOTTOM,COVER TRAY,10
12 82-10030-04 ASSY,FILTER ,BOTTOM,COVER TRAY,12
14 82-10030-05 ASSY,FILTER ,BOTTOM,COVER TRAY,14
16 82-10030-06 ASSY,FILTER ,BOTTOM,COVER TRAY,16
18 82-10030-07 ASSY,FILTER ,BOTTOM,COVER TRAY,18
20 82-10030-08 ASSY,FILTER ,BOTTOM,COVER TRAY,20
FHP FILTER RACK ASSEMBLY FOR 1″ FILTERS
UNIT SIZE PART # DESCRIPTION LIST
20 47-13025-01 ASSY,FILTER RACK
25 47-13025-02 ASSY,FILTER RACK
30 47-13025-03 ASSY,FILTER RACK
40 47-13025-04 ASSY,FILTER RACK
50 47-13025-05 ASSY,FILTER RACK
60 47-13025-06 ASSY,FILTER RACK
MODEL FWC SERIES “B” DECORATOR WALL PANEL
UNIT SIZE R/A PANEL PART # LIST S/A-R/A PANEL

PART #

LIST
20 51-20-125 51-20-126
25 51-25-125 51-25-126
30 51-30-125 51-30-126
40 51-40-125 51-40-126
50 51-50-125 51-50-126
60 51-60-125 51-60-126
MOTORIZED OUTSIDE AIR DAMPER ACTUATORS, MODELS FW & FS1
VOLTAGE Wire Length (in.) LH UNIT (CW) RH UNIT (CCW) LIST
24 PC-02-0351 PC-02-0355
24 15″ PC-00-0747 PC-00-0751
24 84″ PC-00-0785 PC-00-0789
120 PC-02-0352 PC-02-0356
120 15″ PC-00-0748 PC-00-0752
120 84″ PC-00-0786 PC-00-0790
208/230 PC-02-0353 PC-02-0357
208/230 15″ PC-00-0749 PC-00-0753
208/230 84″ PC-00-0787 PC-00-0791

Note:

1. FS unit uses “CW” actuator only

MISCELLANEOUS COMPONENTS
PART # DESCRIPTION LIST
PR-21-0001 PEARL WHITE SATIN SPRAY PAINT CAN
PR-21-0008 BRIGHT WHITE SPRAY PAINT CAN, TELESCOPING BOTTOM PANEL
PR-21-0007 PEARL WHITE SATIN TOUCH-UP BOTTLE, 6OZ.
PM-07-0059 FS UNIT P-TRAP DRAIN HOSE
PH-02-0052 FS P-TRAP TENSION CLIPS – 2 REQUIRED DRAIN HOSE CLIP
PC-01-0032 DRAIN PAN FLOAT SWITCH (MODELS FCC, FH, FN, FS)
00-00047-01 DRAIN PAN FLOAT SWITCH MOUNTING BRACKET (MODELS FCC, FH, FN)
PC-01-0030 DRAIN PAN FLOAT SWITCH (MODEL FW)
00-00-115 FH HANGER BRACKETS
PH-06-0012 FH HANGER BRACKET GROMMETS
PH-06-0018 FH HANGER BRACKET – BRASS EYELETS (#A61)
00-13138-05 WALL MOUNT FAN SWITCH ASSEMBLY – WITH “OFF”1
PE-01-0035 WALL or CONCEALED MOUNTED FAN SWITCH ONLY (WITH “OFF”)
PE-01-0015 FWX/FWI UNIT MOUNT, EXPOSED FAN SWITCH
PH-06-0208 FAN SWITCH KNOB (RC-31) FOR PE-01-0020 & PE-01-0021

Note:

1. Assembly includes switch, knob, & brushed aluminum wall plate.

FHX ALUMINUM DOUBLE DEFLECTION SUPPLY GRILLE (PEARL WHITE)
UNIT SIZE PART # NOMINAL GRILLE SIZE LIST
20 PM-09-0161 20 x 6.5
25 PM-09-0516 26 x 6.5
30 PM-09-0162 30 x 6.5
40 PM-09-0163 40 x 6.5
50 PM-09-0164 50 x 6.5
60 PM-09-0165 60 x 6.5
FHX FRONT DISCHARGE PANEL FOR ALUMINUM DOUBLE DEFLECTION GRILLE (PEARL WHITE)
UNIT SIZE PART # PAINTED FRONT PANEL LIST
20 62-20-025L LEFT HAND
25 62-25-025L LEFT HAND
30 62-30-025L LEFT HAND
40 62-40-025L LEFT HAND
50 62-50-025L LEFT HAND
60 62-60-025L LEFT HAND
20 62-20-025R RIGHT HAND
25 62-25-025R RIGHT HAND
30 62-30-025R RIGHT HAND
40 62-40-025R RIGHT HAND
50 62-50-025R RIGHT HAND
60 62-60-025R RIGHT HAND

Note:

1. Include note on parts order to insulate front panel.

FNX ALUMINUM DOUBLE DEFLECTION SUPPLY GRILLE (PEARL WHITE)
UNIT SIZE PART # NOMINAL GRILLE SIZE LIST
06 PM-09-0218 14 X 12
08 PM-09-0219 19 X 12
10 PM-09-0220 23 X 12
12 PM-09-0221 28 X 12
14 PM-09-0222 33 X 12
16 PM-09-0223 38 X 12
18 PM-09-0224 43 X 12
20 PM-09-0225 47 X 12
FNX ALUMINUM SINGLE DEFLECTION RETURN GRILLE (PEARL WHITE)
UNIT SIZE PART # NOMINAL GRILLE SIZE LIST
06 PM-09-0226 16 X 16
08 PM-09-0227 20 X 16
10 PM-09-0228 25 X 16
12 PM-09-0229 32 X 16
14 PM-09-0230 36 X 16
16 PM-09-0231 40 X 16
18 PM-09-0232 45 X 16
20 PM-09-0233 50 X 16
FNP TELESCOPING BOTTOM PANEL RETURN GRILLE (BRIGHT WHITE)
UNIT SIZE PART # NOMINAL GRILLE SIZE LIST
06 PM-09-0242 16 X 16
08 PM-09-0243 20 X 16
10 PM-09-0244 25 X 16
12 PM-09-0245 32 X 16
14 PM-09-0246 36 X 16
16 PM-09-0247 40 X 16
18 PM-09-0248 45 X 16
20 PM-09-0249 50 X 16
FWX/FWI STEEL DOUBLE DEFLECTION SUPPLY GRILLES (PEARL WHITE)
UNIT SIZE PART # NOMINAL GRILLE SIZE LIST
20 PM-09-0151 25 X 4.5
25 PM-09-0518 31 X 4.5
30 PM-09-0152 35 X 4.5
40 PM-09-0153 45 X 4.5
50 PM-09-0154 55 X 4.5
60 PM-09-0155 65 X 4.5
FWX/FWI ALUMINUM BAR SUPPLY GRILLES (PEARL WHITE)
UNIT SIZE PART # NOMINAL GRILLE SIZE LIST
20 PM-09-0156 25 X 5
25 PM-09-0186 31 X 5
30 PM-09-0157 35 X 5
40 PM-09-0158 45 X 5
50 PM-09-0159 55 X 5
60 PM-09-0160 65 X 5
FS SERIES “A” ALUMINUM DOUBLE DEFLECTION SUPPLY GRILLES (PEARL WHITE)
UNIT SIZE PART # NOMINAL GRILLE SIZE LIST
03 & 04 PM-09-0166 16 X 6
06 & 08 PM-09-0167 18 X 8
10 & 12 (Single) PM-09-0183 22 X 14
10 & 12 (Double) PM-09-0168 22 X 8
03 & 04 w/OBD1 PM-09-0169 16 X 6
06 & 08 w/OBD1 PM-09-0170 18 X 8
10 & 12 w/OBD1 PM-09-0171 22 X 8
FS SERIES “B” ALUMINUM DOUBLE DEFLECTION SUPPLY GRILLES (PEARL WHITE)
UNIT SIZE PART # NOMINAL GRILLE SIZE LIST
03 & 04 PM-09-0204 16 X 8
06 & 08 PM-09-0203 18 X 12
10 & 12 (Single) PM-09-0183 22 X 14
10 & 12 (Double) PM-09-0202 22 X 12
03 & 04 w/OBD1 PM-09-0207 16 X 8
06 & 08 w/OBD1 PM-09-0206 18 X 12
10 & 12 w/OBD1 PM-09-0205 22 X 12

Note:

1. Opposed blade dampers (OBD) are used for air balancing purposes on double supply units. Only one may be used per unit and must not be used in any circumstance for single supply GRILLES.

DRAIN PANS
MODEL TYPE PART # LIST
FNP, FNF, FNM GALVANIZED, SINGLE CONNECTION, SZ06 82-10017-01
FNP, FNF, FNM GALVANIZED, SINGLE CONNECTION, SZ08 82-10017-02
FNP, FNF, FNM GALVANIZED, SINGLE CONNECTION, SZ10 82-10017-03
FNP, FNF, FNM GALVANIZED, SINGLE CONNECTION, SZ12 82-10017-04
FNP, FNF, FNM GALVANIZED, SINGLE CONNECTION, SZ14 82-10017-05
FNP, FNF, FNM GALVANIZED, SINGLE CONNECTION, SZ16 82-10017-06
FNP, FNF, FNM GALVANIZED, SINGLE CONNECTION, SZ18 82-10017-07
FNP, FNF, FNM GALVANIZED, SINGLE CONNECTION, SZ20 82-10017-08
FNP, FNF, FNM STAINLESS, SINGLE CONNECTION, SZ06 82-10018-01
FNP, FNF, FNM STAINLESS, SINGLE CONNECTION, SZ08 82-10018-02
FNP, FNF, FNM STAINLESS, SINGLE CONNECTION, SZ10 82-10018-03
FNP, FNF, FNM STAINLESS, SINGLE CONNECTION, SZ12 82-10018-04
FNP, FNF, FNM STAINLESS, SINGLE CONNECTION, SZ14 82-10018-05
FNP, FNF, FNM STAINLESS, SINGLE CONNECTION, SZ16 82-10018-06
FNP, FNF, FNM STAINLESS, SINGLE CONNECTION, SZ18 82-10018-07
FNP, FNF, FNM STAINLESS, SINGLE CONNECTION, SZ20 82-10018-08
FNP, FNF, FNM GALVANIZED, DOUBLE CONNECTION, SZ06 82-10019-01
FNP, FNF, FNM GALVANIZED, DOUBLE CONNECTION, SZ08 82-10019-02
FNP, FNF, FNM GALVANIZED, DOUBLE CONNECTION, SZ10 82-10019-03
FNP, FNF, FNM GALVANIZED, DOUBLE CONNECTION, SZ12 82-10019-04
FNP, FNF, FNM GALVANIZED, DOUBLE CONNECTION, SZ14 82-10019-05
FNP, FNF, FNM GALVANIZED, DOUBLE CONNECTION, SZ16 82-10019-06
FNP, FNF, FNM GALVANIZED, DOUBLE CONNECTION, SZ18 82-10019-07
FNP, FNF, FNM GALVANIZED, DOUBLE CONNECTION, SZ20 82-10019-08
FNP, FNF, FNM STAINLESS, DOUBLE CONNECTION, SZ06 82-10020-01
FNP, FNF, FNM STAINLESS, DOUBLE CONNECTION, SZ08 82-10020-02
FNP, FNF, FNM STAINLESS, DOUBLE CONNECTION, SZ10 82-10020-03
FNP, FNF, FNM STAINLESS, DOUBLE CONNECTION, SZ12 82-10020-04
FNP, FNF, FNM STAINLESS, DOUBLE CONNECTION, SZ14 82-10020-05
FNP, FNF, FNM STAINLESS, DOUBLE CONNECTION, SZ16 82-10020-06
FNP, FNF, FNM STAINLESS, DOUBLE CONNECTION, SZ18 82-10020-07
FNP, FNF, FNM STAINLESS, DOUBLE CONNECTION, SZ20 82-10020-08
FNX CONTACT FACTORY N/A
FHP, FHF GALVANIZED, DOUBLE CONNECTION, SZ20 B47-20-251
FHP, FHF GALVANIZED, DOUBLE CONNECTION, SZ25 B47-25-251
FHP, FHF GALVANIZED, DOUBLE CONNECTION, SZ30 B47-30-251
FHP, FHF GALVANIZED, DOUBLE CONNECTION, SZ40 B47-40-251
FHP, FHF GALVANIZED, DOUBLE CONNECTION, SZ50 B47-50-251
FHP, FHF GALVANIZED, DOUBLE CONNECTION, SZ60 B47-60-251
FHP, FHF STAINLESS, DOUBLE CONNECTION, SZ20 B47-20-252
FHP, FHF STAINLESS, DOUBLE CONNECTION, SZ25 B47-25-252
FHP, FHF STAINLESS, DOUBLE CONNECTION, SZ30 B47-30-252
FHP, FHF STAINLESS, DOUBLE CONNECTION, SZ40 B47-40-252
FHP, FHF STAINLESS, DOUBLE CONNECTION, SZ50 B47-50-252
FHP, FHF STAINLESS, DOUBLE CONNECTION, SZ60 B47-60-252
FHP, FHF GALVANIZED, SINGLE CONNECTION, SZ20 B47-20-253
FHP, FHF GALVANIZED, SINGLE CONNECTION, SZ25 B47-25-253
FHP, FHF GALVANIZED, SINGLE CONNECTION, SZ30 B47-30-253
FHP, FHF GALVANIZED, SINGLE CONNECTION, SZ40 B47-40-253
FHP, FHF GALVANIZED, SINGLE CONNECTION, SZ50 B47-50-253
FHP, FHF GALVANIZED, SINGLE CONNECTION, SZ60 B47-60-253
FHP, FHF STAINLESS, SINGLE CONNECTION, SZ20 B47-20-254
FHP, FHF STAINLESS, SINGLE CONNECTION, SZ25 B47-25-254
FHP, FHF STAINLESS, SINGLE CONNECTION, SZ30 B47-30-254
FHP, FHF STAINLESS, SINGLE CONNECTION, SZ40 B47-40-254
FHP, FHF STAINLESS, SINGLE CONNECTION, SZ50 B47-50-254
FHP, FHF STAINLESS, SINGLE CONNECTION, SZ60 B47-60-254
FHX CONTACT FACTORY N/A
AUXILIARY DRIP PANS
MODEL TYPE PART # LIST
FHF AND FHP GALVANIZED – ALL UNIT SIZES B47-10-215
MODEL FHX GALVANIZED – ALL UNIT SIZES, LEFT HAND B47-00-076L
MODEL FHX GALVANIZED – ALL UNIT SIZES, RIGHT HAND B47-00-076R
MODEL FW GALVANIZED – ALL UNIT SIZES B51-00-096
MODEL FW STD PLASTIC – ALL UNIT SIZES 51-13006-01
FNF, FNP & FNP GALVANIZED – ALL UNIT SIZES 82-00024-01
MODEL FNX GALVANIZED – ALL UNIT SIZES 82-10065-01
FHF AND FHP STAINLESS – ALL UNIT SIZES B47-10-062
MODEL FHX STAINLESS – ALL UNIT SIZES, LEFT HAND B47-00-078L
MODEL FHX STAINLESS – ALL UNIT SIZES, RIGHT HAND B47-00-078R
MODEL FW STAINLESS – ALL UNIT SIZES B51-01-096
MODEL FW EXTENDED PLASTIC – ALL UNIT SIZES 51-13006-02
FNF, FNP & FNP STAINLESS – ALL UNIT SIZES 82-00038-01
MODEL FNX STAINLESS – ALL UNIT SIZES 82-10066-01
FS P-TRAP P-TRAP DRAIN PM-07-0059
FS P-TRAP TENSION CLIPS P-TRAP TENSION CLIP (QTY 2 PER P-TRAP) PH-02-0052
MODEL FW SERIES “C” INTERNAL DRAIN PAN (DRIP TRAY)
PART # DESCRIPTION LIST
51-00404-01 DRIP TRAY (DRAIN PAN),LH,GALV,FW02,SER C
51-00404-02 DRIP TRAY (DRAIN PAN),LH,GALV,FW03,SER C
51-00404-03 DRIP TRAY (DRAIN PAN),LH,GALV,FW04,SER C
51-00404-04 DRIP TRAY (DRAIN PAN),LH,GALV,FW06,SER C
51-00404-05 DRIP TRAY (DRAIN PAN),LH,GALV,FW08,SER C
51-00404-06 DRIP TRAY (DRAIN PAN),LH,GALV,FW10,SER C
51-00404-07 DRIP TRAY (DRAIN PAN),LH,GALV,FW12,SER C
51-00405-01 DRIP TRAY (DRAIN PAN),RH,GALV,FW02,SER C
51-00405-02 DRIP TRAY (DRAIN PAN),RH,GALV,FW03,SER C
51-00405-03 DRIP TRAY (DRAIN PAN),RH,GALV,FW04,SER C
51-00405-04 DRIP TRAY (DRAIN PAN),RH,GALV,FW06,SER C
51-00405-05 DRIP TRAY (DRAIN PAN),RH,GALV,FW08,SER C
51-00405-06 DRIP TRAY (DRAIN PAN),RH,GALV,FW10,SER C
51-00405-07 DRIP TRAY (DRAIN PAN),RH,GALV,FW12,SER C
51-00406-01 DRIP TRAY (DRAIN PAN),RH,SS,FW02,SER C
51-00406-02 DRIP TRAY (DRAIN PAN),RH,SS,FW03,SER C
51-00406-03 DRIP TRAY (DRAIN PAN),RH,SS,FW04,SER C
51-00406-04 DRIP TRAY (DRAIN PAN),RH,SS,FW06,SER C
51-00406-05 DRIP TRAY (DRAIN PAN),RH,SS,FW08,SER C
51-00406-06 DRIP TRAY (DRAIN PAN),RH,SS,FW10,SER C
51-00406-07 DRIP TRAY (DRAIN PAN),RH,SS,FW12,SER C
51-00407-01 DRIP TRAY (DRAIN PAN),LH,SS,FW02,SER C
51-00407-02 DRIP TRAY (DRAIN PAN),LH,SS,FW03,SER C
51-00407-03 DRIP TRAY (DRAIN PAN),LH,SS,FW04,SER C
51-00407-04 DRIP TRAY (DRAIN PAN),LH,SS,FW06,SER C
51-00407-05 DRIP TRAY (DRAIN PAN),LH,SS,FW08,SER C
51-00407-06 DRIP TRAY (DRAIN PAN),LH,SS,FW10,SER C
51-00407-07 DRIP TRAY (DRAIN PAN),LH,SS,FW12,SER C
51-05055-01 INSUL,CCF,FOR RH DRIP TRAY (DRAIN PAN),FW02,SERIES C
51-05055-02 INSUL,CCF,FOR RH DRIP TRAY (DRAIN PAN),FW03,SERIES C
51-05055-03 INSUL,CCF,FOR RH DRIP TRAY (DRAIN PAN),FW04,SERIES C
51-05055-04 INSUL,CCF,FOR RH DRIP TRAY (DRAIN PAN),FW06,SERIES C
51-05055-05 INSUL,CCF,FOR RH DRIP TRAY (DRAIN PAN),FW08,SERIES C
51-05055-06 INSUL,CCF,FOR RH DRIP TRAY (DRAIN PAN),FW10,SERIES C
51-05055-07 INSUL,CCF,FOR RH DRIP TRAY (DRAIN PAN),FW12,SERIES C
51-05055-08 INSUL,CCF,FOR LH DRIP TRAY (DRAIN PAN),FW02,SERIES C
51-05055-09 INSUL,CCF,FOR LH DRIP TRAY (DRAIN PAN),FW03,SERIES C
51-05055-10 INSUL,CCF,FOR LH DRIP TRAY (DRAIN PAN),FW04,SERIES C
51-05055-11 INSUL,CCF,FOR LH DRIP TRAY (DRAIN PAN),FW06,SERIES C
51-05055-12 INSUL,CCF,FOR LH DRIP TRAY (DRAIN PAN),FW08,SERIES C
51-05055-13 INSUL,CCF,FOR LH DRIP TRAY (DRAIN PAN),FW10,SERIES C
51-05055-14 INSUL,CCF,FOR LH DRIP TRAY (DRAIN PAN),FW12,SERIES C

Note:

1. All drip trays in this table to be ordered with the associated Closed Cell Foam Insulation part number shown above.

MODEL FWX & FWI SERIES “C” SLOTTED TOE-KICK PAINTED RETURN GRILLES
PART # DESCRIPTION LIST
51-00437-01 TOE KICK,W/SLOTS,VFE/S02,SER C
51-00437-02 TOE KICK,W/SLOTS,VFE/S03,SER C
51-00437-03 TOE KICK,W/SLOTS,VFE/S04,SER C
51-00437-04 TOE KICK,W/SLOTS,VFE/S06,SER C
51-00437-05 TOE KICK,W/SLOTS,VFE/S08,SER C
51-00437-06 TOE KICK,W/SLOTS,VFE/S10,SER C
51-00437-07 TOE KICK,W/SLOTS,VFE/S12,SER C
MODEL FWX & FWI SERIES “C” SINGLE AND DOUBLE DEFLECTION SUPPLY GRILLES
PART # DESCRIPTION LIST
PM-09-0268 SUPPLY GRILLE, BAR,PEARL WHITE,FWX/FWI SZ02
PM-09-0269 SUPPLY GRILLE, BAR,PEARL WHITE,FWX/FWI SZ03
PM-09-0270 SUPPLY GRILLE, BAR,PEARL WHITE,FWX/FWI SZ04
PM-09-0271 SUPPLY GRILLE, BAR,PEARL WHITE,FWX/FWI SZ06
PM-09-0272 SUPPLY GRILLE, BAR,PEARL WHITE,FWX/FWI SZ08
PM-09-0273 SUPPLY GRILLE, BAR,PEARL WHITE,FWX/FWI SZ10
PM-09-0274 SUPPLY GRILLE, BAR,PEARL WHITE,FWX/FWI SZ12
PM-09-0275 SUPPLY GRILLE, BAR,BRIGHT WHITE,FWX/FWI SZ02
PM-09-0276 SUPPLY GRILLE, BAR,BRIGHT WHITE,FWX/FWI SZ03
PM-09-0277 SUPPLY GRILLE, BAR,BRIGHT WHITE,FWX/FWI SZ04
PM-09-0278 SUPPLY GRILLE, BAR,BRIGHT WHITE,FWX/FWI SZ06
PM-09-0279 SUPPLY GRILLE, BAR,BRIGHT WHITE,FWX/FWI SZ08
PM-09-0280 SUPPLY GRILLE, BAR,BRIGHT WHITE,FWX/FWI SZ10
PM-09-0281 SUPPLY GRILLE, BAR,BRIGHT WHITE,FWX/FWI SZ12
PM-09-0282 SUPPLY GRILLE,DOUBLE DEFLECTION,PEARL WHITE,FWX/FWI SZ02
PM-09-0283 SUPPLY GRILLE,DOUBLE DEFLECTION,PEARL WHITE,FWX/FWI SZ03
PM-09-0284 SUPPLY GRILLE,DOUBLE DEFLECTION,PEARL WHITE,FWX/FWI SZ04
PM-09-0285 SUPPLY GRILLE,DOUBLE DEFLECTION,PEARL WHITE,FWX/FWI SZ06
PM-09-0286 SUPPLY GRILLE,DOUBLE DEFLECTION,PEARL WHITE,FWX/FWI SZ08
PM-09-0287 SUPPLY GRILLE,DOUBLE DEFLECTION,PEARL WHITE,FWX/FWI SZ10
PM-09-0288 SUPPLY GRILLE,DOUBLE DEFLECTION,PEARL WHITE,FWX/FWI SZ12
PM-09-0289 SUPPLY GRILLE,DOUBLE DEFLECTION,BRIGHT WHITE,FWX/FWI SZ02
PM-09-0290 SUPPLY GRILLE,DOUBLE DEFLECTION,BRIGHT WHITE,FWX/FWI SZ03
PM-09-0291 SUPPLY GRILLE,DOUBLE DEFLECTION,BRIGHT WHITE,FWX/FWI SZ04
PM-09-0292 SUPPLY GRILLE,DOUBLE DEFLECTION,BRIGHT WHITE,FWX/FWI SZ06
PM-09-0293 SUPPLY GRILLE,DOUBLE DEFLECTION,BRIGHT WHITE,FWX/FWI SZ08
PM-09-0294 SUPPLY GRILLE,DOUBLE DEFLECTION,BRIGHT WHITE,FWX/FWI SZ10
PM-09-0295 SUPPLY GRILLE,DOUBLE DEFLECTION,BRIGHT WHITE,FWX/FWI SZ12
MODEL FW SERIES “C” PEARL WHITE 2″ 4″ 6″ 8″ FALSEBACKS
PART # DESCRIPTION LIST
97-13001-01 ASSY,FALSEBACK,2IN,FWX02,STANDARD WIDTH
97-13001-02 ASSY,FALSEBACK,2IN,FWX03,STANDARD WIDTH
97-13001-03 ASSY,FALSEBACK,2IN,FWX04,STANDARD WIDTH
97-13001-04 ASSY,FALSEBACK,2IN,FWX06,STANDARD WIDTH
97-13001-05 ASSY,FALSEBACK,2IN,FWX08,STANDARD WIDTH
97-13001-06 ASSY,FALSEBACK,2IN,FWX10,STANDARD WIDTH
97-13001-07 ASSY,FALSEBACK,2IN,FWX12,STANDARD WIDTH
97-13001-08 ASSY,FALSEBACK,4IN,FWX02,STANDARD WIDTH
97-13001-09 ASSY,FALSEBACK,4IN,FWX03,STANDARD WIDTH
97-13001-10 ASSY,FALSEBACK,4IN,FWX04,STANDARD WIDTH
97-13001-11 ASSY,FALSEBACK,4IN,FWX06,STANDARD WIDTH
97-13001-12 ASSY,FALSEBACK,4IN,FWX08,STANDARD WIDTH
97-13001-13 ASSY,FALSEBACK,4IN,FWX10,STANDARD WIDTH
97-13001-14 ASSY,FALSEBACK,4IN,FWX12,STANDARD WIDTH
97-13001-15 ASSY,FALSEBACK,6IN,FWX02,STANDARD WIDTH
97-13001-16 ASSY,FALSEBACK,6IN,FWX03,STANDARD WIDTH
97-13001-17 ASSY,FALSEBACK,6IN,FWX04,STANDARD WIDTH
97-13001-18 ASSY,FALSEBACK,6IN,FWX06,STANDARD WIDTH
97-13001-19 ASSY,FALSEBACK,6IN,FWX08,STANDARD WIDTH
97-13001-20 ASSY,FALSEBACK,6IN,FWX10,STANDARD WIDTH
97-13001-21 ASSY,FALSEBACK,6IN,FWX12,STANDARD WIDTH
97-13001-22 ASSY,FALSEBACK,8IN,FWX02,STANDARD WIDTH
97-13001-23 ASSY,FALSEBACK,8IN,FWX03,STANDARD WIDTH
97-13001-24 ASSY,FALSEBACK,8IN,FWX04,STANDARD WIDTH
97-13001-25 ASSY,FALSEBACK,8IN,FWX06,STANDARD WIDTH
97-13001-26 ASSY,FALSEBACK,8IN,FWX08,STANDARD WIDTH
97-13001-27 ASSY,FALSEBACK,8IN,FWX10,STANDARD WIDTH
97-13001-28 ASSY,FALSEBACK,8IN,FWX12,STANDARD WIDTH
97-13001-29 ASSY,FALSEBACK,2IN,FWX02,EXTENDED END POCKET
97-13001-30 ASSY,FALSEBACK,2IN,FWX03,EXTENDED END POCKET
97-13001-31 ASSY,FALSEBACK,2IN,FWX04,EXTENDED END POCKET
97-13001-32 ASSY,FALSEBACK,2IN,FWX06,EXTENDED END POCKET
97-13001-33 ASSY,FALSEBACK,2IN,FWX08,EXTENDED END POCKET
97-13001-34 ASSY,FALSEBACK,2IN,FWX10,EXTENDED END POCKET
97-13001-35 ASSY,FALSEBACK,2IN,FWX12,EXTENDED END POCKET
97-13001-36 ASSY,FALSEBACK,4IN,FWX02,EXTENDED END POCKET
97-13001-37 ASSY,FALSEBACK,4IN,FWX03,EXTENDED END POCKET
97-13001-38 ASSY,FALSEBACK,4IN,FWX04,EXTENDED END POCKET
97-13001-39 ASSY,FALSEBACK,4IN,FWX06,EXTENDED END POCKET
97-13001-40 ASSY,FALSEBACK,4IN,FWX08,EXTENDED END POCKET
97-13001-41 ASSY,FALSEBACK,4IN,FWX10,EXTENDED END POCKET
97-13001-42 ASSY,FALSEBACK,4IN,FWX12,EXTENDED END POCKET
97-13001-43 ASSY,FALSEBACK,6IN,FWX02,EXTENDED END POCKET
97-13001-44 ASSY,FALSEBACK,6IN,FWX03,EXTENDED END POCKET
97-13001-45 ASSY,FALSEBACK,6IN,FWX04,EXTENDED END POCKET
97-13001-46 ASSY,FALSEBACK,6IN,FWX06,EXTENDED END POCKET
97-13001-47 ASSY,FALSEBACK,6IN,FWX08,EXTENDED END POCKET
97-13001-48 ASSY,FALSEBACK,6IN,FWX10,EXTENDED END POCKET
97-13001-49 ASSY,FALSEBACK,6IN,FWX12,EXTENDED END POCKET
97-13001-50 ASSY,FALSEBACK,8IN,FWX02,EXTENDED END POCKET
97-13001-51 ASSY,FALSEBACK,8IN,FWX03,EXTENDED END POCKET
97-13001-52 ASSY,FALSEBACK,8IN,FWX04,EXTENDED END POCKET
97-13001-53 ASSY,FALSEBACK,8IN,FWX06,EXTENDED END POCKET
97-13001-54 ASSY,FALSEBACK,8IN,FWX08,EXTENDED END POCKET
97-13001-55 ASSY,FALSEBACK,8IN,FWX10,EXTENDED END POCKET
97-13001-56 ASSY,FALSEBACK,8IN,FWX12,EXTENDED END POCKET
97-13002-01 ASSY,FALSEBACK,2IN,FWI02,STANDARD WIDTH
97-13002-02 ASSY,FALSEBACK,2IN,FWI03,STANDARD WIDTH
97-13002-03 ASSY,FALSEBACK,2IN,FWI04,STANDARD WIDTH
97-13002-04 ASSY,FALSEBACK,2IN,FWI06,STANDARD WIDTH
97-13002-05 ASSY,FALSEBACK,2IN,FWI08,STANDARD WIDTH
97-13002-06 ASSY,FALSEBACK,2IN,FWI10,STANDARD WIDTH
97-13002-07 ASSY,FALSEBACK,2IN,FWI12,STANDARD WIDTH
97-13002-08 ASSY,FALSEBACK,4IN,FWI02,STANDARD WIDTH
97-13002-09 ASSY,FALSEBACK,4IN,FWI03,STANDARD WIDTH
97-13002-10 ASSY,FALSEBACK,4IN,FWI04,STANDARD WIDTH
97-13002-11 ASSY,FALSEBACK,4IN,FWI06,STANDARD WIDTH
97-13002-12 ASSY,FALSEBACK,4IN,FWI08,STANDARD WIDTH
97-13002-13 ASSY,FALSEBACK,4IN,FWI10,STANDARD WIDTH
97-13002-14 ASSY,FALSEBACK,4IN,FWI12,STANDARD WIDTH
97-13002-15 ASSY,FALSEBACK,6IN,FWI02,STANDARD WIDTH
97-13002-16 ASSY,FALSEBACK,6IN,FWI03,STANDARD WIDTH
97-13002-17 ASSY,FALSEBACK,6IN,FWI04,STANDARD WIDTH
97-13002-18 ASSY,FALSEBACK,6IN,FWI06,STANDARD WIDTH
97-13002-19 ASSY,FALSEBACK,6IN,FWI08,STANDARD WIDTH
97-13002-20 ASSY,FALSEBACK,6IN,FWI10,STANDARD WIDTH
97-13002-21 ASSY,FALSEBACK,6IN,FWI12,STANDARD WIDTH
97-13002-22 ASSY,FALSEBACK,8IN,FWI02,STANDARD WIDTH
97-13002-23 ASSY,FALSEBACK,8IN,FWI03,STANDARD WIDTH
97-13002-24 ASSY,FALSEBACK,8IN,FWI04,STANDARD WIDTH
97-13002-25 ASSY,FALSEBACK,8IN,FWI06,STANDARD WIDTH
97-13002-26 ASSY,FALSEBACK,8IN,FWI08,STANDARD WIDTH
97-13002-27 ASSY,FALSEBACK,8IN,FWI10,STANDARD WIDTH
97-13002-28 ASSY,FALSEBACK,8IN,FWI12,STANDARD WIDTH
97-13002-29 ASSY,FALSEBACK,2IN,FWI02,EXTENDED END POCKET
97-13002-30 ASSY,FALSEBACK,2IN,FWI03,EXTENDED END POCKET
97-13002-31 ASSY,FALSEBACK,2IN,FWI04,EXTENDED END POCKET
97-13002-32 ASSY,FALSEBACK,2IN,FWI06,EXTENDED END POCKET
97-13002-33 ASSY,FALSEBACK,2IN,FWI08,EXTENDED END POCKET
97-13002-34 ASSY,FALSEBACK,2IN,FWI10,EXTENDED END POCKET
97-13002-35 ASSY,FALSEBACK,2IN,FWI12,EXTENDED END POCKET
97-13002-36 ASSY,FALSEBACK,4IN,FWI02,EXTENDED END POCKET
97-13002-37 ASSY,FALSEBACK,4IN,FWI03,EXTENDED END POCKET
97-13002-38 ASSY,FALSEBACK,4IN,FWI04,EXTENDED END POCKET
97-13002-39 ASSY,FALSEBACK,4IN,FWI06,EXTENDED END POCKET
97-13002-40 ASSY,FALSEBACK,4IN,FWI08,EXTENDED END POCKET
97-13002-41 ASSY,FALSEBACK,4IN,FWI10,EXTENDED END POCKET
97-13002-42 ASSY,FALSEBACK,4IN,FWI12,EXTENDED END POCKET
97-13002-43 ASSY,FALSEBACK,6IN,FWI02,EXTENDED END POCKET
97-13002-44 ASSY,FALSEBACK,6IN,FWI03,EXTENDED END POCKET
97-13002-45 ASSY,FALSEBACK,6IN,FWI04,EXTENDED END POCKET
97-13002-46 ASSY,FALSEBACK,6IN,FWI06,EXTENDED END POCKET
97-13002-47 ASSY,FALSEBACK,6IN,FWI08,EXTENDED END POCKET
97-13002-48 ASSY,FALSEBACK,6IN,FWI10,EXTENDED END POCKET
97-13002-49 ASSY,FALSEBACK,6IN,FWI12,EXTENDED END POCKET
97-13002-50 ASSY,FALSEBACK,8IN,FWI02,EXTENDED END POCKET
97-13002-51 ASSY,FALSEBACK,8IN,FWI03,EXTENDED END POCKET
97-13002-52 ASSY,FALSEBACK,8IN,FWI04,EXTENDED END POCKET
97-13002-53 ASSY,FALSEBACK,8IN,FWI06,EXTENDED END POCKET
97-13002-54 ASSY,FALSEBACK,8IN,FWI08,EXTENDED END POCKET
97-13002-55 ASSY,FALSEBACK,8IN,FWI10,EXTENDED END POCKET
97-13002-56 ASSY,FALSEBACK,8IN,FWI12,EXTENDED END POCKET
MODEL FWC SERIES “C” TOP BLANK-OFF PANEL FOR FRONT DISCHARGE
PART # DESCRIPTION LIST
51-00534-01 PNL,TOP,BLANK,FWC,02
51-00534-02 PNL,TOP,BLANK,FWC,03
51-00534-03 PNL,TOP,BLANK,FWC,04
51-00534-04 PNL,TOP,BLANK,FWC,06
51-00534-05 PNL,TOP,BLANK,FWC,08
51-00534-06 PNL,TOP,BLANK,FWC,10
51-00534-07 PNL,TOP,BLANK,FWC,12
51-05072-01 INS,CCF,TOP PNL,BLANK,FWC,02
51-05072-02 INS,CCF,TOP PNL,BLANK,FWC,03
51-05072-03 INS,CCF,TOP PNL,BLANK,FWC,04
51-05072-04 INS,CCF,TOP PNL,BLANK,FWC,06
51-05072-05 INS,CCF,TOP PNL,BLANK,FWC,08
51-05072-06 INS,CCF,TOP PNL,BLANK,FWC,10
51-05072-07 INS,CCF,TOP PNL,BLANK,FWC,12
MODEL FWC SERIES “C” PEARL WHITE DECORATOR WALL PANEL
PART # DESCRIPTION LIST
51-13100-01 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,STAMPED RETURN AIR,02
51-13100-02 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,STAMPED RETURN AIR,03
51-13100-03 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,STAMPED RETURN AIR,04
51-13100-04 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,STAMPED RETURN AIR,06
51-13100-05 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,STAMPED RETURN AIR,08
51-13100-06 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,STAMPED RETURN AIR,10
51-13100-07 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,STAMPED RETURN AIR,12
51-13100-08 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,STAMPED RETURN AIR,LH-EXT,02
51-13100-09 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,STAMPED RETURN AIR,LH-EXT,03
51-13100-10 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,STAMPED RETURN AIR,LH-EXT,04
51-13100-11 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,STAMPED RETURN AIR,LH-EXT,06
51-13100-12 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,STAMPED RETURN AIR,LH-EXT,08
51-13100-13 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,STAMPED RETURN AIR,LH-EXT,10
51-13100-14 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,STAMPED RETURN AIR,LH-EXT,12
51-13100-15 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,STAMPED RETURN AIR,RH-EXT,02
51-13100-16 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,STAMPED RETURN AIR,RH-EXT,03
51-13100-17 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,STAMPED RETURN AIR,RH-EXT,04
51-13100-18 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,STAMPED RETURN AIR,RH-EXT,06
51-13100-19 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,STAMPED RETURN AIR,RH-EXT,08
51-13100-20 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,STAMPED RETURN AIR,RH-EXT,10
51-13100-21 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,STAMPED RETURN AIR,RH-EXT,12
51-13101-01 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,02
51-13101-02 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,03
51-13101-03 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,04
51-13101-04 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,06
51-13101-05 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,08
51-13101-06 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,10
51-13101-07 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,12
51-13101-08 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,LH-EXT,02
51-13101-09 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,LH-EXT,03
51-13101-10 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,LH-EXT,04
51-13101-11 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,LH-EXT,06
51-13101-12 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,LH-EXT,08
51-13101-13 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,LH-EXT,10
51-13101-14 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,LH-EXT,12
51-13101-15 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,RH-EXT,02
51-13101-16 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,RH-EXT,03
51-13101-17 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,RH-EXT,04
51-13101-18 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,RH-EXT,06
51-13101-19 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,RH-EXT,08
51-13101-20 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,RH-EXT,10
51-13101-21 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,RH-EXT,12
51-13118-01 NO SPLY,STAMPED RETURN AIR,02
51-13118-02 NO SPLY,STAMPED RETURN AIR,03
51-13118-03 NO SPLY,STAMPED RETURN AIR,04
51-13118-04 NO SPLY,STAMPED RETURN AIR,06
51-13118-05 NO SPLY,STAMPED RETURN AIR,08
51-13118-06 NO SPLY,STAMPED RETURN AIR,10
51-13118-07 NO SPLY,STAMPED RETURN AIR,12
51-13118-08 NO SPLY,STAMPED RETURN AIR,LH-EXT,02
51-13118-09 NO SPLY,STAMPED RETURN AIR,LH-EXT,03
51-13118-10 NO SPLY,STAMPED RETURN AIR,LH-EXT,04
51-13118-11 NO SPLY,STAMPED RETURN AIR,LH-EXT,06
51-13118-12 NO SPLY,STAMPED RETURN AIR,LH-EXT,08
51-13118-13 NO SPLY,STAMPED RETURN AIR,LH-EXT,10
51-13118-14 NO SPLY,STAMPED RETURN AIR,LH-EXT,12
51-13118-15 NO SPLY,STAMPED RETURN AIR,RH-EXT,02
51-13118-16 NO SPLY,STAMPED RETURN AIR,RH-EXT,03
51-13118-17 NO SPLY,STAMPED RETURN AIR,RH-EXT,04
51-13118-18 NO SPLY,STAMPED RETURN AIR,RH-EXT,06
51-13118-19 NO SPLY,STAMPED RETURN AIR,RH-EXT,08
51-13118-20 NO SPLY,STAMPED RETURN AIR,RH-EXT,10
51-13118-21 NO SPLY,STAMPED RETURN AIR,RH-EXT,12
51-13119-01 NO SPLY,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,02
51-13119-02 NO SPLY,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,03
51-13119-03 NO SPLY,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,04
51-13119-04 NO SPLY,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,06
51-13119-05 NO SPLY,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,08
51-13119-06 NO SPLY,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,10
51-13119-07 NO SPLY,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,12
51-13119-08 NO SPLY,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,LH-EXT,02
51-13119-09 NO SPLY,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,LH-EXT,03
51-13119-10 NO SPLY,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,LH-EXT,04
51-13119-11 NO SPLY,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,LH-EXT,06
51-13119-12 NO SPLY,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,LH-EXT,08
51-13119-13 NO SPLY,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,LH-EXT,10
51-13119-14 NO SPLY,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,LH-EXT,12
51-13119-15 NO SPLY,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,RH-EXT,02
51-13119-16 NO SPLY,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,RH-EXT,03
51-13119-17 NO SPLY,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,RH-EXT,04
51-13119-18 NO SPLY,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,RH-EXT,06
51-13119-19 NO SPLY,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,RH-EXT,08
51-13119-20 NO SPLY,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,RH-EXT,10
51-13119-21 NO SPLY,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,RH-EXT,12
MODEL FWC SERIES “C” BRIGHT WHITE DECORATOR WALL PANEL
PART # DESCRIPTION LIST
51-13120-01 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,STAMPED RETURN AIR,02
51-13120-02 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,STAMPED RETURN AIR,03
51-13120-03 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,STAMPED RETURN AIR,04
51-13120-04 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,STAMPED RETURN AIR,06
51-13120-05 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,STAMPED RETURN AIR,08
51-13120-06 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,STAMPED RETURN AIR,10
51-13120-07 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,STAMPED RETURN AIR,12
51-13120-08 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,STAMPED RETURN AIR,LH-EXT,02
51-13120-09 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,STAMPED RETURN AIR,LH-EXT,03
51-13120-10 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,STAMPED RETURN AIR,LH-EXT,04
51-13120-11 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,STAMPED RETURN AIR,LH-EXT,06
51-13120-12 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,STAMPED RETURN AIR,LH-EXT,08
51-13120-13 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,STAMPED RETURN AIR,LH-EXT,10
51-13120-14 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,STAMPED RETURN AIR,LH-EXT,12
51-13120-15 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,STAMPED RETURN AIR,RH-EXT,02
51-13120-16 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,STAMPED RETURN AIR,RH-EXT,03
51-13120-17 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,STAMPED RETURN AIR,RH-EXT,04
51-13120-18 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,STAMPED RETURN AIR,RH-EXT,06
51-13120-19 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,STAMPED RETURN AIR,RH-EXT,08
51-13120-20 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,STAMPED RETURN AIR,RH-EXT,10
51-13120-21 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,STAMPED RETURN AIR,RH-EXT,12
51-13121-01 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,02
51-13121-02 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,03
51-13121-03 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,04
51-13121-04 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,06
51-13121-05 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,08
51-13121-06 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,10
51-13121-07 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,12
51-13121-08 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,LH-EXT,02
51-13121-09 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,LH-EXT,03
51-13121-10 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,LH-EXT,04
51-13121-11 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,LH-EXT,06
51-13121-12 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,LH-EXT,08
51-13121-13 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,LH-EXT,10
51-13121-14 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,LH-EXT,12
51-13121-15 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,RH-EXT,02
51-13121-16 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,RH-EXT,03
51-13121-17 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,RH-EXT,04
51-13121-18 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,RH-EXT,06
51-13121-19 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,RH-EXT,08
51-13121-20 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,RH-EXT,10
51-13121-21 STAMPED SUPPLY AIR,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,RH-EXT,12
51-13122-01 NO SPLY,STAMPED RETURN AIR,02
51-13122-02 NO SPLY,STAMPED RETURN AIR,03
51-13122-03 NO SPLY,STAMPED RETURN AIR,04
51-13122-04 NO SPLY,STAMPED RETURN AIR,06
51-13122-05 NO SPLY,STAMPED RETURN AIR,08
51-13122-06 NO SPLY,STAMPED RETURN AIR,10
51-13122-07 NO SPLY,STAMPED RETURN AIR,12
51-13122-08 NO SPLY,STAMPED RETURN AIR,LH-EXT,02
51-13122-09 NO SPLY,STAMPED RETURN AIR,LH-EXT,03
51-13122-10 NO SPLY,STAMPED RETURN AIR,LH-EXT,04
51-13122-11 NO SPLY,STAMPED RETURN AIR,LH-EXT,06
51-13122-12 NO SPLY,STAMPED RETURN AIR,LH-EXT,08
51-13122-13 NO SPLY,STAMPED RETURN AIR,LH-EXT,10
51-13122-14 NO SPLY,STAMPED RETURN AIR,LH-EXT,12
51-13122-15 NO SPLY,STAMPED RETURN AIR,RH-EXT,02
51-13122-16 NO SPLY,STAMPED RETURN AIR,RH-EXT,03
51-13122-17 NO SPLY,STAMPED RETURN AIR,RH-EXT,04
51-13122-18 NO SPLY,STAMPED RETURN AIR,RH-EXT,06
51-13122-19 NO SPLY,STAMPED RETURN AIR,RH-EXT,08
51-13122-20 NO SPLY,STAMPED RETURN AIR,RH-EXT,10
51-13122-21 NO SPLY,STAMPED RETURN AIR,RH-EXT,12
51-13123-01 NO SPLY,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,02
51-13123-02 NO SPLY,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,03
51-13123-03 NO SPLY,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,04
51-13123-04 NO SPLY,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,06
51-13123-05 NO SPLY,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,08
51-13123-06 NO SPLY,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,10
51-13123-07 NO SPLY,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,12
51-13123-08 NO SPLY,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,LH-EXT,02
51-13123-09 NO SPLY,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,LH-EXT,03
51-13123-10 NO SPLY,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,LH-EXT,04
51-13123-11 NO SPLY,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,LH-EXT,06
51-13123-12 NO SPLY,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,LH-EXT,08
51-13123-13 NO SPLY,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,LH-EXT,10
51-13123-14 NO SPLY,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,LH-EXT,12
51-13123-15 NO SPLY,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,RH-EXT,02
51-13123-16 NO SPLY,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,RH-EXT,03
51-13123-17 NO SPLY,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,RH-EXT,04
51-13123-18 NO SPLY,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,RH-EXT,06
51-13123-19 NO SPLY,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,RH-EXT,08
51-13123-20 NO SPLY,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,RH-EXT,10
51-13123-21 NO SPLY,LOUVERED REMOVABLE RETURN,RH-EXT,12
MOTORIZED OUTSIDE AIR DAMPER ACTUATORS, MODEL FN (MIXING BOX)
VOLTAGE LH UNIT (CW) RH UNIT (CCW) LIST
24 PC-02-0400 PC-02-0400
MODEL FW SERIES “C” MANUAL OUTSIDE AIR DAMPER BOX
UNIT SIZE MANUAL OUTSIDE AIR DAMPER BOX LIST
02 51-13082-01
03 51-13082-02
04 51-13082-03
06 51-13082-04
08 51-13082-05
10 51-13082-06
12 51-13082-07
MODEL FW SERIES “C” MOTORIZED OUTSIDE AIR DAMPER BOX
UNIT SIZE LEFT SIDE ACTUATOR ASSY RIGHT SIDE ACTUATOR

ASSY

LIST
02 51-13081-01 51-13081-08
03 51-13081-02 51-13081-09
04 51-13081-03 51-13081-10
06 51-13081-04 51-13081-11
08 51-13081-05 51-13081-12
10 51-13081-06 51-13081-13
12 51-13081-07 51-13081-14

Note:

1. Select Actuator from below table.

MOTORIZED OUTSIDE AIR DAMPER ACTUATORS, MODELS FW & FS
VOLTAGE Wire Length (in.) LH UNIT (CW) RH UNIT (CCW) LIST
24 PC-02-0351 PC-02-0355
24 15″ PC-00-0747 PC-00-0751
24 84″ PC-00-0785 PC-00-0789
120 PC-02-0352 PC-02-0356
120 15″ PC-00-0748 PC-00-0752
120 84″ PC-00-0786 PC-00-0790
208/230 PC-02-0353 PC-02-0357
208/230 15″ PC-00-0749 PC-00-0753
208/230 84″ PC-00-0787 PC-00-0791

Note:

1. FS unit uses “CW” actuator only

MODEL FW SERIES “C” OUTSIDE AIR WALL BOX
UNIT SIZE WALL BOX P/N LIST
02 51-13087-01
03 51-13087-02
04 51-13087-03
06 51-13087-04
08 51-13087-05
10 51-13087-06
12 51-13087-06
MODEL FW SERIES “B” OUTSIDE AIR WALL BOX
UNIT SIZE WALL BOX P/N LIST
20 B51-20-132
25 B51-25-132
30 B51-30-132
40 B51-40-132
50 B51-50-132
60 B51-60-132
MODEL FS STANDARD RETURN PANEL
UNIT SIZE STANDARD QUICK OPEN LATCH LIST
03 & 04 B74-0304-889
06 & 08 B74-0608-889
10 & 12 B74-1012-889
UNIT SIZE TAMPER RESISTANT LATCH LIST
03 & 04 B74-0304-890
06 & 08 B74-0608-890
10 & 12 B74-1012-890
MODEL FS STANDARD RETURN PANEL FOR “ADA” THERMOSTAT
UNIT SIZE STANDARD QUICK OPEN LATCH LIST
03 & 04 B74-0304-885
06 & 08 B74-0608-885
10 & 12 B74-1012-885
UNIT SIZE TAMPER RESISTANT LATCH LIST
03 & 04 B74-0304-891
06 & 08 B74-0608-891
10 & 12 B74-1012-891
MODEL FS RECESSED RETURN PANEL WITH FRAME
UNIT SIZE STANDARD QUICK OPEN LATCH LIST
03 & 04 B74-0304-884
06 & 08 B74-0608-884
10 & 12 B74-1012-884
UNIT SIZE TAMPER RESISTANT LATCH LIST
03 & 04 B74-0304-892
06 & 08 B74-0608-892
10 & 12 B74-1012-892
MODEL FS RECESSED RETURN PANEL FOR “ADA” THERMOSTAT WITH FRAME
UNIT SIZE STANDARD QUICK OPEN LATCH LIST
03 & 04 B74-0304-886
06 & 08 B74-0608-886
10 & 12 B74-1012-886
UNIT SIZE TAMPER RESISTANT LATCH LIST
03 & 04 B74-0304-893
06 & 08 B74-0608-893
10 & 12 B74-1012-893
MODEL FS PERIMETER INTAKE RETURN PANEL WITH FRAME (PEARL WHITE SATIN)
UNIT SIZE STANDARD MAGNETIC CATCH LIST
Hinged Left Hand Hinged Right Hand
03 & 04 74-13291-07 74-13291-01
06 & 08 74-13291-08 74-13291-02
10 & 12 74-13291-10 74-13291-04
UNIT SIZE TAMPER RESISTANT LATCH LIST
Hinged Left Hand Hinged Right Hand
03 & 04 74-13298-07 74-13298-01
06 & 08 74-13298-08 74-13298-02
10 & 12 74-13298-10 74-13298-04
MODEL FS PERIMETER INTAKE RETURN PANEL FOR “ADA” TTAT W/ FRAME (PEARL WHITE)
UNIT SIZE STANDARD MAGNETIC CATCH LIST
Hinged Left Hand Hinged Right Hand
03 & 04 74-13432-07 74-13432-01
06 & 08 74-13432-08 74-13432-02
10 & 12 74-13432-10 74-13432-04
UNIT SIZE TAMPER RESISTANT LATCH LIST
Hinged Left Hand Hinged Right Hand
03 & 04 74-13295-07 74-13295-01
06 & 08 74-13295-08 74-13295-02
10 & 12 74-13295-10 74-13295-04
MODEL FS PERIMETER INTAKE RETURN PANEL WITH FRAME (BRIGHT WHITE)
UNIT SIZE STANDARD MAGNETIC CATCH LIST
Hinged Left Hand Hinged Right Hand
03 & 04 74-13420-07 74-13420-01
06 & 08 74-13420-08 74-13420-02
10 & 12 74-13420-10 74-13420-04
UNIT SIZE TAMPER RESISTANT LATCH LIST
Hinged Left Hand Hinged Right Hand
03 & 04 74-13418-07 74-13418-01
06 & 08 74-13418-08 74-13418-02
10 & 12 74-13418-10 74-13418-04
MODEL FS PERIMETER INTAKE RETURN PANEL FOR “ADA” TTAT W/ FRAME (BRIGHT WHITE)
UNIT SIZE STANDARD MAGNETIC CATCH LIST
Hinged Left Hand Hinged Right Hand
03 & 04 74-13433-07 74-13433-01
06 & 08 74-13433-08 74-13433-02
10 & 12 74-13433-10 74-13433-04
UNIT SIZE TAMPER RESISTANT LATCH LIST
Hinged Left Hand Hinged Right Hand
03 & 04 74-13414-07 74-13414-01
06 & 08 74-13414-08 74-13414-02
10 & 12 74-13414-10 74-13414-04

©2014 Johnson Controls, Inc.

Electrical Parts Price List

All List Prices Subject to Change Revision Date: February 2014

FAN COIL RELAY BOARD
B63-001-2068 FAN COIL RELAY BOARD (OLD P/N: PC-01-4000)
AQUASTATS AND PIPE SENSORS
PC-01-0020 AQUASTAT, W/CLIP, 5/8 INCH PIPE
PC-01-0021 AQUASTAT, W/CLIP, 7/8 INCH PIPE
PC-01-0022 AQUASTAT, FOR 5/8-7/8 INCH PIPE
61-13500-01 AQUASTAT,5/8 PIPE W/ 50″ LONG HARNESS & CONNECTOR PLUG
61-13500-02 AQUASTAT,7/8 PIPE W/ 50″ LONG HARNESS & CONNECTOR PLUG
61-13500-03 AQUASTAT,5/8 PIPE W/ 90″ LONG HARNESS & CONNECTOR PLUG
61-13500-04 AQUASTAT,7/8 PIPE W/ 90″ LONG HARNESS & CONNECTOR PLUG
61-13500-05 AQUASTAT,UNIVERSAL PIPE W/ 50″ LONG HARNESS & CONNECTOR
61-13500-06 AQUASTAT,UNIVERSAL PIPE W/ 90″ LONG HARNESS & CONNECTOR
PC-07-0103 PROBE,PIPE SENSOR, TTAT W/60 LEADS (WIRE ONLY)
61-13063-01 PROBE,PIPE SENSOR, TTAT W/60 LEADS AND CONNECTOR PLUG
61-13063-02 PROBE,PIPE SENSOR, TTAT W/60 LEADS AND CONNECTOR PINS
LINE BLOCKS
PE-00-0103 1 POLE 30 AMP 600 VOLT CONTROL BLOCK
PE-00-1104 1 TAP 40 AMP LINE BLOCK – NEUTRAL BLOCK
PE-00-2204 2 POLE 40 AMP LINE BLOCK
PE-00-2304 3 POLE 40 AMP LINE BLOCK
PE-00-2309 3 POLE 95 AMP LINE BLOCK
PE-00-2228 2 POLE 285 AMP LINE BLOCK
PE-00-2329 3 POLE 285 AMP LINE BLOCK

Note:

1. Mounting Rail from the Control Block Rails table below is required for the above Line blocks.

CONTROL BLOCK RAILS
44-03213-049 3 TAP RAIL
44-04306-049 4 TAP RAIL
44-05315-049 5 TAP RAIL
44-06408-049 6 TAP RAIL
44-07501-049 7 TAP RAIL
MISCELLANEOUS ELECTRICAL SWITCHES
PE-01-0019 SWITCH,WALL,2POLE,20AMP,2HP,120-277VAC
00-13111-02 ASSY,PE-01-0019 WITH SHEET METAL ENCLOSURE
PE-01-0022 SWITCH,WALL,20AMP,2HP,120VAC – 277VAC
00-13111-01 ASSY,PE-01-0022 WITH SHEET METAL ENCLOSURE
PE-00-0200 3 SPEED SWITCH BLOCK, 4 POSITION
PE-01-0026 SWITCH, NONC CONTACT KA1 (HOA – INTERNAL SWITCH)
PE-01-0025 SWITCH,3POS, CAM 480V 10A KS46B (HOA – EXTERNAL KNOB)
00-13138-01 PE-01-0035 WITH LABELS AND “L” BRACKET (INTERNAL MOUNT)
00-13138-02 PE-01-0035 WITH LABELS AND “J” BRACKET (INTERNAL MOUNT)
00-13138-03 PE-01-0035 WITH LABELS (THROUGH CONTROL ENCLOSURE MOUNT)
00-13138-04 PE-01-0035 WITH LABELS AND “L” BRACKET (INTERNAL VERTICAL MOUNT)
00-13138-05 PE-01-0035 WITH LABELS AND WALL BRACKET (REMOTE / WALL MOUNTED)






00-13111-01

(SINGLE POLE)

00-13111-02

(2-POLE)

DISCONNECT
PE-01-0306 3 POLE 40 AMP DOOR INTERLOCK (6mm)
PE-01-0307 3 POLE 80 AMP DOOR INTERLOCK (6mm)
PE-01-4004 NEW STYLE SHAFT (40 AMP) 180mm LONG (6mm)
PE-01-4006 NEW STYLE HANDLE (KNOB) 40-80 AMP (6mm)
PE-01-0310 3 POLE 100 AMP DOOR INTERLOCK
PE-01-0316 3 POLE 160 AMP DOOR INTERLOCK
PE-01-0320 3 POLE 200 AMP DOOR INTERLOCK
PE-01-0340 3 POLE 400 AMP DOOR INTERLOCK
PE-01-0360 3 POLE 600 AMP DOOR INTERLOCK
PE-01-0380 3 POLE 800 AMP DOOR INTERLOCK
29-00-220 TOGGLE SWITCH ELECTRICAL INSULATOR(DUROID)PR-07-0020

Notes:

1. 100 amp shaft is available with disconnect only.

FUSED DOOR INTERLOCKING DISCONNECT
PE-01-4011 FUSED DISCONNECT SWITCH, 30A, 600V, 3P
PE-01-4012 FUSED DISCONNECT SWITCH, 60A, 600V, 3P
PE-01-4016 FUSED DISCONNECT SWITCH, 100A, 600V, 3P
PE-01-4017 FUSED DISCONNECT SWITCH, 100A, 600V, 2P
PE-01-4019 FUSED DISCONNECT SWITCH, 200A, 600V, 3P
FUSED DOOR INTERLOCKING DISCONNECT ACCESSORIES
PE-01-4013 DISCONNECT SHAFT FOR 60 AMP (6mm)
PE-01-4021 DISCONNECT SHAFT FOR 100 AMP AND 200 AMP
PE-01-4014 DISCONNECT HANDLE (KNOB) FOR 60 AMP SWITCH
PE-01-4020 DISCONNECT HANDLE (KNOB) FOR 100 AND 200 AMP SWITCH
PE-01-4015 TERMINAL LUG KIT FOR 30 & 60 AMP SWITCH
PE-01-4022 TERMINAL LUG KIT FOR 100 & 200 AMP DISCONNECT
PE-01-4018 COVER, FUSE FOR 100 AMP DISCONNECT
FUSE BLOCKS
PE-07-4030 1 POLE 30 AMP 250 VOLT FUSE BLOCK CLASS K
PE-07-1030 1 POLE 30 AMP 600 VOLT MINI FUSE BLOCK CLASS CC
PE-07-7060 1 POLE 60 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE BLOCK CLASS K
PE-07-5100 2 POLE 100 AMP 250 VOLT FUSE BLOCK CLASS K
PE-07-5030 2 POLE 30 AMP 250 VOLT FUSE BLOCK CLASS K
PE-07-2030 2 POLE 30 AMP 600 VOLT MINI FUSE BLOCK CLASS CC
PE-07-5060 2 POLE 60 AMP 250 VOLT FUSE BLOCK CLASS K
PE-07-9100 3 POLE 100 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE BLOCK CLASS K
PE-07-6030 3 POLE 30 AMP 250 VOLT FUSE BLOCK CLASS K
PE-07-9030 3 POLE 30 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE BLOCK CLASS K
PE-07-3030 3 POLE 30 AMP 600 VOLT MINI FUSE BLOCK CLASS CC
PE-07-6060 3 POLE 60 AMP 250 VOLT FUSE BLOCK CLASS K
PE-07-9060 3 POLE 60 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE BLOCK CLASS K
PE-07-1001 2 POLE 30 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE BLOCK CLASS CC, MR
PE-07-1002 3 POLE 30 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE BLOCK CLASS CC, MR
PE-07-8061 2 POLE 60 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE BLOCK CLASS CC, MR
PE-07-9061 3 POLE 60 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE BLOCK CLASS CC, MR
PE-07-8101 2 POLE 100 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE BLOCK CLASS CC, MR
PE-07-9101 3 POLE 100 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE BLOCK CLASS CC, MR
PE-07-8201 2 POLE 200 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE BLOCK CLASS CC, MR
PE-07-9201 3 POLE 200 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE BLOCK CLASS CC, MR
FUSES
250V
PE-06-1002 2 AMP 250 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
PE-06-1003 3 AMP 250 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
PE-06-1004 4 AMP 250 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
PE-06-1006 6 AMP 250 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
PE-06-1010 10 AMP 250 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
PE-06-1015 15 AMP 250 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
PE-06-1020 20 AMP 250 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
PE-06-1025 25 AMP 250 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
PE-06-1030 30 AMP 250 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
PE-06-1035 35 AMP 250 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
PE-06-1040 40 AMP 250 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
PE-06-1045 45 AMP 250 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
PE-06-1050 50 AMP 250 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
PE-06-1060 60 AMP 250 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
600 VOLT
PE-06-2001 1 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
PE-06-2002 2 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
PE-06-2003 3 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
PE-06-2006 6 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
PE-06-2010 10 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
PE-06-2015 15 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
PE-06-2020 20 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
PE-06-2025 25 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
PE-06-2030 30 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
PE-06-2035 35 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
PE-06-2040 40 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
PE-06-2045 45 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
PE-06-2050 50 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
PE-06-2060 60 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
PE-06-0031 1/2 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-0032 8/10 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-0033 1 1/4 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-0034 1 1/2 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-0035 2 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-0036 2 1/2 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-0037 3 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-0038 3 1/2 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-0039 4 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-0040 5 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-0041 6 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-0042 7 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-0043 9 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-0044 10 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-0045 12 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-0046 15 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-0047 20 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-0048 25 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-0049 30 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-3000 35 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS J, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-3001 40 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS J, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-3002 50 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS J, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-3003 60 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS J, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-3004 70 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS J, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-3005 80 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS J, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-3006 90 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS J, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-3007 100 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS J, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-3008 110 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS J, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-3009 125 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS J, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-3010 150 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS J, TIME DELAY, MR
MINIATURE FUSES
PE-06-0001 1 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC
PE-06-0002 2 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC
PE-06-0003 3 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC
PE-06-0006 6 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC
PE-06-0010 10 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC
PE-06-0015 15 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC
PE-06-0020 20 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC
PE-06-0025 25 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC
PE-06-0030 30 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC
MAGNETIC CONTACTORS/RELAYS
24 VOLT CONTROL
PE-05-1301 1 POLE 30 AMP CONTACTOR 24 VOLT
PE-05-1501 1 POLE 50 AMP CONTACTOR 24 VOLT
PE-08-0004 2 Pole 25 AMP RELAY 24 VOLT
PE-05-2301 2 POLE 30 AMP CONTACTOR 24 VOLT
PE-05-2401 2 POLE 40 AMP CONTACTOR 24 VOLT
PE-05-2501 2 POLE 50 AMP CONTACTOR 24 VOLT
PE-05-3301 3 POLE 30 AMP CONTACTOR 24 VOLT
PE-05-3401 3 POLE 40 AMP CONTACTOR 24 VOLT
PE-05-3501 3 POLE 50 AMP CONTACTOR 24 VOLT
120 VOLT CONTROL
PE-05-1302 1 POLE 30 AMP CONTACTOR 120 VOLT
PE-05-1402 1 POLE 40 AMP CONTACTOR 120 VOLT
PE-05-2302 2 POLE 30 AMP CONTACTOR 120 VOLT
PE-05-2402 2 POLE 40 AMP CONTACTOR 120 VOLT
PE-05-2502 2 POLE 50 AMP CONTACTOR 120 VOLT
PE-05-3302 3 POLE 30 AMP CONTACTOR 120 VOLT
PE-05-3402 3 POLE 40 AMP CONTACTOR 120 VOLT
PE-05-3502 3 POLE 50 AMP CONTACTOR 120 VOLT
208 – 240 VOLT CONTROL
PE-05-1306 1 POLE 30 AMP CONTACTOR 208-240 VOLT
PE-05-1406 1 POLE 40 AMP CONTACTOR 208-240 VOLT
PE-05-1506 1 POLE 50 AMP CONTACTOR 208-240 VOLT
PE-05-2306 2 POLE 30 AMP CONTACTOR 208-240 VOLT
PE-05-2406 2 POLE 40 AMP CONTACTOR 208-240 VOLT
PE-05-2506 2 POLE 50 AMP CONTACTOR 208-240 VOLT
PE-05-3306 3 POLE 30 AMP CONTACTOR 208-240 VOLT
PE-05-3406 3 POLE 40 AMP CONTACTOR 208-240 VOLT
PE-05-3506 3 POLE 50 AMP CONTACTOR 208-240 VOLT
277 VOLT CONTROL
PE-05-1305 1 POLE 30 AMP CONTACTOR 277 VOLT
PE-05-1405 1 POLE 40 AMP CONTACTOR 277 VOLT
PE-05-2305 2 POLE 30 AMP CONTACTOR 277 VOLT
PE-05-2405 2 POLE 40 AMP CONTACTOR 277 VOLT
PE-05-2505 2 POLE 50 AMP CONTACTOR 277 VOLT
PE-05-3305 3 POLE 30 AMP CONTACTOR 277 VOLT
PE-05-3405 3 POLE 40 AMP CONTACTOR 277 VOLT
PE-05-3505 3 POLE 50 AMP CONTACTOR 277 VOLT
SOLID STATE RELAYS (SSR)
PE-02-0010 ETSR15 – SOLID STATE RELAY 50 AMP/1 PHASE
n/a ETSR32 – SOLID STATE RELAY 25 AMP/3 PHASE (Obsolete)
PE-02-0025 ETSR35 – SOLID STATE RELAY 50 AMP/3 PHASE
PE-02-0030 SSR,1PH,48-660VAC,18A,120V
PE-02-0031 SSR,1PH,48-660VAC,18A,24V
PE-02-0032 SSR,1PH,42-660VAC, 25A, 280V
PE-02-0033 SSR,1PH,42-660VAC, 50A, 280V
PE-02-0034 SSR,1PH,42-660VAC, 60A, 280V
INTERFACE BOARDS FOR SSR RELAY
ETPHCC SWITCH GROUND SIDE PWM INPUT, CLOSE TO CONTROLLER COM
ETPHCC1 SWITCH HOT SIDE PWM INPUT, CLOSE TO CONTROLLER 24 VAC
ETPHCI SSR 4-20ma INPUT
ETPHCR SSR 135 OHM INPUT
ETPHCT SSR TTAT INPUT
ETPHCV1 SSR 6-9 VDC INPUT
ETPHCV2 SSR 2-10 VDC INPUT
MERCURY CONTACTORS
PE-26-1351 1 POLE 35 AMP 24 VOLT
PE-26-1501 1 POLE 50 AMP 24 VOLT
PE-26-2351 2 POLE 35 AMP 24 VOLT
PE-26-2501 2 POLE 50 AMP 24 VOLT
PE-26-3351 3 POLE 35 AMP 24 VOLT
PE-26-3501 3 POLE 50 AMP 24 VOLT
PE-26-1355 1 POLE 35 AMP 277 VOLT
PE-26-2355 2 POLE 35 AMP 277 VOLT
SECONDARY LIMITS
PE-09-6140 140°F ONE TIME SEC LIMIT 48A 600VAC ONETIME (RING TERMINAL) 61F 322803
PE-09-6240 240°F ONE TIME SEC LIMIT 48A 600VAC ONETIME (RING TERMINAL) 61F 322802
PE-09-8140 140°F ONE TIME SEC LIMIT 25A 600VAC ONETIME (QUICK CONN) 60F 311722
PE-09-8240 240°F ONE TIME SEC LIMIT 25A 600VAC ONETIME (QUICK CONN) 60F 311723
PE-09-8160 160°F MANUAL RESET SEC LIMIT 48A 480VAC (RING TERMINAL) 20413L7-912
PE-09-8300 TUTCO ONE-TIME LIMIT SWITCH 160 DEG (RING TERMINAL) 08-3098-00
PE-09-8301 TUTCO ONE-TIME LIMIT SWITCH 140 DEG (RING TERMINAL) 08-3043-00
PE-09-8302 TUTCO ONE-TIME LIMIT SWITCH 125 -140 DEG (QUICK CONN) 08-3090-00
PRIMARY LIMITS
PE-09-1105 105°F AUTO RESET PRIMARY LIMIT 12.5A 600VAC (QUICK CONN) 60T 313287
PE-09-0125 125°F AUTO RESET PRIMARY LIMIT 13A 600V 312894-60TX11
TRANSFORMERS
PE-10-1105 24 PRIMARY 24 SECONDARY 50VA ISOLATION TRANSFORMER
PE-10-2105 120 PRIMARY 24 SECONDARY 50VA TRANSFORMER
PE-10-2107 120 PRIMARY 24 SECONDARY 75VA TRANSFORMER
PE-10-5105 277 PRIMARY 24 SECONDARY 50VA TRANSFORMER
PE-10-5107 277 PRIMARY 24 SECONDARY 75VA TRANSFORMER
PE-10-6105 208-240 PRIMARY 24 SECONDARY 50VA TRANSFORMER
PE-10-6107 208-240 PRIMARY 24 SECONDARY 75VA TRANSFORMER
PE-10-7105 480 PRIMARY 24 SECONDARY 50VA TRANSFORMER
PE-10-7107 480 PRIMARY 24 SECONDARY 75VA TRANSFORMER
TRANSFORMER WIRING
B61-01-084 ASSY,WIRE,TERM CONNECTOR TO PWR WHT
B61-01-085 ASSY,WIRE,TERM CONNECTOR TO PWR BLK

Note:

  1. Both of the above Tranformer wires are required by code for field chage-out of transformers.
  2. Note on parts orders for tansformers to attached transformer wireing prior to shipping.
WIRELESS FLAG COVERS
PE-19-0002 COVER,WIRELESS FLAG,CLEAR
PE-19-0003 COVER,WIRELESS FLAG,BRIGHT WHITE
PE-19-0004 COVER,WIRELESS FLAG,PEARL WHITE
FAN SPEED CONTROLLERS
VAV & DIRECT DRIVE FAN SCR – SPEED CONTROLLERS – 120V
66-001-1000 ETFC120-4
66-002-1000 ETFC120-10
ETFC120-20 ETFC120-20
ETFC120-30 ETFC120-30
66-001-1000 ETFC115VF-A
66-003-1000 ETFC115VF-B
VAV & DIRECT DRIVE FAN SCR – SPEED CONTROLLERS – 208V
66-009-1000 ETFC208CF-A
66-010-1000 ETFC208CF-B
66-009-1000 ETFC208VF-A
66-011-1000 ETFC208VF-B
VAV & DIRECT DRIVE FAN SCR – SPEED CONTROLLERS – 277V
66-004-1000 ETFC277-4S
66-005-1000 ETFC277-8
66-006-1000 ETFC277VF-A
66-007-1000 ETFC277VF-B
VAV & DIRECT DRIVE FAN SCR – SPEED CONTROLLERS ECM MOTORS
B63-001-2063 ETPWM – Single ECM motor speed controller
B63-003-2063 ETPWM – Dual ECM motor master speed controller1
B63-004-2063 ETPWM – Dual ECM motor slave speed controller1
29-00-269 All model ETPWM* mounting bracket

Note:

1. Speed adjustment is located on master speed controller

MOTOR CABLES
B61-02-069 TCSHW 53″ MOTOR POWER CABLE (INLET SIZES 14 AND LARGER AND/OR FAN SIZE 21
B61-02-092 TCSHW 77″ MOTOR POWER CABLE (INLET SIZES 14 AND LARGER AND/OR FAN SIZE 21
B61-02-029 TCSEH 53″ MOTOR POWER CABLE (INLET SIZES 14 AND LARGER AND/OR FAN SIZE 21
B61-02-024 TCSHW 53″ MOTOR SIGNAL CABLE (INLET SIZES 14 AND LARGER AND/OR FAN SIZE 21
B61-01-086 TCSHW 89″ MOTOR SIGNAL CABLE FOR DUAL MOTOR APPLICATIONS

©2014 Johnson Controls, Inc.

Electrical Parts Price List

All List Prices Subject to Change Revision Date: February 2014

INLINE MOTOR FUSE AND FUSE HOLDER SELECTION CHART
120 Volt 208 Volt
Motor HP Fuse AMP Fuse Qty.

Required

Fuse Part # Fuse Holder

Part #

Fuse AMP Fuse Qty.

Required

Fuse Part # Fuse Holder

Part #

1/13 6 AMP 1 PE-06-0006 PE-07-1030 N/A N/A N/A N/A
1/6 15 AMP 1 PE-06-0015 PE-07-1030 6 AMP 2 PE-06-0006 PE-07-2030
1/4 20 AMP 1 PE-06-0020 PE-07-1030 15 AMP 2 PE-06-0015 PE-07-2030
1/2 30 AMP 1 PE-06-0030 PE-07-1030 15 AMP 2 PE-06-0015 PE-07-2030
3/4 30 AMP 1 PE-06-0030 PE-07-1030 20 AMP 2 PE-06-0020 PE-07-2030
(2) 1/13 10 AMP 1 PE-06-0010 PE-07-1030 N/A N/A N/A N/A
(2) 1/6 20 AMP 1 PE-06-0020 PE-07-1030 10 AMP 2 PE-06-0010 PE-07-2030
(2) 1/4 30 AMP 1 PE-06-0030 PE-07-1030 20 AMP 2 PE-06-0020 PE-07-2030
(2) 1/2 30 AMP 1 PE-06-3030 PE-07-A030 30 AMP 2 PE-06-0030 PE-07-2030
(2) 3/4 30 AMP 1 PE-06-3030 PE-07-A030 20 AMP 2 PE-06-3020 PE-07-A030
1 20 AMP 1 PE-06-3020 PE-07-A030 N/A N/A N/A N/A
(2) 1 35 AMP 1 PE-06-3035 PE-07-A060 N/A N/A N/A N/A
277 Volt 480 Volt
Motor HP Fuse AMP Fuse Qty.

Required

Fuse Part # Fuse Holder

Part #

Fuse AMP Fuse Qty.

Required

Fuse Part # Fuse Holder

Part #

1/13 3 AMP 1 PE-06-0003 PE-07-1030 N/A N/A N/A N/A
1/6 6 AMP 1 PE-06-0006 PE-07-1030 N/A N/A N/A N/A
1/4 10 AMP 1 PE-06-0010 PE-07-1030 6 AMP 2 PE-06-0006 PE-07-2030
1/2 15 AMP 1 PE-06-0015 PE-07-1030 10 AMP 2 PE-06-0010 PE-07-2030
3/4 15 AMP 1 PE-06-0015 PE-07-1030 10 AMP 2 PE-06-0010 PE-07-2030
(2) 1/13 6 AMP 1 PE-06-0006 PE-07-1030 N/A N/A N/A N/A
(2) 1/6 10 AMP 1 PE-06-0010 PE-07-1030 N/A N/A N/A N/A
(2) 1/4 15 AMP 1 PE-06-0015 PE-07-1030 10 AMP 2 PE-06-0010 PE-07-2030
(2) 1/2 25 AMP 1 PE-06-0025 PE-07-1030 20 AMP 2 PE-06-0020 PE-07-2030
(2) 3/4 25 AMP 1 PE-06-0025 PE-07-1030 20 AMP 2 PE-06-0020 PE-07-2030
1 15 AMP 1 PE-06-0015 PE-07-1030 N/A N/A N/A N/A
(2) 1 30 AMP 1 PE-06-0030 PE-07-1030 N/A N/A N/A N/A

Notes:

  1. All fuse holder part numbers shown reflect the quantity of fuses required.
  2. See Fuse Blocks and Fuses tables for pricing.

©2014 Johnson Controls, Inc.

VAV Parts Price List

All List Prices Subject to Change Revision Date: February 2014



©2014 Johnson Controls, Inc.

VAV Parts Price List

All List Prices Subject to Change Revision Date: February 2014



©2014 Johnson Controls, Inc.

VAV Parts Price List

All List Prices Subject to Change Revision Date: February 2014



©2014 Johnson Controls, Inc.

VAV Parts Price List

All List Prices Subject to Change Revision Date: February 2014



©2014 Johnson Controls, Inc.

VAV Parts Price List

All List Prices Subject to Change Revision Date: February 2014



©2014 Johnson Controls, Inc.

VAV Parts Price List

All List Prices Subject to Change Revision Date: February 2014



©2014 Johnson Controls, Inc.

VAV Parts Price List

All List Prices Subject to Change Revision Date: February 2014



©2014 Johnson Controls, Inc.

VAV Parts Price List

All List Prices Subject to Change Revision Date: February 2014

PNEUMATIC CONTROLS
PC-05-0049 DA CONTROLLER – NORMALLY OPEN – BEIGE – (CSC2007)
PC-05-0059 RA CONTROLLER – NORMALLY CLOSED – GRAY – (CSC2008)
PC-05-0050 8-13 P.S.I. KREUTER MULTI-FUNCTION CONTROLLER – (CSC3016)
PC-05-0060 3-8 P.S.I. KREUTER MULTI-FUNCTION CONTROLLER – (CSC3026)
PC-05-0030 REVERSING RELAY – RCC1012 (15151)
PC-05-0080 DIVERTING RELAY – (RCC1009)
PC-05-0075 SNAP ACTING DIVERTING RELAY – (R503-1)
PC-05-0020 LOWER 2 PRESSURE RELAY – RCC1006 (15150)
PC-05-0031 HIGHER 2 PRESSURE RELAY (RCC-1008)
PC-05-0090 PRESSURE REGULATOR (S515)
PH-08-0024 MANUAL QUADRANT (560)
PNEUMATIC ACTUATORS
B00-0510-322 ACTUATOR 5-10 PSI NOMINAL 45° (PDA510)
B00-3510-322 PNEUMATIC ACTUATOR NOMINAL 90° (PDA3-510)
PC-02-0006 5-10 ROTARY ACTUATOR (MCP-3631-3000)
PC-02-0010 3-8 ROTARY ACTUATOR (MCP-3631-8000)
PC-02-0008 8-13 ROTARY ACTUATOR (MCP-3631-5000)
PC-02-0002 DRIVE BUSHING & COLLAR SET FOR ROTARY ACTUATOR (02700)
00-00-240 ACTUATOR MOUNTING BRACKET 45°
00-00-240R ACTUATOR MOUNTING BRACKET 90°
PC-07-0202 DIAPHRAGM FOR PNEUMATIC ACTUATORS (APLUNGER)
PNEUMATIC/ELECTRIC SWITCHES
PC-03-0002 N.O./N.C. ADJ AIR PRESSURE SWITCH (L-02151-048 – AP5044)
PC-03-0001 N.O. FIXED AIR PRESSURE SWITCH (L-01151-048 – FP5011)
PC-03-0000 N.C. FIXED AIR PRESSURE SWITCH (L-01152-048 – FP5042)
M-21215-065 P.E. SWITCH 08, 21 AMPS @ 277V
M-21257-065 P.E. SWITCH 09, 25 AMPS @ 480V
PE-01-1000 ELECTRIC PNEUMATIC SWITCH – 24V (AL-180)
PE-01-0900 ELECTRIC PNEUMATIC SWITCH – 120V (AL-181)
PE-01-1001 ELECTRIC PNEUMATIC SWITCH – 277V (AL-182)
MISCELLANEOUS COMPONENTS
PE-19-0150 3/8″ PLASTIC PNEUMATIC FITTING – STRAIGHT (13735)
PH-05-0034 3/8″ BRASS TEE (224-6)
PH-05-0016 RESTRICTOR TEE (N100-0100)
00-00-115 HANGER BRACKET (00-00-115) (Requires grommet and brass eyelet)
PH-06-0012 GROMMET (QR 370631)
PH-06-0018 BRASS EYELET (NS-SIMPSON #A61)
PR-04-0246 MANUAL AIR VENT
00-00510-02 ELECTRONIC ENCLOSURE – 22GA. SMALL (16 X 10 X 6)
00-00058-01 ELECTRONIC ENCLOSURE COVER – 22GA. SMALL 2-SIDED (16 X 10 X 6)
00-00059-01 ELECTRONIC ENCLOSURE COVER – 22GA. SMALL 1-SIDED (16 X 10 X 6)
00-00510-01 ELECTRONIC ENCLOSURE – 22GA. LARGE (22 X 10 X 6)
00-00058-02 ELECTRONIC ENCLOSURE COVER – 22GA. LARGE 2-SIDED (22 X 10 X 6)
00-00059-02 ELECTRONIC ENCLOSURE COVER – 22GA. LARGE 1-SIDED (22 X 10 X 6)






00-00058-xx

DEP1H

LENGIH

HEIGHT

2 -S IDEDENCLOSURE COVER L xHxD

ELECTR ONIC ENCLOSURE (L x H x D)

00-00059-xx

HEIGHT

LENGIH

DEP1H

I -SIDEDENCLOSURE COVER (L x H x D)




Figure 1A

Figure

1B


PROBES – STATIC & DIFFERENTIAL PRESSURE SENSING
PITOT TUBES
PH-05-0012 2.25″ PITOT TUBE (AA3042) EH AIRFLOW SWITCH PIPING
PROBES – STATIC & DIFFERENTIAL PRESSURE SENSING
LINEAR AVERAGING PROBES (STRAIGHT) FOR 45°AIR VALVES — Figure 1A

FOR OBSOLETE MODELS

B00-06-108 6″ ROUND INLET (00-06-108)
B00-08-108 8″ ROUND INLET (00-08-108)
B00-10-108 10″ OVAL INLET (00-10-108)
B00-12-108 12″ OVAL INLET (00-12-108)
B00-14-108 14″ OVAL INLET (00-14-108)
B00-16-108 16″ OVAL INLET (00-16-108)
B00-18-108 18″ OVAL INLET (00-18-108)
PROBES – STATIC & DIFFERENTIAL PRESSURE SENSING
FLOWSTAR PROBES FOR 90°AIR VALVES — Figure 1B

INCLUDING UNIT MODELS: TSS, TSX, TVS, TCS, TDS

B00-04-108 4″ INLET (LINEAR PROBE) (B00-04-108)
B00-05-108 5″ INLET (LINEAR PROBE) (B00-05-108)
B00-06-330 6″ INLET (B00-06-276)
B00-08-330 8″ INLET (B00-08-276)
B00-10-330 10″ INLET (B00-10-276)
B00-12-330 12″ INLET (B00-12-276)
B00-14/19-330 14″ INLET (B00-14/19-276)
B00-16/22-330 16″ INLET (B00-16/22-276)
B00-14/19-276 19″ INLET (REQUIRES 2 ) (B00-14/19-276)
B00-16/22-276 22″ INLET (REQUIRES 2) (B00-16/22-276)
PM-07-0047 BLACK LINEAR PROBE CAPS – PKG OF 50 (10824)

Probe Assembly

PROBE ASSEMBLIES
FLOWSTAR PROBES FOR UNIT MODELS TSL, TVL, TCL
00-13000-01 10″ x 8″ RECTANGULAR INLET
00-13000-02 14″ x 8″ RECTANGULAR INLET
00-13000-03 16″ x 8″ RECTANGULAR INLET
00-13000-04 14″ x 10″ RECTANGULAR INLET
00-13000-05 12″ x 8″ RECTANGULAR INLET
INLET REDUCERS
PM-14-0002 6″ TO 4″ REDUCER (04109R)
PM-14-0003 6″ TO 5″ REDUCER (05109R)
DAMPER BLADE ASSEMBLIES FOR 90°AIR VALVES
B00-06-307 DAMPER BLADE ASSEMBLY – SIZE 4,5,6 (DBA/4-6)
B00-08-307 DAMPER BLADE ASSEMBLY – SIZE 8 (DBA/8)
B00-10-307 DAMPER BLADE ASSEMBLY – SIZE 10 (DBA/10)
B00-12-307 DAMPER BLADE ASSEMBLY – SIZE 12 (DBA/12)
B00-14-307 DAMPER BLADE ASSEMBLY – SIZE 14 (DBA/14)
B00-16-307 DAMPER BLADE ASSEMBLY – SIZE 16 (DBA/16)
DAMPER BLADE COMPONENTS
PH-08-0018 DRIVE SHAFT (13768)
PC-07-0156 SNAP RING (13767)
PH-08-0022 NYLON BEARING (13770)
PH-08-0020 NON-DRIVE SHAFT

Damper Blade Assembly



Controller Mounting Assembly


INDUCTION SOUND BAFFLES
MODEL TVS
B07-04/08-153 ASSY,SOUND BAFFLE,04/08
B07-10/12-153 ASSY,SOUND BAFFLE,10/12
B07-14/16-153 ASSY,SOUND BAFFLE,14/16
FLAT FILTER RACKS
MODEL TVS
07-04/08-122 MODEL TVS-WC 4 – 8 QTY 2 REQUIRED
07-10/12-122 MODEL TVS-WC 10-12 QTY 2 REQUIRED
07-14/16-122 MODEL TVS-WC 14 – 16 QTY 2 REQUIRED

TVS-WC



TVS-EH

Filter Rail

TCS FILTER CLIP
PH-02-0044 MODEL TCS FLAT FILTER CLIPS QTY 2 REQUIRED


Model TCS Flat Filter Clip Locations

Filter Clip

V-BANK FILTER RACKS
MODELS TCS
B33-04-030 MODEL TCS FILTER RACKS V-BANK 4
B33-06/11-031 MODEL TCS FILTER RACKS V-BANK 6, 8, 11
B33-10/11-031 MODEL TCS FILTER RACKS V-BANK 1011
B33-18/21-031 MODEL TCS FILTER RACKS V-BANK 17, 21
B33-1421-031 MODEL TCS FILTER RACKS V-BANK 1421
B33-24-031 MODEL TCS FILTER RACKS V-BANK 24
B33-30/44-031 MODEL TCS FILTER RACKS V-BANK 30


Model TCS V-Bank Filters/Filter Racks




Size 04

Size 06 thru 44





Filters

FILTERS
MODEL DESCRIPTION 1″ Filter Size LIST
MODEL TVS
PM-04-0066 TVS-4, 5, 6, 8 14 X 24
PM-04-0124 TVS-10, 12 17 X 30
PM-04-0144 TVS-14, 16 19 X 30
MODEL TCS (NEW STYLE) V-BANK
PM-04-0028 TCS 4 7 X 12
PM-04-0033 TCS 6, 11 QTY 2 REQUIRED 12 X 13
PM-04-0027 TCS 1011 QTY 2 REQUIRED 11 X 15
PM-04-0078 TCS 18, 21 QTY 2 REQUIRED 15 X 17
PM-04-0141 TCS 24 QTY 2 REQUIRED 19 X 19
PM-04-0144 TCS 30, 40, 44 QTY 2 REQUIRED 19 X 30
MODEL TCS (FLAT)
PM-04-0028 xx04 & xx05 7 X 12
PM-04-0054 xx06, 08, 11 13 X 14
PM-04-0026 1011 11 X 14
PM-04-0078 xx18, 21 15 X 17
PM-04-0112 1421 13 X 17
PM-04-0141 xx24 19 X 19
PM-04-0144 xx30, 40, 44 19 X 30
MISCELLEANOUS (FOR OSBOLETE MODELS)
PM-04-0066 14 X 24
PM-04-0124 17 X 30
PM-04-0066 QTY 2 REQUIRED 14 X 24
PM-04-0046 QTY 2 REQUIRED 12 X 24
PM-04-0052 QTY 2 REQUIRED 12 X 30
PM-04-0044 QTY 4 REQUIRED 12 X 21
PM-04-0050 QTY 4 REQUIRED 12 X 26
PM-04-0046 QTY 4 REQUIRED 12 X 24
PM-04-0046 QTY 2 REQUIRED 12 X 24
PM-04-0042 QTY 2 REQUIRED 12 X 19
BLOWER ASSEMBLIES (INCLUDES FAN WHEEL & FAN HOUSING)
BLOWER P/N DESCRIPTION UNIT SIZE LIST
PM-06-0118 BLOWER ASSY,9-4R,CW,0.5,CV TCL0406
PM-06-0118 BLOWER ASSY,9-4R,CW,0.5,CV TCL0606
PM-06-0145 BLOWER ASSY, 10-4R TCL0608
PM-06-0118 BLOWER ASSY,9-4R,CW,0.5,CV TCL0806
PM-06-0145 BLOWER ASSY, 10-4R TCL0808
PM-06-0145 BLOWER ASSY, 10-4R TCL1008
PM-06-0151 BLOWER ASSY,10-5,CW,0.5,CV TCL1010
PM-06-0147 BLOWER ASSY, 11-4R TCL1011
PM-06-0145 BLOWER ASSY, 10-4R TCL1019
PM-06-0147 BLOWER ASSY, 11-4R TCL1211
PM-06-0145 BLOWER ASSY, 10-4R TCL1219
PM-06-0145 BLOWER ASSY, 10-4R TCL1319
PM-06-0005 BLOWER,5-7WHEEL W1/2 BORE ASSY TCS0404
PM-06-0133 BLOWER ASSY,10-9T,CW,0.5,CV TCS0419
PM-06-0005 BLOWER,5-7WHEEL W1/2 BORE ASSY TCS0504
PM-06-0119 BLOWER ASSY,9-4T,CW,0.5,CV TCS0506
PM-06-0005 BLOWER,5-7WHEEL W1/2 BORE ASSY TCS0604
PM-06-0119 BLOWER ASSY,9-4T,CW,0.5,CV TCS0606
PM-06-0122 BLOWER ASSY,9-7T,CW,0.5,CV TCS0611
PM-06-0133 BLOWER ASSY,10-9T,CW,0.5,CV TCS0619
PM-06-0135 BLOWER ASSY,10-10T,CW,0.5,CV TCS0621
PM-06-0119 BLOWER ASSY,9-4T,CW,0.5,CV TCS0806
PM-06-0122 BLOWER ASSY,9-7T,CW,0.5,CV TCS0811
PM-06-0124 BLOWER ASSY,9-9R,CW,0.5,CV TCS0818
PM-06-0135 BLOWER ASSY,10-10T,CW,0.5,CV TCS0821
PM-06-0122 BLOWER ASSY,9-7T,CW,0.5,CV TCS1011
PM-06-0124 BLOWER ASSY,9-9R,CW,0.5,CV TCS1018
PM-06-0135 BLOWER ASSY,10-10T,CW,0.5,CV TCS1021
PM-06-0124 BLOWER ASSY,9-9R,CW,0.5,CV TCS1218
PM-06-0134 BLOWER ASSY,10-9R,CW,0.5,CV TCS1219
PM-06-0135 BLOWER ASSY,10-10T,CW,0.5,CV TCS1221
PM-06-0134 BLOWER ASSY,10-9R,CW,0.5,CV TCS1224
PM-06-0124 BLOWER ASSY,9-9R,CW,0.5,CV TCS1230
PM-06-0135 BLOWER ASSY,10-10T,CW,0.5,CV TCS1421
PM-06-0134 BLOWER ASSY,10-9R,CW,0.5,CV TCS1424
PM-06-0124 BLOWER ASSY,9-9R,CW,0.5,CV TCS1430
PM-06-0133 BLOWER ASSY,10-9T,CW,0.5,CV TCS1440
PM-06-0124 BLOWER ASSY,9-9R,CW,0.5,CV TCS1630
PM-06-0133 BLOWER ASSY,10-9T,CW,0.5,CV TCS1640
PM-06-0134 BLOWER ASSY,10-9R,CW,0.5,CV TCS1644
PM-06-0134 BLOWER ASSY,10-9R,CW,0.5,CV TCS1844
PM-06-0122 BLOWER ASSY,9-7T,CW,0.5,CV TCSQ0504
PM-06-0132 BLOWER ASSY,10-8T,CW,0.5,C3 TCSQ0619
PM-06-0122 BLOWER ASSY,9-7T,CW,0.5,CV TCSQ0811
PM-06-0132 BLOWER ASSY,10-8T,CW,0.5,C3 TCSQ0817
PM-06-0133 BLOWER ASSY,10-9T,CW,0.5,CV TCSQ0819
PM-06-0132 BLOWER ASSY,10-8T,CW,0.5,C3 TCSQ0821
PM-06-0122 BLOWER ASSY,9-7T,CW,0.5,CV TCSQ1011
PM-06-0132 BLOWER ASSY,10-8T,CW,0.5,C3 TCSQ1017
PM-06-0133 BLOWER ASSY,10-9T,CW,0.5,CV TCSQ1019
PM-06-0135 BLOWER ASSY,10-10T,CW,0.5,CV TCSQ1021
PM-06-0132 BLOWER ASSY,10-8T,CW,0.5,C3 TCSQ1217
PM-06-0133 BLOWER ASSY,10-9T,CW,0.5,CV TCSQ1219
PM-06-0135 BLOWER ASSY,10-10T,CW,0.5,CV TCSQ1221
PM-06-0134 BLOWER ASSY,10-9R,CW,0.5,CV TCSQ1224
PM-06-0124 BLOWER ASSY,9-9R,CW,0.5,CV TCSQ1230
PM-06-0135 BLOWER ASSY,10-10T,CW,0.5,CV TCSQ1421
PM-06-0134 BLOWER ASSY,10-9R,CW,0.5,CV TCSQ1424
PM-06-0124 BLOWER ASSY,9-9R,CW,0.5,CV TCSQ1430
PM-06-0124 BLOWER ASSY,9-9R,CW,0.5,CV TCSQ1630
PM-06-0006 BLOWER,5.75 X 8 WHEEL,W/HSG,.5 BORE TVL0405
PM-06-0148 BLOWER, VFL 05 & 09 TVL0505
PM-06-0148 BLOWER, VFL 05 & 09 TVL0605
PM-06-0148 BLOWER, VFL 05 & 09 TVL0805
PM-06-0148 BLOWER, VFL 05 & 09 TVL1009
PM-06-0148 BLOWER, VFL 05 & 09 TVL1209
PM-06-0150 BLOWER, VFL 15 TVL1215
PM-06-0150 BLOWER, VFL 15 TVL1415
PM-06-0005 BLOWER,5-7WHEEL W1/2 BORE ASSY TVS0404
PM-06-0005 BLOWER,5-7WHEEL W1/2 BORE ASSY TVS0504
PM-06-0005 BLOWER,5-7WHEEL W1/2 BORE ASSY TVS0604
PM-06-0005 BLOWER,5-7WHEEL W1/2 BORE ASSY TVS0804
PM-06-0119 BLOWER ASSY,9-4T,CW,0.5,CV TVS0606
PM-06-0119 BLOWER ASSY,9-4T,CW,0.5,CV TVS0806
PM-06-0119 BLOWER ASSY,9-4T,CW,0.5,CV TVS1006
PM-06-0122 BLOWER ASSY,9-7T,CW,0.5,CV TVS0811
PM-06-0122 BLOWER ASSY,9-7T,CW,0.5,CV TVS1011
PM-06-0122 BLOWER ASSY,9-7T,CW,0.5,CV TVS1211
PM-06-0122 BLOWER ASSY,9-7T,CW,0.5,CV TVS1411
PM-06-0150 BLOWER, VFL 15 TVS1415
PM-06-0133 BLOWER ASSY,10-9T,CW,0.5,CV TVS1018
PM-06-0133 BLOWER ASSY,10-9T,CW,0.5,CV TVS1218
PM-06-0133 BLOWER ASSY,10-9T,CW,0.5,CV TVS1418
PM-06-0134 BLOWER ASSY,10-9R,CW,0.5,CV TVS1221
PM-06-0134 BLOWER ASSY,10-9R,CW,0.5,CV TVS1421
PM-06-0134 BLOWER ASSY,10-9R,CW,0.5,CV TVS1621
PM-06-0135 BLOWER ASSY,10-10T,CW,0.5,CV TVS1424
PM-06-0135 BLOWER ASSY,10-10T,CW,0.5,CV TVS1624
BLOWER WHEELS
PART # PRODUCT WHEEL SIZE LIST
PM-00-0010 TVS 0606, 0806, 1006, TCS 0506,0606,0806 9-4 Blower wheel
PM-00-0014 TVS 0811,1011,1211,1411,1611, TCS 0611,0811,1011 9-7 Blower wheel
PM-00-0018 TCS 0818,1018,1218,1230,1430,1630 9-9 Blower wheel
PM-00-0028 TCS 1224, 1424 10-9 Blower wheel
PM-00-0030 TCS 1021,1221,1421,1621, TVS 1221,1421,1621 10-10 Blower

wheel

Fan/Motor Assembly



©2014 Johnson Controls, Inc.

VAV Parts Price List

All List Prices Subject to Change Revision Date: February 2014

PNEUMATIC PARTS (SD & DD SEQUENCES)
Sequence Controller Controller Actuator Reversing Relay Diverting Relay Lower of 2 Pressures

Relay

Higher of 2 Pressures

Relay

Restrictor Tee
SD001R,

SD002R

PC-02-0006 & PC-

02-0002

SD003R PC-02-0006 & PC-

02-0002

SD004R PC-02-0006 & PC-

02-0002

SD404R PC-05-0049 B00-3510-322 PH-05-0016
SD405R PC-05-0059 B00-3510-322 PH-05-0016
SD406R PC-05-0049 B00-3510-322 PH-05-0016
SD407R PC-05-0059 B00-3510-322 PH-05-0016
SD408R PC-05-0049 B00-3510-322
SD409R PC-05-0059 B00-3510-322
SD410R PC-05-0049 B00-3510-322
SD411R PC-05-0059 B00-3510-322
SD412R PC-05-0049 B00-3510-322 PC-05-0080
SD413R PC-05-0059 B00-3510-322 PC-05-0080
SD414R,

SD420R, SD422R

PC-05-0049 B00-3510-322 PC-05-0030 PC-05-0080
SD415R, SD421R,

SD423R

PC-05-0059 B00-3510-322 PC-05-0030 PC-05-0080
SD428R PC-05-0049 PC-05-0049 B00-3510-322 PC-05-0075
SD429R PC-05-0059 PC-05-0059 B00-3510-322 PC-05-0075
SD430R PC-05-0049 PC-05-0049 B00-3510-322 PC-05-0030 PC-05-0075
SD431R PC-05-0059 PC-05-0059 B00-3510-322 PC-05-0030 PC-05-0075
SD432R PC-05-0049 B00-3510-322 PC-05-0030 PC-05-0070
SD433R PC-05-0059 B00-3510-322 PC-05-0030 PC-05-0020
SD434R PC-05-0049 B00-3510-322 PC-05-0030 PC-05-0070
SD435R PC-05-0059 B00-3510-322 PC-05-0030 PC-05-0020
SD448R,

SD450R

PC-05-0049 B00-3510-322
SD449R,

SD451R

PC-05-0059 B00-3510-322
SD452R PC-05-0049 PC-05-0049 B00-3510-322 PC-05-0080
SD453R PC-05-0059 PC-05-0059 B00-3510-322 PC-05-0080
SD454R PC-05-0049 PC-05-0049 B00-3510-322 PC-05-0030 PC-05-0080
SD455R PC-05-0059 PC-05-0059 B00-3510-322 PC-05-0030 PC-05-0080
SD456R,

SD459R

CSC3016 N/A B00-3510-322
SD457R,

SD458R

CSC3026 N/A B00-3510-322
DD401R,

DD403R

PC-05-0059 PC-05-0059 (2) B00-3510-322 PC-05-0030
DD402R,

DD404R

PC-05-0049 PC-05-0049 (2) B00-3510-322 PC-05-0030
DD405R,

DD407R

PC-05-0059 PC-05-0059 (2) B00-3510-322 PC-05-0030
DD406R,

DD408R

PC-05-0049 PC-05-0049 (2) B00-3510-322 PC-05-0030
DD409R,

DD412R

PC-05-0059 PC-05-0049 (2) B00-3510-322 PC-05-0030
DD410R,

DD411R

PC-05-0049 PC-05-0059 (2) B00-3510-322

PNEUMATIC PARTS (FV & FC SEQUENCES)

Seq. Controller Fan PE Switch Actuator AF Switch Reversing Relay Diverting Relay Lower of 2 Pressures

Relay

Higher of 2 Pressures

Relay

Restrictor Tee
FV401R PC-05-0059 M-21215-065 B00-3510-322
FV402R PC-05-0049 M-21215-065 B00-3510-322
FV403R PC-05-0059 M-21215-065 B00-3510-322 PC-05-0030
FV404R PC-05-0049 M-21215-065 B00-3510-322 PC-05-0030
FV405R PC-05-0059 M-21215-065 B00-3510-322 PC-05-0080
FV406R PC-05-0049 M-21215-065 B00-3510-322 PC-05-0080
FV407R PC-05-0059 M-21215-065 B00-3510-322 PC-05-0030 PC-05-0080
FV408R PC-05-0049 M-21215-065 B00-3510-322 PC-05-0030 PC-05-0080
FC401R PC-05-0059 B00-3510-322
FC402R PC-05-0049 B00-3510-322
FC403R PC-05-0059 B00-3510-322 PC-05-0030
FC404R PC-05-0049 B00-3510-322 PC-05-0030
FC405R PC-05-0059 M-21215-065 B00-3510-322 PC-03-0001
FC406R PC-05-0049 M-21215-065 B00-3510-322 PC-03-0001
FC407R PC-05-0059 M-21215-065 B00-3510-322 PC-03-0001 PC-05-0030
FC408R PC-05-0049 M-21215-065 B00-3510-322 PC-03-0001 PC-05-0030
FC409R PC-05-0059 M-21215-065 B00-3510-322
FC410R PC-05-0049 M-21215-065 B00-3510-322
FC411R PC-05-0059 M-21215-065 B00-3510-322 PC-05-0030
FC412R PC-05-0049 M-21215-065 B00-3510-322 PC-05-0030

©2014 Johnson Controls, Inc.

VAV Parts Price List

All List Prices Subject to Change Revision Date: February 2014

COILS

Model TSS-WC Coil Assembly


MODEL TSS COILS
Part Number Size Type Hand Access Door Rows Circuiting Fins per Inch Casing List
B01-04/06-201 4, 5, 6 HW ANY None 1 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-08-201 8 HW ANY None 1 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-10-202 10 HW ANY None 1 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-12-203 12 HW ANY None 1 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-14-204 14 HW ANY None 1 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-16-204 16 HW ANY None 1 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-19-204 19 HW ANY None 1 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-22-204 22 HW ANY None 1 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-04/06-205 4, 5, 6 HW ANY None 2 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-08-205 8 HW ANY None 2 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-10-206 10 HW ANY None 2 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-12-207 12 HW ANY None 2 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-14-208 14 HW ANY None 2 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-16-208 16 HW ANY None 2 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-19-208 19 HW ANY None 2 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-22-208 22 HW ANY None 2 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-04/06-209L 4, 5, 6 HW LH None 3 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-08-209L 8 HW LH None 3 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-10-210L 10 HW LH None 3 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-12-211L 12 HW LH None 3 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-14-212L 14 HW LH None 3 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-16-212L 16 HW LH None 3 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-19-212L 19 HW LH None 3 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-22-212L 22 HW LH None 3 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-04/06-213L 4, 5, 6 HW LH None 4 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-08-213L 8 HW LH None 4 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-10-214L 10 HW LH None 4 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-12-215L 12 HW LH None 4 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-14-216L 14 HW LH None 4 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-16-216L 16 HW LH None 4 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-19-216L 19 HW LH None 4 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-22-216L 22 HW LH None 4 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-04/06-209R 4, 5, 6 HW RH None 3 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-08-209R 8 HW RH None 3 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-10-210R 10 HW RH None 3 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-12-211R 12 HW RH None 3 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-14-212R 14 HW RH None 3 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-16-212R 16 HW RH None 3 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-19-212R 19 HW RH None 3 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-22-212R 22 HW RH None 3 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-04/06-213R 4, 5, 6 HW RH None 4 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-08-213R 8 HW RH None 4 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-10-214R 10 HW RH None 4 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-12-215R 12 HW RH None 4 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-14-216R 14 HW RH None 4 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-16-216R 16 HW RH None 4 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-19-216R 19 HW RH None 4 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-22-216R 22 HW RH None 4 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-04/06-217 4, 5, 6 HW ANY Std Access 1 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-08-217 8 HW ANY Std Access 1 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-10-218 10 HW ANY Std Access 1 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-12-219 12 HW ANY Std Access 1 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-14-220 14 HW ANY Std Access 1 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-16-220 16 HW ANY Std Access 1 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-19-220 19 HW ANY Std Access 1 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-22-220 22 HW ANY Std Access 1 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-04/06-221 4, 5, 6 HW ANY Std Access 2 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-08-221 8 HW ANY Std Access 2 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-10-222 10 HW ANY Std Access 2 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-12-223 12 HW ANY Std Access 2 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-14-224 14 HW ANY Std Access 2 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-16-224 16 HW ANY Std Access 2 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-19-224 19 HW ANY Std Access 2 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-22-224 22 HW ANY Std Access 2 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-04/06-225L 4, 5, 6 HW LH Std Access 3 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-08-225L 8 HW LH Std Access 3 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-10-226L 10 HW LH Std Access 3 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-12-227L 12 HW LH Std Access 3 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-14-228L 14 HW LH Std Access 3 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-16-228L 16 HW LH Std Access 3 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-19-228L 19 HW LH Std Access 3 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-22-228L 22 HW LH Std Access 3 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-04/06-229L 4, 5, 6 HW LH Std Access 4 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-08-229L 8 HW LH Std Access 4 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-10-230L 10 HW LH Std Access 4 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-12-231L 12 HW LH Std Access 4 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-14-232L 14 HW LH Std Access 4 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-16-232L 16 HW LH Std Access 4 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-19-232L 19 HW LH Std Access 4 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-22-232L 22 HW LH Std Access 4 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-04/06-225R 4, 5, 6 HW RH Std Access 3 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-08-225R 8 HW RH Std Access 3 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-10-226R 10 HW RH Std Access 3 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-12-227R 12 HW RH Std Access 3 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-14-228R 14 HW RH Std Access 3 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-16-228R 16 HW RH Std Access 3 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-19-228R 19 HW RH Std Access 3 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-22-228R 22 HW RH Std Access 3 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-04/06-229R 4, 5, 6 HW RH Std Access 4 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-08-229R 8 HW RH Std Access 4 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-10-230R 10 HW RH Std Access 4 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-12-231R 12 HW RH Std Access 4 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-14-232R 14 HW RH Std Access 4 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-16-232R 16 HW RH Std Access 4 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-19-232R 19 HW RH Std Access 4 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-22-232R 22 HW RH Std Access 4 Single 10 Galvanized
B01-04/06-301 4, 5, 6 HW ANY None 1 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-08-301 8 HW ANY None 1 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-10-302 10 HW ANY None 1 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-12-303 12 HW ANY None 1 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-14-304 14 HW ANY None 1 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-16-304 16 HW ANY None 1 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-19-304 19 HW ANY None 1 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-22-304 22 HW ANY None 1 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-04/06-305L 4, 5, 6 HW LH None 2 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-08-305L 8 HW LH None 2 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-10-306L 10 HW LH None 2 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-12-307L 12 HW LH None 2 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-14-308L 14 HW LH None 2 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-16-308L 16 HW LH None 2 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-19-308L 19 HW LH None 2 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-22-308L 22 HW LH None 2 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-04/06-309L 4, 5, 6 HW LH None 3 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-08-309L 8 HW LH None 3 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-10-310L 10 HW LH None 3 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-12-311L 12 HW LH None 3 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-14-312L 14 HW LH None 3 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-16-312L 16 HW LH None 3 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-19-312L 19 HW LH None 3 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-22-312L 22 HW LH None 3 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-04/06-313L 4, 5, 6 HW LH None 4 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-08-313L 8 HW LH None 4 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-10-314L 10 HW LH None 4 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-12-315L 12 HW LH None 4 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-14-316L 14 HW LH None 4 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-16-316L 16 HW LH None 4 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-19-316L 19 HW LH None 4 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-22-316L 22 HW LH None 4 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-04/06-305R 4, 5, 6 HW RH None 2 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-08-305R 8 HW RH None 2 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-10-306R 10 HW RH None 2 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-12-307R 12 HW RH None 2 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-14-308R 14 HW RH None 2 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-16-308R 16 HW RH None 2 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-19-308R 19 HW RH None 2 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-22-308R 22 HW RH None 2 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-04/06-309R 4, 5, 6 HW RH None 3 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-08-309R 8 HW RH None 3 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-10-310R 10 HW RH None 3 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-12-311R 12 HW RH None 3 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-14-312R 14 HW RH None 3 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-16-312R 16 HW RH None 3 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-19-312R 19 HW RH None 3 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-22-312R 22 HW RH None 3 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-04/06-313R 4, 5, 6 HW RH None 4 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-08-313R 8 HW RH None 4 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-10-314R 10 HW RH None 4 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-12-315R 12 HW RH None 4 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-14-316R 14 HW RH None 4 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-16-316R 16 HW RH None 4 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-19-316R 19 HW RH None 4 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-22-316R 22 HW RH None 4 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-04/06-317 4, 5, 6 HW ANY Std Access 1 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-08-317 8 HW ANY Std Access 1 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-10-318 10 HW ANY Std Access 1 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-12-319 12 HW ANY Std Access 1 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-14-320 14 HW ANY Std Access 1 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-16-320 16 HW ANY Std Access 1 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-19-320 19 HW ANY Std Access 1 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-22-320 22 HW ANY Std Access 1 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-04/06-321L 4, 5, 6 HW LH Std Access 2 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-08-321L 8 HW LH Std Access 2 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-10-322L 10 HW LH Std Access 2 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-12-323L 12 HW LH Std Access 2 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-14-324L 14 HW LH Std Access 2 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-16-324L 16 HW LH Std Access 2 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-19-324L 19 HW LH Std Access 2 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-22-324L 22 HW LH Std Access 2 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-04/06-325L 4, 5, 6 HW LH Std Access 3 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-08-325L 8 HW LH Std Access 3 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-10-326L 10 HW LH Std Access 3 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-12-327L 12 HW LH Std Access 3 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-14-328L 14 HW LH Std Access 3 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-16-328L 16 HW LH Std Access 3 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-19-328L 19 HW LH Std Access 3 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-22-328L 22 HW LH Std Access 3 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-04/06-329L 4, 5, 6 HW LH Std Access 4 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-08-329L 8 HW LH Std Access 4 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-10-330L 10 HW LH Std Access 4 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-12-331L 12 HW LH Std Access 4 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-14-332L 14 HW LH Std Access 4 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-16-332L 16 HW LH Std Access 4 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-19-332L 19 HW LH Std Access 4 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-22-332L 22 HW LH Std Access 4 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-04/06-321R 4, 5, 6 HW RH Std Access 2 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-08-321R 8 HW RH Std Access 2 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-10-322R 10 HW RH Std Access 2 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-12-323R 12 HW RH Std Access 2 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-14-324R 14 HW RH Std Access 2 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-16-324R 16 HW RH Std Access 2 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-19-324R 19 HW RH Std Access 2 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-22-324R 22 HW RH Std Access 2 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-04/06-325R 4, 5, 6 HW RH Std Access 3 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-08-325R 8 HW RH Std Access 3 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-10-326R 10 HW RH Std Access 3 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-12-327R 12 HW RH Std Access 3 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-14-328R 14 HW RH Std Access 3 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-16-328R 16 HW RH Std Access 3 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-19-328R 19 HW RH Std Access 3 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-22-328R 22 HW RH Std Access 3 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-04/06-329R 4, 5, 6 HW RH Std Access 4 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-08-329R 8 HW RH Std Access 4 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-10-330R 10 HW RH Std Access 4 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-12-331R 12 HW RH Std Access 4 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-14-332R 14 HW RH Std Access 4 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-16-332R 16 HW RH Std Access 4 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-19-332R 19 HW RH Std Access 4 Double 10 Galvanized
B01-22-332R 22 HW RH Std Access 4 Double 10 Galvanized
MODEL TCS COILS
Part Number Size Type Hand Access Door Rows Circuiting Fins per Inch Casing List
33-20001-01 0404, 0504, 0604 HW ANY Std Access 1 Single 10 Galvanized
33-20002-01 0404, 0504, 0604 HW ANY Std Access 2 Single 10 Galvanized
33-20003-01 0404, 0504, 0604 HW ANY Std Access 3 Single 10 Galvanized
33-20004-01 0404, 0504, 0604 HW ANY Std Access 4 Single 10 Galvanized
33-20116-01 0506, 0606, 0806,

0611, 0811, 1011

HW LH Std Access 1 Single 10 Galvanized
33-20117-01 0506, 0606, 0806,

0611, 0811, 1011

HW RH Std Access 1 Single 10 Galvanized
33-20118-01 0506, 0606, 0806,

0611, 0811, 1011

HW LH Std Access 2 Single 10 Galvanized
33-20119-01 0506, 0606, 0806,

0611, 0811, 1011

HW RH Std Access 2 Single 10 Galvanized
33-20120-01 0506, 0606, 0806,

0611, 0811, 1011

HW LH Std Access 3 Single 10 Galvanized
33-20121-01 0506, 0606, 0806,

0611, 0811, 1011

HW RH Std Access 3 Single 10 Galvanized
33-20122-01 0506, 0606, 0806,

0611, 0811, 1011

HW LH Std Access 4 Single 10 Galvanized
33-20122-01 0506, 0606, 0806,

0611, 0811, 1011

HW RH Std Access 4 Single 10 Galvanized
33-20131-01 0817, 1017, 1217,

0819, 1019, 1219

HW LH Std Access 1 Single 10 Galvanized
33-20132-01 0817, 1017, 1217,

0819, 1019, 1219

HW RH Std Access 1 Single 10 Galvanized
33-20133-01 0817, 1017, 1217,

0819, 1019, 1219

HW LH Std Access 2 Single 10 Galvanized
33-20134-01 0817, 1017, 1217,

0819, 1019, 1219

HW RH Std Access 2 Single 10 Galvanized
33-20135-01 0817, 1017, 1217,

0819, 1019, 1219

HW LH Std Access 3 Single 10 Galvanized
33-20136-01 0817, 1017, 1217,

0819, 1019, 1219

HW RH Std Access 3 Single 10 Galvanized
33-20137-01 0817, 1017, 1217,

0819, 1019, 1219

HW LH Std Access 4 Single 10 Galvanized
33-20137-01 0817, 1017, 1217,

0819, 1019, 1219

HW RH Std Access 4 Single 10 Galvanized
33-20131-01 0818, 1018, 1218,

1021, 1221, 1421

HW LH Std Access 1 Single 10 Galvanized
33-20132-01 0818, 1018, 1218,

1021, 1221, 1421

HW RH Std Access 1 Single 10 Galvanized
33-20133-01 0818, 1018, 1218,

1021, 1221, 1421

HW LH Std Access 2 Single 10 Galvanized
33-20134-01 0818, 1018, 1218,

1021, 1221, 1421

HW RH Std Access 2 Single 10 Galvanized
33-20135-01 0818, 1018, 1218,

1021, 1221, 1421

HW LH Std Access 3 Single 10 Galvanized
33-20136-01 0818, 1018, 1218,

1021, 1221, 1421

HW RH Std Access 3 Single 10 Galvanized
33-20137-01 0818, 1018, 1218,

1021, 1221, 1421

HW LH Std Access 4 Single 10 Galvanized
33-20137-01 0818, 1018, 1218,

1021, 1221, 1421

HW RH Std Access 4 Single 10 Galvanized
33-20146-01 1224, 1424 HW LH Std Access 1 Single 10 Galvanized
33-20147-01 1224, 1424 HW RH Std Access 1 Single 10 Galvanized
33-20148-01 1224, 1424 HW LH Std Access 2 Single 10 Galvanized
33-20149-01 1224, 1424 HW RH Std Access 2 Single 10 Galvanized
33-20150-01 1224, 1424 HW LH Std Access 3 Single 10 Galvanized
33-20151-01 1224, 1424 HW RH Std Access 3 Single 10 Galvanized
33-20152-01 1224, 1424 HW LH Std Access 4 Single 10 Galvanized
33-20152-01 1224, 1424 HW RH Std Access 4 Single 10 Galvanized
33-20161-01 1230, 1430, 1630,

1440, 1640

HW LH None 1 Single 10 Galvanized
33-20162-01 1230, 1430, 1630,

1440, 1640

HW RH None 1 Single 10 Galvanized
33-20163-01 1230, 1430, 1630,

1440, 1640

HW LH None 2 Single 10 Galvanized
33-20164-01 1230, 1430, 1630,

1440, 1640

HW RH None 2 Single 10 Galvanized
33-20165-01 1230, 1430, 1630,

1440, 1640

HW LH None 3 Single 10 Galvanized
33-20166-01 1230, 1430, 1630,

1440, 1640

HW RH None 3 Single 10 Galvanized
33-20167-01 1230, 1430, 1630,

1440, 1640

HW LH None 4 Single 10 Galvanized
33-20167-01 1230, 1430, 1630,

1440, 1640

HW RH None 4 Single 10 Galvanized
33-20176-01 1644, 1844 HW LH None 1 Single 10 Galvanized
33-20177-01 1644, 1844 HW RH None 1 Single 10 Galvanized
33-20178-01 1644, 1844 HW LH None 2 Single 10 Galvanized
33-20178-01 1644, 1844 HW RH None 2 Single 10 Galvanized
33-20179-01 1644, 1844 HW LH None 3 Single 10 Galvanized
33-20179-01 1644, 1844 HW RH None 3 Single 10 Galvanized
33-20180-01 1644, 1844 HW LH None 4 Single 10 Galvanized
33-20180-01 1644, 1844 HW RH None 4 Single 10 Galvanized
33-20006-01 0404, 0504, 0604 HW ANY Std Access 1 Double 10 Galvanized
33-20007-01 0404, 0504, 0604 HW LH Std Access 2 Double 10 Galvanized
33-20008-01 0404, 0504, 0604 HW RH Std Access 2 Double 10 Galvanized
33-20009-01 0404, 0504, 0604 HW LH Std Access 3 Double 10 Galvanized
33-20010-01 0404, 0504, 0604 HW RH Std Access 3 Double 10 Galvanized
33-20011-01 0404, 0504, 0604 HW LH Std Access 4 Double 10 Galvanized
33-20012-01 0404, 0504, 0604 HW RH Std Access 4 Double 10 Galvanized
33-20123-01 0506, 0606, 0806,

0611, 0811, 1011

HW LH Std Access 1 Double 10 Galvanized
33-20124-01 0506, 0606, 0806,

0611, 0811, 1011

HW RH Std Access 1 Double 10 Galvanized
33-20125-01 0506, 0606, 0806,

0611, 0811, 1011

HW LH Std Access 2 Double 10 Galvanized
33-20126-01 0506, 0606, 0806,

0611, 0811, 1011

HW RH Std Access 2 Double 10 Galvanized
33-20127-01 0506, 0606, 0806,

0611, 0811, 1011

HW LH Std Access 3 Double 10 Galvanized
33-20128-01 0506, 0606, 0806,

0611, 0811, 1011

HW RH Std Access 3 Double 10 Galvanized
33-20129-01 0506, 0606, 0806,

0611, 0811, 1011

HW LH Std Access 4 Double 10 Galvanized
33-20130-01 0506, 0606, 0806,

0611, 0811, 1011

HW RH Std Access 4 Double 10 Galvanized
33-20138-01 0817, 1017, 1217,

0819, 1019, 1219

HW LH Std Access 1 Double 10 Galvanized
33-20139-01 0817, 1017, 1217,

0819, 1019, 1219

HW RH Std Access 1 Double 10 Galvanized
33-20140-01 0817, 1017, 1217,

0819, 1019, 1219

HW LH Std Access 2 Double 10 Galvanized
33-20141-01 0817, 1017, 1217,

0819, 1019, 1219

HW RH Std Access 2 Double 10 Galvanized
33-20142-01 0817, 1017, 1217,

0819, 1019, 1219

HW LH Std Access 3 Double 10 Galvanized
33-20143-01 0817, 1017, 1217,

0819, 1019, 1219

HW RH Std Access 3 Double 10 Galvanized
33-20144-01 0817, 1017, 1217,

0819, 1019, 1219

HW LH Std Access 4 Double 10 Galvanized
33-20145-01 0817, 1017, 1217,

0819, 1019, 1219

HW RH Std Access 4 Double 10 Galvanized
33-20138-01 0818, 1018, 1218,

1021, 1221, 1421

HW LH Std Access 1 Double 10 Galvanized
33-20139-01 0818, 1018, 1218,

1021, 1221, 1421

HW RH Std Access 1 Double 10 Galvanized
33-20140-01 0818, 1018, 1218,

1021, 1221, 1421

HW LH Std Access 2 Double 10 Galvanized
33-20141-01 0818, 1018, 1218,

1021, 1221, 1421

HW RH Std Access 2 Double 10 Galvanized
33-20142-01 0818, 1018, 1218,

1021, 1221, 1421

HW LH Std Access 3 Double 10 Galvanized
33-20143-01 0818, 1018, 1218,

1021, 1221, 1421

HW RH Std Access 3 Double 10 Galvanized
33-20144-01 0818, 1018, 1218,

1021, 1221, 1421

HW LH Std Access 4 Double 10 Galvanized
33-20145-01 0818, 1018, 1218,

1021, 1221, 1421

HW RH Std Access 4 Double 10 Galvanized
33-20153-01 1224, 1424 HW LH Std Access 1 Double 10 Galvanized
33-20154-01 1224, 1424 HW RH Std Access 1 Double 10 Galvanized
33-20155-01 1224, 1424 HW LH Std Access 2 Double 10 Galvanized
33-20156-01 1224, 1424 HW RH Std Access 2 Double 10 Galvanized
33-20157-01 1224, 1424 HW LH Std Access 3 Double 10 Galvanized
33-20158-01 1224, 1424 HW RH Std Access 3 Double 10 Galvanized
33-20159-01 1224, 1424 HW LH Std Access 4 Double 10 Galvanized
33-20160-01 1224, 1424 HW RH Std Access 4 Double 10 Galvanized
33-20168-01 1230, 1430, 1630,

1440, 1640

HW LH None 1 Double 10 Galvanized
33-20169-01 1230, 1430, 1630,

1440, 1640

HW RH None 1 Double 10 Galvanized
33-20170-01 1230, 1430, 1630,

1440, 1640

HW LH None 2 Double 10 Galvanized
33-20171-01 1230, 1430, 1630,

1440, 1640

HW RH None 2 Double 10 Galvanized
33-20172-01 1230, 1430, 1630,

1440, 1640

HW LH None 3 Double 10 Galvanized
33-20173-01 1230, 1430, 1630,

1440, 1640

HW RH None 3 Double 10 Galvanized
33-20174-01 1230, 1430, 1630,

1440, 1640

HW LH None 4 Double 10 Galvanized
33-20175-01 1230, 1430, 1630,

1440, 1640

HW RH None 4 Double 10 Galvanized
33-20181-01 1644, 1844 HW LH None 1 Double 10 Galvanized
33-20182-01 1644, 1844 HW RH None 1 Double 10 Galvanized
33-20183-01 1644, 1844 HW LH None 2 Double 10 Galvanized
33-20184-01 1644, 1844 HW RH None 2 Double 10 Galvanized
33-20185-01 1644, 1844 HW LH None 3 Double 10 Galvanized
33-20186-01 1644, 1844 HW RH None 3 Double 10 Galvanized
33-20187-01 1644, 1844 HW LH None 4 Double 10 Galvanized
33-20188-01 1644, 1844 HW RH None 4 Double 10 Galvanized

Model TVS Water Coil & Electric Heat Filter Assembly

TVS-WC

MODEL TVS COILS
Part Number Size Type Hand Access Door Rows Circuiting Fins per Inch Casing List
B07-2000-BG 0404, 0504, 0604,

0606, 0804, 0806,

0811

HW Any None 1 Single 10 Galvanized
B07-2020-BG 1006, 1011, 1018,

1211, 1218, 1221

HW Any None 1 Single 10 Galvanized
B07-2040-BG 1411, 1418, 1421,

1424, 1621, 1624

HW Any None 1 Single 10 Galvanized
B07-2001-BG 0404, 0504, 0604,

0606, 0804, 0806,

0811

HW Any None 2 Single 10 Galvanized
B07-2021-BG 1006, 1011, 1018,

1211, 1218, 1221

HW Any None 2 Single 10 Galvanized
B07-2041-BG 1411, 1418, 1421,

1424, 1621, 1624

HW Any None 2 Single 10 Galvanized
B07-2002L-BG 0404, 0504, 0604,

0606, 0804, 0806,

0811

HW LH None 3 Single 10 Galvanized
B07-2002R-BG 0404, 0504, 0604,

0606, 0804, 0806,

0811

HW RH None 3 Single 10 Galvanized
B07-2022L-BG 1006, 1011, 1018,

1211, 1218, 1221

HW LH None 3 Single 10 Galvanized
B07-2022R-BG 1006, 1011, 1018,

1211, 1218, 1221

HW RH None 3 Single 10 Galvanized
B07-2042L-BG 1411, 1418, 1421,

1424, 1621, 1624

HW LH None 3 Single 10 Galvanized
B07-2042R-BG 1411, 1418, 1421,

1424, 1621, 1624

HW RH None 3 Single 10 Galvanized
B07-2003L-BG 0404, 0504, 0604,

0606, 0804, 0806,

0811

HW LH None 4 Single 10 Galvanized
B07-2003R-BG 0404, 0504, 0604,

0606, 0804, 0806,

0811

HW RH None 4 Single 10 Galvanized
B07-2023L-BG 1006, 1011, 1018,

1211, 1218, 1221

HW LH None 4 Single 10 Galvanized
B07-2023R-BG 1006, 1011, 1018,

1211, 1218, 1221

HW RH None 4 Single 10 Galvanized
B07-2043L-BG 1411, 1418, 1421,

1424, 1621, 1624

HW LH None 4 Single 10 Galvanized
B07-2043R-BG 1411, 1418, 1421,

1424, 1621, 1624

HW RH None 4 Single 10 Galvanized
B07-2010-BG 0404, 0504, 0604,

0606, 0804, 0806,

0811

HW Any None 1 Double 10 Galvanized
B07-2030-BG 1006, 1011, 1018,

1211, 1218, 1221

HW Any None 1 Double 10 Galvanized
B07-2050-BG 1411, 1418, 1421,

1424, 1621, 1624

HW Any None 1 Double 10 Galvanized
B07-2011L-BG 0404, 0504, 0604,

0606, 0804, 0806,

0811

HW LH None 2 Double 10 Galvanized
B07-2011R-BG 0404, 0504, 0604,

0606, 0804, 0806,

0811

HW RH None 2 Double 10 Galvanized
B07-2031L-BG 1006, 1011, 1018,

1211, 1218, 1221

HW LH None 2 Double 10 Galvanized
B07-2031R-BG 1006, 1011, 1018,

1211, 1218, 1221

HW RH None 2 Double 10 Galvanized
B07-2051L-BG 1411, 1418, 1421,

1424, 1621, 1624

HW LH None 2 Double 10 Galvanized
B07-2051R-BG 1411, 1418, 1421,

1424, 1621, 1624

HW RH None 2 Double 10 Galvanized
B07-2012L-BG 0404, 0504, 0604,

0606, 0804, 0806,

0811

HW LH None 3 Double 10 Galvanized
B07-2012R-BG 0404, 0504, 0604,

0606, 0804, 0806,

0811

HW RH None 3 Double 10 Galvanized
B07-2032L-BG 1006, 1011, 1018,

1211, 1218, 1221

HW LH None 3 Double 10 Galvanized
B07-2032R-BG 1006, 1011, 1018,

1211, 1218, 1221

HW RH None 3 Double 10 Galvanized
B07-2052L-BG 1411, 1418, 1421,

1424, 1621, 1624

HW LH None 3 Double 10 Galvanized
B07-2052R-BG 1411, 1418, 1421,

1424, 1621, 1624

HW RH None 3 Double 10 Galvanized
B07-2013L-BG 0404, 0504, 0604,

0606, 0804, 0806,

0811

HW LH None 4 Double 10 Galvanized
B07-2013R-BG 0404, 0504, 0604,

0606, 0804, 0806,

0811

HW RH None 4 Double 10 Galvanized
B07-2033L-BG 1006, 1011, 1018,

1211, 1218, 1221

HW LH None 4 Double 10 Galvanized
B07-2033R-BG 1006, 1011, 1018,

1211, 1218, 1221

HW RH None 4 Double 10 Galvanized
B07-2053L-BG 1411, 1418, 1421,

1424, 1621, 1624

HW LH None 4 Double 10 Galvanized
B07-2053R-BG 1411, 1418, 1421,

1424, 1621, 1624

HW RH None 4 Double 10 Galvanized
B07-5000L-BG 0404, 0504, 0604,

0606, 0804, 0806,

0811

Steam LH None 1 N/A 10 Galvanized
B07-5000R-BG 0404, 0504, 0604,

0606, 0804, 0806,

0811

Steam RH None 1 N/A 10 Galvanized
B07-5010L-BG 1006, 1011, 1018,

1211, 1218, 1221

Steam LH None 1 N/A 10 Galvanized
B07-5010R-BG 1006, 1011, 1018,

1211, 1218, 1221

Steam RH None 1 N/A 10 Galvanized
B07-5020L-BG 1411, 1418, 1421,

1424, 1621, 1624

Steam LH None 1 N/A 10 Galvanized
B07-5020R-BG 1411, 1418, 1421,

1424, 1621, 1624

Steam RH None 1 N/A 10 Galvanized
B07-5001L-BG 0404, 0504, 0604,

0606, 0804, 0806,

0811

Steam LH None 2 N/A 10 Galvanized
B07-5001R-BG 0404, 0504, 0604,

0606, 0804, 0806,

0811

Steam RH None 2 N/A 10 Galvanized
B07-5011L-BG 1006, 1011, 1018,

1211, 1218, 1221

Steam LH None 2 N/A 10 Galvanized
B07-5011R-BG 1006, 1011, 1018,

1211, 1218, 1221

Steam RH None 2 N/A 10 Galvanized
B07-5021L-BG 1411, 1418, 1421,

1424, 1621, 1624

Steam LH None 2 N/A 10 Galvanized
B07-5021R-BG 1411, 1418, 1421,

1424, 1621, 1624

Steam RH None 2 N/A 10 Galvanized

Notes:

    1. Contact Factory for AFT, TCL & TVL replacement coils.

©2014 Johnson Controls, Inc.

VAV Parts Price List

All List Prices Subject to Change Revision Date: February 2014

Model TCS & TVS PSC Motors

Capacitor (Purchase Separately)

TCS, TVS, AFT, TCL & TVL MOTOR SELECTION: PERMANENT SPLIT CAPACITOR (PSC)
Product UNIT SIZE QTY. / UNIT VOLTAGE PSC Motor HP PSC Motor Part # List Price Each Capacitor Part # Capacitor List Price Each
TCS 0404, 0504, 0604 1 115 1/12 PM-02-1501 PE-12-0501 5 MFD
TCS 0506, 0606, 0806 1 115 1/6 PM-02-0026 PE-12-0500 4 MFD
TCS 0611, 0811, 1011 1 115 1/4 PM-02-0046 PE-12-0500 4 MFD
TCS 0817, 1017, 1217 1 115 1/2 PM-02-0068 PE-12-0503 7.5 MFD
TCS 0818, 1018, 1218 1 115 1/2 PM-02-0068 PE-12-0503 7.5 MFD
TCS 0819, 1019, 1219 1 115 3/4 PM-02-0098 PE-12-0504 10 MFD
TCS 1021, 1221, 1421 1 115 3/4 PM-02-0098 PE-12-0504 10 MFD
TCS 1224, 1424 1 115 1 PM-02-0124 PE-12-0506 15 MFD
TCS 1230, 1430, 1630 2 115 1/2 PM-02-0068 PE-12-0503 7.5 MFD
TCS 1440, 1640 2 115 3/4 PM-02-0098 PE-12-0504 10 MFD
TCS 1644, 1844 2 115 1 PM-02-0124 PE-12-0506 15 MFD
TCS 0404, 0504, 0604 1 208 1/12 PM-02-1502 PE-12-0501 5 MFD
TCS 0506, 0606, 0806 1 208 1/6 PM-02-0030 PE-12-0500 4 MFD
TCS 0611, 0811, 1011 1 208 1/4 PM-02-0051 PE-12-0500 4 MFD
TCS 0817, 1017, 1217 1 208 1/2 PM-02-0072
TCS 0818, 1018, 1218 1 208 1/2 PM-02-0072
TCS 0819, 1019, 1219 1 208 3/4 PM-02-0104
TCS 1021, 1221, 1421 1 208 3/4 PM-02-0104
TCS 1224, 1424 1 208 1 PM-02-0126
TCS 1230, 1430, 1630 2 208 1/2 PM-02-0072
TCS 1440, 1640 2 208 3/4 PM-02-0104
TCS 1644, 1844 2 208 1 PM-02-0126
TCS 0404, 0504, 0604 1 220 1/12 PM-02-1502
TCS 0506, 0606, 0806 1 220 1/6 PM-02-1338
TCS 0611, 0811, 1011 1 220 1/4 PM-02-1339
TCS 0817, 1017, 1217 1 220 1/2 PM-02-1340
TCS 0818, 1018, 1218 1 220 1/2 PM-02-1340
TCS 0819, 1019, 1219 1 220 3/4 PM-02-1341
TCS 1021, 1221, 1421 1 220 3/4 PM-02-1341
TCS 1224, 1424 1 220 1 PM-02-1342
TCS 1230, 1430, 1630 2 220 1/2 PM-02-1340
TCS 1440, 1640 2 220 3/4 PM-02-1341
TCS 1644, 1844 2 220 1 PM-02-1342
TCS 0404, 0504, 0604 1 230 1/12 PM-02-1502
TCS 0506, 0606, 0806 1 230 1/6 PM-02-0030
TCS 0611, 0811, 1011 1 230 1/4 PM-02-0051
TCS 0817, 1017, 1217 1 230 1/2 PM-02-0072
TCS 0818, 1018, 1218 1 230 1/2 PM-02-0072
TCS 0819, 1019, 1219 1 230 3/4 PM-02-0104
TCS 1021, 1221, 1421 1 230 3/4 PM-02-0104
TCS 1224, 1424 1 230 1 PM-02-0126
TCS 1230, 1430, 1630 2 230 1/2 PM-02-0072
TCS 1440, 1640 2 230 3/4 PM-02-0104
TCS 1644, 1844 2 230 1 PM-02-0126
TCS 0404, 0504, 0604 1 277 1/12 PM-02-1503
PE-12-0503 7.5 MFD
PE-12-0503 7.5 MFD
PE-12-0504 10 MFD
PE-12-0504 10 MFD
PE-12-0508 20 MFD
PE-12-0503 7.5 MFD
PE-12-0504 10 MFD
PE-12-0508 20 MFD
PE-12-0501 5 MFD
PE-12-0502 6 MFD
PE-12-0503 7.5 MFD
PE-12-0504 10 MFD
PE-12-0504 10 MFD
PE-12-0505 12.5 MFD
PE-12-0505 12.5 MFD
PE-12-0508 20 MFD
PE-12-0504 10 MFD
PE-12-0505 12.5 MFD
PE-12-0508 20 MFD
PE-12-0501 5 MFD
PE-12-0500 4 MFD
PE-12-0500 4 MFD
PE-12-0503 7.5 MFD
PE-12-0503 7.5 MFD
PE-12-0504 10 MFD
PE-12-0504 10 MFD
PE-12-0508 20 MFD
PE-12-0503 7.5 MFD
PE-12-0504 10 MFD
PE-12-0508 20 MFD
PE-12-0509 3 MFD
TCS 0506, 0606, 0806 1 277 1/6 PM-02-0032
TCS 0606, 0806 1 277 1/6 PM-02-0032
TCS 0611, 0811, 1011 1 277 1/4 PM-02-0052
TCS 0817, 1017, 1217 1 277 1/2 PM-02-0076
TCS 0818, 1018, 1218 1 277 1/2 PM-02-0076
TCS 0819, 1019, 1219 1 277 3/4 PM-02-0106
TCS 1021, 1221, 1421 1 277 3/4 PM-02-0106
TCS 1224, 1424 1 277 1 PM-02-0128
TCS 1230, 1430, 1630 2 277 1/2 PM-02-0076
TCS 1440, 1640 2 277 3/4 PM-02-0106
TCS 1644, 1844 2 277 1 PM-02-0128
TCS 0506, 0606, 0806 1 480 1/4 PM-02-0056
TCS 0611, 0811, 1011 1 480 1/4 PM-02-0056
TCS 0817, 1017, 1217 1 480 1/2 PM-02-0086
TCS 0818, 1018, 1218 1 480 1/2 PM-02-0086
TCS 0819, 1019, 1219 1 480 3/4 PM-02-0116
TCS 1021, 1221, 1421 1 480 3/4 PM-02-0116
TCS 1230, 1430, 1630 2 480 1/2 PM-02-0086
TCS 1440, 1640 2 480 3/4 PM-02-0116
TCSQ 0606, 0806 1 115 1/6 PM-02-0026
TCSQ 0611, 0811, 1011 1 115 1/4 PM-02-0046
TCSQ 0817, 1017, 1217 1 115 1/2 PM-02-0068
TCSQ 0819, 1019, 1219 1 115 3/4 PM-02-0098
TCSQ 1021, 1221, 1421,

1224, 1424

1 115 1 PM-02-0124
TCSQ 1230, 1430, 1630 2 115 1/2 PM-02-0068
TCSQ 0606, 0806 1 208 1/6 PM-02-0030
TCSQ 0611, 0811, 1011 1 208 1/4 PM-02-0051
TCSQ 0817, 1017, 1217 1 208 1/2 PM-02-0072
TCSQ 0819, 1019, 1219 1 208 3/4 PM-02-0104
TCSQ 1021, 1221, 1421,

1224, 1424

1 208 1 PM-02-0126
TCSQ 1230, 1430, 1630 2 208 1/2 PM-02-0072
PE-12-0502 6 MFD
PE-12-0502 6 MFD
PE-12-0500 4 MFD
PE-12-0503 7.5 MFD
PE-12-0503 7.5 MFD
PE-12-0504 10 MFD
PE-12-0504 10 MFD
PE-12-0506 15 MFD
PE-12-0503 7.5 MFD
PE-12-0504 10 MFD
PE-12-0506 15 MFD
PE-12-0500 4 MFD
PE-12-0500 4 MFD
PE-12-0503 7.5 MFD
PE-12-0503 7.5 MFD
PE-12-0504 10 MFD
PE-12-0504 10 MFD
PE-12-0503 7.5 MFD
PE-12-0504 10 MFD
PE-12-0500 4 MFD
PE-12-0500 4 MFD
PE-12-0503 7.5 MFD
PE-12-0504 10 MFD
PE-12-0506 15 MFD
PE-12-0503 7.5 MFD
PE-12-0500 4 MFD
PE-12-0500 4 MFD
PE-12-0503 7.5 MFD
PE-12-0504 10 MFD
PE-12-0508 20 MFD
PE-12-0503 7.5 MFD
TCSQ 0606, 0806 1 220 1/6 PM-02-1338
TCSQ 0611, 0811, 1011 1 220 1/4 PM-02-1339
TCSQ 0817, 1017, 1217 1 220 1/2 PM-02-1340
TCSQ 0819, 1019, 1219 1 220 3/4 PM-02-1341
TCSQ 1021, 1221, 1421,

1224, 1424

1 220 1 PM-02-1342
TCSQ 1230, 1430, 1630 2 220 1/2 PM-02-1340
TCSQ 0606, 0806 1 230 1/6 PM-02-0030
TCSQ 0817, 1017, 1217 1 230 1/2 PM-02-0072
TCSQ 0819, 1019, 1219 1 230 3/4 PM-02-0104
TCSQ 1021, 1221, 1421,

1224, 1424

1 230 1 PM-02-0126
TCSQ 1230, 1430, 1630 2 230 1/2 PM-02-0072
TCSQ 0606, 0806 1 277 1/6 PM-02-0032
TCSQ 0611, 0811, 1011 1 277 1/4 PM-02-0052
TCSQ 0817, 1017, 1217 1 277 1/2 PM-02-0076
TCSQ 0819, 1019, 1219 1 277 3/4 PM-02-0106
TCSQ 1021, 1221, 1421,

1224, 1424

1 277 1 PM-02-0128
TCSQ 1230, 1430, 1630 2 277 1/2 PM-02-0076
TCSQ 0611, 0811, 1011 1 480 1/4 PM-02-0056
TCSQ 0817, 1017, 1217 1 480 1/2 PM-02-0086
TCSQ 0819, 1019, 1219 1 480 3/4 PM-02-0116
TCSQ 1230, 1430, 1630 2 480 1/2 PM-02-0086
TVS 0404, 0504, 0604,

0804

1 115 1/12 PM-02-1501
TVS 0606, 0806, 1006 1 115 1/6 PM-02-0026
TVS 0811, 1011, 1211,

1411

1 115 1/4 PM-02-0046
TVS 1018, 1218, 1418 1 115 1/2 PM-02-0068
TVS 1221, 1421, 1621 1 115 3/4 PM-02-0098
TVS 1424, 1624 1 115 1 PM-02-0124
TVS 0404, 0504, 0604,

0804

1 208 1/12 PM-02-1502
TVS 0606, 0806, 1006 1 208 1/6 PM-02-0030
TVS 0811, 1011, 1211,

1411

1 208 1/4 PM-02-0051
TVS 1018, 1218, 1418 1 208 1/2 PM-02-0072
PE-12-0502 6 MFD
PE-12-0503 7.5 MFD
PE-12-0504 10 MFD
PE-12-0505 12.5 MFD
PE-12-0508 20 MFD
PE-12-0504 10 MFD
PE-12-0500 4 MFD
PE-12-0503 7.5 MFD
PE-12-0504 10 MFD
PE-12-0508 20 MFD
PE-12-0503 7.5 MFD
PE-12-0502 6 MFD
PE-12-0500 4 MFD
PE-12-0503 7.5 MFD
PE-12-0504 10 MFD
PE-12-0506 15 MFD
PE-12-0503 7.5 MFD
PE-12-0500 4 MFD
PE-12-0503 7.5 MFD
PE-12-0504 10 MFD
PE-12-0503 7.5 MFD
PE-12-0501 5 MFD
PE-12-0500 4 MFD
PE-12-0500 4 MFD
PE-12-0503 7.5 MFD
PE-12-0504 10 MFD
PE-12-0506 15 MFD
PE-12-0501 5 MFD
PE-12-0500 4 MFD
PE-12-0500 4 MFD
PE-12-0503 7.5 MFD
TVS 1221, 1421, 1621 1 208 3/4 PM-02-0104
TVS 1424, 1624 1 208 1 PM-02-0126
TVS 0404, 0504, 0604,

0804

1 220 1/6 PM-02-0032
TVS 0606, 0806, 1006 1 220 1/6 PM-02-1338
TVS 0811, 1011, 1211,

1411

1 220 1/4 PM-02-0052
TVS 1018, 1218, 1418 1 220 1/2 PM-02-0076
TVS 1021, 1221, 1421,

1621

1 220 3/4 PM-02-1341
TVS 1221, 1421, 1621 1 220 3/4 PM-02-0106
TVS 1424, 1624 1 220 1 PM-02-1342
TVS 0404, 0504, 0604,

0804

1 277 1/12 PM-02-1503
TVS 0606, 0806, 1006 1 277 1/6 PM-02-0032
TVS 0811, 1011, 1211,

1411

1 277 1/4 PM-02-0052
TVS 1018, 1218, 1418 1 277 1/2 PM-02-0076
TVS 1221, 1421, 1621 1 277 3/4 PM-02-0106
TVS 1424, 1624 1 277 1 PM-02-0128
TVS 0811, 1011, 1211,

1411

1 480 1/4 PM-02-0056
TVS 1018, 1218, 1418 1 480 1/2 PM-02-0086
TVS 1221, 1421, 1621 1 480 3/4 PM-02-0116
AFT 0505, 0605, 0805 1 115 1/6 PM-02-0026
AFT 0610, 0810, 1010 1 115 1/4 PM-02-1404
AFT 0815, 1015, 1215 1 115 1/2 PM-02-0068
AFT 0505, 0605, 0805 1 208 1/6 PM-02-0030
AFT 0610, 0810, 1010 1 208 1/4 PM-02-1403
AFT 0815, 1015, 1215 1 208 1/2 PM-02-0072
AFT 0505, 0605, 0805 1 220 1/6 Contact Factory
AFT 0610, 0810, 1010 1 220 1/4 Contact Factory
AFT 0815, 1015, 1215 1 220 1/2 Contact Factory
AFT 0505, 0605, 0805 1 230 1/6 PM-02-0030
AFT 0610, 0810, 1010 1 230 1/4 PM-02-1403
AFT 0815, 1015, 1215 1 230 1/2 PM-02-0072
AFT 0505, 0605, 0805 1 277 1/6 PM-02-0032
PE-12-0504 10 MFD
PE-12-0508 20 MFD
PE-12-0502 6 MFD
PE-12-0502 6 MFD
PE-12-0500 4 MFD
PE-12-0503 7.5 MFD
PE-12-0505 12.5 MFD
PE-12-0504 10 MFD
PE-12-0508 20 MFD
PE-12-0509 3 MFD
PE-12-0502 6 MFD
PE-12-0500 4 MFD
PE-12-0503 7.5 MFD
PE-12-0504 10 MFD
PE-12-0506 15 MFD
PE-12-0500 4 MFD
PE-12-0503 7.5 MFD
PE-12-0504 10 MFD
PE-12-0500 4 MFD
PE-12-0500 4 MFD
PE-12-0503 7.5 MFD
PE-12-0500 4 MFD
PE-12-0500 4 MFD
PE-12-0503 7.5 MFD
PE-12-0500 4 MFD
PE-12-0500 4 MFD
PE-12-0503 7.5 MFD
PE-12-0502 6 MFD
AFT 0610, 0810, 1010 1 277 1/4 PM-02-1402
AFT 0815, 1015, 1215 1 277 1/2 PM-02-0076
AFT 0505, 0605, 0805 1 480 1/6 PM-02-1350
AFT 0610, 0810, 1010 1 480 1/4 Contact Factory
AFT 0815, 1015, 1215 1 480 1/2 PM-02-0086
TCL 0406, 0606, 0806 1 115 1/6 PM-02-0026
TCL 0608, 0808, 1008 1 115 1/4 PM-02-1404
TCL 0810, 1010, 1210 1 115 1/3 PM-02-1507
TCL 0811, 1011, 1211 1 115 1/3 PM-02-1507
TCL 1019, 1219, 1319 2 115 1/4 PM-02-1404
TCL 1020, 1220, 1320 2 115 1/4 PM-02-1404
TCL 0406, 0606, 0806 1 208 1/6 PM-02-0030
TCL 0608, 0808, 1008 1 208 1/4 PM-02-1403
TCL 0810, 1010, 1210 1 208 1/3 PM-02-1508
TCL 0811, 1011, 1211 1 208 1/3 PM-02-1508
TCL 1019, 1219, 1319 2 208 1/4 PM-02-1403
TCL 1020, 1220, 1320 2 208 1/4 PM-02-1403
TCL 0406, 0606, 0806 1 220 1/6 Contact Factory
TCL 0608, 0808, 1008 1 220 1/4 Contact Factory
TCL 0810, 1010, 1210 1 220 1/3 Contact Factory
TCL 0811, 1011, 1211 1 220 1/3 Contact Factory
TCL 1019, 1219, 1319 2 220 1/4 Contact Factory
TCL 1020, 1220, 1320 2 220 1/4 Contact Factory
TCL 0406, 0606, 0806 1 230 1/6 PM-02-0030
TCL 0608, 0808, 1008 1 230 1/4 PM-02-1403
TCL 0810, 1010, 1210 1 230 1/3 PM-02-1508
TCL 0811, 1011, 1211 1 230 1/3 PM-02-1508
TCL 1019, 1219, 1319 2 230 1/4 PM-02-1403
TCL 1020, 1220, 1320 2 230 1/4 PM-02-1403
TCL 0406, 0606, 0806 1 277 1/6 PM-02-0032
TCL 0608, 0808, 1008 1 277 1/4 PM-02-1402
PE-12-0500 4 MFD
PE-12-0503 7.5 MFD
PE-12-0502 6 MFD
PE-12-0503 7.5 MFD
PE-12-0500 4 MFD
PE-12-0500 4 MFD
PE-12-0500 4 MFD
PE-12-0500 4 MFD
PE-12-0500 4 MFD
PE-12-0500 4 MFD
PE-12-0500 4 MFD
PE-12-0500 4 MFD
PE-12-0500 4 MFD
PE-12-0500 4 MFD
PE-12-0500 4 MFD
PE-12-0500 4 MFD
PE-12-0500 4 MFD
PE-12-0500 4 MFD
PE-12-0500 4 MFD
PE-12-0500 4 MFD
PE-12-0500 4 MFD
PE-12-0500 4 MFD
PE-12-0502 6 MFD
PE-12-0500 4 MFD
TCL 0810, 1010, 1210 1 277 1/3 PM-02-1509 PE-12-0500 4 MFD
TCL 0811, 1011, 1211 1 277 1/3 PM-02-1509 PE-12-0500 4 MFD
TCL 1019, 1219, 1319 2 277 1/4 PM-02-1402 PE-12-0500 4 MFD
TCL 1020, 1220, 1320 2 277 1/4 PM-02-1402 PE-12-0500 4 MFD
TCL 0406, 0606, 0806 1 480 1/6 PM-02-1350 PE-12-0502 6 MFD
TCL 0608, 0808, 1008 1 480 1/4 Contact Factory
TCL 0810, 1010, 1210 1 480 1/3 Contact Factory
TCL 0811, 1011, 1211 1 480 1/3 Contact Factory
TCL 1019, 1219, 1319 2 480 1/4 Contact Factory
TCL 1020, 1220, 1320 2 480 1/4 Contact Factory
TVL 0405, 0505, 0605,

0805

1 115 1/8 PM-02-0001 PE-12-0501 5 MFD included w/

motor

TVL 1009, 1209 1 115 1/4 PM-02-1367 PE-12-0501 5 MFD included w/

motor

TVL 1215, 1415 1 115 1/2 PM-02-1376 PE-12-0501 5 MFD included w/

motor

TVL 0405, 0505, 0605,

0805

1 208 1/8 PM-02-0003 PE-12-0501 5 MFD included w/

motor

TVL 1009, 1209 1 208 1/4 PM-02-1368 PE-12-0501 5 MFD included w/

motor

TVL 1215, 1415 1 208 1/2 PM-02-1377 PE-12-0501 5 MFD included w/

motor

TVL 0405, 0505, 0605,

0805

1 220 1/8 Contact Factory
TVL 1009, 1209 1 220 1/4 Contact Factory
TVL 1215, 1415 1 220 1/2 Contact Factory
TVL 0405, 0505, 0605,

0805

1 230 1/8 PM-02-0003 PE-12-0501 5 MFD included w/

motor

TVL 1009, 1209 1 230 1/4 PM-02-1368 PE-12-0501 5 MFD included w/

motor

TVL 1215, 1415 1 230 1/2 PM-02-1377 PE-12-0501 5 MFD included w/

motor

TVL 0405, 0505, 0605,

0805

1 277 1/8 PM-02-1516 PE-12-0500 4 MFD included w/

motor

TVL 1009, 1209 1 277 1/4 PM-02-1369 PE-12-0501 5 MFD included w/

motor

TVL 1215, 1415 1 277 1/2 PM-02-1378 PE-12-0501 5 MFD included w/

motor

TVL 0405, 0505, 0605,

0805

1 480 1/8 Contact Factory
TVL 1009, 1209 1 480 1/4 Contact Factory
TVL 1215, 1415 1 480 1/2 Contact Factory
Notes:

  1. Purchase of any PSC motor from this table must include the purchase of the associated capacitor.
  2. Contact Factory for high static applications.
Model TCS & TVS ECM Motors
TCS & TVS ECM 2.3 MOTOR SELECTION
Product UNIT SIZE QTY. / UNIT VOLTAGE ECM Motor HP ECM Motor Part # ECM

Motor List Price

ECM Motor Program
TCS 0611, 0811, 1011 1 115, 208, 230 1/2 PM-02-1335 Contact

Factory

TCS 0818, 1018, 1218 1 115, 208, 230 1/2 PM-02-1335 E0027V01
TCS 0819, 1019, 1219 1 115, 208, 230 1/2 PM-02-1335 E0023V01
TCS 1440, 1640 2 115, 208, 230 1/2 PM-02-1335 E0029V01
TCS 1021, 1221, 1421 1 115, 208, 230 3/4 PM-02-1336 E0026V01
TCS 1424, 1624 1 115, 208, 230 1 PM-02-1337 E0025V01
TCS 1224, 1424 1 115, 208, 230 1 PM-02-1337 E0025V01
TCS 0619 1 277 1/2 PM-02-1303 E0002V01
TCS 0611, 0811, 1011 1 277 1/2 PM-02-1303 Contact

Factory

TCS 0818, 1018, 1218 1 277 1/2 PM-02-1303 E0012V01
TCS 0819, 1019, 1219 1 277 1/2 PM-02-1303 E0002V01
TCS 1440, 1640 2 277 1/2 PM-02-1303 E0019V01
TCS 0621, 0821 1 277 3/4 PM-02-1304 E0011V02
TCS 1021, 1221, 1421 1 277 3/4 PM-02-1304 E0011V02
TCS 1424, 1624 1 277 1 PM-02-1305 E0004V01
TCS 1224, 1424 1 277 1 PM-02-1305 E0004V01

TVS 0606, 0806, 1006 1 115, 208, 230 1/3 PM-02-1334 E0034V01
TVS 0811, 1011, 1211,

1411

1 115, 208, 230 1/2 PM-02-1335 E0035V01
TVS 1018, 1218, 1418 1 115, 208, 230 1/2 PM-02-1335 E0036V01
TVS 1021, 1221, 1421,

1621

1 115, 208, 230 3/4 PM-02-1336 E0037V01
TVS 1424, 1624 1 115, 208, 230 1 PM-02-1337 E0039V01
TVS 1224, 1424 1 115, 208, 230 1 PM-02-1337 E0039V01
TVS 0606, 0806, 1006 1 277 1/3 PM-02-1302 E0030V01
TVS 0811, 1011, 1211,

1411

1 277 1/2 PM-02-1303 E0031V01
TVS 1018, 1218, 1418 1 277 1/2 PM-02-1303 E0032V01
TVS 1021, 1221, 1421,

1621

1 277 3/4 PM-02-1304 E0033V01
AFT ALL SIZES Contact Factory FOR PART NUMBERS AND PRICING ON THESE ECM MOTORS
TCL ALL SIZES
TVL ALL SIZES
Notes:

  1. Purchase of any ECM motor must include the associated ECM program number from this table.
  2. List price for ECM 2.3 Motors include complete motor and controller assembly.

©2014 Johnson Controls, Inc.

VAV Parts Price List

All List Prices Subject to Change Revision Date: February 2014

Note: Use this table for lookup purposes only to locate and order the correct associated PM-02-xxxx part number.

MOTOR MANUFACTURER PART NUMBER CROSS REFERENCE TABLE
Motor Part Number Old/Obsolete P/N Description Drawing

Number

Manufacturer Part # Capacitor Part # Capacitor Motor List

Price

Capacitor

List Price

PM-02-1390 MTR,1/35HP,120V,ODP 3 SPD 7187-0233 PE-12-0499 3 MFD
PM-02-1391 MTR,1/35HP,208/230V,ODP 3 SPD 7187-0256 PE-12-0499 3 MFD
PM-02-1392 MTR,1/35HP,277V,ODP 3 SPD 7187-0238 PE-12-0499 3 MFD
PM-02-1393 MTR,1/25HP,120V, ODP 3 SPD 7187-0239 PE-12-0501 5 MFD
PM-02-1394 MTR,1/25HP,208/230V, ODP 3 SPD 7187-0257 PE-12-0499 3 MFD
PM-02-1395 MTR,1/25HP,277V, ODP 3 SPD 7187-0258 PE-12-0499 3 MFD
PM-02-1396 MTR,1/15HP,120V, ODP 3 SPD 7187-0260 PE-12-0500 4 MFD
PM-02-1397 MTR,1/15HP,208/230V, ODP 3 SPD 7187-0261 PE-12-0500 4 MFD
PM-02-1398 MTR,1/15HP,277V, ODP 3 SPD 7187-0259 PE-12-0500 4 MFD
PM-02-0026 MTR 1/6HP, 1PH, 120/60 ODP 44-189 7126-1290 PE-12-0500 4 MFD
PM-02-0030 MTR 1/6HP, 1PH, 208-230/60 ODP 44-189 7126-3389 PE-12-0500 4 MFD
PM-02-0032 MTR 1/6HP, 1PH, 240-277/50-60 ODP 44-189 7126-1291 PE-12-0502 6 MFD
PM-02-1399 MTR,1/5HP,120V,ODP 3 SPD 7187-0242 PE-12-0501 5 MFD
PM-02-1400 MTR,1/5HP,208/230V, ODP 3SPD 7187-0243 PE-12-0501 5 MFD
PM-02-1401 MTR,1/5HP,277V, ODP 3SPD 7187-0241 PE-12-0501 5 MFD
PM-02-0046 MTR 1/4HP, 1PH, 120/60 ODP 44-189 7126-3992 PE-12-0500 4 MFD
PM-02-0051 MTR 1/4HP, 1PH, 208-230/60 ODP D-FR 7126-3390 PE-12-0500 4 MFD
PM-02-0052 MTR 1/4HP, 1PH, 240-277/50-60 ODP 44-189 7126-1033 PE-12-0500 4 MFD
PM-02-0068 MTR 1/2HP, 1PH, 120/60 ODP 44-189 7126-1031 PE-12-0503 7.5 MFD
PM-02-0072 MTR 1/2HP, 1PH, 208-230/60 ODP 7126-3391 PE-12-0503 7.5 MFD
PM-02-0076 MTR 1/2HP, 1PH, 240-277/50-60 ODP 44-189 7126-1034 PE-12-0503 7.5 MFD
PM-02-1353 MTR,1/4HP,120V 48 FRAME 7126-4890 PE-12-0500 4 MFD
PM-02-1354 MTR,1/4HP,208/230,48 FRAME 7126-4889 PE-12-0500 4 MFD
PM-02-1355 MTR,1/4HP,277V 48 FRAME 7126-4888 PE-12-0500 4 MFD
PM-02-1505 PM-02-0000 MTR,1/30 HP,120 V, SINGLE SHAFT,42411 44-113 7187-0322 included w/ motor n/a
PM-02-1504 PM-02-0002 MTR,1/30HP,208/230V,42FR,SINGLE 44-113 7187-0319 included w/ motor n/a
PM-02-1506 PM-02-0004 MTR,1/30 HP,277 V, SINGLE SHAFT,42FRM 44-113 7187-0323 included w/ motor n/a
PM-02-1510 PM-02-0007 MTR,1/15HP, 120/1/60 SGL SHAFT 7185-0330 included w/ motor n/a
PM-02-1511 PM-02-0009 MTR, 1/15HP, 230/1/60 SGL SHAFT 7185-0331 included w/ motor n/a
PM-02-1512 PM-02-0011 MTR, 1/15HP, 277/1/60 SGL SHAFT 7185-0332 included w/ motor n/a
PM-02-1518 PM-02-0006 MTR 1/10HP,42FRM,DL SHFT,1.6A,115V 7185-0344 included w/ motor n/a
PM-02-1519 PM-02-0008 MTR 1/10H,42FRM,DL SHFT,.7A,208/230 7185-0345 included w/ motor n/a
PM-02-1520 PM-02-0010 MTR 1/10HP,42FRM,DL SHFT,.6A,277V 7185-0343 included w/ motor n/a
PM-02-0012 MTR, 1/6 HP, 120/1/60 DUAL SHAFT 44-116 7185-0114 included w/ motor n/a
PM-02-0014 MTR, 1/6 HP, 230/1/60 DUAL SHAFT 44-116 7185-0117 included w/ motor n/a
PM-02-1517 MTR 1/6HP,42FRM,DUAL SHFT,.85A,277V 7185-0333 included w/ motor n/a
PM-02-0001 MTR, 1/8 HP, 115/1/60 SGL SHAFT 44-127 7184-0275 included w/ motor n/a
PM-02-0003 MTR, 1/8 HP, 230/1/60 SGL SHAFT 44-127 7184-0276 included w/ motor n/a
PM-02-1516 MTR,1/8HP,42FRM,S SHAFT,.68AMP,277V included w/ motor n/a
PM-02-0414 MTR,1/50HP,115/1/60SNGLSHAFT 44-00080 DF3C001 included w/ motor n/a
PM-02-0417 MTR,1/20HP,115/1/60SNGLSHAFT 44-00079 DF3D021 included w/ motor n/a
PM-02-0411 MTR,1/20HP,115/1/60 DBL SHAFT 44-00081 DF3M001 included w/ motor n/a
PM-02-0412 MTR,1/20HP,208/230/1/60DBLSHAFT 44-00095 DF3M002N included w/ motor n/a
PM-02-0413 MTR,1/20HP,277/1/60DBLSHAFT 44-00096 DF3M003N included w/ motor n/a
PM-02-0420 MTR,1/10HP,115/1/60DBLSHAFT 44-00082 DF2E065N included w/ motor n/a
PM-02-0421 MTR,1/10HP,208/230/1/60DBLSHAFT 44-00097 DF2E066N included w/ motor n/a
PM-02-0422 MTR,1/10HP,277/1/60DBLSHAFT 44-00098 DF2E067N included w/ motor n/a
PM-02-1415 MTR,1/25HP,120V,0.6A,1315RPM,SS 7185-0290 included w/ motor n/a
PM-02-1416 MTR,1/25HP,208/280V,0.3,1315RPM 7185-0299-A included w/ motor n/a
PM-02-1417 MTR,1/25HP,277V,0.3,1315RPM 7185-0302 included w/ motor n/a
PM-02-1418 MTR,1/25HP,120V,0.6A,1115RPM,DS 7187-0285 included w/ motor n/a
PM-02-1419 MTR,1/25HP,208/280V,0.3,1115RPM 7187-0295-A included w/ motor n/a
PM-02-1420 MTR,1/25HP,277V,0.3,1115RPM 7187-0296-A included w/ motor n/a
PM-02-1501 MTR.1/12HP,115V,42FR,ODP,3SPD 7185-0324 REV A PE-12-0501 5 MFD
PM-02-0098 MTR 3/4HP, 1PH, 120/60 ODP 44-189 7126-1032 PE-12-0504 10 MFD
PM-02-0124 MTR 1 HP, 1PH, 115/60 ODP 44-189 7126-2655 PE-12-0506 15 MFD
PM-02-1502 MTR,1/12HP,208/230V,42FR,ODP,3SPD 7185-0323 REV A PE-12-0501 5 MFD
PM-02-0104 MTR 3/4HP, 1PH, 208-230/60 ODP 44-189 7126-3392 PE-12-0504 10 MFD
PM-02-0126 MTR 1HP, 1PH, 208-230/60 ODP D-FR 7126-0797 PE-12-0508 20 MFD
PM-02-1338 MTR,1/6HP,220/240,50HZ,48FR 7126-4810 PE-12-0502 6 MFD
PM-02-1339 MTR,1/4HP,220/240,50HZ,48FR 7126-4807 PE-12-0503 7.5 MFD
PM-02-1340 MTR,1/2HP,220/240,50HZ,48FR 7126-4808 PE-12-0504 10 MFD
PM-02-1341 MTR,3/4HP,220/240,50HZ,48FR 7126-4809 PE-12-0505 12.5 MFD
PM-02-1342 MTR,1HP,220/240,50HZ,48FR 7126-4811 PE-12-0508 20 MFD
PM-02-1503 MTR,1/12HP,277V,42FR,ODP,3SPD 7185-0325 REV A PE-12-0509 3 MFD
PM-02-0106 MTR 3/4HP, 1PH, 240-277/50-60 ODP 44-189 7126-1035 PE-12-0504 10 MFD
PM-02-0128 MTR 1 HP, 1PH, 240-277/50-60 ODP 44-189 7126-3142 PE-12-0506 15 MFD
PM-02-0056 MTR 1/4HP, 1PH, 480/60 ODP 44-189 7126-1351 PE-12-0500 4 MFD
PM-02-0086 MTR 1/2HP, 1PH, 480/60 ODP 44-189 7126-1350 PE-12-0503 7.5 MFD
PM-02-0116 MTR 3/4 HP, 1PH, 480/60 ODP 44-189 7126-1386 PE-12-0504 10 MFD
PM-02-1404 MTR,1/4HP,115V,48FRAME, ODP 3SPD 7126-5020 PE-12-0500 4 MFD
PM-02-1403 MTR,1/4HP, 208/230V,48FRAME,ODP3SPD 7126-5019 PE-12-0500 4 MFD
PM-02-1402 MTR,1/4HP,277V 48FRAME ODP 3 SPD 7126-5018 PE-12-0500 4 MFD
PM-02-1350 MTR,1/6HP,3SPD,480V,48FRAME 7126-3577 PE-12-0502 6 MFD
PM-02-1507 MTR,1/3 HP, 115 V, D FRAME MTR,BB REQD 7126-5228 PE-12-0500 4 MFD
PM-02-1508 MTR,1/3 HP,208-230 V, D FRAME MTR,BB REQD 7126-5262 PE-12-0500 4 MFD
PM-02-1509 MTR,1/3 HP, 277 V, D FRAME MTR,BB REQD 7126-5263 PE-12-0500 4 MFD
PM-02-0001 MTR, 1/8 HP, 115/1/60 SGL SHAFT 44-127 7184-0275 included w/ motor 5 MFD
PM-02-1367 MTR,1/4HP,115V,42FR,3SPD,ODP DS 7185-0263 included w/ motor 5 MFD
PM-02-1376 MTR,1/2HP,115V,42FR,3SPD,ODP DS 7124-2336 included w/ motor 5 MFD
PM-02-0003 MTR, 1/8 HP, 230/1/60 SGL SHAFT 44-127 7184-0276 included w/ motor 5 MFD
PM-02-1368 MTR,1/4HP,208/230,42FR 3SPD ODP DS 7185-0247 included w/ motor 5 MFD
PM-02-1377 MTR,1/2HP,208/230V,48FR,3SPD,ODP DS 7124-2337 included w/ motor 5 MFD
PM-02-1516 MTR,1/8HP,42FRM,S SHAFT,.68AMP,277V included w/ motor 4 MFD
PM-02-1369 MTR,1/4HP,277V,42FR.3SPD,ODP DS 7185-0248 included w/ motor 5 MFD
PM-02-1378 MTR,1/2HP,277V,48FR,3SPD,ODP, DS 7124-2338 included w/ motor 5 MFD

©2014 Johnson Controls, Inc.

Electrical Parts Price List

All List Prices Subject to Change Revision Date: February 2014

LINE BLOCKS
PE-00-0103 1 POLE 30 AMP 600 VOLT CONTROL BLOCK
PE-00-1104 1 TAP 40 AMP LINE BLOCK – NEUTRAL BLOCK
PE-00-2204 2 POLE 40 AMP LINE BLOCK
PE-00-2304 3 POLE 40 AMP LINE BLOCK
PE-00-2309 3 POLE 95 AMP LINE BLOCK
PE-00-2228 2 POLE 285 AMP LINE BLOCK
PE-00-2329 3 POLE 285 AMP LINE BLOCK

Note:

1. Mounting Rail from the Control Block Rails table below is required for the above Line blocks.

CONTROL BLOCK RAILS
44-03213-049 3 TAP RAIL
44-04306-049 4 TAP RAIL
44-05315-049 5 TAP RAIL
44-06408-049 6 TAP RAIL
44-07501-049 7 TAP RAIL
MISCELLANEOUS ELECTRICAL SWITCHES
PE-01-0019 SWITCH,WALL,2POLE,20AMP,2HP,120-277VAC
00-13111-02 ASSY,PE-01-0019 WITH SHEET METAL ENCLOSURE
PE-01-0022 SWITCH,WALL,20AMP,2HP,120VAC – 277VAC
00-13111-01 ASSY,PE-01-0022 WITH SHEET METAL ENCLOSURE
PE-00-0200 3 SPEED SWITCH BLOCK, 4 POSITION
PE-01-0026 SWITCH, NONC CONTACT KA1 (HOA – INTERNAL SWITCH)
PE-01-0025 SWITCH,3POS, CAM 480V 10A KS46B (HOA – EXTERNAL KNOB)
DISCONNECT
PE-01-0306 3 POLE 40 AMP DOOR INTERLOCK (6mm)
PE-01-0307 3 POLE 80 AMP DOOR INTERLOCK (6mm)
PE-01-4004 NEW STYLE SHAFT (40 AMP) 180mm LONG (6mm)
PE-01-4006 NEW STYLE HANDLE (KNOB) 40-80 AMP (6mm)
PE-01-0310 3 POLE 100 AMP DOOR INTERLOCK
PE-01-0316 3 POLE 160 AMP DOOR INTERLOCK
PE-01-0320 3 POLE 200 AMP DOOR INTERLOCK
PE-01-0340 3 POLE 400 AMP DOOR INTERLOCK
PE-01-0360 3 POLE 600 AMP DOOR INTERLOCK
PE-01-0380 3 POLE 800 AMP DOOR INTERLOCK
29-00-220 TOGGLE SWITCH ELECTRICAL INSULATOR(DUROID)PR-07-0020

Notes:

1. 100 amp shaft is available with disconnect only.

FUSED DOOR INTERLOCKING DISCONNECT
PE-01-4011 FUSED DISCONNECT SWITCH, 30A, 600V, 3P
PE-01-4012 FUSED DISCONNECT SWITCH, 60A, 600V, 3P
PE-01-4016 FUSED DISCONNECT SWITCH, 100A, 600V, 3P
PE-01-4017 FUSED DISCONNECT SWITCH, 100A, 600V, 2P
PE-01-4019 FUSED DISCONNECT SWITCH, 200A, 600V, 3P
FUSED DOOR INTERLOCKING DISCONNECT ACCESSORIES
PE-01-4013 DISCONNECT SHAFT FOR 60 AMP
PE-01-4021 DISCONNECT SHAFT FOR 100 AMP AND 200 AMP
PE-01-4014 DISCONNECT HANDLE (KNOB) FOR 60 AMP SWITCH
PE-01-4020 DISCONNECT HANDLE (KNOB) FOR 100 AND 200 AMP SWITCH
PE-01-4015 TERMINAL LUG KIT FOR 30 & 60 AMP SWITCH
PE-01-4022 TERMINAL LUG KIT FOR 100 & 200 AMP DISCONNECT
PE-01-4018 COVER, FUSE FOR 100 AMP DISCONNECT
FUSE BLOCKS
PE-07-4030 1 POLE 30 AMP 250 VOLT FUSE BLOCK CLASS K
PE-07-1030 1 POLE 30 AMP 600 VOLT MINI FUSE BLOCK CLASS CC
PE-07-7060 1 POLE 60 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE BLOCK CLASS K
PE-07-5100 2 POLE 100 AMP 250 VOLT FUSE BLOCK CLASS K
PE-07-5030 2 POLE 30 AMP 250 VOLT FUSE BLOCK CLASS K
PE-07-2030 2 POLE 30 AMP 600 VOLT MINI FUSE BLOCK CLASS CC
PE-07-5060 2 POLE 60 AMP 250 VOLT FUSE BLOCK CLASS K
PE-07-9100 3 POLE 100 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE BLOCK CLASS K
PE-07-6030 3 POLE 30 AMP 250 VOLT FUSE BLOCK CLASS K
PE-07-9030 3 POLE 30 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE BLOCK CLASS K
PE-07-3030 3 POLE 30 AMP 600 VOLT MINI FUSE BLOCK CLASS CC
PE-07-6060 3 POLE 60 AMP 250 VOLT FUSE BLOCK CLASS K
PE-07-9060 3 POLE 60 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE BLOCK CLASS K
PE-07-1001 2 POLE 30 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE BLOCK CLASS CC, MR
PE-07-1002 3 POLE 30 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE BLOCK CLASS CC, MR
PE-07-8061 2 POLE 60 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE BLOCK CLASS CC, MR
PE-07-9061 3 POLE 60 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE BLOCK CLASS CC, MR
PE-07-8101 2 POLE 100 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE BLOCK CLASS CC, MR
PE-07-9101 3 POLE 100 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE BLOCK CLASS CC, MR
PE-07-8201 2 POLE 200 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE BLOCK CLASS CC, MR
PE-07-9201 3 POLE 200 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE BLOCK CLASS CC, MR


FUSES
250V
PE-06-1002 2 AMP 250 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
PE-06-1003 3 AMP 250 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
PE-06-1004 4 AMP 250 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
PE-06-1006 6 AMP 250 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
PE-06-1010 10 AMP 250 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
PE-06-1015 15 AMP 250 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
PE-06-1020 20 AMP 250 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
PE-06-1025 25 AMP 250 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
PE-06-1030 30 AMP 250 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
PE-06-1035 35 AMP 250 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
PE-06-1040 40 AMP 250 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
PE-06-1045 45 AMP 250 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
PE-06-1050 50 AMP 250 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
PE-06-1060 60 AMP 250 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
600 VOLT
PE-06-2001 1 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
PE-06-2002 2 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
PE-06-2003 3 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
PE-06-2006 6 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
PE-06-2010 10 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
PE-06-2015 15 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
PE-06-2020 20 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
PE-06-2025 25 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
PE-06-2030 30 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
PE-06-2035 35 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
PE-06-2040 40 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
PE-06-2045 45 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
PE-06-2050 50 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
PE-06-2060 60 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS K5, NON TIME DELAY
PE-06-0031 1/2 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-0032 8/10 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-0033 1 1/4 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-0034 1 1/2 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-0035 2 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-0036 2 1/2 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-0037 3 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-0038 3 1/2 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-0039 4 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-0040 5 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-0041 6 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-0042 7 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-0043 9 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-0044 10 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-0045 12 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-0046 15 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-0047 20 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-0048 25 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-0049 30 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-3000 35 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS J, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-3001 40 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS J, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-3002 50 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS J, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-3003 60 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS J, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-3004 70 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS J, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-3005 80 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS J, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-3006 90 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS J, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-3007 100 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS J, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-3008 110 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS J, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-3009 125 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS J, TIME DELAY, MR
PE-06-3010 150 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS J, TIME DELAY, MR
MINIATURE FUSES
PE-06-0001 1 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC
PE-06-0002 2 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC
PE-06-0003 3 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC
PE-06-0006 6 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC
PE-06-0010 10 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC
PE-06-0015 15 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC
PE-06-0020 20 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC
PE-06-0025 25 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC
PE-06-0030 30 AMP 600 VOLT FUSE CLASS CC
MAGNETIC CONTACTORS/RELAYS
24 VOLT CONTROL
PE-05-1301 1 POLE 30 AMP CONTACTOR 24 VOLT
PE-05-1501 1 POLE 50 AMP CONTACTOR 24 VOLT
PE-08-0004 2 Pole 25 AMP RELAY 24 VOLT
PE-05-2301 2 POLE 30 AMP CONTACTOR 24 VOLT
PE-05-2401 2 POLE 40 AMP CONTACTOR 24 VOLT
PE-05-2501 2 POLE 50 AMP CONTACTOR 24 VOLT
PE-05-3301 3 POLE 30 AMP CONTACTOR 24 VOLT
PE-05-3401 3 POLE 40 AMP CONTACTOR 24 VOLT
PE-05-3501 3 POLE 50 AMP CONTACTOR 24 VOLT
120 VOLT CONTROL
PE-05-1302 1 POLE 30 AMP CONTACTOR 120 VOLT
PE-05-1402 1 POLE 40 AMP CONTACTOR 120 VOLT
PE-05-2302 2 POLE 30 AMP CONTACTOR 120 VOLT
PE-05-2402 2 POLE 40 AMP CONTACTOR 120 VOLT
PE-05-2502 2 POLE 50 AMP CONTACTOR 120 VOLT
PE-05-3302 3 POLE 30 AMP CONTACTOR 120 VOLT
PE-05-3402 3 POLE 40 AMP CONTACTOR 120 VOLT
PE-05-3502 3 POLE 50 AMP CONTACTOR 120 VOLT
208 – 240 VOLT CONTROL
PE-05-1306 1 POLE 30 AMP CONTACTOR 208-240 VOLT
PE-05-1406 1 POLE 40 AMP CONTACTOR 208-240 VOLT
PE-05-1506 1 POLE 50 AMP CONTACTOR 208-240 VOLT
PE-05-2306 2 POLE 30 AMP CONTACTOR 208-240 VOLT
PE-05-2406 2 POLE 40 AMP CONTACTOR 208-240 VOLT
PE-05-2506 2 POLE 50 AMP CONTACTOR 208-240 VOLT
PE-05-3306 3 POLE 30 AMP CONTACTOR 208-240 VOLT
PE-05-3406 3 POLE 40 AMP CONTACTOR 208-240 VOLT
PE-05-3506 3 POLE 50 AMP CONTACTOR 208-240 VOLT
277 VOLT CONTROL
PE-05-1305 1 POLE 30 AMP CONTACTOR 277 VOLT
PE-05-1405 1 POLE 40 AMP CONTACTOR 277 VOLT
PE-05-2305 2 POLE 30 AMP CONTACTOR 277 VOLT
PE-05-2405 2 POLE 40 AMP CONTACTOR 277 VOLT
PE-05-2505 2 POLE 50 AMP CONTACTOR 277 VOLT
PE-05-3305 3 POLE 30 AMP CONTACTOR 277 VOLT
PE-05-3405 3 POLE 40 AMP CONTACTOR 277 VOLT
PE-05-3505 3 POLE 50 AMP CONTACTOR 277 VOLT
SOLID STATE RELAYS (SSR)
PE-02-0010 ETSR15 – SOLID STATE RELAY 50 AMP/1 PHASE
n/a ETSR32 – SOLID STATE RELAY 25 AMP/3 PHASE (Obsolete)
PE-02-0025 ETSR35 – SOLID STATE RELAY 50 AMP/3 PHASE
PE-02-0030 SSR,1PH,48-660VAC,18A,120V
PE-02-0031 SSR,1PH,48-660VAC,18A,24V
PE-02-0032 SSR,1PH,42-660VAC, 25A, 280V
PE-02-0033 SSR,1PH,42-660VAC, 50A, 280V
PE-02-0034 SSR,1PH,42-660VAC, 60A, 280V
INTERFACE BOARDS FOR SSR RELAY
ETPHCC SWITCH GROUND SIDE PWM INPUT, CLOSE TO CONTROLLER COM
ETPHCC1 SWITCH HOT SIDE PWM INPUT, CLOSE TO CONTROLLER 24 VAC
ETPHCI SSR 4-20ma INPUT
ETPHCR SSR 135 OHM INPUT
ETPHCT SSR TTAT INPUT
ETPHCV1 SSR 6-9 VDC INPUT
ETPHCV2 SSR 2-10 VDC INPUT
MERCURY CONTACTORS
PE-26-1351 1 POLE 35 AMP 24 VOLT
PE-26-1501 1 POLE 50 AMP 24 VOLT
PE-26-2351 2 POLE 35 AMP 24 VOLT
PE-26-2501 2 POLE 50 AMP 24 VOLT
PE-26-3351 3 POLE 35 AMP 24 VOLT
PE-26-3501 3 POLE 50 AMP 24 VOLT
PE-26-1355 1 POLE 35 AMP 277 VOLT
PE-26-2355 2 POLE 35 AMP 277 VOLT
SECONDARY LIMITS
PE-09-6140 140°F ONE TIME SEC LIMIT 48A 600VAC ONETIME (RING TERMINAL) 61F 322803
PE-09-6240 240°F ONE TIME SEC LIMIT 48A 600VAC ONETIME (RING TERMINAL) 61F 322802
PE-09-8140 140°F ONE TIME SEC LIMIT 25A 600VAC ONETIME (QUICK CONN) 60F 311722
PE-09-8240 240°F ONE TIME SEC LIMIT 25A 600VAC ONETIME (QUICK CONN) 60F 311723
PE-09-8160 160°F MANUAL RESET SEC LIMIT 48A 480VAC (RING TERMINAL) 20413L7-912
PE-09-8300 TUTCO ONE-TIME LIMIT SWITCH 160 DEG (RING TERMINAL) 08-3098-00
PE-09-8301 TUTCO ONE-TIME LIMIT SWITCH 140 DEG (RING TERMINAL) 08-3043-00
PE-09-8302 TUTCO ONE-TIME LIMIT SWITCH 125 -140 DEG (QUICK CONN) 08-3090-00
PRIMARY LIMITS
PE-09-1105 105°F AUTO RESET PRIMARY LIMIT 12.5A 600VAC (QUICK CONN) 60T 313287
PE-09-0125 125°F AUTO RESET PRIMARY LIMIT 13A 600V 312894-60TX11
TRANSFORMERS
PE-10-1105 24 PRIMARY 24 SECONDARY 50VA ISOLATION TRANSFORMER
PE-10-2105 120 PRIMARY 24 SECONDARY 50VA TRANSFORMER
PE-10-2107 120 PRIMARY 24 SECONDARY 75VA TRANSFORMER
PE-10-5105 277 PRIMARY 24 SECONDARY 50VA TRANSFORMER
PE-10-5107 277 PRIMARY 24 SECONDARY 75VA TRANSFORMER
PE-10-6105 208-240 PRIMARY 24 SECONDARY 50VA TRANSFORMER
PE-10-6107 208-240 PRIMARY 24 SECONDARY 75VA TRANSFORMER
PE-10-7105 480 PRIMARY 24 SECONDARY 50VA TRANSFORMER
PE-10-7107 480 PRIMARY 24 SECONDARY 75VA TRANSFORMER
TRANSFORMER WIRING
B61-01-084 ASSY,WIRE,TERM CONNECTOR TO PWR WHT
B61-01-085 ASSY,WIRE,TERM CONNECTOR TO PWR BLK

Note:

  1. Both of the above Tranformer wires are required by code for field chage-out of transformers.
  2. Note on parts orders for tansformers to attached transformer wireing prior to shipping.
WIRELESS FLAG COVERS
PE-19-0002 COVER,WIRELESS FLAG,CLEAR
PE-19-0003 COVER,WIRELESS FLAG,BRIGHT WHITE
PE-19-0004 COVER,WIRELESS FLAG,PEARL WHITE
FAN SPEED CONTROLLERS
VAV & DIRECT DRIVE FAN SCR – SPEED CONTROLLERS – 120V
66-001-1000 ETFC120-4
66-002-1000 ETFC120-10
ETFC120-20 ETFC120-20
ETFC120-30 ETFC120-30
66-001-1000 ETFC115VF-A
66-003-1000 ETFC115VF-B
VAV & DIRECT DRIVE FAN SCR – SPEED CONTROLLERS – 208V
66-009-1000 ETFC208CF-A
66-010-1000 ETFC208CF-B
66-009-1000 ETFC208VF-A
66-011-1000 ETFC208VF-B
VAV & DIRECT DRIVE FAN SCR – SPEED CONTROLLERS – 277V
66-004-1000 ETFC277-4S
66-005-1000 ETFC277-8
66-006-1000 ETFC277VF-A
66-007-1000 ETFC277VF-B
66-014-1000 ETFC277TVS (VAV-8-A)
VAV & DIRECT DRIVE FAN SCR – SPEED CONTROLLERS ECM MOTORS
B63-001-2063 ETPWM – Single ECM motor speed controller
B63-003-2063 ETPWM – Dual ECM motor master speed controller1
B63-004-2063 ETPWM – Dual ECM motor slave speed controller1
29-00-269 All model ETPWM* mounting bracket

Note:

1. Speed adjustment is located on master speed controller

MOTOR CABLES
B61-02-069 CFRHW 53″ MOTOR POWER CABLE (INLET SIZES 14 AND LARGER AND/OR FAN SIZE 21
B61-02-092 CFRHW 77″ MOTOR POWER CABLE (INLET SIZES 14 AND LARGER AND/OR FAN SIZE 21
B61-02-029 CFREH 53″ MOTOR POWER CABLE (INLET SIZES 14 AND LARGER AND/OR FAN SIZE 21
B61-02-024 CFRHW 53″ MOTOR SIGNAL CABLE (INLET SIZES 14 AND LARGER AND/OR FAN SIZE 21
B61-01-086 CFRHW 89″ MOTOR SIGNAL CABLE FOR DUAL MOTOR APPLICATIONS

©2014 Johnson Controls, Inc.


Electrical Parts Price List

All List Prices Subject to Change Revision Date: February 2014

TERMINAL UNIT SCR USAGE
TCS SERIES
UNIT

SIZE

115V SCR DESIGNATION 277V SCR DESIGNATION 208V SCR DESIGNATION MOTOR HP
Part Number Description Part Number Description Part Number Description
0404 NONE NONE NONE NONE NONE NONE 1/13
0504 NONE NONE NONE NONE NONE NONE 1/13
0604 NONE NONE NONE NONE NONE NONE 1/13
0506 66-001-1000 ETFC120-4 66-004-1000 ETFC277-4S 66-009-1000 ETFC208CF-A 1/6
0606 66-001-1000 ETFC120-4 66-004-1000 ETFC277-4S 66-009-1000 ETFC208CF-A 1/6
0806 66-001-1000 ETFC120-4 66-004-1000 ETFC277-4S 66-009-1000 ETFC208CF-A 1/6
0611 66-002-1000 ETFC120-10 66-005-1000 ETFC277-8 66-010-1000 ETFC208CF-B 1/4
0811 66-002-1000 ETFC120-10 66-005-1000 ETFC277-8 66-010-1000 ETFC208CF-B 1/4
1011 66-002-1000 ETFC120-10 66-005-1000 ETFC277-8 66-010-1000 ETFC208CF-B 1/4
0818 66-002-1000 ETFC120-10 66-005-1000 ETFC277-8 66-010-1000 ETFC208CF-B 1/2
1018 66-002-1000 ETFC120-10 66-005-1000 ETFC277-8 66-010-1000 ETFC208CF-B 1/2
1218 66-002-1000 ETFC120-10 66-005-1000 ETFC277-8 66-010-1000 ETFC208CF-B 1/2
1021 66-002-1000 ETFC120-10 66-005-1000 ETFC277-8 66-010-1000 ETFC208CF-B 3/4
1221 66-002-1000 ETFC120-10 66-005-1000 ETFC277-8 66-010-1000 ETFC208CF-B 3/4
1421 66-002-1000 ETFC120-10 66-005-1000 ETFC277-8 66-010-1000 ETFC208CF-B 3/4
1224 ETFC120-20 ETFC120-20 66-005-1000 ETFC277-8 66-010-1000 ETFC208CF-B 1.0
1424 ETFC120-20 ETFC120-20 66-005-1000 ETFC277-8 66-010-1000 ETFC208CF-B 1.0
1230* ETFC120-20 ETFC120-20 66-005-1000 ETFC277-8 66-010-1000 ETFC208CF-B (2) 1/2
1430* ETFC120-20 ETFC120-20 66-005-1000 ETFC277-8 66-010-1000 ETFC208CF-B (2) 1/2
1630* ETFC120-20 ETFC120-20 66-005-1000 ETFC277-8 66-010-1000 ETFC208CF-B (2) 1/2
1440* ETFC120-30 ETFC120-30 66-005-1000 ETFC277-8 66-010-1000 (2) ETFC208CF-B (2) 3/4
1640* ETFC120-30 ETFC120-30 66-005-1000 ETFC277-8 66-010-1000 (2) ETFC208CF-B (2) 3/4
1644* ETFC120-30 ETFC120-30 66-005-1000 (2) ETFC277-8 66-010-1000 (2) ETFC208CF-B (2) 1.0
1844* ETFC120-30 ETFC120-30 66-005-1000 (2) ETFC277-8 66-010-1000 (2) ETFC208CF-B (2) 1.0
TVS SERIES
UNIT

SIZE

115V SCR DESIGNATION 277V SCR DESIGNATION 208V SCR DESIGNATION MOTOR HP
Part Number Description Part Number Description Part Number Description
0404 NONE NONE NONE NONE NONE NONE 1/13
0504 NONE NONE NONE NONE NONE NONE 1/13
0604 NONE NONE NONE NONE NONE NONE 1/13
0606 66-001-1000 ETFC115VF-A 66-006-1000 ETFC277VF-A 66-009-1000 ETFC208VF-A 1/6
0804 NONE NONE NONE NONE NONE NONE 1/13
0806 66-001-1000 ETFC115VF-A 66-006-1000 ETFC277VF-A 66-009-1000 ETFC208VF-A 1/6
0811 66-003-1000 ETFC115VF-B 66-007-1000 ETFC277VF-B 66-011-1000 ETFC208VF-B 1/4
1006 66-001-1000 ETFC115VF-A 66-006-1000 ETFC277VF-A 66-009-1000 ETFC208VF-A 1/6
1011 66-003-1000 ETFC115VF-B 66-007-1000 ETFC277VF-B 66-011-1000 ETFC208VF-B 1/4
1018 66-003-1000 ETFC115VF-B 66-007-1000 ETFC277VF-B 66-011-1000 ETFC208VF-B 1/2
1211 66-003-1000 ETFC115VF-B 66-007-1000 ETFC277VF-B 66-011-1000 ETFC208VF-B 1/4
1218 66-003-1000 ETFC115VF-B 66-007-1000 ETFC277VF-B 66-011-1000 ETFC208VF-B 1/2
1221 66-003-1000 ETFC115VF-B 66-007-1000 ETFC277VF-B 66-011-1000 ETFC208VF-B 3/4
1411 66-003-1000 ETFC115VF-B 66-007-1000 ETFC277VF-B 66-011-1000 ETFC208VF-B 1/4
1418 66-003-1000 ETFC115VF-B 66-007-1000 ETFC277VF-B 66-011-1000 ETFC208VF-B 1/2
1421 66-003-1000 ETFC115VF-B 66-007-1000 ETFC277VF-B 66-011-1000 ETFC208VF-B 3/4
1424 ETFC120-20 ETFC120-20 66-007-1000 ETFC277VF-B 66-011-1000 ETFC208VF-B 1.0
1611 66-003-1000 ETFC115VF-B 66-007-1000 ETFC277VF-B 66-011-1000 ETFC208VF-B 1/4
1618 66-003-1000 ETFC115VF-B 66-007-1000 ETFC277VF-B 66-011-1000 ETFC208VF-B 1/2
1621 66-003-1000 ETFC115VF-B 66-007-1000 ETFC277VF-B 66-011-1000 ETFC208VF-B 3/4
1624 ETFC120-20 ETFC120-20 66-007-1000 ETFC277VF-B 66-011-1000 ETFC208VF-B 1.0
CVF / CVFQ SERIES
UNIT

SIZE

115V SCR DESIGNATION 277V SCR DESIGNATION 208V SCR DESIGNATION MOTOR HP
Part Number Description Part Number Description Part Number Description
6 66-001-1000 ETFC-120-4 66-004-1000 ETFC-277-4S 66-004-1000 ETFC-277-4S 1/6
8 66-002-1000 ETFC-120-10 66-005-1000 ETFC-277-8 66-004-1000 ETFC-277-4S 1/4
10 66-002-1000 ETFC-120-10 66-005-1000 ETFC-277-8 66-005-1000 ETFC-277-8 1/2
10B 66-002-1000 ETFC-120-10 66-005-1000 ETFC-277-8 66-005-1000 ETFC-277-8 1/2
12 66-002-1000 ETFC-120-10 66-005-1000 ETFC-277-8 66-005-1000 ETFC-277-8 3/4
12B 66-002-1000 ETFC-120-10 66-005-1000 ETFC-277-8 66-005-1000 ETFC-277-8 1/2
14* 66-002-1000 ETFC-120-10 66-005-1000 ETFC-277-8 66-005-1000 ETFC-277-8 (2) 1/2
14A* 66-002-1000 ETFC-120-10 66-005-1000 ETFC-277-8 66-004-1000 ETFC-277-4S (2) 1/4
14B* 66-002-1000 ETFC-120-10 66-005-1000 ETFC-277-8 66-004-1000 ETFC-277-4S (2) 1/4
14C* 66-002-1000 ETFC-120-10 66-005-1000 ETFC-277-8 66-005-1000 ETFC-277-8 (2) 1/2
16* 66-002-1000 ETFC-120-10 66-005-1000 ETFC-277-8 66-005-1000 ETFC-277-8 (2) 3/4
18* 66-002-1000 ETFC-120-10 66-005-1000 ETFC-277-8 66-005-1000 ETFC-277-8 (2) 3/4

*Dual Fan Units.

INLINE MOTOR FUSE AND FUSE HOLDER SELECTION CHART
120 Volt 208 Volt
Motor HP Fuse AMP Fuse Qty.

Required

Fuse Part # Fuse Holder

Part #

Fuse AMP Fuse Qty.

Required

Fuse Part # Fuse Holder

Part #

1/13 6 AMP 1 PE-06-0006 PE-07-1030 N/A N/A N/A N/A
1/6 15 AMP 1 PE-06-0015 PE-07-1030 6 AMP 2 PE-06-0006 PE-07-2030
1/4 20 AMP 1 PE-06-0020 PE-07-1030 15 AMP 2 PE-06-0015 PE-07-2030
1/2 30 AMP 1 PE-06-0030 PE-07-1030 15 AMP 2 PE-06-0015 PE-07-2030
3/4 30 AMP 1 PE-06-0030 PE-07-1030 20 AMP 2 PE-06-0020 PE-07-2030
(2) 1/13 10 AMP 1 PE-06-0010 PE-07-1030 N/A N/A N/A N/A
(2) 1/6 20 AMP 1 PE-06-0020 PE-07-1030 10 AMP 2 PE-06-0010 PE-07-2030
(2) 1/4 30 AMP 1 PE-06-0030 PE-07-1030 20 AMP 2 PE-06-0020 PE-07-2030
(2) 1/2 30 AMP 1 PE-06-3030 PE-07-A030 30 AMP 2 PE-06-0030 PE-07-2030
(2) 3/4 30 AMP 1 PE-06-3030 PE-07-A030 20 AMP 2 PE-06-3020 PE-07-A030
1 20 AMP 1 PE-06-3020 PE-07-A030 N/A N/A N/A N/A
(2) 1 35 AMP 1 PE-06-3035 PE-07-A060 N/A N/A N/A N/A
277 Volt 480 Volt
Motor HP Fuse AMP Fuse Qty.

Required

Fuse Part # Fuse Holder

Part #

Fuse AMP Fuse Qty.

Required

Fuse Part # Fuse Holder

Part #

1/13 3 AMP 1 PE-06-0003 PE-07-1030 N/A N/A N/A N/A
1/6 6 AMP 1 PE-06-0006 PE-07-1030 N/A N/A N/A N/A
1/4 10 AMP 1 PE-06-0010 PE-07-1030 6 AMP 2 PE-06-0006 PE-07-2030
1/2 15 AMP 1 PE-06-0015 PE-07-1030 10 AMP 2 PE-06-0010 PE-07-2030
3/4 15 AMP 1 PE-06-0015 PE-07-1030 10 AMP 2 PE-06-0010 PE-07-2030
(2) 1/13 6 AMP 1 PE-06-0006 PE-07-1030 N/A N/A N/A N/A
(2) 1/6 10 AMP 1 PE-06-0010 PE-07-1030 N/A N/A N/A N/A
(2) 1/4 15 AMP 1 PE-06-0015 PE-07-1030 10 AMP 2 PE-06-0010 PE-07-2030
(2) 1/2 25 AMP 1 PE-06-0025 PE-07-1030 20 AMP 2 PE-06-0020 PE-07-2030
(2) 3/4 25 AMP 1 PE-06-0025 PE-07-1030 20 AMP 2 PE-06-0020 PE-07-2030
1 15 AMP 1 PE-06-0015 PE-07-1030 N/A N/A N/A N/A
(2) 1 30 AMP 1 PE-06-0030 PE-07-1030 N/A N/A N/A N/A

Notes:

  1. All fuse holder part numbers shown reflect the quantity of fuses required.
  2. See Fuse Blocks and Fuses tables for pricing.
  3. For fuse pricing on TCSQ, contact factory.

©2014 Johnson Controls, Inc.


Electronics Parts LIST List

All List LISTs Subject to Change Revision Date: February 2014

ACTUATOR COMPATABILITY GUIDE

Many past (and some present) ENVIRO-TEC® controls were designed to drive a DC (two-wire) actuator. Early controls and the Series 7000 were designed to drive an AC (three-wire) actuator. All current replacement actuators require AC drive (three wire). The type of actuator drive for various controls can be

determined from the lists below:

DC Drive Controls

    1. Series 700 Sequences with an “A”, “R”, “S” or “SB” suffix. The first four letters of the model number will be “ETPD” or “ETPR”. These controllers used a blue or blue-green circuit board.
    2. Series 600 Sequences with an “A” suffix. The first four letters of the model number will be “ETRD”. These controllers used a green circuit board without a flow transducer.
    3. ETVT II zone controllers (not the bypass controller), models ETDD0, ETDD2F and ETDD3F.

AC Drive Controls

  1. Series 700 Sequences with no suffix. The first four letters of the model number will be “ETPI”. These controllers were housed in a black plastic case or used a green circuit board with a flow transducer.
  2. Series 600 Sequences with no suffix. The first four letters of the model number will be “ETRC”. These controllers were housed in a black plastic case without a flow transducer.
  3. ETVT II bypass controllers, model ETDD6V.
  4. ETVT I controllers. The first four letter of the model number will be “ETDC”.
  5. Old model Series 900 sequence controllers. The first four letter of the model number will be “ETDC”.

Replacing Mixed AC and DC Components

  1. If the customer has an operational DC Drive Controller and is replacing the actuator with a current AC Actuator (ACT24 – 3 wire), an ETAC (DC to AC drive interface) will be required.
  2. If the customer has an operational DC Actuator (two wire) and is replacing the controller with a current AC Drive Controller, either the actuator will need to be replaced with a current AC Actuator

(ACT24 – recommended), or an ETADC (AC to DC drive interface) will be required. NOTE: For bypass terminals (BT600 series) having two operational DC Actuators, an ETADC1 (AC to DC drive interface) is required. Both actuators must be the same type – if both are DC, and one fails, both actuators need to be replaced with AC Actuators (ACT24’s).

See Rotary Actuators and Interfaces for actuator interface pricing.

ETAC Installation With ACT24 700 Series Controller

  1. Before installing the ETAC to the controller, wire terminal 3 of the ACT24 to the terminal labeled CW on the ETAC.
  2. Wire terminal 2 of the ACT24 to the terminal labeled CCW on the ETAC.
  3. Connect the black wire supplied with the ETAC to the chassis at the same location that the controller chassis wire is attached.
  4. If not already installed, wire terminal 1 of the ACT24 to either terminal 16A or 16B of the controller (these terminals are electrically common).
  5. Turn over the ETAC and carefully push the two male connectors onto the spade type actuator connectors on the controller (terminals 13 and 14). The screw terminal connector on the ETAC should be facing

away from terminals 15 and 16; i.e., J3 on the ETAC should connect to terminal 13 on a 700 Series controller.

ETAC Installation With ACT24 ETVT II (DDC Series Controller)

  1. Before installing the ETAC to the controller, wire terminal 2 of the ACT24 to the terminal labeled CW on the ETAC.
  2. Wire terminal 3 of the ACT24 to the terminal labeled CCW on the ETAC.
  3. Connect the black wire supplied with the ETAC to the chassis at the same location that the controller

chassis wire is attached.

  1. If not already installed, wire terminal 1 of the ACT24 to either terminal 16A or 16B of the controller (these terminals are electrically common).
  2. Turn over the ETAC and carefully push the two male connectors onto the spade type actuator connectors on the controller (terminals 6 and 7). The screw terminal connector on the ETAC should be facing away from terminals 15 and 16; i.e., J3 on the ETAC should connect to terminal 7 on the ETVT II controller.

NOTE: The ETAC is never required with AC driver controllers, and will not work with them. This includes the complete Series 7000 and ETVT II pressure controller (ETDD6V).

SERIES 700 2″ ANALOG THERMOSTATS
MODEL TSS
SEQUENCE MODEL NO. PART NO. LIST
SD701S – SD718S ETST5AW B63-001-2056
SD723S NONE N/A
SD724S – SD726S ETST5AW B63-001-2056
SD727S – SD728S NONE N/A
SD701SB – SD718SB ETST5AW B63-001-2056
SD723SB NONE N/A
SD724SB – SD726SB ETST5AW B63-001-2056
SD727S – SD728SB NONE N/A
MODEL TVS
SEQUENCE MODEL NO. PART NO. LIST
FV701S – FV708S ETST5AW B63-001-2056
FV717S – FV724S ETST5AW B63-001-2056
FV701SB – FV708SB ETST5AW B63-001-2056
FV717SB – FV724SB ETST5AW B63-001-2056
MODEL TCS
SEQUENCE MODEL NO. PART NO. LIST
FC701S – FC708S ETST5AW B63-001-2056
FC713S – FC720S ETST5AW B63-001-2056
FC701SB – FC708SB ETST5AW B63-001-2056
FC713SB – FC720SB ETST5AW B63-001-2056
MODEL SDD
SEQUENCE MODEL NO. PART NO. LIST
DD701S, DD701SB ETST4H B63-002-2056

Notes:

  1. For 2″ thermostats that require an exposed setpoint, see Thermostat Accessories.
  2. Thermostat pricing is for thermostat and base only. For mounting kit (includes cover), see Thermostat Accessories.
SERIES 7000 2″ ANALOG THERMOSTATS
MODEL TSS
SEQUENCE MODEL NO. PART NO. LIST
SD7000 – SD7005 ETST5AW B63-001-2056
SD7100 – SD7105 ETST5AW B63-001-2056
SD7300 – SD7305 ETST5AW B63-001-2056
SD7600 NONE N/A
SD7606 – SD7607 NONE N/A
MODEL TVS
SEQUENCE MODEL NO. PART NO. LIST
FV7001 – FV7005 ETST5AW B63-001-2056
FV7101 – FV7105 ETST5AW B63-001-2056
FV7201 – FV7205 ETST5AW B63-001-2056
FV7301 – FV7305 ETST5AW B63-001-2056
FV7401 – FV7405 ETST5AW B63-001-2056
FV7501 – FV7505 ETST5AW B63-001-2056
MODEL TCS
SEQUENCE MODEL NO. PART NO. LIST
FC7001 – FC7005 ETST5AW B63-001-2056
FC7101 – FC7105 ETST5AW B63-001-2056
FC7201 – FC7205 ETST5AW B63-001-2056
FC7301 – FC7305 ETST5AW B63-001-2056
FC7401 – FC7405 ETST5AW B63-001-2056
FC7501 – FC7505 ETST5AW B63-001-2056
MODEL TDS
SEQUENCE MODEL NO. PART NO. LIST
DD7100 ETST4H B63-002-2056
DD7200 ETST4H B63-002-2056
DD7300 ETST4H B63-002-2056

Notes:

  1. For 2″ thermostats that require an exposed setpoint, see Thermostat Accessories
  2. Thermostat pricing is for thermostat and base only. For cover and mounting kit, see Thermostat Accessories.

STEP BY STEP GUIDE TO USING THE 600 TO 6000 CROSS REFERENCE TABLES

The Series 600 has been discontinued, but Series 6000 Controller are available as compatable replacements for all standard 600 controllers. Contact factory for replacements on special sequences.

If you know the Series 600 Controller Model Number:

    1. Go to Table B to find the correct replacement Series 6000 Controller Assembly.
    2. Go to Table C to find the LIST for the replacement Series 6000 Controller Assembly.

NOTE: You can also use Table B to find the correct replacement Series 6000 Controller Assembly for the old ETRC controllers (enclosed in black case) by substituting “ETRC” for “ETRD” in the 600 Controller Model Number column.

If you only know the Series 600 Sequence Number:

  1. Go to Table A to find the Series 600 Controller Model Number.
  2. Go to Table B to find the correct replacement Series 6000 Controller Assembly.
  3. Go to Table C to find the LIST and Series 6000 Sequence Number for the replacement Series 6000 Controller Assembly.
A & S SERIES 600 ANALOG THERMOSTATS
MODEL BT WITH 2″ THERMOSTAT
SEQUENCE MODEL NO. PART NO. LIST
BT601S – BT624S ETST4H B63-002-2056
MODEL TSS WITH 2″ THERMOSTAT
SEQUENCE MODEL NO. PART NO. LIST
SD601S – SD623S ETST4H B63-002-2056

Notes:

  1. For the standard thermostats that require an exposed setpoint, add a P to the end of the part number and $16 to the List LIST.
  2. For 2″ thermostats that require an exposed setpoint, see Thermostat Accessories.
  3. Thermostat pricing is for the thermostat only. For base and cover, see Thermostat Accessories.
TABLE A – SERIES 600 SEQUENCE TO CONTROLLER CROSS REFERENCE
600 SEQUENCE 600 CONTROLLER MODEL

NUMBER

600 SEQUENCE 600 CONTROLLER MODEL

NUMBER

SD601A ETRD0 FV601A ETRD0
SD603A ETRD1 FV603A ETRD1
SD605A ETRD2 FV605A ETRD2
SD607A ETRD3 FV607A ETRD3
SD609A ETRD0WD FV609A ETRD0S
SD611A ETRD1WD FV611A ETRD1S
SD613A ETRD2WD FV613A ETRD2S
SD614A ETRD3WD FV615A ETRD3S
SD617A ETRD0CD FV633A ETRD0FWD
SD619A ETRD1CD FV635A ETRD1FWD
SD621A ETRD2CD FV637A ETRD2FWD
SD623A ETRD3CD FV639A ETRD3FWD
BT601A ETRD0 FV641A ETRD0SWD
BT602A* ETRD02 FV643A ETRD1SWD
BT603A ETRD1 FV645A ETRD2SWD
BT604A* ETRD12 FV647A ETRD3SWD
BT605A ETRD2 FC601A ETRD0FY
BT606A* ETRD22 FC603A ETRD1FY
BT607A ETRD3 FC605A ETRD2FY
BT608A* ETRD32 FC607A ETRD3FY
BT609A ETRD0WD FC609A ETRD0FS
BT610A* ETRD0WD2 FC611A ETRD1FS
BT611A ETRD1WD FC613A ETRD2FS
BT612A* ETRD1WD2 FC615A ETRD3FS
BT613A ETRD2WD FC617A ETRD0
BT614A* ETRD2WD2 FC619A ETRD1
BT615A ETRD3WD FC621A ETRD2
BT616A* ETRD3WD2 FC623A ETRD3
BT617A ETRD0CD FC625A ETRD0YWD
BT618A* ETRD0CD2 FC627A ETRD1YWD
BT619A ETRD1CD FC629A ETRD2YWD
BT620A* ETRD1CD2 FC631A ETRD3YWD
BT621A ETRD2CD FC633A ETRD0SYWD
BT622A* ETRD2CD2 FC635A ETRD1SYWD
BT623A ETRD3CD FC637A ETRD2SYWD
BT624A* ETRD3CD2 FC639A ETRD3SYWD

Note: * = Dual actuator applications

TABLE B – SERIES 600 CONTROLLER T0 SERIES 6000 CONTROLLER ASSEMBLY CROSS
600 CONTROLLER MODEL

NUMBER

6000 CONTROLLER

ASSEMBLY

600 CONTROLLER MODEL

NUMBER

6000 CONTROLLER

ASSEMBLY

ETRD0 ETRX0 ETRD2S ETRXNS
ETRD1 ETRXN ETRD3S ETRX3S
ETRD2 ETRXN ETRD0FWD ETRXNWD
ETRD3 ETRX3 ETRD1FWD ETRXNWD
ETRD0WD ETRX0WD ETRD2FWD ETRXNWD
ETRD1WD ETRXNWD ETRD3FWD ETRX3FWD
ETRD2WD ETRXNWD ETRD0SWD ETRXNSWD
ETRD3WD ETRXNWD ETRD1SWD ETRXNSWD
ETRD0CD ETRX0CD ETRD2SWD ETRXNSWD
ETRD1CD ETRXNCD ETRD3SWD ETRX3SWD
ETRD2CD ETRXNCD ETRD0FY ETRXNY
ETRD3CD ETRXNCD ETRD1FY ETRXNY
ETRD02 ETRX0 ETRD2FY ETRXNY
ETRD12 ETRXN ETRD3FY ETRXNY
ETRD22 ETRXN ETRD0FS ETRXNSY
ETRD32 ETRX3 ETRD1FS ETRXNSY
ETRD0WD2 ETRX0WD ETRD2FS ETRXNSY
ETRD1WD2 ETRXNWD ETRD3FS ETRXNSY
ETRD2WD2 ETRXNWD ETRD0YWD ETRXNYWD
ETRD3WD2 ETRXNWD ETRD1YWD ETRXNYWD
ETRD0CD2 ETRX0CD ETRD2YWD ETRXNYWD
ETRD1CD2 ETRXNCD ETRD3YWD ETRXNYWD
ETRD2CD2 ETRXNCD ETRD0SYWD ETRXNSYWD
ETRD3CD2 ETRXNCD ETRD1SYWD ETRXNSYWD
ETRD0S ETRXNS ETRD2SYWD ETRXNSYWD
ETRD1S ETRXNS ETRD3SYWD ETRXNSYWD

* Indicates dual actuator sequences

TABLE C – SERIES 6000 CONTROLLER ASSEMBLY SEQUENCE & LIST LISTS
6000 CONTROLLER ASSEMBLY
Model No. Part No. Sequence
ETRX0 66-000-0095 SD60001, BT6000
ETRXN 66-000-0096 SD60011, BT6001, FV6001
ETRX3 66-000-0105 FV6002
ETRX0WD 66-000-0099 SD6800, BT6800

LIST

ETRXNWD 66-000-0100 SD6801, BT6801
ETRX0CD 66-000-0097 SD6100, BT6100
ETRXNCD 66-000-0098 SD6101, BT6101
ETRXNS 66-000-0106 FV6701
ETRX3S 66-000-0107 FV6702
ETRXNWD 66-000-0100 FV6801
ETRX3FWD 66-000-0108 FV6802
ETRXNSWD 66-000-0109 FV6901
ETRX3SWD 66-000-0110 FV6902
ETRXNY 66-000-0101 FC6002
ETRXNSY 66-000-0102 FC6702
ETRXNYWD 66-000-0103 FC6802
ETRXNSYWD 66-000-0104 FC6902

Note:

  1. The fan was hardwired on for obsolete 600 sequences FC617-FC623, so the wiring diagram is the same as one for a single duct.

STEP BY STEP GUIDE TO USING THE 700 TO 7000 CROSS REFERENCE TABLES

The Series 700 has been discontinued, but Series 7000 Controller are available as compatable replacements for all standard 700 controllers. Contact factory for replacements on special sequences.

If you know the Series 700 Controller Model Number:

    1. If the model number starts with an ETPR or ETPD, go to Table H to find the correct replacement Series 7000 Controller Assembly.
    2. If the model number starts with an ETPI, go to Table J to find the correct replacement Series 7000 Controller Assembly.
    3. Go to Table K to find the LIST for the replacement Series 7000 Controller Assembly.

If you only know the Series 700 Sequence Number:

  1. For sequences without a suffix (e.g., SD701), the controller was either enclosed in a black plastic case, or used a green circuit board

    1. Go to Table G to find the Series 700 Controller Model Number.
    2. Go to Table J to find the correct replacement Series 7000 Controller Assembly.
    3. Go to Table K to find the LIST for the replacement Series 7000 Controller Assembly.
  2. For sequences with an “A” suffix (e.g., SD701A), the controller used a blue or blue-green circuit board, drove a DC (two-wire) actuator, was calibrated to the old style linear probe used on boxes with 45 degree damper travel, and used the old style 3″ by 4″ thermostat.

    1. Go to Table F to find the Series 700 Controller Model Number.
    2. Go to Table H to find the correct replacement Series 7000 Controller Assembly.
    3. Go to Table K to find the LIST for the replacement Series 7000 Controller Assembly.
  3. For sequences with an “R” suffix (e.g., SD701R), the controller used a blue or blue-green circuit board, drove a DC (two-wire) actuator, was calibrated to the new FlowStar™ probe used on boxes with 90 degree damper travel, and used the old style 3″ by 4″ thermostat.

    1. Go to Table E to find the Series 700 Controller Model Number.
    2. Go to Table H to find the correct replacement Series 7000 Controller Assembly.
    3. Go to Table K to find the LIST for the replacement Series 7000 Controller Assembly.
  4. For sequences with an “S” or “SB” suffix (e.g., SD701S or SD701SB), the controller used a blue or bluegreen circuit board and the sequence incorporated the 2″ low profile thermostat. The “S” suffix sequences used a DC (two-wire) actuator. The “SB” suffix sequences used an AC (three-wire) actuator and an ETAC DC to AC drive interface.

    1. Go to Table D to find the Series 700 Controller Model Number.
    2. Go to Table H to find the correct replacement Series 7000 Controller Assembly.
    3. Go to Table K to find the LIST for the replacement Series 7000 Controller Assembly.

TABLE D – SERIES 700 “S” AND “SB” SUFFIX SEQUENCE TO CONTROLLER CROSS

700 SEQUENCE 700 CONTROLLER MODEL

NO.

700 SEQUENCE 700 CONTROLLER MODEL

NO.

SD701S, SD701SB ETPR0 FV706S, FV706SB ETPR1FTB
SD702S, SD702SB ETPR1 FV706SM, FV706SMB ETPR1FTBMP
SD702SM, SD702SMB ETPR1MP FV707S, FV707SB ETPR2FTB
SD703S, SD703SB ETPR2 FV708S, FV708SB ETPR3FTB
SD704S, SD704SB ETPR3 FV717S, FV717SB ETPR0FTWD
SD705S, SD705SB ETPR0CD FV718S, FV718SB ETPR1FTWD
SD706S, SD706SB ETPR1CD FV718SM, FV718SMB ETPR1FTWDMP
SD706SM, SD706SMB ETPR1CDMP FV719S, FV719SB ETPR2FTWD
SD707S, SD707SB ETPR2CD FV720S, FV720SB ETPR3FTWD
SD708S, SD708SB ETPR3CD FV721S, FV721SB ETPR0FTBWD
SD713S, SD713SB ETPR1A FV722S, FV722SB ETPR1FTBWD
SD713SM, SD713SMB ETPR1AMP FV722SM, FV722SMB ETPR1FTBWDMP
SD714S, SD714SB ETPR2A FV723S, FV723SB ETPR2FTBWD
SD715S, SD715SB ETPR3A FV724S, FV724SB ETPR3FTBWD
SD716S, SD716SB ETPR1AWD FC701S, FC701SB ETPR0FY
SD716SM, SD716SMB ETPR1AWMP FC702S, FC702SB ETPR1FY
SD717S, SD717SB ETPR2AWD FC702SM, FC702SMB ETPR1FYMP
SD718S, SD718SB ETPR3AWD FC703S, FC703SB ETPR2FY
SD723S, SD723SB ETSRV, ETSRVC FC704S, FC704SB ETPR3FY
SD724S, SD724SB ETPR1 FC705S, FC705SB ETPR0FB
SD724SM, SD724SMB ETPR1MP FC706S, FC706SB ETPR1FB
SD725S, SD725SB ETPR2 FC706SM, FC706SMB ETPR1FBMP
SD726S, SD726SB ETPR3 FC707S, FC707SB ETPR2FB
SD727S, SD727SB ETSRV, ETSRVP FC708S, FC708SB ETPR3FB
SD728S, SD728SB ETSRV1 FC713S, FC713SB ETPR0FYWD
DD701S, DD701SB (Cold) ETPD0U FC714S, FC714SB ETPR1FYWD
DD701S, DD701SB (Hot) ETPD0HU FC714SM, FC714SMB ETPR1FYWDMP
FV701S, FV701SB ETPR0FT FC715S, FC715SB ETPR2FYWD
FV702S, FV702SB ETPR1FT FC716S, FC716SB ETPR3FYWD
FV702SM, FV702SMB ETPR1FTMP FC717S, FC717SB ETPR0FBWD
FV703S, FV703SB ETPR2FT FC718S, FC718SB ETPR1FBWD
FV704S, FV704SB ETPR3FT FC718SM, FC718SMB ETPR1FBWDMP
FV705S, FV705SB ETPR0FTB FC719S, FC719SB ETPR2FBWD
FC720S, FC720SB ETPR3FBWD
TABLE E – SERIES 700 “R” SUFFIX SEQUENCE TO CONTROLLER CROSS REFERENCE
700 SEQUENCE 700 CONTROLLER MODEL

NO.

700 SEQUENCE 700 CONTROLLER MODEL

NO.

SD701R ETPR0 FV706R ETPR1FTS
SD702R ETPR1 FV706RM ETPR1FTSMP
SD702RM ETPR1MP FV707R ETPR2FTS
SD703R ETPR2 FV708R ETPR3FTS
SD704R ETPR3 FV717R ETPR0FTWD
SD705R ETPR0CD FV718R ETPR1FTWD
SD706R ETPR1CD FV718RM ETPR1FTWDMP
SD706RM ETPR1CDMP FV719R ETPR2FTWD
SD707R ETPR2CD FV720R ETPR3FTWD
SD708R ETPR3CD FV721R ETPR0FTSWD
SD709R ETPR0CD FV722R ETPR1FTSWD
SD710R ETPR1CD FV722RM ETPR1FTSWDMP
SD710RM ETPR1CDMP FV723R ETPR2FTSWD
SD711R ETPR2CD FV724R ETPR3FTSWD
SD712R ETPR3CD FC701R ETPR0FY
SD713R ETPR1A FC702R ETPR1FY
SD713RM ETPR1AMP FC702RM ETPR1FYMP
SD714R ETPR2A FC703R ETPR2FY
SD715R ETPR3A FC704R ETPR3FY
SD716R ETPR1AWD FC705R ETPR0FS
SD716RM ETPR1AWMP FC706R ETPR1FS
SD717R ETPR2AWD FC706RM ETPR1FSMP
SD718R ETPR3AWD FC707R ETPR2FS
SD723R ETSRV, ETSRVC FC708R ETPR3FS
SD724R ETPR1 FC709R ETPR0
SD724RM ETPR1MP FC710R ETPR1
SD725R ETPR2 FC711R ETPR2
SD726R ETPR3 FC712R ETPR3
SD727R ETSRV, ETSRVP FC713R ETPR0FYWD
SD728R ETSRV1 FC714R ETPR1FYWD
DD701R ETPD0U FC714RM ETPR1FYWDMP
DD701R ETPD0HU FC715R ETPR2FYWD
FV701R ETPR0FT FC716R ETPR3FYWD
FV702R ETPR1FT FC717R ETPR0FSWD
FV702RM ETPR1FTMP FC718R ETPR1FSWD
FV703R ETPR2FT FC718RM ETPR1FSWDMP
FV704R ETPR3FT FC719R ETPR2FSWD
FV705R ETPR0FTS FC720R ETPR3FSWD
TABLE F – SERIES 700 “A” SUFFIX SEQUENCE TO CONTROLLER CROSS REFERENCE
700 SEQUENCE 700 CONTROLLER MODEL

NO.

700 SEQUENCE 700 CONTROLLER MODEL

NO.

SD701A ETPD0 FV705A ETPD0FTS
SD702A ETPD1 FV706A ETPD1FTS
SD703A ETPD2 FV707A ETPD2FTS
SD704A ETPD3 FV708A ETPD3FTS
SD705A ETPD0CD FV717A ETPD0FTWD
SD706A ETPD1CD FV718A ETPD1FTWD
SD707A ETPD2CD FV719A ETPD2FTWD
SD708A ETPD3CD FV720A ETPD3FTWD
SD709A ETPD0CD FV721A ETPD0FTSWD
SD710A ETPD1CD FV722A ETPD1FTSWD
SD711A ETPD2CD FV723A ETPD2FTSWD
SD712A ETPD3CD FV724A ETPD3FTSWD
SD713A ETPD1A FC701A ETPD0FY
SD714A ETPD2A FC702A ETPD1FY
SD715A ETPD3A FC703A ETPD2FY
SD716A ETPD1AWD FC704A ETPD3FY
SD717A ETPD2AWD FC705A ETPD0FS
SD718A ETPD3AWD FC706A ETPD1FS
SD723A ETSDV FC707A ETPD2FS
SD724A ETPD1 FC708A ETPD3FS
SD725A ETPD2 FC709A ETPD0
SD726A ETPD3 FC710A ETPD1
SD727A ETSDV FC711A ETPD2
SD728A ETSDV1 FC712A ETPD3
DD701A (Cold) ETPD0U FC713A ETPD0FYWD
DD701A (Hot) ETPD0HU FC714A ETPD1FYWD
DD702A (Cold) ETPD0U FC715A ETPD2FYWD
DD702A (Hot) ETPD0HU FC716A ETPD3FYWD
FV701A ETPD0FT FC717A ETPD0FSWD
FV702A ETPD1FT FC718A ETPD1FSWD
FV703A ETPD2FT FC719A ETPD2FSWD
FV704A ETPD3FT FC720A ETPD3FSWD
TABLE G – SERIES 700 (NO SUFFIX) SEQUENCE TO CONTROLLER CROSS REFERENCE
700 SEQUENCE 700 CONTROLLER MODEL

NO.

700 SEQUENCE 700 CONTROLLER MODEL

NO.

SD701 ETPI0 FV709 ETPI0FTW
SD702 ETPI1 FV710 ETPI1FTW
SD703 ETPI2 FV711 ETPI2FTW
SD704 ETPI3 FV712 ETPI3FTW
SD705 ETPI0CD FV713 ETPI0FTWS
SD706 ETPI1CD FV714 ETPI1FTWS
SD707 ETPI2CD FV715 ETPI2FTWS
SD708 ETPI3CD FV716 ETPI3FTWS
SD709 ETPI0CD FV717 ETPI0FTWD
SD710 ETPI1CD FV718 ETPI1FTWD
SD711 ETPI2CD FV719 ETPI2FTWD
SD712 ETPI3CD FV720 ETPI3FTWD
SD713 ETPI1A FV721 ETPI0FTSWD
SD714 ETPI2A FV722 ETPI1FTSWD
SD715 ETPI3A FV723 ETPI2FTSWD
SD716 ETPI1AWD FV724 ETPI3FTSWD
SD717 ETPI2AWD FC701 ETPI0FY
SD718 ETPI3AWD FC702 ETPI1FY
SD723 ETPI0V FC703 ETPI2FY
SD724 ETPI1 FC704 ETPI3FY
SD725 ETPI2 FC705 ETPI0FS
SD726 ETPI3 FC706 ETPI1FS
SD727 ETSAV FC707 ETPI2FS
SD728 ETSAV1 FC708 ETPI3FS
DD701 (Cold) ETPI0U FC709 ETPI0
DD701 (Hot) ETPI0HU FC710 ETPI1
DD702 (Cold) ETPI0U FC711 ETPI2
DD702 (Hot) ETPI0HU FC712 ETPI3
FV701 ETPI0FT FC713 ETPI0FYWD
FV702 ETPI1FT FC714 ETPI1FYWD
FV703 ETPI2FT FC715 ETPI2FYWD
FV704 ETPI3FT FC716 ETPI3FYWD
FV705 ETPI0FTS FC717 ETPI0FSWD
FV706 ETPI1FTS FC718 ETPI1FSWD
FV707 ETPI2FTS FC719 ETPI2FSWD
FV708 ETPI3FTS FC720 ETPI3FSWD
TABLE H – SERIES 700 CONTROLLER (DC DRIVE) TO SERIES 7000 CONTROLLER
700 CONTROLLER 7000 CONT. ASSEMBLY 700 CONTROLLER 7000 CONT. ASSEMBLY
ETPR0, ETPD0 ETPX0 ETPR2FTWD, ETPD2FTWD ETPXNCD
ETPR1, ETPD1 ETPXN ETPR3FTWD, ETPD3FTWD ETPX3FTWD
ETPR1MP ETPX1MP ETPR0FTBWD ETPXNFTBWD
ETPR2, ETPD2 ETPXN ETPR1FTBWD ETPXNFTBWD
ETPR3, ETPD3 ETPXN ETPR1FTBWDMP ETPX1FTBWDMP
ETPR0CD, ETPD0CD ETPX0CD ETPR2FTBWD ETPXNFTBWD
ETPR1CD, ETPD1CD ETPXNCD ETPR3FTBWD ETPX3FTBWD
ETPR1CDMP ETPX1CDMP ETPR0FTSWD,

ETPD0FTSWD

ETPXNFTSWD
ETPR2CD, ETPD2CD ETPXNCD ETPR1FTSWD,

ETPD1FTSWD

ETPXNFTSWD
ETPR3CD, ETPD3CD ETPXNCD ETPR1FTSWDMP ETPX1FTSWDMP
ETPR1A, ETPD1A ETPXN ETPR2FTSWD,

ETPD2FTSWD

ETPXNFTSWD
ETPR1AMP ETPX1MP ETPR3FTSWD,

ETPD3FTSWD

ETPX3FTSWD
ETPR2A, ETPD2A ETPXN ETPR0FY, ETPD0FY ETPXNFY
ETPR3A, ETPD3A ETPXN ETPR1FY, ETPD1FY ETPXNFY
ETPR1AWD, ETPD1AWD ETPXNCD ETPR1FYMP ETPX1FYMP
ETPR1AWMP ETPX1CDMP ETPR2FY, ETPD2FY ETPXNFY
ETPR2AWD, ETPD2AWD ETPXNCD ETPR3FY, ETPD3FY ETPX3FY
ETPR3AWD, ETPD3AWD ETPXNCD ETPR0FB ETPXNFB
ETSRVC, ETSRV, ETSDV ETPXVC ETPR1FB ETPXNFB
ETSRVP, ETSRV, ETSDV ETPXVP ETPR1FBMP ETPX1FBMP
ETSRV1, ETSDV1 ETPXV1 ETPR2FB ETPXNFB
ETPD0U ETPX0U ETPR3FB ETPX3FB
ETPD0HU ETPX0HU ETPR0FS, ETPD0FS ETPXNFS
ETPR0FT, ETPD0FT ETPXN ETPR1FS, ETPD1FS ETPXNFS
ETPR1FT, ETPD1FT ETPXN ETPR1FSMP ETPX1FSMP
ETPR1FTMP ETPX1FTMP ETPR2FS, ETPD2FS ETPXNFS
ETPR2FT, ETPD2FT ETPXN ETPR3FS, ETPD3FS ETPX3FS
ETPR3FT, ETPD3FT ETPX3FT ETPR0FYWD, ETPD0FYWD ETPXNFYWD
ETPR0FTB ETPXNFTB ETPR1FYWD, ETPD1FYWD ETPXNFYWD
ETPR1FTB ETPXNFTB ETPR1FYWDMP ETPX1FYWDMP
ETPR1FTBMP ETPXNFTBMP ETPR2FYWD, ETPD2FYWD ETPXNFYWD
ETPR2FTB ETPXNFTB ETPR3FYWD, ETPD3FYWD ETPX3FYWD
ETPR3FTB ETPX3FTB ETPR0FBWD ETPXNFBWD
ETPR0FTS, ETPD0FTS ETPXNFTS ETPR1FBWD ETPXNFBWD
ETPR1FTS, ETPD1FTS ETPXNFTS ETPR1FBWDMP ETPX1FBWDMP
ETPR1FTSMP ETPX1FTSMP ETPR2FBWD ETPXNFBWD
ETPR2FTS, ETPD2FTS ETPXNFTS ETPR3FBWD ETPX3FBWD
ETPR3FTS, ETPD3FTS ETPX3FTS ETPR0FSWD, ETPD0FSWD ETPXNFSWD
ETPR0FTWD, ETPD0FTWD ETPXNCD ETPR1FSWD, ETPD1FSWD ETPXNFSWD
ETPR1FTWD, ETPD1FTWD ETPXNCD ETPR1FSWDMP ETPX1FSWDMP
ETPR1FTWDMP ETPX1FTWDMP ETPR2FSWD, ETPD2FSWD ETPXNFSWD
ETPR3FSWD, ETPD3FSWD ETPX3FSWD
TABLE J – SERIES 700 CONTROLLER (AC DRIVE NO SUFFIX) TO SERIES 7000
700 CONTROLLER 7000 CONTROLLER

ASSEMBLY

700 CONTROLLER 7000 CONTROLLER

ASSEMBLY

ETPI0 ETPX0 ETPI2FTW ETPXNFTWS
ETPI1 ETPXN ETPI3FTW ETPX3FTWS
ETPI2 ETPXN ETPI0FTWS ETPXNFTWS
ETPI3 ETPXN ETPI1FTWS ETPXNFTWS
ETPI0CD ETPX0CD ETPI2FTWS ETPXNFTWS
ETPI1CD ETPXNCD ETPI3FTWS ETPX3FTWS
ETPI2CD ETPXNCD ETPI0FTWD ETPXNCD
ETPI3CD ETPXNCD ETPI1FTWD ETPXNCD
ETPI1A ETPXN ETPI2FTWD ETPXNCD
ETPI2A ETPXN ETPI3FTWD ETPX3FTWD
ETPI3A ETPXN ETPI0FTSWD ETPXNFTSWD
ETPI1AWD ETPXNCD ETPI1FTSWD ETPXNFTSWD
ETPI2AWD ETPXNCD ETPI2FTSWD ETPXNFTSWD
ETPI3AWD ETPXNCD ETPI3FTSWD ETPX3FTSWD
ETPI0V ETPXVC ETPI0FY ETPXNFY
ETSAV ETPXVP ETPI1FY ETPXNFY
ETSAV1 ETPXV1 ETPI2FY ETPXNFY
ETPI0U ETPX0U ETPI3FY ETPX3FY
ETPI0HU ETPX0HU ETPI0FS ETPXNFS
ETPI0FT ETPXN ETPI1FS ETPXNFS
ETPI1FT ETPXN ETPI2FS ETPXNFS
ETPI2FT ETPXN ETPI3FS ETPX3FS
ETPI3FT ETPX3FT ETPI0FYWD ETPXNFYWD
ETPI0FTS ETPXNFTS ETPI1FYWD ETPXNFYWD
ETPI1FTS ETPXNFTS ETPI2FYWD ETPXNFYWD
ETPI2FTS ETPXNFTS ETPI3FYWD ETPX3FYWD
ETPI3FTS ETPX3FTS ETPI0FSWD ETPXNFSWD
ETPI0FTW ETPXNFTWS ETPI1FSWD ETPXNFSWD
ETPI1FTW ETPXNFTWS ETPI2FSWD ETPXNFSWD
ETPI3FSWD ETPX3FSWD

STEP BY STEP GUIDE TO FINDING SERIES 7000 MODULE LISTS

In most applications, a Series 7000 controller assembly can be repaired by replacing the faulty module rather than the whole assembly.

If you know the Series 7000 Module Model Number:

      1. Go to Table N to find the LIST.

If you know the Series 7000 Sequence Number:

  1. Go to Table L to find the Series 7000 Controller Assembly.
  2. Go to Table M to find the find the modules used on the Series 7000 Controller assembly.
  3. Go to Table N to find the module LIST.

OR

  1. Find the Module Model Number from the sequence submittal drawing.
  2. Go to Table N to find the module LIST.

LIST

TABLE K – SERIES 7000 CONTROLLER ASSEMBLY SEQUENCE AND LIST LISTS
7000 CONTROLLER ASSEMBLY
Model No. Part No. Sequence(s)
ETPX0 66-000-0000 SD70001
ETPXN 66-000-0001 SD70011, FV7001
ETPX1MP 66-000-0002 SD7003
ETPX1LP 66-000-0003 SD7004
ETPX1HP 66-000-0004 SD7005
ETPX0CD 66-000-0005 SD7100
ETPXNCD 66-000-0006 SD7101, FV7101
ETPX1CDMP 66-000-0007 SD7103
ETPX1CDLP 66-000-0008 SD7104
ETPX1CDHP 66-000-0009 SD7105
ETPX0WD 66-000-0010 SD7300
ETPXNWD 66-000-0011 SD7301, FV7301
ETPX1WDMP 66-000-0012 SD7303
ETPX1WDLP 66-000-0013 SD7304
ETPX1WDHP 66-000-0014 SD7305
ETPXVC 66-000-0015 SD7600
ETPXVP 66-000-0016 SD7606
ETPXV1 66-000-0017 SD7607
ETPX0U 66-000-0087 DD7200
ETPX0HU 66-000-0088 DD7200
ETPX3FT 66-000-0054 FV7002
ETPX1FTMP 66-000-0055 FV7003
ETPX1FTLP 66-000-0056 FV7004
ETPX1FTHP 66-000-0057 FV7005
ETPX3FTWD 66-000-0058 FV7102
ETPX1FTWDMP 66-000-0059 FV7103
ETPX1FTWDLP 66-000-0060 FV7104
ETPX1FTWDHP 66-000-0061 FV7105
ETPXNFTB 66-000-0062 FV7201
ETPX3FTB 66-000-0063 FV7202
ETPXNFTBMP 66-000-0064 FV7203
ETPXNFTBLP 66-000-0065 FV7204
ETPXNFTBHP 66-000-0066 FV7205
ETPX3FTUD 66-000-0067 FV7302
ETPX1FTUDMP 66-000-0068 FV7303
ETPX1FTUDLP 66-000-0069 FV7304
ETPX1FTUDHP 66-000-0070 FV7305
ETPXNFTBWD 66-000-0071 FV7401
ETPX3FTBWD 66-000-0072 FV7402
ETPX1FTBWDMP 66-000-0073 FV7403
ETPX1FTBWDLP 66-000-0074 FV7404
ETPX1FTBWDHP 66-000-0075 FV7405
ETPXNFTBCD 66-000-0076 FV7501
ETPX3FTBCD 66-000-0077 FV7502
ETPX1FTBCDMP 66-000-0078 FV7503
ETPX1FTBCDLP 66-000-0079 FV7504
ETPX1FTBCDHP 66-000-0080 FV7505
ETPXNFTSWD 66-000-0081 FV7601
ETPX3FTSWD 66-000-0082 FV7602
ETPX1FTSWDMP 66-000-0083 FV7603
ETPXNFTS 66-000-0084 FV7701
ETPX3FTS 66-000-0085 FV7702
ETPX1FTSMP 66-000-0086 FV7703
ETPXNFTWS 66-000-0092 FV7801, FV7901
ETPX3FTWS 66-000-0128 FV7802, FV7902
ETPXNFY 66-000-0018 FC7001
ETPX3FY 66-000-0019 FC7002
ETPX1FYMP 66-000-0020 FC7003
ETPX1FYLP 66-000-0021 FC7004
ETPX1FYHP 66-000-0022 FC7005
ETPXNFYWD 66-000-0023 FC7101
ETPX3FYWD 66-000-0024 FC7102
ETPX1FYWDMP 66-000-0025 FC7103
ETPX1FYWDLP 66-000-0026 FC7104
ETPX1FYWDHP 66-000-0027 FC7105
ETPXNFB 66-000-0028 FC7201
ETPX3FB 66-000-0029 FC7202
ETPX1FBMP 66-000-0030 FC7203
ETPX1FBLP 66-000-0031 FC7204
ETPX1FBHP 66-000-0032 FC7205
ETPXNFYUD 66-000-0033 FC7301
ETPX3FYUD 66-000-0034 FC7302
ETPX1FYUDMP 66-000-0035 FC7303
ETPX1FYUDLP 66-000-0036 FC7304
ETPX1FYUDHP 66-000-0037 FC7305
ETPXNFBWD 66-000-0038 FC7401
ETPX3FBWD 66-000-0039 FC7402
ETPX1FBWDMP 66-000-0040 FC7403
ETPX1FBWDLP 66-000-0041 FC7404
ETPX1FBWDHP 66-000-0042 FC7405
ETPXNFBCD 66-000-0043 FC7501
ETPX3FBCD 66-000-0044 FC7502
ETPX1FBCDMP 66-000-0045 FC7503
ETPX1FBCDLP 66-000-0046 FC7504
ETPX1FBCDHP 66-000-0047 FC7505
ETPXNFSWD 66-000-0048 FC7601
ETPX3FSWD 66-000-0049 FC7602
ETPX1FSWDMP 66-000-0050 FC7603
ETPXNFS 66-000-0051 FC7701
ETPX3FS 66-000-0052 FC7702
ETPX1FSMP 66-000-0053 FC7703

Note:

1. The fan was hardwired on for obsolete 700 sequences FC709-FC712, so the wiring diagram is the same as one for a single duct.

TABLE L – SERIES 7000 SEQUENCE TO CONTROLLER ASSEMBLY CROSS REFERENCE
7000 SEQUENCE CONTROLLER ASSEMBLY 7000 SEQUENCE CONTROLLER ASSEMBLY
SD7000 ETPX0 FV7502 ETPX3FTBCD
SD7001 ETPXN FV7503 ETPX1FTBCDMP
SD7003 ETPX1MP FV7504 ETPX1FTBLDMP
SD7004 ETPX1LP FV7505 ETPX1FTBHDMP
SD7005 ETPX1HP FV7601 ETPXNFTSWD
SD7100 ETPX0CD FV7602 ETPX3FTSWD
SD7101 ETPXNCD FV7603 ETPX1FTSWDMP
SD7103 ETPX1CDMP FV7701 ETPXNFTS
SD7104 ETPX1CDLP FV7702 ETPX3FTS
SD7105 ETPX1CDHP FV7703 ETPX1FTSMP
SD7300 ETPX0WD FV7801 ETPXNFTWS
SD7301 ETPXNWD FV7802 ETPX3FTWS
SD7303 ETPX1WDMP FV7901 ETPXNFTWS
SD7304 ETPX1WDLP FV7902 ETPX3FTWS
SD7305 ETPX1WDHP FC7001 ETPXNFY
SD7600 ETPXVC FC7002 ETPX3FY
SD7606 ETPXVP FC7003 ETPX1FYMP
SD7607 ETPXV1 FC7004 ETPX1FYLP
DD7100 (Cold) ETPX0U FC7005 ETPX1FYHP
DD7100 (Hot) ETPXVC FC7101 ETPXNFYWD
DD7200 (Cold) ETPX0U FC7102 ETPX3FYWD
DD7200 (Hot) ETPX0HU FC7103 ETPX1FYWDMP
DD7300 (Cold) ETPX0U FC7104 ETPX1FYWDLP
DD7300 (Hot) ETPXVC FC7105 ETPX1FYWDHP
FV7001 ETPXN FC7201 ETPXNFB
FV7002 ETPX3FT FC7202 ETPX3FB
FV7003 ETPX1FTMP FC7203 ETPX1FBMP
FV7004 ETPX1FTLP FC7204 ETPX1FBLP
FV7005 ETPX1FTHP FC7205 ETPX1FBHP
FV7101 ETPXNCD FC7301 ETPXNFYUB
FV7102 ETPX3FTWD FC7302 ETPX3FYUB
FV7103 ETPX1FTWDMP FC7303 ETPX1FYUBMP
FV7104 ETPX1FTWDLP FC7304 ETPX1FYUBLP
FV7105 ETPX1FTWDHP FC7305 ETPX1FYUBHP
FV7201 ETPXNFTB FC7401 ETPXNFBWD
FV7202 ETPX3FTB FC7402 ETPX3FBWD
FV7203 ETPX1FTBMP FC7403 ETPX1FBWDMP
FV7204 ETPX1FTBLP FC7404 ETPX1FBWDLP
FV7205 ETPX1FTBHP FC7405 ETPX1FBWDHP
FV7301 ETPXNWD FC7501 ETPXNFBCD
FV7302 ETPX3FTUD FC7502 ETPX3FBCD
FV7303 ETPX1FTUDMP FC7503 ETPX1FBCDMP
FV7304 ETPX1FTUDLP FC7504 ETPX1FBCDLP
FV7305 ETPX1FTUDHP FC7505 ETPX1FBCDHP
FV7401 ETPXNFTBWD FC7601 ETPXNFSWD
FV7402 ETPX3FTBWD FC7602 ETPX3FSWD
FV7403 ETPX1FTBWDMP FC7603 ETPX1FSWDMP
FV7404 ETPX1FTBWDLP FC7701 ETPXNFS
FV7405 ETPX1FTBWDHP FC7702 ETPX3FS
FV7501 ETPXNFTBCD FC7703 ETPX1FSMP
TABLE M – SERIES 7000 MODULE CROSS REFERENCE (1 of 2)
MODULES USED
CONTROLLER ASSEMBLY MASTER HEAT / FAN SETBACK / WARMUP FLOW

CONTROL

ETPX0 ETPM7
ETPXN ETPM7 ETPH3
ETPX1MP ETPM7 ETPHM1
ETPX1LP ETPM7 ETPHM2
ETPX1HP ETPM7 ETPHM3
ETPX0CD ETPM7 ETPCO
ETPXNCD ETPM7 ETPH3 ETPCO
ETPX1CDMP ETPM7 ETPHM1 ETPCO
ETPX1CDLP ETPM7 ETPHM2 ETPCO
ETPX1CDHP ETPM7 ETPHM3 ETPCO
ETPX0WD ETPM7 ETPW
ETPXNWD ETPM7 ETPH3 ETPW
ETPX1WDMP ETPM7 ETPHM1 ETPW
ETPX1WDLP ETPM7 ETPHM2 ETPW
ETPX1WDHP ETPM7 ETPHM3 ETPW
ETPXVC ETPM7 ETPCV2
ETPXVP ETPM7 ETPCV2
ETPXV1 ETPM7-2 ETPCV2
ETPX0U ETPM7 ETPUC
ETPXVC ETPM7 ETPCV2
ETPX0U ETPM7 ETPUC
ETPX0HU ETPM7 ETPUH
ETPX0U ETPM7 ETPUC
ETPXVC ETPM7 ETPCV2
ETPX3FT ETPM7 ETPH4
ETPX1FTMP ETPM7 ETPFVHM1
ETPX1FTLP ETPM7 ETPFVHM2
ETPX1FTHP ETPM7 ETPFVHM3
ETPX3FTWD ETPM7 ETPH4 ETPCO
ETPX1FTWDMP ETPM7 ETPFVHM1 ETPCO
ETPX1FTWDLP ETPM7 ETPFVHM2 ETPCO
ETPX1FTWDHP ETPM7 ETPFVHM3 ETPCO
ETPXNFTB ETPM7 ETPH3 ETPSB
ETPX3FTB ETPM7 ETPH4 ETPSB
ETPX1FTBMP ETPM7 ETPFVHM1 ETPSB
ETPX1FTBLP ETPM7 ETPFVHM2 ETPSB
ETPX1FTBHP ETPM7 ETPFVHM3 ETPSB
ETPX3FTUD ETPM7 ETPH4 ETPW
ETPX1FTUDMP ETPM7 ETPFVHM1 ETPW
ETPX1FTUDLP ETPM7 ETPFVHM2 ETPW
ETPX1FTUDHP ETPM7 ETPFVHM3 ETPW
TABLE M – SERIES 7000 MODULE CROSS REFERENCE (2 of 2)
MODULES USED
CONTROLLER ASSEMBLY MASTER HEAT / FAN SETBACK / WARMUP FLOW

CONTROL

ETPXNFTBWD ETPM7 ETPH3 ETPWSB
ETPX3FTBWD ETPM7 ETPH4 ETPWSB
ETPX1FTBWDMP ETPM7 ETPFVHM1 ETPWSB
ETPX1FTBWDLP ETPM7 ETPFVHM2 ETPWSB
ETPX1FTBWDHP ETPM7 ETPFVHM3 ETPWSB
ETPXNFTBCD ETPM7 ETPH3 ETPCOSB ETPECO
ETPX3FTBCD ETPM7 ETPH4 ETPCOSB ETPECO
ETPX1FTBCDMP ETPM7 ETPFVHM1 ETPCOSB ETPECO
ETPX1FTBLDMP ETPM7 ETPFVHM2 ETPCOSB ETPECO
ETPX1FTBHDMP ETPM7 ETPFVHM3 ETPCOSB ETPECO
ETPXNFY ETPM7 ETPFH2
ETPX3FY ETPM7 ETPFH3
ETPX1FYMP ETPM7 ETPFHM1
ETPX1FYLP ETPM7 ETPFHM2
ETPX1FYHP ETPM7 ETPFHM3
ETPXNFYWD ETPM7 ETPFH2 ETPCO
ETPX3FYWD ETPM7 ETPFH3 ETPCO
ETPX1FYWDMP ETPM7 ETPFHM1 ETPCO
ETPX1FYWDLP ETPM7 ETPFHM2 ETPCO
ETPX1FYWDHP ETPM7 ETPFHM3 ETPCO
ETPXNFB ETPM7 ETPFH2 ETPSB
ETPX3FB ETPM7 ETPFH3 ETPSB
ETPX1FBMP ETPM7 ETPFHM1 ETPSB
ETPX1FBLP ETPM7 ETPFHM2 ETPSB
ETPX1FBHP ETPM7 ETPFHM3 ETPSB
ETPXNFYUB ETPM7 ETPFH2 ETPW
ETPX3FYUB ETPM7 ETPFH3 ETPW
ETPX1FYUBMP ETPM7 ETPFHM1 ETPW
ETPX1FYUBLP ETPM7 ETPFHM2 ETPW
ETPX1FYUBHP ETPM7 ETPFHM3 ETPW
ETPXNFBWD ETPM7 ETPFH2 ETPWSB
ETPX3FBWD ETPM7 ETPFH3 ETPWSB
ETPX1FBWDMP ETPM7 ETPFHM1 ETPWSB
ETPX1FBWDLP ETPM7 ETPFHM2 ETPWSB
ETPX1FBWDHP ETPM7 ETPFHM3 ETPWSB
ETPXNFBCD ETPM7 ETPFH2 ETPCOSB ETPECO
ETPX3FBCD ETPM7 ETPFH3 ETPCOSB ETPECO
ETPX1FBCDMP ETPM7 ETPFHM1 ETPCOSB ETPECO
ETPX1FBCDLP ETPM7 ETPFHM2 ETPCOSB ETPECO
ETPX1FBCDHP ETPM7 ETPFHM3 ETPCOSB ETPECO
TABLE N – SERIES 6000 AND 7000 MODULE LIST LISTS
MODULE MODEL NO. PART NO. LIST MODULE MODEL NO. PART NO. LIST
ETPM6 B63-002-2059 ETPFHM2 B63-007-2060
ETPM7 B63-001-2059 ETPFHM3 B63-008-2060
ETPM7-2 B63-003-2059 ETPCO B63-003-2061
ETPH3 B63-001-2060 ETPCO6 B63-006-2061
ETPH4 B63-012-2060 ETPSB B63-001-2061
ETPHM1 B63-002-2060 ETPWSB B63-005-2061
ETPHM2 B63-003-2060 ETPW B63-002-2061
ETPHM3 B63-004-2060 ETPCOSB B63-004-2061
ETPFVHM1 B63-009-2060 ETPS B63-008-2061
ETPFVHM2 B63-010-2060 ETPWS B63-009-2061
ETPFVHM3 B63-011-2060 ETPSXW B63-012-2061
ETPFH2 B63-005-2060 ETPECO B63-001-2062
ETPFH3 B63-013-2060 ETPCV2 B63-002-2062
ETPFH3-6 B63-015-2060 ETPUC B63-003-2062
ETPFHM1 B63-006-2060 ETPUH B63-004-2062
ELECTRONIC CONTROLS RETROFIT KITS
Single Duct Pressure Independent
Sequence LIST Sequence LIST Sequence LIST
RFTSD7000 RFTSD7101 $428 RFTSD7303
RFTSD7001 RFTSD7103 $476 RFTSD7304
RFTSD7003 RFTSD7104 $488 RFTSD7305
RFTSD7004 RFTSD7105 $476 RFTSD7600
RFTSD7005 RFTSD7300 $424 RFTSD7606
RFTSD7100 RFTSD7301 $428 RFTSD7607
Parallel Flow Fan Powered Pressure Independent
Sequence LIST Sequence LIST Sequence LIST
RFTFV7001 RFTFV7201 $479 RFTFV7501
RFTFV7002 RFTFV7202 $520 RFTFV7502
RFTFV7003 RFTFV7203 $486 RFTFV7503
RFTFV7004 RFTFV7204 $554 RFTFV7504
RFTFV7005 RFTFV7205 $486 RFTFV7505
RFTFV7101 RFTFV7301 $531 RFTFV7401
RFTFV7102 RFTFV7302 $538 RFTFV7402
RFTFV7103 RFTFV7303 $531 RFTFV7403
RFTFV7104 RFTFV7304 $575 RFTFV7404
RFTFV7105 RFTFV7305 $531 RFTFV7405
Series Flow Fan Powered Pressure Independent
Sequence LIST Sequence LIST Sequence LIST
RFTFC7001 RFTFC7201 $516 RFTFC7501
RFTFC7002 RFTFC7202 $594 RFTFC7502
RFTFC7003 RFTFC7203 $516 RFTFC7503
RFTFC7004 RFTFC7204 $526 RFTFC7504
RFTFC7005 RFTFC7205 $516 RFTFC7505
RFTFC7101 RFTFC7301 $538 RFTFC7401
RFTFC7102 RFTFC7302 $583 RFTFC7402
RFTFC7103 RFTFC7303 $538 RFTFC7403
RFTFC7104 RFTFC7304 $548 RFTFC7404
RFTFC7105 RFTFC7305 $538 RFTFC7405

Notes:

  1. Electronic retrofit kits include 50VA transformer (must specify voltage), controller, thermostat, enclosure, electric actuator, mount and wire, duct sensor (if applicable), pressure switch (if applicable), and

fan relay with fan powered terminals. Components are mounted and wired in a NEMA 1 control enclosure.

  1. Actuator capable of controlling dampers up to 90°stroke range with 35 in. lbs. of torque.
  2. For fan powered applications, specify fan voltage and horsepower if retrofit includes fan relay and/or transformer. If relay and transformer are not required, deduct $21 List each.
  3. Prior to receiving the retrofit kits, please download the 7000 Installation Operation & Maintenance Manual from www.enviro-tec.com and forward to your customer for start up and balancing of the unit.
PNEUMATIC CONTROLS RETROFIT KITS
Single Duct Pressure Independent – Standard Controller
Control Sequence LIST Control Sequence LIST
SD404R, 405R SD428R, 429R
SD406R, 407R SD430R, 431R
SD408R, 409R, 448R – 451R SD432R – 435R
SD410R, 411R SD452R, 453R
SD412R, 413R SD454R, 455R
SD414R, 415R, 420R – 423R
Single Duct Pressure Independent – Multi-Function CSC-3016 Controller
Control Sequence LIST Control Sequence LIST
SD404RC – 407RC SD428RC – 431RC
SD408RC – 411RC SD432RC – 435RC
SD412RC – 415RC SD452RC – 455RC
SD420RC – 423RC

Notes:

1. Pneumatic retrofit kit includes actuator (35 in. lbs. of torque) with linkage for 90°dampers, controller, relays as shown on sequence diagrams, and all necessary tubing mounted on a plate.

ROTARY ACTUATORS AND INTERFACES
MODEL NO. PART NO. DESCRIPTION LIST
M9104-IGA-3S PC-02-0400 JCI ELECTRONIC ACTUATOR M9104-IGA-3S
LM24 PC-02-0402 ACTUATOR,ELEC,2-10V INPUT
ETAC B63-000-2055 DC TO AC REVERSE RECTIFIER INTERFACE
ETADC B63-001-2066 AC TO DC RECTIFIER INTERFACE
ETADC1 B63-002-2066 AC TO DC RECTIFIER “DUAL” ACTUATOR
MISCELLANEOUS ELECTRONIC PARTS
BXM-32 PE-19-0601 TEST LEADS (TEST & BALANCE)
FUSE 1 PE-06-5001 1 AMP 3AG 1.25″ GLASS FUSE
FUSE 2 PE-06-5002 2 AMP 3AG 1.25″ GLASS FUSE
29-00-236 29-00-236 7000 CONTROLLER MOUNTING BRACKET — INCLUDES STANDOFFS
ETDS B64-00-001 INLET DUCT SENSOR-700 or 7000 Controls
ETCALKIT 63-001-3001 TEST LEADS AND ADJUSTMENT TOOL

Notes:

  1. ETAC: DC to AC rectifier required if replacing a 2 wire (DC) actuator with the PC-02-0400 AC actuator.
  2. ETADC: AC to DC rectifier required if replacing existing 700 controller w/ 7000 controller (verify damper motor is a 2 wire [DC]).
  3. Installation and Operations Manual (IOM) is available online. (No Login required)
THERMOSTAT ACCESSORIES
ETSTKITC B63-001-3000 2″ TTAT MOUNTING KIT WITH CONCEALED SETPOINT
ETSTKITPF B63-002-3000 2″ TTAT MNTG. KIT WITH EXPOSED SETPOINT W/FAHRENHEIT SCALE
ETSTKITPC B63-003-3000 2″ TTAT MNTG. KIT WITH EXPOSED SETPOINT W/CELCIUS SCALE

©2014 Johnson Controls, Inc.

Healthcare group purchasing organizations (GPOs)

Healthcare group purchasing organizations (GPOs) are organizations that negotiate discounts on behalf of their member hospitals and other healthcare providers on a range of products and services, including medical supplies, equipment, and pharmaceuticals. GPOs are designed to help healthcare providers reduce costs and improve efficiency by leveraging the collective purchasing power of their members.

There are several key benefits to healthcare GPOs:

  1. Cost savings: GPOs negotiate discounts with suppliers on behalf of their member hospitals and other healthcare providers. These discounts can be significant, and can result in significant cost savings for the members of the GPO.
  2. Efficiency: GPOs can help healthcare providers streamline their purchasing processes and reduce the time and effort required to purchase products and services.
  3. Quality: GPOs often have quality standards in place that suppliers must meet in order to participate in the GPO. This helps ensure that member hospitals and other healthcare providers are purchasing high-quality products and services.
  4. Compliance: GPOs can help member hospitals and other healthcare providers stay compliant with relevant laws and regulations, including those related to procurement and contracting.

There are several types of GPOs in the healthcare industry, including national and regional GPOs, as well as GPOs that serve specific types of healthcare providers, such as hospitals, nursing homes, and home healthcare agencies.

GPOs have come under scrutiny in recent years due to concerns about their transparency and potential conflicts of interest. Some critics argue that GPOs may prioritize the interests of their suppliers over those of their member hospitals and other healthcare providers, leading to higher prices and reduced savings. However, proponents of GPOs argue that they play a valuable role in the healthcare system by helping to reduce costs and improve efficiency.

In conclusion, healthcare GPOs are organizations that negotiate discounts on behalf of their member hospitals and other healthcare providers on a range of products and services. They can offer significant cost savings and improved efficiency, but have also faced criticism due to concerns about transparency and potential conflicts of interest.

Samsung Galaxy s22 Smartphone w/ Google Fi Service

What plans does Google Fi offer?

Google Fi offers a variety of plans to choose from, including a data-only plan for those who just need internet access, and a 5g plan for those who want the fastest speeds possible. There is also a plan for people who have a Pixel phone, as well as a Samsung Galaxy S22. The latter two plans come with a free Sim card, while the data-only plan requires you to purchase a Sim card separately. Google Fi also offers a discount on taxes applicable to your Fi bill since Google Fi is a tax-exempt entity.

What features does Google Fi offer?

Google Fi is a phone plan designed for the way people use their phones today. With Fi, you get high-speed data in over 200 countries and territories for the same price you pay at home, calls to and from anywhere in the world for no additional charge, and easy ways to stay connected with friends and family.

There are three main features that make Google Fi unique:

1. Data: Fi customers get high-speed data in over 200 countries and territories for the same price they pay at home. And if you run out of data, your phone will automatically connect to a free public Wi-Fi hotspot.

2. Calls: With Fi, you can make calls to and from anywhere in the world for no additional charge.

3. Messages: The Google Fi app comes with Google Messages pre-installed, so you can easily send texts, photos, and videos without using up your data.

What phones does Google Fi offer?

Google Fi offers a variety of Android phones, including the Motorola designed for Fi, as well as iPhones that work with the network. You can also use Wi-Fi with your Google Fi phone.

What is Google Fi, and how does it work?

Google Fi is a phone plan designed to give you the best possible experience, whether you’re at home or abroad. It uses a combination of three different networks – Wi-Fi, SIM and Galaxy Z Fold 4 – to give you the best possible signal strength and coverage. You can also use it to send texts and make calls over data-only networks, like LTE. And because your number is attached to your Fi account, you can use it on any Android phone.

What are the best phones for Google Fi?

Google Fi is a wireless service designed for Fi phones. It offers the best coverage with 5G and Wi-Fi, and the best prices with no contracts. The Google Fi app is also designed for Fi, so you can manage your account, find new ways to save, and stay connected even when you’re abroad. And with Pixel, you get the best of Google Fi with the world’s best smartphone camera.

Which phones are Designed for Fi?

Fi is a phone service by Google that uses multiple carriers to give you the best possible coverage. One of the great things about Fi is that you can use any phone with it, as long as it’s unlocked and has a compatible SIM card. That means you’re not tied to a specific carrier or phone brand. You can even bring your own phone to Fi.

However, there are some phones that are designed specifically for Fi. Google’s own Pixel phones are a great option, as they’re designed to work seamlessly with Fi’s network. Samsung’s Galaxy S22 and Galaxy Z Fold 4 are also great choices, as they support Fi’s 5G network. If you’re looking for the best possible experience with Fi, these are the phones to get.

Which phones are compatible with Fi?

Google Fi is a unique cell phone service that’s designed to work with a variety of different phones. You can use any unlocked Android phone or iPhone with Fi, and you’ll get access to features like 5G data and international calling. If you’re looking for a phone that’s designed specifically for Fi, Google offers a few different options. The Pixel 3a and 4a are both great choices, and they offer features like unlimited storage for your photos and videos. If you have an iPhone, the iPhone SE is a great option for Fi. It’s less expensive than some of the other options, but it still has all the features you need.

Does Google Fi support 5G?

As of October 2020, Google Fi does not support 5G. Though the service is designed for Fi phones, like the Pixel and Pixel 6, it is not currently compatible with any 5G network. Google is working on making Fi more widely available, but as of right now, it only works with select devices on select carriers.

What if I need Google Fi support?

If you need support for Google Fi, there are a few options available to you. You can visit the Google Fi Help Center online, where you can find answers to common questions and problems. You can also contact Google Fi support by phone or email. Finally, if you’re a Google Fi subscriber, you can access the Fi Community Forum, where you can ask questions and get help from other Fi users.

What happens if something goes wrong with my Google Fi phone?

What happens if something goes wrong with my Google Fi phone?

If you have any problems with your Google Fi service or phone, you can use the Google Fi app to troubleshoot or contact Google Fi support. The Google Fi app will help you through any issue you’re having and will even let you know if there’s an outage in your area.

How do I cancel Google Fi service?

If you’re interested in cancelling your Google Fi service, there are a few different ways that you can go about doing so. One way is to simply call Google Fi’s customer service number and request to cancel your service. Another way is to log into your Google Fi account online and follow the directions for cancelling service. Finally, if you signed up for Google Fi through a third-party provider, you’ll need to contact them directly to cancel your service.

Once you’ve decided how you’d like to cancel your service, it’s important to remember that you’ll still be responsible for paying off any remaining balance on your account. So if you have a phone that is financed through Google Fi, you’ll need to make sure that it is paid off before cancelling your service. Similarly, if you have any other outstanding charges on your account, you’ll need to take care of those before cancellation as well.

In short, there are a few different ways to go about cancelling your Google Fi service. Be aware that you may still have some financial obligations even after cancellation, and then take care of those before finalizing the cancellation process.

Can I use my Google Fi phone with another carrier?

Yes, you can use your Google Fi phone with another carrier, but you’ll need to use the Fi service to do so. The Fi service provides a way for you to connect to multiple networks, so you can get the best coverage possible. When you’re not using Fi, you can still use your phone as normal.

T-Mobile bought Sprint. Does that affect Google Fi?

T-Mobile’s purchase of Sprint affects Google Fi customers in a few ways. First, 5G support will eventually come to Google Fi. However, it’s unclear when this will happen. Second, customers with Sprint devices will need to unlock their device before using it on Google Fi. This process can be completed through the Google Fi website. Lastly, LTE features that make Google Fi unique, like wi-fi calling and data anchoring, will eventually be available on all major carriers. This means that customers won’t need to have a Google Pixel or another compatible device to use these features. 2022 is the earliest date that these changes could take place.

How much does Google Fi cost?

Google Fi is a mobile phone plan that offers flexible pricing. You can choose to pay by the gigabyte (GB) or get an unlimited data plan. The base price for a Google Fi plan is $20/mo for unlimited calls and texts, and $10/GB of data. If you go over your data limit, you’ll be charged $10/GB. There are no contracts or hidden fees with Google Fi.

Does Google Fi cover your area?

Google Fi does not have great coverage in rural areas. If you live in a rural area, your best bet is to check with your local carrier to see if they offer service in your area.

How does Google Fi work?

Google Fi is a phone plan that includes unlimited calls and texts, international data coverage in 200+ countries, no contracts, and no surprise bills. You can use your phone as normal with Fi—calls, texts, and mobile data will work just like they do on any other phone plan.

Your phone needs to be unlocked to work with Google Fi. If you have an Android phone, it’s probably already unlocked. If you have a Google Pixel, your phone will automatically unlock when you insert your Fi SIM card. If you’re not sure if your phone is unlocked, contact your carrier.

To get started with Fi, you’ll need a Google Account and a compatible phone. To sign up for Fi, visit fi.google.com/about on your computer or the Google Fi app on your Android phone. Follow the instructions to sign up for service. Once you’ve signed up, we’ll send you a free Fi SIM card that you can insert into your phone.

If you’re using a Pixel phone or another Android phone that’s designed for Fi, once you insert your SIM card, your phone will automatically connect to Fi’s network—no setup required. All you need to do is sign in to your Google Account and start using your phone as usual. Your calls, texts, and mobile data will work just like they do on any other phone plan.

If you’re using an iPhone or another type of smartphone not designed for Fi, you’ll need to set up your device so that it can connect to Fi’s network by following the instructions at fi.google.com/ios-setup. Once your device is connected to Fi’s network, you’ll be able to make calls, send texts, and use mobile data like normal.

Is my phone unlocked to use eSIM?

Is my phone unlocked to use eSIM?

The answer to this question depends on your specific phone model and service provider. In general, however, most newer phone models come unlocked by default. This means that you should be able to use an eSIM with your phone without any issues. However, if your phone is locked, you may need to contact your service provider to unlock it before you can use eSIM.

Order a Google Fi SIM Kit

If you’re looking to use Google Fi, you’ll need to order a Google Fi SIM kit. This kit includes a SIM card that will allow you to unlock your phone and use it with Fi. You’ll also receive a confirmation email with instructions on how to activate your SIM card. Applicable taxes may apply.

Once you have your SIM card, you can use it in any compatible Android phone or one of Fi’s designed-for-Fi phones. You can check if your current phone is compatible with Fi by visiting fi.google.com/devices.

Designed for Fi models

Fi is a mobile network that uses the T-Mobile, Sprint, and US Cellular networks. It’s designed to be more flexible than other carriers, with an unlocked SIM card that you can use in any compatible phone. You can also choose between different data plans, including 5G service.

Pixel phones are designed for Fi, with features like high-speed data and Ultra 5G support. Moto G Power is another great option if you’re looking for a budget-friendly phone that still works with Fi. And if you’re looking to the future, Samsung Galaxy S21 will be compatible with Fi’s 5G service when it launches in 2022.

Apple models compatible with Fi

If you’re looking for an Apple device that’s compatible with Google Fi, you’re in luck. All of Apple’s current iPhones and iPad models are compatible with Fi’s network. That means you can enjoy the benefits of Fi’s fast, reliable Wi-Fi service no matter which Apple device you use.

Samsung models compatible with Fi

If you’re looking for a phone that’s compatible with Fi, you’ve got a few different Samsung models to choose from. The Galaxy S20, S20+, and S20 Ultra all work with Fi, and they come with a bunch of great features like Wi-Fi calling and sending texts over LTE. Plus, they’re all packed with top-of-the-line specs, so you know you’re getting a great phone no matter which one you choose.

LG models compatible with Fi

LG models that are compatible with Fi include the G7 ThinQ, V35 ThinQ, and V40 ThinQ. These phones all have wi-fi and LTE capabilities, making them ideal for use with the Fi service. Fi is a mobile service from Google that gives users access to multiple cellular networks, so they can always have the best signal possible.

Motorola models compatible with Fi

Motorola has a wide range of models that are compatible with Fi, including the Moto G Power and the Moto E LTE. You can unlock your phone with Wi-Fi or 5G, and enjoy fast speeds and reliable service.

OnePlus models compatible with Fi

OnePlus models that are compatible with Fi offer many benefits for users. With Fi, you can get access to high-speed data on Wi-Fi and LTE, so you can always stay connected. In addition, Fi gives you the ability to make calls and texts over Wi-Fi, so you can stay connected even when you’re not in service. And with Fi’s flexible plans, you can choose the data amount that fits your needs. So if you’re looking for a great way to stay connected, consider OnePlus models that are compatible with Fi.

Other models compatible with Fi

If you’re looking for other models that are compatible with Fi, you’re in luck. Many newer phones support Fi’s network switching, and you can bring your own device as long as it’s unlocked and compatible with T-Mobile, Sprint, or US Cellular. You can check the list of supported devices on Google’s website. Even if your phone isn’t on the list, as long as it’s a relatively new device and has Wi-Fi and LTE, it should work with Fi.

Best overall: Samsung Galaxy S22 Ultra 5G

The Samsung Galaxy S22 Ultra 5G is the best overall smartphone you can buy in 2021. It has a great camera system, a powerful Qualcomm Snapdragon 8 Gen 1 chipset, and 128GB of storage. It also supports 5G networks, making it one of the fastest smartphones on the market.

Also great: Samsung Galaxy S22 Plus

The Samsung Galaxy S22 Plus is also a great smartphone. It has a camera system that is compatible with Google Fi, a Snapdragon 8 Gen 1 chipset, and a battery life that is better than the Galaxy S21. The phone is also compatible with the OnePlus 10 Pro, but it is not as good as the camera on the OnePlus 10 Pro.

Best Google phone: Google Pixel 7 Pro

The Google Pixel 7 Pro is the best Google phone you can buy right now. It has a great design, a beautiful display, and a powerful camera. It also comes with the latest version of Android and an excellent processor. The only downside is that it’s not available on all carriers.

The Pixel 7 Pro is the successor to the Pixel 6 and 6 Pro. It features a slightly larger display than its predecessor, as well as a new camera system with two sensors. It’s powered by Qualcomm’s Snapdragon 888 chipset and has 8GB of RAM. The Pixel 7 Pro will be available in three storage options: 128GB, 256GB, and 512GB.

If you’re looking for the best Android phone you can buy, the Pixel 7 Pro is it. It has everything you could want in a smartphone, and it’s only going to get better over time. The only downside is that it doesn’t come cheap. If you’re willing to pay a premium price, the Pixel 7 Pro is the best Google phone you can buy right now.

Best affordable phone: Google Pixel 6a

The Google Pixel 6a is the best affordable phone on the market. It has a tensor processor which makes it one of the fastest smartphones available. The pixel 6 also has fi service which is a great feature for those who want to buy directly from Google. The price tag is very reasonable and the features that make this phone stand out are its OLED display and its fast charging capabilities. The pixel 6 pro also has some great features like an improved camera and water resistance. Overall, the Google Pixel 6a is the best affordable phone on the market and is a great alternative to more expensive iPhones.

Alternate best budget phone: Samsung Galaxy A53 5G

If you’re looking for an alternate best budget phone, the Samsung Galaxy A53 5G is a great option. With 5G compatibility and a mid-range price, this phone is a great option for those on a budget. The battery life is also impressive, with a 5,000mAh battery that can last up to two days on a single charge. Plus, the fingerprint sensor and IP67 rating make this phone a great option for those who want a durable and secure device.

Best value: Moto G Power (2022)

The Moto G Power is one of the best value phones you can buy in 2022. It has a 90hz display, Google Fi support, and 5G. The Mediatek Helio G37 processor is fast and the 4GB of RAM is plenty for most tasks. The 50MP camera takes great photos and the battery life is excellent. You can get the Moto G Power for a very good price and it’s a pretty good phone.

Best foldable phone: Samsung Galaxy Z Fold 4

The Samsung Galaxy Z Fold 4 is the best foldable phone on the market. It is compatible with Google Fi, and has a 50MP camera system. It is also the most expensive phone on this list. The Pixel 7 Pro is a close second, but it does not have 5G. The Galaxy S22 Ultra is the best phone for 2022, and it is listed as one of the best Google Fi phones.

Samsung Refrigerator Service Manual

4-1. Function for failure diagnosis 40

4-1-1) TEST MODE 40

4-1-2) DISPLAY FUNCTION OF COMMUNICATION ERROR 41

4-1-3) SELF-DIAGNOSTIC FUNCTION 42

4-1-4) DISPLAY FUNCTION OF LOAD CONDITION    45

4-1-5) EXHIBITION MODE SETTING FUNCTION 46

4-1-6) OPTION SETTING 46

4-1-7) Option TABLE 49

4-2. Diagnostic method according to the trouble symptom 51

4-2-1) IF THE TROUBLE IS DETECTED BY SELF-DIAGNOSIS 52

4-2-2) IF FAN DOES NOT OPERATE 60

4-2-3) IF ICE MAKER DOES NOT OPERATE 61

4-2-4) IF DEFROST DOES NOT OPERATE (F,R DEF 62

4-2-5) IF POWER IS NOT SUPPLIED 63

4-2-6) IF COMPRESSOR DOES NOT OPERATE 64

4-2-7) WHEN ALARM SOUND CONTINUOUS WITHOUT STOP 65

4-2-8) IF PANEL PCB DOES NOT WORK NORMALLY 67

4-2-9) IF PANTRY PANEL PCB IS NOT WORKING 68

4-2-10) WHEN REFRIGERATOR ROOM LAMP DOES NOT LIGHT UP 69

4-2-11) IF ICE WATER IS NOT SUPPLIED 70

4-2-12) IF WATER IS NOT SUPPLIED    71


4-1-1. Test mode (manual operation / manual defrost function)    

  • If Power Freeze & Fridge temperature control Key on the front of panel are pressed simultaneously for 8 seconds , it will be changed to the test mode and all displays on the front of panel will be off.
  • If any key on the front of panel is pressed within 15 seconds after the test mode, it will be operated as below sequence :

    manual operation(fresh food compartment) manual defrost of fresh food compartment(rd)
    manual defrost of fresh food and freezer compartments (Fd) Cancel(Display all off).

  • If any key on the front of panel is not pressed within 15 seconds after the test mode, the test

    mode will be canceled and it will be returned to previous mode.

    • Manual operation function



1-1) If any key is pressed once in test mode, blinks “FF” on the display and it indicates the refrigerator has entered the manual operation. At this moment, buzzer beeps as an alarm.

1-2) If manual operation is selected, comp will run at once without 5 minutes delay in any mode. If the refrigerator is on the defrost cycle at the moment, defrost will be finished and manual operation will begin.

(Be careful if manual operation get started at the moment of comp off, over load could be occurred)

1-3) If manual operation works, comp & f-fan operate continuously for 24 hours and fresh food compartment will be controlled by the setting temperature.

1-4) When the manual operation runs, setting temperature will be selected automatically as below: freezer compartment (-25), fresh food compartment (1).

1-5) During manual operation, Power Freeze & Power Cool function will not be worked. If a function is selected, the power function icon of the selected function will be off automatically after 10 seconds.

1-6) Manual operation can be canceled during manual operation by turning on the appliance after power off(reset) or choosing the step 4) test cancel mode.

1-7) Alarm(0.25 sec ON/ 0.75 sec OFF) will beep continuously until manual operation is completed and there is no function to make the sound stop.

  • Manual defrost(fresh food compartment) function


2-1) If any key is pressed one more time during manual operation(fresh food compartment), “rd” shows in the display and then manual operation will be canceled at once and fresh food compartment will be defrosted.

2-2) At this moment, alarm beeps for 3 seconds(0.1 sec ON/ 1 sec OFF) during manual defrost(fresh food compartment) function.

  • Simultaneous manual defrost(fresh food and freezer compartments) function


3-1) If any key is pressed one more time during manual defrost(defrost of fresh food compartment, “rd”), “Fd” shows on the display and then fresh food and freezer compartments defrost will operate.

Manual defrost of Fresh food and freezer compartments are followed by manual defrost freezer compartment.

3-2) At this moment, alarm beeps for 3 seconds (0.5 sec ON/ 0.5 sec OFF) during manual defrost function of fresh food and freezer compartment.

  • Test cancel mode

    4-1) During defrosting of fresh food and freezer compartments simultaneously, if the display panel change to the test mode and test button is pressed one more time, defrosting of fresh food and freezer compartments will be canceled at the same time and will return to the normal operation.

    Or, all test functions will be canceled by turning main power ON again after it OFF.

4-1-2. Display function of Communication error    

  • Display function when Panel
    MAIN MICOM communication has error

    1-1) If there is no answer for 10 seconds after the panel micom received the requirement of communication, “Pc – Er” display on the panel PCB will be ON/OFF alternately until the communication error is canceled. (0.5 sec ALL ON, 0.5 sec ALL OFF alternately)

(0.5 sec ALL ON, 0.5 sec ALL OFF alternately)

4-1-3. Self-diagnostic function    

  • Self-diagnostic function in the Initial power ON

    1-1) Micom operates self-diagnostic function to check the temperature sensor condition within 1 second when the refrigerator turned On initially.

    1-2) If bad sensor is detected by the self-diagnostic function, the applicable display LED will blink for 0.5 sec.

    At this moment, there is no beep sound.(Refer to self-diagnostic CHECK LIST)

    1-3) Self-diagnostic button is recognized only when the error is displayed by the bad sensor.

    Display does not operate normally but temperature control will be controlled by the emergency operation.

    1-4) When the error is detected by self-diagnosis, the error can be canceled automatically if all troubled sensors are corrected or Self-diagnostic function key (Power Freeze + Power Cool ) are pressed simultaneously for 8 seconds.

    (Return to normal display mode)



  • Self-diagnostic function during normal operation


2-1) If Power Freeze + Power Cool Key are pressed simultaneously for 6 seconds during normal operation, the temperature setting display will operate for 2 seconds (ON/OFF 0.5sec each).

If Power Freeze + Power Cool Key are pressed simultaneously for 8 seconds (including above 2 seconds), self-diagnostic function will be selected.

2-2) At this moment, self-diagnostic function will be returned with buzzer sound ‘ding-dong’.

If there is an error, display of error will be operated for 30 seconds and then return to normal condition whether problem is corrected or not.

(Refer to self-diagnosis CHECK LIST)

2-3) Input by button is not accepted during self-diagnostic function.

* Self-diagnosis CHECK LIST

NO

Trouble item

Display LED

Trouble contents

1

Ice Maker Sensor Error

R-1-

ICE MAKER SENSOR part error

2

R-Sensor Error

R-1-

FF SENSOR part error

3

R-DEF-Sensor Error

R-1-

FF defrost SENSOR part error

4

R-FAN Error

R-1-

FF inner fan motor part error

5

Ice Maker Error

R-1-

ICE MAKER operation error

6

R-DEF.Error

R-1-

FZ defrost part error

7

Ambient-Sensor Error

F-1-

External SENSOR part error

8

F-Sensor Error

F-1-

FZ SENSOR part error

9

F-DEF-Sensor Error

F-1-

FZ defrost SENSOR part error

10

F-FAN Error

F-1-

FZ inner fan motor part error

11

C-FAN Error

F-1-

Machine room fan motor part error

12

F-DEF. Error

F-1-

FZ defrost part error

13

Pantry-Damper-Heater Error

R-10-

Damper Heater open/wire error

14

Pantry-Sensor Error

R-10-

Pantry Room SENSOR part error

15

Panel Main MICOM communication Error

F-10-

Panel Main MICOM communication error

16

L    M communication Error

F-10-

LOAD Main MICOM communication error

F-10

F-1

R-10

R-1



* Self-diagnostics check list

LED

Item

Trouble contents

Diagnostic method

R-1-

Ice Maker Sensor Error

Display error : separation of sensor housing part, contact error, disconnection, short circuit

Display error of detecting temperature of sensor: more than
(+65°C) or less

than (-50°C)

When checking the voltage of MAIN PCB CN90

#3CN90#4 : shall be between 4.5V~1.0V.

R-1-

R-Sensor Error

When checking the voltage of MAIN PCB CN30#6 CN75#1:shall be between 4.5V~1.0V

R-1-

R-DEF-Sensor Error

When checking the voltage of MAIN PCB CN30#7 CN75#:shall be between 4.5V~1.0V

R-1-

R-FAN Error

Display error during operation of applicable fan motor : Feed Back signal line contact error, separation of motor wire, motor error Voltage of MAIN PCB CN75 Orange
Gray shall be between 7V~12V

R-1-

Ice Maker Error

Display error : ice making kit is harvested more than 3 times and level error

** Apply to the applicable Ice Maker model.

After replacing ice maker, check the operation by turning the appliance ON again.

R-1-

R-DEF. Error

Display error : separation of fresh food compartment defrost heater housing part, contact error, disconnection, short circuit or temperature fuse error.

Display error : the defrosting does not finish though fresh food compartment defrost is heating continuously for more than 80 minutes.

After separating MAIN PCB CN70,CN71 from PCB, check the resistance value between CN70 White CN71 Orange shall be 102(441) ohm 7%. (Resistant value is varied by the input power)

Check 0 Ohm : heater short, Ohm : wire / bimetal Open.

F-1-

Ambient-Sensor Error

Display error : sensor housing separation, contact error, disconnection, short circuit Display error by detecting temperature of sensor: more than (+65°C) or less than (-50°C) When checking the voltage of MAIN PCB CN32#1 #4 : shall be between 4.5V~1.0V.

F-1-

F-Sensor Error

When checking the voltage of MAIN PCB CN30#3 CN75#1:shall be between 4.5V~1.0V

F-1-

DEF-Sensor Error

When check the voltage of MAIN PCB CN30#4 CN75#1:shall be between 4.5V~1.0V

F-1-

F-FAN Error

Display error during operation of applicable fan motor : Feed Back signal line contact error, motor wire separation, motor error Voltage of MAIN PCB CN75 Yellow
Gray shall be between 7V~12V.

F-1-

C-FAN Error

Display error during operation of applicable fan motor : Feed Back signal line contact error, motor wire separation, motor error Voltage of MAIN PCB CN75 Sky-blue
Gray shall be between 7V~12V.

F-1-

F-DEF. Error

Display error : separation of freezer compartment defrost heater housing part , contact error, disconnection, short circuit or temperature fuse error. Display error : the defrosting does not finish though fresh food compartment compartment defrost is heating continuously for more than 70 minutes. After separating MAIN PCB CN70,CN71 from PCB, check the resistant value between CN70 brown CN71 Orange shall be 102(220) ohm
7%. (Resistant value is varied by input power) Check 0 Ohm : heater short,
Ohm : wire / bimetal Open.

R-10-

Pantry-Damper-Heater Error

Display error when open error is detected by damper heater : separation of Damper Heater housing part, contact error, disconnection, short circuit After separating MAIN PCB CN91from PCB, check the resistant value between Black
brown wire shall be 145 ohm
7%. Check 0 Ohm : heater short,
Ohm : wire / bimetal Open.

R-10-

Pantry-Sensor Error

Display error : separation of sensor housing, contact error, disconnection, short circuit.

Display error by detecting temperature of sensor: more

than (+65°C) or less than (-50°C)

When checking the voltage of MAIN PCB CN30#8 #9 : shall be between 4.5V~1.0V.

F-10-

PanelMain communication Error

Display “oP/LC-Er” in the panel with alarm : MICOM MAIN    LOAD communication error MICOM MAIN    PANEL communication error LC-Er is displayed when the Option is not equivalent with the right value Actually, it is desirable to recheck the condition with the oscilloscope after replacing Main and Panel PCB.

F-10-

LoadMain communication Error


4-1-4. Display function of Load condition    



  • If Power Freeze Key + Power Cool Key are pressed simultaneously for 6 seconds during normal operation, the temperature setting display of fresh food and freezer compartments will blink ALL ON/OFF with 0.5 for 2 seconds.
  • At this moment, If Fridge Key after Power Freeze Key + Power Cool Key is pressed, load condition display mode will be returned with alarm.
  • Load condition display mode shows the load that micom signal is outputting.

    However, It means that micom signal is outputting, it does not mean whether load is operating or not. That is to say that though load operation is displayed, load could not be operated by actual load error or PCB relay error etc.

  • Load condition display function will maintain for 30 seconds and then normal condition will be returned automatically.
  • Load condition display is as below.


F-10    R-10

* Load mode Check list

Display LED

Display contents

Operation contents

R-1- R-FAN High

When fresh food compartment fan high operates, applicable LED ON

R-1- R-FAN Low

When fresh food compartment fan low operates, applicable LED ON

R-1- R-DEF Heater

When fresh food compartment defrost heater operates, LED ON

R-1- Start Mode

Initial power ON refrigerator, LED ON

R-1- Overload condition

When ambient temperature is more than 93 (34°C), LED ON

R-1- Low temperature condition

When ambient temperature is less than 72 (22°C), LED ON

F-1- , ALLLEDOff Normal Condition

When ambient temperature is between 73 (23°C) ~ 91 (33°C), LED ON

R1- Exhibition Mode

Display mode, LED ON

F-1- COMP.

When compressor operates, applicable LED ON

F-1- F-FAN High

When freezer compartment fan high operates, applicable LED ON

F-1- F-FAN Low

When freezer compartment fan low operates, applicable LED ON

F-1- F-DEF Heater

When freezer compartment defrost heater operates, LED ON

R-10- C-FAN High

When compressor fan high operates, applicable LED ON

R-10- C-FAN Low

When compressor fan low operates, applicable LED ON

F-10- French Heater

When french heater operates, applicable LED ON

F-10- Pantry Room Damper Open

When damper open, applicable LED ON

4-1-5. Exhibition mode setting function    



  • If Power Freeze Key + Freezer Key are pressed simultaneously for 3 seconds during normal operation, show room mode will be started with buzzer sound(ding-dong).
  • If above Power Freeze & Freezer Key are pressed one more time, show room mode will be canceled.
  • If show room mode is selected, blinks “OF-OF” on the temperature setting display of the panel and it indicates the refrigerator has entered the show room mode.
  • During show room mode, if fresh food and freezer compartments sensors are higher than 65 show room mode will be canceled automatically and freezing operation will be returned. (There is no buzzer sound when the show room mode is canceled by the temperature)
  • Operation contents of show room mode
    • Display, Fan motor and etc operate normally, not to operate compressor only.
    • Defrost is not operated. (including french heater)
    • Display function of the initial real temperature is finished.
    • Under the condition of show room mode, show room mode will be operated when Power On after Power OFF.

4-1-6. Option setting function    
If Freezer Key + Fridge Key are pressed simultaneously for 12 seconds during normal

operation, fresh food and freezer compartments temperature display will be changed to option

setting mode.






* Key control in option mode

Power Freeze Key

Code Down key

Freezer Key

Code Up key

Power Cool key

Reference Value down key

Fridge key

Reference Value Up key


If the display changes to option setting mode, all displays will be off except freezer and fridge compartments temperature display as below.

(Fresh food and freezer compartments case will be explained only because all options are operated with the same method according to the option table.)


    

  • For example, if you want to change freezer compartment standard temperature to (- 2°C) by operating option, do as below.

    This function is for changing the standard temperature.

    In (-19°C) of current temperature of freezer compartment, if you make the temperature lower to (-2°C) by the option, the standard temperature would be controlled (-21°C) Therefore, if you change the setting of temperature option to (-19°C) on the panel, the appliance will be operated with (-21°C).

    It means that standard temperature is controlled (-2°C) less than setting temperature in the display.

NOTE

  • After changing to the option mode, fresh food compartment “0” , freezer compartment “0” will be displayed. ( Basically fresh food compartment “0”, freezer “0” would be set at shipping process, but setting value could be changed for the purpose of improving product at mass producing process.)

    – If fresh food compartment “0” shows only, temperature reference value of freezer compartment will be set and current freezer compartment temperature code will be displayed on the freezer temperature display.

  • If freezer compartment “4” is set as below freezer compartment code after fresh food compartment “0 is set, standard temperature of freezer compartment will be lower than 28.4(-2.0°C).

    (Refer to the picture “changing the freezer compartment temperature”)

        

    : If you wait for 20 seconds after completing the setting, MICOM will save the setting value to the EEPROM and normal display will be returned and the option setting mode will be canceled.

    • Option changing method as above is the same as all RF266/265** model.
  • By the same method as above, it is possible to control the fresh food compartment temperature, water supply, ice-maker harvest temperature/time, defrost return time, hysteresis by temperature, notch gap by temperature etc.
  • Option function is set in the EEPROM at shipping process in the factory. You would better not to change the option of your own.

    Completing the setting is that option function return to normal display after 20 seconds. Do not turn off the appliance before returning to the normal display mode.

NOTE


4-1-7. Option TABLE    

  • Temperature changing table of freezer compartment

ex) If you want to change the freezer standard temperature to 28.4 (-2°C)






  • Temperature changing table of fresh food compartment



Below options are applied to the applicable model with ice maker.

Do not set below options to the model without Ice Maker.

  • To change the ice maker harvest waiting time

    This option controls the harvest waiting time for ice dispensing from Ice maker

Set item

ICE MAKER waiting time of ice making

Reference Value

Fridge Room 7-SEG

3

             




    

ex) If you want to change the waiting time to 60 minutes

  • To change the ice making sensor temperature of ice maker

This option Controls the standard temperature of judgment that is checking whether ice of ice maker is frozen completely or not.

Set item

ICE MAKER control the temperature of ice making

Reference Value

Fridge Room 7-SEG

4


ex) If you want to change the ice making sensor temperature to 5.0 (-15°C)



DATA1.Temperature table

Resistance value and MICOM port voltage of sensor according to the temperature SENSOR CHIP : based on PX41C

Voltage

Resistance

Voltage

Resistance

Voltage

Resistance

-50

-58

4.694

153319

-5

23

3.107

16419

40

104

1.153

2997

-49

-56.2

4.677

144794

-4

24.8

3.057

15731

41

105.8

1.124

2899

-48

-54.4

4.659

136798

-3

26.6

3.006

15076

42

107.6

1.095

2805

-47

-52.6

4.641

129294

-2

28.4

2.955

14452

43

109.4

1.068

2714

-46

-50.8

4.622

122248

-1

30.2

2.904

13857

44

111.2

1.040

2627

-45

-49

4.602

115631

0

32

2.853

13290

45

113

1.014

2543

-44

-47.2

4.581

109413

1

33.8

2.802

12749

46

114.8

0.988

2462

-43

-45.4

4.560

103569

2

35.6

2.751

12233

47

116.6

0.963

2384

-42

-43.6

4.537

98073

3

37.4

2.700

11741

48

118.4

0.938

2309

-41

-41.8

4.514

92903

4

39.2

2.649

11271

49

120.2

0.914

2237

-40

-40

4.490

88037

5

41

2.599

10823

50

122

0.891

2167

-39

-38.2

4.465

83456

6

42.8

2.548

10395

51

123.8

0.868

2100

-38

-36.4

4.439

79142

7

44.6

2.498

9986

52

125.6

0.846

2036

-37

-34.6

4.412

75077

8

46.4

2.449

9596

53

127.4

0.824

1973

-36

-32.8

4.385

71246

9

48.2

2.399

9223

54

129.2

0.803

1913

-35

-31

4.356

67634

10

50

2.350

8867

55

131

0.783

1855

-34

-29.2

4.326

64227

11

51.8

2.301

8526

56

132.8

0.762

1799

-33

-27.4

4.296

61012

12

53.6

2.253

8200

57

134.6

0.743

1745

-32

-25.6

4.264

57977

13

55.4

2.205

7888

58

136.4

0.724

1693

-31

-23.8

4.232

55112

14

57.2

2.158

7590

59

138.2

0.706

1642

-30

-22

4.199

52406

15

59

2.111

7305

60

140

0.688

1594

-29

-20.2

4.165

49848

16

60.8

2.064

7032

61

141.8

0.670

1547

-28

-18.4

4.129

47431

17

62.6

2.019

6771

62

143.6

0.653

1502

-27

-16.6

4.093

45146

18

64.4

1.974

6521

63

145.4

0.636

1458

-26

-14.8

4.056

42984

19

66.2

1.929

6281

64

147.2

0.620

1416

-25

-13

4.018

40938

20

68

1.885

6052

65

149

0.604

1375

-24

-11.2

3.980

39002

21

69.8

1.842

5832

66

150.8

0.589

1335

-23

-9.4

3.940

37169

22

71.6

1.799

5621

67

152.6

0.574

1297

-22

-7.6

3.899

35433

23

73.4

1.757

5419

68

154.4

0.560

1260

-21

-5.8

3.858

33788

24

75.2

1.716

5225

69

156.2

0.546

1225

-20

-4

3.816

32230

25

77

1.675

5039

70

158

0.532

1190

-19

-2.2

3.773

30752

26

78.8

1.636

4861

71

159.8

0.519

1157

-18

-0.4

3.729

29350

27

80.6

1.596

4690

72

161.6

0.506

1125

-17

1.4

3.685

28021

28

82.4

1.558

4526

73

163.4

0.493

1093

-16

3.2

3.640

26760

29

84.2

1.520

4369

74

165.2

0.481

1063

-15

5

3.594

25562

30

86

1.483

4218

75

167

0.469

1034

-14

6.8

3.548

24425

31

87.8

1.447

4072

76

168.8

0.457

1006

-13

8.6

3.501

23345

32

89.6

1.412

3933

77

170.6

0.446

978

-12

10.4

3.453

22320

33

91.4

1.377

3799

78

172.4

0.435

952

-11

12.2

3.405

21345

34

93.2

1.343

3670

79

174.2

0.424

926

-10

14

3.356

20418

35

95

1.309

3547

80

176

0.414

902

-9

15.8

3.307

19537

36

96.8

1.277

3428

81

177.8

0.404

877

-8

17.6

3.258

18698

37

98.6

1.253

3344

82

179.6

0.394

854

-7

19.4

3.208

17901

38

100.4

1.213

3204

83

181.4

0.384

832

-6

21.2

3.158

17142

39

102.2

1.183

3098

84

183.2

0.375

810

4-2-1. If the trouble is detected by self-diagnosis    


  • If ICE Maker Sensor has trouble

ERROR Code

Start

Is MAIN PCB Connector CN90 inserted correctly?

YES

Is ICE Maker Sensor
unit normal?

YES

Is the voltage between

MAIN PCB Connector CN90#”4″(White) and CN1#”3″(Black) normal?

YES

Is input voltage of IC02 MICOM #30 normal?

YES

NO


N
O


NO(0.6V > Measurement < 4.6V)


NO



  • If R Sensor has trouble

ERROR Code


Sensor MICOM/Connector number

Start

Is MAIN PCB

Connector CN30 to CN75

correctly?

YES

Is R Sensor unit normal?

YES

Is the voltage between

inserted

NO


NO


NO(0.6V > Measurement < 4.6V)

Connector CN30#6(White) to CN1#3(Black) PCB typical Ground

Voltage measured between 4.6V ~ 0.6V.

MAIN PCB Connector CN30#6(White) to CN1#3(Black) normal?

YES

Is the input voltage to    NO IC01 MICOM #54 normal?

YES



Start

Is MAIN PCB

Connector CN30 to CN75

correctly?

YES

Is R DEF Sensor unit normal?

YES

NO

inserted


NO

Sensor MICOM/Connector Number

Connector CN30-“7″(Sky-blue) and CN1-“3″(Black) PCB common Ground

Voltage measured between 4.6V ~ 0.6V.

Is the input voltage between MAIN PCB Connector CN30#7(Skyblue)

to CN1#3(Black) normal?

YES

Is the input voltage of IC01 MICOM # 57 normal?

YES

NO(0.6V > Measurement < 4.6V)


NO



Start


Sensor MICOM/Connector number

Connector CN32#1(White) to CN1#3(Black) PCB typical Ground

Voltage measured between 4.6V ~ 0.6V.

Is MAIN PCB

Connector CN32 inserted correctly?

YES

Is Ambient Sensor unit normal?

YES

Is the voltage between

MAIN PCB Connector CN32#1(White) to CN1#3(Black) normal?

YES

Is the input voltage of IC01 MICOM #59 normal?

YES

NO


NO


NO(0.6V > Measurement < 4.6V)


NO



Start


Sensor MICOM/Connector number

Connector CN30#3(Red) to CN1#3(Black) PCB typical Ground

Voltage measured between 4.6V ~ 0.6V.

Are MAIN PCB

Connector CN30 to CN75 inserted correctly?

YES

Is F Sensor unit normal?

YES

Is the voltage between

MAIN PCB Connector CN30#3(Red) to CN1#3(Black) normal?

YES

Is the input voltage of IC01 MICOM #52 normal?

YES

NO


NO


NO(0.6V > Measurement < 4.6V)


NO



Start


Sensor MICOM/Connector number

Connector CN30#4(Orange) to CN1#3(Black) PCB typical Ground

Voltage measured between 4.6V ~ 0.6V.

Are MAIN PCB

Connector CN30 to CN75 insert correctly?

YES

Is F DEF Sensor unit normal?

YES

Is the voltage between

MAIN PCB Connector CN30#4(Orange) to CN1#3(Black) normal?

YES

Is the input voltage of IC01 MICOM #53 normal?

YES

NO


NO


NO(0.6V > Measurement < 4.6V)


NO



  • If Pantry Sensor has trouble

ERROR Code

Start


Sensor MICOM/Connector number

Connector CN30#8(White-black) to CN1#3(Black) PCB typical Ground

Voltage measured between 4.6V ~ 0.6V.

Is MAIN PCB

Connector CN30 insert correctly?

YES

Is Pantry Sensor normal?

YES

Is the voltage between

MAIN PCB Connector CN30#8(Whiteblack) to CN1#3(Black) normal?

YES

Is the input voltage of IC01 MICOM Pin# 58 normal?

YES

NO


NO


NO(0.6V > Measurement < 4.6V)


NO




  • If Pantry Room Damper Heater has trouble

ERROR Code

MICOM

#37

condition

Initial

power On

Damper

heater off

Damper

heater On

4.0V ~

4.5V

4.0V ~

4.5V

0V


4-2-2. If FAN does not operate    


Start

Is COMP ON ?


IsthevoltagebetweenMAIN PCBCN1#3(Black)andCN75#4(Sky

-blue)aroundDC7~12V?

IsthevoltagebetweenMAIN PCBCN1#3(Black)andCN75#3

(Orange)aroundDC7~12V?

Is the voltage between MAIN

PCB CN1#3 (Black) and CN75#2          (Yellow) around DC7~12V?



Is the voltage between MAIN PCB CN1#3 (Black) and CN30#2

(Purple) around 0V?

Is the voltage between MAIN PCB CN1#3 (Black) and CN30#1

(Black) around 5V?

Door & MICOM State

Door

Close Open

F MICOM (#50)

5V(High) 0V(Low)

R MICOM(#3)

Right and Left 0V(Low)

5V(High)

Power ON with 5 minutes delay after power OFF.

For preventing the over load of compressor)

In initial power to appliance, the compressor and fans of fresh food/ freezer, compressor fan operate. If freezer temperature is sensed of 41 by momentary power failure, fans will operate after 5 minutes.

DoesDC7~12Valternatewithbelow DC2VbetweenMAINPCBCN1#3(Black) andCN75#4(Sky-blue)

DoesDC7~12Valternatewithbelow DC2VbetweenMAINPCBCN1#3(Black) andCN75#3(Orange)

DoesDC7~12Valternatewith belowDC2VbetweenMAINPCB CN1#3(Black)andCN75-#2(Yellow)

Replace MAIN PCB

F FAN pulse voltage    typical PCB Ground CN75#5(Black)        CN10#3(Black)

The voltage measured around 2~3V with multi-meter though the voltage is

Reference

CN75-5(F),6(R),7(C)will generate the pulse signal when motor rotates. These signals will be inputted into MICOM.

Unless signals are not inputted during motor operating, will be ON 10 seconds after fan Off. But if signals are not still entered, the above operation will restart four times more.

If signals are not entered continuously, the motor will be restarted after 10 seconds.

This function is effective when the normal operation of motor would be restrained by foreign matters such as ice.

Expected causes

Check that if FAN-MOTOR has failure itself.

Check that if wiring connection has bad contact.

Check the input of the fan motor rotation pulse when motor fan operates.

very weak because of pulse signal

Display for checking the self-diagnostic function R FAN ERROR

Checking method of R,F,C FAN Motor voltage

The voltage between PCB typical Ground CN1-“3″(Black) and R FAN ; CN75#2(Yellow) shall be less than DC 7~12V.

F FAN ; CN75#3(Orange) shall be less than DC 7~12V. C FAN ; CN75#4(Sky-blue) shall be less than DC 7~12V.

– Recheck if resistance values are different after measuring.

typical PCB Ground

CN1#3(Black)

F FAN ERROR

1) R-FAN    2) F-FAN    3) C-FAN

C FAN ERROR

4-2-3. If ICE MAKER does not operate    


Function ERROR Code




    




    

    

  • Check the wiring connection part
    • Replace ICE MAKER KIT
    • Replace the MAIN PCB

    

1) Replace the Water Valve

* refer to operation condition of water valve

    



    




4-2-4. If defrost does not operate (F,R DEF Heater)    


R DEF ERROR    F DEF ERROR


    

Start

**Measuring point of resistance value according to sensor ** F-DEF : CN30#4 CN75#1 measuring resistance value

R-DEF : CN30#7 CN75#1 measuring resistance value

** 0 : Short trouble /    : Open trouble

Are the all deforst          heater normal?



Is defrost sensor by          self-diagnostic normal?



**Measuring point of resistance value according to sensor ** F-DEF : CN30#4 CN75#1 measuring resistance value

  • EF : CN30#7 CN75#1 measuring resistance value

** 0V: Short trouble / 5V: Open trouble

Is the temperature of          defrost sensor lower

than 53.6 (12°C)?

If Power Freeze Key + Fridge Key are pressed simultaneously for 8 seconds and then select any key, 3rd test mode(manual defrosting) will be operated.

Is power applied to each defrost heaters?

            Doesthesystemreturn tocoolingoperationafter heatingforspecifiedtime?

Reference
If defrost sensor temperatures of fresh food and freezer compartments are higher than 50 (10 ), 53.6 (12 ) by

the heating from heater, heating would be finished and will return to cooling operation after a pause.

Checking method of F,R DEF Heater resistance value F FEF ; CN70#9(Brown)    CN71#9(Orange) R FEF ; CN70#7(White)    CN71#9(Orange)

– Recheck if resistance values are different after the test

  • F DEF Heater    2) R DEF Heater


Isconnectionterminalof MAINPCBpartnormal?





4-2-5. If Power is not supplied    

    Start    

Is plug connected in?


Is power 115(220)V          both terminals of SMPS

PCB CN1?

Checking method of SMPS voltage CN1 input ; CN1#1(Red) #3(Black) AC voltage

Is fuse on the SMPS          PCB down?

Is DC170(325)V applied both

terminals of BD1+,-

Is DC5.8V

  • CheckPCBPATTERNandreplaceBD1
  • ReplacePCBASS’Y

Checking method of SMPS 2nd output voltage CN2 input ; CN2#1(Red)

#3(Black) same as C19 terminals.. DC 5V    0.3V

applied between TOP          switch 246Y C to S?

ReplacePCBASS’Y

Is 12V applied both          terminals of C16?

Checking method of SMPS 2nd output voltage CN2 input ; CN2#5(Yellow)

#3(Black) same as C16 terminals. DC 12V    0.6V

Is 5V applied both terminals of C19?

  • Replace U4 (D10LC20U)
  • Replace PCB ASS’Y
  • Replace REG1 (KA7805)
  • Replace PCB ASS’Y

Does Panel PCB          operate normally?

  • Checkassemblywireandrepair
  • ReplacePanelPCB

Is normal load such          as Relay?

-CheckMAINPCBconnection

-Checktheconnections betweencabinettodoor

-Checktheconnections betweendoortopanelPCB

Is there any PCB soldering, short, breakage?

Normal(Recheck)

  • Check the contact of lead wire
  • Replace the applicable relay / PCB MAIN
  • Solder again
  • Replace PCB MAIN


4-2-6. If compressor does not operate    




4-2-7. When alarm sound continuous without stop(related with buzzer sound)    


If ‘ding-dong’ sounds continuously




    


    




If ‘beep-beep’ sounds continuously

    




    




If buzzer does not sound

Buzzer is installed on the panel PCB in this model.

If buzzer does not sound when button is pressed, manual operation is started and door is opened, should separate panel PCB and check the breakage of buzzer and bad soldering.

It is very hard to repair the panel PCB because it consists of SMD assemblies.

It is recommended to replace assembly PCB when the failure associated with panel is occurred except the minor error such as switch pressing error, surface peeling off and so on.




4-2-8. If Panel PCB does not work normally    


When lighting of Panel PCB is disabled or only some LED Lamp are disabled


Is the connector of upper hinge cover inserted correctly?

        

Is MAIN PCB

connector (CN50) inserted correctly?

Is Top Table Panel PCB connector

inserted correctly?

Is lighting operate normally when replace Panel-PCB?

    




If Panel PCB KEY is not selected

If it is not repaired with using the basic checking method as above


4-2-9. If Pantry Panel PCB is not working normally    


Start

Does fresh food compartment door switch operate normally?

Is the connector of

pantry room in fresh food          compartment inserted

correctly?


Is MAIN PCB

Connector (CN78) inserted correctly?




If Panel Key is not selected

Is signal of MAIN PCB CN78 normal?



Is the lighting operated when replace Pantry

Panel-PCB?

    




typical PCB Ground CN1#3(Black)

If Panel Panel PCB Key is not selected

If it is not repaired with using the basic checking method as above

Checking method of voltage Based on PCB typical Ground CN1#3(Black)

1) Key voltage ; CN78#1″(Purple)

  • select(operating)(0V)    2)normal(about5.0V 0.5V)
  • LED part voltage ; CN78-“7″(Yellow), “8”(Pink)    Voltage of CN78 is same as IC74 #12,#11 voltage.

– Display On (0.7V 0.3V)    – Display Off (9.7V 1V)

Is a key pressed continuously?

Is the PCB system

still operated by separating of the mechanism?

Is the lighting operated when replace Pantry Panel-PCB?

Is a normal voltage outputted from MAIN PCB IC74

in the key operating?

Reassemble PCB ASS’Y / Enforce the cancelation of pressed keys


Convertible compartment Panel PCB itself has trouble.

Replace MAIN PCB Check the short of MAIN Panel wire

Check the wire of Pantry Room – disconnection, short between wires

Check the short/open of the pantry panel lighting circuit in MAIN PCB.


4-2-10. When refrigerator ROOM Lamp does not light up    



The case of fresh food compartment(room) lamp will be explained only.

Because it is possible to repair the other room lamps with the same method.

Is the connection          point of R-door switch

normal?



    





Reference
If the door is opened, the contact of door switch will be opened and MICOM will get applied 5V to finally sense Open.
If 5V has been sensed over two minutes afterwards, Door-Open alarm will sound for 10 seconds in a oneminute cycle. For that reason, if the door switch has failure, the refrigerator can make Ding-Dong sound per a oneminute cycle. Please note the step for its service.
When measure lamp resistance to the Wire Resistance can be changed by Lamp input voltage. (Actual measurement is below, it can be changed by performance)

Fresh food compartment lamp CN70#1(Red) CN71#1 (Blue) ;
10(33)Ohm3 Ohm Lamp ; 60W + 60W

Freezer compartment lamp CN70#1(Red)
CN71#3 (Purple) ; 15(66)Ohm5 Ohm Lamp ; 60WChecking method of Door Switch voltage
Measuring voltage of Sensor Check Point #5(IC01 MICOM #58) on PCB or CN30#8(White-black) CN75#1(Gray)
Compare time table after measuring
Measuring voltage of CN30#8(white-black) CN75#1(Gray) are below

typical PCB Ground CN10#3″(Black)




 

4-2-11. If ICE Water is not supplied    

typical PCB Ground CN1#3(Black)



4-2-12. If Water is not supplied    


    

Does Main PCB IC73 #14          have about 0.7V output?

            Is the contact point of main          PCB RELAY RY7A normal?


KENMORE REFRIGERATOR SERVICE MANUAL



REFRIGERATOR SERVICE MANUAL

CAUTION

BEFORE SERVICING THE UNIT,

READ THE SAFETY PRECAUTIONS IN THIS MANUAL.

Model #s:

P/No. MFL62188020

795.71052.01, 795.71053.01, 795.71054.01

SAFETY PRECAUTIONS    2

  • SPECIFICATIONS    3-4
  • PARTS IDENTIFICATION    5
  • REMOVING AND REPLACING REFRIGERATOR DOORS    6

    DOOR    7

    DOOR ALIGNMENT    8

    FAN AND FAN MOTOR (EVAPORATOR)    8

    DEFROST CONTROL ASSEMBLY    8

    LAMP    9

    MULTI DUCT    9

    MAIN PWB    9

    DISPENSER    10

    DISPLAY PWB REPLACEMENT    10

    FUNNEL REPLACEMENT    10

    SUB PWB FOR DISPENSER    10

    CAP DUCT REPLACEMENT    11

    CAP DUCT MOTOR REPLACEMENT    11

    ICE CORNER DOOR REPLACEMENT    11

    ICE MAKER REPLACEMENT    12

    HOW TO REMOVE A ICE BIN    13

    HOW TO INSERT A ICE BIN    13

    HOW TO REMOVE AND REINSTALL THE PULLOUT DRAWER    14-15

    WATER VALVE DISASSEMBLY METHOD    16

    FAN AND FAN MOTOR DISASSEMBLY METHOD    16

    PULL OUT DRAWER    17

  • ADJUSTMENT    18-19

    COMPRESSOR    18

    INTRODUCTION OF E-LINEAR COMPRESSOR    18-20

  • CIRCUIT DIAGRAM    21
  • TROUBLESHOOTINTG    22
  • PCB PICTURE    23-24
  • TROUBLESHOOTING WITH ERROR DISPLAY    25-34
  • TROUBLESHOOTING WITH ERROR DISPLAY    35-44
  • REFERENCE    44-49
  • COMPONENT TESTING INFORMATION    50-54
  • TRBOUBLESHOOTING    55-61
  • ICEMAKER OPERATING METHOD AND TROUBLE SHOOTING    62-65
  • DESCIPTION OF FUNCTION & CIRCUIT OF MICOM    66-69

SAFETY PRECAUTIONS

Please read the following instructions before servicing your refrigerator.

  • Unplug the power before handling any electrical components.
  • Check the rated current, voltage, and capacity.
  • Take caution not to get water near any electrical components.
  • Use exact replacement parts.
  • Remove any objects from the top prior to tilting the product.

1-1 DISCONNECT POWER CORD BEFORE SERVICING

IMPORTANT – RECONNECT ALL GROUNDING DEVICES

All parts of this appliance capable of conducting electrical

1-7 REPLACEMENT PARTS

28cu,ft 795.71052.01*

795.71053.01*

795.71054.01*

795.71056.01*

795.71059.01*

current are grounded. If grounding wires, screws, straps, clips, nuts or washers used to complete a path to ground are removed for service, they must be returned to their original position and properly fastened.

  • IMPORTANT NOTICE

This information is intended for use by individuals possessing adequate backgrounds of electrical, electronic and mechanical experience. Any attempt to repair a major appliance may result in personal injury and property damage. The manufacturer or seller cannot be responsible for the interpretation of this information, nor can it assume any liability in connection with its use.

  • ELECTRICAL SPECIFICATIONS

Temperature Control (Freezer Compartment) . -6°F to +8°F Defrost Control ……Total Comp Running Time: 7 hrs~50 hrs Defrost Thermostat ……………………………………………… 46°F Electrical Rating : 115VAC, 60Hz ………………………….. 5.2 A

Maximum Current Leakage ……………………………….. 0.5 mA

Maximum Ground Path Resistance ………………. 0.14 Ohms

Energy Consumption …………………… 28cu,ft. 528 (E/STAR)

Defrost Thermostat ………………………………… 6615JB2005H

Defrost Heater ……………………………………….. 5300JK1005D

Evaporator Fan Motor …………………………….. 4681JB1027C

Capacitor (Running) ………………………………. EAE58905701

Compressor (Hi-Side) …………………………….. TCA34649901

Evaporator (Lo-Side) ……………………………….. 5421JJ1003L

Condenser …………………………………………… ACG72915205

Dryer ……………………………………………………. 5851JA2007E Condenser Fan Motor ……………………………. .4681JB1029D

Temperature Control …………………….. ACQ76217902(STS)

ACQ76217904(WB) ACQ76217906(SW) ACQ76217907(TI) ACQ76217908(BI)

Main Control …………………………………………. EBR65002702

Ice Fan Motor ………………………………………… 4681JB1027E

(4681JB1029E) Refrigerator Fan Motor ………………………………4681JB1027J

1-8 AIR FLOW / CIRCULATION D’AIR

  • NO LOAD PERFORMANCE CONTROL POSITION: MID/MID

And Ambient of : ……………. 70°F …………………………… 90°F Fresh Food, °F ……………… 33°F to 41°F …….. 33°F to 41°F

Frozen Food, °F ……………. -4°F to +4°F ……… -4°F to +4°F

Percent Running Time …… 35%-45% …………….. 50°F-70°F

EVAPORTOR FAN MOTOR

CONDENSER FAN MOTOR

  • REFRIGERATION SYSTEM

Minimum Compressor Capacity Vacuum ……………. 21 MIN. Minimum Equalized Pressure

@ 70°F …………………………………………………… 49 PSIG

@ 90°F …………………………………………………… 56 PSIG

Refrigerant R134a …………………………………………… 4.93 oz.

Compressor ………………………………………………. 956 BTU/hr


  • INSTALLATION

Clearance must be provided at rear of the refrigerator for air circulation.

AT REAR ……………………………………………………………… 1 in

ICE ROOM



Description

795.7105*

Depth w/ Handles

A

35 3/8 in

Depth w/ Handles

B

32 7/8 in

Depth w/ o Door

C

29 in

Depth (Total with Door Open)

D

47 5/8 in

Height to Top of Case

E

68 3/8 in

Height to Top of Door Hinge

F

69 3/4 in

Width

G

35 3/4 in

Width (door open 90 deg. w/o handle)

H

39 1/4 in

Width (door open 90 deg. w/ handle)

I

44 1/4 in


A Refrigerator Light B Filter (Inside)

C Modular Door Bins D Fixed Door Bin

  • Fixed Door Bin
  • Refrigerator Shelves G Ice Room

    (Ice Maker and Ice Bin)

    H Humidity Controlled Crisper I    Temperature Controlled

    Pantry Drawer

    Extra Ice Bin

K Pullout Drawer L Durabase

  • Divider
  • Door Bins O Dairy Bin

    P Water Tank Cover Q Mullion

  • REMOVING AND REPLACING REFRIGERATOR DOORS
To remove the left refrigerator door:

Pull the water tube out of the fitting while pressing the release ring on the fitting.

When you pull out the tube, first you have to push the collet by opposite direction of arrow in the upper picture and tube pull out by direction of arrow.

To remove the Right refrigerator door:

CAUTION: Before you begin, remove food and bins from the doors.


Open the door. Remove the top hinge cover screw (1).

Lift up the cover (2). Remove the cover.

Rotate the hinge lever (3) clockwise.

Lift the top hinge (4) free of the hinge lever latch (5). IMPORTANT: When lifting the hinge free of the latch, be careful that the door does not fall forward.

    

Open the door. Remove the top hinge cover screw (1). Use a flat-head screwdriver to pry back the hooks (not shown) on the front underside of the cover (2).

Lift up the cover.

Remove the cover. Pull out the tube (3). Disconnect all the wire harnesses (4). Remove the grounding screw(5)

Rotate hinge lever (6) counterclockwise.

Lift the top hinge (7) free of the hinge lever latch (8).

IMPORTANT: When lifting the hinge free of the latch, be careful that the door does not fall forward.


Lift the door from the middle hinge pin and remove the

door.


Place the door, inside facing up, on a nonscratching surface.

  • DOOR

Mullion Removal
  • Remove 2 screws.


  • Lift mullion up carefully.


  • Disconnect wire harness.


Door Gasket Removal

1. Remove gasket

Pull gasket free from gasket channel on the four remaining sides of door.

Door Gasket Replacement

1. Insert gasket into channel

Press gasket into channels on the four remaining sides of door.


Mullion Replacement
  • Connect wire harness.


  • Insert mullion into channel.

    Inserting mullion assy’ into bracket, door


  • Assemble 2 screws.



  • Door Alignment

If the space between your doors is uneven, follow the instructions below to align the doors:

Remove the Base Grillie. Turn the leveling legs (CCW) to raise or (CW) to lower the height of the front of the refrigerator by using flat blade screw driver or 11/32″ wrench. Use the wrench (Included with the User Manual) to adjust the bolt in the door hinge to adjust the height. (CCW to raise or CW to lower the height.)

  • FAN AND FAN MOTOR(EVAPORATOR)

  • Remove the freezer drawer. (If your refrigerator has an icemaker, remove the icemaker first)
  • Remove the plastic guide for slides on left side by unscrewing phillips head screws.
  • Remove the grille by removing four screws and pulling the grille forward.
  • Remove the Fan Motor assembly by loosening 3 screws and disassembling the shroud.
  • Pull out the fan and separate the Fan Motor and Bracket.


  • Ice Fan Scroll Assembly Replacement
  • Remove the plastic guide for slides on left side by unscrewing phillips head screws.
  • Pull out the cover sensor to disassemble using tools shown in the figure.
  • Pull out the cover grille to disassemble using tools shown in the figure.
  • Put your hand into the inside of grille to disassemble shown in the figure.
  • Disconnect wire harness of the grille
  • Remove the scroll assembly by loosening all screws



(1)    (2)


(3)    (4)


(5)    (6)

  • DEFROST CONTROL ASSEMBLY

Defrost Control assembly consists of Defrost Sensor and FUSE-M.

The Defrost Sensor works to defrost automatically. It is attached to the metal side of the Evaporator and senses its temperature. At 46F(8°C), it turns the Defrost Heater off.

Fuse-M is a safety device for preventing over-heating of the Heater when defrosting.

  • Pull out the grille assembly. (Figure 1)
  • Separate the connector with the Defrost Control assembly and replace the Defrost Control assembly after cutting the Tie Wrap. (Figure 2)

GRILLE ASSEMBLY    DEFROST-CONTROL

ASSEMBLY

    

Figure 1    Figure 2
  • LAMP

Unplug Refrigerator, or disconnect power at the circuit breaker.

If necessary, remove top shelf or shelves.

3-6-1 Refrigerator Compartment Lamp
  • Release 2 screws.
  • Hold both ends with your both hands and pull it downward to remove it.



  • To remove the case lamp and cover lamp, release another 2 screws as following picture.


  • Use a flat blade screwdriver as shown below to remove the cover lamp.



  • To remove the LED Assembly, open the Hook part to pull it out as shown in the following picture.
  • MULTI DUCT

  • Remove the upper and lower Caps by using a flat screwdriver, and remove 2 screws. (Figure 3)
  • Disconnect the lead wire on the bottom position.
  • MAIN PWB

WARNING : Unplug the refrigerator before removing the control board.

  • Loosen the 3 screws on the PWB cover.


  • Remove the PWB cover

Case, lamp

Cover, lamp LED, Assembly

3-6-2 Freezer Compartment Lamp
  • Unplug refrigerator power cord form outlet.
  • Remove screw with driver.
  • Grasp the cover Lamp,pull the cover downward.
  • Disconnect wire harness and replace the main PWB in the reverse order of removal.

    


3-9 DISPENSER

  • Disconnect funnel by pulling down and forward.
  • Follow the steps in the pictures.
  • Use a flat blade screwdriver at bottom side hole of the “Cover Assembly dispenser” to detach hooks of the bottom side.
  • FUNNEL REPLACEMENT

  • Pull up and out on the dispenser cover to remove.
  • Remove 2 screws.
  • Disconnect the wire harness.
  • Replace in reverse order.

3) Hold the bottom side of the “Cover Assembly, dispenser” as shown in the picture, and pull and remove it. The cover dispenser is attached with a hook.

CAUTION: When replacing the dispenser cover in the reverse order of removal, be careful that the lead wire does not come out and the water tube is not pinched by the dispenser cover, as shown in the picture below.

  • SUB PWB FOR WORKING DISPENSER

1) Loosen the screw on the sub PWB.


3-10 DISPLAY PWB REPLACEMENT

  • Pull up and out on the dispenser cover to remove and replace PWB with dispenser cover.
  • Pull the sub PWB down.
  • Disconnect the wire harness and replace the sub PWB in the reverse order of removal.


  • CAP DUCT REPLACEMENT

  • Pull up and out on the dispenser cover to remove.
  • Disconnect the wire harness.
  • Remove the funnel.
  • Replace in reverse order.
  • Contract the Housing.



  • CAP DUCT MOTOR REPLACEMENT

1) Separate the Housing of the Cap Duct Motor.

  • ICE CORNER DOOR REPLACEMENT

  • Loosen the front screw as shown in the picture.
  • Lift up the hinge with one hand.
  • Pull out the Ice Corner Door with the other hand.


  • Unscrew 3 screws to disassemble the motor.
  • When replacing to a new Motor, always check position of the Duct Door and Link to install the Motor.

Duct Door Link

Cap Duct Motor

NG Position

  • Assemble on the screws.
  • Icemaker replacement

  • Remove the stainless screws marked in the picture below.


  • Grasp the bottom of motor cover assembly and pull it out slowly.


  • Disconnect wire harness from wall of compartment.

CAUTION : Make sure that the wire harness shown below is positioned properly in the clips on the back of the cover, and taped in place. If this harness is loose it will not allow the motor housung assembly to fit flush to the door liner.



In-door motor

  • HOW TO REMOVE A ICE BIN

1) Grip the handles, as shown in the picture.

  • HOW TO INSERT A ICE BIN

  • Insert the Ice Bin, slightly tilting it to avoid touching the Icemaker. (Especially, Ice-Detecting Sensor)

    

  • Lift the lower part slightly.


  • Take the Ice Bin out slowly.


  • HOW TO REMOVE AND REINSTALL THE PULLOUT DRAWER

  • Follow Steps to Remove

Step 1) Open the freezer door.    Step 2) Remove the lower basket.


Step 3) Remove the two screws from the guide rails (one from each side).

Step 4) Lift the freezer door up to unhook it from the rail support and remove.

Pull both rails to full extension.


Step 5) First: Remove the gear from the left side first by releasing the tab behind the gear, place a screwdriver between the gear and the tab and pull up on the gear.

Second: Remove the center rail.

Third: Remove the gear from the right side by following the same steps for the left side.

NOTE: THIS TAB MUST BE PUSHED IN TO RELEASE THE GEAR.


  • Follow Steps to Reinstall

Step 1) Reinstall the right side gear into the clip.


Step 2) Insert the rail into the right side gear. Gears do not need to be perpendicular to each other.


Step 4) The rail system will align itself by pushing the rails all the way into the freezer section.

Pull the rails back out to full extension.


Step 6) Reinstall the two screws into the guide rails (one from each side).

Step 3) Insert the rail into the left side gear, and insert the gear into the clip.


Step 5) Reinstall the freezer door by inserting the rail tabs into the guide rail.


Step 7) Reinstall the lower basket, and close the freezer door.

    

  • WATER VALVE DISASSEMBLY METHOD

1) Turn off the water. Then separate the water line from the valve.

  • FAN AND FAN MOTOR DISASSEMBLY METHOD

  • Using a short screwdriver, loosen one SCREW in DRAIN PIPE ASSEMBLY and one connected to the MOTOR COVER.

MOTOR COVER




  • Separate the Mechanical Cover and Valve Screw.


  • Separate the housing and pull out the valve.



  • Befrore disconnecting the water lines, place a towel under the water valve to catch any water that may come out. Pull out the clip and press the collet to separte the water line from the valve.

2) Pull and separate the FAN ASSEMBLY and MOTOR turning counterclockwise based on the MOTOR SHAFT.

FAN ASSEMBLY    MOTOR




The assembly is in the reverse order of the disassembly and take special care for the following details.

  • Be careful not to bend the tube during assembly.
  • Press the WATER DISPENSER button until water pours out and check for leakage in the CONNECTOR TUBE (It differs by the water pressure but usually takes about 2 minutes until water pours out.)

    

  • PULL OUT DRAWER

To remove, pull the drawer out to full extension.

Lift the front of the drawer up, then pull it straight out.


To install, slightly tilt up the front and insert the drawer into the frame and push it back into place.


  • COMPRESSOR

    • Role

The compressor intakes low temperature and low pressure gas from the evaporator of the refrigerator and compresses this gas to high-temperature and high-pressure gas. It then delivers the gas to the condenser.

  • Note for Usage
  • Be careful not to allow over-voltage and over-current.
  • Do not drop or handle carelessly.
  • Keep away from any liquid.

    If liquid such as oil or water enters the Cover PTC Compressor may fail due to breakdown of their insulating capabilities.

  • Always use the Parts designed for the compressor and make sure it is properly attached to the compressor. Parts may appear physically identical but could have different electrical ratings. Replace parts by part number and model number. Use only approved substitute parts.
  • REMOVE THE COVER PTC


  • Remove the Cover Back M/C


  • Loosen two screws on comp base


  • Use a L-shaped flap tooll to pry off the cover
  • Assembly in reverse order of disassembly

4-2 Introduction of E-Linear Compressor

E-Linear compressor is run by mechanical part design through automatically varying the cooling power. The main parts consist of compressor and Sub PCB which controls the compressor. PCB authorizes constant voltage and constant frequency to the compressor and protects it.


  • Control of Compressor Block Diagram
Compressor Controller

Signal

Frequ

-ency

Counter elec-

tromotive force

Control Block Diagram of Compressor

  • Compressor operating pattern

Drive half stroke after turning on initial power for 30 seconds. Then, slowly increase stroke and reach target input. Once reaching the target input, input naturally changes according to refrigerator load without any special control.


Interval 1) Half stroke interval – after initial running, stay at the initial value for 30 seconds

Interval 2) Running interval – Increase at every 0.8 till it reaches the target input; it takes about 3′ 45″

Interval 3) CVCF interval – Run by target voltage and main operating frequency and the input naturally changes according to refrigerator load


PWBDADSSEMBDLYYD,DDD SMADRDTDBUUZZZZEEDDRD

PWBDD ASSEMBDLYYD,DD AMBIENDTDLEDDD

6-1. Error Code Summary
WARNING: When you check the Resistance values, be sure to turn off the power.
And wait for the voltage-discharge sufficiently.

NOTE) 3 hours before the error : Press the Ultra ICE button and Freezer button simultaneously 3 hours after the error : All errors, except for “Er rt”, “Er SS”, “Er IS(except for Icing sensor)”, “Er gF”, “Er It” error, are displayed.
“Er IS” which is displayed without input of user is the error of Icing Sensor.

NO
Error Detection CategoryError Display
Error Generation Factors
RemarkFreezer TemperatureFreezer Temperature1NormalityNoneNormal operation of Display2Freezer Sensor ErrorErFSShort or Disconnection of Freezer Sensor

Check each sensor and its connector.3Refrigerator Sensor ErrorErrSShort or Disconnection of Refrigerator Sensor4Defrosting Sensor ErrorErdSShort or Disconnection of Defrosting Sensor
5
Icing Sensor Error
Er
ISShort or disconnection of the sensor about Ice maker (Icing sensor, Ice maker sensor)6Pantry sensor errorErSSShort or Disconnection of Pantry Sensor7Room Temp Sensor ErrorErrtShort or Disconnectoin of Room temp.sensor
8
Ice maker kit defect
Er
It
Other Electric system error such as moter, gear, Hall IC, operation circuit within I/M kitWhen the ice does not drop even when the I/M Test S/W is pressed
(same as model applied Twisting Ice Maker before)
9Flow Meter(Sensor) Defect
Er
gFError of flow meter or water input or low water pressureError of flow meter or water input or low water pressure or flow meter connection
10
Poor Defrosting
Er
dHEven though it is passed
1 hour since then Defrosting, if Defrosting sensor is not over 46°F(8°C), it is causedTemperature Fuse Disconnection, Heater disconnection, DRAIN Jam, Poor Relay for Heater
11Abnormality of BLDC FAN Motor for Ice Making
Er
IFIt is caused when feedback signal isn’t over 65 seconds during BLDC FAN motor operating
Poor BLDC Motor connection, DRIVE IC, and TR
12Abnormality of BLDC FAN Motor for Freezer
Er
FFIt is caused when feedback signal isn’t over 65 seconds during BLDC FAN motor operating
Poor BLDC Motor connection, DRIVE IC, and TR
13Abnormality of BLDC FAN MOTOR For
Refrigerator
Er
rFIt is caused when feedback signal isn’t over 65 seconds during BLDC FAN motor operating
Poor BLDC Motor connection, DRIVE IC, and TR
14Abnormality of BLDC FAN Motor for Mechanic Room
Er
CFIt is caused when feedback signal isn’t over 65 seconds during BLDC FAN motor operating
Poor BLDC Motor connection, DRIVE IC, and TR
15
Communication Error
Er
CO
Communication Error between Micom of Main PCB and Display MicomPoor Communication connection,Poor TR of Transmitter and Receiver Tx/Rx between display and main board.
Main PCB

P/No & MFG

Picture

CON1

CON8

CON6

EBR65002701 (2010.02~)

CON2

CON5

CON4

CON3

CON10

EBR64173902 (2010.02~)

Refer to 48Page

CON203

CON201

CON2


  • Display PCB & Sub PCB

P/No

Picture

Display PCB EBR65768601 (2010.02~)

CON104

CON102 CON101

Sub PCB EBR60070704 (2010.02~)

CON1

CON2

  • Troubleshooting With Error Display    
  • Freezer Sensor Error (Er FS)

No

Checking flow

Result & SVC Action

1

Check for a loose connection.

2

Check the Blue/White to
Blue/White.


<CON6>




<Temperature table-1>


    


    


    


    


    


    


    


The sensor is determined by the temperature.

For example,
indicates -4°F.


  • Refrigerator Sensor Error (Er rS)

No

Checking flow

Result & SVC Action

1

Check for a loose connection.

2

Check the White to White.


<CON6>




<Temperature table-2>


    


    


    


    


    


The sensor is determined by the temperature.

For example,
indicates 32°F.


  • Icing Sensor Error (Er IS)

No

Checking flow

Result & SVC Action

1

Check for a loose connection.

2

Check the Blue to Blue.

    





<Display>    <CON101>




<Temperature table-1>


    


    


    


    


    


    


    


The sensor is determined by the temperature.

For example,
indicates -4°F.


  • Defrost Sensor Error (F dS)

No

Checking flow

Result & SVC Action

1

Check for a loose connection.

    

2

Check the Orange to Orange.


Check the Brown to Brown.


<CON6>




<Temperature table-3>


    


    


    


    


    


    


    


The sensor is determined by the temperature.

For example,
indicates -4°F.


  • Defrost Heater Error (Er dH)

No

Checking flow

Result & SVC Action

1

Check the Door gasket.



    


    

2

Check the Defrost control part.

Fuse        

M    Sensor

Def Heater

3

Input Test 3 Mode.

(Push the button 3 times)


4

Check the Blue to Orange.


<CON3>

5

Release the test mode.

push the button 1 times. (normal)


6

Check the Blue to Orange.


<CON3>


  • Freezer Fan Error (Er FF)

No

Checking flow

Result & SVC Action

1

Reset the unit and Input Test 1 Mode.

(Push the button 1 time)


2

Open the freezer door and Check the air flow.


While an error code is displayed, the fan is not working.

3

Check the Fan motor.




 

Rotate fan using your hand.

It feel sticky, change the motor. (cause of ice or rust inside of motor)

4

Check the Fan motor voltage.

(1) (2) (3)


<CON4>


  • Icing Fan Error (Er IF)

No

Checking flow

Result & SVC Action

1

Reset the unit and Input Test 1 Mode.

(Push the button 1 time)


2

Open the refrigerator door and Check the air flow.


While an error code is displayed, the fan is not working.

3

Check the Connector

(Frozen caused the PCB short)

        


Tip

To protect ice short, add wire seal in connector. We developed new type connector, so order the new type.





Wire seal (Silicon)

4

Check the Fan motor. (Frozen, Lock, ect.)

        


5

Check the Fan motor voltage.

(1) (2) (3)


<CON4>


  • Condenser Fan Error (Er CF)

No

Checking flow

Result & SVC Action

1

Reset the unit and Input Test 1 Mode.

(Push the button 1 time)


2

Check the fan rotating.


While an error code is displayed, the fan is not working.

3

Check the Fan motor and surrounding.


Rotate fan using your hand.

It feel sticky, change the motor.

4

Check the Fan motor voltage.

(1) (2) (3)


<CON4>

  • Communication Error (Er CO)

No    Checking flow

  • Check the loose connection.
  • Check the Red to White Red.

<CON101>

Result & SVC Action


  • Check the Orange to Brown.

<CON101>

  • Check the Orange to Red.

<CON101>

  • Check the White/Red to Orange.

Result

SVC Action

0 or 5 VDC

Change the Display PCB

Other

Go to the 6

<CON5>

  • Check the White Red to White/Black.

Result

SVC Action

0 or 5 VDC

Change the Main PCB

Other

Explain to customer

<CON5>

  • Troubleshooting Without    Error Display    
  • Cube mode doesn’t work

No

Checking flow

Result & SVC Action

1

Check the loose connection.

2

Check the Black to White. (While pushing the lever S/W)



<CON2>

3

Check the RED to White Red. (While pushing the lever S/W)



<CON1>

4

Check the resistance value.


<Ice Maker>

(1)    (2)    (3)

(4)

<Geared Motor>    <Dispenser Motor>



  • Crush mode doesn’t work

No

Checking flow

Result & SVC Action

1

Check the loose connection.

2

Check the Sky Blue to White. (While pushing the lever S/W)



<CON2>

3

Check the RED to White Red. (While pushing the lever S/W)



<CON1>

4

Check the resistance value.


<Ice Maker>

(3)

(1)    (2)    (4)

<Geared Motor>    <Dispenser Motor>



  • Water mode doesn’t work

No

Checking flow

Result & SVC Action

1

Check the loose connection.

2

Check the Purple to White. (While pushing the lever S/W)



<CON2>

3

Check the Blue to Gray. (While pushing the lever S/W)


<CON3>

4

Check the resistance value.

(1) (2)    (3) (4)

Dispenser Ice Maker

<Pilot Valve>    <Water Valve>

Machine Room    In door



  • Freezer room LED lamp doesn’t work

No    Checking flow    Result & SVC Action

  • Check the Freezer door switch.    If feel sticky, Change the door s/w.
  • Check the door S/W resistance.
  • Check the Black to Sky blue.

<CON6>

  • Check the Blue to Black.

<CON3>


  • Refrigerator room lamp doesn’t work

No    Checking flow    Result & SVC Action

  • Check the Refrigerator door switch.    If feel sticky, Change the door s/w.
  • Check the door S/W resistance.
  • Check the Black to Orange.

<CON6>

  • Check the Red to BLue.
  • Check the Red to BLue.


  • Poor cooling in Fresh food section

No

Checking flow

Result & SVC Action

1

Check the sensor resistance.


<CON6>


The sensor is determined by the temperature.

For example,
indicates 32°F.


    


    


    


    


    

2

Reset the unit and Input Test 1 Mode.

(Push the button 1 time)


3

Open the fresh food door and Check the air flow.

4

Check the air temperature. Cold or not ?

No    Checking flow

5    Damper checking method. Inputting TEST Mode, Check the damper and PCB.

(3)

(1)

Result & SVC Action

Test Mode

Damper State

SVC Action

1 Mode

Open

Damper is normal. (Check the

2 Mode

Closed

1,2

mode

Not working

Change the damper

(2)    (4)

  • Check the Fan motor. Rotate fan using your hand.

    It feel sticky, change the motor. (Cause of ice or rust inside of motor)

  • Check the R Fan motor voltage.

(1) (2) (3)

<CON4>


  • Poor cooling in Freezer compratment

No

Checking flow

Result & SVC Action

1

Check the sensor resistance.


<CON6>


The sensor is determined by the temperature.

For example,
indicates -4°F.


    


    


    


    


    


    


    

2

Reset the unit and Input Test 1 Mode.

(Push the button 1 time)


3

Open the freezer door and Check the air flow.

4

Check the air temperature. Cold or not ?


  • Over cooling in Fresh food compartment

No

Checking flow

Result & SVC Action

1

Check the sensor resistance.


<CON6>


The sensor is determined by the temperature.

For example,
indicates 32°F.


    


    


    


    


    

2

Reset the unit and Input Test 1 Mode.

(Push the button 1 time)


3

Open the refrigerator door and Check the air flow.

4

Input Test 2 Mode and Check the air flow. (Push the button 1 time)


5

Check the damper resistance.

(3)    (1)

(2)    (4)


  • Reference    
  • TEST MODE and Removing TPA
  • How to make TEST MODE

If you push the test button on the Main PCB, the refrigerator will be enter the TEST MODE.

  • 1 time : Comp / Damper / All FAN on (All things displayed)
  • 2 times : Damper closed

    (22 22 displayed)

  • 3 times : Forced defrost mode

    (33 33 displayed)

Main PWB

  • How to remove Terminal Position Assurance (TPA)

    <AC TPA>    <DC TPA>

After measure the values, you should put in the TPA again.

  • Wire Color

    BL : Blue WH : White

    BO : Bright Orange BK : Black

    BN : Brown PR : Purple RE : Red

GN : Green SB : Sky Blue GY : Gray

BL/WH : Blue & White WH/RD : White & Red YL/BK : Yellow & Black

  • TEMPERATRUE CHART – FRZ AND ICING SENSOR
TEMP

RESISTANCE

VOLTAGE

-39°F (-40°C)

73.29

4.09 V

-30°F (-35°C)

53.63

3.84 V

-21°F (-30°C)

39.66

3.55 V

-13°F (-25°C)

29.62

3.23 V

-4°F (-20°C)

22.33

2.89 V

5°F (-15°C)

16.99

2.56 V

14°F (-10°C)

13.05

2.23 V

23°F (-5°C)

10.10

1.92 V

32°F (0°C)

7.88

1.63 V

41°F (5°C)

6.19

1.38 V

50°F (10°C)

4.91

1.16 V

59°F (15°C)

3.91

0.97 V

68°F (20°C)

3.14

0.81 V

77°F (25°C)

2.54

0.67 V

86°F (30°C)

2.07

0.56 V

95°F (35°C)

1.69

0.47 V

104°F (40°C)

1.39

0.39 V

  • TEMPERATRUE CHART – REF AND DEF SENSOR
TEMP

RESISTANCE

VOLTAGE

-39°F (-40°C)

225.1

4.48 V

-30°F (-35°C)

169.8

4.33 V

-21°F (-30°C)

129.3

4.16 V

-13°F (-25°C)

99.30

3.95 V

-4°F (-20°C)

76.96

3.734 V

5°F (-15°C)

60.13

3.487 V

14°F (-10°C)

47.34

3.22 V

23°F (-5°C)

37.55

2.95 V

32°F (0°C)

30

2.67 V

41°F (5°C)

24.13

2.40 V

50°F (10°C)

19.53

2.14 V

59°F (15°C)

15.91

1.89 V

68°F (20°C)

13.03

1.64 V

77°F (25°C)

10.74

1.45 V

86°F (30°C)

8.89

1.27 V

95°F (35°C)

7.40

1.10 V

104°F (40°C)

6.20

0.96 V



Step 1) Open PWB cover    Step 2) Check for blinking frequency of LED, PWB



If compressor is normal, it does not blink

: Refer to the next page to find out what actions to take according to how many times LED blink



No

LED operating condition

Cause

Service guideline

1

LED two – time repetiton


on on – off – on on – off – on on – off    repeating

PCB part defect (piston overrun)

  • After resetting power, check if it is running normal
  • If the same symptom arises after the first action, replace PCB

LED four – time repetiton


on on on on – off – on on on on – off    repeating

1.After resetting

power, check if it is

running normal

2.If the same

2

outlet clogging

symptom arises after the first action,

replace PCB

3.If the same

symptom arises after

the second action,

replace compressor

LED five – time repetiton


on on on on on – off – on on on on on – off    repeating

1. After resetting

power, check if it is

running normal

2. If the same

3

piston constraint

symptom arises after the first action,

replace PCB

3. If the same

symptom arises after

the second action,

replace compressor

LED six – time repetiton


on on on on on on – off – on on on on on on – off

repeating

1. After resetting

power, check if it is

running normal

4

circuit overcurrent error

If the same symptom arises after the first action, replace PCB

If the same symptom

arises after the

second action,

replace compressor

LED seven- time repetiton


on on on on on on on – off – on on on on on onon – off repeating

1.After resetting

power, check if it is

5

PCB part defect (IPM)

running normal

2. If the same symptom arises after the first action,

replace PCB

  • How to check the Fan-Error

(1) EBR650027

After sending a signal to the fan, the MICOM checks the BLDC fan motor s lock status. If there is no feedback signal from the BLDC fan, the fan motor stops for 10 seconds and then is powered again for 15 seconds. To determine that there is a fan motor malfunction,

this process is repeated 3 times. If the fan motor is determined to be defective, the error code will be shown in the display for 30 minutes.

At this point, the process will be repeated until the fan motor operates normally. If normal operation is achieved, the error display is erased and the MICOM is reset automatically.


  • COMPONENT TESTING INFORMATION    

  • Defrost Controller Assembly

Function

  • Controller assembly is consist of 2 kinds of part those are fuse-m and sensor. we can decide part is defect or not when we check the resistance.
  • Fuse-m can cut off the source when defrost heater operate the unusual high temperature.
  • Sensor give temperature information to Micom

How to Measure (Fuse-M)

(1) to (2)

Set a ohmmeter to the 2 housing pin. Measure the 2 pin connected to Fuse-M. If the ohmmeter indicate below 0.1ohm fuse-m is a good condition, But infinitely great ohm Fuse-M is disconnection

How to Measure (Sensor)

(1) to (2)

Set a ohmmeter to The 2housing pin. Measure the 2 pin connected to Sensor. If the ohmmeter indicate
(at room temperature) Sensor is not a defect.

When check the ohm at other temperature Check the sensor manual.

Standard

Fuse-M (at all temperature)


Sensor (at room temperature)



  • Sheath Heater

Function

Sheath heater is a part for defrost. All heating wire is connected to only one line. So we can decide part is defect or not when we check the resistance.

How to Measure

    

(1) (2)

Set a ohmmeter connect to The 2 housing pin. Measure the 2 pin connected to Sheath Heater.

If the ohmmeter indicate (V°øV)/Watt=R is good condition, ex) when watt=350w, voltage=115v R=(115°ø115)/350=38
But the ohmmeter indicate infinitely great

Sheath heater is disconnection

Standard

Sheath heater (at all temperature)



  • Door Heater Assembly
Function

The heater is

designed

to

prevent

the raising dew from door.

How to
Measure

1

    

3

2

    

6

4

5

7

8

9

Standard


  • Door Switch

Function

The switch sense if the door open or close.

  • When the door open, lamp on.
  • When the door open, the switch give information to Micom.

When the door open, internal contact operate on and off moving plunger of door switch up and down.

How to Measure

<Switch, Freezer>    <Switch, Refrigerator>

Button (Plunger)

1    2    3    4    1    2    3    4

3    4    2    1

Beep    Beep

Check the resistance between connectors 1, 2 and 3, 4 .It means check whether or not applying an electric current. If there is resistance, it means the switch not inferiority

Standard

Multimeter beep – Switch F,R

    


  • Dispenser DC Motor

Function

– Dispenser DC Motor : When customer push the dispenser button, Pull duct door and abstract from ice bank.

How to Measure

(1)

(2)

Dispensor DC Motor

Standard

Dispenser DC Motor



  • AC Motor ASSEMBLY

Function

The In-door motor of AC motor assembly pushes ices to the dispenser.

How to Measure

< In-door Motor >    < In-door Motor >

  • Take out the male    1 Take out the male housing from        housing from

    female housing    female housing

  • Measure the    2 Measure the resistance between        resistance between

    (1) and (2)    (1) and (3)

(1)    (2)

(1)    (3)

Check the resistance between connectors (In-door motor 1, 2) and (In-door motor 1, 3). It means check whether or not applying an Electric current. If there is resistance, it means the geared motor or solenoid is not inferiority

Standard

Geared Motor    Cube Solenoid

    


  • Damper

Function

The damper supplies the cold air at freezer room to chillroom by using the damper’s plate. Chillroom is colder than before when damper’s plate is open. When damper’s plate is close, chillroom’s temperature will rise.

How to Measure

             

< Damper Circuit >

1    Blue    1    Blue

  • Red

3    White

  • White

3 Yellow    Check the    1 , 3

< extension >


Check the 2 , 4    Check the    1 , 3

Check the resistance between connectors 1,3 and 2,4 .It means check whether or not applying an electric current. If there is resistance, it means the damper not inferiority

Standard

Damper

    


  • Lamp Socket

Function

The lamp socket connect cover lamp assembly to lamp.

The lamp socket fix lamp and unite lamp and cover lamp assembly. The lamp socket supply electric source to lamp also.

How to Measure

(1)    (2)

(3)    (4)

Check the resistance between connector of housing and connector of lamp socket. It means check whether or not applying an electric current.

If there is resistance it means the lamp socket is not inferiority.

Standard


  • Flow Sensor

Function

Flow Sensor (in machine room)

Count the water quantity from city water to water filter in refrigerator

How to Measure


Flow Sensor (in machine room)

Standard

  • TROUBLESHOOTING    
  • INFORMATION OF LINEAR COMPRESSOR

The information tag provides compressor model, refrigerant, serial number and safety approval

Compressor Label


Name Plate

Size : 90mm X 20mm

There are two types of controllers used in the linear compressor system.

  • The “E”-inverter system is used with the FC75LANE compressor.
  • The “A”-inverter system is used with the FC90LANA compressor.

Refrigerator

Comp Drive

Compressor

FC75LANE

E-Inverter System

FC90LANA

A-Inverter System

*VVVF : Variable Voltage Variable Frequency

**CVCF : Constant Voltage Constant Frequency


To reduce noise level, the piston stroke is slowly increased to full power during start up.

Step 1) Start up – Half stroke interval for first 30 seconds.

Step 2) Ramp up – Stroke increases every 0.8sec until maximum stroke length is reached (about 3 min, 15 sec)

Step 3) CVCF interval – 180V / 60Hz


Step 1) Start up – Half stroke interval for first 20 seconds.

Step 2) Ramp up – Stroke increases until maximum stroke length is reached (about 1 min, 40 sec)

Step 3) VVVF interval – target voltage and frequency controlled by Control Board signals

There are 6 protection logics designed to protect the linear compressor system. When a failure is detected, the compressor will shut and will try to restart after a set period of time for each type of failure. The LED located on the inverter drive PCB will flash the appropriate code to indicate the detected failure. This code will continue to flash until the unit is disconnected from the power source.

Inverter Error Codes

App.RequirementWaiting TimeThe number of LED flashesFCT0A-Inv.Compressor current and voltage error.20 sec.1Stroke TripE-Inv.
A-Inv.Piston stroke overrun detected.1 min.2Locked Piston TripE-Inv.
A-Inv.Piston is locked.2 min. 30 sec.5Current TripE-Inv.
A-Inv.Current overload detected.2 min. 30 sec.6IPM FaultE-Inv.
A-Inv.High current detected due to IPM failure.2 min. 30 sec.7Communication ErrorA-Inv.Miscommunication with Refrigerator08

Bridge Diodes converts 115V AC (Alternating current) to 115V DC (Direct current) The Voltage Multiplying circuit then increases the 115V DC to 230V DC.

Then the IPM (Intelligent Power Module) converts the 230V DC to 230V AC.

The converted AC power can be regulated to any required voltage and frequency.

    

There are two PCB located behind the PCB cover. One is the main PCB, and the other is the driver PCB the linear compressor.

A-Inverter FC90LANA

Measure the voltage at locations on the connector (as shown picture) with a multi-tester.


IPM Voltage Check

To ensure proper diagnosis, make sure that the unit has been plugged in for at least 10 min.

To determine if the compressor is receiving the proper voltage, check the PCB output voltage during operation.

Normal operating voltage will be between 80V AC and 180V AC.

Note : Higher voltage readings may occur under “heavy” load conditions.

Insulation check : Check for infinite Ohms between all compressor terminal and ground.


LG Linear Compressor

NOTE : Any Terminal to Ground should read Inf ( ~ )

Inf (~)    

6 ~ 8     6 ~ 8     Inf (~)

GN

GND


  • SERVICE DIAGNOSIS CHART

COMPLAINT

POINTS TO BE CHECKED

REMEDY

No Cooling.
  • Is the power cord unplugged from the outlet?
  • Check if the power switch is set to OFF.
  • Check if the fuse of the power switch is shorted.
  • Measure the voltage of the power outlet.
  • Plug into the outlet.
  • Set the switch to ON.
  • Replace the fuse.
  • If the voltage is low, correct the wiring.
Cools poorly.
  • Check if the unit is placed too close to the wall.
  • Check if the unit is placed too close to the stove, gas cooker, or in direct sunlight.
  • Is the ambient temperature too high or the room door closed?
  • Check if food put in the refrigerator is hot.
  • Did you open the door of the unit too often or check if the door is sealed properly?
  • Check if the Control is set to Warm position.
  • Place the unit about 4 inches (10 cm) from the wall.
  • Place the unit away from these heat sources.
  • Lower the ambient temperature.
  • Put in foods after they have cooled down.
  • Don’t open the door too often and close it firmly.
  • Set the control to Recommended position.
Food in the Refrigerator is frozen.
  • Is food placed in the cooling air outlet?
  • Check if the control is set to colder position.
  • Is the ambient temperature below 41°F(5°C)?
  • Place foods in the high-temperature section. (front part)
  • Set the control to Recommended position.
  • Set the control to Warm position.
Condensation or ice forms inside the unit.
  • Is liquid food sealed?
  • Check if food put in the refrigerator is hot.
  • Did you open the door of the unit too often or check if the door is sealed properly?
  • Seal liquid foods with wrap.
  • Put in foods after they have cooled down.
  • Don’t open the door too often and close it firmly.
Condensation forms in the Exterior Case.
  • Check if the ambient temperature and humidity of the surrounding air are high.
  • Is there a gap in the door gasket?
  • Wipe moisture with a dry cloth. It will disappear in low temperature and humidity.
  • Fill up the gap.
There is abnormal noise.
  • Is the unit positioned in a firm and even place?
  • Are any unnecessary objects placed in the back side of the unit?
  • Check if the Drip Tray is not firmly fixed.
  • Check if the cover of the compressor enclosure in the lower front side is taken out.
  • Adjust the Leveling Screw, and position the refrigerator in a firm place.
  • Remove the objects.
  • Fix the Drip Tray firmly in the original position.
  • Place the cover in its original position.
Door does not close well.
  • Check if the door gasket is dirty with an item like juice.
  • Is the refrigerator level?
  • Is there too much food in the refrigerator?
  • Clean the door gasket.
  • Position in a firm place and level the Leveling Screw.
  • Make sure food stored in shelves does not prevent the door from closing.
Ice and foods smell unpleasant.
  • Check if the inside of the unit is dirty.
  • Are foods with a strong odor unwrapped?
  • The unit smells of plastic.
  • Clean the inside of the unit.
  • Wrap foods that have a strong odor.
  • New products smell of plastic, but this will go away after 1-2 weeks.

Other possible problems:

Check if frost forms in the freezer.

Not defrosting

Check Components of the defrosting circuit.

Check the refrigeration system.

The system is faulty.

Perform sealed system repair.

Check the Thermistor.

The operation of the Thermistor is incorrect.

Replace the Thermistor.

  • REFRIGERATION CYCLE

Troubleshooting Chart

CAUSE

STATE OF THE UNIT

STATE OF THE EVAPORATOR

TEMPERATURE OF THE COMPRESSOR

REMARKS

LEAKAGE

PARTIAL LEAKAGE

Freezer compartment and Refrigerator don’t cool normally.

Low flowing sound of Refrigerant is heard and frost forms in inlet only.

A little higher than ambient temperature.

  • Refrigerant level is low due to a leak.
  • Normal cooling is possible by restoring the normal amount of refrigerant and repairing the leak.

COMPLETE LEAKAGE

Freezer compartment and Refrigerator don’t cool normally.

Flowing sound of refrigerant is not heard and frost isn’t formed.

Equal to ambient temperature.

  • No discharging of Refrigerant.
  • Normal cooling is possible by restoring the normal amount of refrigerant and repairing the leak.

CLOGGED BY DUST

PARTIAL CLOG

Freezer compartment and Refrigerator don’t cool normally.

Flowing sound of refrigerant is heard and frost forms in inlet only.

A little higher than ambient temperature.

  • Normal discharging of the refrigerant.
  • The capillary tube is faulty.

WHOLE CLOG

Freezer compartment and Refrigerator don’t cool.

Flowing sound of refrigerant is not heard and frost isn’t formed.

Equal to ambient temperature.

  • Normal discharging of the Refrigerant.
MOISTURE CLOG

Cooling operation stops periodically.

Flowing sound of refrigerant is not heard and frost melts.

Lower than ambient temperature.

  • Cooling operation restarts when heating the inlet of the capillary tube.
DEFECTIVE COMPRESSION

COMP- RESSION

Freezer and Refrigerator don’t cool.

Low flowing sound of refrigerant is heard and frost forms in inlet only.

A little higher than ambient temperature.

  • Low pressure at high side of compressor due to low refrigerant level.

NO COMP- RESSION

No compressing operation.

Flowing sound of refrigerant is not heard and there is no frost.

Equal to ambient temperature.

  • No pressure in the high pressure part of the compressor.
  • Cleaning

There is no need for routine condenser cleaning in normal Home operating environments. If the environment is particularly greasy or dusty, or there is significant pet traffic in the home, the condenser should be cleaned every 2 to 3 months to ensure maximum efficiency.

If you need to clean the condenser: Remove the mechanical cover.

Use a vacuum cleaner with a soft brush to clean the grille, the open areas behind the grille and the front surface area of the condenser.

Replace the mechanical cover.

  • SEALED SYSTEM DIAGNOSIS


(The equalization test is trying to restart a compressor using a start kit after it has been operating.)

  • ICEMAKER OPERATING METHOD AND TROUBLE SHOOTING

  • Icemaker’s Basic Operating Method
  • Adjusts Ice Tray to Start Position with power on.
  • Waits until water becomes ice.

    For cold air circulation, Ice tray will be on a slightly tilt one hour after

    ice-making mode begins. Atilt ice tray means icemaker’s normal operation.

  • If water becomes ices in the ice tray, Ice-detecting sensor check if the ice bin is full.
  • Twist the ice tray to drop ice into the ICE BIN.
  • Supply water to the ice tray by operating the solenoid valve.
  • To force water to supply to the ice tray, or check icemaker’s condition press and hold the FILL Key for about 3seconds.

    In the test mode, The icemaker will run through 3 stages step by step

    : Harvest
    Fill water
    Ice making

To reset the icemaker’s operation, set the power switch OFF position and back it to ON position.

Power Switch

Icemaker Unit

  • ICE MAKER FUNCTIONS
  • Icemaking Mode
  • Icemaking Mode begins right after the ice tray fills with water.
  • Icemaker waits until water becomes ice in the ice tray.
    Ice-detecting sensor checks if the ice bin is full every 2min.
    • Harvest Mode

    At least in 110min, since icemaker begun icemaking mode, Icemaker starts to twist the ice tray to drop ices into the Ice bin. (After installation, at least 1day is needed to make ices)


    If the icemaker never drop ices to the ice bin though water becomes ices in the ice tray, check the real temperature of compartment. (not temperature on display)

    Icemaker needs below 0°F to drop ices to ice bin.

  • Fill/Park Position

Once the normal harvest mode has been completed, the water solenoid will be activated.

  • Trouble Shooting Ice & Water system Issues

  • Icemaker not making ice or not making enough ice (Environmental Diagnosis)


Icemaker can’t make ices itself. Basically, water, temperature and time are needed.

  • Water : If no Water, then no Ice.
  • Temperature : The compartment, where the icemaker is located, has to be at least 1°F so that icemaker dumps ices to the bin.
  • Time : At least 80 minutes must be passed to make one series of ices after water comes into icemaker.

Test Mode should not be carried out before checking below.

Not making ice

er

Is the icemaker’s tray filled with water or Ice?

No

emperature

Yes

Is the temperature below 10 degrees F in the icemaker compartment.

No

ime

Yes

Advise the customer on how long it takes to make ice.

No

  • Depending on the temperature settings, door openings and ambient temperatures it will tak betwee 90 and 120 minutes to make 1 batch of ice (12 cubes).
  • I take approximately 24 hours to fill the ice container.
  • Icemaker not making ice or not making enough ice (Icemaker Unit & Ice-detecting sensor Diagnosis)


Icemaker Unit and Ice-detecting sensor Diagnosis

The icemaker unit and Ice-detecting sensor is programmed to be diagnosed.

Follow the procedure step by step to check to see if icemaker and Ice-detecting sensor is working normally.

Icemaker Unit

Ice-detecting sensor

Test Switch

1stSTEP (Icemaker Unit Diagnosis)

Press the test switch (located on the bottom of the icemaker head) for about 3 seconds. The icemaker tray should turn to the twisting position and return to the flat position, the fills with water.


CAUTION: Be sure that the ice tray is not filled with water before pressing fill key.

2stSTEP (Ice-detecting sensor Diagnosis)




  • Icemaker not making ice or not making enough ice (Other Suspected Items)

Strongly suspect items below If the issue remains yet, though all the diagnosis for icemaker has been carried out.

  • Cap duct bad sealing
  • Defective thermal sensor in the icemaker compartment
  • Not cold icemaker compartment area (sealed system)
  • Not Dispensing Ice


Clogged Ice In the Ice Bin (suspected items)

  • Customer haven’t used ice dispenser over a week.


    Resolution : the ices gets stuck if customer doesn’t use ice dispenser.

    In this case, empty the ice bin and wait until the new ices are stacked in the ice bin.

  • Temperature of icemaker compartment is not cold enough.


    Resolution : Check ice fan, sealed system, cap duct, vent and other items related to temperature.

  • Cap duct doesn’t seal the air properly.


    Resolution : Possibly, warm air could get into the compartment and make ices get stuck. Replace the cap duct with new one.

  • In-door geared motor doesn’t work


    Resolution : Change the in-door geared motor and test it.

  • The water comes out of fill cup and the water get into the ice bin.


    Resolution : The water pressure from shutoff valve is too high.

    Recommend to use regulator to the customer and close the shutoff valve slightly.


Clogged Ices In the Chute (suspected items)

  • Cap duct doesn’t seal the air properly.


    Resolution : Possibly, warm air could get into the compartment and make ices get stuck. Replace the cap duct with new one.

  • DESCRIPTION OF FUNCTION & CIRCUIT OF MICOM
  • FUNCTION

  • Function
  • When the appliance is plugged in, it is set to 37°F for Refrigerator and 0°F for freezer.

    You can adjust the Refrigerator and the Freezer control temperature by pressing the ADJUST button.

  • When the power is initially applied or restored after a power failure, it is set to Control temperature Previously.
  • If you do not press any button after turning on the power, only the water, Ice type, lock Icon that has been selected will be turned on and all other LEDs on the Dispenser Panel will be turned off Within 60 seconds. (Power Save Mode)
  • If you press a button, only the water, Ice type, lock Icon that has been selected will be turned on and all other LEDs on the Dispenser Panel will be turned off Within 20 seconds. (Power Save Mode)


  • If you do not want to use the Power Save Mode, you can change the Mode by pressing the ULTRA ICE Button and Freezer TEMP button simultaneously for more than 5 seconds.
  • How to Toggle the Display between °F & °C

1. The initial setting is °F and the display temperature mode can be changed from °F to °C or °C to °F by pressing and holding the FRZ TEMP and the REF TEMP keys at the same time for over 5 seconds.

  • Alarm/Lock function (dispenser and display button lock)

  • When the refrigerator is first turned on, the buttons are not locked. “LOCK” is deactivated with light off.
  • To lock the display, the dispenser, and the control panel, press

    and hold the LOCK button for 3 seconds. “LOCK” is activated with light on.

  • The LOCK button is the only control feature that remains active in the locked state. The buzzer sound, other control buttons, and the dispenser are deactivated.
  • To release from the locked state, press and hold the LOCK button again for 3 seconds.
  • If you don t hold the Alarm/Lock button more than 3 seconds,

    Alarm function will be changed and alarm for opened door will be on/off same as alarm icon indicating.

Ex) In selecting “LOCK”

Ex) In selecting “LOCK” again

  • Filter condition display function

  • There is a replacement indicator light for the filter cartridge on the dispenser.
  • Water filter needs replacement once six months or of using water filter.
  • When the Water Filter Icon lights on, you must exchange the filter.
  • After replacing the filter, press and hold the lock button for more than 3 seconds .

    After then water Filter icon turn off with reset status.

Classification

Filter Status Display

  • Ultra Ice selection

Please select this function for quick freezing.

  • When you press the Ultra Ice Button, the Ultra ICE ICON will be turned on again.
  • Ultra Ice function automatically turns off after a fixed time passes.
  • Dispenser use selection

You can select water or ice.

  • When you press the Water Button, the Water Icon will be selected.
  • When you press the Ice button, the Cube/Crush ICON will be selected in order.
  • Hold your cup in the dispenser for a few seconds after dispensing ice or water to allow the last pieoes of ice or drops of water to fall into the cup.
  • When after initially establ ishing the water comes out, the water tank inside fills and until at the time of quality the hour is caught.
  • DISPENSER LIGHT

– Whenever pressed the LIGHT button, DISPLAY is changed as belows.


Normal status : Ambient Light is off.

AUTO status : Detecting the lighting of room by LIGHT SENSOR, Ambient Light is on and off automatically. ON status : Ambient Light is on continuously.

For all status : When dispenser is operated, DISPENSER LIGHT is on.

  • CONTROL OF FREEZER FAN MOTOR

  • Freezer fan motor has high and standard speeds.
  • High speed is used at power-up, for Ultra Ice, and when refrigerator is overloaded. Standard speeds is used for general purposes.
  • To improve cooling speed, the RPM of the freezer fan motor change from normal speed to high.
  • High speed (2700RPM) : Initial power on or load corresponding operation, Ultra Ice. Normal speed (2400RPM) : General working conditions.
  • Cooling Fan Motor

  • The cooling fan is switched ON and OFF in conjunction with the compressor.
  • The cooling fan Motor has high and standard speeds. (When room temper rapture more high then 38°C speed is high)
  • The Failure sensing method is the same as in the fan motor of the freezing fan motor(refer to failure diagnosis function table for failure display).
    • Ice Compartment Fan

  • The Icing Fan is controlled by the the sensor on the top of the ice compartment.
  • The Failure sensing method is the same as in the fan motor of the freezer (refer to failure diagnosis function table for failure display)
  • Refrigeration room Fan Motor

  • The refrigeration room fan is switched ON and OFF in conjunction with the refrigeration room temperature.
  • The Failure sensing method is the same as in the fan motor of the freezing fan motor (refer to failure diagnosis function table for failure display).
  • Ultra ICE

  • The purpose of this function is to intensify the cooling speed of freezer and to increase the amount of ice.
  • Whenever selection switch is pressed, selection/release, the Icon will turn ON or OFF.
  • If there is a power outage and the refrigerator is powered on again, Ultra ICE will be canceled.
  • To activate this function, press the Ultra ICE key and the Icon will turn ON. This function will remain activated for 24 hrs. The first one hours the compressor, Freezer Fan and Icing Fan(high speed) will be ON. The next 23 hours the Ice room will be controlled at the lowest temperature. And icing fan run high speed. After 24 hours or if the Ultra ICE key is pressed again, the Ice room will return to its previous temperature. And icing fan run standard speed.
  • During the first 1 hours :
    • Compressor, Freezer Fan and Icing Fan(high speed) run continuously.
    • If a defrost cycle begins during the first 30 minutes of Ultra ICE, the Ultra ICE cycle will complete its cycle after defrosting has ended.

    If the defrost cycle begins when Ultra ICE has run for more than 30 minutes, Ultra ICE will run for 40 minutes after the defrost is completed.

    • If Ultra ICE is pressed during defrost, Ultra ICE Icon is on but this function will start seven minutes after defrost is completed and it shall operate for one hours.
    • If Ultra Ice is selected within seven minutes after compressor has stopped, the compressor (compressor delays seven minutes) shall start after the balance of the delay time.
  • For the rest of the 23 hours, the Ice room will be controlled at the lowest temperature. And icing fan run high speed.
  • How to set the display mode and cancel it

  • With the refrigerator door open, keep pressing the Refrigerator Temp Button and ULTRA ICE Button more than 5 seconds, then it goes to the display mode with Special Beep Sound.
  • Perform the same way again to cancel the display mode.
  • All freezing units do not work at the display mode.
  • Energy Saver

  • If you want additional power save, you can turn on energy saver (some heater off for anti-dew).
  • To turn on or off the energy saver function, press Energy Saver Button for more than 3 seconds.
  • We recommend using energy saver function when you go out for quite a long time and are out of the rainy season.
Pillar Heater Off

Pillar Heater On

  • Defrosting (removing frost)
  • Defrosting starts each time the COMPRESSOR running time Betwee 7~50 hours.
  • For initial power on or for restoring power, defrosting starts when the compressor running time reaches 4 hours.
  • Defrosting stops if the sensor temperature reaches 46.4°F(8°C) or more. If the sensor doesn’t reach 46.4°F(8°C) in 1 hours, the defrost mode is malfunctioning. (Refer to the defect diagnosis function, 8-1-15.)
  • Defrosting won’t function if its sensor is defective (wires are cut or short circuited)
  • Defect Diagnosis Function

  • Automatic diagnosis makes servicing the refrigerator easy.
  • When a defect occurs, the buttons will not operate; but the tones. such as ding. will sound.
  • When the defect CODE removes the sign, it returns to normal operation (RESET).
  • The defect CODE shows on the Refrigerator and Freezer Display.


  • LED check function: If simultaneously pressing Ultra Ice button and freezing temperature adjustment button for a second, display LED graphics on. If releasing the button, the LED graphic displays the previous status.

    You can check the error code Within 3-hour Period from initial error

  • Auto pantry

  • The temperature control will automatically start upon the selected Auto Pantry temperature control.
  • You can adjust the Pantry control with three different temperature ranges by pressing the activate button.

    



                        


    






                        


                        


                        


                        


    






                        


CASE PARTS

CAUTION : Use the part number to order the part, not the position number.

603E

603C

626A

624E

624D

207B

S03

402A

503E

503D

S11

S01

624C    

500P

624A

503G

409D

501F

S02

S01

103A

103B

207A

S03

402A

B01

271B

120A

158A

S11

501G

610D

B01

406D

405G

329B

145A

120C    282G

120B

405E

411A

500A

410J

500H

313A

S02

271D    S10

145B

S11

262B

405D

404B

405C

405H

405F

405I

282F

S11

262H

406B

B02

S14

302B

400A

316A

314A

300A

318A

105A

317A

303A

304A

249D

S14

B02    249C

106A

408A

316B

310B

312A

309B    329C

420A

323B

410G

312C

106A

290A

315B

145G

409B

503F

405H

405F

404A

405C

405B

329A

332C

319C S20

319A

315C

315A

407A

610C

315C

315B

103C


S17

B04


                        


                        


                        


                        


                        


                        


                        


                        


                        


                        


                        


                        


                        


                        


                        


                        


                        


                        


                        


                        


                        


                        


                        



                        


                        


                        


                        


                        


                        


                        


                        


                        


                        


                        


                        


                        


                        


                        


                        


                        


                        


                        


                        


                    


                        


                        


                        


                        


FREEZER PARTS

CAUTION : Use the part number to order part, not the position number.

133B

133B

145C

131A

136C

136B

133B

133A

132P

145F    237C

136A


REFRIGERATOR PARTS

CAUTION : Use the part number to order part, not the position number.

141A

141A

            

141A

141A

            

141D

154A

151A

161C

161B

151B

146E

161A

162B

145D

162A


DOOR PARTS

CAUTION : Use the part number to order part, not the position number.

230B

241K

241A

230A

231B

233B

241C

241B

233A

231A

235A

212G

241K

B06

B06

241D

241G

241D

312B

243C

B06

241E

B06

243D

262C

243B

244A

615A

619B

603B

603C

244A

243A

262E    262C

250A

250H

250F

250B

250B

200A

249P

201A

249E

B06

B06    212D

249J


203A

249F

249K


                        


                        


                        


                        


                        


                        


                        


                        


                        


                        


                        


                        


                        






                        

                        


                        


                        

                        


                        


                        

                        

                        


                        


                        

                        

ICE MAKER & ICE BANK PARTS

630J

630J

612A

630F

630B

600A

611A

630C

630A

606A

630E

630D

630H

630Q

630G


– 10 –

REFRIGERATOR SERVICE MANUAL PDF =